blob: 7b5ee655c76519cc988fd555f023485841525586 [file] [log] [blame]
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001 ----------------------
Willy Tarreau8317b282014-04-23 01:49:41 +02002 HAProxy
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02003 Configuration Manual
4 ----------------------
Willy Tarreau1db55792020-11-05 17:20:35 +01005 version 2.4
Willy Tarreaud1756702023-08-19 11:25:53 +02006 2023/08/19
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02007
8
9This document covers the configuration language as implemented in the version
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010specified above. It does not provide any hints, examples, or advice. For such
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010011documentation, please refer to the Reference Manual or the Architecture Manual.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012The summary below is meant to help you find sections by name and navigate
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020013through the document.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020014
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020015Note to documentation contributors :
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040016 This document is formatted with 80 columns per line, with even number of
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020017 spaces for indentation and without tabs. Please follow these rules strictly
18 so that it remains easily printable everywhere. If a line needs to be
19 printed verbatim and does not fit, please end each line with a backslash
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020020 ('\') and continue on next line, indented by two characters. It is also
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010021 sometimes useful to prefix all output lines (logs, console outputs) with 3
22 closing angle brackets ('>>>') in order to emphasize the difference between
23 inputs and outputs when they may be ambiguous. If you add sections,
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020024 please update the summary below for easier searching.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020025
26
27Summary
28-------
29
301. Quick reminder about HTTP
311.1. The HTTP transaction model
321.2. HTTP request
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100331.2.1. The request line
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200341.2.2. The request headers
351.3. HTTP response
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100361.3.1. The response line
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200371.3.2. The response headers
38
392. Configuring HAProxy
402.1. Configuration file format
William Lallemandf9873ba2015-05-05 17:37:14 +0200412.2. Quoting and escaping
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +0200422.3. Environment variables
Willy Tarreau4b103022021-02-12 17:59:10 +0100432.4. Conditional blocks
442.5. Time format
Daniel Epperson07ff2fb2023-05-15 12:45:27 -0700452.6. Size format
462.7. Examples
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020047
483. Global parameters
493.1. Process management and security
503.2. Performance tuning
513.3. Debugging
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +0100523.4. Userlists
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +0200533.5. Peers
Cyril Bonté307ee1e2015-09-28 23:16:06 +0200543.6. Mailers
William Lallemandc9515522019-06-12 16:32:11 +0200553.7. Programs
Christopher Faulet76edc0f2020-01-13 15:52:01 +0100563.8. HTTP-errors
Emeric Brun99c453d2020-05-25 15:01:04 +0200573.9. Rings
William Lallemand0217b7b2020-11-18 10:41:24 +0100583.10. Log forwarding
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020059
604. Proxies
614.1. Proxy keywords matrix
624.2. Alphabetically sorted keywords reference
63
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100645. Bind and server options
Willy Tarreau086fbf52012-09-24 20:34:51 +0200655.1. Bind options
665.2. Server and default-server options
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +0200675.3. Server DNS resolution
685.3.1. Global overview
695.3.2. The resolvers section
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020070
Julien Pivotto6ccee412019-11-27 15:49:54 +0100716. Cache
726.1. Limitation
736.2. Setup
746.2.1. Cache section
756.2.2. Proxy section
76
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200777. Using ACLs and fetching samples
787.1. ACL basics
797.1.1. Matching booleans
807.1.2. Matching integers
817.1.3. Matching strings
827.1.4. Matching regular expressions (regexes)
837.1.5. Matching arbitrary data blocks
847.1.6. Matching IPv4 and IPv6 addresses
857.2. Using ACLs to form conditions
867.3. Fetching samples
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +0200877.3.1. Converters
887.3.2. Fetching samples from internal states
897.3.3. Fetching samples at Layer 4
907.3.4. Fetching samples at Layer 5
917.3.5. Fetching samples from buffer contents (Layer 6)
927.3.6. Fetching HTTP samples (Layer 7)
Christopher Faulete596d182020-05-05 17:46:34 +0200937.3.7. Fetching samples for developers
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200947.4. Pre-defined ACLs
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020095
968. Logging
978.1. Log levels
988.2. Log formats
998.2.1. Default log format
1008.2.2. TCP log format
1018.2.3. HTTP log format
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +01001028.2.4. Custom log format
Willy Tarreau5f51e1a2012-12-03 18:40:10 +01001038.2.5. Error log format
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02001048.3. Advanced logging options
1058.3.1. Disabling logging of external tests
1068.3.2. Logging before waiting for the session to terminate
1078.3.3. Raising log level upon errors
1088.3.4. Disabling logging of successful connections
1098.4. Timing events
1108.5. Session state at disconnection
1118.6. Non-printable characters
1128.7. Capturing HTTP cookies
1138.8. Capturing HTTP headers
1148.9. Examples of logs
115
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +02001169. Supported filters
1179.1. Trace
1189.2. HTTP compression
Christopher Fauletf7e4e7e2016-10-27 22:29:49 +02001199.3. Stream Processing Offload Engine (SPOE)
Christopher Faulet99a17a22018-12-11 09:18:27 +01001209.4. Cache
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +02001219.5. fcgi-app
Miroslav Zagoracdc32cd92020-12-13 18:32:57 +01001229.6. OpenTracing
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +0200123
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +020012410. FastCGI applications
12510.1. Setup
12610.1.1. Fcgi-app section
12710.1.2. Proxy section
12810.1.3. Example
12910.2. Default parameters
13010.3. Limitations
131
Emeric Brunce325c42021-04-02 17:05:09 +020013211. Address formats
13311.1. Address family prefixes
13411.2. Socket type prefixes
13511.3. Protocol prefixes
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200136
1371. Quick reminder about HTTP
138----------------------------
139
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100140When HAProxy is running in HTTP mode, both the request and the response are
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200141fully analyzed and indexed, thus it becomes possible to build matching criteria
142on almost anything found in the contents.
143
144However, it is important to understand how HTTP requests and responses are
145formed, and how HAProxy decomposes them. It will then become easier to write
146correct rules and to debug existing configurations.
147
148
1491.1. The HTTP transaction model
150-------------------------------
151
152The HTTP protocol is transaction-driven. This means that each request will lead
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +0100153to one and only one response. Traditionally, a TCP connection is established
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100154from the client to the server, a request is sent by the client through the
155connection, the server responds, and the connection is closed. A new request
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200156will involve a new connection :
157
158 [CON1] [REQ1] ... [RESP1] [CLO1] [CON2] [REQ2] ... [RESP2] [CLO2] ...
159
160In this mode, called the "HTTP close" mode, there are as many connection
161establishments as there are HTTP transactions. Since the connection is closed
162by the server after the response, the client does not need to know the content
163length.
164
165Due to the transactional nature of the protocol, it was possible to improve it
166to avoid closing a connection between two subsequent transactions. In this mode
167however, it is mandatory that the server indicates the content length for each
168response so that the client does not wait indefinitely. For this, a special
169header is used: "Content-length". This mode is called the "keep-alive" mode :
170
171 [CON] [REQ1] ... [RESP1] [REQ2] ... [RESP2] [CLO] ...
172
173Its advantages are a reduced latency between transactions, and less processing
174power required on the server side. It is generally better than the close mode,
175but not always because the clients often limit their concurrent connections to
Patrick Mezard9ec2ec42010-06-12 17:02:45 +0200176a smaller value.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200177
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +0100178Another improvement in the communications is the pipelining mode. It still uses
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200179keep-alive, but the client does not wait for the first response to send the
180second request. This is useful for fetching large number of images composing a
181page :
182
183 [CON] [REQ1] [REQ2] ... [RESP1] [RESP2] [CLO] ...
184
185This can obviously have a tremendous benefit on performance because the network
186latency is eliminated between subsequent requests. Many HTTP agents do not
187correctly support pipelining since there is no way to associate a response with
188the corresponding request in HTTP. For this reason, it is mandatory for the
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +0100189server to reply in the exact same order as the requests were received.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200190
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +0100191The next improvement is the multiplexed mode, as implemented in HTTP/2. This
192time, each transaction is assigned a single stream identifier, and all streams
193are multiplexed over an existing connection. Many requests can be sent in
194parallel by the client, and responses can arrive in any order since they also
195carry the stream identifier.
196
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +0100197By default HAProxy operates in keep-alive mode with regards to persistent
198connections: for each connection it processes each request and response, and
199leaves the connection idle on both sides between the end of a response and the
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +0100200start of a new request. When it receives HTTP/2 connections from a client, it
201processes all the requests in parallel and leaves the connection idling,
202waiting for new requests, just as if it was a keep-alive HTTP connection.
Patrick Mezard9ec2ec42010-06-12 17:02:45 +0200203
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +0200204HAProxy supports 4 connection modes :
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +0100205 - keep alive : all requests and responses are processed (default)
206 - tunnel : only the first request and response are processed,
Christopher Faulet6c9bbb22019-03-26 21:37:23 +0100207 everything else is forwarded with no analysis (deprecated).
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +0100208 - server close : the server-facing connection is closed after the response.
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +0200209 - close : the connection is actively closed after end of response.
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +0100210
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +0100211
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200212
2131.2. HTTP request
214-----------------
215
216First, let's consider this HTTP request :
217
218 Line Contents
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100219 number
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200220 1 GET /serv/login.php?lang=en&profile=2 HTTP/1.1
221 2 Host: www.mydomain.com
222 3 User-agent: my small browser
223 4 Accept: image/jpeg, image/gif
224 5 Accept: image/png
225
226
2271.2.1. The Request line
228-----------------------
229
230Line 1 is the "request line". It is always composed of 3 fields :
231
232 - a METHOD : GET
233 - a URI : /serv/login.php?lang=en&profile=2
234 - a version tag : HTTP/1.1
235
236All of them are delimited by what the standard calls LWS (linear white spaces),
237which are commonly spaces, but can also be tabs or line feeds/carriage returns
238followed by spaces/tabs. The method itself cannot contain any colon (':') and
239is limited to alphabetic letters. All those various combinations make it
240desirable that HAProxy performs the splitting itself rather than leaving it to
241the user to write a complex or inaccurate regular expression.
242
243The URI itself can have several forms :
244
245 - A "relative URI" :
246
247 /serv/login.php?lang=en&profile=2
248
249 It is a complete URL without the host part. This is generally what is
250 received by servers, reverse proxies and transparent proxies.
251
252 - An "absolute URI", also called a "URL" :
253
254 http://192.168.0.12:8080/serv/login.php?lang=en&profile=2
255
256 It is composed of a "scheme" (the protocol name followed by '://'), a host
257 name or address, optionally a colon (':') followed by a port number, then
258 a relative URI beginning at the first slash ('/') after the address part.
259 This is generally what proxies receive, but a server supporting HTTP/1.1
260 must accept this form too.
261
262 - a star ('*') : this form is only accepted in association with the OPTIONS
263 method and is not relayable. It is used to inquiry a next hop's
264 capabilities.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100265
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200266 - an address:port combination : 192.168.0.12:80
267 This is used with the CONNECT method, which is used to establish TCP
268 tunnels through HTTP proxies, generally for HTTPS, but sometimes for
269 other protocols too.
270
271In a relative URI, two sub-parts are identified. The part before the question
272mark is called the "path". It is typically the relative path to static objects
273on the server. The part after the question mark is called the "query string".
274It is mostly used with GET requests sent to dynamic scripts and is very
275specific to the language, framework or application in use.
276
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +0100277HTTP/2 doesn't convey a version information with the request, so the version is
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100278assumed to be the same as the one of the underlying protocol (i.e. "HTTP/2").
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +0100279
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200280
2811.2.2. The request headers
282--------------------------
283
284The headers start at the second line. They are composed of a name at the
285beginning of the line, immediately followed by a colon (':'). Traditionally,
286an LWS is added after the colon but that's not required. Then come the values.
287Multiple identical headers may be folded into one single line, delimiting the
288values with commas, provided that their order is respected. This is commonly
289encountered in the "Cookie:" field. A header may span over multiple lines if
290the subsequent lines begin with an LWS. In the example in 1.2, lines 4 and 5
291define a total of 3 values for the "Accept:" header.
292
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100293Contrary to a common misconception, header names are not case-sensitive, and
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200294their values are not either if they refer to other header names (such as the
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +0100295"Connection:" header). In HTTP/2, header names are always sent in lower case,
Willy Tarreau253c2512020-07-07 15:55:23 +0200296as can be seen when running in debug mode. Internally, all header names are
297normalized to lower case so that HTTP/1.x and HTTP/2 use the exact same
298representation, and they are sent as-is on the other side. This explains why an
299HTTP/1.x request typed with camel case is delivered in lower case.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200300
301The end of the headers is indicated by the first empty line. People often say
302that it's a double line feed, which is not exact, even if a double line feed
303is one valid form of empty line.
304
305Fortunately, HAProxy takes care of all these complex combinations when indexing
306headers, checking values and counting them, so there is no reason to worry
307about the way they could be written, but it is important not to accuse an
308application of being buggy if it does unusual, valid things.
309
310Important note:
Lukas Tribus23953682017-04-28 13:24:30 +0000311 As suggested by RFC7231, HAProxy normalizes headers by replacing line breaks
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200312 in the middle of headers by LWS in order to join multi-line headers. This
313 is necessary for proper analysis and helps less capable HTTP parsers to work
314 correctly and not to be fooled by such complex constructs.
315
316
3171.3. HTTP response
318------------------
319
320An HTTP response looks very much like an HTTP request. Both are called HTTP
321messages. Let's consider this HTTP response :
322
323 Line Contents
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100324 number
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200325 1 HTTP/1.1 200 OK
326 2 Content-length: 350
327 3 Content-Type: text/html
328
Willy Tarreau816b9792009-09-15 21:25:21 +0200329As a special case, HTTP supports so called "Informational responses" as status
330codes 1xx. These messages are special in that they don't convey any part of the
331response, they're just used as sort of a signaling message to ask a client to
Willy Tarreau5843d1a2010-02-01 15:13:32 +0100332continue to post its request for instance. In the case of a status 100 response
333the requested information will be carried by the next non-100 response message
334following the informational one. This implies that multiple responses may be
335sent to a single request, and that this only works when keep-alive is enabled
336(1xx messages are HTTP/1.1 only). HAProxy handles these messages and is able to
337correctly forward and skip them, and only process the next non-100 response. As
338such, these messages are neither logged nor transformed, unless explicitly
339state otherwise. Status 101 messages indicate that the protocol is changing
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -0400340over the same connection and that HAProxy must switch to tunnel mode, just as
Willy Tarreau5843d1a2010-02-01 15:13:32 +0100341if a CONNECT had occurred. Then the Upgrade header would contain additional
342information about the type of protocol the connection is switching to.
Willy Tarreau816b9792009-09-15 21:25:21 +0200343
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200344
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003451.3.1. The response line
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200346------------------------
347
348Line 1 is the "response line". It is always composed of 3 fields :
349
350 - a version tag : HTTP/1.1
351 - a status code : 200
352 - a reason : OK
353
354The status code is always 3-digit. The first digit indicates a general status :
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100355 - 1xx = informational message to be skipped (e.g. 100, 101)
356 - 2xx = OK, content is following (e.g. 200, 206)
357 - 3xx = OK, no content following (e.g. 302, 304)
358 - 4xx = error caused by the client (e.g. 401, 403, 404)
359 - 5xx = error caused by the server (e.g. 500, 502, 503)
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200360
Lukas Tribus23953682017-04-28 13:24:30 +0000361Please refer to RFC7231 for the detailed meaning of all such codes. The
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100362"reason" field is just a hint, but is not parsed by clients. Anything can be
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200363found there, but it's a common practice to respect the well-established
364messages. It can be composed of one or multiple words, such as "OK", "Found",
365or "Authentication Required".
366
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100367HAProxy may emit the following status codes by itself :
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200368
369 Code When / reason
370 200 access to stats page, and when replying to monitoring requests
371 301 when performing a redirection, depending on the configured code
372 302 when performing a redirection, depending on the configured code
373 303 when performing a redirection, depending on the configured code
Willy Tarreaub67fdc42013-03-29 19:28:11 +0100374 307 when performing a redirection, depending on the configured code
375 308 when performing a redirection, depending on the configured code
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200376 400 for an invalid or too large request
377 401 when an authentication is required to perform the action (when
378 accessing the stats page)
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +0200379 403 when a request is forbidden by a "http-request deny" rule
Florian Tham9205fea2020-01-08 13:35:30 +0100380 404 when the requested resource could not be found
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200381 408 when the request timeout strikes before the request is complete
Florian Tham272e29b2020-01-08 10:19:05 +0100382 410 when the requested resource is no longer available and will not
383 be available again
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -0400384 500 when HAProxy encounters an unrecoverable internal error, such as a
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200385 memory allocation failure, which should never happen
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -0400386 501 when HAProxy is unable to satisfy a client request because of an
Christopher Faulete095f312020-12-07 11:22:24 +0100387 unsupported feature
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200388 502 when the server returns an empty, invalid or incomplete response, or
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +0200389 when an "http-response deny" rule blocks the response.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200390 503 when no server was available to handle the request, or in response to
391 monitoring requests which match the "monitor fail" condition
392 504 when the response timeout strikes before the server responds
393
394The error 4xx and 5xx codes above may be customized (see "errorloc" in section
3954.2).
396
397
3981.3.2. The response headers
399---------------------------
400
401Response headers work exactly like request headers, and as such, HAProxy uses
402the same parsing function for both. Please refer to paragraph 1.2.2 for more
403details.
404
405
4062. Configuring HAProxy
407----------------------
408
4092.1. Configuration file format
410------------------------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200411
412HAProxy's configuration process involves 3 major sources of parameters :
413
414 - the arguments from the command-line, which always take precedence
Willy Tarreau6f1129d2020-11-25 19:58:20 +0100415 - the configuration file(s), whose format is described here
Thayne McCombscdbcca92021-01-07 21:24:41 -0700416 - the running process's environment, in case some environment variables are
Willy Tarreau6f1129d2020-11-25 19:58:20 +0100417 explicitly referenced
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200418
Willy Tarreau6f1129d2020-11-25 19:58:20 +0100419The configuration file follows a fairly simple hierarchical format which obey
420a few basic rules:
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +0100421
Willy Tarreau6f1129d2020-11-25 19:58:20 +0100422 1. a configuration file is an ordered sequence of statements
423
424 2. a statement is a single non-empty line before any unprotected "#" (hash)
425
426 3. a line is a series of tokens or "words" delimited by unprotected spaces or
427 tab characters
428
429 4. the first word or sequence of words of a line is one of the keywords or
430 keyword sequences listed in this document
431
432 5. all other words are all arguments of the first one, some being well-known
433 keywords listed in this document, others being values, references to other
434 parts of the configuration, or expressions
435
436 6. certain keywords delimit a section inside which only a subset of keywords
437 are supported
438
439 7. a section ends at the end of a file or on a special keyword starting a new
440 section
441
442This is all that is needed to know to write a simple but reliable configuration
443generator, but this is not enough to reliably parse any configuration nor to
444figure how to deal with certain corner cases.
445
446First, there are a few consequences of the rules above. Rule 6 and 7 imply that
447the keywords used to define a new section are valid everywhere and cannot have
448a different meaning in a specific section. These keywords are always a single
449word (as opposed to a sequence of words), and traditionally the section that
450follows them is designated using the same name. For example when speaking about
451the "global section", it designates the section of configuration that follows
452the "global" keyword. This usage is used a lot in error messages to help locate
453the parts that need to be addressed.
454
455A number of sections create an internal object or configuration space, which
456requires to be distinguished from other ones. In this case they will take an
457extra word which will set the name of this particular section. For some of them
458the section name is mandatory. For example "frontend foo" will create a new
459section of type "frontend" named "foo". Usually a name is specific to its
460section and two sections of different types may use the same name, but this is
461not recommended as it tends to complexify configuration management.
462
463A direct consequence of rule 7 is that when multiple files are read at once,
464each of them must start with a new section, and the end of each file will end
465a section. A file cannot contain sub-sections nor end an existing section and
466start a new one.
467
468Rule 1 mentioned that ordering matters. Indeed, some keywords create directives
469that can be repeated multiple times to create ordered sequences of rules to be
470applied in a certain order. For example "tcp-request" can be used to alternate
471"accept" and "reject" rules on varying criteria. As such, a configuration file
472processor must always preserve a section's ordering when editing a file. The
473ordering of sections usually does not matter except for the global section
474which must be placed before other sections, but it may be repeated if needed.
475In addition, some automatic identifiers may automatically be assigned to some
476of the created objects (e.g. proxies), and by reordering sections, their
477identifiers will change. These ones appear in the statistics for example. As
478such, the configuration below will assign "foo" ID number 1 and "bar" ID number
4792, which will be swapped if the two sections are reversed:
480
481 listen foo
482 bind :80
483
484 listen bar
485 bind :81
486
487Another important point is that according to rules 2 and 3 above, empty lines,
488spaces, tabs, and comments following and unprotected "#" character are not part
489of the configuration as they are just used as delimiters. This implies that the
490following configurations are strictly equivalent:
491
492 global#this is the global section
493 daemon#daemonize
494 frontend foo
495 mode http # or tcp
496
497and:
498
499 global
500 daemon
501
502 # this is the public web frontend
503 frontend foo
504 mode http
505
506The common practice is to align to the left only the keyword that initiates a
507new section, and indent (i.e. prepend a tab character or a few spaces) all
508other keywords so that it's instantly visible that they belong to the same
509section (as done in the second example above). Placing comments before a new
510section helps the reader decide if it's the desired one. Leaving a blank line
511at the end of a section also visually helps spotting the end when editing it.
512
513Tabs are very convenient for indent but they do not copy-paste well. If spaces
514are used instead, it is recommended to avoid placing too many (2 to 4) so that
515editing in field doesn't become a burden with limited editors that do not
516support automatic indent.
517
518In the early days it used to be common to see arguments split at fixed tab
519positions because most keywords would not take more than two arguments. With
520modern versions featuring complex expressions this practice does not stand
521anymore, and is not recommended.
522
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200523
William Lallemandf9873ba2015-05-05 17:37:14 +02005242.2. Quoting and escaping
525-------------------------
526
Willy Tarreau6f1129d2020-11-25 19:58:20 +0100527In modern configurations, some arguments require the use of some characters
528that were previously considered as pure delimiters. In order to make this
529possible, HAProxy supports character escaping by prepending a backslash ('\')
530in front of the character to be escaped, weak quoting within double quotes
531('"') and strong quoting within single quotes ("'").
William Lallemandf9873ba2015-05-05 17:37:14 +0200532
Willy Tarreau6f1129d2020-11-25 19:58:20 +0100533This is pretty similar to what is done in a number of programming languages and
534very close to what is commonly encountered in Bourne shell. The principle is
535the following: while the configuration parser cuts the lines into words, it
536also takes care of quotes and backslashes to decide whether a character is a
537delimiter or is the raw representation of this character within the current
538word. The escape character is then removed, the quotes are removed, and the
539remaining word is used as-is as a keyword or argument for example.
William Lallemandf9873ba2015-05-05 17:37:14 +0200540
Willy Tarreau6f1129d2020-11-25 19:58:20 +0100541If a backslash is needed in a word, it must either be escaped using itself
542(i.e. double backslash) or be strongly quoted.
543
544Escaping outside quotes is achieved by preceding a special character by a
545backslash ('\'):
William Lallemandf9873ba2015-05-05 17:37:14 +0200546
547 \ to mark a space and differentiate it from a delimiter
548 \# to mark a hash and differentiate it from a comment
549 \\ to use a backslash
550 \' to use a single quote and differentiate it from strong quoting
551 \" to use a double quote and differentiate it from weak quoting
552
Willy Tarreau6f1129d2020-11-25 19:58:20 +0100553In addition, a few non-printable characters may be emitted using their usual
554C-language representation:
555
556 \n to insert a line feed (LF, character \x0a or ASCII 10 decimal)
557 \r to insert a carriage return (CR, character \x0d or ASCII 13 decimal)
558 \t to insert a tab (character \x09 or ASCII 9 decimal)
559 \xNN to insert character having ASCII code hex NN (e.g \x0a for LF).
560
561Weak quoting is achieved by surrounding double quotes ("") around the character
562or sequence of characters to protect. Weak quoting prevents the interpretation
563of:
William Lallemandf9873ba2015-05-05 17:37:14 +0200564
Willy Tarreau6f1129d2020-11-25 19:58:20 +0100565 space or tab as a word separator
William Lallemandf9873ba2015-05-05 17:37:14 +0200566 ' single quote as a strong quoting delimiter
567 # hash as a comment start
568
Willy Tarreau6f1129d2020-11-25 19:58:20 +0100569Weak quoting permits the interpretation of environment variables (which are not
570evaluated outside of quotes) by preceding them with a dollar sign ('$'). If a
571dollar character is needed inside double quotes, it must be escaped using a
572backslash.
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +0200573
Willy Tarreau6f1129d2020-11-25 19:58:20 +0100574Strong quoting is achieved by surrounding single quotes ('') around the
575character or sequence of characters to protect. Inside single quotes, nothing
576is interpreted, it's the efficient way to quote regular expressions.
William Lallemandf9873ba2015-05-05 17:37:14 +0200577
Willy Tarreau6f1129d2020-11-25 19:58:20 +0100578As a result, here is the matrix indicating how special characters can be
579entered in different contexts (unprintable characters are replaced with their
580name within angle brackets). Note that some characters that may only be
581represented escaped have no possible representation inside single quotes,
582hence the '-' there:
William Lallemandf9873ba2015-05-05 17:37:14 +0200583
Willy Tarreau6f1129d2020-11-25 19:58:20 +0100584 Character | Unquoted | Weakly quoted | Strongly quoted
585 -----------+---------------+-----------------------------+-----------------
586 <TAB> | \<TAB>, \x09 | "<TAB>", "\<TAB>", "\x09" | '<TAB>'
587 <LF> | \n, \x0a | "\n", "\x0a" | -
588 <CR> | \r, \x0d | "\r", "\x0d" | -
589 <SPC> | \<SPC>, \x20 | "<SPC>", "\<SPC>", "\x20" | '<SPC>'
590 " | \", \x22 | "\"", "\x22" | '"'
591 # | \#, \x23 | "#", "\#", "\x23" | '#'
592 $ | $, \$, \x24 | "\$", "\x24" | '$'
593 ' | \', \x27 | "'", "\'", "\x27" | -
594 \ | \\, \x5c | "\\", "\x5c" | '\'
William Lallemandf9873ba2015-05-05 17:37:14 +0200595
596 Example:
Willy Tarreau6f1129d2020-11-25 19:58:20 +0100597 # those are all strictly equivalent:
William Lallemandf9873ba2015-05-05 17:37:14 +0200598 log-format %{+Q}o\ %t\ %s\ %{-Q}r
599 log-format "%{+Q}o %t %s %{-Q}r"
600 log-format '%{+Q}o %t %s %{-Q}r'
601 log-format "%{+Q}o %t"' %s %{-Q}r'
602 log-format "%{+Q}o %t"' %s'\ %{-Q}r
603
Willy Tarreau6f1129d2020-11-25 19:58:20 +0100604There is one particular case where a second level of quoting or escaping may be
605necessary. Some keywords take arguments within parenthesis, sometimes delimited
606by commas. These arguments are commonly integers or predefined words, but when
607they are arbitrary strings, it may be required to perform a separate level of
608escaping to disambiguate the characters that belong to the argument from the
609characters that are used to delimit the arguments themselves. A pretty common
610case is the "regsub" converter. It takes a regular expression in argument, and
611if a closing parenthesis is needed inside, this one will require to have its
612own quotes.
613
614The keyword argument parser is exactly the same as the top-level one regarding
Thayne McCombsf87e4f72021-10-04 01:02:58 -0600615quotes, except that the \#, \$, and \xNN escapes are not processed. But what is
Ilya Shipitsin2272d8a2020-12-21 01:22:40 +0500616not always obvious is that the delimiters used inside must first be escaped or
Willy Tarreau6f1129d2020-11-25 19:58:20 +0100617quoted so that they are not resolved at the top level.
618
619Let's take this example making use of the "regsub" converter which takes 3
620arguments, one regular expression, one replacement string and one set of flags:
621
622 # replace all occurrences of "foo" with "blah" in the path:
623 http-request set-path %[path,regsub(foo,blah,g)]
624
625Here no special quoting was necessary. But if now we want to replace either
626"foo" or "bar" with "blah", we'll need the regular expression "(foo|bar)". We
627cannot write:
628
629 http-request set-path %[path,regsub((foo|bar),blah,g)]
630
631because we would like the string to cut like this:
632
633 http-request set-path %[path,regsub((foo|bar),blah,g)]
634 |---------|----|-|
635 arg1 _/ / /
636 arg2 __________/ /
637 arg3 ______________/
638
639but actually what is passed is a string between the opening and closing
640parenthesis then garbage:
641
642 http-request set-path %[path,regsub((foo|bar),blah,g)]
643 |--------|--------|
644 arg1=(foo|bar _/ /
645 trailing garbage _________/
646
647The obvious solution here seems to be that the closing parenthesis needs to be
648quoted, but alone this will not work, because as mentioned above, quotes are
649processed by the top-level parser which will resolve them before processing
650this word:
651
652 http-request set-path %[path,regsub("(foo|bar)",blah,g)]
653 ------------ -------- ----------------------------------
654 word1 word2 word3=%[path,regsub((foo|bar),blah,g)]
655
656So we didn't change anything for the argument parser at the second level which
657still sees a truncated regular expression as the only argument, and garbage at
658the end of the string. By escaping the quotes they will be passed unmodified to
659the second level:
660
661 http-request set-path %[path,regsub(\"(foo|bar)\",blah,g)]
662 ------------ -------- ------------------------------------
663 word1 word2 word3=%[path,regsub("(foo|bar)",blah,g)]
664 |---------||----|-|
665 arg1=(foo|bar) _/ / /
666 arg2=blah ___________/ /
667 arg3=g _______________/
668
Ilya Shipitsin2272d8a2020-12-21 01:22:40 +0500669Another approach consists in using single quotes outside the whole string and
Willy Tarreau6f1129d2020-11-25 19:58:20 +0100670double quotes inside (so that the double quotes are not stripped again):
671
672 http-request set-path '%[path,regsub("(foo|bar)",blah,g)]'
673 ------------ -------- ----------------------------------
674 word1 word2 word3=%[path,regsub("(foo|bar)",blah,g)]
675 |---------||----|-|
676 arg1=(foo|bar) _/ / /
677 arg2 ___________/ /
678 arg3 _______________/
679
680When using regular expressions, it can happen that the dollar ('$') character
681appears in the expression or that a backslash ('\') is used in the replacement
682string. In this case these ones will also be processed inside the double quotes
683thus single quotes are preferred (or double escaping). Example:
684
685 http-request set-path '%[path,regsub("^/(here)(/|$)","my/\1",g)]'
686 ------------ -------- -----------------------------------------
687 word1 word2 word3=%[path,regsub("^/(here)(/|$)","my/\1",g)]
688 |-------------| |-----||-|
689 arg1=(here)(/|$) _/ / /
690 arg2=my/\1 ________________/ /
691 arg3 ______________________/
692
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -0400693Remember that backslashes are not escape characters within single quotes and
Thayne McCombsf87e4f72021-10-04 01:02:58 -0600694that the whole word above is already protected against them using the single
Willy Tarreau6f1129d2020-11-25 19:58:20 +0100695quotes. Conversely, if double quotes had been used around the whole expression,
696single the dollar character and the backslashes would have been resolved at top
697level, breaking the argument contents at the second level.
698
Thayne McCombsf87e4f72021-10-04 01:02:58 -0600699Unfortunately, since single quotes can't be escaped inside of strong quoting,
700if you need to include single quotes in your argument, you will need to escape
701or quote them twice. There are a few ways to do this:
702
703 http-request set-var(txn.foo) str("\\'foo\\'")
704 http-request set-var(txn.foo) str(\"\'foo\'\")
705 http-request set-var(txn.foo) str(\\\'foo\\\')
706
Willy Tarreau6f1129d2020-11-25 19:58:20 +0100707When in doubt, simply do not use quotes anywhere, and start to place single or
708double quotes around arguments that require a comma or a closing parenthesis,
Thayne McCombsf87e4f72021-10-04 01:02:58 -0600709and think about escaping these quotes using a backslash if the string contains
Willy Tarreau6f1129d2020-11-25 19:58:20 +0100710a dollar or a backslash. Again, this is pretty similar to what is used under
711a Bourne shell when double-escaping a command passed to "eval". For API writers
712the best is probably to place escaped quotes around each and every argument,
713regardless of their contents. Users will probably find that using single quotes
714around the whole expression and double quotes around each argument provides
715more readable configurations.
William Lallemandf9873ba2015-05-05 17:37:14 +0200716
717
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +02007182.3. Environment variables
719--------------------------
720
721HAProxy's configuration supports environment variables. Those variables are
722interpreted only within double quotes. Variables are expanded during the
723configuration parsing. Variable names must be preceded by a dollar ("$") and
724optionally enclosed with braces ("{}") similarly to what is done in Bourne
725shell. Variable names can contain alphanumerical characters or the character
Amaury Denoyellefa41cb62020-10-01 14:32:35 +0200726underscore ("_") but should not start with a digit. If the variable contains a
727list of several values separated by spaces, it can be expanded as individual
728arguments by enclosing the variable with braces and appending the suffix '[*]'
729before the closing brace.
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +0200730
731 Example:
732
733 bind "fd@${FD_APP1}"
734
735 log "${LOCAL_SYSLOG}:514" local0 notice # send to local server
736
737 user "$HAPROXY_USER"
738
William Lallemand4d03e432019-06-14 15:35:37 +0200739Some variables are defined by HAProxy, they can be used in the configuration
740file, or could be inherited by a program (See 3.7. Programs):
William Lallemanddaf4cd22018-04-17 16:46:13 +0200741
William Lallemand4d03e432019-06-14 15:35:37 +0200742* HAPROXY_LOCALPEER: defined at the startup of the process which contains the
743 name of the local peer. (See "-L" in the management guide.)
744
745* HAPROXY_CFGFILES: list of the configuration files loaded by HAProxy,
746 separated by semicolons. Can be useful in the case you specified a
747 directory.
748
749* HAPROXY_MWORKER: In master-worker mode, this variable is set to 1.
750
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -0500751* HAPROXY_CLI: configured listeners addresses of the stats socket for every
William Lallemand4d03e432019-06-14 15:35:37 +0200752 processes, separated by semicolons.
753
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -0500754* HAPROXY_MASTER_CLI: In master-worker mode, listeners addresses of the master
William Lallemand4d03e432019-06-14 15:35:37 +0200755 CLI, separated by semicolons.
756
William Lallemanda48f51b2023-02-21 14:07:05 +0100757* HAPROXY_STARTUP_VERSION: contains the version used to start, in master-worker
758 mode this is the version which was used to start the master, even after
759 updating the binary and reloading.
760
Willy Tarreaua46f1af2021-05-06 10:25:11 +0200761In addition, some pseudo-variables are internally resolved and may be used as
762regular variables. Pseudo-variables always start with a dot ('.'), and are the
763only ones where the dot is permitted. The current list of pseudo-variables is:
764
765* .FILE: the name of the configuration file currently being parsed.
766
767* .LINE: the line number of the configuration file currently being parsed,
768 starting at one.
769
770* .SECTION: the name of the section currently being parsed, or its type if the
771 section doesn't have a name (e.g. "global"), or an empty string before the
772 first section.
773
774These variables are resolved at the location where they are parsed. For example
775if a ".LINE" variable is used in a "log-format" directive located in a defaults
776section, its line number will be resolved before parsing and compiling the
777"log-format" directive, so this same line number will be reused by subsequent
778proxies.
779
780This way it is possible to emit information to help locate a rule in variables,
781logs, error statuses, health checks, header values, or even to use line numbers
782to name some config objects like servers for example.
783
William Lallemand4d03e432019-06-14 15:35:37 +0200784See also "external-check command" for other variables.
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +0200785
Willy Tarreau4b103022021-02-12 17:59:10 +0100786
7872.4. Conditional blocks
788-----------------------
789
790It may sometimes be convenient to be able to conditionally enable or disable
791some arbitrary parts of the configuration, for example to enable/disable SSL or
792ciphers, enable or disable some pre-production listeners without modifying the
793configuration, or adjust the configuration's syntax to support two distinct
794versions of HAProxy during a migration.. HAProxy brings a set of nestable
795preprocessor-like directives which allow to integrate or ignore some blocks of
796text. These directives must be placed on their own line and they act on the
797lines that follow them. Two of them support an expression, the other ones only
798switch to an alternate block or end a current level. The 4 following directives
799are defined to form conditional blocks:
800
801 - .if <condition>
802 - .elif <condition>
803 - .else
804 - .endif
805
806The ".if" directive nests a new level, ".elif" stays at the same level, ".else"
807as well, and ".endif" closes a level. Each ".if" must be terminated by a
808matching ".endif". The ".elif" may only be placed after ".if" or ".elif", and
809there is no limit to the number of ".elif" that may be chained. There may be
810only one ".else" per ".if" and it must always be after the ".if" or the last
811".elif" of a block.
812
813Comments may be placed on the same line if needed after a '#', they will be
814ignored. The directives are tokenized like other configuration directives, and
815as such it is possible to use environment variables in conditions.
816
817The conditions are currently limited to:
818
819 - an empty string, always returns "false"
820 - the integer zero ('0'), always returns "false"
821 - a non-nul integer (e.g. '1'), always returns "true".
Willy Tarreau42ed14b2021-05-06 15:55:14 +0200822 - a predicate optionally followed by argument(s) in parenthesis.
823
824The list of currently supported predicates is the following:
825
826 - defined(<name>) : returns true if an environment variable <name>
827 exists, regardless of its contents
828
Willy Tarreau58ca7062021-05-06 16:34:23 +0200829 - feature(<name>) : returns true if feature <name> is listed as present
830 in the features list reported by "haproxy -vv"
831 (which means a <name> appears after a '+')
832
Willy Tarreau6492e872021-05-06 16:10:09 +0200833 - streq(<str1>,<str2>) : returns true only if the two strings are equal
834 - strneq(<str1>,<str2>) : returns true only if the two strings differ
835
Willy Tarreau0b7c78a2021-05-06 16:53:26 +0200836 - version_atleast(<ver>): returns true if the current haproxy version is
837 at least as recent as <ver> otherwise false. The
838 version syntax is the same as shown by "haproxy -v"
839 and missing components are assumed as being zero.
840
841 - version_before(<ver>) : returns true if the current haproxy version is
842 strictly older than <ver> otherwise false. The
843 version syntax is the same as shown by "haproxy -v"
844 and missing components are assumed as being zero.
845
Willy Tarreau42ed14b2021-05-06 15:55:14 +0200846Example:
Willy Tarreau4b103022021-02-12 17:59:10 +0100847
Willy Tarreau42ed14b2021-05-06 15:55:14 +0200848 .if defined(HAPROXY_MWORKER)
849 listen mwcli_px
850 bind :1111
851 ...
852 .endif
Willy Tarreau4b103022021-02-12 17:59:10 +0100853
Willy Tarreau6492e872021-05-06 16:10:09 +0200854 .if strneq("$SSL_ONLY",yes)
855 bind :80
856 .endif
857
858 .if streq("$WITH_SSL",yes)
Willy Tarreau58ca7062021-05-06 16:34:23 +0200859 .if feature(OPENSSL)
Willy Tarreau6492e872021-05-06 16:10:09 +0200860 bind :443 ssl crt ...
Willy Tarreau58ca7062021-05-06 16:34:23 +0200861 .endif
Willy Tarreau6492e872021-05-06 16:10:09 +0200862 .endif
863
Willy Tarreau0b7c78a2021-05-06 16:53:26 +0200864 .if version_atleast(2.4-dev19)
865 profiling.memory on
866 .endif
867
Willy Tarreau7190b982021-05-07 08:59:50 +0200868Four other directives are provided to report some status:
Willy Tarreau4b103022021-02-12 17:59:10 +0100869
Willy Tarreau7190b982021-05-07 08:59:50 +0200870 - .diag "message" : emit this message only when in diagnostic mode (-dD)
Willy Tarreau4b103022021-02-12 17:59:10 +0100871 - .notice "message" : emit this message at level NOTICE
872 - .warning "message" : emit this message at level WARNING
873 - .alert "message" : emit this message at level ALERT
874
875Messages emitted at level WARNING may cause the process to fail to start if the
876"strict-mode" is enabled. Messages emitted at level ALERT will always cause a
877fatal error. These can be used to detect some inappropriate conditions and
878provide advice to the user.
879
880Example:
881
882 .if "${A}"
883 .if "${B}"
884 .notice "A=1, B=1"
885 .elif "${C}"
886 .notice "A=1, B=0, C=1"
887 .elif "${D}"
888 .warning "A=1, B=0, C=0, D=1"
889 .else
890 .alert "A=1, B=0, C=0, D=0"
891 .endif
892 .else
893 .notice "A=0"
894 .endif
895
Willy Tarreau7190b982021-05-07 08:59:50 +0200896 .diag "WTA/2021-05-07: replace 'redirect' with 'return' after switch to 2.4"
897 http-request redirect location /goaway if ABUSE
898
Willy Tarreau4b103022021-02-12 17:59:10 +0100899
9002.5. Time format
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200901----------------
902
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +0100903Some parameters involve values representing time, such as timeouts. These
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +0100904values are generally expressed in milliseconds (unless explicitly stated
905otherwise) but may be expressed in any other unit by suffixing the unit to the
906numeric value. It is important to consider this because it will not be repeated
907for every keyword. Supported units are :
908
909 - us : microseconds. 1 microsecond = 1/1000000 second
910 - ms : milliseconds. 1 millisecond = 1/1000 second. This is the default.
911 - s : seconds. 1s = 1000ms
912 - m : minutes. 1m = 60s = 60000ms
913 - h : hours. 1h = 60m = 3600s = 3600000ms
914 - d : days. 1d = 24h = 1440m = 86400s = 86400000ms
915
916
Daniel Epperson07ff2fb2023-05-15 12:45:27 -07009172.6. Size format
918----------------
919
920Some parameters involve values representing size, such as bandwidth limits.
921These values are generally expressed in bytes (unless explicitly stated
922otherwise) but may be expressed in any other unit by suffixing the unit to the
923numeric value. It is important to consider this because it will not be repeated
924for every keyword. Supported units are case insensitive :
925
926 - k : kilobytes. 1 kilobyte = 1024 bytes
927 - m : megabytes. 1 megabyte = 1048576 bytes
928 - g : gigabytes. 1 gigabyte = 1073741824 bytes
929
930Both time and size formats require integers, decimal notation is not allowed.
931
932
9332.7. Examples
Patrick Mezard35da19c2010-06-12 17:02:47 +0200934-------------
935
936 # Simple configuration for an HTTP proxy listening on port 80 on all
937 # interfaces and forwarding requests to a single backend "servers" with a
938 # single server "server1" listening on 127.0.0.1:8000
939 global
940 daemon
941 maxconn 256
942
943 defaults
944 mode http
945 timeout connect 5000ms
946 timeout client 50000ms
947 timeout server 50000ms
948
949 frontend http-in
950 bind *:80
951 default_backend servers
952
953 backend servers
954 server server1 127.0.0.1:8000 maxconn 32
955
956
957 # The same configuration defined with a single listen block. Shorter but
958 # less expressive, especially in HTTP mode.
959 global
960 daemon
961 maxconn 256
962
963 defaults
964 mode http
965 timeout connect 5000ms
966 timeout client 50000ms
967 timeout server 50000ms
968
969 listen http-in
970 bind *:80
971 server server1 127.0.0.1:8000 maxconn 32
972
973
974Assuming haproxy is in $PATH, test these configurations in a shell with:
975
Willy Tarreauccb289d2010-12-11 20:19:38 +0100976 $ sudo haproxy -f configuration.conf -c
Patrick Mezard35da19c2010-06-12 17:02:47 +0200977
978
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009793. Global parameters
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200980--------------------
981
982Parameters in the "global" section are process-wide and often OS-specific. They
983are generally set once for all and do not need being changed once correct. Some
984of them have command-line equivalents.
985
986The following keywords are supported in the "global" section :
987
988 * Process management and security
Willy Tarreau0cb29002022-11-16 17:42:34 +0100989 - 51degrees-cache-size
990 - 51degrees-data-file
991 - 51degrees-property-name-list
992 - 51degrees-property-separator
Emeric Brunc8e8d122012-10-02 18:42:10 +0200993 - ca-base
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200994 - chroot
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +0200995 - cpu-map
Willy Tarreau0cb29002022-11-16 17:42:34 +0100996 - crt-base
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200997 - daemon
Willy Tarreau8a022d52021-04-27 20:29:11 +0200998 - default-path
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +0200999 - description
1000 - deviceatlas-json-file
1001 - deviceatlas-log-level
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +02001002 - deviceatlas-properties-cookie
Willy Tarreau0cb29002022-11-16 17:42:34 +01001003 - deviceatlas-separator
Amaury Denoyelled2e53cd2021-05-06 16:21:39 +02001004 - expose-experimental-directives
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09001005 - external-check
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001006 - gid
1007 - group
Christopher Faulet98fbe952019-07-22 16:18:24 +02001008 - h1-case-adjust
1009 - h1-case-adjust-file
Willy Tarreau0cb29002022-11-16 17:42:34 +01001010 - h2-workaround-bogus-websocket-clients
1011 - hard-stop-after
Willy Tarreaud96f1122019-12-03 07:07:36 +01001012 - insecure-fork-wanted
Willy Tarreaua45a8b52019-12-06 16:31:45 +01001013 - insecure-setuid-wanted
Emmanuel Hocdet70df7bf2019-01-04 11:08:20 +01001014 - issuers-chain-path
Dragan Dosen13cd54c2020-06-18 18:24:05 +02001015 - localpeer
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001016 - log
Joe Williamsdf5b38f2010-12-29 17:05:48 +01001017 - log-send-hostname
Willy Tarreau0cb29002022-11-16 17:42:34 +01001018 - log-tag
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +02001019 - lua-load
Thierry Fournier59f11be2020-11-29 00:37:41 +01001020 - lua-load-per-thread
Tim Duesterhusdd74b5f2020-01-12 13:55:40 +01001021 - lua-prepend-path
William Lallemand27edc4b2019-05-07 17:49:33 +02001022 - mworker-max-reloads
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001023 - nbproc
Christopher Fauletbe0faa22017-08-29 15:37:10 +02001024 - nbthread
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +02001025 - node
Amaury Denoyelle0f50cb92021-03-26 18:50:33 +01001026 - numa-cpu-mapping
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001027 - pidfile
Willy Tarreau119e50e2020-05-22 13:53:29 +02001028 - pp2-never-send-local
Willy Tarreau1d549722016-02-16 12:41:57 +01001029 - presetenv
1030 - resetenv
Willy Tarreau636848a2019-04-15 19:38:50 +02001031 - set-dumpable
Willy Tarreau13d2ba22021-03-26 11:38:08 +01001032 - set-var
Willy Tarreau1d549722016-02-16 12:41:57 +01001033 - setenv
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +02001034 - ssl-default-bind-ciphers
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +02001035 - ssl-default-bind-ciphersuites
Jerome Magninb203ff62020-04-03 15:28:22 +02001036 - ssl-default-bind-curves
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +02001037 - ssl-default-bind-options
1038 - ssl-default-server-ciphers
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +02001039 - ssl-default-server-ciphersuites
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +02001040 - ssl-default-server-options
1041 - ssl-dh-param-file
Emeric Brun850efd52014-01-29 12:24:34 +01001042 - ssl-server-verify
Emmanuel Hocdetc3b7e742020-04-22 11:06:19 +02001043 - ssl-skip-self-issued-ca
Willy Tarreau0cb29002022-11-16 17:42:34 +01001044 - stats
1045 - strict-limits
1046 - uid
1047 - ulimit-n
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01001048 - unix-bind
Willy Tarreau1d549722016-02-16 12:41:57 +01001049 - unsetenv
Willy Tarreau0cb29002022-11-16 17:42:34 +01001050 - user
1051 - wurfl-cache-size
Willy Tarreaub3cc9f22019-04-19 16:03:32 +02001052 - wurfl-data-file
1053 - wurfl-information-list
1054 - wurfl-information-list-separator
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01001055
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001056 * Performance tuning
William Dauchy0a8824f2019-10-27 20:08:09 +01001057 - busy-polling
Willy Tarreau1746eec2014-04-25 10:46:47 +02001058 - max-spread-checks
Willy Tarreau0cb29002022-11-16 17:42:34 +01001059 - maxcompcpuusage
1060 - maxcomprate
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001061 - maxconn
Willy Tarreau81c25d02011-09-07 15:17:21 +02001062 - maxconnrate
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01001063 - maxpipes
Willy Tarreau93e7c002013-10-07 18:51:07 +02001064 - maxsessrate
Willy Tarreau403edff2012-09-06 11:58:37 +02001065 - maxsslconn
Willy Tarreaue43d5322013-10-07 20:01:52 +02001066 - maxsslrate
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +02001067 - maxzlibmem
Willy Tarreau85dd5212022-03-08 10:41:40 +01001068 - no-memory-trimming
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001069 - noepoll
Emmanuel Hocdet0ba4f482019-04-08 16:53:32 +00001070 - noevports
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03001071 - nogetaddrinfo
Willy Tarreau0cb29002022-11-16 17:42:34 +01001072 - nokqueue
1073 - nopoll
Lukas Tribusa0bcbdc2016-09-12 21:42:20 +00001074 - noreuseport
Willy Tarreau0cb29002022-11-16 17:42:34 +01001075 - nosplice
Willy Tarreau75c62c22018-11-22 11:02:09 +01001076 - profiling.tasks
Baptiste Assmann5626f482015-08-23 10:00:10 +02001077 - server-state-base
Baptiste Assmannef1f0fc2015-08-23 10:06:39 +02001078 - server-state-file
Willy Tarreau0cb29002022-11-16 17:42:34 +01001079 - spread-checks
Grant Zhang872f9c22017-01-21 01:10:18 +00001080 - ssl-engine
Grant Zhangfa6c7ee2017-01-14 01:42:15 +00001081 - ssl-mode-async
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +02001082 - tune.buffers.limit
1083 - tune.buffers.reserve
Willy Tarreau27a674e2009-08-17 07:23:33 +02001084 - tune.bufsize
Willy Tarreau43961d52010-10-04 20:39:20 +02001085 - tune.chksize
William Lallemandf3747832012-11-09 12:33:10 +01001086 - tune.comp.maxlevel
Christopher Faulet48110bc2023-02-20 14:33:46 +01001087 - tune.fail-alloc
Willy Tarreaubc52bec2020-06-18 08:58:47 +02001088 - tune.fd.edge-triggered
Willy Tarreaufe20e5b2017-07-27 11:42:14 +02001089 - tune.h2.header-table-size
Willy Tarreaue6baec02017-07-27 11:45:11 +02001090 - tune.h2.initial-window-size
Willy Tarreau5242ef82017-07-27 11:47:28 +02001091 - tune.h2.max-concurrent-streams
Tim Duesterhus1da7ab32023-06-13 15:08:47 +02001092 - tune.h2.max-frame-size
Willy Tarreau193b8c62012-11-22 00:17:38 +01001093 - tune.http.cookielen
Stéphane Cottin23e9e932017-05-18 08:58:41 +02001094 - tune.http.logurilen
Willy Tarreauac1932d2011-10-24 19:14:41 +02001095 - tune.http.maxhdr
Willy Tarreau76cc6992020-07-01 18:49:24 +02001096 - tune.idle-pool.shared
Willy Tarreau7e312732014-02-12 16:35:14 +01001097 - tune.idletimer
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +01001098 - tune.lua.forced-yield
Willy Tarreau32f61e22015-03-18 17:54:59 +01001099 - tune.lua.maxmem
Willy Tarreau0cb29002022-11-16 17:42:34 +01001100 - tune.lua.service-timeout
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +01001101 - tune.lua.session-timeout
1102 - tune.lua.task-timeout
Willy Tarreaua0250ba2008-01-06 11:22:57 +01001103 - tune.maxaccept
1104 - tune.maxpollevents
Willy Tarreau27a674e2009-08-17 07:23:33 +02001105 - tune.maxrewrite
Willy Tarreauf3045d22015-04-29 16:24:50 +02001106 - tune.pattern.cache-size
Willy Tarreaubd9a0a72011-10-23 21:14:29 +02001107 - tune.pipesize
Willy Tarreaua8e2d972020-07-01 18:27:16 +02001108 - tune.pool-high-fd-ratio
1109 - tune.pool-low-fd-ratio
Willy Tarreaue803de22010-01-21 17:43:04 +01001110 - tune.rcvbuf.client
1111 - tune.rcvbuf.server
Willy Tarreaub22fc302015-12-14 12:04:35 +01001112 - tune.recv_enough
Olivier Houchard1599b802018-05-24 18:59:04 +02001113 - tune.runqueue-depth
Willy Tarreaue7723bd2020-06-24 11:11:02 +02001114 - tune.sched.low-latency
Willy Tarreaue803de22010-01-21 17:43:04 +01001115 - tune.sndbuf.client
1116 - tune.sndbuf.server
Willy Tarreau6ec58db2012-11-16 16:32:15 +01001117 - tune.ssl.cachesize
Willy Tarreau0cb29002022-11-16 17:42:34 +01001118 - tune.ssl.capture-cipherlist-size
1119 - tune.ssl.default-dh-param
1120 - tune.ssl.force-private-cache
William Lallemand7d42ef52020-07-06 11:41:30 +02001121 - tune.ssl.keylog
Willy Tarreaubfd59462013-02-21 07:46:09 +01001122 - tune.ssl.lifetime
1123 - tune.ssl.maxrecord
Christopher Faulet31af49d2015-06-09 17:29:50 +02001124 - tune.ssl.ssl-ctx-cache-size
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02001125 - tune.vars.global-max-size
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +01001126 - tune.vars.proc-max-size
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02001127 - tune.vars.reqres-max-size
1128 - tune.vars.sess-max-size
1129 - tune.vars.txn-max-size
William Lallemanda509e4c2012-11-07 16:54:34 +01001130 - tune.zlib.memlevel
1131 - tune.zlib.windowsize
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01001132
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001133 * Debugging
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001134 - quiet
Willy Tarreau3eb10b82020-04-15 16:42:39 +02001135 - zero-warning
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001136
1137
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011383.1. Process management and security
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001139------------------------------------
1140
Willy Tarreau0cb29002022-11-16 17:42:34 +0100114151degrees-data-file <file path>
1142 The path of the 51Degrees data file to provide device detection services. The
1143 file should be unzipped and accessible by HAProxy with relevant permissions.
1144
1145 Please note that this option is only available when HAProxy has been
1146 compiled with USE_51DEGREES.
1147
114851degrees-property-name-list [<string> ...]
1149 A list of 51Degrees property names to be load from the dataset. A full list
1150 of names is available on the 51Degrees website:
1151 https://51degrees.com/resources/property-dictionary
1152
1153 Please note that this option is only available when HAProxy has been
1154 compiled with USE_51DEGREES.
1155
115651degrees-property-separator <char>
1157 A char that will be appended to every property value in a response header
1158 containing 51Degrees results. If not set that will be set as ','.
1159
1160 Please note that this option is only available when HAProxy has been
1161 compiled with USE_51DEGREES.
1162
116351degrees-cache-size <number>
1164 Sets the size of the 51Degrees converter cache to <number> entries. This
1165 is an LRU cache which reminds previous device detections and their results.
1166 By default, this cache is disabled.
1167
1168 Please note that this option is only available when HAProxy has been
1169 compiled with USE_51DEGREES.
1170
Emeric Brunc8e8d122012-10-02 18:42:10 +02001171ca-base <dir>
1172 Assigns a default directory to fetch SSL CA certificates and CRLs from when a
Emmanuel Hocdet842e94e2019-12-16 16:39:17 +01001173 relative path is used with "ca-file", "ca-verify-file" or "crl-file"
1174 directives. Absolute locations specified in "ca-file", "ca-verify-file" and
1175 "crl-file" prevail and ignore "ca-base".
Emeric Brunc8e8d122012-10-02 18:42:10 +02001176
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001177chroot <jail dir>
1178 Changes current directory to <jail dir> and performs a chroot() there before
1179 dropping privileges. This increases the security level in case an unknown
1180 vulnerability would be exploited, since it would make it very hard for the
1181 attacker to exploit the system. This only works when the process is started
1182 with superuser privileges. It is important to ensure that <jail_dir> is both
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001183 empty and non-writable to anyone.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01001184
Christopher Fauletcb6a9452017-11-22 16:50:41 +01001185cpu-map [auto:]<process-set>[/<thread-set>] <cpu-set>...
1186 On Linux 2.6 and above, it is possible to bind a process or a thread to a
1187 specific CPU set. This means that the process or the thread will never run on
1188 other CPUs. The "cpu-map" directive specifies CPU sets for process or thread
1189 sets. The first argument is a process set, eventually followed by a thread
1190 set. These sets have the format
1191
1192 all | odd | even | number[-[number]]
1193
1194 <number>> must be a number between 1 and 32 or 64, depending on the machine's
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001195 word size. Any process IDs above nbproc and any thread IDs above nbthread are
Christopher Fauletcb6a9452017-11-22 16:50:41 +01001196 ignored. It is possible to specify a range with two such number delimited by
1197 a dash ('-'). It also is possible to specify all processes at once using
Christopher Faulet1dcb9cb2017-11-22 10:24:40 +01001198 "all", only odd numbers using "odd" or even numbers using "even", just like
1199 with the "bind-process" directive. The second and forthcoming arguments are
Amaury Denoyelle982fb532021-04-21 18:39:58 +02001200 CPU sets. Each CPU set is either a unique number starting at 0 for the first
1201 CPU or a range with two such numbers delimited by a dash ('-'). Outside of
1202 Linux and BSDs, there may be a limitation on the maximum CPU index to either
1203 31 or 63. Multiple CPU numbers or ranges may be specified, and the processes
1204 or threads will be allowed to bind to all of them. Obviously, multiple
1205 "cpu-map" directives may be specified. Each "cpu-map" directive will replace
1206 the previous ones when they overlap. A thread will be bound on the
1207 intersection of its mapping and the one of the process on which it is
1208 attached. If the intersection is null, no specific binding will be set for
1209 the thread.
Willy Tarreaufc6c0322012-11-16 16:12:27 +01001210
Christopher Fauletff4121f2017-11-22 16:38:49 +01001211 Ranges can be partially defined. The higher bound can be omitted. In such
1212 case, it is replaced by the corresponding maximum value, 32 or 64 depending
1213 on the machine's word size.
1214
Christopher Faulet26028f62017-11-22 15:01:51 +01001215 The prefix "auto:" can be added before the process set to let HAProxy
Christopher Fauletcb6a9452017-11-22 16:50:41 +01001216 automatically bind a process or a thread to a CPU by incrementing
1217 process/thread and CPU sets. To be valid, both sets must have the same
1218 size. No matter the declaration order of the CPU sets, it will be bound from
1219 the lowest to the highest bound. Having a process and a thread range with the
1220 "auto:" prefix is not supported. Only one range is supported, the other one
1221 must be a fixed number.
Christopher Faulet26028f62017-11-22 15:01:51 +01001222
1223 Examples:
Christopher Fauletcb6a9452017-11-22 16:50:41 +01001224 cpu-map 1-4 0-3 # bind processes 1 to 4 on the first 4 CPUs
1225
1226 cpu-map 1/all 0-3 # bind all threads of the first process on the
1227 # first 4 CPUs
1228
1229 cpu-map 1- 0- # will be replaced by "cpu-map 1-64 0-63"
1230 # or "cpu-map 1-32 0-31" depending on the machine's
1231 # word size.
1232
Christopher Faulet26028f62017-11-22 15:01:51 +01001233 # all these lines bind the process 1 to the cpu 0, the process 2 to cpu 1
Christopher Fauletcb6a9452017-11-22 16:50:41 +01001234 # and so on.
Christopher Faulet26028f62017-11-22 15:01:51 +01001235 cpu-map auto:1-4 0-3
1236 cpu-map auto:1-4 0-1 2-3
1237 cpu-map auto:1-4 3 2 1 0
1238
Christopher Fauletcb6a9452017-11-22 16:50:41 +01001239 # all these lines bind the thread 1 to the cpu 0, the thread 2 to cpu 1
1240 # and so on.
1241 cpu-map auto:1/1-4 0-3
1242 cpu-map auto:1/1-4 0-1 2-3
1243 cpu-map auto:1/1-4 3 2 1 0
1244
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001245 # bind each process to exactly one CPU using all/odd/even keyword
Christopher Faulet26028f62017-11-22 15:01:51 +01001246 cpu-map auto:all 0-63
1247 cpu-map auto:even 0-31
1248 cpu-map auto:odd 32-63
1249
1250 # invalid cpu-map because process and CPU sets have different sizes.
1251 cpu-map auto:1-4 0 # invalid
1252 cpu-map auto:1 0-3 # invalid
1253
Christopher Fauletcb6a9452017-11-22 16:50:41 +01001254 # invalid cpu-map because automatic binding is used with a process range
1255 # and a thread range.
1256 cpu-map auto:all/all 0 # invalid
1257 cpu-map auto:all/1-4 0 # invalid
1258 cpu-map auto:1-4/all 0 # invalid
1259
Emeric Brunc8e8d122012-10-02 18:42:10 +02001260crt-base <dir>
1261 Assigns a default directory to fetch SSL certificates from when a relative
William Dauchy238ea3b2020-01-11 13:09:12 +01001262 path is used with "crtfile" or "crt" directives. Absolute locations specified
1263 prevail and ignore "crt-base".
Emeric Brunc8e8d122012-10-02 18:42:10 +02001264
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001265daemon
1266 Makes the process fork into background. This is the recommended mode of
1267 operation. It is equivalent to the command line "-D" argument. It can be
Lukas Tribusf46bf952017-11-21 12:39:34 +01001268 disabled by the command line "-db" argument. This option is ignored in
1269 systemd mode.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001270
Willy Tarreau8a022d52021-04-27 20:29:11 +02001271default-path { current | config | parent | origin <path> }
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04001272 By default HAProxy loads all files designated by a relative path from the
Willy Tarreau8a022d52021-04-27 20:29:11 +02001273 location the process is started in. In some circumstances it might be
1274 desirable to force all relative paths to start from a different location
1275 just as if the process was started from such locations. This is what this
1276 directive is made for. Technically it will perform a temporary chdir() to
1277 the designated location while processing each configuration file, and will
1278 return to the original directory after processing each file. It takes an
1279 argument indicating the policy to use when loading files whose path does
1280 not start with a slash ('/'):
1281 - "current" indicates that all relative files are to be loaded from the
1282 directory the process is started in ; this is the default.
1283
1284 - "config" indicates that all relative files should be loaded from the
1285 directory containing the configuration file. More specifically, if the
1286 configuration file contains a slash ('/'), the longest part up to the
1287 last slash is used as the directory to change to, otherwise the current
1288 directory is used. This mode is convenient to bundle maps, errorfiles,
1289 certificates and Lua scripts together as relocatable packages. When
1290 multiple configuration files are loaded, the directory is updated for
1291 each of them.
1292
1293 - "parent" indicates that all relative files should be loaded from the
1294 parent of the directory containing the configuration file. More
1295 specifically, if the configuration file contains a slash ('/'), ".."
1296 is appended to the longest part up to the last slash is used as the
1297 directory to change to, otherwise the directory is "..". This mode is
1298 convenient to bundle maps, errorfiles, certificates and Lua scripts
1299 together as relocatable packages, but where each part is located in a
1300 different subdirectory (e.g. "config/", "certs/", "maps/", ...).
1301
1302 - "origin" indicates that all relative files should be loaded from the
1303 designated (mandatory) path. This may be used to ease management of
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04001304 different HAProxy instances running in parallel on a system, where each
Willy Tarreau8a022d52021-04-27 20:29:11 +02001305 instance uses a different prefix but where the rest of the sections are
1306 made easily relocatable.
1307
1308 Each "default-path" directive instantly replaces any previous one and will
1309 possibly result in switching to a different directory. While this should
1310 always result in the desired behavior, it is really not a good practice to
1311 use multiple default-path directives, and if used, the policy ought to remain
1312 consistent across all configuration files.
1313
1314 Warning: some configuration elements such as maps or certificates are
1315 uniquely identified by their configured path. By using a relocatable layout,
1316 it becomes possible for several of them to end up with the same unique name,
1317 making it difficult to update them at run time, especially when multiple
1318 configuration files are loaded from different directories. It is essential to
1319 observe a strict collision-free file naming scheme before adopting relative
1320 paths. A robust approach could consist in prefixing all files names with
1321 their respective site name, or in doing so at the directory level.
1322
Willy Tarreau0cb29002022-11-16 17:42:34 +01001323description <text>
1324 Add a text that describes the instance.
1325
1326 Please note that it is required to escape certain characters (# for example)
1327 and this text is inserted into a html page so you should avoid using
1328 "<" and ">" characters.
1329
David Carlier8167f302015-06-01 13:50:06 +02001330deviceatlas-json-file <path>
1331 Sets the path of the DeviceAtlas JSON data file to be loaded by the API.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001332 The path must be a valid JSON data file and accessible by HAProxy process.
David Carlier8167f302015-06-01 13:50:06 +02001333
1334deviceatlas-log-level <value>
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001335 Sets the level of information returned by the API. This directive is
David Carlier8167f302015-06-01 13:50:06 +02001336 optional and set to 0 by default if not set.
1337
Cyril Bonté0306c4a2015-10-26 22:37:38 +01001338deviceatlas-properties-cookie <name>
Cyril Bonté307ee1e2015-09-28 23:16:06 +02001339 Sets the client cookie's name used for the detection if the DeviceAtlas
1340 Client-side component was used during the request. This directive is optional
1341 and set to DAPROPS by default if not set.
David Carlier29b3ca32015-09-25 14:09:21 +01001342
Willy Tarreau0cb29002022-11-16 17:42:34 +01001343deviceatlas-separator <char>
1344 Sets the character separator for the API properties results. This directive
1345 is optional and set to | by default if not set.
1346
Amaury Denoyelled2e53cd2021-05-06 16:21:39 +02001347expose-experimental-directives
1348 This statement must appear before using directives tagged as experimental or
1349 the config file will be rejected.
1350
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09001351external-check
Willy Tarreaud96f1122019-12-03 07:07:36 +01001352 Allows the use of an external agent to perform health checks. This is
1353 disabled by default as a security precaution, and even when enabled, checks
Willy Tarreaua45a8b52019-12-06 16:31:45 +01001354 may still fail unless "insecure-fork-wanted" is enabled as well. If the
1355 program launched makes use of a setuid executable (it should really not),
1356 you may also need to set "insecure-setuid-wanted" in the global section.
1357 See "option external-check", and "insecure-fork-wanted", and
1358 "insecure-setuid-wanted".
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09001359
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001360gid <number>
Thayne McCombscdbcca92021-01-07 21:24:41 -07001361 Changes the process's group ID to <number>. It is recommended that the group
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001362 ID is dedicated to HAProxy or to a small set of similar daemons. HAProxy must
1363 be started with a user belonging to this group, or with superuser privileges.
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04001364 Note that if HAProxy is started from a user having supplementary groups, it
Michael Schererab012dd2013-01-12 18:35:19 +01001365 will only be able to drop these groups if started with superuser privileges.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001366 See also "group" and "uid".
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01001367
Willy Tarreau11770ce2019-12-03 08:29:22 +01001368group <group name>
1369 Similar to "gid" but uses the GID of group name <group name> from /etc/group.
1370 See also "gid" and "user".
1371
Christopher Faulet98fbe952019-07-22 16:18:24 +02001372h1-case-adjust <from> <to>
1373 Defines the case adjustment to apply, when enabled, to the header name
1374 <from>, to change it to <to> before sending it to HTTP/1 clients or
1375 servers. <from> must be in lower case, and <from> and <to> must not differ
1376 except for their case. It may be repeated if several header names need to be
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +05001377 adjusted. Duplicate entries are not allowed. If a lot of header names have to
Christopher Faulet98fbe952019-07-22 16:18:24 +02001378 be adjusted, it might be more convenient to use "h1-case-adjust-file".
1379 Please note that no transformation will be applied unless "option
1380 h1-case-adjust-bogus-client" or "option h1-case-adjust-bogus-server" is
1381 specified in a proxy.
1382
1383 There is no standard case for header names because, as stated in RFC7230,
1384 they are case-insensitive. So applications must handle them in a case-
1385 insensitive manner. But some bogus applications violate the standards and
1386 erroneously rely on the cases most commonly used by browsers. This problem
1387 becomes critical with HTTP/2 because all header names must be exchanged in
1388 lower case, and HAProxy follows the same convention. All header names are
1389 sent in lower case to clients and servers, regardless of the HTTP version.
1390
1391 Applications which fail to properly process requests or responses may require
1392 to temporarily use such workarounds to adjust header names sent to them for
1393 the time it takes the application to be fixed. Please note that an
1394 application which requires such workarounds might be vulnerable to content
1395 smuggling attacks and must absolutely be fixed.
1396
1397 Example:
1398 global
1399 h1-case-adjust content-length Content-Length
1400
1401 See "h1-case-adjust-file", "option h1-case-adjust-bogus-client" and
1402 "option h1-case-adjust-bogus-server".
1403
1404h1-case-adjust-file <hdrs-file>
1405 Defines a file containing a list of key/value pairs used to adjust the case
1406 of some header names before sending them to HTTP/1 clients or servers. The
1407 file <hdrs-file> must contain 2 header names per line. The first one must be
1408 in lower case and both must not differ except for their case. Lines which
1409 start with '#' are ignored, just like empty lines. Leading and trailing tabs
1410 and spaces are stripped. Duplicate entries are not allowed. Please note that
1411 no transformation will be applied unless "option h1-case-adjust-bogus-client"
1412 or "option h1-case-adjust-bogus-server" is specified in a proxy.
1413
1414 If this directive is repeated, only the last one will be processed. It is an
1415 alternative to the directive "h1-case-adjust" if a lot of header names need
1416 to be adjusted. Please read the risks associated with using this.
1417
1418 See "h1-case-adjust", "option h1-case-adjust-bogus-client" and
1419 "option h1-case-adjust-bogus-server".
1420
Willy Tarreau0cb29002022-11-16 17:42:34 +01001421h2-workaround-bogus-websocket-clients
1422 This disables the announcement of the support for h2 websockets to clients.
1423 This can be use to overcome clients which have issues when implementing the
1424 relatively fresh RFC8441, such as Firefox 88. To allow clients to
1425 automatically downgrade to http/1.1 for the websocket tunnel, specify h2
1426 support on the bind line using "alpn" without an explicit "proto" keyword. If
1427 this statement was previously activated, this can be disabled by prefixing
1428 the keyword with "no'.
1429
1430hard-stop-after <time>
1431 Defines the maximum time allowed to perform a clean soft-stop.
1432
1433 Arguments :
1434 <time> is the maximum time (by default in milliseconds) for which the
1435 instance will remain alive when a soft-stop is received via the
1436 SIGUSR1 signal.
1437
1438 This may be used to ensure that the instance will quit even if connections
1439 remain opened during a soft-stop (for example with long timeouts for a proxy
1440 in tcp mode). It applies both in TCP and HTTP mode.
1441
1442 Example:
1443 global
1444 hard-stop-after 30s
1445
1446 See also: grace
1447
Willy Tarreaud96f1122019-12-03 07:07:36 +01001448insecure-fork-wanted
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04001449 By default HAProxy tries hard to prevent any thread and process creation
Willy Tarreaud96f1122019-12-03 07:07:36 +01001450 after it starts. Doing so is particularly important when using Lua files of
1451 uncertain origin, and when experimenting with development versions which may
1452 still contain bugs whose exploitability is uncertain. And generally speaking
1453 it's good hygiene to make sure that no unexpected background activity can be
1454 triggered by traffic. But this prevents external checks from working, and may
1455 break some very specific Lua scripts which actively rely on the ability to
1456 fork. This option is there to disable this protection. Note that it is a bad
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04001457 idea to disable it, as a vulnerability in a library or within HAProxy itself
Willy Tarreaud96f1122019-12-03 07:07:36 +01001458 will be easier to exploit once disabled. In addition, forking from Lua or
1459 anywhere else is not reliable as the forked process may randomly embed a lock
1460 set by another thread and never manage to finish an operation. As such it is
1461 highly recommended that this option is never used and that any workload
1462 requiring such a fork be reconsidered and moved to a safer solution (such as
1463 agents instead of external checks). This option supports the "no" prefix to
1464 disable it.
1465
Willy Tarreaua45a8b52019-12-06 16:31:45 +01001466insecure-setuid-wanted
1467 HAProxy doesn't need to call executables at run time (except when using
1468 external checks which are strongly recommended against), and is even expected
1469 to isolate itself into an empty chroot. As such, there basically is no valid
1470 reason to allow a setuid executable to be called without the user being fully
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04001471 aware of the risks. In a situation where HAProxy would need to call external
Willy Tarreaua45a8b52019-12-06 16:31:45 +01001472 checks and/or disable chroot, exploiting a vulnerability in a library or in
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04001473 HAProxy itself could lead to the execution of an external program. On Linux
Willy Tarreaua45a8b52019-12-06 16:31:45 +01001474 it is possible to lock the process so that any setuid bit present on such an
1475 executable is ignored. This significantly reduces the risk of privilege
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04001476 escalation in such a situation. This is what HAProxy does by default. In case
Willy Tarreaua45a8b52019-12-06 16:31:45 +01001477 this causes a problem to an external check (for example one which would need
1478 the "ping" command), then it is possible to disable this protection by
1479 explicitly adding this directive in the global section. If enabled, it is
1480 possible to turn it back off by prefixing it with the "no" keyword.
1481
Emmanuel Hocdet70df7bf2019-01-04 11:08:20 +01001482issuers-chain-path <dir>
1483 Assigns a directory to load certificate chain for issuer completion. All
1484 files must be in PEM format. For certificates loaded with "crt" or "crt-list",
1485 if certificate chain is not included in PEM (also commonly known as
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04001486 intermediate certificate), HAProxy will complete chain if the issuer of the
Emmanuel Hocdet70df7bf2019-01-04 11:08:20 +01001487 certificate corresponds to the first certificate of the chain loaded with
1488 "issuers-chain-path".
1489 A "crt" file with PrivateKey+Certificate+IntermediateCA2+IntermediateCA1
1490 could be replaced with PrivateKey+Certificate. HAProxy will complete the
1491 chain if a file with IntermediateCA2+IntermediateCA1 is present in
1492 "issuers-chain-path" directory. All other certificates with the same issuer
1493 will share the chain in memory.
1494
Dragan Dosen13cd54c2020-06-18 18:24:05 +02001495localpeer <name>
1496 Sets the local instance's peer name. It will be ignored if the "-L"
1497 command line argument is specified or if used after "peers" section
1498 definitions. In such cases, a warning message will be emitted during
1499 the configuration parsing.
1500
1501 This option will also set the HAPROXY_LOCALPEER environment variable.
1502 See also "-L" in the management guide and "peers" section below.
1503
Jan Wagner3e678602020-12-17 22:22:32 +01001504log <address> [len <length>] [format <format>] [sample <ranges>:<sample_size>]
Frédéric Lécailled690dfa2019-04-25 10:52:17 +02001505 <facility> [max level [min level]]
Cyril Bonté3e954872018-03-20 23:30:27 +01001506 Adds a global syslog server. Several global servers can be defined. They
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001507 will receive logs for starts and exits, as well as all logs from proxies
Robert Tsai81ae1952007-12-05 10:47:29 +01001508 configured with "log global".
1509
1510 <address> can be one of:
1511
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01001512 - An IPv4 address optionally followed by a colon and a UDP port. If
Robert Tsai81ae1952007-12-05 10:47:29 +01001513 no port is specified, 514 is used by default (the standard syslog
1514 port).
1515
David du Colombier24bb5f52011-03-17 10:40:23 +01001516 - An IPv6 address followed by a colon and optionally a UDP port. If
1517 no port is specified, 514 is used by default (the standard syslog
1518 port).
1519
Willy Tarreau5a32ecc2018-11-12 07:34:59 +01001520 - A filesystem path to a datagram UNIX domain socket, keeping in mind
Robert Tsai81ae1952007-12-05 10:47:29 +01001521 considerations for chroot (be sure the path is accessible inside
1522 the chroot) and uid/gid (be sure the path is appropriately
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001523 writable).
Robert Tsai81ae1952007-12-05 10:47:29 +01001524
Willy Tarreau5a32ecc2018-11-12 07:34:59 +01001525 - A file descriptor number in the form "fd@<number>", which may point
1526 to a pipe, terminal, or socket. In this case unbuffered logs are used
1527 and one writev() call per log is performed. This is a bit expensive
1528 but acceptable for most workloads. Messages sent this way will not be
1529 truncated but may be dropped, in which case the DroppedLogs counter
1530 will be incremented. The writev() call is atomic even on pipes for
1531 messages up to PIPE_BUF size, which POSIX recommends to be at least
1532 512 and which is 4096 bytes on most modern operating systems. Any
1533 larger message may be interleaved with messages from other processes.
1534 Exceptionally for debugging purposes the file descriptor may also be
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04001535 directed to a file, but doing so will significantly slow HAProxy down
Willy Tarreau5a32ecc2018-11-12 07:34:59 +01001536 as non-blocking calls will be ignored. Also there will be no way to
1537 purge nor rotate this file without restarting the process. Note that
1538 the configured syslog format is preserved, so the output is suitable
Willy Tarreauc1b06452018-11-12 11:57:56 +01001539 for use with a TCP syslog server. See also the "short" and "raw"
1540 format below.
Willy Tarreau5a32ecc2018-11-12 07:34:59 +01001541
1542 - "stdout" / "stderr", which are respectively aliases for "fd@1" and
1543 "fd@2", see above.
1544
Willy Tarreauc046d162019-08-30 15:24:59 +02001545 - A ring buffer in the form "ring@<name>", which will correspond to an
1546 in-memory ring buffer accessible over the CLI using the "show events"
1547 command, which will also list existing rings and their sizes. Such
1548 buffers are lost on reload or restart but when used as a complement
1549 this can help troubleshooting by having the logs instantly available.
1550
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +02001551 You may want to reference some environment variables in the address
1552 parameter, see section 2.3 about environment variables.
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01001553
Willy Tarreau18324f52014-06-27 18:10:07 +02001554 <length> is an optional maximum line length. Log lines larger than this value
1555 will be truncated before being sent. The reason is that syslog
1556 servers act differently on log line length. All servers support the
1557 default value of 1024, but some servers simply drop larger lines
1558 while others do log them. If a server supports long lines, it may
1559 make sense to set this value here in order to avoid truncating long
1560 lines. Similarly, if a server drops long lines, it is preferable to
1561 truncate them before sending them. Accepted values are 80 to 65535
1562 inclusive. The default value of 1024 is generally fine for all
1563 standard usages. Some specific cases of long captures or
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001564 JSON-formatted logs may require larger values. You may also need to
1565 increase "tune.http.logurilen" if your request URIs are truncated.
Willy Tarreau18324f52014-06-27 18:10:07 +02001566
Dragan Dosen7ad31542015-09-28 17:16:47 +02001567 <format> is the log format used when generating syslog messages. It may be
1568 one of the following :
1569
Emeric Brun0237c4e2020-11-27 16:24:34 +01001570 local Analog to rfc3164 syslog message format except that hostname
1571 field is stripped. This is the default.
1572 Note: option "log-send-hostname" switches the default to
1573 rfc3164.
1574
1575 rfc3164 The RFC3164 syslog message format.
Dragan Dosen7ad31542015-09-28 17:16:47 +02001576 (https://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc3164)
1577
1578 rfc5424 The RFC5424 syslog message format.
1579 (https://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc5424)
1580
Emeric Brun54648852020-07-06 15:54:06 +02001581 priority A message containing only a level plus syslog facility between
1582 angle brackets such as '<63>', followed by the text. The PID,
1583 date, time, process name and system name are omitted. This is
1584 designed to be used with a local log server.
1585
Willy Tarreaue8746a02018-11-12 08:45:00 +01001586 short A message containing only a level between angle brackets such as
1587 '<3>', followed by the text. The PID, date, time, process name
1588 and system name are omitted. This is designed to be used with a
1589 local log server. This format is compatible with what the systemd
1590 logger consumes.
1591
Emeric Brun54648852020-07-06 15:54:06 +02001592 timed A message containing only a level between angle brackets such as
1593 '<3>', followed by ISO date and by the text. The PID, process
1594 name and system name are omitted. This is designed to be
1595 used with a local log server.
1596
1597 iso A message containing only the ISO date, followed by the text.
1598 The PID, process name and system name are omitted. This is
1599 designed to be used with a local log server.
1600
Willy Tarreauc1b06452018-11-12 11:57:56 +01001601 raw A message containing only the text. The level, PID, date, time,
1602 process name and system name are omitted. This is designed to be
1603 used in containers or during development, where the severity only
1604 depends on the file descriptor used (stdout/stderr).
1605
Frédéric Lécailled690dfa2019-04-25 10:52:17 +02001606 <ranges> A list of comma-separated ranges to identify the logs to sample.
1607 This is used to balance the load of the logs to send to the log
1608 server. The limits of the ranges cannot be null. They are numbered
1609 from 1. The size or period (in number of logs) of the sample must be
1610 set with <sample_size> parameter.
1611
1612 <sample_size>
1613 The size of the sample in number of logs to consider when balancing
1614 their logging loads. It is used to balance the load of the logs to
1615 send to the syslog server. This size must be greater or equal to the
1616 maximum of the high limits of the ranges.
1617 (see also <ranges> parameter).
1618
Robert Tsai81ae1952007-12-05 10:47:29 +01001619 <facility> must be one of the 24 standard syslog facilities :
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001620
Willy Tarreaue8746a02018-11-12 08:45:00 +01001621 kern user mail daemon auth syslog lpr news
1622 uucp cron auth2 ftp ntp audit alert cron2
1623 local0 local1 local2 local3 local4 local5 local6 local7
1624
Willy Tarreauc1b06452018-11-12 11:57:56 +01001625 Note that the facility is ignored for the "short" and "raw"
1626 formats, but still required as a positional field. It is
1627 recommended to use "daemon" in this case to make it clear that
1628 it's only supposed to be used locally.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001629
1630 An optional level can be specified to filter outgoing messages. By default,
Willy Tarreauf7edefa2009-05-10 17:20:05 +02001631 all messages are sent. If a maximum level is specified, only messages with a
1632 severity at least as important as this level will be sent. An optional minimum
1633 level can be specified. If it is set, logs emitted with a more severe level
1634 than this one will be capped to this level. This is used to avoid sending
1635 "emerg" messages on all terminals on some default syslog configurations.
1636 Eight levels are known :
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001637
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02001638 emerg alert crit err warning notice info debug
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001639
Joe Williamsdf5b38f2010-12-29 17:05:48 +01001640log-send-hostname [<string>]
1641 Sets the hostname field in the syslog header. If optional "string" parameter
1642 is set the header is set to the string contents, otherwise uses the hostname
1643 of the system. Generally used if one is not relaying logs through an
1644 intermediate syslog server or for simply customizing the hostname printed in
1645 the logs.
1646
Kevinm48936af2010-12-22 16:08:21 +00001647log-tag <string>
1648 Sets the tag field in the syslog header to this string. It defaults to the
1649 program name as launched from the command line, which usually is "haproxy".
1650 Sometimes it can be useful to differentiate between multiple processes
Willy Tarreau094af4e2015-01-07 15:03:42 +01001651 running on the same host. See also the per-proxy "log-tag" directive.
Kevinm48936af2010-12-22 16:08:21 +00001652
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +01001653lua-load <file>
Thierry Fournier59f11be2020-11-29 00:37:41 +01001654 This global directive loads and executes a Lua file in the shared context
1655 that is visible to all threads. Any variable set in such a context is visible
1656 from any thread. This is the easiest and recommended way to load Lua programs
1657 but it will not scale well if a lot of Lua calls are performed, as only one
1658 thread may be running on the global state at a time. A program loaded this
1659 way will always see 0 in the "core.thread" variable. This directive can be
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +01001660 used multiple times.
1661
Thierry Fournier59f11be2020-11-29 00:37:41 +01001662lua-load-per-thread <file>
1663 This global directive loads and executes a Lua file into each started thread.
1664 Any global variable has a thread-local visibility so that each thread could
1665 see a different value. As such it is strongly recommended not to use global
1666 variables in programs loaded this way. An independent copy is loaded and
1667 initialized for each thread, everything is done sequentially and in the
1668 thread's numeric order from 1 to nbthread. If some operations need to be
1669 performed only once, the program should check the "core.thread" variable to
1670 figure what thread is being initialized. Programs loaded this way will run
1671 concurrently on all threads and will be highly scalable. This is the
1672 recommended way to load simple functions that register sample-fetches,
1673 converters, actions or services once it is certain the program doesn't depend
1674 on global variables. For the sake of simplicity, the directive is available
1675 even if only one thread is used and even if threads are disabled (in which
1676 case it will be equivalent to lua-load). This directive can be used multiple
1677 times.
1678
Tim Duesterhusdd74b5f2020-01-12 13:55:40 +01001679lua-prepend-path <string> [<type>]
1680 Prepends the given string followed by a semicolon to Lua's package.<type>
1681 variable.
1682 <type> must either be "path" or "cpath". If <type> is not given it defaults
1683 to "path".
1684
1685 Lua's paths are semicolon delimited lists of patterns that specify how the
1686 `require` function attempts to find the source file of a library. Question
1687 marks (?) within a pattern will be replaced by module name. The path is
1688 evaluated left to right. This implies that paths that are prepended later
1689 will be checked earlier.
1690
1691 As an example by specifying the following path:
1692
1693 lua-prepend-path /usr/share/haproxy-lua/?/init.lua
1694 lua-prepend-path /usr/share/haproxy-lua/?.lua
1695
1696 When `require "example"` is being called Lua will first attempt to load the
1697 /usr/share/haproxy-lua/example.lua script, if that does not exist the
1698 /usr/share/haproxy-lua/example/init.lua will be attempted and the default
1699 paths if that does not exist either.
1700
1701 See https://www.lua.org/pil/8.1.html for the details within the Lua
1702 documentation.
1703
William Lallemand4cfede82017-11-24 22:02:34 +01001704master-worker [no-exit-on-failure]
William Lallemande202b1e2017-06-01 17:38:56 +02001705 Master-worker mode. It is equivalent to the command line "-W" argument.
1706 This mode will launch a "master" which will monitor the "workers". Using
1707 this mode, you can reload HAProxy directly by sending a SIGUSR2 signal to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001708 the master. The master-worker mode is compatible either with the foreground
William Lallemande202b1e2017-06-01 17:38:56 +02001709 or daemon mode. It is recommended to use this mode with multiprocess and
1710 systemd.
William Lallemand4cfede82017-11-24 22:02:34 +01001711 By default, if a worker exits with a bad return code, in the case of a
1712 segfault for example, all workers will be killed, and the master will leave.
1713 It is convenient to combine this behavior with Restart=on-failure in a
1714 systemd unit file in order to relaunch the whole process. If you don't want
1715 this behavior, you must use the keyword "no-exit-on-failure".
William Lallemande202b1e2017-06-01 17:38:56 +02001716
William Lallemand4cfede82017-11-24 22:02:34 +01001717 See also "-W" in the management guide.
William Lallemande202b1e2017-06-01 17:38:56 +02001718
William Lallemand27edc4b2019-05-07 17:49:33 +02001719mworker-max-reloads <number>
1720 In master-worker mode, this option limits the number of time a worker can
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -05001721 survive to a reload. If the worker did not leave after a reload, once its
William Lallemand27edc4b2019-05-07 17:49:33 +02001722 number of reloads is greater than this number, the worker will receive a
1723 SIGTERM. This option helps to keep under control the number of workers.
1724 See also "show proc" in the Management Guide.
1725
Willy Tarreauf42d7942020-10-20 11:54:49 +02001726nbproc <number> (deprecated)
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001727 Creates <number> processes when going daemon. This requires the "daemon"
1728 mode. By default, only one process is created, which is the recommended mode
1729 of operation. For systems limited to small sets of file descriptors per
Willy Tarreau149ab772019-01-26 14:27:06 +01001730 process, it may be needed to fork multiple daemons. When set to a value
1731 larger than 1, threads are automatically disabled. USING MULTIPLE PROCESSES
Willy Tarreauf42d7942020-10-20 11:54:49 +02001732 IS HARDER TO DEBUG AND IS REALLY DISCOURAGED. This directive is deprecated
1733 and scheduled for removal in 2.5. Please use "nbthread" instead. See also
1734 "daemon" and "nbthread".
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001735
Christopher Fauletbe0faa22017-08-29 15:37:10 +02001736nbthread <number>
1737 This setting is only available when support for threads was built in. It
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04001738 makes HAProxy run on <number> threads. This is exclusive with "nbproc". While
Willy Tarreau26f6ae12019-02-02 12:56:15 +01001739 "nbproc" historically used to be the only way to use multiple processors, it
1740 also involved a number of shortcomings related to the lack of synchronization
1741 between processes (health-checks, peers, stick-tables, stats, ...) which do
1742 not affect threads. As such, any modern configuration is strongly encouraged
Willy Tarreau149ab772019-01-26 14:27:06 +01001743 to migrate away from "nbproc" to "nbthread". "nbthread" also works when
1744 HAProxy is started in foreground. On some platforms supporting CPU affinity,
1745 when nbproc is not used, the default "nbthread" value is automatically set to
1746 the number of CPUs the process is bound to upon startup. This means that the
1747 thread count can easily be adjusted from the calling process using commands
1748 like "taskset" or "cpuset". Otherwise, this value defaults to 1. The default
1749 value is reported in the output of "haproxy -vv". See also "nbproc".
Christopher Fauletbe0faa22017-08-29 15:37:10 +02001750
Amaury Denoyelle0f50cb92021-03-26 18:50:33 +01001751numa-cpu-mapping
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04001752 By default, if running on Linux, HAProxy inspects on startup the CPU topology
Amaury Denoyelle0f50cb92021-03-26 18:50:33 +01001753 of the machine. If a multi-socket machine is detected, the affinity is
1754 automatically calculated to run on the CPUs of a single node. This is done in
1755 order to not suffer from the performance penalties caused by the inter-socket
1756 bus latency. However, if the applied binding is non optimal on a particular
1757 architecture, it can be disabled with the statement 'no numa-cpu-mapping'.
1758 This automatic binding is also not applied if a nbthread statement is present
1759 in the configuration, or the affinity of the process is already specified,
1760 for example via the 'cpu-map' directive or the taskset utility.
1761
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001762pidfile <pidfile>
MIZUTA Takeshic32f3942020-08-26 13:46:19 +09001763 Writes PIDs of all daemons into file <pidfile> when daemon mode or writes PID
1764 of master process into file <pidfile> when master-worker mode. This option is
1765 equivalent to the "-p" command line argument. The file must be accessible to
1766 the user starting the process. See also "daemon" and "master-worker".
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001767
Willy Tarreau119e50e2020-05-22 13:53:29 +02001768pp2-never-send-local
1769 A bug in the PROXY protocol v2 implementation was present in HAProxy up to
1770 version 2.1, causing it to emit a PROXY command instead of a LOCAL command
1771 for health checks. This is particularly minor but confuses some servers'
1772 logs. Sadly, the bug was discovered very late and revealed that some servers
1773 which possibly only tested their PROXY protocol implementation against
1774 HAProxy fail to properly handle the LOCAL command, and permanently remain in
1775 the "down" state when HAProxy checks them. When this happens, it is possible
1776 to enable this global option to revert to the older (bogus) behavior for the
1777 time it takes to contact the affected components' vendors and get them fixed.
1778 This option is disabled by default and acts on all servers having the
1779 "send-proxy-v2" statement.
1780
Willy Tarreau1d549722016-02-16 12:41:57 +01001781presetenv <name> <value>
1782 Sets environment variable <name> to value <value>. If the variable exists, it
1783 is NOT overwritten. The changes immediately take effect so that the next line
1784 in the configuration file sees the new value. See also "setenv", "resetenv",
1785 and "unsetenv".
1786
1787resetenv [<name> ...]
1788 Removes all environment variables except the ones specified in argument. It
1789 allows to use a clean controlled environment before setting new values with
1790 setenv or unsetenv. Please note that some internal functions may make use of
1791 some environment variables, such as time manipulation functions, but also
1792 OpenSSL or even external checks. This must be used with extreme care and only
1793 after complete validation. The changes immediately take effect so that the
1794 next line in the configuration file sees the new environment. See also
1795 "setenv", "presetenv", and "unsetenv".
1796
Christopher Fauletff4121f2017-11-22 16:38:49 +01001797stats bind-process [ all | odd | even | <process_num>[-[process_num>]] ] ...
Willy Tarreau35b7b162012-10-22 23:17:18 +02001798 Limits the stats socket to a certain set of processes numbers. By default the
1799 stats socket is bound to all processes, causing a warning to be emitted when
1800 nbproc is greater than 1 because there is no way to select the target process
1801 when connecting. However, by using this setting, it becomes possible to pin
1802 the stats socket to a specific set of processes, typically the first one. The
1803 warning will automatically be disabled when this setting is used, whatever
Willy Tarreaua9db57e2013-01-18 11:29:29 +01001804 the number of processes used. The maximum process ID depends on the machine's
Christopher Fauletff4121f2017-11-22 16:38:49 +01001805 word size (32 or 64). Ranges can be partially defined. The higher bound can
1806 be omitted. In such case, it is replaced by the corresponding maximum
1807 value. A better option consists in using the "process" setting of the "stats
1808 socket" line to force the process on each line.
Willy Tarreau35b7b162012-10-22 23:17:18 +02001809
Baptiste Assmann5626f482015-08-23 10:00:10 +02001810server-state-base <directory>
1811 Specifies the directory prefix to be prepended in front of all servers state
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02001812 file names which do not start with a '/'. See also "server-state-file",
1813 "load-server-state-from-file" and "server-state-file-name".
Baptiste Assmannef1f0fc2015-08-23 10:06:39 +02001814
1815server-state-file <file>
1816 Specifies the path to the file containing state of servers. If the path starts
1817 with a slash ('/'), it is considered absolute, otherwise it is considered
1818 relative to the directory specified using "server-state-base" (if set) or to
1819 the current directory. Before reloading HAProxy, it is possible to save the
1820 servers' current state using the stats command "show servers state". The
1821 output of this command must be written in the file pointed by <file>. When
1822 starting up, before handling traffic, HAProxy will read, load and apply state
1823 for each server found in the file and available in its current running
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02001824 configuration. See also "server-state-base" and "show servers state",
1825 "load-server-state-from-file" and "server-state-file-name"
Baptiste Assmann5626f482015-08-23 10:00:10 +02001826
Willy Tarreau0cb29002022-11-16 17:42:34 +01001827set-dumpable
1828 This option is better left disabled by default and enabled only upon a
1829 developer's request. If it has been enabled, it may still be forcibly
1830 disabled by prefixing it with the "no" keyword. It has no impact on
1831 performance nor stability but will try hard to re-enable core dumps that were
1832 possibly disabled by file size limitations (ulimit -f), core size limitations
1833 (ulimit -c), or "dumpability" of a process after changing its UID/GID (such
1834 as /proc/sys/fs/suid_dumpable on Linux). Core dumps might still be limited by
1835 the current directory's permissions (check what directory the file is started
1836 from), the chroot directory's permission (it may be needed to temporarily
1837 disable the chroot directive or to move it to a dedicated writable location),
1838 or any other system-specific constraint. For example, some Linux flavours are
1839 notorious for replacing the default core file with a path to an executable
1840 not even installed on the system (check /proc/sys/kernel/core_pattern). Often,
1841 simply writing "core", "core.%p" or "/var/log/core/core.%p" addresses the
1842 issue. When trying to enable this option waiting for a rare issue to
1843 re-appear, it's often a good idea to first try to obtain such a dump by
1844 issuing, for example, "kill -11" to the "haproxy" process and verify that it
1845 leaves a core where expected when dying.
1846
Willy Tarreau13d2ba22021-03-26 11:38:08 +01001847set-var <var-name> <expr>
1848 Sets the process-wide variable '<var-name>' to the result of the evaluation
1849 of the sample expression <expr>. The variable '<var-name>' may only be a
1850 process-wide variable (using the 'proc.' prefix). It works exactly like the
1851 'set-var' action in TCP or HTTP rules except that the expression is evaluated
1852 at configuration parsing time and that the variable is instantly set. The
1853 sample fetch functions and converters permitted in the expression are only
1854 those using internal data, typically 'int(value)' or 'str(value)'. It's is
1855 possible to reference previously allocated variables as well. These variables
1856 will then be readable (and modifiable) from the regular rule sets.
1857
1858 Example:
1859 global
1860 set-var proc.current_state str(primary)
1861 set-var proc.prio int(100)
1862 set-var proc.threshold int(200),sub(proc.prio)
1863
Willy Tarreau1d549722016-02-16 12:41:57 +01001864setenv <name> <value>
1865 Sets environment variable <name> to value <value>. If the variable exists, it
1866 is overwritten. The changes immediately take effect so that the next line in
1867 the configuration file sees the new value. See also "presetenv", "resetenv",
1868 and "unsetenv".
1869
Willy Tarreau610f04b2014-02-13 11:36:41 +01001870ssl-default-bind-ciphers <ciphers>
1871 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
1872 the default string describing the list of cipher algorithms ("cipher suite")
Bertrand Jacquin8cf7c1e2019-02-03 18:35:25 +00001873 that are negotiated during the SSL/TLS handshake up to TLSv1.2 for all
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +02001874 "bind" lines which do not explicitly define theirs. The format of the string
Bertrand Jacquin4f03ab02019-02-03 18:48:49 +00001875 is defined in "man 1 ciphers" from OpenSSL man pages. For background
1876 information and recommendations see e.g.
1877 (https://wiki.mozilla.org/Security/Server_Side_TLS) and
1878 (https://mozilla.github.io/server-side-tls/ssl-config-generator/). For TLSv1.3
1879 cipher configuration, please check the "ssl-default-bind-ciphersuites" keyword.
1880 Please check the "bind" keyword for more information.
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +02001881
1882ssl-default-bind-ciphersuites <ciphersuites>
1883 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in and
1884 OpenSSL 1.1.1 or later was used to build HAProxy. It sets the default string
1885 describing the list of cipher algorithms ("cipher suite") that are negotiated
1886 during the TLSv1.3 handshake for all "bind" lines which do not explicitly define
1887 theirs. The format of the string is defined in
Bertrand Jacquin4f03ab02019-02-03 18:48:49 +00001888 "man 1 ciphers" from OpenSSL man pages under the section "ciphersuites". For
1889 cipher configuration for TLSv1.2 and earlier, please check the
1890 "ssl-default-bind-ciphers" keyword. Please check the "bind" keyword for more
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +02001891 information.
Willy Tarreau610f04b2014-02-13 11:36:41 +01001892
Jerome Magninb203ff62020-04-03 15:28:22 +02001893ssl-default-bind-curves <curves>
1894 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
1895 the default string describing the list of elliptic curves algorithms ("curve
1896 suite") that are negotiated during the SSL/TLS handshake with ECDHE. The format
1897 of the string is a colon-delimited list of curve name.
1898 Please check the "bind" keyword for more information.
1899
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +01001900ssl-default-bind-options [<option>]...
1901 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
1902 default ssl-options to force on all "bind" lines. Please check the "bind"
1903 keyword to see available options.
1904
1905 Example:
1906 global
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +02001907 ssl-default-bind-options ssl-min-ver TLSv1.0 no-tls-tickets
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +01001908
Willy Tarreau610f04b2014-02-13 11:36:41 +01001909ssl-default-server-ciphers <ciphers>
1910 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
1911 sets the default string describing the list of cipher algorithms that are
Bertrand Jacquin8cf7c1e2019-02-03 18:35:25 +00001912 negotiated during the SSL/TLS handshake up to TLSv1.2 with the server,
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +02001913 for all "server" lines which do not explicitly define theirs. The format of
Bertrand Jacquin4f03ab02019-02-03 18:48:49 +00001914 the string is defined in "man 1 ciphers" from OpenSSL man pages. For background
1915 information and recommendations see e.g.
1916 (https://wiki.mozilla.org/Security/Server_Side_TLS) and
1917 (https://mozilla.github.io/server-side-tls/ssl-config-generator/).
1918 For TLSv1.3 cipher configuration, please check the
1919 "ssl-default-server-ciphersuites" keyword. Please check the "server" keyword
1920 for more information.
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +02001921
1922ssl-default-server-ciphersuites <ciphersuites>
1923 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in and
1924 OpenSSL 1.1.1 or later was used to build HAProxy. It sets the default
1925 string describing the list of cipher algorithms that are negotiated during
1926 the TLSv1.3 handshake with the server, for all "server" lines which do not
1927 explicitly define theirs. The format of the string is defined in
Bertrand Jacquin4f03ab02019-02-03 18:48:49 +00001928 "man 1 ciphers" from OpenSSL man pages under the section "ciphersuites". For
1929 cipher configuration for TLSv1.2 and earlier, please check the
1930 "ssl-default-server-ciphers" keyword. Please check the "server" keyword for
1931 more information.
Willy Tarreau610f04b2014-02-13 11:36:41 +01001932
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +01001933ssl-default-server-options [<option>]...
1934 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
1935 default ssl-options to force on all "server" lines. Please check the "server"
1936 keyword to see available options.
1937
Remi Gacogne47783ef2015-05-29 15:53:22 +02001938ssl-dh-param-file <file>
1939 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
1940 the default DH parameters that are used during the SSL/TLS handshake when
1941 ephemeral Diffie-Hellman (DHE) key exchange is used, for all "bind" lines
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001942 which do not explicitly define theirs. It will be overridden by custom DH
Remi Gacogne47783ef2015-05-29 15:53:22 +02001943 parameters found in a bind certificate file if any. If custom DH parameters
Cyril Bonté307ee1e2015-09-28 23:16:06 +02001944 are not specified either by using ssl-dh-param-file or by setting them
1945 directly in the certificate file, pre-generated DH parameters of the size
1946 specified by tune.ssl.default-dh-param will be used. Custom parameters are
1947 known to be more secure and therefore their use is recommended.
Remi Gacogne47783ef2015-05-29 15:53:22 +02001948 Custom DH parameters may be generated by using the OpenSSL command
1949 "openssl dhparam <size>", where size should be at least 2048, as 1024-bit DH
1950 parameters should not be considered secure anymore.
1951
William Lallemand8e8581e2020-10-20 17:36:46 +02001952ssl-load-extra-del-ext
1953 This setting allows to configure the way HAProxy does the lookup for the
1954 extra SSL files. By default HAProxy adds a new extension to the filename.
William Lallemand089c1382020-10-23 17:35:12 +02001955 (ex: with "foobar.crt" load "foobar.crt.key"). With this option enabled,
William Lallemand8e8581e2020-10-20 17:36:46 +02001956 HAProxy removes the extension before adding the new one (ex: with
William Lallemand089c1382020-10-23 17:35:12 +02001957 "foobar.crt" load "foobar.key").
1958
1959 Your crt file must have a ".crt" extension for this option to work.
William Lallemand8e8581e2020-10-20 17:36:46 +02001960
1961 This option is not compatible with bundle extensions (.ecdsa, .rsa. .dsa)
1962 and won't try to remove them.
1963
1964 This option is disabled by default. See also "ssl-load-extra-files".
1965
William Lallemand4c5adbf2020-02-24 14:23:22 +01001966ssl-load-extra-files <none|all|bundle|sctl|ocsp|issuer|key>*
William Lallemand3af48e72020-02-03 17:15:52 +01001967 This setting alters the way HAProxy will look for unspecified files during
Remi Tricot-Le Breton7c980df2021-05-07 15:28:08 +02001968 the loading of the SSL certificates. This option applies to certificates
1969 associated to "bind" lines as well as "server" lines but some of the extra
1970 files will not have any functional impact for "server" line certificates.
William Lallemand3af48e72020-02-03 17:15:52 +01001971
1972 By default, HAProxy discovers automatically a lot of files not specified in
1973 the configuration, and you may want to disable this behavior if you want to
1974 optimize the startup time.
1975
1976 "none": Only load the files specified in the configuration. Don't try to load
1977 a certificate bundle if the file does not exist. In the case of a directory,
1978 it won't try to bundle the certificates if they have the same basename.
1979
1980 "all": This is the default behavior, it will try to load everything,
William Lallemand4c5adbf2020-02-24 14:23:22 +01001981 bundles, sctl, ocsp, issuer, key.
William Lallemand3af48e72020-02-03 17:15:52 +01001982
1983 "bundle": When a file specified in the configuration does not exist, HAProxy
Remi Tricot-Le Breton7c980df2021-05-07 15:28:08 +02001984 will try to load a "cert bundle". Certificate bundles are only managed on the
1985 frontend side and will not work for backend certificates.
William Lallemandf9ff3ec2020-10-02 17:57:44 +02001986
1987 Starting from HAProxy 2.3, the bundles are not loaded in the same OpenSSL
1988 certificate store, instead it will loads each certificate in a separate
1989 store which is equivalent to declaring multiple "crt". OpenSSL 1.1.1 is
1990 required to achieve this. Which means that bundles are now used only for
1991 backward compatibility and are not mandatory anymore to do an hybrid RSA/ECC
Remi Tricot-Le Breton7c980df2021-05-07 15:28:08 +02001992 bind configuration.
William Lallemandf9ff3ec2020-10-02 17:57:44 +02001993
1994 To associate these PEM files into a "cert bundle" that is recognized by
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04001995 HAProxy, they must be named in the following way: All PEM files that are to
William Lallemandf9ff3ec2020-10-02 17:57:44 +02001996 be bundled must have the same base name, with a suffix indicating the key
1997 type. Currently, three suffixes are supported: rsa, dsa and ecdsa. For
1998 example, if www.example.com has two PEM files, an RSA file and an ECDSA
1999 file, they must be named: "example.pem.rsa" and "example.pem.ecdsa". The
2000 first part of the filename is arbitrary; only the suffix matters. To load
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04002001 this bundle into HAProxy, specify the base name only:
William Lallemandf9ff3ec2020-10-02 17:57:44 +02002002
2003 Example : bind :8443 ssl crt example.pem
2004
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04002005 Note that the suffix is not given to HAProxy; this tells HAProxy to look for
William Lallemandf9ff3ec2020-10-02 17:57:44 +02002006 a cert bundle.
2007
2008 HAProxy will load all PEM files in the bundle as if they were configured
2009 separately in several "crt".
2010
2011 The bundle loading does not have an impact anymore on the directory loading
2012 since files are loading separately.
2013
2014 On the CLI, bundles are seen as separate files, and the bundle extension is
2015 required to commit them.
2016
William Dauchy57dd6f12020-10-06 15:22:37 +02002017 OCSP files (.ocsp), issuer files (.issuer), Certificate Transparency (.sctl)
William Lallemandf9ff3ec2020-10-02 17:57:44 +02002018 as well as private keys (.key) are supported with multi-cert bundling.
William Lallemand3af48e72020-02-03 17:15:52 +01002019
Remi Tricot-Le Breton7c980df2021-05-07 15:28:08 +02002020 "sctl": Try to load "<basename>.sctl" for each crt keyword. If provided for
2021 a backend certificate, it will be loaded but will not have any functional
2022 impact.
William Lallemand3af48e72020-02-03 17:15:52 +01002023
Remi Tricot-Le Breton7c980df2021-05-07 15:28:08 +02002024 "ocsp": Try to load "<basename>.ocsp" for each crt keyword. If provided for
2025 a backend certificate, it will be loaded but will not have any functional
2026 impact.
William Lallemand3af48e72020-02-03 17:15:52 +01002027
2028 "issuer": Try to load "<basename>.issuer" if the issuer of the OCSP file is
Remi Tricot-Le Breton7c980df2021-05-07 15:28:08 +02002029 not provided in the PEM file. If provided for a backend certificate, it will
2030 be loaded but will not have any functional impact.
William Lallemand3af48e72020-02-03 17:15:52 +01002031
William Lallemand4c5adbf2020-02-24 14:23:22 +01002032 "key": If the private key was not provided by the PEM file, try to load a
2033 file "<basename>.key" containing a private key.
2034
William Lallemand3af48e72020-02-03 17:15:52 +01002035 The default behavior is "all".
2036
2037 Example:
2038 ssl-load-extra-files bundle sctl
2039 ssl-load-extra-files sctl ocsp issuer
2040 ssl-load-extra-files none
2041
Remi Tricot-Le Breton7c980df2021-05-07 15:28:08 +02002042 See also: "crt", section 5.1 about bind options and section 5.2 about server
2043 options.
William Lallemand3af48e72020-02-03 17:15:52 +01002044
Emeric Brun850efd52014-01-29 12:24:34 +01002045ssl-server-verify [none|required]
2046 The default behavior for SSL verify on servers side. If specified to 'none',
2047 servers certificates are not verified. The default is 'required' except if
2048 forced using cmdline option '-dV'.
2049
Emmanuel Hocdetc3b7e742020-04-22 11:06:19 +02002050ssl-skip-self-issued-ca
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -04002051 Self issued CA, aka x509 root CA, is the anchor for chain validation: as a
Emmanuel Hocdetc3b7e742020-04-22 11:06:19 +02002052 server is useless to send it, client must have it. Standard configuration
2053 need to not include such CA in PEM file. This option allows you to keep such
2054 CA in PEM file without sending it to the client. Use case is to provide
2055 issuer for ocsp without the need for '.issuer' file and be able to share it
2056 with 'issuers-chain-path'. This concerns all certificates without intermediate
2057 certificates. It's useless for BoringSSL, .issuer is ignored because ocsp
William Lallemand9a1d8392020-08-10 17:28:23 +02002058 bits does not need it. Requires at least OpenSSL 1.0.2.
Emmanuel Hocdetc3b7e742020-04-22 11:06:19 +02002059
Willy Tarreau0cb29002022-11-16 17:42:34 +01002060stats maxconn <connections>
2061 By default, the stats socket is limited to 10 concurrent connections. It is
2062 possible to change this value with "stats maxconn".
2063
Willy Tarreauabb175f2012-09-24 12:43:26 +02002064stats socket [<address:port>|<path>] [param*]
2065 Binds a UNIX socket to <path> or a TCPv4/v6 address to <address:port>.
2066 Connections to this socket will return various statistics outputs and even
2067 allow some commands to be issued to change some runtime settings. Please
Willy Tarreau1af20c72017-06-23 16:01:14 +02002068 consult section 9.3 "Unix Socket commands" of Management Guide for more
Kevin Decherf949c7202015-10-13 23:26:44 +02002069 details.
Willy Tarreau6162db22009-10-10 17:13:00 +02002070
Willy Tarreauabb175f2012-09-24 12:43:26 +02002071 All parameters supported by "bind" lines are supported, for instance to
2072 restrict access to some users or their access rights. Please consult
2073 section 5.1 for more information.
Willy Tarreaufbee7132007-10-18 13:53:22 +02002074
2075stats timeout <timeout, in milliseconds>
2076 The default timeout on the stats socket is set to 10 seconds. It is possible
2077 to change this value with "stats timeout". The value must be passed in
Willy Tarreaubefdff12007-12-02 22:27:38 +01002078 milliseconds, or be suffixed by a time unit among { us, ms, s, m, h, d }.
Willy Tarreaufbee7132007-10-18 13:53:22 +02002079
Willy Tarreau0cb29002022-11-16 17:42:34 +01002080strict-limits
2081 Makes process fail at startup when a setrlimit fails. HAProxy tries to set the
2082 best setrlimit according to what has been calculated. If it fails, it will
2083 emit a warning. This option is here to guarantee an explicit failure of
2084 HAProxy when those limits fail. It is enabled by default. It may still be
2085 forcibly disabled by prefixing it with the "no" keyword.
Willy Tarreaufbee7132007-10-18 13:53:22 +02002086
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002087uid <number>
Thayne McCombscdbcca92021-01-07 21:24:41 -07002088 Changes the process's user ID to <number>. It is recommended that the user ID
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002089 is dedicated to HAProxy or to a small set of similar daemons. HAProxy must
2090 be started with superuser privileges in order to be able to switch to another
2091 one. See also "gid" and "user".
2092
2093ulimit-n <number>
2094 Sets the maximum number of per-process file-descriptors to <number>. By
2095 default, it is automatically computed, so it is recommended not to use this
2096 option.
2097
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01002098unix-bind [ prefix <prefix> ] [ mode <mode> ] [ user <user> ] [ uid <uid> ]
2099 [ group <group> ] [ gid <gid> ]
2100
2101 Fixes common settings to UNIX listening sockets declared in "bind" statements.
2102 This is mainly used to simplify declaration of those UNIX sockets and reduce
2103 the risk of errors, since those settings are most commonly required but are
2104 also process-specific. The <prefix> setting can be used to force all socket
2105 path to be relative to that directory. This might be needed to access another
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04002106 component's chroot. Note that those paths are resolved before HAProxy chroots
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01002107 itself, so they are absolute. The <mode>, <user>, <uid>, <group> and <gid>
2108 all have the same meaning as their homonyms used by the "bind" statement. If
2109 both are specified, the "bind" statement has priority, meaning that the
2110 "unix-bind" settings may be seen as process-wide default settings.
2111
Willy Tarreau1d549722016-02-16 12:41:57 +01002112unsetenv [<name> ...]
2113 Removes environment variables specified in arguments. This can be useful to
2114 hide some sensitive information that are occasionally inherited from the
2115 user's environment during some operations. Variables which did not exist are
2116 silently ignored so that after the operation, it is certain that none of
2117 these variables remain. The changes immediately take effect so that the next
2118 line in the configuration file will not see these variables. See also
2119 "setenv", "presetenv", and "resetenv".
2120
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002121user <user name>
2122 Similar to "uid" but uses the UID of user name <user name> from /etc/passwd.
2123 See also "uid" and "group".
2124
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki48cb2ae2009-10-02 22:51:14 +02002125node <name>
2126 Only letters, digits, hyphen and underscore are allowed, like in DNS names.
2127
2128 This statement is useful in HA configurations where two or more processes or
2129 servers share the same IP address. By setting a different node-name on all
2130 nodes, it becomes easy to immediately spot what server is handling the
2131 traffic.
2132
Willy Tarreau0cb29002022-11-16 17:42:34 +01002133wurfl-cache-size <size>
2134 Sets the WURFL Useragent cache size. For faster lookups, already processed user
2135 agents are kept in a LRU cache :
2136 - "0" : no cache is used.
2137 - <size> : size of lru cache in elements.
Dragan Dosenae6d39a2015-06-29 16:43:27 +02002138
Willy Tarreau0cb29002022-11-16 17:42:34 +01002139 Please note that this option is only available when HAProxy has been compiled
2140 with USE_WURFL=1.
Thomas Holmesdb04f192015-05-18 13:21:39 +01002141
Willy Tarreaub3cc9f22019-04-19 16:03:32 +02002142wurfl-data-file <file path>
2143 The path of the WURFL data file to provide device detection services. The
2144 file should be accessible by HAProxy with relevant permissions.
2145
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04002146 Please note that this option is only available when HAProxy has been compiled
Willy Tarreaub3cc9f22019-04-19 16:03:32 +02002147 with USE_WURFL=1.
2148
2149wurfl-information-list [<capability>]*
2150 A space-delimited list of WURFL capabilities, virtual capabilities, property
2151 names we plan to use in injected headers. A full list of capability and
2152 virtual capability names is available on the Scientiamobile website :
2153
2154 https://www.scientiamobile.com/wurflCapability
2155
2156 Valid WURFL properties are:
2157 - wurfl_id Contains the device ID of the matched device.
2158
2159 - wurfl_root_id Contains the device root ID of the matched
2160 device.
2161
2162 - wurfl_isdevroot Tells if the matched device is a root device.
2163 Possible values are "TRUE" or "FALSE".
2164
2165 - wurfl_useragent The original useragent coming with this
2166 particular web request.
2167
2168 - wurfl_api_version Contains a string representing the currently
2169 used Libwurfl API version.
2170
Willy Tarreaub3cc9f22019-04-19 16:03:32 +02002171 - wurfl_info A string containing information on the parsed
2172 wurfl.xml and its full path.
2173
2174 - wurfl_last_load_time Contains the UNIX timestamp of the last time
2175 WURFL has been loaded successfully.
2176
2177 - wurfl_normalized_useragent The normalized useragent.
2178
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04002179 Please note that this option is only available when HAProxy has been compiled
Willy Tarreaub3cc9f22019-04-19 16:03:32 +02002180 with USE_WURFL=1.
2181
2182wurfl-information-list-separator <char>
2183 A char that will be used to separate values in a response header containing
2184 WURFL results. If not set that a comma (',') will be used by default.
2185
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04002186 Please note that this option is only available when HAProxy has been compiled
Willy Tarreaub3cc9f22019-04-19 16:03:32 +02002187 with USE_WURFL=1.
2188
2189wurfl-patch-file [<file path>]
2190 A list of WURFL patch file paths. Note that patches are loaded during startup
2191 thus before the chroot.
2192
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04002193 Please note that this option is only available when HAProxy has been compiled
Willy Tarreaub3cc9f22019-04-19 16:03:32 +02002194 with USE_WURFL=1.
2195
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020021963.2. Performance tuning
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002197-----------------------
2198
Willy Tarreaubeb859a2018-11-22 18:07:59 +01002199busy-polling
2200 In some situations, especially when dealing with low latency on processors
2201 supporting a variable frequency or when running inside virtual machines, each
2202 time the process waits for an I/O using the poller, the processor goes back
2203 to sleep or is offered to another VM for a long time, and it causes
2204 excessively high latencies. This option provides a solution preventing the
2205 processor from sleeping by always using a null timeout on the pollers. This
2206 results in a significant latency reduction (30 to 100 microseconds observed)
2207 at the expense of a risk to overheat the processor. It may even be used with
2208 threads, in which case improperly bound threads may heavily conflict,
2209 resulting in a worse performance and high values for the CPU stolen fields
2210 in "show info" output, indicating which threads are misconfigured. It is
2211 important not to let the process run on the same processor as the network
2212 interrupts when this option is used. It is also better to avoid using it on
2213 multiple CPU threads sharing the same core. This option is disabled by
2214 default. If it has been enabled, it may still be forcibly disabled by
2215 prefixing it with the "no" keyword. It is ignored by the "select" and
2216 "poll" pollers.
2217
William Dauchy3894d972019-12-28 15:36:02 +01002218 This option is automatically disabled on old processes in the context of
2219 seamless reload; it avoids too much cpu conflicts when multiple processes
2220 stay around for some time waiting for the end of their current connections.
2221
Willy Tarreau1746eec2014-04-25 10:46:47 +02002222max-spread-checks <delay in milliseconds>
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04002223 By default, HAProxy tries to spread the start of health checks across the
Willy Tarreau1746eec2014-04-25 10:46:47 +02002224 smallest health check interval of all the servers in a farm. The principle is
2225 to avoid hammering services running on the same server. But when using large
2226 check intervals (10 seconds or more), the last servers in the farm take some
2227 time before starting to be tested, which can be a problem. This parameter is
2228 used to enforce an upper bound on delay between the first and the last check,
2229 even if the servers' check intervals are larger. When servers run with
2230 shorter intervals, their intervals will be respected though.
2231
Willy Tarreau0cb29002022-11-16 17:42:34 +01002232maxcompcpuusage <number>
2233 Sets the maximum CPU usage HAProxy can reach before stopping the compression
2234 for new requests or decreasing the compression level of current requests.
2235 It works like 'maxcomprate' but measures CPU usage instead of incoming data
2236 bandwidth. The value is expressed in percent of the CPU used by HAProxy. A
2237 value of 100 disable the limit. The default value is 100. Setting a lower
2238 value will prevent the compression work from slowing the whole process down
2239 and from introducing high latencies.
2240
2241maxcomprate <number>
2242 Sets the maximum per-process input compression rate to <number> kilobytes
2243 per second. For each session, if the maximum is reached, the compression
2244 level will be decreased during the session. If the maximum is reached at the
2245 beginning of a session, the session will not compress at all. If the maximum
2246 is not reached, the compression level will be increased up to
2247 tune.comp.maxlevel. A value of zero means there is no limit, this is the
2248 default value.
2249
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002250maxconn <number>
2251 Sets the maximum per-process number of concurrent connections to <number>. It
2252 is equivalent to the command-line argument "-n". Proxies will stop accepting
2253 connections when this limit is reached. The "ulimit-n" parameter is
Willy Tarreau8274e102014-06-19 15:31:25 +02002254 automatically adjusted according to this value. See also "ulimit-n". Note:
2255 the "select" poller cannot reliably use more than 1024 file descriptors on
2256 some platforms. If your platform only supports select and reports "select
2257 FAILED" on startup, you need to reduce maxconn until it works (slightly
Willy Tarreaub28f3442019-03-04 08:13:43 +01002258 below 500 in general). If this value is not set, it will automatically be
2259 calculated based on the current file descriptors limit reported by the
2260 "ulimit -n" command, possibly reduced to a lower value if a memory limit
2261 is enforced, based on the buffer size, memory allocated to compression, SSL
2262 cache size, and use or not of SSL and the associated maxsslconn (which can
2263 also be automatic).
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002264
Willy Tarreau81c25d02011-09-07 15:17:21 +02002265maxconnrate <number>
2266 Sets the maximum per-process number of connections per second to <number>.
2267 Proxies will stop accepting connections when this limit is reached. It can be
2268 used to limit the global capacity regardless of each frontend capacity. It is
2269 important to note that this can only be used as a service protection measure,
2270 as there will not necessarily be a fair share between frontends when the
2271 limit is reached, so it's a good idea to also limit each frontend to some
2272 value close to its expected share. Also, lowering tune.maxaccept can improve
2273 fairness.
2274
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01002275maxpipes <number>
2276 Sets the maximum per-process number of pipes to <number>. Currently, pipes
2277 are only used by kernel-based tcp splicing. Since a pipe contains two file
2278 descriptors, the "ulimit-n" value will be increased accordingly. The default
2279 value is maxconn/4, which seems to be more than enough for most heavy usages.
2280 The splice code dynamically allocates and releases pipes, and can fall back
2281 to standard copy, so setting this value too low may only impact performance.
2282
Willy Tarreau93e7c002013-10-07 18:51:07 +02002283maxsessrate <number>
2284 Sets the maximum per-process number of sessions per second to <number>.
2285 Proxies will stop accepting connections when this limit is reached. It can be
2286 used to limit the global capacity regardless of each frontend capacity. It is
2287 important to note that this can only be used as a service protection measure,
2288 as there will not necessarily be a fair share between frontends when the
2289 limit is reached, so it's a good idea to also limit each frontend to some
2290 value close to its expected share. Also, lowering tune.maxaccept can improve
2291 fairness.
2292
Willy Tarreau403edff2012-09-06 11:58:37 +02002293maxsslconn <number>
2294 Sets the maximum per-process number of concurrent SSL connections to
2295 <number>. By default there is no SSL-specific limit, which means that the
2296 global maxconn setting will apply to all connections. Setting this limit
2297 avoids having openssl use too much memory and crash when malloc returns NULL
2298 (since it unfortunately does not reliably check for such conditions). Note
2299 that the limit applies both to incoming and outgoing connections, so one
2300 connection which is deciphered then ciphered accounts for 2 SSL connections.
Willy Tarreaud0256482015-01-15 21:45:22 +01002301 If this value is not set, but a memory limit is enforced, this value will be
2302 automatically computed based on the memory limit, maxconn, the buffer size,
2303 memory allocated to compression, SSL cache size, and use of SSL in either
2304 frontends, backends or both. If neither maxconn nor maxsslconn are specified
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04002305 when there is a memory limit, HAProxy will automatically adjust these values
Willy Tarreaud0256482015-01-15 21:45:22 +01002306 so that 100% of the connections can be made over SSL with no risk, and will
2307 consider the sides where it is enabled (frontend, backend, both).
Willy Tarreau403edff2012-09-06 11:58:37 +02002308
Willy Tarreaue43d5322013-10-07 20:01:52 +02002309maxsslrate <number>
2310 Sets the maximum per-process number of SSL sessions per second to <number>.
2311 SSL listeners will stop accepting connections when this limit is reached. It
2312 can be used to limit the global SSL CPU usage regardless of each frontend
2313 capacity. It is important to note that this can only be used as a service
2314 protection measure, as there will not necessarily be a fair share between
2315 frontends when the limit is reached, so it's a good idea to also limit each
2316 frontend to some value close to its expected share. It is also important to
2317 note that the sessions are accounted before they enter the SSL stack and not
2318 after, which also protects the stack against bad handshakes. Also, lowering
2319 tune.maxaccept can improve fairness.
2320
William Lallemand9d5f5482012-11-07 16:12:57 +01002321maxzlibmem <number>
2322 Sets the maximum amount of RAM in megabytes per process usable by the zlib.
2323 When the maximum amount is reached, future sessions will not compress as long
2324 as RAM is unavailable. When sets to 0, there is no limit.
William Lallemande3a7d992012-11-20 11:25:20 +01002325 The default value is 0. The value is available in bytes on the UNIX socket
2326 with "show info" on the line "MaxZlibMemUsage", the memory used by zlib is
2327 "ZlibMemUsage" in bytes.
2328
Willy Tarreau85dd5212022-03-08 10:41:40 +01002329no-memory-trimming
2330 Disables memory trimming ("malloc_trim") at a few moments where attempts are
2331 made to reclaim lots of memory (on memory shortage or on reload). Trimming
2332 memory forces the system's allocator to scan all unused areas and to release
2333 them. This is generally seen as nice action to leave more available memory to
2334 a new process while the old one is unlikely to make significant use of it.
2335 But some systems dealing with tens to hundreds of thousands of concurrent
2336 connections may experience a lot of memory fragmentation, that may render
2337 this release operation extremely long. During this time, no more traffic
2338 passes through the process, new connections are not accepted anymore, some
2339 health checks may even fail, and the watchdog may even trigger and kill the
2340 unresponsive process, leaving a huge core dump. If this ever happens, then it
2341 is suggested to use this option to disable trimming and stop trying to be
2342 nice with the new process. Note that advanced memory allocators usually do
2343 not suffer from such a problem.
2344
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002345noepoll
2346 Disables the use of the "epoll" event polling system on Linux. It is
2347 equivalent to the command-line argument "-de". The next polling system
Willy Tarreaue9f49e72012-11-11 17:42:00 +01002348 used will generally be "poll". See also "nopoll".
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002349
Emmanuel Hocdet0ba4f482019-04-08 16:53:32 +00002350noevports
2351 Disables the use of the event ports event polling system on SunOS systems
2352 derived from Solaris 10 and later. It is equivalent to the command-line
2353 argument "-dv". The next polling system used will generally be "poll". See
2354 also "nopoll".
2355
Willy Tarreau0cb29002022-11-16 17:42:34 +01002356nogetaddrinfo
2357 Disables the use of getaddrinfo(3) for name resolving. It is equivalent to
2358 the command line argument "-dG". Deprecated gethostbyname(3) will be used.
2359
2360nokqueue
2361 Disables the use of the "kqueue" event polling system on BSD. It is
2362 equivalent to the command-line argument "-dk". The next polling system
2363 used will generally be "poll". See also "nopoll".
2364
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002365nopoll
2366 Disables the use of the "poll" event polling system. It is equivalent to the
2367 command-line argument "-dp". The next polling system used will be "select".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002368 It should never be needed to disable "poll" since it's available on all
Emmanuel Hocdet0ba4f482019-04-08 16:53:32 +00002369 platforms supported by HAProxy. See also "nokqueue", "noepoll" and
2370 "noevports".
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002371
Willy Tarreau0cb29002022-11-16 17:42:34 +01002372noreuseport
2373 Disables the use of SO_REUSEPORT - see socket(7). It is equivalent to the
2374 command line argument "-dR".
2375
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01002376nosplice
2377 Disables the use of kernel tcp splicing between sockets on Linux. It is
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002378 equivalent to the command line argument "-dS". Data will then be copied
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01002379 using conventional and more portable recv/send calls. Kernel tcp splicing is
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01002380 limited to some very recent instances of kernel 2.6. Most versions between
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01002381 2.6.25 and 2.6.28 are buggy and will forward corrupted data, so they must not
2382 be used. This option makes it easier to globally disable kernel splicing in
2383 case of doubt. See also "option splice-auto", "option splice-request" and
2384 "option splice-response".
2385
Willy Tarreauca3afc22021-05-05 18:33:19 +02002386profiling.memory { on | off }
2387 Enables ('on') or disables ('off') per-function memory profiling. This will
2388 keep usage statistics of malloc/calloc/realloc/free calls anywhere in the
2389 process (including libraries) which will be reported on the CLI using the
2390 "show profiling" command. This is essentially meant to be used when an
2391 abnormal memory usage is observed that cannot be explained by the pools and
2392 other info are required. The performance hit will typically be around 1%,
2393 maybe a bit more on highly threaded machines, so it is normally suitable for
2394 use in production. The same may be achieved at run time on the CLI using the
2395 "set profiling memory" command, please consult the management manual.
2396
Willy Tarreaud2d33482019-04-25 17:09:07 +02002397profiling.tasks { auto | on | off }
2398 Enables ('on') or disables ('off') per-task CPU profiling. When set to 'auto'
2399 the profiling automatically turns on a thread when it starts to suffer from
2400 an average latency of 1000 microseconds or higher as reported in the
2401 "avg_loop_us" activity field, and automatically turns off when the latency
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -05002402 returns below 990 microseconds (this value is an average over the last 1024
Willy Tarreaud2d33482019-04-25 17:09:07 +02002403 loops so it does not vary quickly and tends to significantly smooth short
2404 spikes). It may also spontaneously trigger from time to time on overloaded
2405 systems, containers, or virtual machines, or when the system swaps (which
2406 must absolutely never happen on a load balancer).
2407
2408 CPU profiling per task can be very convenient to report where the time is
2409 spent and which requests have what effect on which other request. Enabling
2410 it will typically affect the overall's performance by less than 1%, thus it
2411 is recommended to leave it to the default 'auto' value so that it only
2412 operates when a problem is identified. This feature requires a system
Willy Tarreau75c62c22018-11-22 11:02:09 +01002413 supporting the clock_gettime(2) syscall with clock identifiers
2414 CLOCK_MONOTONIC and CLOCK_THREAD_CPUTIME_ID, otherwise the reported time will
2415 be zero. This option may be changed at run time using "set profiling" on the
2416 CLI.
2417
Willy Tarreaufe255b72007-10-14 23:09:26 +02002418spread-checks <0..50, in percent>
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +09002419 Sometimes it is desirable to avoid sending agent and health checks to
2420 servers at exact intervals, for instance when many logical servers are
2421 located on the same physical server. With the help of this parameter, it
2422 becomes possible to add some randomness in the check interval between 0
2423 and +/- 50%. A value between 2 and 5 seems to show good results. The
2424 default value remains at 0.
Willy Tarreaufe255b72007-10-14 23:09:26 +02002425
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002426ssl-engine <name> [algo <comma-separated list of algorithms>]
Grant Zhang872f9c22017-01-21 01:10:18 +00002427 Sets the OpenSSL engine to <name>. List of valid values for <name> may be
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002428 obtained using the command "openssl engine". This statement may be used
Grant Zhang872f9c22017-01-21 01:10:18 +00002429 multiple times, it will simply enable multiple crypto engines. Referencing an
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04002430 unsupported engine will prevent HAProxy from starting. Note that many engines
Grant Zhang872f9c22017-01-21 01:10:18 +00002431 will lead to lower HTTPS performance than pure software with recent
2432 processors. The optional command "algo" sets the default algorithms an ENGINE
2433 will supply using the OPENSSL function ENGINE_set_default_string(). A value
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002434 of "ALL" uses the engine for all cryptographic operations. If no list of
2435 algo is specified then the value of "ALL" is used. A comma-separated list
Grant Zhang872f9c22017-01-21 01:10:18 +00002436 of different algorithms may be specified, including: RSA, DSA, DH, EC, RAND,
2437 CIPHERS, DIGESTS, PKEY, PKEY_CRYPTO, PKEY_ASN1. This is the same format that
2438 openssl configuration file uses:
2439 https://www.openssl.org/docs/man1.0.2/apps/config.html
2440
Grant Zhangfa6c7ee2017-01-14 01:42:15 +00002441ssl-mode-async
2442 Adds SSL_MODE_ASYNC mode to the SSL context. This enables asynchronous TLS
Emeric Brun3854e012017-05-17 20:42:48 +02002443 I/O operations if asynchronous capable SSL engines are used. The current
Emeric Brunb5e42a82017-06-06 12:35:14 +00002444 implementation supports a maximum of 32 engines. The Openssl ASYNC API
2445 doesn't support moving read/write buffers and is not compliant with
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04002446 HAProxy's buffer management. So the asynchronous mode is disabled on
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -05002447 read/write operations (it is only enabled during initial and renegotiation
Emeric Brunb5e42a82017-06-06 12:35:14 +00002448 handshakes).
Grant Zhangfa6c7ee2017-01-14 01:42:15 +00002449
Willy Tarreau33cb0652014-12-23 22:52:37 +01002450tune.buffers.limit <number>
2451 Sets a hard limit on the number of buffers which may be allocated per process.
2452 The default value is zero which means unlimited. The minimum non-zero value
2453 will always be greater than "tune.buffers.reserve" and should ideally always
2454 be about twice as large. Forcing this value can be particularly useful to
2455 limit the amount of memory a process may take, while retaining a sane
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002456 behavior. When this limit is reached, sessions which need a buffer wait for
Willy Tarreau33cb0652014-12-23 22:52:37 +01002457 another one to be released by another session. Since buffers are dynamically
2458 allocated and released, the waiting time is very short and not perceptible
2459 provided that limits remain reasonable. In fact sometimes reducing the limit
2460 may even increase performance by increasing the CPU cache's efficiency. Tests
2461 have shown good results on average HTTP traffic with a limit to 1/10 of the
2462 expected global maxconn setting, which also significantly reduces memory
2463 usage. The memory savings come from the fact that a number of connections
2464 will not allocate 2*tune.bufsize. It is best not to touch this value unless
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04002465 advised to do so by an HAProxy core developer.
Willy Tarreau33cb0652014-12-23 22:52:37 +01002466
Willy Tarreau1058ae72014-12-23 22:40:40 +01002467tune.buffers.reserve <number>
2468 Sets the number of buffers which are pre-allocated and reserved for use only
2469 during memory shortage conditions resulting in failed memory allocations. The
2470 minimum value is 2 and is also the default. There is no reason a user would
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04002471 want to change this value, it's mostly aimed at HAProxy core developers.
Willy Tarreau1058ae72014-12-23 22:40:40 +01002472
Willy Tarreau27a674e2009-08-17 07:23:33 +02002473tune.bufsize <number>
2474 Sets the buffer size to this size (in bytes). Lower values allow more
2475 sessions to coexist in the same amount of RAM, and higher values allow some
2476 applications with very large cookies to work. The default value is 16384 and
2477 can be changed at build time. It is strongly recommended not to change this
2478 from the default value, as very low values will break some services such as
2479 statistics, and values larger than default size will increase memory usage,
2480 possibly causing the system to run out of memory. At least the global maxconn
Willy Tarreau45a66cc2017-11-24 11:28:00 +01002481 parameter should be decreased by the same factor as this one is increased. In
2482 addition, use of HTTP/2 mandates that this value must be 16384 or more. If an
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04002483 HTTP request is larger than (tune.bufsize - tune.maxrewrite), HAProxy will
Dmitry Sivachenkof6f4f7b2012-10-21 18:10:25 +04002484 return HTTP 400 (Bad Request) error. Similarly if an HTTP response is larger
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04002485 than this size, HAProxy will return HTTP 502 (Bad Gateway). Note that the
Willy Tarreauc77d3642018-12-12 06:19:42 +01002486 value set using this parameter will automatically be rounded up to the next
2487 multiple of 8 on 32-bit machines and 16 on 64-bit machines.
Willy Tarreau27a674e2009-08-17 07:23:33 +02002488
Christopher Fauletbb9fb8b2020-11-25 17:20:57 +01002489tune.chksize <number> (deprecated)
2490 This option is deprecated and ignored.
Willy Tarreau43961d52010-10-04 20:39:20 +02002491
William Lallemandf3747832012-11-09 12:33:10 +01002492tune.comp.maxlevel <number>
2493 Sets the maximum compression level. The compression level affects CPU
2494 usage during compression. This value affects CPU usage during compression.
2495 Each session using compression initializes the compression algorithm with
2496 this value. The default value is 1.
2497
Willy Tarreauc299e1e2019-02-27 11:35:12 +01002498tune.fail-alloc
2499 If compiled with DEBUG_FAIL_ALLOC, gives the percentage of chances an
2500 allocation attempt fails. Must be between 0 (no failure) and 100 (no
2501 success). This is useful to debug and make sure memory failures are handled
2502 gracefully.
2503
Willy Tarreaubc52bec2020-06-18 08:58:47 +02002504tune.fd.edge-triggered { on | off } [ EXPERIMENTAL ]
2505 Enables ('on') or disables ('off') the edge-triggered polling mode for FDs
2506 that support it. This is currently only support with epoll. It may noticeably
2507 reduce the number of epoll_ctl() calls and slightly improve performance in
2508 certain scenarios. This is still experimental, it may result in frozen
2509 connections if bugs are still present, and is disabled by default.
2510
Willy Tarreaufe20e5b2017-07-27 11:42:14 +02002511tune.h2.header-table-size <number>
2512 Sets the HTTP/2 dynamic header table size. It defaults to 4096 bytes and
2513 cannot be larger than 65536 bytes. A larger value may help certain clients
2514 send more compact requests, depending on their capabilities. This amount of
2515 memory is consumed for each HTTP/2 connection. It is recommended not to
2516 change it.
2517
Willy Tarreaue6baec02017-07-27 11:45:11 +02002518tune.h2.initial-window-size <number>
2519 Sets the HTTP/2 initial window size, which is the number of bytes the client
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04002520 can upload before waiting for an acknowledgment from HAProxy. This setting
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002521 only affects payload contents (i.e. the body of POST requests), not headers.
Willy Tarreaue6baec02017-07-27 11:45:11 +02002522 The default value is 65535, which roughly allows up to 5 Mbps of upload
2523 bandwidth per client over a network showing a 100 ms ping time, or 500 Mbps
2524 over a 1-ms local network. It can make sense to increase this value to allow
2525 faster uploads, or to reduce it to increase fairness when dealing with many
2526 clients. It doesn't affect resource usage.
2527
Willy Tarreau5242ef82017-07-27 11:47:28 +02002528tune.h2.max-concurrent-streams <number>
2529 Sets the HTTP/2 maximum number of concurrent streams per connection (ie the
2530 number of outstanding requests on a single connection). The default value is
2531 100. A larger one may slightly improve page load time for complex sites when
2532 visited over high latency networks, but increases the amount of resources a
2533 single client may allocate. A value of zero disables the limit so a single
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04002534 client may create as many streams as allocatable by HAProxy. It is highly
Willy Tarreau5242ef82017-07-27 11:47:28 +02002535 recommended not to change this value.
2536
Willy Tarreaua24b35c2019-02-21 13:24:36 +01002537tune.h2.max-frame-size <number>
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04002538 Sets the HTTP/2 maximum frame size that HAProxy announces it is willing to
Willy Tarreaua24b35c2019-02-21 13:24:36 +01002539 receive to its peers. The default value is the largest between 16384 and the
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04002540 buffer size (tune.bufsize). In any case, HAProxy will not announce support
Willy Tarreaua24b35c2019-02-21 13:24:36 +01002541 for frame sizes larger than buffers. The main purpose of this setting is to
2542 allow to limit the maximum frame size setting when using large buffers. Too
2543 large frame sizes might have performance impact or cause some peers to
2544 misbehave. It is highly recommended not to change this value.
2545
Willy Tarreau193b8c62012-11-22 00:17:38 +01002546tune.http.cookielen <number>
2547 Sets the maximum length of captured cookies. This is the maximum value that
2548 the "capture cookie xxx len yyy" will be allowed to take, and any upper value
2549 will automatically be truncated to this one. It is important not to set too
2550 high a value because all cookie captures still allocate this size whatever
2551 their configured value (they share a same pool). This value is per request
2552 per response, so the memory allocated is twice this value per connection.
2553 When not specified, the limit is set to 63 characters. It is recommended not
2554 to change this value.
2555
Stéphane Cottin23e9e932017-05-18 08:58:41 +02002556tune.http.logurilen <number>
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002557 Sets the maximum length of request URI in logs. This prevents truncating long
2558 request URIs with valuable query strings in log lines. This is not related
Stéphane Cottin23e9e932017-05-18 08:58:41 +02002559 to syslog limits. If you increase this limit, you may also increase the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002560 'log ... len yyy' parameter. Your syslog daemon may also need specific
Stéphane Cottin23e9e932017-05-18 08:58:41 +02002561 configuration directives too.
2562 The default value is 1024.
2563
Willy Tarreauac1932d2011-10-24 19:14:41 +02002564tune.http.maxhdr <number>
2565 Sets the maximum number of headers in a request. When a request comes with a
2566 number of headers greater than this value (including the first line), it is
2567 rejected with a "400 Bad Request" status code. Similarly, too large responses
2568 are blocked with "502 Bad Gateway". The default value is 101, which is enough
2569 for all usages, considering that the widely deployed Apache server uses the
2570 same limit. It can be useful to push this limit further to temporarily allow
Christopher Faulet50174f32017-06-21 16:31:35 +02002571 a buggy application to work by the time it gets fixed. The accepted range is
2572 1..32767. Keep in mind that each new header consumes 32bits of memory for
2573 each session, so don't push this limit too high.
Willy Tarreauac1932d2011-10-24 19:14:41 +02002574
Willy Tarreau76cc6992020-07-01 18:49:24 +02002575tune.idle-pool.shared { on | off }
2576 Enables ('on') or disables ('off') sharing of idle connection pools between
2577 threads for a same server. The default is to share them between threads in
2578 order to minimize the number of persistent connections to a server, and to
2579 optimize the connection reuse rate. But to help with debugging or when
2580 suspecting a bug in HAProxy around connection reuse, it can be convenient to
2581 forcefully disable this idle pool sharing between multiple threads, and force
Willy Tarreau0784db82021-02-19 11:45:22 +01002582 this option to "off". The default is on. It is strongly recommended against
2583 disabling this option without setting a conservative value on "pool-low-conn"
2584 for all servers relying on connection reuse to achieve a high performance
2585 level, otherwise connections might be closed very often as the thread count
2586 increases.
Willy Tarreau76cc6992020-07-01 18:49:24 +02002587
Willy Tarreau7e312732014-02-12 16:35:14 +01002588tune.idletimer <timeout>
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04002589 Sets the duration after which HAProxy will consider that an empty buffer is
Willy Tarreau7e312732014-02-12 16:35:14 +01002590 probably associated with an idle stream. This is used to optimally adjust
2591 some packet sizes while forwarding large and small data alternatively. The
2592 decision to use splice() or to send large buffers in SSL is modulated by this
2593 parameter. The value is in milliseconds between 0 and 65535. A value of zero
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04002594 means that HAProxy will not try to detect idle streams. The default is 1000,
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002595 which seems to correctly detect end user pauses (e.g. read a page before
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -05002596 clicking). There should be no reason for changing this value. Please check
Willy Tarreau7e312732014-02-12 16:35:14 +01002597 tune.ssl.maxrecord below.
2598
Willy Tarreau7ac908b2019-02-27 12:02:18 +01002599tune.listener.multi-queue { on | off }
2600 Enables ('on') or disables ('off') the listener's multi-queue accept which
2601 spreads the incoming traffic to all threads a "bind" line is allowed to run
2602 on instead of taking them for itself. This provides a smoother traffic
2603 distribution and scales much better, especially in environments where threads
2604 may be unevenly loaded due to external activity (network interrupts colliding
2605 with one thread for example). This option is enabled by default, but it may
2606 be forcefully disabled for troubleshooting or for situations where it is
2607 estimated that the operating system already provides a good enough
2608 distribution and connections are extremely short-lived.
2609
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +01002610tune.lua.forced-yield <number>
2611 This directive forces the Lua engine to execute a yield each <number> of
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +01002612 instructions executed. This permits interrupting a long script and allows the
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +01002613 HAProxy scheduler to process other tasks like accepting connections or
2614 forwarding traffic. The default value is 10000 instructions. If HAProxy often
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002615 executes some Lua code but more responsiveness is required, this value can be
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +01002616 lowered. If the Lua code is quite long and its result is absolutely required
2617 to process the data, the <number> can be increased.
2618
Willy Tarreau32f61e22015-03-18 17:54:59 +01002619tune.lua.maxmem
2620 Sets the maximum amount of RAM in megabytes per process usable by Lua. By
2621 default it is zero which means unlimited. It is important to set a limit to
2622 ensure that a bug in a script will not result in the system running out of
2623 memory.
2624
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +01002625tune.lua.session-timeout <timeout>
2626 This is the execution timeout for the Lua sessions. This is useful for
Thierry FOURNIER7dd784b2015-10-01 14:49:33 +02002627 preventing infinite loops or spending too much time in Lua. This timeout
2628 counts only the pure Lua runtime. If the Lua does a sleep, the sleep is
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002629 not taken in account. The default timeout is 4s.
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +01002630
Thierry FOURNIER7dd784b2015-10-01 14:49:33 +02002631tune.lua.service-timeout <timeout>
2632 This is the execution timeout for the Lua services. This is useful for
2633 preventing infinite loops or spending too much time in Lua. This timeout
2634 counts only the pure Lua runtime. If the Lua does a sleep, the sleep is
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002635 not taken in account. The default timeout is 4s.
Thierry FOURNIER7dd784b2015-10-01 14:49:33 +02002636
Willy Tarreau0cb29002022-11-16 17:42:34 +01002637tune.lua.task-timeout <timeout>
2638 Purpose is the same as "tune.lua.session-timeout", but this timeout is
2639 dedicated to the tasks. By default, this timeout isn't set because a task may
2640 remain alive during of the lifetime of HAProxy. For example, a task used to
2641 check servers.
2642
Willy Tarreaua0250ba2008-01-06 11:22:57 +01002643tune.maxaccept <number>
Willy Tarreau16a21472012-11-19 12:39:59 +01002644 Sets the maximum number of consecutive connections a process may accept in a
2645 row before switching to other work. In single process mode, higher numbers
Willy Tarreau66161322021-02-19 15:50:27 +01002646 used to give better performance at high connection rates, though this is not
2647 the case anymore with the multi-queue. This value applies individually to
2648 each listener, so that the number of processes a listener is bound to is
2649 taken into account. This value defaults to 4 which showed best results. If a
2650 significantly higher value was inherited from an ancient config, it might be
2651 worth removing it as it will both increase performance and lower response
2652 time. In multi-process mode, it is divided by twice the number of processes
2653 the listener is bound to. Setting this value to -1 completely disables the
2654 limitation. It should normally not be needed to tweak this value.
Willy Tarreaua0250ba2008-01-06 11:22:57 +01002655
2656tune.maxpollevents <number>
2657 Sets the maximum amount of events that can be processed at once in a call to
2658 the polling system. The default value is adapted to the operating system. It
2659 has been noticed that reducing it below 200 tends to slightly decrease
2660 latency at the expense of network bandwidth, and increasing it above 200
2661 tends to trade latency for slightly increased bandwidth.
2662
Willy Tarreau27a674e2009-08-17 07:23:33 +02002663tune.maxrewrite <number>
2664 Sets the reserved buffer space to this size in bytes. The reserved space is
2665 used for header rewriting or appending. The first reads on sockets will never
2666 fill more than bufsize-maxrewrite. Historically it has defaulted to half of
2667 bufsize, though that does not make much sense since there are rarely large
2668 numbers of headers to add. Setting it too high prevents processing of large
2669 requests or responses. Setting it too low prevents addition of new headers
2670 to already large requests or to POST requests. It is generally wise to set it
2671 to about 1024. It is automatically readjusted to half of bufsize if it is
2672 larger than that. This means you don't have to worry about it when changing
2673 bufsize.
2674
Willy Tarreauf3045d22015-04-29 16:24:50 +02002675tune.pattern.cache-size <number>
2676 Sets the size of the pattern lookup cache to <number> entries. This is an LRU
2677 cache which reminds previous lookups and their results. It is used by ACLs
2678 and maps on slow pattern lookups, namely the ones using the "sub", "reg",
2679 "dir", "dom", "end", "bin" match methods as well as the case-insensitive
2680 strings. It applies to pattern expressions which means that it will be able
2681 to memorize the result of a lookup among all the patterns specified on a
2682 configuration line (including all those loaded from files). It automatically
2683 invalidates entries which are updated using HTTP actions or on the CLI. The
2684 default cache size is set to 10000 entries, which limits its footprint to
Willy Tarreau403bfbb2019-10-23 06:59:31 +02002685 about 5 MB per process/thread on 32-bit systems and 8 MB per process/thread
2686 on 64-bit systems, as caches are thread/process local. There is a very low
Willy Tarreauf3045d22015-04-29 16:24:50 +02002687 risk of collision in this cache, which is in the order of the size of the
2688 cache divided by 2^64. Typically, at 10000 requests per second with the
2689 default cache size of 10000 entries, there's 1% chance that a brute force
2690 attack could cause a single collision after 60 years, or 0.1% after 6 years.
2691 This is considered much lower than the risk of a memory corruption caused by
2692 aging components. If this is not acceptable, the cache can be disabled by
2693 setting this parameter to 0.
2694
Willy Tarreaubd9a0a72011-10-23 21:14:29 +02002695tune.pipesize <number>
2696 Sets the kernel pipe buffer size to this size (in bytes). By default, pipes
2697 are the default size for the system. But sometimes when using TCP splicing,
2698 it can improve performance to increase pipe sizes, especially if it is
2699 suspected that pipes are not filled and that many calls to splice() are
2700 performed. This has an impact on the kernel's memory footprint, so this must
2701 not be changed if impacts are not understood.
2702
Olivier Houchard88698d92019-04-16 19:07:22 +02002703tune.pool-high-fd-ratio <number>
2704 This setting sets the max number of file descriptors (in percentage) used by
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04002705 HAProxy globally against the maximum number of file descriptors HAProxy can
Olivier Houchard88698d92019-04-16 19:07:22 +02002706 use before we start killing idle connections when we can't reuse a connection
2707 and we have to create a new one. The default is 25 (one quarter of the file
2708 descriptor will mean that roughly half of the maximum front connections can
2709 keep an idle connection behind, anything beyond this probably doesn't make
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -05002710 much sense in the general case when targeting connection reuse).
Olivier Houchard88698d92019-04-16 19:07:22 +02002711
Willy Tarreau83ca3052020-07-01 18:30:16 +02002712tune.pool-low-fd-ratio <number>
2713 This setting sets the max number of file descriptors (in percentage) used by
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04002714 HAProxy globally against the maximum number of file descriptors HAProxy can
Willy Tarreau83ca3052020-07-01 18:30:16 +02002715 use before we stop putting connection into the idle pool for reuse. The
2716 default is 20.
2717
Willy Tarreaue803de22010-01-21 17:43:04 +01002718tune.rcvbuf.client <number>
2719tune.rcvbuf.server <number>
2720 Forces the kernel socket receive buffer size on the client or the server side
2721 to the specified value in bytes. This value applies to all TCP/HTTP frontends
2722 and backends. It should normally never be set, and the default size (0) lets
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -05002723 the kernel auto-tune this value depending on the amount of available memory.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002724 However it can sometimes help to set it to very low values (e.g. 4096) in
Willy Tarreaue803de22010-01-21 17:43:04 +01002725 order to save kernel memory by preventing it from buffering too large amounts
2726 of received data. Lower values will significantly increase CPU usage though.
2727
Willy Tarreaub22fc302015-12-14 12:04:35 +01002728tune.recv_enough <number>
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002729 HAProxy uses some hints to detect that a short read indicates the end of the
Willy Tarreaub22fc302015-12-14 12:04:35 +01002730 socket buffers. One of them is that a read returns more than <recv_enough>
2731 bytes, which defaults to 10136 (7 segments of 1448 each). This default value
2732 may be changed by this setting to better deal with workloads involving lots
2733 of short messages such as telnet or SSH sessions.
2734
Olivier Houchard1599b802018-05-24 18:59:04 +02002735tune.runqueue-depth <number>
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -05002736 Sets the maximum amount of task that can be processed at once when running
Willy Tarreau060a7612021-03-10 11:06:26 +01002737 tasks. The default value depends on the number of threads but sits between 35
2738 and 280, which tend to show the highest request rates and lowest latencies.
2739 Increasing it may incur latency when dealing with I/Os, making it too small
2740 can incur extra overhead. Higher thread counts benefit from lower values.
2741 When experimenting with much larger values, it may be useful to also enable
2742 tune.sched.low-latency and possibly tune.fd.edge-triggered to limit the
2743 maximum latency to the lowest possible.
Willy Tarreaue7723bd2020-06-24 11:11:02 +02002744
2745tune.sched.low-latency { on | off }
2746 Enables ('on') or disables ('off') the low-latency task scheduler. By default
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04002747 HAProxy processes tasks from several classes one class at a time as this is
Willy Tarreaue7723bd2020-06-24 11:11:02 +02002748 the most efficient. But when running with large values of tune.runqueue-depth
2749 this can have a measurable effect on request or connection latency. When this
2750 low-latency setting is enabled, tasks of lower priority classes will always
2751 be executed before other ones if they exist. This will permit to lower the
2752 maximum latency experienced by new requests or connections in the middle of
2753 massive traffic, at the expense of a higher impact on this large traffic.
2754 For regular usage it is better to leave this off. The default value is off.
Olivier Houchard1599b802018-05-24 18:59:04 +02002755
Willy Tarreaue803de22010-01-21 17:43:04 +01002756tune.sndbuf.client <number>
2757tune.sndbuf.server <number>
2758 Forces the kernel socket send buffer size on the client or the server side to
2759 the specified value in bytes. This value applies to all TCP/HTTP frontends
2760 and backends. It should normally never be set, and the default size (0) lets
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -05002761 the kernel auto-tune this value depending on the amount of available memory.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002762 However it can sometimes help to set it to very low values (e.g. 4096) in
Willy Tarreaue803de22010-01-21 17:43:04 +01002763 order to save kernel memory by preventing it from buffering too large amounts
2764 of received data. Lower values will significantly increase CPU usage though.
2765 Another use case is to prevent write timeouts with extremely slow clients due
2766 to the kernel waiting for a large part of the buffer to be read before
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04002767 notifying HAProxy again.
Willy Tarreaue803de22010-01-21 17:43:04 +01002768
Willy Tarreau6ec58db2012-11-16 16:32:15 +01002769tune.ssl.cachesize <number>
Emeric Brunaf9619d2012-11-28 18:47:52 +01002770 Sets the size of the global SSL session cache, in a number of blocks. A block
William Dauchy9a4bbfe2021-02-12 15:58:46 +01002771 is large enough to contain an encoded session without peer certificate. An
2772 encoded session with peer certificate is stored in multiple blocks depending
2773 on the size of the peer certificate. A block uses approximately 200 bytes of
2774 memory (based on `sizeof(struct sh_ssl_sess_hdr) + SHSESS_BLOCK_MIN_SIZE`
2775 calculation used for `shctx_init` function). The default value may be forced
2776 at build time, otherwise defaults to 20000. When the cache is full, the most
2777 idle entries are purged and reassigned. Higher values reduce the occurrence
2778 of such a purge, hence the number of CPU-intensive SSL handshakes by ensuring
2779 that all users keep their session as long as possible. All entries are
2780 pre-allocated upon startup and are shared between all processes if "nbproc"
2781 is greater than 1. Setting this value to 0 disables the SSL session cache.
Willy Tarreau6ec58db2012-11-16 16:32:15 +01002782
Willy Tarreau0cb29002022-11-16 17:42:34 +01002783tune.ssl.capture-cipherlist-size <number>
2784 Sets the maximum size of the buffer used for capturing client hello cipher
2785 list, extensions list, elliptic curves list and elliptic curve point
2786 formats. If the value is 0 (default value) the capture is disabled,
2787 otherwise a buffer is allocated for each SSL/TLS connection.
2788
2789tune.ssl.default-dh-param <number>
2790 Sets the maximum size of the Diffie-Hellman parameters used for generating
2791 the ephemeral/temporary Diffie-Hellman key in case of DHE key exchange. The
2792 final size will try to match the size of the server's RSA (or DSA) key (e.g,
2793 a 2048 bits temporary DH key for a 2048 bits RSA key), but will not exceed
2794 this maximum value. Only 1024 or higher values are allowed. Higher values
2795 will increase the CPU load, and values greater than 1024 bits are not
2796 supported by Java 7 and earlier clients. This value is not used if static
2797 Diffie-Hellman parameters are supplied either directly in the certificate
2798 file or by using the ssl-dh-param-file parameter.
2799 If there is neither a default-dh-param nor a ssl-dh-param-file defined, and
2800 if the server's PEM file of a given frontend does not specify its own DH
2801 parameters, then DHE ciphers will be unavailable for this frontend.
2802
Emeric Brun8dc60392014-05-09 13:52:00 +02002803tune.ssl.force-private-cache
Lukas Tribus27935782018-10-01 02:00:16 +02002804 This option disables SSL session cache sharing between all processes. It
Emeric Brun8dc60392014-05-09 13:52:00 +02002805 should normally not be used since it will force many renegotiations due to
2806 clients hitting a random process. But it may be required on some operating
2807 systems where none of the SSL cache synchronization method may be used. In
2808 this case, adding a first layer of hash-based load balancing before the SSL
2809 layer might limit the impact of the lack of session sharing.
2810
William Lallemand7d42ef52020-07-06 11:41:30 +02002811tune.ssl.keylog { on | off }
2812 This option activates the logging of the TLS keys. It should be used with
2813 care as it will consume more memory per SSL session and could decrease
2814 performances. This is disabled by default.
2815
2816 These sample fetches should be used to generate the SSLKEYLOGFILE that is
2817 required to decipher traffic with wireshark.
2818
2819 https://developer.mozilla.org/en-US/docs/Mozilla/Projects/NSS/Key_Log_Format
2820
2821 The SSLKEYLOG is a series of lines which are formatted this way:
2822
2823 <Label> <space> <ClientRandom> <space> <Secret>
2824
2825 The ClientRandom is provided by the %[ssl_fc_client_random,hex] sample
2826 fetch, the secret and the Label could be find in the array below. You need
2827 to generate a SSLKEYLOGFILE with all the labels in this array.
2828
2829 The following sample fetches are hexadecimal strings and does not need to be
2830 converted.
2831
2832 SSLKEYLOGFILE Label | Sample fetches for the Secrets
2833 --------------------------------|-----------------------------------------
2834 CLIENT_EARLY_TRAFFIC_SECRET | %[ssl_fc_client_early_traffic_secret]
2835 CLIENT_HANDSHAKE_TRAFFIC_SECRET | %[ssl_fc_client_handshake_traffic_secret]
2836 SERVER_HANDSHAKE_TRAFFIC_SECRET | %[ssl_fc_server_handshake_traffic_secret]
2837 CLIENT_TRAFFIC_SECRET_0 | %[ssl_fc_client_traffic_secret_0]
2838 SERVER_TRAFFIC_SECRET_0 | %[ssl_fc_server_traffic_secret_0]
William Lallemandd742b6c2020-07-07 10:14:56 +02002839 EXPORTER_SECRET | %[ssl_fc_exporter_secret]
2840 EARLY_EXPORTER_SECRET | %[ssl_fc_early_exporter_secret]
William Lallemand7d42ef52020-07-06 11:41:30 +02002841
2842 This is only available with OpenSSL 1.1.1, and useful with TLS1.3 session.
2843
2844 If you want to generate the content of a SSLKEYLOGFILE with TLS < 1.3, you
2845 only need this line:
2846
2847 "CLIENT_RANDOM %[ssl_fc_client_random,hex] %[ssl_fc_session_key,hex]"
2848
Emeric Brun4f65bff2012-11-16 15:11:00 +01002849tune.ssl.lifetime <timeout>
2850 Sets how long a cached SSL session may remain valid. This time is expressed
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03002851 in seconds and defaults to 300 (5 min). It is important to understand that it
Emeric Brun4f65bff2012-11-16 15:11:00 +01002852 does not guarantee that sessions will last that long, because if the cache is
2853 full, the longest idle sessions will be purged despite their configured
2854 lifetime. The real usefulness of this setting is to prevent sessions from
2855 being used for too long.
2856
Willy Tarreaubfd59462013-02-21 07:46:09 +01002857tune.ssl.maxrecord <number>
2858 Sets the maximum amount of bytes passed to SSL_write() at a time. Default
2859 value 0 means there is no limit. Over SSL/TLS, the client can decipher the
2860 data only once it has received a full record. With large records, it means
2861 that clients might have to download up to 16kB of data before starting to
2862 process them. Limiting the value can improve page load times on browsers
2863 located over high latency or low bandwidth networks. It is suggested to find
2864 optimal values which fit into 1 or 2 TCP segments (generally 1448 bytes over
2865 Ethernet with TCP timestamps enabled, or 1460 when timestamps are disabled),
2866 keeping in mind that SSL/TLS add some overhead. Typical values of 1419 and
2867 2859 gave good results during tests. Use "strace -e trace=write" to find the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002868 best value. HAProxy will automatically switch to this setting after an idle
Willy Tarreau7e312732014-02-12 16:35:14 +01002869 stream has been detected (see tune.idletimer above).
Willy Tarreaubfd59462013-02-21 07:46:09 +01002870
Christopher Faulet31af49d2015-06-09 17:29:50 +02002871tune.ssl.ssl-ctx-cache-size <number>
2872 Sets the size of the cache used to store generated certificates to <number>
2873 entries. This is a LRU cache. Because generating a SSL certificate
2874 dynamically is expensive, they are cached. The default cache size is set to
2875 1000 entries.
2876
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02002877tune.vars.global-max-size <size>
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +01002878tune.vars.proc-max-size <size>
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02002879tune.vars.reqres-max-size <size>
2880tune.vars.sess-max-size <size>
2881tune.vars.txn-max-size <size>
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +01002882 These five tunes help to manage the maximum amount of memory used by the
2883 variables system. "global" limits the overall amount of memory available for
2884 all scopes. "proc" limits the memory for the process scope, "sess" limits the
2885 memory for the session scope, "txn" for the transaction scope, and "reqres"
2886 limits the memory for each request or response processing.
2887 Memory accounting is hierarchical, meaning more coarse grained limits include
2888 the finer grained ones: "proc" includes "sess", "sess" includes "txn", and
2889 "txn" includes "reqres".
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02002890
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +01002891 For example, when "tune.vars.sess-max-size" is limited to 100,
2892 "tune.vars.txn-max-size" and "tune.vars.reqres-max-size" cannot exceed
2893 100 either. If we create a variable "txn.var" that contains 100 bytes,
2894 all available space is consumed.
2895 Notice that exceeding the limits at runtime will not result in an error
2896 message, but values might be cut off or corrupted. So make sure to accurately
2897 plan for the amount of space needed to store all your variables.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02002898
William Lallemanda509e4c2012-11-07 16:54:34 +01002899tune.zlib.memlevel <number>
2900 Sets the memLevel parameter in zlib initialization for each session. It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03002901 defines how much memory should be allocated for the internal compression
William Lallemanda509e4c2012-11-07 16:54:34 +01002902 state. A value of 1 uses minimum memory but is slow and reduces compression
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002903 ratio, a value of 9 uses maximum memory for optimal speed. Can be a value
William Lallemanda509e4c2012-11-07 16:54:34 +01002904 between 1 and 9. The default value is 8.
2905
2906tune.zlib.windowsize <number>
2907 Sets the window size (the size of the history buffer) as a parameter of the
2908 zlib initialization for each session. Larger values of this parameter result
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002909 in better compression at the expense of memory usage. Can be a value between
2910 8 and 15. The default value is 15.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002911
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020029123.3. Debugging
2913--------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002914
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002915quiet
2916 Do not display any message during startup. It is equivalent to the command-
2917 line argument "-q".
2918
Willy Tarreau3eb10b82020-04-15 16:42:39 +02002919zero-warning
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04002920 When this option is set, HAProxy will refuse to start if any warning was
Willy Tarreau3eb10b82020-04-15 16:42:39 +02002921 emitted while processing the configuration. It is highly recommended to set
2922 this option on configurations that are not changed often, as it helps detect
2923 subtle mistakes and keep the configuration clean and forward-compatible. Note
2924 that "haproxy -c" will also report errors in such a case. This option is
2925 equivalent to command line argument "-dW".
2926
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02002927
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +010029283.4. Userlists
2929--------------
2930It is possible to control access to frontend/backend/listen sections or to
2931http stats by allowing only authenticated and authorized users. To do this,
2932it is required to create at least one userlist and to define users.
2933
2934userlist <listname>
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01002935 Creates new userlist with name <listname>. Many independent userlists can be
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01002936 used to store authentication & authorization data for independent customers.
2937
2938group <groupname> [users <user>,<user>,(...)]
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01002939 Adds group <groupname> to the current userlist. It is also possible to
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01002940 attach users to this group by using a comma separated list of names
2941 proceeded by "users" keyword.
2942
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01002943user <username> [password|insecure-password <password>]
2944 [groups <group>,<group>,(...)]
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01002945 Adds user <username> to the current userlist. Both secure (encrypted) and
2946 insecure (unencrypted) passwords can be used. Encrypted passwords are
Daniel Schnellerd06f31c2017-11-06 16:51:04 +01002947 evaluated using the crypt(3) function, so depending on the system's
2948 capabilities, different algorithms are supported. For example, modern Glibc
2949 based Linux systems support MD5, SHA-256, SHA-512, and, of course, the
2950 classic DES-based method of encrypting passwords.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01002951
Daniel Schnellerd06f31c2017-11-06 16:51:04 +01002952 Attention: Be aware that using encrypted passwords might cause significantly
2953 increased CPU usage, depending on the number of requests, and the algorithm
2954 used. For any of the hashed variants, the password for each request must
2955 be processed through the chosen algorithm, before it can be compared to the
2956 value specified in the config file. Most current algorithms are deliberately
2957 designed to be expensive to compute to achieve resistance against brute
2958 force attacks. They do not simply salt/hash the clear text password once,
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04002959 but thousands of times. This can quickly become a major factor in HAProxy's
Daniel Schnellerd06f31c2017-11-06 16:51:04 +01002960 overall CPU consumption!
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01002961
2962 Example:
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01002963 userlist L1
2964 group G1 users tiger,scott
2965 group G2 users xdb,scott
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01002966
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01002967 user tiger password $6$k6y3o.eP$JlKBx9za9667qe4(...)xHSwRv6J.C0/D7cV91
2968 user scott insecure-password elgato
2969 user xdb insecure-password hello
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01002970
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01002971 userlist L2
2972 group G1
2973 group G2
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01002974
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01002975 user tiger password $6$k6y3o.eP$JlKBx(...)xHSwRv6J.C0/D7cV91 groups G1
2976 user scott insecure-password elgato groups G1,G2
2977 user xdb insecure-password hello groups G2
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01002978
2979 Please note that both lists are functionally identical.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002980
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02002981
29823.5. Peers
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02002983----------
Emeric Brun94900952015-06-11 18:25:54 +02002984It is possible to propagate entries of any data-types in stick-tables between
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04002985several HAProxy instances over TCP connections in a multi-master fashion. Each
Emeric Brun94900952015-06-11 18:25:54 +02002986instance pushes its local updates and insertions to remote peers. The pushed
2987values overwrite remote ones without aggregation. Interrupted exchanges are
2988automatically detected and recovered from the last known point.
2989In addition, during a soft restart, the old process connects to the new one
2990using such a TCP connection to push all its entries before the new process
2991tries to connect to other peers. That ensures very fast replication during a
2992reload, it typically takes a fraction of a second even for large tables.
2993Note that Server IDs are used to identify servers remotely, so it is important
2994that configurations look similar or at least that the same IDs are forced on
2995each server on all participants.
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02002996
2997peers <peersect>
Jamie Gloudon801a0a32012-08-25 00:18:33 -04002998 Creates a new peer list with name <peersect>. It is an independent section,
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02002999 which is referenced by one or more stick-tables.
3000
Christopher Faulet23e69ae2023-05-31 11:55:23 +02003001bind [<address>]:port [param*]
3002bind /<path> [param*]
Frédéric Lécaille2f167b32019-01-11 14:13:54 +01003003 Defines the binding parameters of the local peer of this "peers" section.
3004 Such lines are not supported with "peer" line in the same "peers" section.
3005
Willy Tarreau77e4bd12015-05-01 20:02:17 +02003006disabled
3007 Disables a peers section. It disables both listening and any synchronization
3008 related to this section. This is provided to disable synchronization of stick
3009 tables without having to comment out all "peers" references.
3010
Frédéric Lécaille2f167b32019-01-11 14:13:54 +01003011default-bind [param*]
3012 Defines the binding parameters for the local peer, excepted its address.
3013
3014default-server [param*]
3015 Change default options for a server in a "peers" section.
3016
3017 Arguments:
3018 <param*> is a list of parameters for this server. The "default-server"
3019 keyword accepts an important number of options and has a complete
Willy Tarreaufd5d0e82022-05-31 10:22:12 +02003020 section dedicated to it. In a peers section, the transport
3021 parameters of a "default-server" line are supported. Please refer
3022 to section 5 for more details, and the "server" keyword below in
3023 this section for some of the restrictions.
Frédéric Lécaille2f167b32019-01-11 14:13:54 +01003024
3025 See also: "server" and section 5 about server options
3026
Emeric Brun7214dcf2021-09-29 10:29:52 +02003027enabled
3028 This re-enables a peers section which was previously disabled via the
3029 "disabled" keyword.
Willy Tarreau77e4bd12015-05-01 20:02:17 +02003030
Jan Wagner3e678602020-12-17 22:22:32 +01003031log <address> [len <length>] [format <format>] [sample <ranges>:<sample_size>]
Frédéric Lécailleb6f759b2019-11-05 09:57:45 +01003032 <facility> [<level> [<minlevel>]]
3033 "peers" sections support the same "log" keyword as for the proxies to
3034 log information about the "peers" listener. See "log" option for proxies for
3035 more details.
3036
Christopher Faulet23e69ae2023-05-31 11:55:23 +02003037peer <peername> [<address>]:port [param*]
3038peer <peername> /<path> [param*]
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02003039 Defines a peer inside a peers section.
3040 If <peername> is set to the local peer name (by default hostname, or forced
Dragan Dosen13cd54c2020-06-18 18:24:05 +02003041 using "-L" command line option or "localpeer" global configuration setting),
Christopher Faulet23e69ae2023-05-31 11:55:23 +02003042 HAProxy will listen for incoming remote peer connection on the provided
3043 address. Otherwise, the address defines where to connect to in order to join
3044 the remote peer, and <peername> is used at the protocol level to identify and
Dragan Dosen13cd54c2020-06-18 18:24:05 +02003045 validate the remote peer on the server side.
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02003046
Christopher Faulet23e69ae2023-05-31 11:55:23 +02003047 During a soft restart, local peer address is used by the old instance to
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02003048 connect the new one and initiate a complete replication (teaching process).
3049
3050 It is strongly recommended to have the exact same peers declaration on all
Dragan Dosen13cd54c2020-06-18 18:24:05 +02003051 peers and to only rely on the "-L" command line argument or the "localpeer"
3052 global configuration setting to change the local peer name. This makes it
3053 easier to maintain coherent configuration files across all peers.
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02003054
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +02003055 You may want to reference some environment variables in the address
3056 parameter, see section 2.3 about environment variables.
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01003057
Frédéric Lécaille2f167b32019-01-11 14:13:54 +01003058 Note: "peer" keyword may transparently be replaced by "server" keyword (see
3059 "server" keyword explanation below).
3060
Christopher Faulet23e69ae2023-05-31 11:55:23 +02003061server <peername> [<address>:<port>] [param*]
3062server <peername> [/<path>] [param*]
Michael Prokop4438c602019-05-24 10:25:45 +02003063 As previously mentioned, "peer" keyword may be replaced by "server" keyword
Willy Tarreaufd5d0e82022-05-31 10:22:12 +02003064 with a support for all "server" parameters found in 5.2 paragraph that are
Christopher Faulet23e69ae2023-05-31 11:55:23 +02003065 related to transport settings. If the underlying peer is local, the address
3066 parameter must not be present; it must be provided on a "bind" line (see
3067 "bind" keyword of this "peers" section).
Frédéric Lécaille2f167b32019-01-11 14:13:54 +01003068
Willy Tarreaufd5d0e82022-05-31 10:22:12 +02003069 A number of "server" parameters are irrelevant for "peers" sections. Peers by
3070 nature do not support dynamic host name resolution nor health checks, hence
3071 parameters like "init_addr", "resolvers", "check", "agent-check", or "track"
3072 are not supported. Similarly, there is no load balancing nor stickiness, thus
3073 parameters such as "weight" or "cookie" have no effect.
Frédéric Lécaille2f167b32019-01-11 14:13:54 +01003074
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02003075 Example:
Frédéric Lécaille2f167b32019-01-11 14:13:54 +01003076 # The old way.
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02003077 peers mypeers
Willy Tarreauf7b30a92010-12-06 22:59:17 +01003078 peer haproxy1 192.168.0.1:1024
3079 peer haproxy2 192.168.0.2:1024
3080 peer haproxy3 10.2.0.1:1024
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02003081
3082 backend mybackend
3083 mode tcp
3084 balance roundrobin
3085 stick-table type ip size 20k peers mypeers
3086 stick on src
3087
Willy Tarreauf7b30a92010-12-06 22:59:17 +01003088 server srv1 192.168.0.30:80
3089 server srv2 192.168.0.31:80
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02003090
Frédéric Lécaille2f167b32019-01-11 14:13:54 +01003091 Example:
3092 peers mypeers
Emeric Brun6ca8ba42022-05-30 18:13:35 +02003093 bind 192.168.0.1:1024 ssl crt mycerts/pem
3094 default-server ssl verify none
3095 server haproxy1 #local peer
3096 server haproxy2 192.168.0.2:1024
3097 server haproxy3 10.2.0.1:1024
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02003098
Frédéric Lécaille4f5b77c2019-03-18 14:05:58 +01003099
3100table <tablename> type {ip | integer | string [len <length>] | binary [len <length>]}
3101 size <size> [expire <expire>] [nopurge] [store <data_type>]*
3102
3103 Configure a stickiness table for the current section. This line is parsed
3104 exactly the same way as the "stick-table" keyword in others section, except
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -05003105 for the "peers" argument which is not required here and with an additional
Frédéric Lécaille4f5b77c2019-03-18 14:05:58 +01003106 mandatory first parameter to designate the stick-table. Contrary to others
3107 sections, there may be several "table" lines in "peers" sections (see also
3108 "stick-table" keyword).
3109
3110 Also be aware of the fact that "peers" sections have their own stick-table
3111 namespaces to avoid collisions between stick-table names identical in
3112 different "peers" section. This is internally handled prepending the "peers"
3113 sections names to the name of the stick-tables followed by a '/' character.
3114 If somewhere else in the configuration file you have to refer to such
3115 stick-tables declared in "peers" sections you must use the prefixed version
3116 of the stick-table name as follows:
3117
3118 peers mypeers
3119 peer A ...
3120 peer B ...
3121 table t1 ...
3122
3123 frontend fe1
3124 tcp-request content track-sc0 src table mypeers/t1
3125
3126 This is also this prefixed version of the stick-table names which must be
3127 used to refer to stick-tables through the CLI.
3128
3129 About "peers" protocol, as only "peers" belonging to the same section may
3130 communicate with each others, there is no need to do such a distinction.
3131 Several "peers" sections may declare stick-tables with the same name.
3132 This is shorter version of the stick-table name which is sent over the network.
3133 There is only a '/' character as prefix to avoid stick-table name collisions between
3134 stick-tables declared as backends and stick-table declared in "peers" sections
3135 as follows in this weird but supported configuration:
3136
3137 peers mypeers
3138 peer A ...
3139 peer B ...
3140 table t1 type string size 10m store gpc0
3141
3142 backend t1
3143 stick-table type string size 10m store gpc0 peers mypeers
3144
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -04003145 Here "t1" table declared in "mypeers" section has "mypeers/t1" as global name.
Frédéric Lécaille4f5b77c2019-03-18 14:05:58 +01003146 "t1" table declared as a backend as "t1" as global name. But at peer protocol
3147 level the former table is named "/t1", the latter is again named "t1".
3148
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +090031493.6. Mailers
3150------------
3151It is possible to send email alerts when the state of servers changes.
3152If configured email alerts are sent to each mailer that is configured
3153in a mailers section. Email is sent to mailers using SMTP.
3154
Pieter Baauw386a1272015-08-16 15:26:24 +02003155mailers <mailersect>
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09003156 Creates a new mailer list with the name <mailersect>. It is an
3157 independent section which is referenced by one or more proxies.
3158
3159mailer <mailername> <ip>:<port>
3160 Defines a mailer inside a mailers section.
3161
3162 Example:
3163 mailers mymailers
3164 mailer smtp1 192.168.0.1:587
3165 mailer smtp2 192.168.0.2:587
3166
3167 backend mybackend
3168 mode tcp
3169 balance roundrobin
3170
3171 email-alert mailers mymailers
3172 email-alert from test1@horms.org
3173 email-alert to test2@horms.org
3174
3175 server srv1 192.168.0.30:80
3176 server srv2 192.168.0.31:80
3177
Pieter Baauw235fcfc2016-02-13 15:33:40 +01003178timeout mail <time>
3179 Defines the time available for a mail/connection to be made and send to
3180 the mail-server. If not defined the default value is 10 seconds. To allow
3181 for at least two SYN-ACK packets to be send during initial TCP handshake it
3182 is advised to keep this value above 4 seconds.
3183
3184 Example:
3185 mailers mymailers
3186 timeout mail 20s
3187 mailer smtp1 192.168.0.1:587
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09003188
William Lallemandc9515522019-06-12 16:32:11 +020031893.7. Programs
3190-------------
3191In master-worker mode, it is possible to launch external binaries with the
3192master, these processes are called programs. These programs are launched and
3193managed the same way as the workers.
3194
3195During a reload of HAProxy, those processes are dealing with the same
3196sequence as a worker:
3197
3198 - the master is re-executed
3199 - the master sends a SIGUSR1 signal to the program
3200 - if "option start-on-reload" is not disabled, the master launches a new
3201 instance of the program
3202
3203During a stop, or restart, a SIGTERM is sent to the programs.
3204
3205program <name>
3206 This is a new program section, this section will create an instance <name>
3207 which is visible in "show proc" on the master CLI. (See "9.4. Master CLI" in
3208 the management guide).
3209
3210command <command> [arguments*]
3211 Define the command to start with optional arguments. The command is looked
3212 up in the current PATH if it does not include an absolute path. This is a
3213 mandatory option of the program section. Arguments containing spaces must
3214 be enclosed in quotes or double quotes or be prefixed by a backslash.
3215
Andrew Heberle97236962019-07-12 11:50:26 +08003216user <user name>
3217 Changes the executed command user ID to the <user name> from /etc/passwd.
3218 See also "group".
3219
3220group <group name>
3221 Changes the executed command group ID to the <group name> from /etc/group.
3222 See also "user".
3223
William Lallemandc9515522019-06-12 16:32:11 +02003224option start-on-reload
3225no option start-on-reload
3226 Start (or not) a new instance of the program upon a reload of the master.
3227 The default is to start a new instance. This option may only be used in a
3228 program section.
3229
3230
Christopher Faulet76edc0f2020-01-13 15:52:01 +010032313.8. HTTP-errors
3232----------------
3233
3234It is possible to globally declare several groups of HTTP errors, to be
3235imported afterwards in any proxy section. Same group may be referenced at
3236several places and can be fully or partially imported.
3237
3238http-errors <name>
3239 Create a new http-errors group with the name <name>. It is an independent
3240 section that may be referenced by one or more proxies using its name.
3241
3242errorfile <code> <file>
3243 Associate a file contents to an HTTP error code
3244
3245 Arguments :
3246 <code> is the HTTP status code. Currently, HAProxy is capable of
Christopher Faulet612f2ea2020-05-27 09:57:28 +02003247 generating codes 200, 400, 401, 403, 404, 405, 407, 408, 410,
Christopher Faulete095f312020-12-07 11:22:24 +01003248 425, 429, 500, 501, 502, 503, and 504.
Christopher Faulet76edc0f2020-01-13 15:52:01 +01003249
3250 <file> designates a file containing the full HTTP response. It is
3251 recommended to follow the common practice of appending ".http" to
3252 the filename so that people do not confuse the response with HTML
3253 error pages, and to use absolute paths, since files are read
3254 before any chroot is performed.
3255
3256 Please referrers to "errorfile" keyword in section 4 for details.
3257
3258 Example:
3259 http-errors website-1
3260 errorfile 400 /etc/haproxy/errorfiles/site1/400.http
3261 errorfile 404 /etc/haproxy/errorfiles/site1/404.http
3262 errorfile 408 /dev/null # work around Chrome pre-connect bug
3263
3264 http-errors website-2
3265 errorfile 400 /etc/haproxy/errorfiles/site2/400.http
3266 errorfile 404 /etc/haproxy/errorfiles/site2/404.http
3267 errorfile 408 /dev/null # work around Chrome pre-connect bug
3268
Emeric Brun99c453d2020-05-25 15:01:04 +020032693.9. Rings
3270----------
3271
3272It is possible to globally declare ring-buffers, to be used as target for log
3273servers or traces.
3274
3275ring <ringname>
3276 Creates a new ring-buffer with name <ringname>.
3277
3278description <text>
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -04003279 The description is an optional description string of the ring. It will
Emeric Brun99c453d2020-05-25 15:01:04 +02003280 appear on CLI. By default, <name> is reused to fill this field.
3281
3282format <format>
3283 Format used to store events into the ring buffer.
3284
3285 Arguments:
3286 <format> is the log format used when generating syslog messages. It may be
3287 one of the following :
3288
3289 iso A message containing only the ISO date, followed by the text.
3290 The PID, process name and system name are omitted. This is
3291 designed to be used with a local log server.
3292
Emeric Brun0237c4e2020-11-27 16:24:34 +01003293 local Analog to rfc3164 syslog message format except that hostname
3294 field is stripped. This is the default.
3295 Note: option "log-send-hostname" switches the default to
3296 rfc3164.
3297
Emeric Brun99c453d2020-05-25 15:01:04 +02003298 raw A message containing only the text. The level, PID, date, time,
3299 process name and system name are omitted. This is designed to be
3300 used in containers or during development, where the severity
3301 only depends on the file descriptor used (stdout/stderr). This
3302 is the default.
3303
Emeric Brun0237c4e2020-11-27 16:24:34 +01003304 rfc3164 The RFC3164 syslog message format.
Emeric Brun99c453d2020-05-25 15:01:04 +02003305 (https://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc3164)
3306
3307 rfc5424 The RFC5424 syslog message format.
3308 (https://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc5424)
3309
3310 short A message containing only a level between angle brackets such as
3311 '<3>', followed by the text. The PID, date, time, process name
3312 and system name are omitted. This is designed to be used with a
3313 local log server. This format is compatible with what the systemd
3314 logger consumes.
3315
Emeric Brun54648852020-07-06 15:54:06 +02003316 priority A message containing only a level plus syslog facility between angle
3317 brackets such as '<63>', followed by the text. The PID, date, time,
3318 process name and system name are omitted. This is designed to be used
3319 with a local log server.
3320
Emeric Brun99c453d2020-05-25 15:01:04 +02003321 timed A message containing only a level between angle brackets such as
3322 '<3>', followed by ISO date and by the text. The PID, process
3323 name and system name are omitted. This is designed to be
3324 used with a local log server.
3325
3326maxlen <length>
3327 The maximum length of an event message stored into the ring,
3328 including formatted header. If an event message is longer than
3329 <length>, it will be truncated to this length.
3330
Emeric Brun494c5052020-05-28 11:13:15 +02003331server <name> <address> [param*]
3332 Used to configure a syslog tcp server to forward messages from ring buffer.
3333 This supports for all "server" parameters found in 5.2 paragraph. Some of
3334 these parameters are irrelevant for "ring" sections. Important point: there
3335 is little reason to add more than one server to a ring, because all servers
3336 will receive the exact same copy of the ring contents, and as such the ring
3337 will progress at the speed of the slowest server. If one server does not
3338 respond, it will prevent old messages from being purged and may block new
3339 messages from being inserted into the ring. The proper way to send messages
3340 to multiple servers is to use one distinct ring per log server, not to
Emeric Brun97556472020-05-30 01:42:45 +02003341 attach multiple servers to the same ring. Note that specific server directive
3342 "log-proto" is used to set the protocol used to send messages.
Emeric Brun494c5052020-05-28 11:13:15 +02003343
Emeric Brun99c453d2020-05-25 15:01:04 +02003344size <size>
3345 This is the optional size in bytes for the ring-buffer. Default value is
3346 set to BUFSIZE.
3347
Emeric Brun494c5052020-05-28 11:13:15 +02003348timeout connect <timeout>
3349 Set the maximum time to wait for a connection attempt to a server to succeed.
3350
3351 Arguments :
3352 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
3353 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
3354 as explained at the top of this document.
3355
3356timeout server <timeout>
3357 Set the maximum time for pending data staying into output buffer.
3358
3359 Arguments :
3360 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
3361 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
3362 as explained at the top of this document.
3363
Emeric Brun99c453d2020-05-25 15:01:04 +02003364 Example:
3365 global
3366 log ring@myring local7
3367
3368 ring myring
3369 description "My local buffer"
3370 format rfc3164
3371 maxlen 1200
3372 size 32764
Emeric Brun494c5052020-05-28 11:13:15 +02003373 timeout connect 5s
3374 timeout server 10s
Emeric Brun97556472020-05-30 01:42:45 +02003375 server mysyslogsrv 127.0.0.1:6514 log-proto octet-count
Emeric Brun99c453d2020-05-25 15:01:04 +02003376
Emeric Brun12941c82020-07-07 14:19:42 +020033773.10. Log forwarding
3378-------------------
3379
3380It is possible to declare one or multiple log forwarding section,
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04003381HAProxy will forward all received log messages to a log servers list.
Emeric Brun12941c82020-07-07 14:19:42 +02003382
3383log-forward <name>
3384 Creates a new log forwarder proxy identified as <name>.
3385
Emeric Bruncbb7bf72020-10-05 14:39:35 +02003386backlog <conns>
3387 Give hints to the system about the approximate listen backlog desired size
3388 on connections accept.
3389
3390bind <addr> [param*]
3391 Used to configure a stream log listener to receive messages to forward.
Emeric Brunda46c1c2020-10-08 08:39:02 +02003392 This supports the "bind" parameters found in 5.1 paragraph including
3393 those about ssl but some statements such as "alpn" may be irrelevant for
3394 syslog protocol over TCP.
3395 Those listeners support both "Octet Counting" and "Non-Transparent-Framing"
Emeric Bruncbb7bf72020-10-05 14:39:35 +02003396 modes as defined in rfc-6587.
3397
Willy Tarreau76aaa7f2020-09-16 15:07:22 +02003398dgram-bind <addr> [param*]
Emeric Bruncbb7bf72020-10-05 14:39:35 +02003399 Used to configure a datagram log listener to receive messages to forward.
3400 Addresses must be in IPv4 or IPv6 form,followed by a port. This supports
3401 for some of the "bind" parameters found in 5.1 paragraph among which
3402 "interface", "namespace" or "transparent", the other ones being
Willy Tarreau26ff5da2020-09-16 15:22:19 +02003403 silently ignored as irrelevant for UDP/syslog case.
Emeric Brun12941c82020-07-07 14:19:42 +02003404
3405log global
Jan Wagner3e678602020-12-17 22:22:32 +01003406log <address> [len <length>] [format <format>] [sample <ranges>:<sample_size>]
Emeric Brun12941c82020-07-07 14:19:42 +02003407 <facility> [<level> [<minlevel>]]
3408 Used to configure target log servers. See more details on proxies
3409 documentation.
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04003410 If no format specified, HAProxy tries to keep the incoming log format.
Emeric Brun12941c82020-07-07 14:19:42 +02003411 Configured facility is ignored, except if incoming message does not
3412 present a facility but one is mandatory on the outgoing format.
3413 If there is no timestamp available in the input format, but the field
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04003414 exists in output format, HAProxy will use the local date.
Emeric Brun12941c82020-07-07 14:19:42 +02003415
3416 Example:
3417 global
3418 log stderr format iso local7
3419
3420 ring myring
3421 description "My local buffer"
3422 format rfc5424
3423 maxlen 1200
3424 size 32764
3425 timeout connect 5s
3426 timeout server 10s
3427 # syslog tcp server
3428 server mysyslogsrv 127.0.0.1:514 log-proto octet-count
3429
3430 log-forward sylog-loadb
Emeric Bruncbb7bf72020-10-05 14:39:35 +02003431 dgram-bind 127.0.0.1:1514
3432 bind 127.0.0.1:1514
Emeric Brun12941c82020-07-07 14:19:42 +02003433 # all messages on stderr
3434 log global
3435 # all messages on local tcp syslog server
3436 log ring@myring local0
3437 # load balance messages on 4 udp syslog servers
3438 log 127.0.0.1:10001 sample 1:4 local0
3439 log 127.0.0.1:10002 sample 2:4 local0
3440 log 127.0.0.1:10003 sample 3:4 local0
3441 log 127.0.0.1:10004 sample 4:4 local0
Christopher Faulet76edc0f2020-01-13 15:52:01 +01003442
Emeric Bruncbb7bf72020-10-05 14:39:35 +02003443maxconn <conns>
3444 Fix the maximum number of concurrent connections on a log forwarder.
3445 10 is the default.
3446
3447timeout client <timeout>
3448 Set the maximum inactivity time on the client side.
3449
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020034504. Proxies
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02003451----------
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003452
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02003453Proxy configuration can be located in a set of sections :
Willy Tarreau7c0b4d82021-02-12 14:58:08 +01003454 - defaults [<name>] [ from <defaults_name> ]
3455 - frontend <name> [ from <defaults_name> ]
3456 - backend <name> [ from <defaults_name> ]
3457 - listen <name> [ from <defaults_name> ]
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02003458
3459A "frontend" section describes a set of listening sockets accepting client
3460connections.
3461
3462A "backend" section describes a set of servers to which the proxy will connect
3463to forward incoming connections.
3464
3465A "listen" section defines a complete proxy with its frontend and backend
3466parts combined in one section. It is generally useful for TCP-only traffic.
3467
Willy Tarreau7c0b4d82021-02-12 14:58:08 +01003468A "defaults" section resets all settings to the documented ones and presets new
3469ones for use by subsequent sections. All of "frontend", "backend" and "listen"
3470sections always take their initial settings from a defaults section, by default
3471the latest one that appears before the newly created section. It is possible to
3472explicitly designate a specific "defaults" section to load the initial settings
3473from by indicating its name on the section line after the optional keyword
3474"from". While "defaults" section do not impose a name, this use is encouraged
3475for better readability. It is also the only way to designate a specific section
3476to use instead of the default previous one. Since "defaults" section names are
3477optional, by default a very permissive check is applied on their name and these
3478are even permitted to overlap. However if a "defaults" section is referenced by
3479any other section, its name must comply with the syntax imposed on all proxy
3480names, and this name must be unique among the defaults sections. Please note
3481that regardless of what is currently permitted, it is recommended to avoid
3482duplicate section names in general and to respect the same syntax as for proxy
3483names. This rule might be enforced in a future version.
3484
3485Note that it is even possible for a defaults section to take its initial
3486settings from another one, and as such, inherit settings across multiple levels
3487of defaults sections. This can be convenient to establish certain configuration
3488profiles to carry groups of default settings (e.g. TCP vs HTTP or short vs long
3489timeouts) but can quickly become confusing to follow.
3490
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003491All proxy names must be formed from upper and lower case letters, digits,
3492'-' (dash), '_' (underscore) , '.' (dot) and ':' (colon). ACL names are
3493case-sensitive, which means that "www" and "WWW" are two different proxies.
3494
3495Historically, all proxy names could overlap, it just caused troubles in the
3496logs. Since the introduction of content switching, it is mandatory that two
3497proxies with overlapping capabilities (frontend/backend) have different names.
3498However, it is still permitted that a frontend and a backend share the same
3499name, as this configuration seems to be commonly encountered.
3500
3501Right now, two major proxy modes are supported : "tcp", also known as layer 4,
3502and "http", also known as layer 7. In layer 4 mode, HAProxy simply forwards
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01003503bidirectional traffic between two sides. In layer 7 mode, HAProxy analyzes the
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003504protocol, and can interact with it by allowing, blocking, switching, adding,
3505modifying, or removing arbitrary contents in requests or responses, based on
3506arbitrary criteria.
3507
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01003508In HTTP mode, the processing applied to requests and responses flowing over
3509a connection depends in the combination of the frontend's HTTP options and
Julien Pivotto21ad3152019-12-10 13:11:17 +01003510the backend's. HAProxy supports 3 connection modes :
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01003511
3512 - KAL : keep alive ("option http-keep-alive") which is the default mode : all
3513 requests and responses are processed, and connections remain open but idle
3514 between responses and new requests.
3515
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01003516 - SCL: server close ("option http-server-close") : the server-facing
3517 connection is closed after the end of the response is received, but the
3518 client-facing connection remains open.
3519
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02003520 - CLO: close ("option httpclose"): the connection is closed after the end of
3521 the response and "Connection: close" appended in both directions.
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01003522
3523The effective mode that will be applied to a connection passing through a
3524frontend and a backend can be determined by both proxy modes according to the
3525following matrix, but in short, the modes are symmetric, keep-alive is the
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02003526weakest option and close is the strongest.
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01003527
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02003528 Backend mode
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01003529
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02003530 | KAL | SCL | CLO
3531 ----+-----+-----+----
3532 KAL | KAL | SCL | CLO
3533 ----+-----+-----+----
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02003534 mode SCL | SCL | SCL | CLO
3535 ----+-----+-----+----
3536 CLO | CLO | CLO | CLO
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01003537
Christopher Faulet4d37e532021-03-26 14:44:00 +01003538It is possible to chain a TCP frontend to an HTTP backend. It is pointless if
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04003539only HTTP traffic is handled. But it may be used to handle several protocols
3540within the same frontend. In this case, the client's connection is first handled
Christopher Faulet4d37e532021-03-26 14:44:00 +01003541as a raw tcp connection before being upgraded to HTTP. Before the upgrade, the
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04003542content processings are performend on raw data. Once upgraded, data is parsed
Christopher Faulet4d37e532021-03-26 14:44:00 +01003543and stored using an internal representation called HTX and it is no longer
3544possible to rely on raw representation. There is no way to go back.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003545
Christopher Faulet4d37e532021-03-26 14:44:00 +01003546There are two kind of upgrades, in-place upgrades and destructive upgrades. The
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04003547first ones involves a TCP to HTTP/1 upgrade. In HTTP/1, the request
Christopher Faulet4d37e532021-03-26 14:44:00 +01003548processings are serialized, thus the applicative stream can be preserved. The
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04003549second one involves a TCP to HTTP/2 upgrade. Because it is a multiplexed
Christopher Faulet4d37e532021-03-26 14:44:00 +01003550protocol, the applicative stream cannot be associated to any HTTP/2 stream and
3551is destroyed. New applicative streams are then created when HAProxy receives
3552new HTTP/2 streams at the lower level, in the H2 multiplexer. It is important
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04003553to understand this difference because that drastically changes the way to
Christopher Faulet4d37e532021-03-26 14:44:00 +01003554process data. When an HTTP/1 upgrade is performed, the content processings
3555already performed on raw data are neither lost nor reexecuted while for an
3556HTTP/2 upgrade, applicative streams are distinct and all frontend rules are
3557evaluated systematically on each one. And as said, the first stream, the TCP
3558one, is destroyed, but only after the frontend rules were evaluated.
3559
3560There is another importnat point to understand when HTTP processings are
3561performed from a TCP proxy. While HAProxy is able to parse HTTP/1 in-fly from
3562tcp-request content rules, it is not possible for HTTP/2. Only the HTTP/2
3563preface can be parsed. This is a huge limitation regarding the HTTP content
3564analysis in TCP. Concretely it is only possible to know if received data are
3565HTTP. For instance, it is not possible to choose a backend based on the Host
3566header value while it is trivial in HTTP/1. Hopefully, there is a solution to
3567mitigate this drawback.
3568
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04003569There are two ways to perform an HTTP upgrade. The first one, the historical
Christopher Faulet4d37e532021-03-26 14:44:00 +01003570method, is to select an HTTP backend. The upgrade happens when the backend is
3571set. Thus, for in-place upgrades, only the backend configuration is considered
3572in the HTTP data processing. For destructive upgrades, the applicative stream
3573is destroyed, thus its processing is stopped. With this method, possibilities
3574to choose a backend with an HTTP/2 connection are really limited, as mentioned
3575above, and a bit useless because the stream is destroyed. The second method is
3576to upgrade during the tcp-request content rules evaluation, thanks to the
3577"switch-mode http" action. In this case, the upgrade is performed in the
3578frontend context and it is possible to define HTTP directives in this
3579frontend. For in-place upgrades, it offers all the power of the HTTP analysis
3580as soon as possible. It is not that far from an HTTP frontend. For destructive
3581upgrades, it does not change anything except it is useless to choose a backend
3582on limited information. It is of course the recommended method. Thus, testing
3583the request protocol from the tcp-request content rules to perform an HTTP
3584upgrade is enough. All the remaining HTTP manipulation may be moved to the
3585frontend http-request ruleset. But keep in mind that tcp-request content rules
3586remains evaluated on each streams, that can't be changed.
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01003587
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020035884.1. Proxy keywords matrix
3589--------------------------
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003590
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02003591The following list of keywords is supported. Most of them may only be used in a
3592limited set of section types. Some of them are marked as "deprecated" because
3593they are inherited from an old syntax which may be confusing or functionally
3594limited, and there are new recommended keywords to replace them. Keywords
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003595marked with "(*)" can be optionally inverted using the "no" prefix, e.g. "no
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02003596option contstats". This makes sense when the option has been enabled by default
Willy Tarreau3842f002009-06-14 11:39:52 +02003597and must be disabled for a specific instance. Such options may also be prefixed
3598with "default" in order to restore default settings regardless of what has been
3599specified in a previous "defaults" section.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003600
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02003601
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003602 keyword defaults frontend listen backend
3603------------------------------------+----------+----------+---------+---------
3604acl - X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003605backlog X X X -
3606balance X - X X
3607bind - X X -
3608bind-process X X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003609capture cookie - X X -
3610capture request header - X X -
3611capture response header - X X -
MIZUTA Takeshib24bc0d2020-07-09 11:13:20 +09003612clitcpka-cnt X X X -
3613clitcpka-idle X X X -
3614clitcpka-intvl X X X -
William Lallemand82fe75c2012-10-23 10:25:10 +02003615compression X X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003616cookie X - X X
Thierry FOURNIERa0a1b752015-05-26 17:44:32 +02003617declare capture - X X -
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003618default-server X - X X
3619default_backend X X X -
3620description - X X X
3621disabled X X X X
3622dispatch - - X X
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09003623email-alert from X X X X
Simon Horman64e34162015-02-06 11:11:57 +09003624email-alert level X X X X
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09003625email-alert mailers X X X X
3626email-alert myhostname X X X X
3627email-alert to X X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003628enabled X X X X
3629errorfile X X X X
Christopher Faulet76edc0f2020-01-13 15:52:01 +01003630errorfiles X X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003631errorloc X X X X
3632errorloc302 X X X X
3633-- keyword -------------------------- defaults - frontend - listen -- backend -
3634errorloc303 X X X X
Cyril Bonté4288c5a2018-03-12 22:02:59 +01003635force-persist - - X X
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +02003636filter - X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003637fullconn X - X X
3638grace X X X X
3639hash-type X - X X
Christopher Faulet6d0c3df2020-01-22 09:26:35 +01003640http-after-response - X X X
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +02003641http-check comment X - X X
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02003642http-check connect X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003643http-check disable-on-404 X - X X
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02003644http-check expect X - X X
Peter Gervai8912ae62020-06-11 18:26:36 +02003645http-check send X - X X
Willy Tarreau7ab6aff2010-10-12 06:30:16 +02003646http-check send-state X - X X
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02003647http-check set-var X - X X
3648http-check unset-var X - X X
Christopher Faulet3b967c12020-05-15 15:47:44 +02003649http-error X X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003650http-request - X X X
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02003651http-response - X X X
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02003652http-reuse X - X X
Aurelien DARRAGON17e3cd52023-01-12 15:59:27 +01003653http-send-name-header X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003654id - X X X
Cyril Bonté4288c5a2018-03-12 22:02:59 +01003655ignore-persist - - X X
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02003656load-server-state-from-file X - X X
William Lallemand0f99e342011-10-12 17:50:54 +02003657log (*) X X X X
Willy Tarreaufb4e7ea2015-01-07 14:55:17 +01003658log-format X X X -
Dragan Dosen7ad31542015-09-28 17:16:47 +02003659log-format-sd X X X -
Willy Tarreau094af4e2015-01-07 15:03:42 +01003660log-tag X X X X
Willy Tarreauc35362a2014-04-25 13:58:37 +02003661max-keep-alive-queue X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003662maxconn X X X -
3663mode X X X X
3664monitor fail - X X -
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003665monitor-uri X X X -
3666option abortonclose (*) X - X X
3667option accept-invalid-http-request (*) X X X -
3668option accept-invalid-http-response (*) X - X X
3669option allbackups (*) X - X X
3670option checkcache (*) X - X X
3671option clitcpka (*) X X X -
3672option contstats (*) X X X -
Christopher Faulet89aed322020-06-02 17:33:56 +02003673option disable-h2-upgrade (*) X X X -
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003674option dontlog-normal (*) X X X -
3675option dontlognull (*) X X X -
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003676-- keyword -------------------------- defaults - frontend - listen -- backend -
3677option forwardfor X X X X
Christopher Faulet98fbe952019-07-22 16:18:24 +02003678option h1-case-adjust-bogus-client (*) X X X -
3679option h1-case-adjust-bogus-server (*) X - X X
Willy Tarreau9fbe18e2015-05-01 22:42:08 +02003680option http-buffer-request (*) X X X X
Willy Tarreau82649f92015-05-01 22:40:51 +02003681option http-ignore-probes (*) X X X -
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01003682option http-keep-alive (*) X X X X
Willy Tarreau96e31212011-05-30 18:10:30 +02003683option http-no-delay (*) X X X X
Christopher Faulet98db9762018-09-21 10:25:19 +02003684option http-pretend-keepalive (*) X - X X
Christopher Faulet79507152022-05-16 11:43:10 +02003685option http-restrict-req-hdr-names X X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003686option http-server-close (*) X X X X
3687option http-use-proxy-header (*) X X X -
3688option httpchk X - X X
3689option httpclose (*) X X X X
Freddy Spierenburge88b7732019-03-25 14:35:17 +01003690option httplog X X X -
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003691option http_proxy (*) X X X X
Jamie Gloudon801a0a32012-08-25 00:18:33 -04003692option independent-streams (*) X X X X
Gabor Lekenyb4c81e42010-09-29 18:17:05 +02003693option ldap-check X - X X
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09003694option external-check X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003695option log-health-checks (*) X - X X
3696option log-separate-errors (*) X X X -
3697option logasap (*) X X X -
3698option mysql-check X - X X
3699option nolinger (*) X X X X
3700option originalto X X X X
3701option persist (*) X - X X
Baptiste Assmann809e22a2015-10-12 20:22:55 +02003702option pgsql-check X - X X
3703option prefer-last-server (*) X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003704option redispatch (*) X - X X
Hervé COMMOWICKec032d62011-08-05 16:23:48 +02003705option redis-check X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003706option smtpchk X - X X
3707option socket-stats (*) X X X -
3708option splice-auto (*) X X X X
3709option splice-request (*) X X X X
3710option splice-response (*) X X X X
Aurelien DARRAGON54832622023-01-12 15:06:11 +01003711option spop-check X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003712option srvtcpka (*) X - X X
3713option ssl-hello-chk X - X X
3714-- keyword -------------------------- defaults - frontend - listen -- backend -
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01003715option tcp-check X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003716option tcp-smart-accept (*) X X X -
3717option tcp-smart-connect (*) X - X X
3718option tcpka X X X X
3719option tcplog X X X X
3720option transparent (*) X - X X
William Dauchy4711a892022-01-05 22:53:24 +01003721option idle-close-on-response (*) X X X -
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09003722external-check command X - X X
3723external-check path X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003724persist rdp-cookie X - X X
3725rate-limit sessions X X X -
3726redirect - X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003727-- keyword -------------------------- defaults - frontend - listen -- backend -
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003728retries X - X X
Olivier Houcharda254a372019-04-05 15:30:12 +02003729retry-on X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003730server - - X X
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02003731server-state-file-name X - X X
Frédéric Lécaillecb4502e2017-04-20 13:36:25 +02003732server-template - - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003733source X - X X
MIZUTA Takeshib24bc0d2020-07-09 11:13:20 +09003734srvtcpka-cnt X - X X
3735srvtcpka-idle X - X X
3736srvtcpka-intvl X - X X
Baptiste Assmann5a549212015-10-12 20:30:24 +02003737stats admin - X X X
3738stats auth X X X X
3739stats enable X X X X
3740stats hide-version X X X X
3741stats http-request - X X X
3742stats realm X X X X
3743stats refresh X X X X
3744stats scope X X X X
3745stats show-desc X X X X
3746stats show-legends X X X X
3747stats show-node X X X X
3748stats uri X X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003749-- keyword -------------------------- defaults - frontend - listen -- backend -
3750stick match - - X X
3751stick on - - X X
3752stick store-request - - X X
Willy Tarreaud8dc99f2011-07-01 11:33:25 +02003753stick store-response - - X X
Adam Spiers68af3c12017-04-06 16:31:39 +01003754stick-table - X X X
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +02003755tcp-check comment X - X X
Christopher Faulet404f9192020-04-09 23:13:54 +02003756tcp-check connect X - X X
3757tcp-check expect X - X X
3758tcp-check send X - X X
Christopher Fauletb50b3e62020-05-05 18:43:43 +02003759tcp-check send-lf X - X X
Christopher Faulet404f9192020-04-09 23:13:54 +02003760tcp-check send-binary X - X X
Christopher Fauletb50b3e62020-05-05 18:43:43 +02003761tcp-check send-binary-lf X - X X
Christopher Faulet404f9192020-04-09 23:13:54 +02003762tcp-check set-var X - X X
3763tcp-check unset-var X - X X
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02003764tcp-request connection - X X -
3765tcp-request content - X X X
Willy Tarreaua56235c2010-09-14 11:31:36 +02003766tcp-request inspect-delay - X X X
Willy Tarreau4f614292016-10-21 17:49:36 +02003767tcp-request session - X X -
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +02003768tcp-response content - - X X
3769tcp-response inspect-delay - - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003770timeout check X - X X
3771timeout client X X X -
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +02003772timeout client-fin X X X -
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003773timeout connect X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003774timeout http-keep-alive X X X X
3775timeout http-request X X X X
3776timeout queue X - X X
3777timeout server X - X X
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +02003778timeout server-fin X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003779timeout tarpit X X X X
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02003780timeout tunnel X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003781transparent (deprecated) X - X X
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +01003782unique-id-format X X X -
3783unique-id-header X X X -
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003784use_backend - X X -
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +02003785use-fcgi-app - - X X
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +02003786use-server - - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003787------------------------------------+----------+----------+---------+---------
3788 keyword defaults frontend listen backend
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02003789
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003790
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020037914.2. Alphabetically sorted keywords reference
3792---------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003793
3794This section provides a description of each keyword and its usage.
3795
3796
3797acl <aclname> <criterion> [flags] [operator] <value> ...
3798 Declare or complete an access list.
3799 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3800 no | yes | yes | yes
3801 Example:
3802 acl invalid_src src 0.0.0.0/7 224.0.0.0/3
3803 acl invalid_src src_port 0:1023
3804 acl local_dst hdr(host) -i localhost
3805
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02003806 See section 7 about ACL usage.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003807
3808
Willy Tarreauc73ce2b2008-01-06 10:55:10 +01003809backlog <conns>
3810 Give hints to the system about the approximate listen backlog desired size
3811 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3812 yes | yes | yes | no
3813 Arguments :
3814 <conns> is the number of pending connections. Depending on the operating
3815 system, it may represent the number of already acknowledged
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02003816 connections, of non-acknowledged ones, or both.
Willy Tarreauc73ce2b2008-01-06 10:55:10 +01003817
3818 In order to protect against SYN flood attacks, one solution is to increase
3819 the system's SYN backlog size. Depending on the system, sometimes it is just
3820 tunable via a system parameter, sometimes it is not adjustable at all, and
3821 sometimes the system relies on hints given by the application at the time of
3822 the listen() syscall. By default, HAProxy passes the frontend's maxconn value
3823 to the listen() syscall. On systems which can make use of this value, it can
3824 sometimes be useful to be able to specify a different value, hence this
3825 backlog parameter.
3826
3827 On Linux 2.4, the parameter is ignored by the system. On Linux 2.6, it is
3828 used as a hint and the system accepts up to the smallest greater power of
3829 two, and never more than some limits (usually 32768).
3830
3831 See also : "maxconn" and the target operating system's tuning guide.
3832
3833
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003834balance <algorithm> [ <arguments> ]
Willy Tarreau226071e2014-04-10 11:55:45 +02003835balance url_param <param> [check_post]
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003836 Define the load balancing algorithm to be used in a backend.
3837 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3838 yes | no | yes | yes
3839 Arguments :
3840 <algorithm> is the algorithm used to select a server when doing load
3841 balancing. This only applies when no persistence information
3842 is available, or when a connection is redispatched to another
3843 server. <algorithm> may be one of the following :
3844
3845 roundrobin Each server is used in turns, according to their weights.
3846 This is the smoothest and fairest algorithm when the server's
3847 processing time remains equally distributed. This algorithm
3848 is dynamic, which means that server weights may be adjusted
Willy Tarreau9757a382009-10-03 12:56:50 +02003849 on the fly for slow starts for instance. It is limited by
Godbacha34bdc02013-07-22 07:44:53 +08003850 design to 4095 active servers per backend. Note that in some
Willy Tarreau9757a382009-10-03 12:56:50 +02003851 large farms, when a server becomes up after having been down
3852 for a very short time, it may sometimes take a few hundreds
3853 requests for it to be re-integrated into the farm and start
3854 receiving traffic. This is normal, though very rare. It is
3855 indicated here in case you would have the chance to observe
3856 it, so that you don't worry.
3857
3858 static-rr Each server is used in turns, according to their weights.
3859 This algorithm is as similar to roundrobin except that it is
3860 static, which means that changing a server's weight on the
3861 fly will have no effect. On the other hand, it has no design
3862 limitation on the number of servers, and when a server goes
3863 up, it is always immediately reintroduced into the farm, once
3864 the full map is recomputed. It also uses slightly less CPU to
3865 run (around -1%).
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003866
Willy Tarreau2d2a7f82008-03-17 12:07:56 +01003867 leastconn The server with the lowest number of connections receives the
3868 connection. Round-robin is performed within groups of servers
3869 of the same load to ensure that all servers will be used. Use
3870 of this algorithm is recommended where very long sessions are
3871 expected, such as LDAP, SQL, TSE, etc... but is not very well
3872 suited for protocols using short sessions such as HTTP. This
3873 algorithm is dynamic, which means that server weights may be
Willy Tarreau8c855f62020-10-22 17:41:45 +02003874 adjusted on the fly for slow starts for instance. It will
3875 also consider the number of queued connections in addition to
3876 the established ones in order to minimize queuing.
Willy Tarreau2d2a7f82008-03-17 12:07:56 +01003877
Willy Tarreauf09c6602012-02-13 17:12:08 +01003878 first The first server with available connection slots receives the
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03003879 connection. The servers are chosen from the lowest numeric
Willy Tarreauf09c6602012-02-13 17:12:08 +01003880 identifier to the highest (see server parameter "id"), which
3881 defaults to the server's position in the farm. Once a server
Willy Tarreau64559c52012-04-07 09:08:45 +02003882 reaches its maxconn value, the next server is used. It does
Willy Tarreauf09c6602012-02-13 17:12:08 +01003883 not make sense to use this algorithm without setting maxconn.
3884 The purpose of this algorithm is to always use the smallest
3885 number of servers so that extra servers can be powered off
3886 during non-intensive hours. This algorithm ignores the server
3887 weight, and brings more benefit to long session such as RDP
Willy Tarreau64559c52012-04-07 09:08:45 +02003888 or IMAP than HTTP, though it can be useful there too. In
3889 order to use this algorithm efficiently, it is recommended
3890 that a cloud controller regularly checks server usage to turn
3891 them off when unused, and regularly checks backend queue to
3892 turn new servers on when the queue inflates. Alternatively,
3893 using "http-check send-state" may inform servers on the load.
Willy Tarreauf09c6602012-02-13 17:12:08 +01003894
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003895 source The source IP address is hashed and divided by the total
3896 weight of the running servers to designate which server will
3897 receive the request. This ensures that the same client IP
3898 address will always reach the same server as long as no
3899 server goes down or up. If the hash result changes due to the
3900 number of running servers changing, many clients will be
3901 directed to a different server. This algorithm is generally
3902 used in TCP mode where no cookie may be inserted. It may also
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01003903 be used on the Internet to provide a best-effort stickiness
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003904 to clients which refuse session cookies. This algorithm is
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02003905 static by default, which means that changing a server's
3906 weight on the fly will have no effect, but this can be
3907 changed using "hash-type".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003908
Oskar Stolc8dc41842012-05-19 10:19:54 +01003909 uri This algorithm hashes either the left part of the URI (before
3910 the question mark) or the whole URI (if the "whole" parameter
3911 is present) and divides the hash value by the total weight of
3912 the running servers. The result designates which server will
3913 receive the request. This ensures that the same URI will
3914 always be directed to the same server as long as no server
3915 goes up or down. This is used with proxy caches and
3916 anti-virus proxies in order to maximize the cache hit rate.
3917 Note that this algorithm may only be used in an HTTP backend.
3918 This algorithm is static by default, which means that
3919 changing a server's weight on the fly will have no effect,
3920 but this can be changed using "hash-type".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003921
Oskar Stolc8dc41842012-05-19 10:19:54 +01003922 This algorithm supports two optional parameters "len" and
Marek Majkowski9c30fc12008-04-27 23:25:55 +02003923 "depth", both followed by a positive integer number. These
3924 options may be helpful when it is needed to balance servers
3925 based on the beginning of the URI only. The "len" parameter
3926 indicates that the algorithm should only consider that many
3927 characters at the beginning of the URI to compute the hash.
3928 Note that having "len" set to 1 rarely makes sense since most
3929 URIs start with a leading "/".
3930
3931 The "depth" parameter indicates the maximum directory depth
3932 to be used to compute the hash. One level is counted for each
3933 slash in the request. If both parameters are specified, the
3934 evaluation stops when either is reached.
3935
Willy Tarreau57a37412020-09-23 08:56:29 +02003936 A "path-only" parameter indicates that the hashing key starts
3937 at the first '/' of the path. This can be used to ignore the
3938 authority part of absolute URIs, and to make sure that HTTP/1
3939 and HTTP/2 URIs will provide the same hash.
3940
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003941 url_param The URL parameter specified in argument will be looked up in
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02003942 the query string of each HTTP GET request.
3943
3944 If the modifier "check_post" is used, then an HTTP POST
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02003945 request entity will be searched for the parameter argument,
3946 when it is not found in a query string after a question mark
Willy Tarreau226071e2014-04-10 11:55:45 +02003947 ('?') in the URL. The message body will only start to be
3948 analyzed once either the advertised amount of data has been
3949 received or the request buffer is full. In the unlikely event
3950 that chunked encoding is used, only the first chunk is
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02003951 scanned. Parameter values separated by a chunk boundary, may
Willy Tarreau226071e2014-04-10 11:55:45 +02003952 be randomly balanced if at all. This keyword used to support
3953 an optional <max_wait> parameter which is now ignored.
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02003954
3955 If the parameter is found followed by an equal sign ('=') and
3956 a value, then the value is hashed and divided by the total
3957 weight of the running servers. The result designates which
3958 server will receive the request.
3959
3960 This is used to track user identifiers in requests and ensure
3961 that a same user ID will always be sent to the same server as
3962 long as no server goes up or down. If no value is found or if
3963 the parameter is not found, then a round robin algorithm is
3964 applied. Note that this algorithm may only be used in an HTTP
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02003965 backend. This algorithm is static by default, which means
3966 that changing a server's weight on the fly will have no
3967 effect, but this can be changed using "hash-type".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003968
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02003969 hdr(<name>) The HTTP header <name> will be looked up in each HTTP
3970 request. Just as with the equivalent ACL 'hdr()' function,
3971 the header name in parenthesis is not case sensitive. If the
3972 header is absent or if it does not contain any value, the
3973 roundrobin algorithm is applied instead.
Benoitaffb4812009-03-25 13:02:10 +01003974
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01003975 An optional 'use_domain_only' parameter is available, for
Benoitaffb4812009-03-25 13:02:10 +01003976 reducing the hash algorithm to the main domain part with some
3977 specific headers such as 'Host'. For instance, in the Host
3978 value "haproxy.1wt.eu", only "1wt" will be considered.
3979
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02003980 This algorithm is static by default, which means that
3981 changing a server's weight on the fly will have no effect,
3982 but this can be changed using "hash-type".
3983
Willy Tarreau21c741a2019-01-14 18:14:27 +01003984 random
3985 random(<draws>)
3986 A random number will be used as the key for the consistent
Willy Tarreau760e81d2018-05-03 07:20:40 +02003987 hashing function. This means that the servers' weights are
3988 respected, dynamic weight changes immediately take effect, as
3989 well as new server additions. Random load balancing can be
3990 useful with large farms or when servers are frequently added
Willy Tarreau21c741a2019-01-14 18:14:27 +01003991 or removed as it may avoid the hammering effect that could
3992 result from roundrobin or leastconn in this situation. The
3993 hash-balance-factor directive can be used to further improve
3994 fairness of the load balancing, especially in situations
3995 where servers show highly variable response times. When an
3996 argument <draws> is present, it must be an integer value one
3997 or greater, indicating the number of draws before selecting
3998 the least loaded of these servers. It was indeed demonstrated
3999 that picking the least loaded of two servers is enough to
4000 significantly improve the fairness of the algorithm, by
4001 always avoiding to pick the most loaded server within a farm
4002 and getting rid of any bias that could be induced by the
4003 unfair distribution of the consistent list. Higher values N
4004 will take away N-1 of the highest loaded servers at the
4005 expense of performance. With very high values, the algorithm
4006 will converge towards the leastconn's result but much slower.
4007 The default value is 2, which generally shows very good
4008 distribution and performance. This algorithm is also known as
4009 the Power of Two Random Choices and is described here :
4010 http://www.eecs.harvard.edu/~michaelm/postscripts/handbook2001.pdf
Willy Tarreau760e81d2018-05-03 07:20:40 +02004011
Emeric Brun736aa232009-06-30 17:56:00 +02004012 rdp-cookie
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02004013 rdp-cookie(<name>)
Emeric Brun736aa232009-06-30 17:56:00 +02004014 The RDP cookie <name> (or "mstshash" if omitted) will be
4015 looked up and hashed for each incoming TCP request. Just as
Christian Ruppertfd3184c2022-02-20 22:54:01 +01004016 with the equivalent ACL 'req.rdp_cookie()' function, the name
Emeric Brun736aa232009-06-30 17:56:00 +02004017 is not case-sensitive. This mechanism is useful as a degraded
4018 persistence mode, as it makes it possible to always send the
4019 same user (or the same session ID) to the same server. If the
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01004020 cookie is not found, the normal roundrobin algorithm is
Emeric Brun736aa232009-06-30 17:56:00 +02004021 used instead.
4022
4023 Note that for this to work, the frontend must ensure that an
4024 RDP cookie is already present in the request buffer. For this
4025 you must use 'tcp-request content accept' rule combined with
Christian Ruppertfd3184c2022-02-20 22:54:01 +01004026 a 'req.rdp_cookie_cnt' ACL.
Emeric Brun736aa232009-06-30 17:56:00 +02004027
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02004028 This algorithm is static by default, which means that
4029 changing a server's weight on the fly will have no effect,
4030 but this can be changed using "hash-type".
4031
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004032 <arguments> is an optional list of arguments which may be needed by some
Marek Majkowski9c30fc12008-04-27 23:25:55 +02004033 algorithms. Right now, only "url_param" and "uri" support an
4034 optional argument.
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02004035
Willy Tarreau3cd9af22009-03-15 14:06:41 +01004036 The load balancing algorithm of a backend is set to roundrobin when no other
4037 algorithm, mode nor option have been set. The algorithm may only be set once
4038 for each backend.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004039
Lukas Tribus80512b12018-10-27 20:07:40 +02004040 With authentication schemes that require the same connection like NTLM, URI
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -05004041 based algorithms must not be used, as they would cause subsequent requests
Lukas Tribus80512b12018-10-27 20:07:40 +02004042 to be routed to different backend servers, breaking the invalid assumptions
4043 NTLM relies on.
4044
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004045 Examples :
4046 balance roundrobin
4047 balance url_param userid
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02004048 balance url_param session_id check_post 64
Benoitaffb4812009-03-25 13:02:10 +01004049 balance hdr(User-Agent)
4050 balance hdr(host)
4051 balance hdr(Host) use_domain_only
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02004052
4053 Note: the following caveats and limitations on using the "check_post"
4054 extension with "url_param" must be considered :
4055
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01004056 - all POST requests are eligible for consideration, because there is no way
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02004057 to determine if the parameters will be found in the body or entity which
4058 may contain binary data. Therefore another method may be required to
4059 restrict consideration of POST requests that have no URL parameters in
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +02004060 the body. (see acl http_end)
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02004061
4062 - using a <max_wait> value larger than the request buffer size does not
4063 make sense and is useless. The buffer size is set at build time, and
4064 defaults to 16 kB.
4065
4066 - Content-Encoding is not supported, the parameter search will probably
4067 fail; and load balancing will fall back to Round Robin.
4068
4069 - Expect: 100-continue is not supported, load balancing will fall back to
4070 Round Robin.
4071
Lukas Tribus23953682017-04-28 13:24:30 +00004072 - Transfer-Encoding (RFC7230 3.3.1) is only supported in the first chunk.
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02004073 If the entire parameter value is not present in the first chunk, the
4074 selection of server is undefined (actually, defined by how little
4075 actually appeared in the first chunk).
4076
4077 - This feature does not support generation of a 100, 411 or 501 response.
4078
4079 - In some cases, requesting "check_post" MAY attempt to scan the entire
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01004080 contents of a message body. Scanning normally terminates when linear
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02004081 white space or control characters are found, indicating the end of what
4082 might be a URL parameter list. This is probably not a concern with SGML
4083 type message bodies.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004084
Willy Tarreau294d0f02015-08-10 19:40:12 +02004085 See also : "dispatch", "cookie", "transparent", "hash-type" and "http_proxy".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004086
4087
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02004088bind [<address>]:<port_range> [, ...] [param*]
4089bind /<path> [, ...] [param*]
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004090 Define one or several listening addresses and/or ports in a frontend.
4091 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4092 no | yes | yes | no
4093 Arguments :
Willy Tarreaub1e52e82008-01-13 14:49:51 +01004094 <address> is optional and can be a host name, an IPv4 address, an IPv6
4095 address, or '*'. It designates the address the frontend will
4096 listen on. If unset, all IPv4 addresses of the system will be
4097 listened on. The same will apply for '*' or the system's
David du Colombier9c938da2011-03-17 10:40:27 +01004098 special address "0.0.0.0". The IPv6 equivalent is '::'.
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +01004099 Optionally, an address family prefix may be used before the
4100 address to force the family regardless of the address format,
4101 which can be useful to specify a path to a unix socket with
4102 no slash ('/'). Currently supported prefixes are :
4103 - 'ipv4@' -> address is always IPv4
4104 - 'ipv6@' -> address is always IPv6
Emeric Brun3835c0d2020-07-07 09:46:09 +02004105 - 'udp@' -> address is resolved as IPv4 or IPv6 and
Emeric Brun12941c82020-07-07 14:19:42 +02004106 protocol UDP is used. Currently those listeners are
4107 supported only in log-forward sections.
Emeric Brun3835c0d2020-07-07 09:46:09 +02004108 - 'udp4@' -> address is always IPv4 and protocol UDP
Emeric Brun12941c82020-07-07 14:19:42 +02004109 is used. Currently those listeners are supported
4110 only in log-forward sections.
Emeric Brun3835c0d2020-07-07 09:46:09 +02004111 - 'udp6@' -> address is always IPv6 and protocol UDP
Emeric Brun12941c82020-07-07 14:19:42 +02004112 is used. Currently those listeners are supported
4113 only in log-forward sections.
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +01004114 - 'unix@' -> address is a path to a local unix socket
Willy Tarreau70f72e02014-07-08 00:37:50 +02004115 - 'abns@' -> address is in abstract namespace (Linux only).
4116 Note: since abstract sockets are not "rebindable", they
4117 do not cope well with multi-process mode during
4118 soft-restart, so it is better to avoid them if
4119 nbproc is greater than 1. The effect is that if the
4120 new process fails to start, only one of the old ones
4121 will be able to rebind to the socket.
Willy Tarreau40aa0702013-03-10 23:51:38 +01004122 - 'fd@<n>' -> use file descriptor <n> inherited from the
4123 parent. The fd must be bound and may or may not already
4124 be listening.
William Lallemand2fe7dd02018-09-11 16:51:29 +02004125 - 'sockpair@<n>'-> like fd@ but you must use the fd of a
4126 connected unix socket or of a socketpair. The bind waits
4127 to receive a FD over the unix socket and uses it as if it
4128 was the FD of an accept(). Should be used carefully.
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +02004129 You may want to reference some environment variables in the
4130 address parameter, see section 2.3 about environment
4131 variables.
Willy Tarreaub1e52e82008-01-13 14:49:51 +01004132
Willy Tarreauc5011ca2010-03-22 11:53:56 +01004133 <port_range> is either a unique TCP port, or a port range for which the
4134 proxy will accept connections for the IP address specified
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01004135 above. The port is mandatory for TCP listeners. Note that in
4136 the case of an IPv6 address, the port is always the number
4137 after the last colon (':'). A range can either be :
Willy Tarreauc5011ca2010-03-22 11:53:56 +01004138 - a numerical port (ex: '80')
4139 - a dash-delimited ports range explicitly stating the lower
4140 and upper bounds (ex: '2000-2100') which are included in
4141 the range.
4142
4143 Particular care must be taken against port ranges, because
4144 every <address:port> couple consumes one socket (= a file
4145 descriptor), so it's easy to consume lots of descriptors
4146 with a simple range, and to run out of sockets. Also, each
4147 <address:port> couple must be used only once among all
4148 instances running on a same system. Please note that binding
4149 to ports lower than 1024 generally require particular
Jamie Gloudon801a0a32012-08-25 00:18:33 -04004150 privileges to start the program, which are independent of
Willy Tarreauc5011ca2010-03-22 11:53:56 +01004151 the 'uid' parameter.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004152
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01004153 <path> is a UNIX socket path beginning with a slash ('/'). This is
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01004154 alternative to the TCP listening port. HAProxy will then
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01004155 receive UNIX connections on the socket located at this place.
4156 The path must begin with a slash and by default is absolute.
4157 It can be relative to the prefix defined by "unix-bind" in
4158 the global section. Note that the total length of the prefix
4159 followed by the socket path cannot exceed some system limits
4160 for UNIX sockets, which commonly are set to 107 characters.
4161
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02004162 <param*> is a list of parameters common to all sockets declared on the
4163 same line. These numerous parameters depend on OS and build
4164 options and have a complete section dedicated to them. Please
4165 refer to section 5 to for more details.
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +02004166
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004167 It is possible to specify a list of address:port combinations delimited by
4168 commas. The frontend will then listen on all of these addresses. There is no
4169 fixed limit to the number of addresses and ports which can be listened on in
4170 a frontend, as well as there is no limit to the number of "bind" statements
4171 in a frontend.
4172
4173 Example :
4174 listen http_proxy
4175 bind :80,:443
4176 bind 10.0.0.1:10080,10.0.0.1:10443
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01004177 bind /var/run/ssl-frontend.sock user root mode 600 accept-proxy
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004178
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +02004179 listen http_https_proxy
4180 bind :80
Cyril Bonté0d44fc62012-10-09 22:45:33 +02004181 bind :443 ssl crt /etc/haproxy/site.pem
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +02004182
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +01004183 listen http_https_proxy_explicit
4184 bind ipv6@:80
4185 bind ipv4@public_ssl:443 ssl crt /etc/haproxy/site.pem
4186 bind unix@ssl-frontend.sock user root mode 600 accept-proxy
4187
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01004188 listen external_bind_app1
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +02004189 bind "fd@${FD_APP1}"
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01004190
Willy Tarreau55dcaf62015-09-27 15:03:15 +02004191 Note: regarding Linux's abstract namespace sockets, HAProxy uses the whole
4192 sun_path length is used for the address length. Some other programs
4193 such as socat use the string length only by default. Pass the option
4194 ",unix-tightsocklen=0" to any abstract socket definition in socat to
4195 make it compatible with HAProxy's.
4196
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01004197 See also : "source", "option forwardfor", "unix-bind" and the PROXY protocol
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02004198 documentation, and section 5 about bind options.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004199
4200
Christopher Fauletff4121f2017-11-22 16:38:49 +01004201bind-process [ all | odd | even | <process_num>[-[<process_num>]] ] ...
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01004202 Limit visibility of an instance to a certain set of processes numbers.
4203 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4204 yes | yes | yes | yes
4205 Arguments :
4206 all All process will see this instance. This is the default. It
4207 may be used to override a default value.
4208
Willy Tarreaua9db57e2013-01-18 11:29:29 +01004209 odd This instance will be enabled on processes 1,3,5,...63. This
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01004210 option may be combined with other numbers.
4211
Willy Tarreaua9db57e2013-01-18 11:29:29 +01004212 even This instance will be enabled on processes 2,4,6,...64. This
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01004213 option may be combined with other numbers. Do not use it
4214 with less than 2 processes otherwise some instances might be
4215 missing from all processes.
4216
Christopher Fauletff4121f2017-11-22 16:38:49 +01004217 process_num The instance will be enabled on this process number or range,
Willy Tarreaua9db57e2013-01-18 11:29:29 +01004218 whose values must all be between 1 and 32 or 64 depending on
Christopher Fauletff4121f2017-11-22 16:38:49 +01004219 the machine's word size. Ranges can be partially defined. The
4220 higher bound can be omitted. In such case, it is replaced by
4221 the corresponding maximum value. If a proxy is bound to
4222 process numbers greater than the configured global.nbproc, it
4223 will either be forced to process #1 if a single process was
Willy Tarreau102df612014-05-07 23:56:38 +02004224 specified, or to all processes otherwise.
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01004225
4226 This keyword limits binding of certain instances to certain processes. This
4227 is useful in order not to have too many processes listening to the same
4228 ports. For instance, on a dual-core machine, it might make sense to set
4229 'nbproc 2' in the global section, then distributes the listeners among 'odd'
4230 and 'even' instances.
4231
Willy Tarreaua9db57e2013-01-18 11:29:29 +01004232 At the moment, it is not possible to reference more than 32 or 64 processes
4233 using this keyword, but this should be more than enough for most setups.
4234 Please note that 'all' really means all processes regardless of the machine's
4235 word size, and is not limited to the first 32 or 64.
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01004236
Willy Tarreau6ae1ba62014-05-07 19:01:58 +02004237 Each "bind" line may further be limited to a subset of the proxy's processes,
4238 please consult the "process" bind keyword in section 5.1.
4239
Willy Tarreaub369a042014-09-16 13:21:03 +02004240 When a frontend has no explicit "bind-process" line, it tries to bind to all
4241 the processes referenced by its "bind" lines. That means that frontends can
4242 easily adapt to their listeners' processes.
4243
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01004244 If some backends are referenced by frontends bound to other processes, the
4245 backend automatically inherits the frontend's processes.
4246
4247 Example :
4248 listen app_ip1
4249 bind 10.0.0.1:80
Willy Tarreaubfcd3112010-10-23 11:22:08 +02004250 bind-process odd
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01004251
4252 listen app_ip2
4253 bind 10.0.0.2:80
Willy Tarreaubfcd3112010-10-23 11:22:08 +02004254 bind-process even
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01004255
4256 listen management
4257 bind 10.0.0.3:80
Willy Tarreaubfcd3112010-10-23 11:22:08 +02004258 bind-process 1 2 3 4
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01004259
Willy Tarreau110ecc12012-11-15 17:50:01 +01004260 listen management
4261 bind 10.0.0.4:80
4262 bind-process 1-4
4263
Willy Tarreau6ae1ba62014-05-07 19:01:58 +02004264 See also : "nbproc" in global section, and "process" in section 5.1.
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01004265
4266
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004267capture cookie <name> len <length>
4268 Capture and log a cookie in the request and in the response.
4269 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4270 no | yes | yes | no
4271 Arguments :
4272 <name> is the beginning of the name of the cookie to capture. In order
4273 to match the exact name, simply suffix the name with an equal
4274 sign ('='). The full name will appear in the logs, which is
4275 useful with application servers which adjust both the cookie name
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01004276 and value (e.g. ASPSESSIONXXX).
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004277
4278 <length> is the maximum number of characters to report in the logs, which
4279 include the cookie name, the equal sign and the value, all in the
4280 standard "name=value" form. The string will be truncated on the
4281 right if it exceeds <length>.
4282
4283 Only the first cookie is captured. Both the "cookie" request headers and the
4284 "set-cookie" response headers are monitored. This is particularly useful to
4285 check for application bugs causing session crossing or stealing between
4286 users, because generally the user's cookies can only change on a login page.
4287
4288 When the cookie was not presented by the client, the associated log column
4289 will report "-". When a request does not cause a cookie to be assigned by the
4290 server, a "-" is reported in the response column.
4291
4292 The capture is performed in the frontend only because it is necessary that
4293 the log format does not change for a given frontend depending on the
4294 backends. This may change in the future. Note that there can be only one
Willy Tarreau193b8c62012-11-22 00:17:38 +01004295 "capture cookie" statement in a frontend. The maximum capture length is set
4296 by the global "tune.http.cookielen" setting and defaults to 63 characters. It
4297 is not possible to specify a capture in a "defaults" section.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004298
4299 Example:
4300 capture cookie ASPSESSION len 32
4301
4302 See also : "capture request header", "capture response header" as well as
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02004303 section 8 about logging.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004304
4305
4306capture request header <name> len <length>
Willy Tarreau4460d032012-11-21 23:37:37 +01004307 Capture and log the last occurrence of the specified request header.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004308 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4309 no | yes | yes | no
4310 Arguments :
4311 <name> is the name of the header to capture. The header names are not
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01004312 case-sensitive, but it is a common practice to write them as they
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004313 appear in the requests, with the first letter of each word in
4314 upper case. The header name will not appear in the logs, only the
4315 value is reported, but the position in the logs is respected.
4316
4317 <length> is the maximum number of characters to extract from the value and
4318 report in the logs. The string will be truncated on the right if
4319 it exceeds <length>.
4320
Willy Tarreau4460d032012-11-21 23:37:37 +01004321 The complete value of the last occurrence of the header is captured. The
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004322 value will be added to the logs between braces ('{}'). If multiple headers
4323 are captured, they will be delimited by a vertical bar ('|') and will appear
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01004324 in the same order they were declared in the configuration. Non-existent
4325 headers will be logged just as an empty string. Common uses for request
4326 header captures include the "Host" field in virtual hosting environments, the
4327 "Content-length" when uploads are supported, "User-agent" to quickly
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01004328 differentiate between real users and robots, and "X-Forwarded-For" in proxied
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01004329 environments to find where the request came from.
4330
4331 Note that when capturing headers such as "User-agent", some spaces may be
4332 logged, making the log analysis more difficult. Thus be careful about what
4333 you log if you know your log parser is not smart enough to rely on the
4334 braces.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004335
Willy Tarreau0900abb2012-11-22 00:21:46 +01004336 There is no limit to the number of captured request headers nor to their
4337 length, though it is wise to keep them low to limit memory usage per session.
4338 In order to keep log format consistent for a same frontend, header captures
4339 can only be declared in a frontend. It is not possible to specify a capture
4340 in a "defaults" section.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004341
4342 Example:
4343 capture request header Host len 15
4344 capture request header X-Forwarded-For len 15
Cyril Bontéd1b0f7c2015-10-26 22:37:39 +01004345 capture request header Referer len 15
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004346
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02004347 See also : "capture cookie", "capture response header" as well as section 8
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004348 about logging.
4349
4350
4351capture response header <name> len <length>
Willy Tarreau4460d032012-11-21 23:37:37 +01004352 Capture and log the last occurrence of the specified response header.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004353 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4354 no | yes | yes | no
4355 Arguments :
4356 <name> is the name of the header to capture. The header names are not
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01004357 case-sensitive, but it is a common practice to write them as they
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004358 appear in the response, with the first letter of each word in
4359 upper case. The header name will not appear in the logs, only the
4360 value is reported, but the position in the logs is respected.
4361
4362 <length> is the maximum number of characters to extract from the value and
4363 report in the logs. The string will be truncated on the right if
4364 it exceeds <length>.
4365
Willy Tarreau4460d032012-11-21 23:37:37 +01004366 The complete value of the last occurrence of the header is captured. The
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004367 result will be added to the logs between braces ('{}') after the captured
4368 request headers. If multiple headers are captured, they will be delimited by
4369 a vertical bar ('|') and will appear in the same order they were declared in
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01004370 the configuration. Non-existent headers will be logged just as an empty
4371 string. Common uses for response header captures include the "Content-length"
4372 header which indicates how many bytes are expected to be returned, the
4373 "Location" header to track redirections.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004374
Willy Tarreau0900abb2012-11-22 00:21:46 +01004375 There is no limit to the number of captured response headers nor to their
4376 length, though it is wise to keep them low to limit memory usage per session.
4377 In order to keep log format consistent for a same frontend, header captures
4378 can only be declared in a frontend. It is not possible to specify a capture
4379 in a "defaults" section.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004380
4381 Example:
4382 capture response header Content-length len 9
4383 capture response header Location len 15
4384
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02004385 See also : "capture cookie", "capture request header" as well as section 8
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004386 about logging.
4387
4388
MIZUTA Takeshib24bc0d2020-07-09 11:13:20 +09004389clitcpka-cnt <count>
4390 Sets the maximum number of keepalive probes TCP should send before dropping
4391 the connection on the client side.
4392 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4393 yes | yes | yes | no
4394 Arguments :
4395 <count> is the maximum number of keepalive probes.
4396
4397 This keyword corresponds to the socket option TCP_KEEPCNT. If this keyword
4398 is not specified, system-wide TCP parameter (tcp_keepalive_probes) is used.
Willy Tarreau52543212020-07-09 05:58:51 +02004399 The availability of this setting depends on the operating system. It is
4400 known to work on Linux.
MIZUTA Takeshib24bc0d2020-07-09 11:13:20 +09004401
4402 See also : "option clitcpka", "clitcpka-idle", "clitcpka-intvl".
4403
4404
4405clitcpka-idle <timeout>
4406 Sets the time the connection needs to remain idle before TCP starts sending
4407 keepalive probes, if enabled the sending of TCP keepalive packets on the
4408 client side.
4409 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4410 yes | yes | yes | no
4411 Arguments :
4412 <timeout> is the time the connection needs to remain idle before TCP starts
4413 sending keepalive probes. It is specified in seconds by default,
4414 but can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the
4415 unit, as explained at the top of this document.
4416
4417 This keyword corresponds to the socket option TCP_KEEPIDLE. If this keyword
4418 is not specified, system-wide TCP parameter (tcp_keepalive_time) is used.
Willy Tarreau52543212020-07-09 05:58:51 +02004419 The availability of this setting depends on the operating system. It is
4420 known to work on Linux.
MIZUTA Takeshib24bc0d2020-07-09 11:13:20 +09004421
4422 See also : "option clitcpka", "clitcpka-cnt", "clitcpka-intvl".
4423
4424
4425clitcpka-intvl <timeout>
4426 Sets the time between individual keepalive probes on the client side.
4427 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4428 yes | yes | yes | no
4429 Arguments :
4430 <timeout> is the time between individual keepalive probes. It is specified
4431 in seconds by default, but can be in any other unit if the number
4432 is suffixed by the unit, as explained at the top of this
4433 document.
4434
4435 This keyword corresponds to the socket option TCP_KEEPINTVL. If this keyword
4436 is not specified, system-wide TCP parameter (tcp_keepalive_intvl) is used.
Willy Tarreau52543212020-07-09 05:58:51 +02004437 The availability of this setting depends on the operating system. It is
4438 known to work on Linux.
MIZUTA Takeshib24bc0d2020-07-09 11:13:20 +09004439
4440 See also : "option clitcpka", "clitcpka-cnt", "clitcpka-idle".
4441
4442
Cyril Bonté316a8cf2012-11-11 13:38:27 +01004443compression algo <algorithm> ...
4444compression type <mime type> ...
Willy Tarreau70737d12012-10-27 00:34:28 +02004445compression offload
William Lallemand82fe75c2012-10-23 10:25:10 +02004446 Enable HTTP compression.
4447 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4448 yes | yes | yes | yes
4449 Arguments :
Cyril Bonté316a8cf2012-11-11 13:38:27 +01004450 algo is followed by the list of supported compression algorithms.
4451 type is followed by the list of MIME types that will be compressed.
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04004452 offload makes HAProxy work as a compression offloader only (see notes).
Cyril Bonté316a8cf2012-11-11 13:38:27 +01004453
4454 The currently supported algorithms are :
Willy Tarreauc91840a2015-03-28 17:00:39 +01004455 identity this is mostly for debugging, and it was useful for developing
4456 the compression feature. Identity does not apply any change on
4457 data.
Cyril Bonté316a8cf2012-11-11 13:38:27 +01004458
Willy Tarreauc91840a2015-03-28 17:00:39 +01004459 gzip applies gzip compression. This setting is only available when
Baptiste Assmannf085d632015-12-21 17:57:32 +01004460 support for zlib or libslz was built in.
Willy Tarreauc91840a2015-03-28 17:00:39 +01004461
4462 deflate same as "gzip", but with deflate algorithm and zlib format.
4463 Note that this algorithm has ambiguous support on many
4464 browsers and no support at all from recent ones. It is
4465 strongly recommended not to use it for anything else than
4466 experimentation. This setting is only available when support
Baptiste Assmannf085d632015-12-21 17:57:32 +01004467 for zlib or libslz was built in.
Cyril Bonté316a8cf2012-11-11 13:38:27 +01004468
Willy Tarreauc91840a2015-03-28 17:00:39 +01004469 raw-deflate same as "deflate" without the zlib wrapper, and used as an
4470 alternative when the browser wants "deflate". All major
4471 browsers understand it and despite violating the standards,
4472 it is known to work better than "deflate", at least on MSIE
4473 and some versions of Safari. Do not use it in conjunction
4474 with "deflate", use either one or the other since both react
4475 to the same Accept-Encoding token. This setting is only
Baptiste Assmannf085d632015-12-21 17:57:32 +01004476 available when support for zlib or libslz was built in.
Cyril Bonté316a8cf2012-11-11 13:38:27 +01004477
Dmitry Sivachenko87c208b2012-11-22 20:03:26 +04004478 Compression will be activated depending on the Accept-Encoding request
Cyril Bonté316a8cf2012-11-11 13:38:27 +01004479 header. With identity, it does not take care of that header.
Dmitry Sivachenkoc9f3b452012-11-28 17:47:11 +04004480 If backend servers support HTTP compression, these directives
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04004481 will be no-op: HAProxy will see the compressed response and will not
Dmitry Sivachenkoc9f3b452012-11-28 17:47:11 +04004482 compress again. If backend servers do not support HTTP compression and
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04004483 there is Accept-Encoding header in request, HAProxy will compress the
Dmitry Sivachenkoc9f3b452012-11-28 17:47:11 +04004484 matching response.
Willy Tarreau70737d12012-10-27 00:34:28 +02004485
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04004486 The "offload" setting makes HAProxy remove the Accept-Encoding header to
Willy Tarreau70737d12012-10-27 00:34:28 +02004487 prevent backend servers from compressing responses. It is strongly
4488 recommended not to do this because this means that all the compression work
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04004489 will be done on the single point where HAProxy is located. However in some
4490 deployment scenarios, HAProxy may be installed in front of a buggy gateway
Dmitry Sivachenkoc9f3b452012-11-28 17:47:11 +04004491 with broken HTTP compression implementation which can't be turned off.
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04004492 In that case HAProxy can be used to prevent that gateway from emitting
Dmitry Sivachenkoc9f3b452012-11-28 17:47:11 +04004493 invalid payloads. In this case, simply removing the header in the
4494 configuration does not work because it applies before the header is parsed,
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04004495 so that prevents HAProxy from compressing. The "offload" setting should
Willy Tarreauffea9fd2014-07-12 16:37:02 +02004496 then be used for such scenarios. Note: for now, the "offload" setting is
4497 ignored when set in a defaults section.
William Lallemand82fe75c2012-10-23 10:25:10 +02004498
William Lallemand05097442012-11-20 12:14:28 +01004499 Compression is disabled when:
Baptiste Assmann650d53d2013-01-05 15:44:44 +01004500 * the request does not advertise a supported compression algorithm in the
4501 "Accept-Encoding" header
Julien Pivottoff80c822021-03-29 12:41:40 +02004502 * the response message is not HTTP/1.1 or above
Tim Duesterhusbb48c9a2019-01-30 23:46:04 +01004503 * HTTP status code is not one of 200, 201, 202, or 203
Baptiste Assmann650d53d2013-01-05 15:44:44 +01004504 * response contain neither a "Content-Length" header nor a
4505 "Transfer-Encoding" whose last value is "chunked"
4506 * response contains a "Content-Type" header whose first value starts with
4507 "multipart"
4508 * the response contains the "no-transform" value in the "Cache-control"
4509 header
4510 * User-Agent matches "Mozilla/4" unless it is MSIE 6 with XP SP2, or MSIE 7
4511 and later
4512 * The response contains a "Content-Encoding" header, indicating that the
4513 response is already compressed (see compression offload)
Tim Duesterhusbb48c9a2019-01-30 23:46:04 +01004514 * The response contains an invalid "ETag" header or multiple ETag headers
William Lallemand05097442012-11-20 12:14:28 +01004515
Tim Duesterhusb229f012019-01-29 16:38:56 +01004516 Note: The compression does not emit the Warning header.
William Lallemand05097442012-11-20 12:14:28 +01004517
William Lallemand82fe75c2012-10-23 10:25:10 +02004518 Examples :
4519 compression algo gzip
4520 compression type text/html text/plain
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004521
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +02004522
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02004523cookie <name> [ rewrite | insert | prefix ] [ indirect ] [ nocache ]
Willy Tarreau4992dd22012-05-31 21:02:17 +02004524 [ postonly ] [ preserve ] [ httponly ] [ secure ]
4525 [ domain <domain> ]* [ maxidle <idle> ] [ maxlife <life> ]
Christopher Faulet2f533902020-01-21 11:06:48 +01004526 [ dynamic ] [ attr <value> ]*
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004527 Enable cookie-based persistence in a backend.
4528 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4529 yes | no | yes | yes
4530 Arguments :
4531 <name> is the name of the cookie which will be monitored, modified or
4532 inserted in order to bring persistence. This cookie is sent to
4533 the client via a "Set-Cookie" header in the response, and is
4534 brought back by the client in a "Cookie" header in all requests.
4535 Special care should be taken to choose a name which does not
4536 conflict with any likely application cookie. Also, if the same
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01004537 backends are subject to be used by the same clients (e.g.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004538 HTTP/HTTPS), care should be taken to use different cookie names
4539 between all backends if persistence between them is not desired.
4540
4541 rewrite This keyword indicates that the cookie will be provided by the
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04004542 server and that HAProxy will have to modify its value to set the
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004543 server's identifier in it. This mode is handy when the management
4544 of complex combinations of "Set-cookie" and "Cache-control"
4545 headers is left to the application. The application can then
4546 decide whether or not it is appropriate to emit a persistence
Lukas Tribusf01a9cd2016-02-03 18:09:37 +01004547 cookie. Since all responses should be monitored, this mode
4548 doesn't work in HTTP tunnel mode. Unless the application
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01004549 behavior is very complex and/or broken, it is advised not to
Lukas Tribusf01a9cd2016-02-03 18:09:37 +01004550 start with this mode for new deployments. This keyword is
4551 incompatible with "insert" and "prefix".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004552
4553 insert This keyword indicates that the persistence cookie will have to
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04004554 be inserted by HAProxy in server responses if the client did not
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02004555
Willy Tarreaua79094d2010-08-31 22:54:15 +02004556 already have a cookie that would have permitted it to access this
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02004557 server. When used without the "preserve" option, if the server
Michael Prokop4438c602019-05-24 10:25:45 +02004558 emits a cookie with the same name, it will be removed before
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01004559 processing. For this reason, this mode can be used to upgrade
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02004560 existing configurations running in the "rewrite" mode. The cookie
4561 will only be a session cookie and will not be stored on the
4562 client's disk. By default, unless the "indirect" option is added,
4563 the server will see the cookies emitted by the client. Due to
4564 caching effects, it is generally wise to add the "nocache" or
4565 "postonly" keywords (see below). The "insert" keyword is not
4566 compatible with "rewrite" and "prefix".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004567
4568 prefix This keyword indicates that instead of relying on a dedicated
4569 cookie for the persistence, an existing one will be completed.
4570 This may be needed in some specific environments where the client
4571 does not support more than one single cookie and the application
4572 already needs it. In this case, whenever the server sets a cookie
4573 named <name>, it will be prefixed with the server's identifier
4574 and a delimiter. The prefix will be removed from all client
4575 requests so that the server still finds the cookie it emitted.
4576 Since all requests and responses are subject to being modified,
Lukas Tribusf01a9cd2016-02-03 18:09:37 +01004577 this mode doesn't work with tunnel mode. The "prefix" keyword is
Willy Tarreau37229df2011-10-17 12:24:55 +02004578 not compatible with "rewrite" and "insert". Note: it is highly
4579 recommended not to use "indirect" with "prefix", otherwise server
4580 cookie updates would not be sent to clients.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004581
Willy Tarreaua79094d2010-08-31 22:54:15 +02004582 indirect When this option is specified, no cookie will be emitted to a
4583 client which already has a valid one for the server which has
4584 processed the request. If the server sets such a cookie itself,
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02004585 it will be removed, unless the "preserve" option is also set. In
4586 "insert" mode, this will additionally remove cookies from the
4587 requests transmitted to the server, making the persistence
4588 mechanism totally transparent from an application point of view.
Willy Tarreau37229df2011-10-17 12:24:55 +02004589 Note: it is highly recommended not to use "indirect" with
4590 "prefix", otherwise server cookie updates would not be sent to
4591 clients.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004592
4593 nocache This option is recommended in conjunction with the insert mode
4594 when there is a cache between the client and HAProxy, as it
4595 ensures that a cacheable response will be tagged non-cacheable if
4596 a cookie needs to be inserted. This is important because if all
4597 persistence cookies are added on a cacheable home page for
4598 instance, then all customers will then fetch the page from an
4599 outer cache and will all share the same persistence cookie,
4600 leading to one server receiving much more traffic than others.
4601 See also the "insert" and "postonly" options.
4602
4603 postonly This option ensures that cookie insertion will only be performed
4604 on responses to POST requests. It is an alternative to the
4605 "nocache" option, because POST responses are not cacheable, so
4606 this ensures that the persistence cookie will never get cached.
4607 Since most sites do not need any sort of persistence before the
4608 first POST which generally is a login request, this is a very
4609 efficient method to optimize caching without risking to find a
4610 persistence cookie in the cache.
4611 See also the "insert" and "nocache" options.
4612
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02004613 preserve This option may only be used with "insert" and/or "indirect". It
4614 allows the server to emit the persistence cookie itself. In this
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04004615 case, if a cookie is found in the response, HAProxy will leave it
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02004616 untouched. This is useful in order to end persistence after a
4617 logout request for instance. For this, the server just has to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01004618 emit a cookie with an invalid value (e.g. empty) or with a date in
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02004619 the past. By combining this mechanism with the "disable-on-404"
4620 check option, it is possible to perform a completely graceful
4621 shutdown because users will definitely leave the server after
4622 they logout.
4623
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04004624 httponly This option tells HAProxy to add an "HttpOnly" cookie attribute
Willy Tarreau4992dd22012-05-31 21:02:17 +02004625 when a cookie is inserted. This attribute is used so that a
4626 user agent doesn't share the cookie with non-HTTP components.
4627 Please check RFC6265 for more information on this attribute.
4628
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04004629 secure This option tells HAProxy to add a "Secure" cookie attribute when
Willy Tarreau4992dd22012-05-31 21:02:17 +02004630 a cookie is inserted. This attribute is used so that a user agent
4631 never emits this cookie over non-secure channels, which means
4632 that a cookie learned with this flag will be presented only over
4633 SSL/TLS connections. Please check RFC6265 for more information on
4634 this attribute.
4635
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkiefe3b6f2008-05-23 23:49:32 +02004636 domain This option allows to specify the domain at which a cookie is
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01004637 inserted. It requires exactly one parameter: a valid domain
Willy Tarreau68a897b2009-12-03 23:28:34 +01004638 name. If the domain begins with a dot, the browser is allowed to
4639 use it for any host ending with that name. It is also possible to
4640 specify several domain names by invoking this option multiple
4641 times. Some browsers might have small limits on the number of
4642 domains, so be careful when doing that. For the record, sending
4643 10 domains to MSIE 6 or Firefox 2 works as expected.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkiefe3b6f2008-05-23 23:49:32 +02004644
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +02004645 maxidle This option allows inserted cookies to be ignored after some idle
4646 time. It only works with insert-mode cookies. When a cookie is
4647 sent to the client, the date this cookie was emitted is sent too.
4648 Upon further presentations of this cookie, if the date is older
4649 than the delay indicated by the parameter (in seconds), it will
4650 be ignored. Otherwise, it will be refreshed if needed when the
4651 response is sent to the client. This is particularly useful to
4652 prevent users who never close their browsers from remaining for
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01004653 too long on the same server (e.g. after a farm size change). When
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +02004654 this option is set and a cookie has no date, it is always
4655 accepted, but gets refreshed in the response. This maintains the
4656 ability for admins to access their sites. Cookies that have a
4657 date in the future further than 24 hours are ignored. Doing so
4658 lets admins fix timezone issues without risking kicking users off
4659 the site.
4660
4661 maxlife This option allows inserted cookies to be ignored after some life
4662 time, whether they're in use or not. It only works with insert
4663 mode cookies. When a cookie is first sent to the client, the date
4664 this cookie was emitted is sent too. Upon further presentations
4665 of this cookie, if the date is older than the delay indicated by
4666 the parameter (in seconds), it will be ignored. If the cookie in
4667 the request has no date, it is accepted and a date will be set.
4668 Cookies that have a date in the future further than 24 hours are
4669 ignored. Doing so lets admins fix timezone issues without risking
4670 kicking users off the site. Contrary to maxidle, this value is
4671 not refreshed, only the first visit date counts. Both maxidle and
4672 maxlife may be used at the time. This is particularly useful to
4673 prevent users who never close their browsers from remaining for
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01004674 too long on the same server (e.g. after a farm size change). This
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +02004675 is stronger than the maxidle method in that it forces a
4676 redispatch after some absolute delay.
4677
Olivier Houchard4e694042017-03-14 20:01:29 +01004678 dynamic Activate dynamic cookies. When used, a session cookie is
4679 dynamically created for each server, based on the IP and port
4680 of the server, and a secret key, specified in the
4681 "dynamic-cookie-key" backend directive.
4682 The cookie will be regenerated each time the IP address change,
4683 and is only generated for IPv4/IPv6.
4684
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04004685 attr This option tells HAProxy to add an extra attribute when a
Christopher Faulet2f533902020-01-21 11:06:48 +01004686 cookie is inserted. The attribute value can contain any
4687 characters except control ones or ";". This option may be
4688 repeated.
4689
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004690 There can be only one persistence cookie per HTTP backend, and it can be
4691 declared in a defaults section. The value of the cookie will be the value
4692 indicated after the "cookie" keyword in a "server" statement. If no cookie
4693 is declared for a given server, the cookie is not set.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02004694
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004695 Examples :
4696 cookie JSESSIONID prefix
4697 cookie SRV insert indirect nocache
4698 cookie SRV insert postonly indirect
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +02004699 cookie SRV insert indirect nocache maxidle 30m maxlife 8h
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004700
Willy Tarreau294d0f02015-08-10 19:40:12 +02004701 See also : "balance source", "capture cookie", "server" and "ignore-persist".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004702
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +01004703
Thierry FOURNIERa0a1b752015-05-26 17:44:32 +02004704declare capture [ request | response ] len <length>
4705 Declares a capture slot.
4706 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4707 no | yes | yes | no
4708 Arguments:
4709 <length> is the length allowed for the capture.
4710
4711 This declaration is only available in the frontend or listen section, but the
4712 reserved slot can be used in the backends. The "request" keyword allocates a
4713 capture slot for use in the request, and "response" allocates a capture slot
4714 for use in the response.
4715
4716 See also: "capture-req", "capture-res" (sample converters),
Baptiste Assmann5ac425c2015-10-21 23:13:46 +02004717 "capture.req.hdr", "capture.res.hdr" (sample fetches),
Thierry FOURNIERa0a1b752015-05-26 17:44:32 +02004718 "http-request capture" and "http-response capture".
4719
4720
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +01004721default-server [param*]
4722 Change default options for a server in a backend
4723 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4724 yes | no | yes | yes
4725 Arguments:
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +01004726 <param*> is a list of parameters for this server. The "default-server"
4727 keyword accepts an important number of options and has a complete
4728 section dedicated to it. Please refer to section 5 for more
4729 details.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +01004730
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +01004731 Example :
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +01004732 default-server inter 1000 weight 13
4733
4734 See also: "server" and section 5 about server options
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004735
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +01004736
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004737default_backend <backend>
4738 Specify the backend to use when no "use_backend" rule has been matched.
4739 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4740 yes | yes | yes | no
4741 Arguments :
4742 <backend> is the name of the backend to use.
4743
4744 When doing content-switching between frontend and backends using the
4745 "use_backend" keyword, it is often useful to indicate which backend will be
4746 used when no rule has matched. It generally is the dynamic backend which
4747 will catch all undetermined requests.
4748
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004749 Example :
4750
4751 use_backend dynamic if url_dyn
4752 use_backend static if url_css url_img extension_img
4753 default_backend dynamic
4754
Willy Tarreau98d04852015-05-26 12:18:29 +02004755 See also : "use_backend"
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004756
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004757
Baptiste Assmann27f51342013-10-09 06:51:49 +02004758description <string>
4759 Describe a listen, frontend or backend.
4760 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4761 no | yes | yes | yes
4762 Arguments : string
4763
4764 Allows to add a sentence to describe the related object in the HAProxy HTML
4765 stats page. The description will be printed on the right of the object name
4766 it describes.
4767 No need to backslash spaces in the <string> arguments.
4768
4769
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004770disabled
4771 Disable a proxy, frontend or backend.
4772 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4773 yes | yes | yes | yes
4774 Arguments : none
4775
4776 The "disabled" keyword is used to disable an instance, mainly in order to
4777 liberate a listening port or to temporarily disable a service. The instance
4778 will still be created and its configuration will be checked, but it will be
4779 created in the "stopped" state and will appear as such in the statistics. It
4780 will not receive any traffic nor will it send any health-checks or logs. It
4781 is possible to disable many instances at once by adding the "disabled"
4782 keyword in a "defaults" section.
4783
4784 See also : "enabled"
4785
4786
Willy Tarreau5ce94572010-06-07 14:35:41 +02004787dispatch <address>:<port>
4788 Set a default server address
4789 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4790 no | no | yes | yes
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02004791 Arguments :
Willy Tarreau5ce94572010-06-07 14:35:41 +02004792
4793 <address> is the IPv4 address of the default server. Alternatively, a
4794 resolvable hostname is supported, but this name will be resolved
4795 during start-up.
4796
4797 <ports> is a mandatory port specification. All connections will be sent
4798 to this port, and it is not permitted to use port offsets as is
4799 possible with normal servers.
4800
Willy Tarreau787aed52011-04-15 06:45:37 +02004801 The "dispatch" keyword designates a default server for use when no other
Willy Tarreau5ce94572010-06-07 14:35:41 +02004802 server can take the connection. In the past it was used to forward non
4803 persistent connections to an auxiliary load balancer. Due to its simple
4804 syntax, it has also been used for simple TCP relays. It is recommended not to
4805 use it for more clarity, and to use the "server" directive instead.
4806
4807 See also : "server"
4808
Olivier Houchard4e694042017-03-14 20:01:29 +01004809
4810dynamic-cookie-key <string>
4811 Set the dynamic cookie secret key for a backend.
4812 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4813 yes | no | yes | yes
4814 Arguments : The secret key to be used.
4815
4816 When dynamic cookies are enabled (see the "dynamic" directive for cookie),
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01004817 a dynamic cookie is created for each server (unless one is explicitly
Olivier Houchard4e694042017-03-14 20:01:29 +01004818 specified on the "server" line), using a hash of the IP address of the
4819 server, the TCP port, and the secret key.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01004820 That way, we can ensure session persistence across multiple load-balancers,
Olivier Houchard4e694042017-03-14 20:01:29 +01004821 even if servers are dynamically added or removed.
Willy Tarreau5ce94572010-06-07 14:35:41 +02004822
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004823enabled
4824 Enable a proxy, frontend or backend.
4825 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4826 yes | yes | yes | yes
4827 Arguments : none
4828
4829 The "enabled" keyword is used to explicitly enable an instance, when the
4830 defaults has been set to "disabled". This is very rarely used.
4831
4832 See also : "disabled"
4833
4834
4835errorfile <code> <file>
4836 Return a file contents instead of errors generated by HAProxy
4837 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4838 yes | yes | yes | yes
4839 Arguments :
4840 <code> is the HTTP status code. Currently, HAProxy is capable of
Christopher Faulet612f2ea2020-05-27 09:57:28 +02004841 generating codes 200, 400, 401, 403, 404, 405, 407, 408, 410,
Christopher Faulete095f312020-12-07 11:22:24 +01004842 413, 425, 429, 500, 501, 502, 503, and 504.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004843
4844 <file> designates a file containing the full HTTP response. It is
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01004845 recommended to follow the common practice of appending ".http" to
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004846 the filename so that people do not confuse the response with HTML
Willy Tarreau59140a22009-02-22 12:02:30 +01004847 error pages, and to use absolute paths, since files are read
4848 before any chroot is performed.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004849
4850 It is important to understand that this keyword is not meant to rewrite
4851 errors returned by the server, but errors detected and returned by HAProxy.
4852 This is why the list of supported errors is limited to a small set.
4853
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02004854 Code 200 is emitted in response to requests matching a "monitor-uri" rule.
4855
Christopher Faulet70170672020-05-18 17:42:48 +02004856 The files are parsed when HAProxy starts and must be valid according to the
4857 HTTP specification. They should not exceed the configured buffer size
4858 (BUFSIZE), which generally is 16 kB, otherwise an internal error will be
4859 returned. It is also wise not to put any reference to local contents
4860 (e.g. images) in order to avoid loops between the client and HAProxy when all
4861 servers are down, causing an error to be returned instead of an
4862 image. Finally, The response cannot exceed (tune.bufsize - tune.maxrewrite)
4863 so that "http-after-response" rules still have room to operate (see
4864 "tune.maxrewrite").
Willy Tarreau59140a22009-02-22 12:02:30 +01004865
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004866 The files are read at the same time as the configuration and kept in memory.
4867 For this reason, the errors continue to be returned even when the process is
4868 chrooted, and no file change is considered while the process is running. A
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01004869 simple method for developing those files consists in associating them to the
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004870 403 status code and interrogating a blocked URL.
4871
Christopher Faulet3b967c12020-05-15 15:47:44 +02004872 See also : "http-error", "errorloc", "errorloc302", "errorloc303"
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004873
Willy Tarreau59140a22009-02-22 12:02:30 +01004874 Example :
4875 errorfile 400 /etc/haproxy/errorfiles/400badreq.http
Willy Tarreau989222a2016-01-15 10:26:26 +01004876 errorfile 408 /dev/null # work around Chrome pre-connect bug
Willy Tarreau59140a22009-02-22 12:02:30 +01004877 errorfile 403 /etc/haproxy/errorfiles/403forbid.http
4878 errorfile 503 /etc/haproxy/errorfiles/503sorry.http
4879
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004880
Christopher Faulet76edc0f2020-01-13 15:52:01 +01004881errorfiles <name> [<code> ...]
4882 Import, fully or partially, the error files defined in the <name> http-errors
4883 section.
4884 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4885 yes | yes | yes | yes
4886 Arguments :
4887 <name> is the name of an existing http-errors section.
4888
4889 <code> is a HTTP status code. Several status code may be listed.
Christopher Faulet612f2ea2020-05-27 09:57:28 +02004890 Currently, HAProxy is capable of generating codes 200, 400, 401,
Christopher Faulete095f312020-12-07 11:22:24 +01004891 403, 404, 405, 407, 408, 410, 413, 425, 429, 500, 501, 502, 503,
4892 and 504.
Christopher Faulet76edc0f2020-01-13 15:52:01 +01004893
4894 Errors defined in the http-errors section with the name <name> are imported
4895 in the current proxy. If no status code is specified, all error files of the
4896 http-errors section are imported. Otherwise, only error files associated to
4897 the listed status code are imported. Those error files override the already
4898 defined custom errors for the proxy. And they may be overridden by following
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -04004899 ones. Functionally, it is exactly the same as declaring all error files by
Christopher Faulet76edc0f2020-01-13 15:52:01 +01004900 hand using "errorfile" directives.
4901
Christopher Faulet3b967c12020-05-15 15:47:44 +02004902 See also : "http-error", "errorfile", "errorloc", "errorloc302" ,
4903 "errorloc303" and section 3.8 about http-errors.
Christopher Faulet76edc0f2020-01-13 15:52:01 +01004904
4905 Example :
4906 errorfiles generic
4907 errorfiles site-1 403 404
4908
4909
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004910errorloc <code> <url>
4911errorloc302 <code> <url>
4912 Return an HTTP redirection to a URL instead of errors generated by HAProxy
4913 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4914 yes | yes | yes | yes
4915 Arguments :
4916 <code> is the HTTP status code. Currently, HAProxy is capable of
Christopher Faulet612f2ea2020-05-27 09:57:28 +02004917 generating codes 200, 400, 401, 403, 404, 405, 407, 408, 410,
Christopher Faulete095f312020-12-07 11:22:24 +01004918 413, 425, 429, 500, 501, 502, 503, and 504.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004919
4920 <url> it is the exact contents of the "Location" header. It may contain
4921 either a relative URI to an error page hosted on the same site,
4922 or an absolute URI designating an error page on another site.
4923 Special care should be given to relative URIs to avoid redirect
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01004924 loops if the URI itself may generate the same error (e.g. 500).
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004925
4926 It is important to understand that this keyword is not meant to rewrite
4927 errors returned by the server, but errors detected and returned by HAProxy.
4928 This is why the list of supported errors is limited to a small set.
4929
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02004930 Code 200 is emitted in response to requests matching a "monitor-uri" rule.
4931
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004932 Note that both keyword return the HTTP 302 status code, which tells the
4933 client to fetch the designated URL using the same HTTP method. This can be
4934 quite problematic in case of non-GET methods such as POST, because the URL
4935 sent to the client might not be allowed for something other than GET. To
Willy Tarreau989222a2016-01-15 10:26:26 +01004936 work around this problem, please use "errorloc303" which send the HTTP 303
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004937 status code, indicating to the client that the URL must be fetched with a GET
4938 request.
4939
Christopher Faulet3b967c12020-05-15 15:47:44 +02004940 See also : "http-error", "errorfile", "errorloc303"
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004941
4942
4943errorloc303 <code> <url>
4944 Return an HTTP redirection to a URL instead of errors generated by HAProxy
4945 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4946 yes | yes | yes | yes
4947 Arguments :
4948 <code> is the HTTP status code. Currently, HAProxy is capable of
Christopher Faulet612f2ea2020-05-27 09:57:28 +02004949 generating codes 200, 400, 401, 403, 404, 405, 407, 408, 410,
Christopher Faulete095f312020-12-07 11:22:24 +01004950 413, 425, 429, 500, 501, 502, 503, and 504.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004951
4952 <url> it is the exact contents of the "Location" header. It may contain
4953 either a relative URI to an error page hosted on the same site,
4954 or an absolute URI designating an error page on another site.
4955 Special care should be given to relative URIs to avoid redirect
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01004956 loops if the URI itself may generate the same error (e.g. 500).
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004957
4958 It is important to understand that this keyword is not meant to rewrite
4959 errors returned by the server, but errors detected and returned by HAProxy.
4960 This is why the list of supported errors is limited to a small set.
4961
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02004962 Code 200 is emitted in response to requests matching a "monitor-uri" rule.
4963
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004964 Note that both keyword return the HTTP 303 status code, which tells the
4965 client to fetch the designated URL using the same HTTP GET method. This
4966 solves the usual problems associated with "errorloc" and the 302 code. It is
4967 possible that some very old browsers designed before HTTP/1.1 do not support
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01004968 it, but no such problem has been reported till now.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004969
Christopher Faulet3b967c12020-05-15 15:47:44 +02004970 See also : "http-error", "errorfile", "errorloc", "errorloc302"
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004971
4972
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09004973email-alert from <emailaddr>
4974 Declare the from email address to be used in both the envelope and header
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01004975 of email alerts. This is the address that email alerts are sent from.
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09004976 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4977 yes | yes | yes | yes
4978
4979 Arguments :
4980
4981 <emailaddr> is the from email address to use when sending email alerts
4982
4983 Also requires "email-alert mailers" and "email-alert to" to be set
4984 and if so sending email alerts is enabled for the proxy.
4985
Simon Horman64e34162015-02-06 11:11:57 +09004986 See also : "email-alert level", "email-alert mailers",
Cyril Bonté307ee1e2015-09-28 23:16:06 +02004987 "email-alert myhostname", "email-alert to", section 3.6 about
4988 mailers.
Simon Horman64e34162015-02-06 11:11:57 +09004989
4990
4991email-alert level <level>
4992 Declare the maximum log level of messages for which email alerts will be
4993 sent. This acts as a filter on the sending of email alerts.
4994 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4995 yes | yes | yes | yes
4996
4997 Arguments :
4998
4999 <level> One of the 8 syslog levels:
5000 emerg alert crit err warning notice info debug
5001 The above syslog levels are ordered from lowest to highest.
5002
5003 By default level is alert
5004
5005 Also requires "email-alert from", "email-alert mailers" and
5006 "email-alert to" to be set and if so sending email alerts is enabled
5007 for the proxy.
5008
Simon Horman1421e212015-04-30 13:10:35 +09005009 Alerts are sent when :
5010
5011 * An un-paused server is marked as down and <level> is alert or lower
5012 * A paused server is marked as down and <level> is notice or lower
5013 * A server is marked as up or enters the drain state and <level>
5014 is notice or lower
5015 * "option log-health-checks" is enabled, <level> is info or lower,
5016 and a health check status update occurs
5017
Simon Horman64e34162015-02-06 11:11:57 +09005018 See also : "email-alert from", "email-alert mailers",
5019 "email-alert myhostname", "email-alert to",
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09005020 section 3.6 about mailers.
5021
5022
5023email-alert mailers <mailersect>
5024 Declare the mailers to be used when sending email alerts
5025 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5026 yes | yes | yes | yes
5027
5028 Arguments :
5029
5030 <mailersect> is the name of the mailers section to send email alerts.
5031
5032 Also requires "email-alert from" and "email-alert to" to be set
5033 and if so sending email alerts is enabled for the proxy.
5034
Simon Horman64e34162015-02-06 11:11:57 +09005035 See also : "email-alert from", "email-alert level", "email-alert myhostname",
5036 "email-alert to", section 3.6 about mailers.
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09005037
5038
5039email-alert myhostname <hostname>
5040 Declare the to hostname address to be used when communicating with
5041 mailers.
5042 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5043 yes | yes | yes | yes
5044
5045 Arguments :
5046
Baptiste Assmann738bad92015-12-21 15:27:53 +01005047 <hostname> is the hostname to use when communicating with mailers
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09005048
5049 By default the systems hostname is used.
5050
5051 Also requires "email-alert from", "email-alert mailers" and
5052 "email-alert to" to be set and if so sending email alerts is enabled
5053 for the proxy.
5054
Simon Horman64e34162015-02-06 11:11:57 +09005055 See also : "email-alert from", "email-alert level", "email-alert mailers",
5056 "email-alert to", section 3.6 about mailers.
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09005057
5058
5059email-alert to <emailaddr>
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01005060 Declare both the recipient address in the envelope and to address in the
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09005061 header of email alerts. This is the address that email alerts are sent to.
5062 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5063 yes | yes | yes | yes
5064
5065 Arguments :
5066
5067 <emailaddr> is the to email address to use when sending email alerts
5068
5069 Also requires "email-alert mailers" and "email-alert to" to be set
5070 and if so sending email alerts is enabled for the proxy.
5071
Simon Horman64e34162015-02-06 11:11:57 +09005072 See also : "email-alert from", "email-alert level", "email-alert mailers",
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09005073 "email-alert myhostname", section 3.6 about mailers.
5074
5075
Willy Tarreau4de91492010-01-22 19:10:05 +01005076force-persist { if | unless } <condition>
5077 Declare a condition to force persistence on down servers
5078 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Cyril Bonté4288c5a2018-03-12 22:02:59 +01005079 no | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau4de91492010-01-22 19:10:05 +01005080
5081 By default, requests are not dispatched to down servers. It is possible to
5082 force this using "option persist", but it is unconditional and redispatches
5083 to a valid server if "option redispatch" is set. That leaves with very little
5084 possibilities to force some requests to reach a server which is artificially
5085 marked down for maintenance operations.
5086
5087 The "force-persist" statement allows one to declare various ACL-based
5088 conditions which, when met, will cause a request to ignore the down status of
5089 a server and still try to connect to it. That makes it possible to start a
5090 server, still replying an error to the health checks, and run a specially
5091 configured browser to test the service. Among the handy methods, one could
5092 use a specific source IP address, or a specific cookie. The cookie also has
5093 the advantage that it can easily be added/removed on the browser from a test
5094 page. Once the service is validated, it is then possible to open the service
5095 to the world by returning a valid response to health checks.
5096
5097 The forced persistence is enabled when an "if" condition is met, or unless an
5098 "unless" condition is met. The final redispatch is always disabled when this
5099 is used.
5100
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02005101 See also : "option redispatch", "ignore-persist", "persist",
Cyril Bontéa8e7bbc2010-04-25 22:29:29 +02005102 and section 7 about ACL usage.
Willy Tarreau4de91492010-01-22 19:10:05 +01005103
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +02005104
5105filter <name> [param*]
5106 Add the filter <name> in the filter list attached to the proxy.
5107 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5108 no | yes | yes | yes
5109 Arguments :
5110 <name> is the name of the filter. Officially supported filters are
5111 referenced in section 9.
5112
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +01005113 <param*> is a list of parameters accepted by the filter <name>. The
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +02005114 parsing of these parameters are the responsibility of the
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +01005115 filter. Please refer to the documentation of the corresponding
5116 filter (section 9) for all details on the supported parameters.
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +02005117
5118 Multiple occurrences of the filter line can be used for the same proxy. The
5119 same filter can be referenced many times if needed.
5120
5121 Example:
5122 listen
5123 bind *:80
5124
5125 filter trace name BEFORE-HTTP-COMP
5126 filter compression
5127 filter trace name AFTER-HTTP-COMP
5128
5129 compression algo gzip
5130 compression offload
5131
5132 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
5133
5134 See also : section 9.
5135
Willy Tarreau4de91492010-01-22 19:10:05 +01005136
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005137fullconn <conns>
5138 Specify at what backend load the servers will reach their maxconn
5139 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5140 yes | no | yes | yes
5141 Arguments :
5142 <conns> is the number of connections on the backend which will make the
5143 servers use the maximal number of connections.
5144
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01005145 When a server has a "maxconn" parameter specified, it means that its number
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005146 of concurrent connections will never go higher. Additionally, if it has a
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01005147 "minconn" parameter, it indicates a dynamic limit following the backend's
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005148 load. The server will then always accept at least <minconn> connections,
5149 never more than <maxconn>, and the limit will be on the ramp between both
5150 values when the backend has less than <conns> concurrent connections. This
5151 makes it possible to limit the load on the servers during normal loads, but
5152 push it further for important loads without overloading the servers during
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01005153 exceptional loads.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005154
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04005155 Since it's hard to get this value right, HAProxy automatically sets it to
Willy Tarreaufbb78422011-06-05 15:38:35 +02005156 10% of the sum of the maxconns of all frontends that may branch to this
Bertrand Jacquin702d44f2013-11-19 11:43:06 +01005157 backend (based on "use_backend" and "default_backend" rules). That way it's
5158 safe to leave it unset. However, "use_backend" involving dynamic names are
5159 not counted since there is no way to know if they could match or not.
Willy Tarreaufbb78422011-06-05 15:38:35 +02005160
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005161 Example :
5162 # The servers will accept between 100 and 1000 concurrent connections each
5163 # and the maximum of 1000 will be reached when the backend reaches 10000
5164 # connections.
5165 backend dynamic
5166 fullconn 10000
5167 server srv1 dyn1:80 minconn 100 maxconn 1000
5168 server srv2 dyn2:80 minconn 100 maxconn 1000
5169
5170 See also : "maxconn", "server"
5171
5172
Willy Tarreauab0a5192020-10-09 19:07:01 +02005173grace <time> (deprecated)
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005174 Maintain a proxy operational for some time after a soft stop
5175 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Cyril Bonté99ed3272010-01-24 23:29:44 +01005176 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005177 Arguments :
5178 <time> is the time (by default in milliseconds) for which the instance
5179 will remain operational with the frontend sockets still listening
5180 when a soft-stop is received via the SIGUSR1 signal.
5181
5182 This may be used to ensure that the services disappear in a certain order.
5183 This was designed so that frontends which are dedicated to monitoring by an
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01005184 external equipment fail immediately while other ones remain up for the time
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005185 needed by the equipment to detect the failure.
5186
5187 Note that currently, there is very little benefit in using this parameter,
5188 and it may in fact complicate the soft-reconfiguration process more than
5189 simplify it.
5190
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01005191
Andrew Rodland17be45e2016-10-25 17:04:12 -04005192hash-balance-factor <factor>
5193 Specify the balancing factor for bounded-load consistent hashing
5194 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5195 yes | no | no | yes
5196 Arguments :
5197 <factor> is the control for the maximum number of concurrent requests to
5198 send to a server, expressed as a percentage of the average number
Frédéric Lécaille93d33162019-03-06 09:35:59 +01005199 of concurrent requests across all of the active servers.
Andrew Rodland17be45e2016-10-25 17:04:12 -04005200
5201 Specifying a "hash-balance-factor" for a server with "hash-type consistent"
5202 enables an algorithm that prevents any one server from getting too many
5203 requests at once, even if some hash buckets receive many more requests than
5204 others. Setting <factor> to 0 (the default) disables the feature. Otherwise,
5205 <factor> is a percentage greater than 100. For example, if <factor> is 150,
5206 then no server will be allowed to have a load more than 1.5 times the average.
5207 If server weights are used, they will be respected.
5208
5209 If the first-choice server is disqualified, the algorithm will choose another
5210 server based on the request hash, until a server with additional capacity is
5211 found. A higher <factor> allows more imbalance between the servers, while a
5212 lower <factor> means that more servers will be checked on average, affecting
5213 performance. Reasonable values are from 125 to 200.
5214
Willy Tarreau760e81d2018-05-03 07:20:40 +02005215 This setting is also used by "balance random" which internally relies on the
5216 consistent hashing mechanism.
5217
Andrew Rodland17be45e2016-10-25 17:04:12 -04005218 See also : "balance" and "hash-type".
5219
5220
Bhaskar Maddalab6c0ac92013-11-05 11:54:02 -05005221hash-type <method> <function> <modifier>
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02005222 Specify a method to use for mapping hashes to servers
5223 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5224 yes | no | yes | yes
5225 Arguments :
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04005226 <method> is the method used to select a server from the hash computed by
5227 the <function> :
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02005228
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04005229 map-based the hash table is a static array containing all alive servers.
5230 The hashes will be very smooth, will consider weights, but
5231 will be static in that weight changes while a server is up
5232 will be ignored. This means that there will be no slow start.
5233 Also, since a server is selected by its position in the array,
5234 most mappings are changed when the server count changes. This
5235 means that when a server goes up or down, or when a server is
5236 added to a farm, most connections will be redistributed to
5237 different servers. This can be inconvenient with caches for
5238 instance.
Willy Tarreau798a39c2010-11-24 15:04:29 +01005239
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04005240 consistent the hash table is a tree filled with many occurrences of each
5241 server. The hash key is looked up in the tree and the closest
5242 server is chosen. This hash is dynamic, it supports changing
5243 weights while the servers are up, so it is compatible with the
5244 slow start feature. It has the advantage that when a server
5245 goes up or down, only its associations are moved. When a
5246 server is added to the farm, only a few part of the mappings
5247 are redistributed, making it an ideal method for caches.
5248 However, due to its principle, the distribution will never be
5249 very smooth and it may sometimes be necessary to adjust a
5250 server's weight or its ID to get a more balanced distribution.
5251 In order to get the same distribution on multiple load
5252 balancers, it is important that all servers have the exact
Bhaskar Maddalab6c0ac92013-11-05 11:54:02 -05005253 same IDs. Note: consistent hash uses sdbm and avalanche if no
5254 hash function is specified.
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04005255
5256 <function> is the hash function to be used :
5257
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03005258 sdbm this function was created initially for sdbm (a public-domain
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04005259 reimplementation of ndbm) database library. It was found to do
5260 well in scrambling bits, causing better distribution of the keys
5261 and fewer splits. It also happens to be a good general hashing
Bhaskar Maddalab6c0ac92013-11-05 11:54:02 -05005262 function with good distribution, unless the total server weight
5263 is a multiple of 64, in which case applying the avalanche
5264 modifier may help.
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04005265
5266 djb2 this function was first proposed by Dan Bernstein many years ago
5267 on comp.lang.c. Studies have shown that for certain workload this
Bhaskar Maddalab6c0ac92013-11-05 11:54:02 -05005268 function provides a better distribution than sdbm. It generally
5269 works well with text-based inputs though it can perform extremely
5270 poorly with numeric-only input or when the total server weight is
5271 a multiple of 33, unless the avalanche modifier is also used.
5272
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04005273 wt6 this function was designed for HAProxy while testing other
Willy Tarreaua0f42712013-11-14 14:30:35 +01005274 functions in the past. It is not as smooth as the other ones, but
5275 is much less sensible to the input data set or to the number of
5276 servers. It can make sense as an alternative to sdbm+avalanche or
5277 djb2+avalanche for consistent hashing or when hashing on numeric
5278 data such as a source IP address or a visitor identifier in a URL
5279 parameter.
5280
Willy Tarreau324f07f2015-01-20 19:44:50 +01005281 crc32 this is the most common CRC32 implementation as used in Ethernet,
5282 gzip, PNG, etc. It is slower than the other ones but may provide
5283 a better distribution or less predictable results especially when
5284 used on strings.
5285
Bhaskar Maddalab6c0ac92013-11-05 11:54:02 -05005286 <modifier> indicates an optional method applied after hashing the key :
5287
5288 avalanche This directive indicates that the result from the hash
5289 function above should not be used in its raw form but that
5290 a 4-byte full avalanche hash must be applied first. The
5291 purpose of this step is to mix the resulting bits from the
5292 previous hash in order to avoid any undesired effect when
5293 the input contains some limited values or when the number of
5294 servers is a multiple of one of the hash's components (64
5295 for SDBM, 33 for DJB2). Enabling avalanche tends to make the
5296 result less predictable, but it's also not as smooth as when
5297 using the original function. Some testing might be needed
5298 with some workloads. This hash is one of the many proposed
5299 by Bob Jenkins.
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02005300
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04005301 The default hash type is "map-based" and is recommended for most usages. The
5302 default function is "sdbm", the selection of a function should be based on
5303 the range of the values being hashed.
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02005304
Andrew Rodland17be45e2016-10-25 17:04:12 -04005305 See also : "balance", "hash-balance-factor", "server"
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02005306
5307
Christopher Faulet6d0c3df2020-01-22 09:26:35 +01005308http-after-response <action> <options...> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5309 Access control for all Layer 7 responses (server, applet/service and internal
5310 ones).
5311
5312 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5313 no | yes | yes | yes
5314
5315 The http-after-response statement defines a set of rules which apply to layer
5316 7 processing. The rules are evaluated in their declaration order when they
5317 are met in a frontend, listen or backend section. Any rule may optionally be
5318 followed by an ACL-based condition, in which case it will only be evaluated
5319 if the condition is true. Since these rules apply on responses, the backend
5320 rules are applied first, followed by the frontend's rules.
5321
5322 Unlike http-response rules, these ones are applied on all responses, the
5323 server ones but also to all responses generated by HAProxy. These rules are
5324 evaluated at the end of the responses analysis, before the data forwarding.
5325
5326 The first keyword is the rule's action. The supported actions are described
5327 below.
5328
5329 There is no limit to the number of http-after-response statements per
5330 instance.
5331
Christopher Fauletd5ac6de2020-12-02 08:40:14 +01005332 Note: Errors emitted in early stage of the request parsing are handled by the
5333 multiplexer at a lower level, before any http analysis. Thus no
5334 http-after-response ruleset is evaluated on these errors.
5335
Christopher Faulet6d0c3df2020-01-22 09:26:35 +01005336 Example:
5337 http-after-response set-header Strict-Transport-Security "max-age=31536000"
5338 http-after-response set-header Cache-Control "no-store,no-cache,private"
5339 http-after-response set-header Pragma "no-cache"
5340
5341http-after-response add-header <name> <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5342
5343 This appends an HTTP header field whose name is specified in <name> and whose
5344 value is defined by <fmt> which follows the log-format rules (see Custom Log
5345 Format in section 8.2.4). This may be used to send a cookie to a client for
5346 example, or to pass some internal information.
5347 This rule is not final, so it is possible to add other similar rules.
5348 Note that header addition is performed immediately, so one rule might reuse
5349 the resulting header from a previous rule.
5350
5351http-after-response allow [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5352
5353 This stops the evaluation of the rules and lets the response pass the check.
5354 No further "http-after-response" rules are evaluated.
5355
Maciej Zdebebdd4c52020-11-20 13:58:48 +00005356http-after-response del-header <name> [ -m <meth> ] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Christopher Faulet6d0c3df2020-01-22 09:26:35 +01005357
Maciej Zdebebdd4c52020-11-20 13:58:48 +00005358 This removes all HTTP header fields whose name is specified in <name>. <meth>
5359 is the matching method, applied on the header name. Supported matching methods
5360 are "str" (exact match), "beg" (prefix match), "end" (suffix match), "sub"
5361 (substring match) and "reg" (regex match). If not specified, exact matching
5362 method is used.
Christopher Faulet6d0c3df2020-01-22 09:26:35 +01005363
5364http-after-response replace-header <name> <regex-match> <replace-fmt>
5365 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5366
5367 This works like "http-response replace-header".
5368
5369 Example:
5370 http-after-response replace-header Set-Cookie (C=[^;]*);(.*) \1;ip=%bi;\2
5371
5372 # applied to:
5373 Set-Cookie: C=1; expires=Tue, 14-Jun-2016 01:40:45 GMT
5374
5375 # outputs:
5376 Set-Cookie: C=1;ip=192.168.1.20; expires=Tue, 14-Jun-2016 01:40:45 GMT
5377
5378 # assuming the backend IP is 192.168.1.20.
5379
5380http-after-response replace-value <name> <regex-match> <replace-fmt>
5381 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5382
5383 This works like "http-response replace-value".
5384
5385 Example:
5386 http-after-response replace-value Cache-control ^public$ private
5387
5388 # applied to:
5389 Cache-Control: max-age=3600, public
5390
5391 # outputs:
5392 Cache-Control: max-age=3600, private
5393
5394http-after-response set-header <name> <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5395
5396 This does the same as "add-header" except that the header name is first
5397 removed if it existed. This is useful when passing security information to
5398 the server, where the header must not be manipulated by external users.
5399
5400http-after-response set-status <status> [reason <str>]
5401 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5402
5403 This replaces the response status code with <status> which must be an integer
5404 between 100 and 999. Optionally, a custom reason text can be provided defined
5405 by <str>, or the default reason for the specified code will be used as a
5406 fallback.
5407
5408 Example:
5409 # return "431 Request Header Fields Too Large"
5410 http-response set-status 431
5411 # return "503 Slow Down", custom reason
5412 http-response set-status 503 reason "Slow Down"
5413
5414http-after-response set-var(<var-name>) <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5415
5416 This is used to set the contents of a variable. The variable is declared
5417 inline.
5418
5419 Arguments:
5420 <var-name> The name of the variable starts with an indication about its
5421 scope. The scopes allowed are:
5422 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
5423 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
5424 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction
5425 (request and response)
5426 "req" : the variable is shared only during request
5427 processing
5428 "res" : the variable is shared only during response
5429 processing
5430 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'.
5431 The name may only contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.'
5432 and '_'.
5433
5434 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
5435 followed by some converters.
5436
5437 Example:
5438 http-after-response set-var(sess.last_redir) res.hdr(location)
5439
5440http-after-response strict-mode { on | off }
5441
5442 This enables or disables the strict rewriting mode for following rules. It
5443 does not affect rules declared before it and it is only applicable on rules
5444 performing a rewrite on the responses. When the strict mode is enabled, any
5445 rewrite failure triggers an internal error. Otherwise, such errors are
5446 silently ignored. The purpose of the strict rewriting mode is to make some
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +05005447 rewrites optional while others must be performed to continue the response
Christopher Faulet6d0c3df2020-01-22 09:26:35 +01005448 processing.
5449
5450 By default, the strict rewriting mode is enabled. Its value is also reset
5451 when a ruleset evaluation ends. So, for instance, if you change the mode on
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -04005452 the backend, the default mode is restored when HAProxy starts the frontend
Christopher Faulet6d0c3df2020-01-22 09:26:35 +01005453 rules evaluation.
5454
5455http-after-response unset-var(<var-name>) [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5456
5457 This is used to unset a variable. See "http-after-response set-var" for
5458 details about <var-name>.
5459
5460 Example:
5461 http-after-response unset-var(sess.last_redir)
5462
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +02005463
5464http-check comment <string>
5465 Defines a comment for the following the http-check rule, reported in logs if
5466 it fails.
5467 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5468 yes | no | yes | yes
5469
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +02005470 Arguments :
5471 <string> is the comment message to add in logs if the following http-check
5472 rule fails.
5473
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02005474 It only works for connect, send and expect rules. It is useful to make
5475 user-friendly error reporting.
5476
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -04005477 See also : "option httpchk", "http-check connect", "http-check send" and
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +02005478 "http-check expect".
5479
5480
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02005481http-check connect [default] [port <expr>] [addr <ip>] [send-proxy]
5482 [via-socks4] [ssl] [sni <sni>] [alpn <alpn>] [linger]
Christopher Fauletedc6ed92020-04-23 16:27:59 +02005483 [proto <name>] [comment <msg>]
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005484 Opens a new connection to perform an HTTP health check
5485 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5486 yes | no | yes | yes
5487
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02005488 Arguments :
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +02005489 comment <msg> defines a message to report if the rule evaluation fails.
5490
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005491 default Use default options of the server line to do the health
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -04005492 checks. The server options are used only if not redefined.
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005493
5494 port <expr> if not set, check port or server port is used.
5495 It tells HAProxy where to open the connection to.
5496 <port> must be a valid TCP port source integer, from 1 to
5497 65535 or an sample-fetch expression.
5498
5499 addr <ip> defines the IP address to do the health check.
5500
5501 send-proxy send a PROXY protocol string
5502
5503 via-socks4 enables outgoing health checks using upstream socks4 proxy.
5504
5505 ssl opens a ciphered connection
5506
5507 sni <sni> specifies the SNI to use to do health checks over SSL.
5508
5509 alpn <alpn> defines which protocols to advertise with ALPN. The protocol
5510 list consists in a comma-delimited list of protocol names,
5511 for instance: "h2,http/1.1". If it is not set, the server ALPN
5512 is used.
5513
Christopher Fauletedc6ed92020-04-23 16:27:59 +02005514 proto <name> forces the multiplexer's protocol to use for this connection.
5515 It must be an HTTP mux protocol and it must be usable on the
5516 backend side. The list of available protocols is reported in
5517 haproxy -vv.
5518
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005519 linger cleanly close the connection instead of using a single RST.
5520
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02005521 Just like tcp-check health checks, it is possible to configure the connection
5522 to use to perform HTTP health check. This directive should also be used to
5523 describe a scenario involving several request/response exchanges, possibly on
5524 different ports or with different servers.
5525
5526 When there are no TCP port configured on the server line neither server port
5527 directive, then the first step of the http-check sequence must be to specify
5528 the port with a "http-check connect".
5529
5530 In an http-check ruleset a 'connect' is required, it is also mandatory to start
5531 the ruleset with a 'connect' rule. Purpose is to ensure admin know what they
5532 do.
5533
5534 When a connect must start the ruleset, if may still be preceded by set-var,
5535 unset-var or comment rules.
5536
5537 Examples :
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005538 # check HTTP and HTTPs services on a server.
5539 # first open port 80 thanks to server line port directive, then
5540 # tcp-check opens port 443, ciphered and run a request on it:
5541 option httpchk
5542
5543 http-check connect
Christopher Fauleta5c14ef2020-04-29 14:19:13 +02005544 http-check send meth GET uri / ver HTTP/1.1 hdr host haproxy.1wt.eu
Christopher Faulet8021a5f2020-04-24 13:53:12 +02005545 http-check expect status 200-399
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005546 http-check connect port 443 ssl sni haproxy.1wt.eu
Christopher Fauleta5c14ef2020-04-29 14:19:13 +02005547 http-check send meth GET uri / ver HTTP/1.1 hdr host haproxy.1wt.eu
Christopher Faulet8021a5f2020-04-24 13:53:12 +02005548 http-check expect status 200-399
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005549
5550 server www 10.0.0.1 check port 80
5551
5552 See also : "option httpchk", "http-check send", "http-check expect"
Christopher Faulet6d0c3df2020-01-22 09:26:35 +01005553
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02005554
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01005555http-check disable-on-404
5556 Enable a maintenance mode upon HTTP/404 response to health-checks
5557 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005558 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01005559 Arguments : none
5560
5561 When this option is set, a server which returns an HTTP code 404 will be
5562 excluded from further load-balancing, but will still receive persistent
5563 connections. This provides a very convenient method for Web administrators
5564 to perform a graceful shutdown of their servers. It is also important to note
5565 that a server which is detected as failed while it was in this mode will not
5566 generate an alert, just a notice. If the server responds 2xx or 3xx again, it
5567 will immediately be reinserted into the farm. The status on the stats page
5568 reports "NOLB" for a server in this mode. It is important to note that this
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01005569 option only works in conjunction with the "httpchk" option. If this option
5570 is used with "http-check expect", then it has precedence over it so that 404
Christopher Fauletfa8b89a2020-11-20 18:54:13 +01005571 responses will still be considered as soft-stop. Note also that a stopped
5572 server will stay stopped even if it replies 404s. This option is only
5573 evaluated for running servers.
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01005574
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02005575 See also : "option httpchk" and "http-check expect".
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01005576
5577
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +02005578http-check expect [min-recv <int>] [comment <msg>]
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005579 [ok-status <st>] [error-status <st>] [tout-status <st>]
5580 [on-success <fmt>] [on-error <fmt>] [status-code <expr>]
5581 [!] <match> <pattern>
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04005582 Make HTTP health checks consider response contents or specific status codes
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01005583 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreau1ee51a62011-08-19 20:04:17 +02005584 yes | no | yes | yes
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005585
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01005586 Arguments :
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +02005587 comment <msg> defines a message to report if the rule evaluation fails.
5588
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005589 min-recv is optional and can define the minimum amount of data required to
5590 evaluate the current expect rule. If the number of received bytes
5591 is under this limit, the check will wait for more data. This
5592 option can be used to resolve some ambiguous matching rules or to
5593 avoid executing costly regex matches on content known to be still
5594 incomplete. If an exact string is used, the minimum between the
5595 string length and this parameter is used. This parameter is
5596 ignored if it is set to -1. If the expect rule does not match,
5597 the check will wait for more data. If set to 0, the evaluation
5598 result is always conclusive.
5599
5600 ok-status <st> is optional and can be used to set the check status if
5601 the expect rule is successfully evaluated and if it is
5602 the last rule in the tcp-check ruleset. "L7OK", "L7OKC",
Christopher Fauletd888f0f2020-05-07 07:40:17 +02005603 "L6OK" and "L4OK" are supported :
5604 - L7OK : check passed on layer 7
Christopher Faulet83662b52020-11-20 17:47:47 +01005605 - L7OKC : check conditionally passed on layer 7, set
5606 server to NOLB state.
Christopher Fauletd888f0f2020-05-07 07:40:17 +02005607 - L6OK : check passed on layer 6
5608 - L4OK : check passed on layer 4
5609 By default "L7OK" is used.
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005610
5611 error-status <st> is optional and can be used to set the check status if
5612 an error occurred during the expect rule evaluation.
Christopher Faulet83662b52020-11-20 17:47:47 +01005613 "L7OKC", "L7RSP", "L7STS", "L6RSP" and "L4CON" are
5614 supported :
5615 - L7OKC : check conditionally passed on layer 7, set
5616 server to NOLB state.
Christopher Fauletd888f0f2020-05-07 07:40:17 +02005617 - L7RSP : layer 7 invalid response - protocol error
5618 - L7STS : layer 7 response error, for example HTTP 5xx
5619 - L6RSP : layer 6 invalid response - protocol error
5620 - L4CON : layer 1-4 connection problem
5621 By default "L7RSP" is used.
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005622
5623 tout-status <st> is optional and can be used to set the check status if
5624 a timeout occurred during the expect rule evaluation.
Christopher Fauletd888f0f2020-05-07 07:40:17 +02005625 "L7TOUT", "L6TOUT", and "L4TOUT" are supported :
5626 - L7TOUT : layer 7 (HTTP/SMTP) timeout
5627 - L6TOUT : layer 6 (SSL) timeout
5628 - L4TOUT : layer 1-4 timeout
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005629 By default "L7TOUT" is used.
5630
5631 on-success <fmt> is optional and can be used to customize the
5632 informational message reported in logs if the expect
5633 rule is successfully evaluated and if it is the last rule
5634 in the tcp-check ruleset. <fmt> is a log-format string.
5635
5636 on-error <fmt> is optional and can be used to customize the
5637 informational message reported in logs if an error
5638 occurred during the expect rule evaluation. <fmt> is a
5639 log-format string.
5640
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01005641 <match> is a keyword indicating how to look for a specific pattern in the
Christopher Fauletb5594262020-05-05 20:23:13 +02005642 response. The keyword may be one of "status", "rstatus", "hdr",
5643 "fhdr", "string", or "rstring". The keyword may be preceded by an
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01005644 exclamation mark ("!") to negate the match. Spaces are allowed
5645 between the exclamation mark and the keyword. See below for more
5646 details on the supported keywords.
5647
Christopher Faulet39708192020-05-05 10:47:36 +02005648 <pattern> is the pattern to look for. It may be a string, a regular
5649 expression or a more complex pattern with several arguments. If
5650 the string pattern contains spaces, they must be escaped with the
5651 usual backslash ('\').
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01005652
5653 By default, "option httpchk" considers that response statuses 2xx and 3xx
5654 are valid, and that others are invalid. When "http-check expect" is used,
5655 it defines what is considered valid or invalid. Only one "http-check"
5656 statement is supported in a backend. If a server fails to respond or times
5657 out, the check obviously fails. The available matches are :
5658
Christopher Faulet8021a5f2020-04-24 13:53:12 +02005659 status <codes> : test the status codes found parsing <codes> string. it
5660 must be a comma-separated list of status codes or range
5661 codes. A health check response will be considered as
5662 valid if the response's status code matches any status
5663 code or is inside any range of the list. If the "status"
5664 keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response will be
5665 considered invalid if the status code matches.
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01005666
5667 rstatus <regex> : test a regular expression for the HTTP status code.
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04005668 A health check response will be considered valid if the
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01005669 response's status code matches the expression. If the
5670 "rstatus" keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response
5671 will be considered invalid if the status code matches.
5672 This is mostly used to check for multiple codes.
5673
Christopher Fauletb5594262020-05-05 20:23:13 +02005674 hdr { name | name-lf } [ -m <meth> ] <name>
5675 [ { value | value-lf } [ -m <meth> ] <value> :
Christopher Faulet39708192020-05-05 10:47:36 +02005676 test the specified header pattern on the HTTP response
5677 headers. The name pattern is mandatory but the value
5678 pattern is optional. If not specified, only the header
5679 presence is verified. <meth> is the matching method,
5680 applied on the header name or the header value. Supported
5681 matching methods are "str" (exact match), "beg" (prefix
5682 match), "end" (suffix match), "sub" (substring match) or
5683 "reg" (regex match). If not specified, exact matching
Christopher Fauletb5594262020-05-05 20:23:13 +02005684 method is used. If the "name-lf" parameter is used,
5685 <name> is evaluated as a log-format string. If "value-lf"
5686 parameter is used, <value> is evaluated as a log-format
5687 string. These parameters cannot be used with the regex
5688 matching method. Finally, the header value is considered
5689 as comma-separated list. Note that matchings are case
5690 insensitive on the header names.
5691
5692 fhdr { name | name-lf } [ -m <meth> ] <name>
5693 [ { value | value-lf } [ -m <meth> ] <value> :
5694 test the specified full header pattern on the HTTP
5695 response headers. It does exactly the same than "hdr"
5696 keyword, except the full header value is tested, commas
5697 are not considered as delimiters.
Christopher Faulet39708192020-05-05 10:47:36 +02005698
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01005699 string <string> : test the exact string match in the HTTP response body.
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04005700 A health check response will be considered valid if the
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01005701 response's body contains this exact string. If the
5702 "string" keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response
5703 will be considered invalid if the body contains this
5704 string. This can be used to look for a mandatory word at
5705 the end of a dynamic page, or to detect a failure when a
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01005706 specific error appears on the check page (e.g. a stack
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01005707 trace).
5708
5709 rstring <regex> : test a regular expression on the HTTP response body.
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04005710 A health check response will be considered valid if the
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01005711 response's body matches this expression. If the "rstring"
5712 keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response will be
5713 considered invalid if the body matches the expression.
5714 This can be used to look for a mandatory word at the end
5715 of a dynamic page, or to detect a failure when a specific
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01005716 error appears on the check page (e.g. a stack trace).
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01005717
Christopher Fauletaaab0832020-05-05 15:54:22 +02005718 string-lf <fmt> : test a log-format string match in the HTTP response body.
5719 A health check response will be considered valid if the
5720 response's body contains the string resulting of the
5721 evaluation of <fmt>, which follows the log-format rules.
5722 If prefixed with "!", then the response will be
5723 considered invalid if the body contains the string.
5724
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01005725 It is important to note that the responses will be limited to a certain size
Christopher Fauletbb9fb8b2020-11-25 17:20:57 +01005726 defined by the global "tune.bufsize" option, which defaults to 16384 bytes.
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01005727 Thus, too large responses may not contain the mandatory pattern when using
5728 "string" or "rstring". If a large response is absolutely required, it is
5729 possible to change the default max size by setting the global variable.
5730 However, it is worth keeping in mind that parsing very large responses can
5731 waste some CPU cycles, especially when regular expressions are used, and that
5732 it is always better to focus the checks on smaller resources.
5733
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005734 In an http-check ruleset, the last expect rule may be implicit. If no expect
5735 rule is specified after the last "http-check send", an implicit expect rule
5736 is defined to match on 2xx or 3xx status codes. It means this rule is also
5737 defined if there is no "http-check" rule at all, when only "option httpchk"
5738 is set.
Cyril Bonté32602d22015-01-30 00:07:07 +01005739
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01005740 Last, if "http-check expect" is combined with "http-check disable-on-404",
5741 then this last one has precedence when the server responds with 404.
5742
5743 Examples :
5744 # only accept status 200 as valid
Christopher Faulet8021a5f2020-04-24 13:53:12 +02005745 http-check expect status 200,201,300-310
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01005746
Christopher Faulet39708192020-05-05 10:47:36 +02005747 # be sure a sessid coookie is set
5748 http-check expect header name "set-cookie" value -m beg "sessid="
5749
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01005750 # consider SQL errors as errors
Willy Tarreau8f2a1e72011-01-06 16:36:10 +01005751 http-check expect ! string SQL\ Error
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01005752
5753 # consider status 5xx only as errors
Willy Tarreau8f2a1e72011-01-06 16:36:10 +01005754 http-check expect ! rstatus ^5
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01005755
5756 # check that we have a correct hexadecimal tag before /html
Jarno Huuskonene5ae7022017-04-03 14:36:21 +03005757 http-check expect rstring <!--tag:[0-9a-f]*--></html>
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01005758
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005759 See also : "option httpchk", "http-check connect", "http-check disable-on-404"
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02005760 and "http-check send".
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005761
5762
Christopher Faulet7c95f5f2020-05-06 15:06:34 +02005763http-check send [meth <method>] [{ uri <uri> | uri-lf <fmt> }>] [ver <version>]
Christopher Faulet574e7bd2020-05-06 15:38:58 +02005764 [hdr <name> <fmt>]* [{ body <string> | body-lf <fmt> }]
5765 [comment <msg>]
Christopher Faulet8acb1282020-04-09 08:44:06 +02005766 Add a possible list of headers and/or a body to the request sent during HTTP
5767 health checks.
5768 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5769 yes | no | yes | yes
5770 Arguments :
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +02005771 comment <msg> defines a message to report if the rule evaluation fails.
5772
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005773 meth <method> is the optional HTTP method used with the requests. When not
5774 set, the "OPTIONS" method is used, as it generally requires
5775 low server processing and is easy to filter out from the
5776 logs. Any method may be used, though it is not recommended
5777 to invent non-standard ones.
5778
Christopher Faulet7c95f5f2020-05-06 15:06:34 +02005779 uri <uri> is optional and set the URI referenced in the HTTP requests
5780 to the string <uri>. It defaults to "/" which is accessible
5781 by default on almost any server, but may be changed to any
5782 other URI. Query strings are permitted.
5783
5784 uri-lf <fmt> is optional and set the URI referenced in the HTTP requests
5785 using the log-format string <fmt>. It defaults to "/" which
5786 is accessible by default on almost any server, but may be
5787 changed to any other URI. Query strings are permitted.
Christopher Faulet8acb1282020-04-09 08:44:06 +02005788
Christopher Faulet907701b2020-04-28 09:37:00 +02005789 ver <version> is the optional HTTP version string. It defaults to
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005790 "HTTP/1.0" but some servers might behave incorrectly in HTTP
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -04005791 1.0, so turning it to HTTP/1.1 may sometimes help. Note that
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005792 the Host field is mandatory in HTTP/1.1, use "hdr" argument
5793 to add it.
5794
5795 hdr <name> <fmt> adds the HTTP header field whose name is specified in
5796 <name> and whose value is defined by <fmt>, which follows
5797 to the log-format rules.
5798
5799 body <string> add the body defined by <string> to the request sent during
5800 HTTP health checks. If defined, the "Content-Length" header
5801 is thus automatically added to the request.
Christopher Faulet8acb1282020-04-09 08:44:06 +02005802
Christopher Faulet574e7bd2020-05-06 15:38:58 +02005803 body-lf <fmt> add the body defined by the log-format string <fmt> to the
5804 request sent during HTTP health checks. If defined, the
5805 "Content-Length" header is thus automatically added to the
5806 request.
5807
Christopher Faulet8acb1282020-04-09 08:44:06 +02005808 In addition to the request line defined by the "option httpchk" directive,
5809 this one is the valid way to add some headers and optionally a body to the
5810 request sent during HTTP health checks. If a body is defined, the associate
Christopher Faulet9df910c2020-04-29 14:20:47 +02005811 "Content-Length" header is automatically added. Thus, this header or
5812 "Transfer-encoding" header should not be present in the request provided by
5813 "http-check send". If so, it will be ignored. The old trick consisting to add
5814 headers after the version string on the "option httpchk" line is now
Amaury Denoyelle6d975f02020-12-22 14:08:52 +01005815 deprecated.
Christopher Faulet8acb1282020-04-09 08:44:06 +02005816
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005817 Also "http-check send" doesn't support HTTP keep-alive. Keep in mind that it
Amaury Denoyelle6d975f02020-12-22 14:08:52 +01005818 will automatically append a "Connection: close" header, unless a Connection
5819 header has already already been configured via a hdr entry.
Christopher Faulet9df910c2020-04-29 14:20:47 +02005820
5821 Note that the Host header and the request authority, when both defined, are
5822 automatically synchronized. It means when the HTTP request is sent, when a
5823 Host is inserted in the request, the request authority is accordingly
5824 updated. Thus, don't be surprised if the Host header value overwrites the
5825 configured request authority.
5826
5827 Note also for now, no Host header is automatically added in HTTP/1.1 or above
5828 requests. You should add it explicitly.
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005829
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02005830 See also : "option httpchk", "http-check send-state" and "http-check expect".
Christopher Faulet8acb1282020-04-09 08:44:06 +02005831
5832
Willy Tarreauef781042010-01-27 11:53:01 +01005833http-check send-state
5834 Enable emission of a state header with HTTP health checks
5835 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5836 yes | no | yes | yes
5837 Arguments : none
5838
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04005839 When this option is set, HAProxy will systematically send a special header
Willy Tarreauef781042010-01-27 11:53:01 +01005840 "X-Haproxy-Server-State" with a list of parameters indicating to each server
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04005841 how they are seen by HAProxy. This can be used for instance when a server is
5842 manipulated without access to HAProxy and the operator needs to know whether
5843 HAProxy still sees it up or not, or if the server is the last one in a farm.
Willy Tarreauef781042010-01-27 11:53:01 +01005844
5845 The header is composed of fields delimited by semi-colons, the first of which
5846 is a word ("UP", "DOWN", "NOLB"), possibly followed by a number of valid
5847 checks on the total number before transition, just as appears in the stats
5848 interface. Next headers are in the form "<variable>=<value>", indicating in
5849 no specific order some values available in the stats interface :
Joseph Lynch514061c2015-01-15 17:52:59 -08005850 - a variable "address", containing the address of the backend server.
5851 This corresponds to the <address> field in the server declaration. For
5852 unix domain sockets, it will read "unix".
5853
5854 - a variable "port", containing the port of the backend server. This
5855 corresponds to the <port> field in the server declaration. For unix
5856 domain sockets, it will read "unix".
5857
Willy Tarreauef781042010-01-27 11:53:01 +01005858 - a variable "name", containing the name of the backend followed by a slash
5859 ("/") then the name of the server. This can be used when a server is
5860 checked in multiple backends.
5861
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04005862 - a variable "node" containing the name of the HAProxy node, as set in the
Willy Tarreauef781042010-01-27 11:53:01 +01005863 global "node" variable, otherwise the system's hostname if unspecified.
5864
5865 - a variable "weight" indicating the weight of the server, a slash ("/")
5866 and the total weight of the farm (just counting usable servers). This
5867 helps to know if other servers are available to handle the load when this
5868 one fails.
5869
5870 - a variable "scur" indicating the current number of concurrent connections
5871 on the server, followed by a slash ("/") then the total number of
5872 connections on all servers of the same backend.
5873
5874 - a variable "qcur" indicating the current number of requests in the
5875 server's queue.
5876
5877 Example of a header received by the application server :
5878 >>> X-Haproxy-Server-State: UP 2/3; name=bck/srv2; node=lb1; weight=1/2; \
5879 scur=13/22; qcur=0
5880
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02005881 See also : "option httpchk", "http-check disable-on-404" and
5882 "http-check send".
Willy Tarreauef781042010-01-27 11:53:01 +01005883
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005884
5885http-check set-var(<var-name>) <expr>
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005886 This operation sets the content of a variable. The variable is declared inline.
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005887 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5888 yes | no | yes | yes
5889
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02005890 Arguments :
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005891 <var-name> The name of the variable starts with an indication about its
5892 scope. The scopes allowed for http-check are:
5893 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process.
5894 "sess" : the variable is shared with the tcp-check session.
5895 "check": the variable is declared for the lifetime of the tcp-check.
5896 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'.
5897 The name may only contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.',
5898 and '-'.
5899
5900 <expr> Is a sample-fetch expression potentially followed by converters.
5901
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02005902 Examples :
5903 http-check set-var(check.port) int(1234)
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005904
5905
5906http-check unset-var(<var-name>)
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005907 Free a reference to a variable within its scope.
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005908 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5909 yes | no | yes | yes
5910
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02005911 Arguments :
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005912 <var-name> The name of the variable starts with an indication about its
5913 scope. The scopes allowed for http-check are:
5914 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process.
5915 "sess" : the variable is shared with the tcp-check session.
5916 "check": the variable is declared for the lifetime of the tcp-check.
5917 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'.
5918 The name may only contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.',
5919 and '-'.
5920
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02005921 Examples :
5922 http-check unset-var(check.port)
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005923
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005924
Christopher Faulet3b967c12020-05-15 15:47:44 +02005925http-error status <code> [content-type <type>]
5926 [ { default-errorfiles | errorfile <file> | errorfiles <name> |
5927 file <file> | lf-file <file> | string <str> | lf-string <fmt> } ]
5928 [ hdr <name> <fmt> ]*
5929 Defines a custom error message to use instead of errors generated by HAProxy.
5930 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5931 yes | yes | yes | yes
5932 Arguments :
Ilya Shipitsin11057a32020-06-21 21:18:27 +05005933 status <code> is the HTTP status code. It must be specified.
Christopher Faulet3b967c12020-05-15 15:47:44 +02005934 Currently, HAProxy is capable of generating codes
Anthonin Bonnefoy85048f82020-06-22 09:17:01 +02005935 200, 400, 401, 403, 404, 405, 407, 408, 410, 413, 425,
Christopher Faulete095f312020-12-07 11:22:24 +01005936 429, 500, 501, 502, 503, and 504.
Christopher Faulet3b967c12020-05-15 15:47:44 +02005937
5938 content-type <type> is the response content type, for instance
5939 "text/plain". This parameter is ignored and should be
5940 omitted when an errorfile is configured or when the
5941 payload is empty. Otherwise, it must be defined.
5942
5943 default-errorfiles Reset the previously defined error message for current
5944 proxy for the status <code>. If used on a backend, the
5945 frontend error message is used, if defined. If used on
5946 a frontend, the default error message is used.
5947
5948 errorfile <file> designates a file containing the full HTTP response.
5949 It is recommended to follow the common practice of
5950 appending ".http" to the filename so that people do
5951 not confuse the response with HTML error pages, and to
5952 use absolute paths, since files are read before any
5953 chroot is performed.
5954
5955 errorfiles <name> designates the http-errors section to use to import
5956 the error message with the status code <code>. If no
5957 such message is found, the proxy's error messages are
5958 considered.
5959
5960 file <file> specifies the file to use as response payload. If the
5961 file is not empty, its content-type must be set as
5962 argument to "content-type", otherwise, any
5963 "content-type" argument is ignored. <file> is
5964 considered as a raw string.
5965
5966 string <str> specifies the raw string to use as response payload.
5967 The content-type must always be set as argument to
5968 "content-type".
5969
5970 lf-file <file> specifies the file to use as response payload. If the
5971 file is not empty, its content-type must be set as
5972 argument to "content-type", otherwise, any
5973 "content-type" argument is ignored. <file> is
5974 evaluated as a log-format string.
5975
5976 lf-string <str> specifies the log-format string to use as response
5977 payload. The content-type must always be set as
5978 argument to "content-type".
5979
5980 hdr <name> <fmt> adds to the response the HTTP header field whose name
5981 is specified in <name> and whose value is defined by
5982 <fmt>, which follows to the log-format rules.
5983 This parameter is ignored if an errorfile is used.
5984
5985 This directive may be used instead of "errorfile", to define a custom error
5986 message. As "errorfile" directive, it is used for errors detected and
5987 returned by HAProxy. If an errorfile is defined, it is parsed when HAProxy
5988 starts and must be valid according to the HTTP standards. The generated
5989 response must not exceed the configured buffer size (BUFFSIZE), otherwise an
5990 internal error will be returned. Finally, if you consider to use some
5991 http-after-response rules to rewrite these errors, the reserved buffer space
5992 should be available (see "tune.maxrewrite").
5993
5994 The files are read at the same time as the configuration and kept in memory.
5995 For this reason, the errors continue to be returned even when the process is
5996 chrooted, and no file change is considered while the process is running.
5997
Christopher Fauletd5ac6de2020-12-02 08:40:14 +01005998 Note: 400/408/500 errors emitted in early stage of the request parsing are
5999 handled by the multiplexer at a lower level. No custom formatting is
6000 supported at this level. Thus only static error messages, defined with
6001 "errorfile" directive, are supported. However, this limitation only
6002 exists during the request headers parsing or between two transactions.
6003
Christopher Faulet3b967c12020-05-15 15:47:44 +02006004 See also : "errorfile", "errorfiles", "errorloc", "errorloc302",
6005 "errorloc303" and section 3.8 about http-errors.
6006
6007
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006008http-request <action> [options...] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01006009 Access control for Layer 7 requests
6010
6011 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6012 no | yes | yes | yes
6013
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01006014 The http-request statement defines a set of rules which apply to layer 7
6015 processing. The rules are evaluated in their declaration order when they are
6016 met in a frontend, listen or backend section. Any rule may optionally be
6017 followed by an ACL-based condition, in which case it will only be evaluated
6018 if the condition is true.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01006019
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006020 The first keyword is the rule's action. The supported actions are described
6021 below.
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01006022
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006023 There is no limit to the number of http-request statements per instance.
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01006024
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006025 Example:
6026 acl nagios src 192.168.129.3
6027 acl local_net src 192.168.0.0/16
6028 acl auth_ok http_auth(L1)
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01006029
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006030 http-request allow if nagios
6031 http-request allow if local_net auth_ok
6032 http-request auth realm Gimme if local_net auth_ok
6033 http-request deny
Willy Tarreau81499eb2012-12-27 12:19:02 +01006034
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006035 Example:
6036 acl key req.hdr(X-Add-Acl-Key) -m found
6037 acl add path /addacl
6038 acl del path /delacl
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01006039
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006040 acl myhost hdr(Host) -f myhost.lst
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01006041
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006042 http-request add-acl(myhost.lst) %[req.hdr(X-Add-Acl-Key)] if key add
6043 http-request del-acl(myhost.lst) %[req.hdr(X-Add-Acl-Key)] if key del
Thierry FOURNIERdad3d1d2014-04-22 18:07:25 +02006044
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006045 Example:
6046 acl value req.hdr(X-Value) -m found
6047 acl setmap path /setmap
6048 acl delmap path /delmap
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06006049
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006050 use_backend bk_appli if { hdr(Host),map_str(map.lst) -m found }
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06006051
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006052 http-request set-map(map.lst) %[src] %[req.hdr(X-Value)] if setmap value
6053 http-request del-map(map.lst) %[src] if delmap
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06006054
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006055 See also : "stats http-request", section 3.4 about userlists and section 7
6056 about ACL usage.
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06006057
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006058http-request add-acl(<file-name>) <key fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06006059
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006060 This is used to add a new entry into an ACL. The ACL must be loaded from a
6061 file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the ACL to be updated is
6062 passed between parentheses. It takes one argument: <key fmt>, which follows
6063 log-format rules, to collect content of the new entry. It performs a lookup
6064 in the ACL before insertion, to avoid duplicated (or more) values. This
6065 lookup is done by a linear search and can be expensive with large lists!
6066 It is the equivalent of the "add acl" command from the stats socket, but can
6067 be triggered by an HTTP request.
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06006068
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006069http-request add-header <name> <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06006070
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006071 This appends an HTTP header field whose name is specified in <name> and
6072 whose value is defined by <fmt> which follows the log-format rules (see
6073 Custom Log Format in section 8.2.4). This is particularly useful to pass
6074 connection-specific information to the server (e.g. the client's SSL
6075 certificate), or to combine several headers into one. This rule is not
6076 final, so it is possible to add other similar rules. Note that header
6077 addition is performed immediately, so one rule might reuse the resulting
6078 header from a previous rule.
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06006079
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006080http-request allow [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06006081
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006082 This stops the evaluation of the rules and lets the request pass the check.
6083 No further "http-request" rules are evaluated.
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06006084
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06006085
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006086http-request auth [realm <realm>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06006087
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006088 This stops the evaluation of the rules and immediately responds with an
6089 HTTP 401 or 407 error code to invite the user to present a valid user name
6090 and password. No further "http-request" rules are evaluated. An optional
6091 "realm" parameter is supported, it sets the authentication realm that is
6092 returned with the response (typically the application's name).
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06006093
Christopher Faulet612f2ea2020-05-27 09:57:28 +02006094 The corresponding proxy's error message is used. It may be customized using
6095 an "errorfile" or an "http-error" directive. For 401 responses, all
6096 occurrences of the WWW-Authenticate header are removed and replaced by a new
6097 one with a basic authentication challenge for realm "<realm>". For 407
6098 responses, the same is done on the Proxy-Authenticate header. If the error
6099 message must not be altered, consider to use "http-request return" rule
6100 instead.
6101
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006102 Example:
6103 acl auth_ok http_auth_group(L1) G1
6104 http-request auth unless auth_ok
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06006105
Jarno Huuskonen251a6b72019-01-04 14:05:02 +02006106http-request cache-use <name> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06006107
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +02006108 See section 6.2 about cache setup.
Willy Tarreaua0dc23f2015-01-22 20:46:11 +01006109
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006110http-request capture <sample> [ len <length> | id <id> ]
6111 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreaua0dc23f2015-01-22 20:46:11 +01006112
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006113 This captures sample expression <sample> from the request buffer, and
6114 converts it to a string of at most <len> characters. The resulting string is
6115 stored into the next request "capture" slot, so it will possibly appear next
6116 to some captured HTTP headers. It will then automatically appear in the logs,
6117 and it will be possible to extract it using sample fetch rules to feed it
6118 into headers or anything. The length should be limited given that this size
6119 will be allocated for each capture during the whole session life.
6120 Please check section 7.3 (Fetching samples) and "capture request header" for
6121 more information.
Willy Tarreaua0dc23f2015-01-22 20:46:11 +01006122
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006123 If the keyword "id" is used instead of "len", the action tries to store the
6124 captured string in a previously declared capture slot. This is useful to run
6125 captures in backends. The slot id can be declared by a previous directive
Baptiste Assmann19a69b32020-01-16 14:34:22 +01006126 "http-request capture" or with the "declare capture" keyword.
6127
6128 When using this action in a backend, double check that the relevant
6129 frontend(s) have the required capture slots otherwise, this rule will be
6130 ignored at run time. This can't be detected at configuration parsing time
6131 due to HAProxy's ability to dynamically resolve backend name at runtime.
Willy Tarreaua0dc23f2015-01-22 20:46:11 +01006132
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006133http-request del-acl(<file-name>) <key fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreaua0dc23f2015-01-22 20:46:11 +01006134
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006135 This is used to delete an entry from an ACL. The ACL must be loaded from a
6136 file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the ACL to be updated is
6137 passed between parentheses. It takes one argument: <key fmt>, which follows
6138 log-format rules, to collect content of the entry to delete.
6139 It is the equivalent of the "del acl" command from the stats socket, but can
6140 be triggered by an HTTP request.
Willy Tarreaua0dc23f2015-01-22 20:46:11 +01006141
Maciej Zdebebdd4c52020-11-20 13:58:48 +00006142http-request del-header <name> [ -m <meth> ] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreauf4c43c12013-06-11 17:01:13 +02006143
Maciej Zdebebdd4c52020-11-20 13:58:48 +00006144 This removes all HTTP header fields whose name is specified in <name>. <meth>
6145 is the matching method, applied on the header name. Supported matching methods
6146 are "str" (exact match), "beg" (prefix match), "end" (suffix match), "sub"
6147 (substring match) and "reg" (regex match). If not specified, exact matching
6148 method is used.
Willy Tarreau9a355ec2013-06-11 17:45:46 +02006149
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006150http-request del-map(<file-name>) <key fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreau42cf39e2013-06-11 18:51:32 +02006151
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006152 This is used to delete an entry from a MAP. The MAP must be loaded from a
6153 file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the MAP to be updated is
6154 passed between parentheses. It takes one argument: <key fmt>, which follows
6155 log-format rules, to collect content of the entry to delete.
6156 It takes one argument: "file name" It is the equivalent of the "del map"
6157 command from the stats socket, but can be triggered by an HTTP request.
Willy Tarreau51347ed2013-06-11 19:34:13 +02006158
Christopher Faulet5cb513a2020-05-13 17:56:56 +02006159http-request deny [deny_status <status>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6160http-request deny [ { status | deny_status } <code>] [content-type <type>]
6161 [ { default-errorfiles | errorfile <file> | errorfiles <name> |
6162 file <file> | lf-file <file> | string <str> | lf-string <fmt> } ]
6163 [ hdr <name> <fmt> ]*
6164 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Patrick Hemmer268a7072018-05-11 12:52:31 -04006165
Christopher Faulet5cb513a2020-05-13 17:56:56 +02006166 This stops the evaluation of the rules and immediately rejects the request.
6167 By default an HTTP 403 error is returned. But the response may be customized
6168 using same syntax than "http-request return" rules. Thus, see "http-request
Ilya Shipitsin11057a32020-06-21 21:18:27 +05006169 return" for details. For compatibility purpose, when no argument is defined,
Christopher Faulet5cb513a2020-05-13 17:56:56 +02006170 or only "deny_status", the argument "default-errorfiles" is implied. It means
6171 "http-request deny [deny_status <status>]" is an alias of
6172 "http-request deny [status <status>] default-errorfiles".
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006173 No further "http-request" rules are evaluated.
Christopher Faulet5cb513a2020-05-13 17:56:56 +02006174 See also "http-request return".
Patrick Hemmer268a7072018-05-11 12:52:31 -04006175
Olivier Houchard602bf7d2019-05-10 13:59:15 +02006176http-request disable-l7-retry [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6177 This disables any attempt to retry the request if it fails for any other
6178 reason than a connection failure. This can be useful for example to make
6179 sure POST requests aren't retried on failure.
6180
Baptiste Assmann333939c2019-01-21 08:34:50 +01006181http-request do-resolve(<var>,<resolvers>,[ipv4,ipv6]) <expr> :
6182
6183 This action performs a DNS resolution of the output of <expr> and stores
6184 the result in the variable <var>. It uses the DNS resolvers section
6185 pointed by <resolvers>.
6186 It is possible to choose a resolution preference using the optional
6187 arguments 'ipv4' or 'ipv6'.
6188 When performing the DNS resolution, the client side connection is on
6189 pause waiting till the end of the resolution.
6190 If an IP address can be found, it is stored into <var>. If any kind of
6191 error occurs, then <var> is not set.
6192 One can use this action to discover a server IP address at run time and
6193 based on information found in the request (IE a Host header).
6194 If this action is used to find the server's IP address (using the
6195 "set-dst" action), then the server IP address in the backend must be set
William Lallemandac83dba2022-08-26 16:38:43 +02006196 to 0.0.0.0. The do-resolve action takes an host-only parameter, any port must
6197 be removed from the string.
Baptiste Assmann333939c2019-01-21 08:34:50 +01006198
6199 Example:
6200 resolvers mydns
6201 nameserver local 127.0.0.53:53
6202 nameserver google 8.8.8.8:53
6203 timeout retry 1s
6204 hold valid 10s
6205 hold nx 3s
6206 hold other 3s
6207 hold obsolete 0s
6208 accepted_payload_size 8192
6209
6210 frontend fe
6211 bind 10.42.0.1:80
William Lallemandac83dba2022-08-26 16:38:43 +02006212 http-request do-resolve(txn.myip,mydns,ipv4) hdr(Host),lower,regsub(:[0-9]*$,)
Baptiste Assmann333939c2019-01-21 08:34:50 +01006213 http-request capture var(txn.myip) len 40
6214
6215 # return 503 when the variable is not set,
6216 # which mean DNS resolution error
6217 use_backend b_503 unless { var(txn.myip) -m found }
6218
6219 default_backend be
6220
6221 backend b_503
6222 # dummy backend used to return 503.
6223 # one can use the errorfile directive to send a nice
6224 # 503 error page to end users
6225
6226 backend be
6227 # rule to prevent HAProxy from reconnecting to services
6228 # on the local network (forged DNS name used to scan the network)
6229 http-request deny if { var(txn.myip) -m ip 127.0.0.0/8 10.0.0.0/8 }
6230 http-request set-dst var(txn.myip)
6231 server clear 0.0.0.0:0
6232
6233 NOTE: Don't forget to set the "protection" rules to ensure HAProxy won't
6234 be used to scan the network or worst won't loop over itself...
6235
Frédéric Lécaille06f5b642018-11-12 11:01:10 +01006236http-request early-hint <name> <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6237
6238 This is used to build an HTTP 103 Early Hints response prior to any other one.
6239 This appends an HTTP header field to this response whose name is specified in
6240 <name> and whose value is defined by <fmt> which follows the log-format rules
6241 (see Custom Log Format in section 8.2.4). This is particularly useful to pass
Frédéric Lécaille3aac1062018-11-13 09:42:13 +01006242 to the client some Link headers to preload resources required to render the
6243 HTML documents.
Frédéric Lécaille06f5b642018-11-12 11:01:10 +01006244
6245 See RFC 8297 for more information.
6246
Tim Duesterhusd371e992021-04-15 21:45:58 +02006247http-request normalize-uri <normalizer> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Tim Duesterhusdec1c362021-05-10 17:28:26 +02006248http-request normalize-uri fragment-encode [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Tim Duesterhusc9e05ab2021-05-10 17:28:25 +02006249http-request normalize-uri fragment-strip [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Tim Duesterhus5be6ab22021-04-17 11:21:10 +02006250http-request normalize-uri path-merge-slashes [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Maximilian Maderff3bb8b2021-04-21 00:22:50 +02006251http-request normalize-uri path-strip-dot [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Tim Duesterhus5be6ab22021-04-17 11:21:10 +02006252http-request normalize-uri path-strip-dotdot [ full ] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Tim Duesterhus2e4a18e2021-04-21 21:20:36 +02006253http-request normalize-uri percent-decode-unreserved [ strict ] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Tim Duesterhus5be6ab22021-04-17 11:21:10 +02006254http-request normalize-uri percent-to-uppercase [ strict ] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6255http-request normalize-uri query-sort-by-name [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Tim Duesterhusd371e992021-04-15 21:45:58 +02006256
Tim Duesterhusb918a4a2021-04-16 23:52:29 +02006257 Performs normalization of the request's URI.
6258
Tim Duesterhus2963fd32021-04-17 00:24:56 +02006259 URI normalization in HAProxy 2.4 is currently available as an experimental
Amaury Denoyellea9e639a2021-05-06 15:50:12 +02006260 technical preview. As such, it requires the global directive
6261 'expose-experimental-directives' first to be able to invoke it. You should be
6262 prepared that the behavior of normalizers might change to fix possible
6263 issues, possibly breaking proper request processing in your infrastructure.
Tim Duesterhus2963fd32021-04-17 00:24:56 +02006264
Tim Duesterhusb918a4a2021-04-16 23:52:29 +02006265 Each normalizer handles a single type of normalization to allow for a
6266 fine-grained selection of the level of normalization that is appropriate for
6267 the supported backend.
6268
6269 As an example the "path-strip-dotdot" normalizer might be useful for a static
6270 fileserver that directly maps the requested URI to the path within the local
6271 filesystem. However it might break routing of an API that expects a specific
6272 number of segments in the path.
6273
Tim Duesterhus2e4a18e2021-04-21 21:20:36 +02006274 It is important to note that some normalizers might result in unsafe
6275 transformations for broken URIs. It might also be possible that a combination
6276 of normalizers that are safe by themselves results in unsafe transformations
6277 when improperly combined.
6278
6279 As an example the "percent-decode-unreserved" normalizer might result in
6280 unexpected results when a broken URI includes bare percent characters. One
6281 such a broken URI is "/%%36%36" which would be decoded to "/%66" which in
6282 turn is equivalent to "/f". By specifying the "strict" option requests to
6283 such a broken URI would safely be rejected.
6284
Tim Duesterhusb918a4a2021-04-16 23:52:29 +02006285 The following normalizers are available:
Tim Duesterhusd371e992021-04-15 21:45:58 +02006286
Tim Duesterhusdec1c362021-05-10 17:28:26 +02006287 - fragment-encode: Encodes "#" as "%23".
6288
6289 The "fragment-strip" normalizer should be preferred, unless it is known
6290 that broken clients do not correctly encode '#' within the path component.
6291
6292 Example:
6293 - /#foo -> /%23foo
6294
Tim Duesterhusc9e05ab2021-05-10 17:28:25 +02006295 - fragment-strip: Removes the URI's "fragment" component.
6296
6297 According to RFC 3986#3.5 the "fragment" component of an URI should not
6298 be sent, but handled by the User Agent after retrieving a resource.
6299
6300 This normalizer should be applied first to ensure that the fragment is
6301 not interpreted as part of the request's path component.
6302
6303 Example:
6304 - /#foo -> /
6305
Tim Duesterhusd6d33de2021-04-21 21:20:35 +02006306 - path-strip-dot: Removes "/./" segments within the "path" component
6307 (RFC 3986#6.2.2.3).
Maximilian Maderff3bb8b2021-04-21 00:22:50 +02006308
Tim Duesterhus2e4a18e2021-04-21 21:20:36 +02006309 Segments including percent encoded dots ("%2E") will not be detected. Use
6310 the "percent-decode-unreserved" normalizer first if this is undesired.
6311
Tim Duesterhus7a95f412021-04-21 21:20:33 +02006312 Example:
6313 - /. -> /
6314 - /./bar/ -> /bar/
6315 - /a/./a -> /a/a
6316 - /.well-known/ -> /.well-known/ (no change)
Maximilian Maderff3bb8b2021-04-21 00:22:50 +02006317
Tim Duesterhusd6d33de2021-04-21 21:20:35 +02006318 - path-strip-dotdot: Normalizes "/../" segments within the "path" component
6319 (RFC 3986#6.2.2.3).
6320
Tim Duesterhus5be6ab22021-04-17 11:21:10 +02006321 This merges segments that attempt to access the parent directory with
Tim Duesterhus2e4a18e2021-04-21 21:20:36 +02006322 their preceding segment.
6323
6324 Empty segments do not receive special treatment. Use the "merge-slashes"
6325 normalizer first if this is undesired.
6326
6327 Segments including percent encoded dots ("%2E") will not be detected. Use
6328 the "percent-decode-unreserved" normalizer first if this is undesired.
Tim Duesterhus9982fc22021-04-15 21:45:59 +02006329
6330 Example:
6331 - /foo/../ -> /
6332 - /foo/../bar/ -> /bar/
6333 - /foo/bar/../ -> /foo/
6334 - /../bar/ -> /../bar/
Tim Duesterhus560e1a62021-04-15 21:46:00 +02006335 - /bar/../../ -> /../
Tim Duesterhus9982fc22021-04-15 21:45:59 +02006336 - /foo//../ -> /foo/
Tim Duesterhus2e4a18e2021-04-21 21:20:36 +02006337 - /foo/%2E%2E/ -> /foo/%2E%2E/
Tim Duesterhus9982fc22021-04-15 21:45:59 +02006338
Tim Duesterhus560e1a62021-04-15 21:46:00 +02006339 If the "full" option is specified then "../" at the beginning will be
6340 removed as well:
6341
6342 Example:
6343 - /../bar/ -> /bar/
6344 - /bar/../../ -> /
6345
Tim Duesterhus5be6ab22021-04-17 11:21:10 +02006346 - path-merge-slashes: Merges adjacent slashes within the "path" component
6347 into a single slash.
Tim Duesterhusd371e992021-04-15 21:45:58 +02006348
6349 Example:
6350 - // -> /
6351 - /foo//bar -> /foo/bar
6352
Tim Duesterhus2e4a18e2021-04-21 21:20:36 +02006353 - percent-decode-unreserved: Decodes unreserved percent encoded characters to
6354 their representation as a regular character (RFC 3986#6.2.2.2).
6355
6356 The set of unreserved characters includes all letters, all digits, "-",
6357 ".", "_", and "~".
6358
6359 Example:
6360 - /%61dmin -> /admin
6361 - /foo%3Fbar=baz -> /foo%3Fbar=baz (no change)
6362 - /%%36%36 -> /%66 (unsafe)
6363 - /%ZZ -> /%ZZ
6364
6365 If the "strict" option is specified then invalid sequences will result
6366 in a HTTP 400 Bad Request being returned.
6367
6368 Example:
6369 - /%%36%36 -> HTTP 400
6370 - /%ZZ -> HTTP 400
6371
Tim Duesterhus5be6ab22021-04-17 11:21:10 +02006372 - percent-to-uppercase: Uppercases letters within percent-encoded sequences
Tim Duesterhusc315efd2021-04-21 21:20:34 +02006373 (RFC 3986#6.2.2.1).
Tim Duesterhusa4071932021-04-15 21:46:02 +02006374
6375 Example:
6376 - /%6f -> /%6F
6377 - /%zz -> /%zz
6378
6379 If the "strict" option is specified then invalid sequences will result
6380 in a HTTP 400 Bad Request being returned.
6381
6382 Example:
6383 - /%zz -> HTTP 400
6384
Tim Duesterhus5be6ab22021-04-17 11:21:10 +02006385 - query-sort-by-name: Sorts the query string parameters by parameter name.
Tim Duesterhusd7b89be2021-04-15 21:46:01 +02006386 Parameters are assumed to be delimited by '&'. Shorter names sort before
6387 longer names and identical parameter names maintain their relative order.
6388
6389 Example:
6390 - /?c=3&a=1&b=2 -> /?a=1&b=2&c=3
6391 - /?aaa=3&a=1&aa=2 -> /?a=1&aa=2&aaa=3
6392 - /?a=3&b=4&a=1&b=5&a=2 -> /?a=3&a=1&a=2&b=4&b=5
6393
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006394http-request redirect <rule> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02006395
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006396 This performs an HTTP redirection based on a redirect rule. This is exactly
6397 the same as the "redirect" statement except that it inserts a redirect rule
6398 which can be processed in the middle of other "http-request" rules and that
6399 these rules use the "log-format" strings. See the "redirect" keyword for the
6400 rule's syntax.
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02006401
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006402http-request reject [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02006403
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006404 This stops the evaluation of the rules and immediately closes the connection
6405 without sending any response. It acts similarly to the
6406 "tcp-request content reject" rules. It can be useful to force an immediate
6407 connection closure on HTTP/2 connections.
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02006408
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006409http-request replace-header <name> <match-regex> <replace-fmt>
6410 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreaua9083d02015-05-08 15:27:59 +02006411
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +05006412 This matches the value of all occurrences of header field <name> against
Tim Duesterhus2252beb2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01006413 <match-regex>. Matching is performed case-sensitively. Matching values are
6414 completely replaced by <replace-fmt>. Format characters are allowed in
6415 <replace-fmt> and work like <fmt> arguments in "http-request add-header".
6416 Standard back-references using the backslash ('\') followed by a number are
6417 supported.
Thierry FOURNIER82bf70d2015-05-26 17:58:29 +02006418
Tim Duesterhus2252beb2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01006419 This action acts on whole header lines, regardless of the number of values
6420 they may contain. Thus it is well-suited to process headers naturally
6421 containing commas in their value, such as If-Modified-Since. Headers that
6422 contain a comma-separated list of values, such as Accept, should be processed
6423 using "http-request replace-value".
William Lallemand86d0df02017-11-24 21:36:45 +01006424
Tim Duesterhus2252beb2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01006425 Example:
6426 http-request replace-header Cookie foo=([^;]*);(.*) foo=\1;ip=%bi;\2
6427
6428 # applied to:
6429 Cookie: foo=foobar; expires=Tue, 14-Jun-2016 01:40:45 GMT;
6430
6431 # outputs:
6432 Cookie: foo=foobar;ip=192.168.1.20; expires=Tue, 14-Jun-2016 01:40:45 GMT;
6433
6434 # assuming the backend IP is 192.168.1.20
Willy Tarreau09448f72014-06-25 18:12:15 +02006435
Tim Duesterhus2252beb2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01006436 http-request replace-header User-Agent curl foo
6437
6438 # applied to:
6439 User-Agent: curl/7.47.0
Willy Tarreau09448f72014-06-25 18:12:15 +02006440
Tim Duesterhus2252beb2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01006441 # outputs:
6442 User-Agent: foo
Willy Tarreau09448f72014-06-25 18:12:15 +02006443
Willy Tarreau262c3f12019-12-17 06:52:51 +01006444http-request replace-path <match-regex> <replace-fmt>
6445 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6446
6447 This works like "replace-header" except that it works on the request's path
6448 component instead of a header. The path component starts at the first '/'
Christopher Faulet82c83322020-09-02 14:16:59 +02006449 after an optional scheme+authority and ends before the question mark. Thus,
6450 the replacement does not modify the scheme, the authority and the
6451 query-string.
Willy Tarreau262c3f12019-12-17 06:52:51 +01006452
6453 It is worth noting that regular expressions may be more expensive to evaluate
6454 than certain ACLs, so rare replacements may benefit from a condition to avoid
6455 performing the evaluation at all if it does not match.
6456
6457 Example:
6458 # prefix /foo : turn /bar?q=1 into /foo/bar?q=1 :
6459 http-request replace-path (.*) /foo\1
6460
Willy Tarreau262c3f12019-12-17 06:52:51 +01006461 # strip /foo : turn /foo/bar?q=1 into /bar?q=1
6462 http-request replace-path /foo/(.*) /\1
6463 # or more efficient if only some requests match :
6464 http-request replace-path /foo/(.*) /\1 if { url_beg /foo/ }
6465
Christopher Faulet312294f2020-09-02 17:17:44 +02006466http-request replace-pathq <match-regex> <replace-fmt>
6467 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6468
6469 This does the same as "http-request replace-path" except that the path
6470 contains the query-string if any is present. Thus, the path and the
6471 query-string are replaced.
6472
6473 Example:
6474 # suffix /foo : turn /bar?q=1 into /bar/foo?q=1 :
6475 http-request replace-pathq ([^?]*)(\?(.*))? \1/foo\2
6476
Willy Tarreau33810222019-06-12 17:44:02 +02006477http-request replace-uri <match-regex> <replace-fmt>
6478 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6479
Tim Duesterhus2252beb2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01006480 This works like "replace-header" except that it works on the request's URI part
6481 instead of a header. The URI part may contain an optional scheme, authority or
6482 query string. These are considered to be part of the value that is matched
6483 against.
6484
6485 It is worth noting that regular expressions may be more expensive to evaluate
6486 than certain ACLs, so rare replacements may benefit from a condition to avoid
6487 performing the evaluation at all if it does not match.
Willy Tarreau33810222019-06-12 17:44:02 +02006488
Willy Tarreau62b59132019-12-17 06:51:20 +01006489 IMPORTANT NOTE: historically in HTTP/1.x, the vast majority of requests sent
6490 by browsers use the "origin form", which differs from the "absolute form" in
6491 that they do not contain a scheme nor authority in the URI portion. Mostly
6492 only requests sent to proxies, those forged by hand and some emitted by
6493 certain applications use the absolute form. As such, "replace-uri" usually
6494 works fine most of the time in HTTP/1.x with rules starting with a "/". But
6495 with HTTP/2, clients are encouraged to send absolute URIs only, which look
6496 like the ones HTTP/1 clients use to talk to proxies. Such partial replace-uri
6497 rules may then fail in HTTP/2 when they work in HTTP/1. Either the rules need
Willy Tarreau262c3f12019-12-17 06:52:51 +01006498 to be adapted to optionally match a scheme and authority, or replace-path
6499 should be used.
Willy Tarreau33810222019-06-12 17:44:02 +02006500
Willy Tarreau62b59132019-12-17 06:51:20 +01006501 Example:
6502 # rewrite all "http" absolute requests to "https":
6503 http-request replace-uri ^http://(.*) https://\1
Willy Tarreau33810222019-06-12 17:44:02 +02006504
Willy Tarreau62b59132019-12-17 06:51:20 +01006505 # prefix /foo : turn /bar?q=1 into /foo/bar?q=1 :
6506 http-request replace-uri ([^/:]*://[^/]*)?(.*) \1/foo\2
Willy Tarreau33810222019-06-12 17:44:02 +02006507
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006508http-request replace-value <name> <match-regex> <replace-fmt>
6509 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreau09448f72014-06-25 18:12:15 +02006510
Tim Duesterhus2252beb2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01006511 This works like "replace-header" except that it matches the regex against
6512 every comma-delimited value of the header field <name> instead of the
6513 entire header. This is suited for all headers which are allowed to carry
6514 more than one value. An example could be the Accept header.
Willy Tarreau09448f72014-06-25 18:12:15 +02006515
Tim Duesterhus2252beb2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01006516 Example:
6517 http-request replace-value X-Forwarded-For ^192\.168\.(.*)$ 172.16.\1
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +02006518
Tim Duesterhus2252beb2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01006519 # applied to:
6520 X-Forwarded-For: 192.168.10.1, 192.168.13.24, 10.0.0.37
Thierry FOURNIERe0627bd2015-08-04 08:20:33 +02006521
Tim Duesterhus2252beb2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01006522 # outputs:
6523 X-Forwarded-For: 172.16.10.1, 172.16.13.24, 10.0.0.37
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +01006524
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01006525http-request return [status <code>] [content-type <type>]
6526 [ { default-errorfiles | errorfile <file> | errorfiles <name> |
6527 file <file> | lf-file <file> | string <str> | lf-string <fmt> } ]
Christopher Faulet4a2c1422020-01-31 17:36:01 +01006528 [ hdr <name> <fmt> ]*
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01006529 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6530
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +05006531 This stops the evaluation of the rules and immediately returns a response. The
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01006532 default status code used for the response is 200. It can be optionally
6533 specified as an arguments to "status". The response content-type may also be
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -04006534 specified as an argument to "content-type". Finally the response itself may
Sébastien Grossab877122020-10-08 10:06:03 +02006535 be defined. It can be a full HTTP response specifying the errorfile to use,
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +05006536 or the response payload specifying the file or the string to use. These rules
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01006537 are followed to create the response :
6538
6539 * If neither the errorfile nor the payload to use is defined, a dummy
6540 response is returned. Only the "status" argument is considered. It can be
6541 any code in the range [200, 599]. The "content-type" argument, if any, is
6542 ignored.
6543
6544 * If "default-errorfiles" argument is set, the proxy's errorfiles are
6545 considered. If the "status" argument is defined, it must be one of the
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04006546 status code handled by HAProxy (200, 400, 403, 404, 405, 408, 410, 413,
Christopher Faulete095f312020-12-07 11:22:24 +01006547 425, 429, 500, 501, 502, 503, and 504). The "content-type" argument, if
6548 any, is ignored.
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01006549
6550 * If a specific errorfile is defined, with an "errorfile" argument, the
6551 corresponding file, containing a full HTTP response, is returned. Only the
6552 "status" argument is considered. It must be one of the status code handled
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04006553 by HAProxy (200, 400, 403, 404, 405, 408, 410, 413, 425, 429, 500, 501,
Christopher Faulete095f312020-12-07 11:22:24 +01006554 502, 503, and 504). The "content-type" argument, if any, is ignored.
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01006555
6556 * If an http-errors section is defined, with an "errorfiles" argument, the
6557 corresponding file in the specified http-errors section, containing a full
6558 HTTP response, is returned. Only the "status" argument is considered. It
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04006559 must be one of the status code handled by HAProxy (200, 400, 403, 404, 405,
Christopher Faulete095f312020-12-07 11:22:24 +01006560 408, 410, 413, 425, 429, 500, 501, 502, 503, and 504). The "content-type"
Anthonin Bonnefoy85048f82020-06-22 09:17:01 +02006561 argument, if any, is ignored.
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01006562
6563 * If a "file" or a "lf-file" argument is specified, the file's content is
6564 used as the response payload. If the file is not empty, its content-type
6565 must be set as argument to "content-type". Otherwise, any "content-type"
6566 argument is ignored. With a "lf-file" argument, the file's content is
6567 evaluated as a log-format string. With a "file" argument, it is considered
6568 as a raw content.
6569
6570 * If a "string" or "lf-string" argument is specified, the defined string is
6571 used as the response payload. The content-type must always be set as
6572 argument to "content-type". With a "lf-string" argument, the string is
6573 evaluated as a log-format string. With a "string" argument, it is
6574 considered as a raw string.
6575
Sébastien Grossab877122020-10-08 10:06:03 +02006576 When the response is not based on an errorfile, it is possible to append HTTP
Christopher Faulet4a2c1422020-01-31 17:36:01 +01006577 header fields to the response using "hdr" arguments. Otherwise, all "hdr"
6578 arguments are ignored. For each one, the header name is specified in <name>
6579 and its value is defined by <fmt> which follows the log-format rules.
6580
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01006581 Note that the generated response must be smaller than a buffer. And to avoid
6582 any warning, when an errorfile or a raw file is loaded, the buffer space
Sébastien Grossab877122020-10-08 10:06:03 +02006583 reserved for the headers rewriting should also be free.
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01006584
6585 No further "http-request" rules are evaluated.
6586
6587 Example:
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -04006588 http-request return errorfile /etc/haproxy/errorfiles/200.http \
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01006589 if { path /ping }
6590
6591 http-request return content-type image/x-icon file /var/www/favicon.ico \
6592 if { path /favicon.ico }
6593
6594 http-request return status 403 content-type text/plain \
6595 lf-string "Access denied. IP %[src] is blacklisted." \
6596 if { src -f /etc/haproxy/blacklist.lst }
6597
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006598http-request sc-inc-gpc0(<sc-id>) [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6599http-request sc-inc-gpc1(<sc-id>) [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02006600
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006601 This actions increments the GPC0 or GPC1 counter according with the sticky
6602 counter designated by <sc-id>. If an error occurs, this action silently fails
6603 and the actions evaluation continues.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02006604
Cédric Dufour0d7712d2019-11-06 18:38:53 +01006605http-request sc-set-gpt0(<sc-id>) { <int> | <expr> }
6606 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02006607
Cédric Dufour0d7712d2019-11-06 18:38:53 +01006608 This action sets the 32-bit unsigned GPT0 tag according to the sticky counter
6609 designated by <sc-id> and the value of <int>/<expr>. The expected result is a
6610 boolean. If an error occurs, this action silently fails and the actions
6611 evaluation continues.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02006612
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006613http-request set-dst <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02006614
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006615 This is used to set the destination IP address to the value of specified
6616 expression. Useful when a proxy in front of HAProxy rewrites destination IP,
6617 but provides the correct IP in a HTTP header; or you want to mask the IP for
6618 privacy. If you want to connect to the new address/port, use '0.0.0.0:0' as a
6619 server address in the backend.
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +01006620
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006621 Arguments:
6622 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch followed
6623 by some converters.
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +01006624
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006625 Example:
6626 http-request set-dst hdr(x-dst)
6627 http-request set-dst dst,ipmask(24)
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +01006628
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006629 When possible, set-dst preserves the original destination port as long as the
6630 address family allows it, otherwise the destination port is set to 0.
Adis Nezirovic2fbcafc2015-07-06 15:44:30 +02006631
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006632http-request set-dst-port <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Adis Nezirovic2fbcafc2015-07-06 15:44:30 +02006633
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006634 This is used to set the destination port address to the value of specified
6635 expression. If you want to connect to the new address/port, use '0.0.0.0:0'
6636 as a server address in the backend.
Adis Nezirovic2fbcafc2015-07-06 15:44:30 +02006637
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006638 Arguments:
6639 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
6640 followed by some converters.
Adis Nezirovic2fbcafc2015-07-06 15:44:30 +02006641
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006642 Example:
6643 http-request set-dst-port hdr(x-port)
6644 http-request set-dst-port int(4000)
Adis Nezirovic2fbcafc2015-07-06 15:44:30 +02006645
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006646 When possible, set-dst-port preserves the original destination address as
6647 long as the address family supports a port, otherwise it forces the
6648 destination address to IPv4 "0.0.0.0" before rewriting the port.
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +02006649
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006650http-request set-header <name> <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +02006651
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006652 This does the same as "http-request add-header" except that the header name
6653 is first removed if it existed. This is useful when passing security
6654 information to the server, where the header must not be manipulated by
6655 external users. Note that the new value is computed before the removal so it
6656 is possible to concatenate a value to an existing header.
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +02006657
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006658 Example:
6659 http-request set-header X-Haproxy-Current-Date %T
6660 http-request set-header X-SSL %[ssl_fc]
6661 http-request set-header X-SSL-Session_ID %[ssl_fc_session_id,hex]
6662 http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-Verify %[ssl_c_verify]
6663 http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-DN %{+Q}[ssl_c_s_dn]
6664 http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-CN %{+Q}[ssl_c_s_dn(cn)]
6665 http-request set-header X-SSL-Issuer %{+Q}[ssl_c_i_dn]
6666 http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-NotBefore %{+Q}[ssl_c_notbefore]
6667 http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-NotAfter %{+Q}[ssl_c_notafter]
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +02006668
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006669http-request set-log-level <level> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +02006670
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006671 This is used to change the log level of the current request when a certain
6672 condition is met. Valid levels are the 8 syslog levels (see the "log"
6673 keyword) plus the special level "silent" which disables logging for this
6674 request. This rule is not final so the last matching rule wins. This rule
6675 can be useful to disable health checks coming from another equipment.
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +02006676
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006677http-request set-map(<file-name>) <key fmt> <value fmt>
6678 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +02006679
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006680 This is used to add a new entry into a MAP. The MAP must be loaded from a
6681 file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the MAP to be updated is
6682 passed between parentheses. It takes 2 arguments: <key fmt>, which follows
6683 log-format rules, used to collect MAP key, and <value fmt>, which follows
6684 log-format rules, used to collect content for the new entry.
6685 It performs a lookup in the MAP before insertion, to avoid duplicated (or
6686 more) values. This lookup is done by a linear search and can be expensive
6687 with large lists! It is the equivalent of the "set map" command from the
6688 stats socket, but can be triggered by an HTTP request.
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +02006689
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006690http-request set-mark <mark> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +02006691
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006692 This is used to set the Netfilter MARK on all packets sent to the client to
6693 the value passed in <mark> on platforms which support it. This value is an
6694 unsigned 32 bit value which can be matched by netfilter and by the routing
6695 table. It can be expressed both in decimal or hexadecimal format (prefixed by
6696 "0x"). This can be useful to force certain packets to take a different route
6697 (for example a cheaper network path for bulk downloads). This works on Linux
6698 kernels 2.6.32 and above and requires admin privileges.
Willy Tarreau00005ce2016-10-21 15:07:45 +02006699
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006700http-request set-method <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +02006701
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006702 This rewrites the request method with the result of the evaluation of format
6703 string <fmt>. There should be very few valid reasons for having to do so as
6704 this is more likely to break something than to fix it.
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +02006705
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006706http-request set-nice <nice> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +02006707
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006708 This sets the "nice" factor of the current request being processed. It only
6709 has effect against the other requests being processed at the same time.
6710 The default value is 0, unless altered by the "nice" setting on the "bind"
6711 line. The accepted range is -1024..1024. The higher the value, the nicest
6712 the request will be. Lower values will make the request more important than
6713 other ones. This can be useful to improve the speed of some requests, or
6714 lower the priority of non-important requests. Using this setting without
6715 prior experimentation can cause some major slowdown.
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +02006716
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006717http-request set-path <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreau00005ce2016-10-21 15:07:45 +02006718
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006719 This rewrites the request path with the result of the evaluation of format
6720 string <fmt>. The query string, if any, is left intact. If a scheme and
6721 authority is found before the path, they are left intact as well. If the
6722 request doesn't have a path ("*"), this one is replaced with the format.
6723 This can be used to prepend a directory component in front of a path for
6724 example. See also "http-request set-query" and "http-request set-uri".
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +02006725
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006726 Example :
6727 # prepend the host name before the path
6728 http-request set-path /%[hdr(host)]%[path]
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +02006729
Christopher Faulet312294f2020-09-02 17:17:44 +02006730http-request set-pathq <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6731
6732 This does the same as "http-request set-path" except that the query-string is
6733 also rewritten. It may be used to remove the query-string, including the
6734 question mark (it is not possible using "http-request set-query").
6735
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006736http-request set-priority-class <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Olivier Houchardccaa7de2017-10-02 11:51:03 +02006737
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006738 This is used to set the queue priority class of the current request.
6739 The value must be a sample expression which converts to an integer in the
6740 range -2047..2047. Results outside this range will be truncated.
6741 The priority class determines the order in which queued requests are
6742 processed. Lower values have higher priority.
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +02006743
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006744http-request set-priority-offset <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +02006745
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006746 This is used to set the queue priority timestamp offset of the current
6747 request. The value must be a sample expression which converts to an integer
6748 in the range -524287..524287. Results outside this range will be truncated.
6749 When a request is queued, it is ordered first by the priority class, then by
6750 the current timestamp adjusted by the given offset in milliseconds. Lower
6751 values have higher priority.
6752 Note that the resulting timestamp is is only tracked with enough precision
6753 for 524,287ms (8m44s287ms). If the request is queued long enough to where the
6754 adjusted timestamp exceeds this value, it will be misidentified as highest
6755 priority. Thus it is important to set "timeout queue" to a value, where when
6756 combined with the offset, does not exceed this limit.
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +02006757
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006758http-request set-query <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01006759
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006760 This rewrites the request's query string which appears after the first
6761 question mark ("?") with the result of the evaluation of format string <fmt>.
6762 The part prior to the question mark is left intact. If the request doesn't
6763 contain a question mark and the new value is not empty, then one is added at
6764 the end of the URI, followed by the new value. If a question mark was
6765 present, it will never be removed even if the value is empty. This can be
6766 used to add or remove parameters from the query string.
Ruoshan Huangeb5a3632015-12-08 21:00:23 +08006767
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006768 See also "http-request set-query" and "http-request set-uri".
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01006769
6770 Example:
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006771 # replace "%3D" with "=" in the query string
6772 http-request set-query %[query,regsub(%3D,=,g)]
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01006773
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006774http-request set-src <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6775 This is used to set the source IP address to the value of specified
6776 expression. Useful when a proxy in front of HAProxy rewrites source IP, but
6777 provides the correct IP in a HTTP header; or you want to mask source IP for
Olivier Doucet56e31202020-04-21 09:32:56 +02006778 privacy. All subsequent calls to "src" fetch will return this value
6779 (see example).
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006780
6781 Arguments :
6782 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch followed
6783 by some converters.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01006784
Olivier Doucet56e31202020-04-21 09:32:56 +02006785 See also "option forwardfor".
6786
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01006787 Example:
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006788 http-request set-src hdr(x-forwarded-for)
6789 http-request set-src src,ipmask(24)
6790
Olivier Doucet56e31202020-04-21 09:32:56 +02006791 # After the masking this will track connections
6792 # based on the IP address with the last byte zeroed out.
6793 http-request track-sc0 src
6794
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006795 When possible, set-src preserves the original source port as long as the
6796 address family allows it, otherwise the source port is set to 0.
6797
6798http-request set-src-port <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6799
6800 This is used to set the source port address to the value of specified
6801 expression.
6802
6803 Arguments:
6804 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch followed
6805 by some converters.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01006806
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01006807 Example:
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006808 http-request set-src-port hdr(x-port)
6809 http-request set-src-port int(4000)
6810
6811 When possible, set-src-port preserves the original source address as long as
6812 the address family supports a port, otherwise it forces the source address to
6813 IPv4 "0.0.0.0" before rewriting the port.
6814
Alex59c53352021-04-27 12:57:07 +02006815http-request set-timeout { server | tunnel } { <timeout> | <expr> }
Amaury Denoyelle8d228232020-12-10 13:43:54 +01006816 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6817
6818 This action overrides the specified "server" or "tunnel" timeout for the
6819 current stream only. The timeout can be specified in millisecond or with any
6820 other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit as explained at the top of
6821 this document. It is also possible to write an expression which must returns
6822 a number interpreted as a timeout in millisecond.
6823
6824 Note that the server/tunnel timeouts are only relevant on the backend side
6825 and thus this rule is only available for the proxies with backend
6826 capabilities. Also the timeout value must be non-null to obtain the expected
6827 results.
6828
6829 Example:
Alex59c53352021-04-27 12:57:07 +02006830 http-request set-timeout tunnel 5s
6831 http-request set-timeout server req.hdr(host),map_int(host.lst)
Amaury Denoyelle8d228232020-12-10 13:43:54 +01006832
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006833http-request set-tos <tos> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6834
6835 This is used to set the TOS or DSCP field value of packets sent to the client
6836 to the value passed in <tos> on platforms which support this. This value
6837 represents the whole 8 bits of the IP TOS field, and can be expressed both in
6838 decimal or hexadecimal format (prefixed by "0x"). Note that only the 6 higher
6839 bits are used in DSCP or TOS, and the two lower bits are always 0. This can
6840 be used to adjust some routing behavior on border routers based on some
6841 information from the request.
6842
6843 See RFC 2474, 2597, 3260 and 4594 for more information.
6844
6845http-request set-uri <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6846
6847 This rewrites the request URI with the result of the evaluation of format
6848 string <fmt>. The scheme, authority, path and query string are all replaced
Christopher Faulete6794272022-11-22 15:41:48 +01006849 at once. This can be used to rewrite hosts in front of proxies, or to perform
6850 complex modifications to the URI such as moving parts between the path and
6851 the query string. If an absolute URI is set, it will be sent as is to
6852 HTTP/1.1 servers. If it is not the desired behavior, the host, the path
6853 and/or the query string should be set separately.
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006854 See also "http-request set-path" and "http-request set-query".
6855
6856http-request set-var(<var-name>) <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6857
6858 This is used to set the contents of a variable. The variable is declared
6859 inline.
6860
6861 Arguments:
6862 <var-name> The name of the variable starts with an indication about its
6863 scope. The scopes allowed are:
6864 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
6865 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
6866 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction
6867 (request and response)
6868 "req" : the variable is shared only during request
6869 processing
6870 "res" : the variable is shared only during response
6871 processing
6872 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'.
6873 The name may only contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9'
6874 and '_'.
6875
6876 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
6877 followed by some converters.
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01006878
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02006879 Example:
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006880 http-request set-var(req.my_var) req.fhdr(user-agent),lower
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02006881
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006882http-request send-spoe-group <engine-name> <group-name>
6883 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02006884
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006885 This action is used to trigger sending of a group of SPOE messages. To do so,
6886 the SPOE engine used to send messages must be defined, as well as the SPOE
6887 group to send. Of course, the SPOE engine must refer to an existing SPOE
6888 filter. If not engine name is provided on the SPOE filter line, the SPOE
6889 agent name must be used.
6890
6891 Arguments:
6892 <engine-name> The SPOE engine name.
6893
6894 <group-name> The SPOE group name as specified in the engine
6895 configuration.
6896
6897http-request silent-drop [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6898
6899 This stops the evaluation of the rules and makes the client-facing connection
6900 suddenly disappear using a system-dependent way that tries to prevent the
6901 client from being notified. The effect it then that the client still sees an
6902 established connection while there's none on HAProxy. The purpose is to
6903 achieve a comparable effect to "tarpit" except that it doesn't use any local
6904 resource at all on the machine running HAProxy. It can resist much higher
6905 loads than "tarpit", and slow down stronger attackers. It is important to
6906 understand the impact of using this mechanism. All stateful equipment placed
6907 between the client and HAProxy (firewalls, proxies, load balancers) will also
6908 keep the established connection for a long time and may suffer from this
6909 action.
6910 On modern Linux systems running with enough privileges, the TCP_REPAIR socket
6911 option is used to block the emission of a TCP reset. On other systems, the
6912 socket's TTL is reduced to 1 so that the TCP reset doesn't pass the first
6913 router, though it's still delivered to local networks. Do not use it unless
6914 you fully understand how it works.
6915
Christopher Faulet46f95542019-12-20 10:07:22 +01006916http-request strict-mode { on | off }
6917
6918 This enables or disables the strict rewriting mode for following rules. It
6919 does not affect rules declared before it and it is only applicable on rules
6920 performing a rewrite on the requests. When the strict mode is enabled, any
6921 rewrite failure triggers an internal error. Otherwise, such errors are
6922 silently ignored. The purpose of the strict rewriting mode is to make some
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +05006923 rewrites optional while others must be performed to continue the request
Christopher Faulet46f95542019-12-20 10:07:22 +01006924 processing.
6925
Christopher Faulet1aea50e2020-01-17 16:03:53 +01006926 By default, the strict rewriting mode is enabled. Its value is also reset
Christopher Faulet46f95542019-12-20 10:07:22 +01006927 when a ruleset evaluation ends. So, for instance, if you change the mode on
6928 the frontend, the default mode is restored when HAProxy starts the backend
6929 rules evaluation.
6930
Christopher Faulet5cb513a2020-05-13 17:56:56 +02006931http-request tarpit [deny_status <status>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6932http-request tarpit [ { status | deny_status } <code>] [content-type <type>]
6933 [ { default-errorfiles | errorfile <file> | errorfiles <name> |
6934 file <file> | lf-file <file> | string <str> | lf-string <fmt> } ]
6935 [ hdr <name> <fmt> ]*
6936 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006937
6938 This stops the evaluation of the rules and immediately blocks the request
6939 without responding for a delay specified by "timeout tarpit" or
6940 "timeout connect" if the former is not set. After that delay, if the client
Christopher Faulet5cb513a2020-05-13 17:56:56 +02006941 is still connected, a response is returned so that the client does not
6942 suspect it has been tarpitted. Logs will report the flags "PT". The goal of
6943 the tarpit rule is to slow down robots during an attack when they're limited
6944 on the number of concurrent requests. It can be very efficient against very
6945 dumb robots, and will significantly reduce the load on firewalls compared to
6946 a "deny" rule. But when facing "correctly" developed robots, it can make
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04006947 things worse by forcing HAProxy and the front firewall to support insane
Christopher Faulet5cb513a2020-05-13 17:56:56 +02006948 number of concurrent connections. By default an HTTP error 500 is returned.
6949 But the response may be customized using same syntax than
6950 "http-request return" rules. Thus, see "http-request return" for details.
Ilya Shipitsin11057a32020-06-21 21:18:27 +05006951 For compatibility purpose, when no argument is defined, or only "deny_status",
Christopher Faulet5cb513a2020-05-13 17:56:56 +02006952 the argument "default-errorfiles" is implied. It means
6953 "http-request tarpit [deny_status <status>]" is an alias of
6954 "http-request tarpit [status <status>] default-errorfiles".
6955 No further "http-request" rules are evaluated.
6956 See also "http-request return" and "http-request silent-drop".
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006957
6958http-request track-sc0 <key> [table <table>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6959http-request track-sc1 <key> [table <table>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6960http-request track-sc2 <key> [table <table>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6961
6962 This enables tracking of sticky counters from current request. These rules do
6963 not stop evaluation and do not change default action. The number of counters
6964 that may be simultaneously tracked by the same connection is set in
6965 MAX_SESS_STKCTR at build time (reported in haproxy -vv) which defaults to 3,
Matteo Contrini1857b8c2020-10-16 17:35:54 +02006966 so the track-sc number is between 0 and (MAX_SESS_STKCTR-1). The first
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006967 "track-sc0" rule executed enables tracking of the counters of the specified
6968 table as the first set. The first "track-sc1" rule executed enables tracking
6969 of the counters of the specified table as the second set. The first
6970 "track-sc2" rule executed enables tracking of the counters of the specified
6971 table as the third set. It is a recommended practice to use the first set of
6972 counters for the per-frontend counters and the second set for the per-backend
6973 ones. But this is just a guideline, all may be used everywhere.
6974
6975 Arguments :
6976 <key> is mandatory, and is a sample expression rule as described in
6977 section 7.3. It describes what elements of the incoming request or
6978 connection will be analyzed, extracted, combined, and used to
6979 select which table entry to update the counters.
6980
6981 <table> is an optional table to be used instead of the default one, which
6982 is the stick-table declared in the current proxy. All the counters
6983 for the matches and updates for the key will then be performed in
6984 that table until the session ends.
6985
6986 Once a "track-sc*" rule is executed, the key is looked up in the table and if
6987 it is not found, an entry is allocated for it. Then a pointer to that entry
6988 is kept during all the session's life, and this entry's counters are updated
6989 as often as possible, every time the session's counters are updated, and also
6990 systematically when the session ends. Counters are only updated for events
6991 that happen after the tracking has been started. As an exception, connection
6992 counters and request counters are systematically updated so that they reflect
6993 useful information.
6994
6995 If the entry tracks concurrent connection counters, one connection is counted
6996 for as long as the entry is tracked, and the entry will not expire during
6997 that time. Tracking counters also provides a performance advantage over just
6998 checking the keys, because only one table lookup is performed for all ACL
6999 checks that make use of it.
7000
7001http-request unset-var(<var-name>) [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
7002
7003 This is used to unset a variable. See above for details about <var-name>.
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02007004
7005 Example:
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02007006 http-request unset-var(req.my_var)
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02007007
Christopher Faulet579d83b2019-11-22 15:34:17 +01007008http-request use-service <service-name> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
7009
7010 This directive executes the configured HTTP service to reply to the request
7011 and stops the evaluation of the rules. An HTTP service may choose to reply by
7012 sending any valid HTTP response or it may immediately close the connection
7013 without sending any response. Outside natives services, for instance the
7014 Prometheus exporter, it is possible to write your own services in Lua. No
7015 further "http-request" rules are evaluated.
7016
7017 Arguments :
7018 <service-name> is mandatory. It is the service to call
7019
7020 Example:
7021 http-request use-service prometheus-exporter if { path /metrics }
7022
Christopher Faulet021a8e42021-03-29 10:46:38 +02007023http-request wait-for-body time <time> [ at-least <bytes> ]
7024 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
7025
7026 This will delay the processing of the request waiting for the payload for at
7027 most <time> milliseconds. if "at-least" argument is specified, HAProxy stops
7028 to wait the payload when the first <bytes> bytes are received. 0 means no
7029 limit, it is the default value. Regardless the "at-least" argument value,
7030 HAProxy stops to wait if the whole payload is received or if the request
7031 buffer is full. This action may be used as a replacement to "option
7032 http-buffer-request".
7033
7034 Arguments :
7035
7036 <time> is mandatory. It is the maximum time to wait for the body. It
7037 follows the HAProxy time format and is expressed in milliseconds.
7038
7039 <bytes> is optional. It is the minimum payload size to receive to stop to
Ilya Shipitsinb2be9a12021-04-24 13:25:42 +05007040 wait. It follows the HAProxy size format and is expressed in
Christopher Faulet021a8e42021-03-29 10:46:38 +02007041 bytes.
7042
7043 Example:
7044 http-request wait-for-body time 1s at-least 1k if METH_POST
7045
7046 See also : "option http-buffer-request"
7047
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02007048http-request wait-for-handshake [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02007049
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02007050 This will delay the processing of the request until the SSL handshake
7051 happened. This is mostly useful to delay processing early data until we're
7052 sure they are valid.
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02007053
Willy Tarreauef781042010-01-27 11:53:01 +01007054
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007055http-response <action> <options...> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02007056 Access control for Layer 7 responses
7057
7058 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7059 no | yes | yes | yes
7060
7061 The http-response statement defines a set of rules which apply to layer 7
7062 processing. The rules are evaluated in their declaration order when they are
7063 met in a frontend, listen or backend section. Any rule may optionally be
7064 followed by an ACL-based condition, in which case it will only be evaluated
7065 if the condition is true. Since these rules apply on responses, the backend
7066 rules are applied first, followed by the frontend's rules.
7067
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007068 The first keyword is the rule's action. The supported actions are described
7069 below.
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02007070
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007071 There is no limit to the number of http-response statements per instance.
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02007072
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007073 Example:
7074 acl key_acl res.hdr(X-Acl-Key) -m found
Thierry FOURNIERdad3d1d2014-04-22 18:07:25 +02007075
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007076 acl myhost hdr(Host) -f myhost.lst
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06007077
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007078 http-response add-acl(myhost.lst) %[res.hdr(X-Acl-Key)] if key_acl
7079 http-response del-acl(myhost.lst) %[res.hdr(X-Acl-Key)] if key_acl
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06007080
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007081 Example:
7082 acl value res.hdr(X-Value) -m found
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06007083
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007084 use_backend bk_appli if { hdr(Host),map_str(map.lst) -m found }
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06007085
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007086 http-response set-map(map.lst) %[src] %[res.hdr(X-Value)] if value
7087 http-response del-map(map.lst) %[src] if ! value
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06007088
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007089 See also : "http-request", section 3.4 about userlists and section 7 about
7090 ACL usage.
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06007091
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007092http-response add-acl(<file-name>) <key fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06007093
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007094 This is used to add a new entry into an ACL. The ACL must be loaded from a
7095 file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the ACL to be updated is
7096 passed between parentheses. It takes one argument: <key fmt>, which follows
7097 log-format rules, to collect content of the new entry. It performs a lookup
7098 in the ACL before insertion, to avoid duplicated (or more) values.
7099 This lookup is done by a linear search and can be expensive with large lists!
7100 It is the equivalent of the "add acl" command from the stats socket, but can
7101 be triggered by an HTTP response.
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06007102
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007103http-response add-header <name> <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06007104
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007105 This appends an HTTP header field whose name is specified in <name> and whose
7106 value is defined by <fmt> which follows the log-format rules (see Custom Log
7107 Format in section 8.2.4). This may be used to send a cookie to a client for
7108 example, or to pass some internal information.
7109 This rule is not final, so it is possible to add other similar rules.
7110 Note that header addition is performed immediately, so one rule might reuse
7111 the resulting header from a previous rule.
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06007112
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007113http-response allow [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06007114
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007115 This stops the evaluation of the rules and lets the response pass the check.
7116 No further "http-response" rules are evaluated for the current section.
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06007117
Jarno Huuskonen251a6b72019-01-04 14:05:02 +02007118http-response cache-store <name> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06007119
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +02007120 See section 6.2 about cache setup.
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06007121
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007122http-response capture <sample> id <id> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06007123
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007124 This captures sample expression <sample> from the response buffer, and
7125 converts it to a string. The resulting string is stored into the next request
7126 "capture" slot, so it will possibly appear next to some captured HTTP
7127 headers. It will then automatically appear in the logs, and it will be
7128 possible to extract it using sample fetch rules to feed it into headers or
7129 anything. Please check section 7.3 (Fetching samples) and
7130 "capture response header" for more information.
Thierry FOURNIER35d70ef2015-08-26 16:21:56 +02007131
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007132 The keyword "id" is the id of the capture slot which is used for storing the
7133 string. The capture slot must be defined in an associated frontend.
7134 This is useful to run captures in backends. The slot id can be declared by a
7135 previous directive "http-response capture" or with the "declare capture"
7136 keyword.
Baptiste Assmann19a69b32020-01-16 14:34:22 +01007137
7138 When using this action in a backend, double check that the relevant
7139 frontend(s) have the required capture slots otherwise, this rule will be
7140 ignored at run time. This can't be detected at configuration parsing time
7141 due to HAProxy's ability to dynamically resolve backend name at runtime.
Thierry FOURNIER35d70ef2015-08-26 16:21:56 +02007142
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007143http-response del-acl(<file-name>) <key fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Thierry FOURNIER35d70ef2015-08-26 16:21:56 +02007144
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007145 This is used to delete an entry from an ACL. The ACL must be loaded from a
7146 file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the ACL to be updated is
7147 passed between parentheses. It takes one argument: <key fmt>, which follows
7148 log-format rules, to collect content of the entry to delete.
7149 It is the equivalent of the "del acl" command from the stats socket, but can
7150 be triggered by an HTTP response.
Willy Tarreauf4c43c12013-06-11 17:01:13 +02007151
Maciej Zdebebdd4c52020-11-20 13:58:48 +00007152http-response del-header <name> [ -m <meth> ] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreau9a355ec2013-06-11 17:45:46 +02007153
Maciej Zdebebdd4c52020-11-20 13:58:48 +00007154 This removes all HTTP header fields whose name is specified in <name>. <meth>
7155 is the matching method, applied on the header name. Supported matching methods
7156 are "str" (exact match), "beg" (prefix match), "end" (suffix match), "sub"
7157 (substring match) and "reg" (regex match). If not specified, exact matching
7158 method is used.
Willy Tarreau42cf39e2013-06-11 18:51:32 +02007159
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007160http-response del-map(<file-name>) <key fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreau51347ed2013-06-11 19:34:13 +02007161
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007162 This is used to delete an entry from a MAP. The MAP must be loaded from a
7163 file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the MAP to be updated is
7164 passed between parentheses. It takes one argument: <key fmt>, which follows
7165 log-format rules, to collect content of the entry to delete.
7166 It takes one argument: "file name" It is the equivalent of the "del map"
7167 command from the stats socket, but can be triggered by an HTTP response.
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02007168
Christopher Faulet5cb513a2020-05-13 17:56:56 +02007169http-response deny [deny_status <status>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
7170http-response deny [ { status | deny_status } <code>] [content-type <type>]
7171 [ { default-errorfiles | errorfile <file> | errorfiles <name> |
7172 file <file> | lf-file <file> | string <str> | lf-string <fmt> } ]
7173 [ hdr <name> <fmt> ]*
7174 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02007175
Christopher Faulet5cb513a2020-05-13 17:56:56 +02007176 This stops the evaluation of the rules and immediately rejects the response.
7177 By default an HTTP 502 error is returned. But the response may be customized
7178 using same syntax than "http-response return" rules. Thus, see
Ilya Shipitsin11057a32020-06-21 21:18:27 +05007179 "http-response return" for details. For compatibility purpose, when no
Christopher Faulet5cb513a2020-05-13 17:56:56 +02007180 argument is defined, or only "deny_status", the argument "default-errorfiles"
7181 is implied. It means "http-response deny [deny_status <status>]" is an alias
7182 of "http-response deny [status <status>] default-errorfiles".
Christopher Faulet040c8cd2020-01-13 16:43:45 +01007183 No further "http-response" rules are evaluated.
Christopher Faulet5cb513a2020-05-13 17:56:56 +02007184 See also "http-response return".
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02007185
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007186http-response redirect <rule> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02007187
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007188 This performs an HTTP redirection based on a redirect rule.
7189 This supports a format string similarly to "http-request redirect" rules,
7190 with the exception that only the "location" type of redirect is possible on
7191 the response. See the "redirect" keyword for the rule's syntax. When a
7192 redirect rule is applied during a response, connections to the server are
7193 closed so that no data can be forwarded from the server to the client.
Thierry FOURNIERe80fada2015-05-26 18:06:31 +02007194
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007195http-response replace-header <name> <regex-match> <replace-fmt>
7196 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Thierry FOURNIERe80fada2015-05-26 18:06:31 +02007197
Tim Duesterhus2252beb2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01007198 This works like "http-request replace-header" except that it works on the
7199 server's response instead of the client's request.
William Lallemand86d0df02017-11-24 21:36:45 +01007200
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007201 Example:
7202 http-response replace-header Set-Cookie (C=[^;]*);(.*) \1;ip=%bi;\2
Willy Tarreau51d861a2015-05-22 17:30:48 +02007203
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007204 # applied to:
7205 Set-Cookie: C=1; expires=Tue, 14-Jun-2016 01:40:45 GMT
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02007206
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007207 # outputs:
7208 Set-Cookie: C=1;ip=192.168.1.20; expires=Tue, 14-Jun-2016 01:40:45 GMT
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02007209
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007210 # assuming the backend IP is 192.168.1.20.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02007211
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007212http-response replace-value <name> <regex-match> <replace-fmt>
7213 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02007214
Tim Duesterhus6bd909b2020-01-17 15:53:18 +01007215 This works like "http-request replace-value" except that it works on the
Tim Duesterhus2252beb2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01007216 server's response instead of the client's request.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02007217
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007218 Example:
7219 http-response replace-value Cache-control ^public$ private
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +01007220
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007221 # applied to:
7222 Cache-Control: max-age=3600, public
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +01007223
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007224 # outputs:
7225 Cache-Control: max-age=3600, private
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +01007226
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01007227http-response return [status <code>] [content-type <type>]
7228 [ { default-errorfiles | errorfile <file> | errorfiles <name> |
7229 file <file> | lf-file <file> | string <str> | lf-string <fmt> } ]
Christopher Faulet4a2c1422020-01-31 17:36:01 +01007230 [ hdr <name> <value> ]*
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01007231 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
7232
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +05007233 This stops the evaluation of the rules and immediately returns a response. The
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01007234 default status code used for the response is 200. It can be optionally
7235 specified as an arguments to "status". The response content-type may also be
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -04007236 specified as an argument to "content-type". Finally the response itself may
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01007237 be defined. If can be a full HTTP response specifying the errorfile to use,
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +05007238 or the response payload specifying the file or the string to use. These rules
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01007239 are followed to create the response :
7240
7241 * If neither the errorfile nor the payload to use is defined, a dummy
7242 response is returned. Only the "status" argument is considered. It can be
7243 any code in the range [200, 599]. The "content-type" argument, if any, is
7244 ignored.
7245
7246 * If "default-errorfiles" argument is set, the proxy's errorfiles are
7247 considered. If the "status" argument is defined, it must be one of the
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04007248 status code handled by HAProxy (200, 400, 403, 404, 405, 408, 410, 413,
Christopher Faulete095f312020-12-07 11:22:24 +01007249 425, 429, 500, 501, 502, 503, and 504). The "content-type" argument, if
7250 any, is ignored.
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01007251
7252 * If a specific errorfile is defined, with an "errorfile" argument, the
7253 corresponding file, containing a full HTTP response, is returned. Only the
7254 "status" argument is considered. It must be one of the status code handled
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04007255 by HAProxy (200, 400, 403, 404, 405, 408, 410, 413, 425, 429, 500, 501,
Christopher Faulete095f312020-12-07 11:22:24 +01007256 502, 503, and 504). The "content-type" argument, if any, is ignored.
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01007257
7258 * If an http-errors section is defined, with an "errorfiles" argument, the
7259 corresponding file in the specified http-errors section, containing a full
7260 HTTP response, is returned. Only the "status" argument is considered. It
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04007261 must be one of the status code handled by HAProxy (200, 400, 403, 404, 405,
Christopher Faulete095f312020-12-07 11:22:24 +01007262 408, 410, 413, 425, 429, 500, 501, 502, 503, and 504). The "content-type"
Anthonin Bonnefoy85048f82020-06-22 09:17:01 +02007263 argument, if any, is ignored.
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01007264
7265 * If a "file" or a "lf-file" argument is specified, the file's content is
7266 used as the response payload. If the file is not empty, its content-type
7267 must be set as argument to "content-type". Otherwise, any "content-type"
7268 argument is ignored. With a "lf-file" argument, the file's content is
7269 evaluated as a log-format string. With a "file" argument, it is considered
7270 as a raw content.
7271
7272 * If a "string" or "lf-string" argument is specified, the defined string is
7273 used as the response payload. The content-type must always be set as
7274 argument to "content-type". With a "lf-string" argument, the string is
7275 evaluated as a log-format string. With a "string" argument, it is
7276 considered as a raw string.
7277
Christopher Faulet4a2c1422020-01-31 17:36:01 +01007278 When the response is not based an errorfile, it is possible to appends HTTP
7279 header fields to the response using "hdr" arguments. Otherwise, all "hdr"
7280 arguments are ignored. For each one, the header name is specified in <name>
7281 and its value is defined by <fmt> which follows the log-format rules.
7282
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01007283 Note that the generated response must be smaller than a buffer. And to avoid
7284 any warning, when an errorfile or a raw file is loaded, the buffer space
Ilya Shipitsin11057a32020-06-21 21:18:27 +05007285 reserved to the headers rewriting should also be free.
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01007286
7287 No further "http-response" rules are evaluated.
7288
7289 Example:
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -04007290 http-response return errorfile /etc/haproxy/errorfiles/200.http \
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01007291 if { status eq 404 }
7292
7293 http-response return content-type text/plain \
7294 string "This is the end !" \
7295 if { status eq 500 }
7296
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007297http-response sc-inc-gpc0(<sc-id>) [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
7298http-response sc-inc-gpc1(<sc-id>) [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Ruoshan Huange4edc6b2016-07-14 15:07:45 +08007299
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007300 This action increments the GPC0 or GPC1 counter according with the sticky
7301 counter designated by <sc-id>. If an error occurs, this action silently fails
7302 and the actions evaluation continues.
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +02007303
Cédric Dufour0d7712d2019-11-06 18:38:53 +01007304http-response sc-set-gpt0(<sc-id>) { <int> | <expr> }
7305 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Thierry FOURNIERe0627bd2015-08-04 08:20:33 +02007306
Cédric Dufour0d7712d2019-11-06 18:38:53 +01007307 This action sets the 32-bit unsigned GPT0 tag according to the sticky counter
7308 designated by <sc-id> and the value of <int>/<expr>. The expected result is a
7309 boolean. If an error occurs, this action silently fails and the actions
7310 evaluation continues.
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +01007311
Christopher Faulet68fc3a12021-08-12 09:32:07 +02007312http-response send-spoe-group <engine-name> <group-name>
7313 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +02007314
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007315 This action is used to trigger sending of a group of SPOE messages. To do so,
7316 the SPOE engine used to send messages must be defined, as well as the SPOE
7317 group to send. Of course, the SPOE engine must refer to an existing SPOE
7318 filter. If not engine name is provided on the SPOE filter line, the SPOE
7319 agent name must be used.
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +02007320
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007321 Arguments:
7322 <engine-name> The SPOE engine name.
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +02007323
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007324 <group-name> The SPOE group name as specified in the engine
7325 configuration.
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +02007326
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007327http-response set-header <name> <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02007328
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007329 This does the same as "add-header" except that the header name is first
7330 removed if it existed. This is useful when passing security information to
7331 the server, where the header must not be manipulated by external users.
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02007332
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007333http-response set-log-level <level> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
7334
7335 This is used to change the log level of the current request when a certain
7336 condition is met. Valid levels are the 8 syslog levels (see the "log"
7337 keyword) plus the special level "silent" which disables logging for this
7338 request. This rule is not final so the last matching rule wins. This rule can
7339 be useful to disable health checks coming from another equipment.
7340
7341http-response set-map(<file-name>) <key fmt> <value fmt>
7342
7343 This is used to add a new entry into a MAP. The MAP must be loaded from a
7344 file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the MAP to be updated is
7345 passed between parentheses. It takes 2 arguments: <key fmt>, which follows
7346 log-format rules, used to collect MAP key, and <value fmt>, which follows
7347 log-format rules, used to collect content for the new entry. It performs a
7348 lookup in the MAP before insertion, to avoid duplicated (or more) values.
7349 This lookup is done by a linear search and can be expensive with large lists!
7350 It is the equivalent of the "set map" command from the stats socket, but can
7351 be triggered by an HTTP response.
7352
7353http-response set-mark <mark> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
7354
7355 This is used to set the Netfilter MARK on all packets sent to the client to
7356 the value passed in <mark> on platforms which support it. This value is an
7357 unsigned 32 bit value which can be matched by netfilter and by the routing
7358 table. It can be expressed both in decimal or hexadecimal format (prefixed
7359 by "0x"). This can be useful to force certain packets to take a different
7360 route (for example a cheaper network path for bulk downloads). This works on
7361 Linux kernels 2.6.32 and above and requires admin privileges.
7362
7363http-response set-nice <nice> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
7364
7365 This sets the "nice" factor of the current request being processed.
7366 It only has effect against the other requests being processed at the same
7367 time. The default value is 0, unless altered by the "nice" setting on the
7368 "bind" line. The accepted range is -1024..1024. The higher the value, the
7369 nicest the request will be. Lower values will make the request more important
7370 than other ones. This can be useful to improve the speed of some requests, or
7371 lower the priority of non-important requests. Using this setting without
7372 prior experimentation can cause some major slowdown.
7373
7374http-response set-status <status> [reason <str>]
7375 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
7376
7377 This replaces the response status code with <status> which must be an integer
7378 between 100 and 999. Optionally, a custom reason text can be provided defined
7379 by <str>, or the default reason for the specified code will be used as a
7380 fallback.
Ruoshan Huangeb5a3632015-12-08 21:00:23 +08007381
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02007382 Example:
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007383 # return "431 Request Header Fields Too Large"
7384 http-response set-status 431
7385 # return "503 Slow Down", custom reason
7386 http-response set-status 503 reason "Slow Down".
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02007387
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007388http-response set-tos <tos> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02007389
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007390 This is used to set the TOS or DSCP field value of packets sent to the client
7391 to the value passed in <tos> on platforms which support this.
7392 This value represents the whole 8 bits of the IP TOS field, and can be
7393 expressed both in decimal or hexadecimal format (prefixed by "0x"). Note that
7394 only the 6 higher bits are used in DSCP or TOS, and the two lower bits are
7395 always 0. This can be used to adjust some routing behavior on border routers
7396 based on some information from the request.
7397
7398 See RFC 2474, 2597, 3260 and 4594 for more information.
7399
7400http-response set-var(<var-name>) <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
7401
7402 This is used to set the contents of a variable. The variable is declared
7403 inline.
7404
7405 Arguments:
7406 <var-name> The name of the variable starts with an indication about its
7407 scope. The scopes allowed are:
7408 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
7409 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
7410 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction
7411 (request and response)
7412 "req" : the variable is shared only during request
7413 processing
7414 "res" : the variable is shared only during response
7415 processing
7416 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'.
7417 The name may only contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.'
7418 and '_'.
7419
7420 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
7421 followed by some converters.
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02007422
7423 Example:
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007424 http-response set-var(sess.last_redir) res.hdr(location)
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02007425
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007426http-response silent-drop [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02007427
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007428 This stops the evaluation of the rules and makes the client-facing connection
7429 suddenly disappear using a system-dependent way that tries to prevent the
7430 client from being notified. The effect it then that the client still sees an
7431 established connection while there's none on HAProxy. The purpose is to
7432 achieve a comparable effect to "tarpit" except that it doesn't use any local
7433 resource at all on the machine running HAProxy. It can resist much higher
7434 loads than "tarpit", and slow down stronger attackers. It is important to
7435 understand the impact of using this mechanism. All stateful equipment placed
7436 between the client and HAProxy (firewalls, proxies, load balancers) will also
7437 keep the established connection for a long time and may suffer from this
7438 action.
7439 On modern Linux systems running with enough privileges, the TCP_REPAIR socket
7440 option is used to block the emission of a TCP reset. On other systems, the
7441 socket's TTL is reduced to 1 so that the TCP reset doesn't pass the first
7442 router, though it's still delivered to local networks. Do not use it unless
7443 you fully understand how it works.
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02007444
Christopher Faulet46f95542019-12-20 10:07:22 +01007445http-response strict-mode { on | off }
7446
7447 This enables or disables the strict rewriting mode for following rules. It
7448 does not affect rules declared before it and it is only applicable on rules
7449 performing a rewrite on the responses. When the strict mode is enabled, any
7450 rewrite failure triggers an internal error. Otherwise, such errors are
7451 silently ignored. The purpose of the strict rewriting mode is to make some
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +05007452 rewrites optional while others must be performed to continue the response
Christopher Faulet46f95542019-12-20 10:07:22 +01007453 processing.
7454
Christopher Faulet1aea50e2020-01-17 16:03:53 +01007455 By default, the strict rewriting mode is enabled. Its value is also reset
Christopher Faulet46f95542019-12-20 10:07:22 +01007456 when a ruleset evaluation ends. So, for instance, if you change the mode on
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -04007457 the backend, the default mode is restored when HAProxy starts the frontend
Christopher Faulet46f95542019-12-20 10:07:22 +01007458 rules evaluation.
7459
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007460http-response track-sc0 <key> [table <table>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
7461http-response track-sc1 <key> [table <table>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
7462http-response track-sc2 <key> [table <table>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02007463
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007464 This enables tracking of sticky counters from current response. Please refer
7465 to "http-request track-sc" for a complete description. The only difference
7466 from "http-request track-sc" is the <key> sample expression can only make use
7467 of samples in response (e.g. res.*, status etc.) and samples below Layer 6
7468 (e.g. SSL-related samples, see section 7.3.4). If the sample is not
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04007469 supported, HAProxy will fail and warn while parsing the config.
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007470
7471http-response unset-var(<var-name>) [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
7472
7473 This is used to unset a variable. See "http-response set-var" for details
7474 about <var-name>.
7475
7476 Example:
7477 http-response unset-var(sess.last_redir)
7478
Christopher Faulet021a8e42021-03-29 10:46:38 +02007479http-response wait-for-body time <time> [ at-least <bytes> ]
7480 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
7481
7482 This will delay the processing of the response waiting for the payload for at
7483 most <time> milliseconds. if "at-least" argument is specified, HAProxy stops
7484 to wait the payload when the first <bytes> bytes are received. 0 means no
7485 limit, it is the default value. Regardless the "at-least" argument value,
7486 HAProxy stops to wait if the whole payload is received or if the response
7487 buffer is full.
7488
7489 Arguments :
7490
7491 <time> is mandatory. It is the maximum time to wait for the body. It
7492 follows the HAProxy time format and is expressed in milliseconds.
7493
7494 <bytes> is optional. It is the minimum payload size to receive to stop to
Ilya Shipitsinb2be9a12021-04-24 13:25:42 +05007495 wait. It follows the HAProxy size format and is expressed in
Christopher Faulet021a8e42021-03-29 10:46:38 +02007496 bytes.
7497
7498 Example:
7499 http-response wait-for-body time 1s at-least 10k
Baptiste Assmann5ecb77f2013-10-06 23:24:13 +02007500
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02007501http-reuse { never | safe | aggressive | always }
7502 Declare how idle HTTP connections may be shared between requests
7503
7504 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7505 yes | no | yes | yes
7506
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04007507 By default, a connection established between HAProxy and the backend server
Olivier Houchard86006a52018-12-14 19:37:49 +01007508 which is considered safe for reuse is moved back to the server's idle
7509 connections pool so that any other request can make use of it. This is the
7510 "safe" strategy below.
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02007511
7512 The argument indicates the desired connection reuse strategy :
7513
Olivier Houchard86006a52018-12-14 19:37:49 +01007514 - "never" : idle connections are never shared between sessions. This mode
7515 may be enforced to cancel a different strategy inherited from
7516 a defaults section or for troubleshooting. For example, if an
7517 old bogus application considers that multiple requests over
7518 the same connection come from the same client and it is not
7519 possible to fix the application, it may be desirable to
7520 disable connection sharing in a single backend. An example of
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04007521 such an application could be an old HAProxy using cookie
Olivier Houchard86006a52018-12-14 19:37:49 +01007522 insertion in tunnel mode and not checking any request past the
7523 first one.
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02007524
Olivier Houchard86006a52018-12-14 19:37:49 +01007525 - "safe" : this is the default and the recommended strategy. The first
7526 request of a session is always sent over its own connection,
7527 and only subsequent requests may be dispatched over other
7528 existing connections. This ensures that in case the server
7529 closes the connection when the request is being sent, the
7530 browser can decide to silently retry it. Since it is exactly
7531 equivalent to regular keep-alive, there should be no side
Amaury Denoyelle27179652020-10-14 18:17:12 +02007532 effects. There is also a special handling for the connections
7533 using protocols subject to Head-of-line blocking (backend with
7534 h2 or fcgi). In this case, when at least one stream is
7535 processed, the used connection is reserved to handle streams
7536 of the same session. When no more streams are processed, the
7537 connection is released and can be reused.
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02007538
7539 - "aggressive" : this mode may be useful in webservices environments where
7540 all servers are not necessarily known and where it would be
7541 appreciable to deliver most first requests over existing
7542 connections. In this case, first requests are only delivered
7543 over existing connections that have been reused at least once,
7544 proving that the server correctly supports connection reuse.
7545 It should only be used when it's sure that the client can
7546 retry a failed request once in a while and where the benefit
Michael Prokop4438c602019-05-24 10:25:45 +02007547 of aggressive connection reuse significantly outweighs the
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02007548 downsides of rare connection failures.
7549
7550 - "always" : this mode is only recommended when the path to the server is
7551 known for never breaking existing connections quickly after
7552 releasing them. It allows the first request of a session to be
7553 sent to an existing connection. This can provide a significant
7554 performance increase over the "safe" strategy when the backend
7555 is a cache farm, since such components tend to show a
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007556 consistent behavior and will benefit from the connection
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02007557 sharing. It is recommended that the "http-keep-alive" timeout
7558 remains low in this mode so that no dead connections remain
7559 usable. In most cases, this will lead to the same performance
7560 gains as "aggressive" but with more risks. It should only be
7561 used when it improves the situation over "aggressive".
7562
7563 When http connection sharing is enabled, a great care is taken to respect the
Amaury Denoyelled773a4e2021-01-29 15:18:49 +01007564 connection properties and compatibility. Indeed, some properties are specific
7565 and it is not possibly to reuse it blindly. Those are the SSL SNI, source
7566 and destination address and proxy protocol block. A connection is reused only
7567 if it shares the same set of properties with the request.
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02007568
Amaury Denoyelled773a4e2021-01-29 15:18:49 +01007569 Also note that connections with certain bogus authentication schemes (relying
7570 on the connection) like NTLM are marked private and never shared.
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02007571
Lukas Tribuse8adfeb2019-11-06 11:50:25 +01007572 A connection pool is involved and configurable with "pool-max-conn".
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02007573
7574 Note: connection reuse improves the accuracy of the "server maxconn" setting,
7575 because almost no new connection will be established while idle connections
7576 remain available. This is particularly true with the "always" strategy.
7577
Willy Tarreauee9afa22022-11-25 09:17:18 +01007578 The rules to decide to keep an idle connection opened or to close it after
7579 processing are also governed by the "tune.pool-low-fd-ratio" (default: 20%)
7580 and "tune.pool-high-fd-ratio" (default: 25%). These correspond to the
7581 percentage of total file descriptors spent in idle connections above which
7582 haproxy will respectively refrain from keeping a connection opened after a
7583 response, and actively kill idle connections. Some setups using a very high
7584 ratio of idle connections, either because of too low a global "maxconn", or
7585 due to a lot of HTTP/2 or HTTP/3 traffic on the frontend (few connections)
7586 but HTTP/1 connections on the backend, may observe a lower reuse rate because
7587 too few connections are kept open. It may be desirable in this case to adjust
7588 such thresholds or simply to increase the global "maxconn" value.
7589
7590 Similarly, when thread groups are explicitly enabled, it is important to
7591 understand that idle connections are only usable between threads from a same
7592 group. As such it may happen that unfair load between groups leads to more
7593 idle connections being needed, causing a lower reuse rate. The same solution
7594 may then be applied (increase global "maxconn" or increase pool ratios).
7595
7596 See also : "option http-keep-alive", "server maxconn", "thread-groups",
7597 "tune.pool-high-fd-ratio", "tune.pool-low-fd-ratio"
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02007598
7599
Mark Lamourinec2247f02012-01-04 13:02:01 -05007600http-send-name-header [<header>]
7601 Add the server name to a request. Use the header string given by <header>
Mark Lamourinec2247f02012-01-04 13:02:01 -05007602 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7603 yes | no | yes | yes
Mark Lamourinec2247f02012-01-04 13:02:01 -05007604 Arguments :
Mark Lamourinec2247f02012-01-04 13:02:01 -05007605 <header> The header string to use to send the server name
7606
Willy Tarreau81bef7e2019-10-07 14:58:02 +02007607 The "http-send-name-header" statement causes the header field named <header>
7608 to be set to the name of the target server at the moment the request is about
7609 to be sent on the wire. Any existing occurrences of this header are removed.
7610 Upon retries and redispatches, the header field is updated to always reflect
7611 the server being attempted to connect to. Given that this header is modified
7612 very late in the connection setup, it may have unexpected effects on already
7613 modified headers. For example using it with transport-level header such as
7614 connection, content-length, transfer-encoding and so on will likely result in
7615 invalid requests being sent to the server. Additionally it has been reported
7616 that this directive is currently being used as a way to overwrite the Host
7617 header field in outgoing requests; while this trick has been known to work
7618 as a side effect of the feature for some time, it is not officially supported
7619 and might possibly not work anymore in a future version depending on the
7620 technical difficulties this feature induces. A long-term solution instead
7621 consists in fixing the application which required this trick so that it binds
7622 to the correct host name.
Mark Lamourinec2247f02012-01-04 13:02:01 -05007623
7624 See also : "server"
7625
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif58a9622008-02-23 01:19:10 +01007626id <value>
Willy Tarreau53fb4ae2009-10-04 23:04:08 +02007627 Set a persistent ID to a proxy.
7628 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7629 no | yes | yes | yes
7630 Arguments : none
7631
7632 Set a persistent ID for the proxy. This ID must be unique and positive.
7633 An unused ID will automatically be assigned if unset. The first assigned
7634 value will be 1. This ID is currently only returned in statistics.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif58a9622008-02-23 01:19:10 +01007635
7636
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02007637ignore-persist { if | unless } <condition>
7638 Declare a condition to ignore persistence
7639 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Cyril Bonté4288c5a2018-03-12 22:02:59 +01007640 no | no | yes | yes
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02007641
7642 By default, when cookie persistence is enabled, every requests containing
7643 the cookie are unconditionally persistent (assuming the target server is up
7644 and running).
7645
7646 The "ignore-persist" statement allows one to declare various ACL-based
7647 conditions which, when met, will cause a request to ignore persistence.
7648 This is sometimes useful to load balance requests for static files, which
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03007649 often don't require persistence. This can also be used to fully disable
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02007650 persistence for a specific User-Agent (for example, some web crawler bots).
7651
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02007652 The persistence is ignored when an "if" condition is met, or unless an
7653 "unless" condition is met.
7654
Jarno Huuskonene5ae7022017-04-03 14:36:21 +03007655 Example:
7656 acl url_static path_beg /static /images /img /css
7657 acl url_static path_end .gif .png .jpg .css .js
7658 ignore-persist if url_static
7659
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02007660 See also : "force-persist", "cookie", and section 7 about ACL usage.
7661
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02007662load-server-state-from-file { global | local | none }
7663 Allow seamless reload of HAProxy
7664 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7665 yes | no | yes | yes
7666
7667 This directive points HAProxy to a file where server state from previous
7668 running process has been saved. That way, when starting up, before handling
7669 traffic, the new process can apply old states to servers exactly has if no
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007670 reload occurred. The purpose of the "load-server-state-from-file" directive is
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04007671 to tell HAProxy which file to use. For now, only 2 arguments to either prevent
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02007672 loading state or load states from a file containing all backends and servers.
7673 The state file can be generated by running the command "show servers state"
7674 over the stats socket and redirect output.
7675
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007676 The format of the file is versioned and is very specific. To understand it,
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02007677 please read the documentation of the "show servers state" command (chapter
Willy Tarreau1af20c72017-06-23 16:01:14 +02007678 9.3 of Management Guide).
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02007679
7680 Arguments:
7681 global load the content of the file pointed by the global directive
7682 named "server-state-file".
7683
7684 local load the content of the file pointed by the directive
7685 "server-state-file-name" if set. If not set, then the backend
7686 name is used as a file name.
7687
7688 none don't load any stat for this backend
7689
7690 Notes:
Willy Tarreaue5a60682016-11-09 14:54:53 +01007691 - server's IP address is preserved across reloads by default, but the
7692 order can be changed thanks to the server's "init-addr" setting. This
7693 means that an IP address change performed on the CLI at run time will
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007694 be preserved, and that any change to the local resolver (e.g. /etc/hosts)
Willy Tarreaue5a60682016-11-09 14:54:53 +01007695 will possibly not have any effect if the state file is in use.
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02007696
7697 - server's weight is applied from previous running process unless it has
7698 has changed between previous and new configuration files.
7699
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +02007700 Example: Minimal configuration
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02007701
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +02007702 global
7703 stats socket /tmp/socket
7704 server-state-file /tmp/server_state
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02007705
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +02007706 defaults
7707 load-server-state-from-file global
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02007708
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +02007709 backend bk
7710 server s1 127.0.0.1:22 check weight 11
7711 server s2 127.0.0.1:22 check weight 12
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02007712
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02007713
7714 Then one can run :
7715
7716 socat /tmp/socket - <<< "show servers state" > /tmp/server_state
7717
7718 Content of the file /tmp/server_state would be like this:
7719
7720 1
7721 # <field names skipped for the doc example>
7722 1 bk 1 s1 127.0.0.1 2 0 11 11 4 6 3 4 6 0 0
7723 1 bk 2 s2 127.0.0.1 2 0 12 12 4 6 3 4 6 0 0
7724
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +02007725 Example: Minimal configuration
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02007726
7727 global
7728 stats socket /tmp/socket
7729 server-state-base /etc/haproxy/states
7730
7731 defaults
7732 load-server-state-from-file local
7733
7734 backend bk
7735 server s1 127.0.0.1:22 check weight 11
7736 server s2 127.0.0.1:22 check weight 12
7737
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +02007738
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02007739 Then one can run :
7740
7741 socat /tmp/socket - <<< "show servers state bk" > /etc/haproxy/states/bk
7742
7743 Content of the file /etc/haproxy/states/bk would be like this:
7744
7745 1
7746 # <field names skipped for the doc example>
7747 1 bk 1 s1 127.0.0.1 2 0 11 11 4 6 3 4 6 0 0
7748 1 bk 2 s2 127.0.0.1 2 0 12 12 4 6 3 4 6 0 0
7749
7750 See also: "server-state-file", "server-state-file-name", and
7751 "show servers state"
7752
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02007753
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01007754log global
Jan Wagner3e678602020-12-17 22:22:32 +01007755log <address> [len <length>] [format <format>] [sample <ranges>:<sample_size>]
Frédéric Lécailled690dfa2019-04-25 10:52:17 +02007756 <facility> [<level> [<minlevel>]]
William Lallemand0f99e342011-10-12 17:50:54 +02007757no log
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01007758 Enable per-instance logging of events and traffic.
7759 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7760 yes | yes | yes | yes
William Lallemand0f99e342011-10-12 17:50:54 +02007761
7762 Prefix :
7763 no should be used when the logger list must be flushed. For example,
7764 if you don't want to inherit from the default logger list. This
7765 prefix does not allow arguments.
7766
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01007767 Arguments :
7768 global should be used when the instance's logging parameters are the
7769 same as the global ones. This is the most common usage. "global"
7770 replaces <address>, <facility> and <level> with those of the log
7771 entries found in the "global" section. Only one "log global"
7772 statement may be used per instance, and this form takes no other
7773 parameter.
7774
7775 <address> indicates where to send the logs. It takes the same format as
7776 for the "global" section's logs, and can be one of :
7777
7778 - An IPv4 address optionally followed by a colon (':') and a UDP
7779 port. If no port is specified, 514 is used by default (the
7780 standard syslog port).
7781
David du Colombier24bb5f52011-03-17 10:40:23 +01007782 - An IPv6 address followed by a colon (':') and optionally a UDP
7783 port. If no port is specified, 514 is used by default (the
7784 standard syslog port).
7785
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01007786 - A filesystem path to a UNIX domain socket, keeping in mind
7787 considerations for chroot (be sure the path is accessible
7788 inside the chroot) and uid/gid (be sure the path is
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007789 appropriately writable).
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01007790
Willy Tarreau5a32ecc2018-11-12 07:34:59 +01007791 - A file descriptor number in the form "fd@<number>", which may
7792 point to a pipe, terminal, or socket. In this case unbuffered
7793 logs are used and one writev() call per log is performed. This
7794 is a bit expensive but acceptable for most workloads. Messages
7795 sent this way will not be truncated but may be dropped, in
7796 which case the DroppedLogs counter will be incremented. The
7797 writev() call is atomic even on pipes for messages up to
7798 PIPE_BUF size, which POSIX recommends to be at least 512 and
7799 which is 4096 bytes on most modern operating systems. Any
7800 larger message may be interleaved with messages from other
7801 processes. Exceptionally for debugging purposes the file
7802 descriptor may also be directed to a file, but doing so will
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04007803 significantly slow HAProxy down as non-blocking calls will be
Willy Tarreau5a32ecc2018-11-12 07:34:59 +01007804 ignored. Also there will be no way to purge nor rotate this
7805 file without restarting the process. Note that the configured
7806 syslog format is preserved, so the output is suitable for use
Willy Tarreauc1b06452018-11-12 11:57:56 +01007807 with a TCP syslog server. See also the "short" and "raw"
7808 formats below.
Willy Tarreau5a32ecc2018-11-12 07:34:59 +01007809
7810 - "stdout" / "stderr", which are respectively aliases for "fd@1"
7811 and "fd@2", see above.
7812
Willy Tarreauc046d162019-08-30 15:24:59 +02007813 - A ring buffer in the form "ring@<name>", which will correspond
7814 to an in-memory ring buffer accessible over the CLI using the
7815 "show events" command, which will also list existing rings and
7816 their sizes. Such buffers are lost on reload or restart but
7817 when used as a complement this can help troubleshooting by
7818 having the logs instantly available.
7819
Emeric Brun94aab062021-04-02 10:41:36 +02007820 - An explicit stream address prefix such as "tcp@","tcp6@",
7821 "tcp4@" or "uxst@" will allocate an implicit ring buffer with
7822 a stream forward server targeting the given address.
7823
Willy Tarreau5a32ecc2018-11-12 07:34:59 +01007824 You may want to reference some environment variables in the
7825 address parameter, see section 2.3 about environment variables.
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01007826
Willy Tarreau18324f52014-06-27 18:10:07 +02007827 <length> is an optional maximum line length. Log lines larger than this
7828 value will be truncated before being sent. The reason is that
7829 syslog servers act differently on log line length. All servers
7830 support the default value of 1024, but some servers simply drop
7831 larger lines while others do log them. If a server supports long
7832 lines, it may make sense to set this value here in order to avoid
7833 truncating long lines. Similarly, if a server drops long lines,
7834 it is preferable to truncate them before sending them. Accepted
7835 values are 80 to 65535 inclusive. The default value of 1024 is
7836 generally fine for all standard usages. Some specific cases of
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007837 long captures or JSON-formatted logs may require larger values.
Willy Tarreau18324f52014-06-27 18:10:07 +02007838
Frédéric Lécailled690dfa2019-04-25 10:52:17 +02007839 <ranges> A list of comma-separated ranges to identify the logs to sample.
7840 This is used to balance the load of the logs to send to the log
7841 server. The limits of the ranges cannot be null. They are numbered
7842 from 1. The size or period (in number of logs) of the sample must
7843 be set with <sample_size> parameter.
7844
7845 <sample_size>
7846 The size of the sample in number of logs to consider when balancing
7847 their logging loads. It is used to balance the load of the logs to
7848 send to the syslog server. This size must be greater or equal to the
7849 maximum of the high limits of the ranges.
7850 (see also <ranges> parameter).
7851
Willy Tarreauadb345d2018-11-12 07:56:13 +01007852 <format> is the log format used when generating syslog messages. It may be
7853 one of the following :
7854
Emeric Brun0237c4e2020-11-27 16:24:34 +01007855 local Analog to rfc3164 syslog message format except that hostname
7856 field is stripped. This is the default.
7857 Note: option "log-send-hostname" switches the default to
7858 rfc3164.
7859
7860 rfc3164 The RFC3164 syslog message format.
Willy Tarreauadb345d2018-11-12 07:56:13 +01007861 (https://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc3164)
7862
7863 rfc5424 The RFC5424 syslog message format.
7864 (https://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc5424)
7865
Emeric Brun54648852020-07-06 15:54:06 +02007866 priority A message containing only a level plus syslog facility between
7867 angle brackets such as '<63>', followed by the text. The PID,
7868 date, time, process name and system name are omitted. This is
7869 designed to be used with a local log server.
7870
Willy Tarreaue8746a02018-11-12 08:45:00 +01007871 short A message containing only a level between angle brackets such as
7872 '<3>', followed by the text. The PID, date, time, process name
7873 and system name are omitted. This is designed to be used with a
7874 local log server. This format is compatible with what the
7875 systemd logger consumes.
7876
Emeric Brun54648852020-07-06 15:54:06 +02007877 timed A message containing only a level between angle brackets such as
7878 '<3>', followed by ISO date and by the text. The PID, process
7879 name and system name are omitted. This is designed to be
7880 used with a local log server.
7881
7882 iso A message containing only the ISO date, followed by the text.
7883 The PID, process name and system name are omitted. This is
7884 designed to be used with a local log server.
7885
Willy Tarreauc1b06452018-11-12 11:57:56 +01007886 raw A message containing only the text. The level, PID, date, time,
7887 process name and system name are omitted. This is designed to
7888 be used in containers or during development, where the severity
7889 only depends on the file descriptor used (stdout/stderr).
7890
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01007891 <facility> must be one of the 24 standard syslog facilities :
7892
Willy Tarreaue8746a02018-11-12 08:45:00 +01007893 kern user mail daemon auth syslog lpr news
7894 uucp cron auth2 ftp ntp audit alert cron2
7895 local0 local1 local2 local3 local4 local5 local6 local7
7896
Willy Tarreauc1b06452018-11-12 11:57:56 +01007897 Note that the facility is ignored for the "short" and "raw"
7898 formats, but still required as a positional field. It is
7899 recommended to use "daemon" in this case to make it clear that
7900 it's only supposed to be used locally.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01007901
7902 <level> is optional and can be specified to filter outgoing messages. By
7903 default, all messages are sent. If a level is specified, only
7904 messages with a severity at least as important as this level
Willy Tarreauf7edefa2009-05-10 17:20:05 +02007905 will be sent. An optional minimum level can be specified. If it
7906 is set, logs emitted with a more severe level than this one will
7907 be capped to this level. This is used to avoid sending "emerg"
7908 messages on all terminals on some default syslog configurations.
7909 Eight levels are known :
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01007910
7911 emerg alert crit err warning notice info debug
7912
William Lallemand0f99e342011-10-12 17:50:54 +02007913 It is important to keep in mind that it is the frontend which decides what to
7914 log from a connection, and that in case of content switching, the log entries
7915 from the backend will be ignored. Connections are logged at level "info".
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01007916
7917 However, backend log declaration define how and where servers status changes
7918 will be logged. Level "notice" will be used to indicate a server going up,
7919 "warning" will be used for termination signals and definitive service
7920 termination, and "alert" will be used for when a server goes down.
7921
7922 Note : According to RFC3164, messages are truncated to 1024 bytes before
7923 being emitted.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01007924
7925 Example :
7926 log global
Willy Tarreauc1b06452018-11-12 11:57:56 +01007927 log stdout format short daemon # send log to systemd
7928 log stdout format raw daemon # send everything to stdout
7929 log stderr format raw daemon notice # send important events to stderr
Willy Tarreauf7edefa2009-05-10 17:20:05 +02007930 log 127.0.0.1:514 local0 notice # only send important events
Emeric Brun94aab062021-04-02 10:41:36 +02007931 log tcp@127.0.0.1:514 local0 notice notice # same but limit output
7932 # level and send in tcp
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +02007933 log "${LOCAL_SYSLOG}:514" local0 notice # send to local server
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01007934
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01007935
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +01007936log-format <string>
Willy Tarreaufb4e7ea2015-01-07 14:55:17 +01007937 Specifies the log format string to use for traffic logs
7938 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7939 yes | yes | yes | no
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +01007940
Willy Tarreaufb4e7ea2015-01-07 14:55:17 +01007941 This directive specifies the log format string that will be used for all logs
7942 resulting from traffic passing through the frontend using this line. If the
7943 directive is used in a defaults section, all subsequent frontends will use
7944 the same log format. Please see section 8.2.4 which covers the log format
7945 string in depth.
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +01007946
Guillaume de Lafond29f45602017-03-31 19:52:15 +02007947 "log-format" directive overrides previous "option tcplog", "log-format" and
7948 "option httplog" directives.
7949
Dragan Dosen7ad31542015-09-28 17:16:47 +02007950log-format-sd <string>
7951 Specifies the RFC5424 structured-data log format string
7952 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7953 yes | yes | yes | no
7954
7955 This directive specifies the RFC5424 structured-data log format string that
7956 will be used for all logs resulting from traffic passing through the frontend
7957 using this line. If the directive is used in a defaults section, all
7958 subsequent frontends will use the same log format. Please see section 8.2.4
7959 which covers the log format string in depth.
7960
7961 See https://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc5424#section-6.3 for more information
7962 about the RFC5424 structured-data part.
7963
7964 Note : This log format string will be used only for loggers that have set
7965 log format to "rfc5424".
7966
7967 Example :
7968 log-format-sd [exampleSDID@1234\ bytes=\"%B\"\ status=\"%ST\"]
7969
7970
Willy Tarreau094af4e2015-01-07 15:03:42 +01007971log-tag <string>
7972 Specifies the log tag to use for all outgoing logs
7973 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7974 yes | yes | yes | yes
7975
7976 Sets the tag field in the syslog header to this string. It defaults to the
7977 log-tag set in the global section, otherwise the program name as launched
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04007978 from the command line, which usually is "HAProxy". Sometimes it can be useful
Willy Tarreau094af4e2015-01-07 15:03:42 +01007979 to differentiate between multiple processes running on the same host, or to
7980 differentiate customer instances running in the same process. In the backend,
7981 logs about servers up/down will use this tag. As a hint, it can be convenient
7982 to set a log-tag related to a hosted customer in a defaults section then put
7983 all the frontends and backends for that customer, then start another customer
7984 in a new defaults section. See also the global "log-tag" directive.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01007985
Willy Tarreauc35362a2014-04-25 13:58:37 +02007986max-keep-alive-queue <value>
7987 Set the maximum server queue size for maintaining keep-alive connections
7988 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7989 yes | no | yes | yes
7990
7991 HTTP keep-alive tries to reuse the same server connection whenever possible,
7992 but sometimes it can be counter-productive, for example if a server has a lot
7993 of connections while other ones are idle. This is especially true for static
7994 servers.
7995
7996 The purpose of this setting is to set a threshold on the number of queued
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04007997 connections at which HAProxy stops trying to reuse the same server and prefers
Willy Tarreauc35362a2014-04-25 13:58:37 +02007998 to find another one. The default value, -1, means there is no limit. A value
7999 of zero means that keep-alive requests will never be queued. For very close
8000 servers which can be reached with a low latency and which are not sensible to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008001 breaking keep-alive, a low value is recommended (e.g. local static server can
Willy Tarreauc35362a2014-04-25 13:58:37 +02008002 use a value of 10 or less). For remote servers suffering from a high latency,
8003 higher values might be needed to cover for the latency and/or the cost of
8004 picking a different server.
8005
8006 Note that this has no impact on responses which are maintained to the same
8007 server consecutively to a 401 response. They will still go to the same server
8008 even if they have to be queued.
8009
8010 See also : "option http-server-close", "option prefer-last-server", server
8011 "maxconn" and cookie persistence.
8012
Olivier Houcharda4d4fdf2018-12-14 19:27:06 +01008013max-session-srv-conns <nb>
8014 Set the maximum number of outgoing connections we can keep idling for a given
8015 client session. The default is 5 (it precisely equals MAX_SRV_LIST which is
8016 defined at build time).
Willy Tarreauc35362a2014-04-25 13:58:37 +02008017
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01008018maxconn <conns>
8019 Fix the maximum number of concurrent connections on a frontend
8020 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8021 yes | yes | yes | no
8022 Arguments :
8023 <conns> is the maximum number of concurrent connections the frontend will
8024 accept to serve. Excess connections will be queued by the system
8025 in the socket's listen queue and will be served once a connection
8026 closes.
8027
8028 If the system supports it, it can be useful on big sites to raise this limit
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04008029 very high so that HAProxy manages connection queues, instead of leaving the
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01008030 clients with unanswered connection attempts. This value should not exceed the
8031 global maxconn. Also, keep in mind that a connection contains two buffers
Baptiste Assmann79fb45d2016-03-06 23:34:31 +01008032 of tune.bufsize (16kB by default) each, as well as some other data resulting
8033 in about 33 kB of RAM being consumed per established connection. That means
8034 that a medium system equipped with 1GB of RAM can withstand around
8035 20000-25000 concurrent connections if properly tuned.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01008036
8037 Also, when <conns> is set to large values, it is possible that the servers
8038 are not sized to accept such loads, and for this reason it is generally wise
8039 to assign them some reasonable connection limits.
8040
Willy Tarreauc8d5b952019-02-27 17:25:52 +01008041 When this value is set to zero, which is the default, the global "maxconn"
8042 value is used.
Vincent Bernat6341be52012-06-27 17:18:30 +02008043
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01008044 See also : "server", global section's "maxconn", "fullconn"
8045
8046
Willy Tarreau77e0dae2020-10-14 15:44:27 +02008047mode { tcp|http }
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01008048 Set the running mode or protocol of the instance
8049 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8050 yes | yes | yes | yes
8051 Arguments :
8052 tcp The instance will work in pure TCP mode. A full-duplex connection
8053 will be established between clients and servers, and no layer 7
8054 examination will be performed. This is the default mode. It
8055 should be used for SSL, SSH, SMTP, ...
8056
8057 http The instance will work in HTTP mode. The client request will be
8058 analyzed in depth before connecting to any server. Any request
8059 which is not RFC-compliant will be rejected. Layer 7 filtering,
8060 processing and switching will be possible. This is the mode which
8061 brings HAProxy most of its value.
8062
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02008063 When doing content switching, it is mandatory that the frontend and the
8064 backend are in the same mode (generally HTTP), otherwise the configuration
8065 will be refused.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01008066
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02008067 Example :
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01008068 defaults http_instances
8069 mode http
8070
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01008071
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01008072monitor fail { if | unless } <condition>
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01008073 Add a condition to report a failure to a monitor HTTP request.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01008074 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8075 no | yes | yes | no
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01008076 Arguments :
8077 if <cond> the monitor request will fail if the condition is satisfied,
8078 and will succeed otherwise. The condition should describe a
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01008079 combined test which must induce a failure if all conditions
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01008080 are met, for instance a low number of servers both in a
8081 backend and its backup.
8082
8083 unless <cond> the monitor request will succeed only if the condition is
8084 satisfied, and will fail otherwise. Such a condition may be
8085 based on a test on the presence of a minimum number of active
8086 servers in a list of backends.
8087
8088 This statement adds a condition which can force the response to a monitor
8089 request to report a failure. By default, when an external component queries
8090 the URI dedicated to monitoring, a 200 response is returned. When one of the
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04008091 conditions above is met, HAProxy will return 503 instead of 200. This is
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01008092 very useful to report a site failure to an external component which may base
8093 routing advertisements between multiple sites on the availability reported by
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04008094 HAProxy. In this case, one would rely on an ACL involving the "nbsrv"
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02008095 criterion. Note that "monitor fail" only works in HTTP mode. Both status
8096 messages may be tweaked using "errorfile" or "errorloc" if needed.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01008097
8098 Example:
8099 frontend www
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01008100 mode http
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01008101 acl site_dead nbsrv(dynamic) lt 2
8102 acl site_dead nbsrv(static) lt 2
8103 monitor-uri /site_alive
8104 monitor fail if site_dead
8105
Willy Tarreau9e9919d2020-10-14 15:55:23 +02008106 See also : "monitor-uri", "errorfile", "errorloc"
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01008107
8108
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01008109monitor-uri <uri>
8110 Intercept a URI used by external components' monitor requests
8111 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8112 yes | yes | yes | no
8113 Arguments :
8114 <uri> is the exact URI which we want to intercept to return HAProxy's
8115 health status instead of forwarding the request.
8116
8117 When an HTTP request referencing <uri> will be received on a frontend,
8118 HAProxy will not forward it nor log it, but instead will return either
8119 "HTTP/1.0 200 OK" or "HTTP/1.0 503 Service unavailable", depending on failure
8120 conditions defined with "monitor fail". This is normally enough for any
8121 front-end HTTP probe to detect that the service is UP and running without
8122 forwarding the request to a backend server. Note that the HTTP method, the
8123 version and all headers are ignored, but the request must at least be valid
8124 at the HTTP level. This keyword may only be used with an HTTP-mode frontend.
8125
Willy Tarreau721d8e02017-12-01 18:25:08 +01008126 Monitor requests are processed very early, just after the request is parsed
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +02008127 and even before any "http-request". The only rulesets applied before are the
8128 tcp-request ones. They cannot be logged either, and it is the intended
Willy Tarreau28848542022-11-25 10:24:44 +01008129 purpose. Only one URI may be configured for monitoring; when multiple
8130 "monitor-uri" statements are present, the last one will define the URI to
8131 be used. They are only used to report HAProxy's health to an upper component,
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +02008132 nothing more. However, it is possible to add any number of conditions using
8133 "monitor fail" and ACLs so that the result can be adjusted to whatever check
8134 can be imagined (most often the number of available servers in a backend).
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01008135
Christopher Faulet6072beb2020-02-18 15:34:58 +01008136 Note: if <uri> starts by a slash ('/'), the matching is performed against the
8137 request's path instead of the request's uri. It is a workaround to let
8138 the HTTP/2 requests match the monitor-uri. Indeed, in HTTP/2, clients
8139 are encouraged to send absolute URIs only.
8140
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01008141 Example :
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04008142 # Use /haproxy_test to report HAProxy's status
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01008143 frontend www
8144 mode http
8145 monitor-uri /haproxy_test
8146
Willy Tarreau9e9919d2020-10-14 15:55:23 +02008147 See also : "monitor fail"
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01008148
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01008149
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01008150option abortonclose
8151no option abortonclose
8152 Enable or disable early dropping of aborted requests pending in queues.
8153 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8154 yes | no | yes | yes
8155 Arguments : none
8156
8157 In presence of very high loads, the servers will take some time to respond.
8158 The per-instance connection queue will inflate, and the response time will
8159 increase respective to the size of the queue times the average per-session
8160 response time. When clients will wait for more than a few seconds, they will
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01008161 often hit the "STOP" button on their browser, leaving a useless request in
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01008162 the queue, and slowing down other users, and the servers as well, because the
8163 request will eventually be served, then aborted at the first error
8164 encountered while delivering the response.
8165
8166 As there is no way to distinguish between a full STOP and a simple output
8167 close on the client side, HTTP agents should be conservative and consider
8168 that the client might only have closed its output channel while waiting for
8169 the response. However, this introduces risks of congestion when lots of users
8170 do the same, and is completely useless nowadays because probably no client at
8171 all will close the session while waiting for the response. Some HTTP agents
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008172 support this behavior (Squid, Apache, HAProxy), and others do not (TUX, most
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01008173 hardware-based load balancers). So the probability for a closed input channel
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01008174 to represent a user hitting the "STOP" button is close to 100%, and the risk
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01008175 of being the single component to break rare but valid traffic is extremely
8176 low, which adds to the temptation to be able to abort a session early while
8177 still not served and not pollute the servers.
8178
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008179 In HAProxy, the user can choose the desired behavior using the option
8180 "abortonclose". By default (without the option) the behavior is HTTP
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01008181 compliant and aborted requests will be served. But when the option is
8182 specified, a session with an incoming channel closed will be aborted while
8183 it is still possible, either pending in the queue for a connection slot, or
8184 during the connection establishment if the server has not yet acknowledged
8185 the connection request. This considerably reduces the queue size and the load
8186 on saturated servers when users are tempted to click on STOP, which in turn
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01008187 reduces the response time for other users.
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01008188
8189 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
8190 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
8191
8192 See also : "timeout queue" and server's "maxconn" and "maxqueue" parameters
8193
8194
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02008195option accept-invalid-http-request
8196no option accept-invalid-http-request
8197 Enable or disable relaxing of HTTP request parsing
8198 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8199 yes | yes | yes | no
8200 Arguments : none
8201
Willy Tarreau91852eb2015-05-01 13:26:00 +02008202 By default, HAProxy complies with RFC7230 in terms of message parsing. This
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02008203 means that invalid characters in header names are not permitted and cause an
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008204 error to be returned to the client. This is the desired behavior as such
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02008205 forbidden characters are essentially used to build attacks exploiting server
8206 weaknesses, and bypass security filtering. Sometimes, a buggy browser or
8207 server will emit invalid header names for whatever reason (configuration,
8208 implementation) and the issue will not be immediately fixed. In such a case,
8209 it is possible to relax HAProxy's header name parser to accept any character
Willy Tarreau422246e2012-01-07 23:54:13 +01008210 even if that does not make sense, by specifying this option. Similarly, the
8211 list of characters allowed to appear in a URI is well defined by RFC3986, and
8212 chars 0-31, 32 (space), 34 ('"'), 60 ('<'), 62 ('>'), 92 ('\'), 94 ('^'), 96
8213 ('`'), 123 ('{'), 124 ('|'), 125 ('}'), 127 (delete) and anything above are
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008214 not allowed at all. HAProxy always blocks a number of them (0..32, 127). The
Willy Tarreau91852eb2015-05-01 13:26:00 +02008215 remaining ones are blocked by default unless this option is enabled. This
Willy Tarreau13317662015-05-01 13:47:08 +02008216 option also relaxes the test on the HTTP version, it allows HTTP/0.9 requests
8217 to pass through (no version specified) and multiple digits for both the major
Willy Tarreau3706e172023-08-08 19:35:25 +02008218 and the minor version. Finally, this option also allows incoming URLs to
8219 contain fragment references ('#' after the path).
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02008220
8221 This option should never be enabled by default as it hides application bugs
8222 and open security breaches. It should only be deployed after a problem has
8223 been confirmed.
8224
8225 When this option is enabled, erroneous header names will still be accepted in
8226 requests, but the complete request will be captured in order to permit later
Willy Tarreau422246e2012-01-07 23:54:13 +01008227 analysis using the "show errors" request on the UNIX stats socket. Similarly,
8228 requests containing invalid chars in the URI part will be logged. Doing this
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02008229 also helps confirming that the issue has been solved.
8230
8231 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
8232 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
8233
8234 See also : "option accept-invalid-http-response" and "show errors" on the
8235 stats socket.
8236
8237
8238option accept-invalid-http-response
8239no option accept-invalid-http-response
8240 Enable or disable relaxing of HTTP response parsing
8241 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8242 yes | no | yes | yes
8243 Arguments : none
8244
Willy Tarreau91852eb2015-05-01 13:26:00 +02008245 By default, HAProxy complies with RFC7230 in terms of message parsing. This
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02008246 means that invalid characters in header names are not permitted and cause an
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008247 error to be returned to the client. This is the desired behavior as such
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02008248 forbidden characters are essentially used to build attacks exploiting server
8249 weaknesses, and bypass security filtering. Sometimes, a buggy browser or
8250 server will emit invalid header names for whatever reason (configuration,
8251 implementation) and the issue will not be immediately fixed. In such a case,
8252 it is possible to relax HAProxy's header name parser to accept any character
Willy Tarreau91852eb2015-05-01 13:26:00 +02008253 even if that does not make sense, by specifying this option. This option also
8254 relaxes the test on the HTTP version format, it allows multiple digits for
8255 both the major and the minor version.
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02008256
8257 This option should never be enabled by default as it hides application bugs
8258 and open security breaches. It should only be deployed after a problem has
8259 been confirmed.
8260
8261 When this option is enabled, erroneous header names will still be accepted in
8262 responses, but the complete response will be captured in order to permit
8263 later analysis using the "show errors" request on the UNIX stats socket.
8264 Doing this also helps confirming that the issue has been solved.
8265
8266 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
8267 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
8268
8269 See also : "option accept-invalid-http-request" and "show errors" on the
8270 stats socket.
8271
8272
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01008273option allbackups
8274no option allbackups
8275 Use either all backup servers at a time or only the first one
8276 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8277 yes | no | yes | yes
8278 Arguments : none
8279
8280 By default, the first operational backup server gets all traffic when normal
8281 servers are all down. Sometimes, it may be preferred to use multiple backups
8282 at once, because one will not be enough. When "option allbackups" is enabled,
8283 the load balancing will be performed among all backup servers when all normal
8284 ones are unavailable. The same load balancing algorithm will be used and the
8285 servers' weights will be respected. Thus, there will not be any priority
8286 order between the backup servers anymore.
8287
8288 This option is mostly used with static server farms dedicated to return a
8289 "sorry" page when an application is completely offline.
8290
8291 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
8292 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
8293
8294
8295option checkcache
8296no option checkcache
Godbach7056a352013-12-11 20:01:07 +08008297 Analyze all server responses and block responses with cacheable cookies
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01008298 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8299 yes | no | yes | yes
8300 Arguments : none
8301
8302 Some high-level frameworks set application cookies everywhere and do not
8303 always let enough control to the developer to manage how the responses should
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01008304 be cached. When a session cookie is returned on a cacheable object, there is a
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01008305 high risk of session crossing or stealing between users traversing the same
8306 caches. In some situations, it is better to block the response than to let
Willy Tarreau3c92c5f2011-08-28 09:45:47 +02008307 some sensitive session information go in the wild.
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01008308
8309 The option "checkcache" enables deep inspection of all server responses for
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01008310 strict compliance with HTTP specification in terms of cacheability. It
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01008311 carefully checks "Cache-control", "Pragma" and "Set-cookie" headers in server
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01008312 response to check if there's a risk of caching a cookie on a client-side
8313 proxy. When this option is enabled, the only responses which can be delivered
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01008314 to the client are :
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008315 - all those without "Set-Cookie" header;
Willy Tarreauc55ddce2017-12-21 11:41:38 +01008316 - all those with a return code other than 200, 203, 204, 206, 300, 301,
8317 404, 405, 410, 414, 501, provided that the server has not set a
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008318 "Cache-control: public" header field;
Willy Tarreau24ea0bc2017-12-21 11:32:55 +01008319 - all those that result from a request using a method other than GET, HEAD,
8320 OPTIONS, TRACE, provided that the server has not set a 'Cache-Control:
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008321 public' header field;
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01008322 - those with a 'Pragma: no-cache' header
8323 - those with a 'Cache-control: private' header
8324 - those with a 'Cache-control: no-store' header
8325 - those with a 'Cache-control: max-age=0' header
8326 - those with a 'Cache-control: s-maxage=0' header
8327 - those with a 'Cache-control: no-cache' header
8328 - those with a 'Cache-control: no-cache="set-cookie"' header
8329 - those with a 'Cache-control: no-cache="set-cookie,' header
8330 (allowing other fields after set-cookie)
8331
8332 If a response doesn't respect these requirements, then it will be blocked
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +02008333 just as if it was from an "http-response deny" rule, with an "HTTP 502 bad
8334 gateway". The session state shows "PH--" meaning that the proxy blocked the
8335 response during headers processing. Additionally, an alert will be sent in
8336 the logs so that admins are informed that there's something to be fixed.
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01008337
8338 Due to the high impact on the application, the application should be tested
8339 in depth with the option enabled before going to production. It is also a
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01008340 good practice to always activate it during tests, even if it is not used in
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008341 production, as it will report potentially dangerous application behaviors.
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01008342
8343 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
8344 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
8345
8346
8347option clitcpka
8348no option clitcpka
8349 Enable or disable the sending of TCP keepalive packets on the client side
8350 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8351 yes | yes | yes | no
8352 Arguments : none
8353
8354 When there is a firewall or any session-aware component between a client and
8355 a server, and when the protocol involves very long sessions with long idle
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008356 periods (e.g. remote desktops), there is a risk that one of the intermediate
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01008357 components decides to expire a session which has remained idle for too long.
8358
8359 Enabling socket-level TCP keep-alives makes the system regularly send packets
8360 to the other end of the connection, leaving it active. The delay between
8361 keep-alive probes is controlled by the system only and depends both on the
8362 operating system and its tuning parameters.
8363
8364 It is important to understand that keep-alive packets are neither emitted nor
8365 received at the application level. It is only the network stacks which sees
8366 them. For this reason, even if one side of the proxy already uses keep-alives
8367 to maintain its connection alive, those keep-alive packets will not be
8368 forwarded to the other side of the proxy.
8369
8370 Please note that this has nothing to do with HTTP keep-alive.
8371
8372 Using option "clitcpka" enables the emission of TCP keep-alive probes on the
8373 client side of a connection, which should help when session expirations are
8374 noticed between HAProxy and a client.
8375
8376 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
8377 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
8378
8379 See also : "option srvtcpka", "option tcpka"
8380
8381
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01008382option contstats
8383 Enable continuous traffic statistics updates
8384 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8385 yes | yes | yes | no
8386 Arguments : none
8387
8388 By default, counters used for statistics calculation are incremented
8389 only when a session finishes. It works quite well when serving small
8390 objects, but with big ones (for example large images or archives) or
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04008391 with A/V streaming, a graph generated from HAProxy counters looks like
Willy Tarreaudef0d222016-11-08 22:03:00 +01008392 a hedgehog. With this option enabled counters get incremented frequently
8393 along the session, typically every 5 seconds, which is often enough to
8394 produce clean graphs. Recounting touches a hotpath directly so it is not
8395 not enabled by default, as it can cause a lot of wakeups for very large
8396 session counts and cause a small performance drop.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01008397
Christopher Faulet89aed322020-06-02 17:33:56 +02008398option disable-h2-upgrade
8399no option disable-h2-upgrade
8400 Enable or disable the implicit HTTP/2 upgrade from an HTTP/1.x client
8401 connection.
8402 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8403 yes | yes | yes | no
8404 Arguments : none
8405
8406 By default, HAProxy is able to implicitly upgrade an HTTP/1.x client
8407 connection to an HTTP/2 connection if the first request it receives from a
8408 given HTTP connection matches the HTTP/2 connection preface (i.e. the string
8409 "PRI * HTTP/2.0\r\n\r\nSM\r\n\r\n"). This way, it is possible to support
Christopher Faulet982e17d2021-03-26 14:44:18 +01008410 HTTP/1.x and HTTP/2 clients on a non-SSL connections. This option must be
8411 used to disable the implicit upgrade. Note this implicit upgrade is only
8412 supported for HTTP proxies, thus this option too. Note also it is possible to
8413 force the HTTP/2 on clear connections by specifying "proto h2" on the bind
8414 line. Finally, this option is applied on all bind lines. To disable implicit
8415 HTTP/2 upgrades for a specific bind line, it is possible to use "proto h1".
Christopher Faulet89aed322020-06-02 17:33:56 +02008416
8417 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
8418 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01008419
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +02008420option dontlog-normal
8421no option dontlog-normal
8422 Enable or disable logging of normal, successful connections
8423 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8424 yes | yes | yes | no
8425 Arguments : none
8426
8427 There are large sites dealing with several thousand connections per second
8428 and for which logging is a major pain. Some of them are even forced to turn
8429 logs off and cannot debug production issues. Setting this option ensures that
8430 normal connections, those which experience no error, no timeout, no retry nor
8431 redispatch, will not be logged. This leaves disk space for anomalies. In HTTP
8432 mode, the response status code is checked and return codes 5xx will still be
8433 logged.
8434
8435 It is strongly discouraged to use this option as most of the time, the key to
8436 complex issues is in the normal logs which will not be logged here. If you
8437 need to separate logs, see the "log-separate-errors" option instead.
8438
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008439 See also : "log", "dontlognull", "log-separate-errors" and section 8 about
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +02008440 logging.
8441
8442
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01008443option dontlognull
8444no option dontlognull
8445 Enable or disable logging of null connections
8446 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8447 yes | yes | yes | no
8448 Arguments : none
8449
8450 In certain environments, there are components which will regularly connect to
8451 various systems to ensure that they are still alive. It can be the case from
8452 another load balancer as well as from monitoring systems. By default, even a
8453 simple port probe or scan will produce a log. If those connections pollute
8454 the logs too much, it is possible to enable option "dontlognull" to indicate
8455 that a connection on which no data has been transferred will not be logged,
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +02008456 which typically corresponds to those probes. Note that errors will still be
8457 returned to the client and accounted for in the stats. If this is not what is
8458 desired, option http-ignore-probes can be used instead.
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01008459
8460 It is generally recommended not to use this option in uncontrolled
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008461 environments (e.g. internet), otherwise scans and other malicious activities
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01008462 would not be logged.
8463
8464 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
8465 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
8466
Willy Tarreau9e9919d2020-10-14 15:55:23 +02008467 See also : "log", "http-ignore-probes", "monitor-uri", and
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +02008468 section 8 about logging.
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01008469
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01008470
Willy Tarreau87cf5142011-08-19 22:57:24 +02008471option forwardfor [ except <network> ] [ header <name> ] [ if-none ]
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01008472 Enable insertion of the X-Forwarded-For header to requests sent to servers
8473 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8474 yes | yes | yes | yes
8475 Arguments :
8476 <network> is an optional argument used to disable this option for sources
8477 matching <network>
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02008478 <name> an optional argument to specify a different "X-Forwarded-For"
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01008479 header name.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01008480
8481 Since HAProxy works in reverse-proxy mode, the servers see its IP address as
8482 their client address. This is sometimes annoying when the client's IP address
8483 is expected in server logs. To solve this problem, the well-known HTTP header
8484 "X-Forwarded-For" may be added by HAProxy to all requests sent to the server.
8485 This header contains a value representing the client's IP address. Since this
8486 header is always appended at the end of the existing header list, the server
8487 must be configured to always use the last occurrence of this header only. See
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02008488 the server's manual to find how to enable use of this standard header. Note
8489 that only the last occurrence of the header must be used, since it is really
8490 possible that the client has already brought one.
8491
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01008492 The keyword "header" may be used to supply a different header name to replace
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02008493 the default "X-Forwarded-For". This can be useful where you might already
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008494 have a "X-Forwarded-For" header from a different application (e.g. stunnel),
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01008495 and you need preserve it. Also if your backend server doesn't use the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008496 "X-Forwarded-For" header and requires different one (e.g. Zeus Web Servers
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02008497 require "X-Cluster-Client-IP").
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01008498
8499 Sometimes, a same HAProxy instance may be shared between a direct client
8500 access and a reverse-proxy access (for instance when an SSL reverse-proxy is
8501 used to decrypt HTTPS traffic). It is possible to disable the addition of the
8502 header for a known source address or network by adding the "except" keyword
8503 followed by the network address. In this case, any source IP matching the
8504 network will not cause an addition of this header. Most common uses are with
Christopher Faulet5d1def62021-02-26 09:19:15 +01008505 private networks or 127.0.0.1. IPv4 and IPv6 are both supported.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01008506
Willy Tarreau87cf5142011-08-19 22:57:24 +02008507 Alternatively, the keyword "if-none" states that the header will only be
8508 added if it is not present. This should only be used in perfectly trusted
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04008509 environment, as this might cause a security issue if headers reaching HAProxy
Willy Tarreau87cf5142011-08-19 22:57:24 +02008510 are under the control of the end-user.
8511
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01008512 This option may be specified either in the frontend or in the backend. If at
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02008513 least one of them uses it, the header will be added. Note that the backend's
8514 setting of the header subargument takes precedence over the frontend's if
Willy Tarreau87cf5142011-08-19 22:57:24 +02008515 both are defined. In the case of the "if-none" argument, if at least one of
8516 the frontend or the backend does not specify it, it wants the addition to be
8517 mandatory, so it wins.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01008518
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +02008519 Example :
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01008520 # Public HTTP address also used by stunnel on the same machine
8521 frontend www
8522 mode http
8523 option forwardfor except 127.0.0.1 # stunnel already adds the header
8524
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02008525 # Those servers want the IP Address in X-Client
8526 backend www
8527 mode http
8528 option forwardfor header X-Client
8529
Willy Tarreau87cf5142011-08-19 22:57:24 +02008530 See also : "option httpclose", "option http-server-close",
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02008531 "option http-keep-alive"
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01008532
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02008533
Christopher Faulet98fbe952019-07-22 16:18:24 +02008534option h1-case-adjust-bogus-client
8535no option h1-case-adjust-bogus-client
8536 Enable or disable the case adjustment of HTTP/1 headers sent to bogus clients
8537 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8538 yes | yes | yes | no
8539 Arguments : none
8540
8541 There is no standard case for header names because, as stated in RFC7230,
8542 they are case-insensitive. So applications must handle them in a case-
8543 insensitive manner. But some bogus applications violate the standards and
8544 erroneously rely on the cases most commonly used by browsers. This problem
8545 becomes critical with HTTP/2 because all header names must be exchanged in
8546 lower case, and HAProxy follows the same convention. All header names are
8547 sent in lower case to clients and servers, regardless of the HTTP version.
8548
8549 When HAProxy receives an HTTP/1 response, its header names are converted to
8550 lower case and manipulated and sent this way to the clients. If a client is
8551 known to violate the HTTP standards and to fail to process a response coming
8552 from HAProxy, it is possible to transform the lower case header names to a
8553 different format when the response is formatted and sent to the client, by
8554 enabling this option and specifying the list of headers to be reformatted
8555 using the global directives "h1-case-adjust" or "h1-case-adjust-file". This
8556 must only be a temporary workaround for the time it takes the client to be
8557 fixed, because clients which require such workarounds might be vulnerable to
8558 content smuggling attacks and must absolutely be fixed.
8559
8560 Please note that this option will not affect standards-compliant clients.
8561
8562 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
8563 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
8564
8565 See also: "option h1-case-adjust-bogus-server", "h1-case-adjust",
8566 "h1-case-adjust-file".
8567
8568
8569option h1-case-adjust-bogus-server
8570no option h1-case-adjust-bogus-server
8571 Enable or disable the case adjustment of HTTP/1 headers sent to bogus servers
8572 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8573 yes | no | yes | yes
8574 Arguments : none
8575
8576 There is no standard case for header names because, as stated in RFC7230,
8577 they are case-insensitive. So applications must handle them in a case-
8578 insensitive manner. But some bogus applications violate the standards and
8579 erroneously rely on the cases most commonly used by browsers. This problem
8580 becomes critical with HTTP/2 because all header names must be exchanged in
8581 lower case, and HAProxy follows the same convention. All header names are
8582 sent in lower case to clients and servers, regardless of the HTTP version.
8583
8584 When HAProxy receives an HTTP/1 request, its header names are converted to
8585 lower case and manipulated and sent this way to the servers. If a server is
8586 known to violate the HTTP standards and to fail to process a request coming
8587 from HAProxy, it is possible to transform the lower case header names to a
8588 different format when the request is formatted and sent to the server, by
8589 enabling this option and specifying the list of headers to be reformatted
8590 using the global directives "h1-case-adjust" or "h1-case-adjust-file". This
8591 must only be a temporary workaround for the time it takes the server to be
8592 fixed, because servers which require such workarounds might be vulnerable to
8593 content smuggling attacks and must absolutely be fixed.
8594
8595 Please note that this option will not affect standards-compliant servers.
8596
8597 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
8598 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
8599
8600 See also: "option h1-case-adjust-bogus-client", "h1-case-adjust",
8601 "h1-case-adjust-file".
8602
8603
Willy Tarreau9fbe18e2015-05-01 22:42:08 +02008604option http-buffer-request
8605no option http-buffer-request
8606 Enable or disable waiting for whole HTTP request body before proceeding
8607 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8608 yes | yes | yes | yes
8609 Arguments : none
8610
8611 It is sometimes desirable to wait for the body of an HTTP request before
8612 taking a decision. This is what is being done by "balance url_param" for
8613 example. The first use case is to buffer requests from slow clients before
8614 connecting to the server. Another use case consists in taking the routing
8615 decision based on the request body's contents. This option placed in a
8616 frontend or backend forces the HTTP processing to wait until either the whole
Christopher Faulet6db8a2e2019-11-19 16:27:25 +01008617 body is received or the request buffer is full. It can have undesired side
8618 effects with some applications abusing HTTP by expecting unbuffered
8619 transmissions between the frontend and the backend, so this should definitely
8620 not be used by default.
Willy Tarreau9fbe18e2015-05-01 22:42:08 +02008621
Christopher Faulet021a8e42021-03-29 10:46:38 +02008622 See also : "option http-no-delay", "timeout http-request",
8623 "http-request wait-for-body"
Willy Tarreau9fbe18e2015-05-01 22:42:08 +02008624
8625
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +02008626option http-ignore-probes
8627no option http-ignore-probes
8628 Enable or disable logging of null connections and request timeouts
8629 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8630 yes | yes | yes | no
8631 Arguments : none
8632
8633 Recently some browsers started to implement a "pre-connect" feature
8634 consisting in speculatively connecting to some recently visited web sites
8635 just in case the user would like to visit them. This results in many
8636 connections being established to web sites, which end up in 408 Request
8637 Timeout if the timeout strikes first, or 400 Bad Request when the browser
8638 decides to close them first. These ones pollute the log and feed the error
8639 counters. There was already "option dontlognull" but it's insufficient in
8640 this case. Instead, this option does the following things :
8641 - prevent any 400/408 message from being sent to the client if nothing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008642 was received over a connection before it was closed;
8643 - prevent any log from being emitted in this situation;
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +02008644 - prevent any error counter from being incremented
8645
8646 That way the empty connection is silently ignored. Note that it is better
8647 not to use this unless it is clear that it is needed, because it will hide
8648 real problems. The most common reason for not receiving a request and seeing
8649 a 408 is due to an MTU inconsistency between the client and an intermediary
8650 element such as a VPN, which blocks too large packets. These issues are
8651 generally seen with POST requests as well as GET with large cookies. The logs
8652 are often the only way to detect them.
8653
8654 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
8655 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
8656
8657 See also : "log", "dontlognull", "errorfile", and section 8 about logging.
8658
8659
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01008660option http-keep-alive
8661no option http-keep-alive
Christopher Faulet84145a72023-02-20 17:09:34 +01008662 Enable or disable HTTP keep-alive from client to server for HTTP/1.x
8663 connections
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01008664 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8665 yes | yes | yes | yes
8666 Arguments : none
8667
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01008668 By default HAProxy operates in keep-alive mode with regards to persistent
Christopher Faulet84145a72023-02-20 17:09:34 +01008669 HTTP/1.x connections: for each connection it processes each request and
8670 response, and leaves the connection idle on both sides. This mode may be
8671 changed by several options such as "option http-server-close" or "option
8672 httpclose". This option allows to set back the keep-alive mode, which can be
8673 useful when another mode was used in a defaults section.
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01008674
8675 Setting "option http-keep-alive" enables HTTP keep-alive mode on the client-
8676 and server- sides. This provides the lowest latency on the client side (slow
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01008677 network) and the fastest session reuse on the server side at the expense
8678 of maintaining idle connections to the servers. In general, it is possible
8679 with this option to achieve approximately twice the request rate that the
8680 "http-server-close" option achieves on small objects. There are mainly two
8681 situations where this option may be useful :
8682
8683 - when the server is non-HTTP compliant and authenticates the connection
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008684 instead of requests (e.g. NTLM authentication)
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01008685
8686 - when the cost of establishing the connection to the server is significant
8687 compared to the cost of retrieving the associated object from the server.
8688
8689 This last case can happen when the server is a fast static server of cache.
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01008690
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01008691 At the moment, logs will not indicate whether requests came from the same
8692 session or not. The accept date reported in the logs corresponds to the end
8693 of the previous request, and the request time corresponds to the time spent
8694 waiting for a new request. The keep-alive request time is still bound to the
8695 timeout defined by "timeout http-keep-alive" or "timeout http-request" if
8696 not set.
8697
Christopher Faulet159e6672019-07-16 15:09:52 +02008698 This option disables and replaces any previous "option httpclose" or "option
Christopher Faulet84145a72023-02-20 17:09:34 +01008699 http-server-close".
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01008700
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02008701 See also : "option httpclose",, "option http-server-close",
Christopher Faulet84145a72023-02-20 17:09:34 +01008702 "option prefer-last-server" and "option http-pretend-keepalive".
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01008703
8704
Willy Tarreau96e31212011-05-30 18:10:30 +02008705option http-no-delay
8706no option http-no-delay
8707 Instruct the system to favor low interactive delays over performance in HTTP
8708 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8709 yes | yes | yes | yes
8710 Arguments : none
8711
8712 In HTTP, each payload is unidirectional and has no notion of interactivity.
8713 Any agent is expected to queue data somewhat for a reasonably low delay.
8714 There are some very rare server-to-server applications that abuse the HTTP
8715 protocol and expect the payload phase to be highly interactive, with many
8716 interleaved data chunks in both directions within a single request. This is
8717 absolutely not supported by the HTTP specification and will not work across
8718 most proxies or servers. When such applications attempt to do this through
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04008719 HAProxy, it works but they will experience high delays due to the network
Willy Tarreau96e31212011-05-30 18:10:30 +02008720 optimizations which favor performance by instructing the system to wait for
8721 enough data to be available in order to only send full packets. Typical
8722 delays are around 200 ms per round trip. Note that this only happens with
8723 abnormal uses. Normal uses such as CONNECT requests nor WebSockets are not
8724 affected.
8725
8726 When "option http-no-delay" is present in either the frontend or the backend
8727 used by a connection, all such optimizations will be disabled in order to
8728 make the exchanges as fast as possible. Of course this offers no guarantee on
8729 the functionality, as it may break at any other place. But if it works via
8730 HAProxy, it will work as fast as possible. This option should never be used
8731 by default, and should never be used at all unless such a buggy application
8732 is discovered. The impact of using this option is an increase of bandwidth
8733 usage and CPU usage, which may significantly lower performance in high
8734 latency environments.
8735
Willy Tarreau9fbe18e2015-05-01 22:42:08 +02008736 See also : "option http-buffer-request"
8737
Willy Tarreau96e31212011-05-30 18:10:30 +02008738
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02008739option http-pretend-keepalive
8740no option http-pretend-keepalive
Christopher Faulet84145a72023-02-20 17:09:34 +01008741 Define whether HAProxy will announce keepalive for HTTP/1.x connection to the
8742 server or not
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02008743 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Christopher Faulet98db9762018-09-21 10:25:19 +02008744 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02008745 Arguments : none
8746
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04008747 When running with "option http-server-close" or "option httpclose", HAProxy
Christopher Faulet84145a72023-02-20 17:09:34 +01008748 adds a "Connection: close" header to the HTTP/1.x request forwarded to the
8749 server. Unfortunately, when some servers see this header, they automatically
8750 refrain from using the chunked encoding for responses of unknown length,
8751 while this is totally unrelated. The effect is that a client or a cache could
8752 receive an incomplete response without being aware of it, and consider the
8753 response complete.
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02008754
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04008755 By setting "option http-pretend-keepalive", HAProxy will make the server
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02008756 believe it will keep the connection alive. The server will then not fall back
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04008757 to the abnormal undesired above. When HAProxy gets the whole response, it
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02008758 will close the connection with the server just as it would do with the
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02008759 "option httpclose". That way the client gets a normal response and the
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02008760 connection is correctly closed on the server side.
8761
8762 It is recommended not to enable this option by default, because most servers
8763 will more efficiently close the connection themselves after the last packet,
8764 and release its buffers slightly earlier. Also, the added packet on the
8765 network could slightly reduce the overall peak performance. However it is
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04008766 worth noting that when this option is enabled, HAProxy will have slightly
8767 less work to do. So if HAProxy is the bottleneck on the whole architecture,
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02008768 enabling this option might save a few CPU cycles.
8769
Christopher Faulet98db9762018-09-21 10:25:19 +02008770 This option may be set in backend and listen sections. Using it in a frontend
8771 section will be ignored and a warning will be reported during startup. It is
8772 a backend related option, so there is no real reason to set it on a
Christopher Faulet84145a72023-02-20 17:09:34 +01008773 frontend.
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02008774
8775 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
8776 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
8777
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02008778 See also : "option httpclose", "option http-server-close", and
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01008779 "option http-keep-alive"
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02008780
Christopher Faulet79507152022-05-16 11:43:10 +02008781option http-restrict-req-hdr-names { preserve | delete | reject }
8782 Set HAProxy policy about HTTP request header names containing characters
8783 outside the "[a-zA-Z0-9-]" charset
8784 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8785 yes | yes | yes | yes
8786 Arguments :
8787 preserve disable the filtering. It is the default mode for HTTP proxies
8788 with no FastCGI application configured.
8789
8790 delete remove request headers with a name containing a character
8791 outside the "[a-zA-Z0-9-]" charset. It is the default mode for
8792 HTTP backends with a configured FastCGI application.
8793
8794 reject reject the request with a 403-Forbidden response if it contains a
8795 header name with a character outside the "[a-zA-Z0-9-]" charset.
8796
8797 This option may be used to restrict the request header names to alphanumeric
8798 and hyphen characters ([A-Za-z0-9-]). This may be mandatory to interoperate
8799 with non-HTTP compliant servers that fail to handle some characters in header
8800 names. It may also be mandatory for FastCGI applications because all
8801 non-alphanumeric characters in header names are replaced by an underscore
8802 ('_'). Thus, it is easily possible to mix up header names and bypass some
8803 rules. For instance, "X-Forwarded-For" and "X_Forwarded-For" headers are both
8804 converted to "HTTP_X_FORWARDED_FOR" in FastCGI.
8805
8806 Note this option is evaluated per proxy and after the http-request rules
8807 evaluation.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01008808
Willy Tarreaub608feb2010-01-02 22:47:18 +01008809option http-server-close
8810no option http-server-close
Christopher Faulet84145a72023-02-20 17:09:34 +01008811 Enable or disable HTTP/1.x connection closing on the server side
Willy Tarreaub608feb2010-01-02 22:47:18 +01008812 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8813 yes | yes | yes | yes
8814 Arguments : none
8815
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01008816 By default HAProxy operates in keep-alive mode with regards to persistent
Christopher Faulet84145a72023-02-20 17:09:34 +01008817 HTTP/1.x connections: for each connection it processes each request and
8818 response, and leaves the connection idle on both sides. This mode may be
8819 changed by several options such as "option http-server-close" or "option
8820 httpclose". Setting "option http-server-close" enables HTTP connection-close
8821 mode on the server side while keeping the ability to support HTTP keep-alive
8822 and pipelining on the client side. This provides the lowest latency on the
8823 client side (slow network) and the fastest session reuse on the server side
8824 to save server resources, similarly to "option httpclose". It also permits
8825 non-keepalive capable servers to be served in keep-alive mode to the clients
8826 if they conform to the requirements of RFC7230. Please note that some servers
8827 do not always conform to those requirements when they see "Connection: close"
8828 in the request. The effect will be that keep-alive will never be used. A
8829 workaround consists in enabling "option http-pretend-keepalive".
Willy Tarreaub608feb2010-01-02 22:47:18 +01008830
8831 At the moment, logs will not indicate whether requests came from the same
8832 session or not. The accept date reported in the logs corresponds to the end
8833 of the previous request, and the request time corresponds to the time spent
8834 waiting for a new request. The keep-alive request time is still bound to the
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +01008835 timeout defined by "timeout http-keep-alive" or "timeout http-request" if
8836 not set.
Willy Tarreaub608feb2010-01-02 22:47:18 +01008837
8838 This option may be set both in a frontend and in a backend. It is enabled if
8839 at least one of the frontend or backend holding a connection has it enabled.
Christopher Faulet159e6672019-07-16 15:09:52 +02008840 It disables and replaces any previous "option httpclose" or "option
8841 http-keep-alive". Please check section 4 ("Proxies") to see how this option
8842 combines with others when frontend and backend options differ.
Willy Tarreaub608feb2010-01-02 22:47:18 +01008843
8844 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
8845 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
8846
Christopher Faulet84145a72023-02-20 17:09:34 +01008847 See also : "option httpclose", "option http-pretend-keepalive" and
8848 "option http-keep-alive".
Willy Tarreaub608feb2010-01-02 22:47:18 +01008849
Willy Tarreau88d349d2010-01-25 12:15:43 +01008850option http-use-proxy-header
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01008851no option http-use-proxy-header
Willy Tarreau88d349d2010-01-25 12:15:43 +01008852 Make use of non-standard Proxy-Connection header instead of Connection
8853 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8854 yes | yes | yes | no
8855 Arguments : none
8856
Lukas Tribus23953682017-04-28 13:24:30 +00008857 While RFC7230 explicitly states that HTTP/1.1 agents must use the
Willy Tarreau88d349d2010-01-25 12:15:43 +01008858 Connection header to indicate their wish of persistent or non-persistent
8859 connections, both browsers and proxies ignore this header for proxied
8860 connections and make use of the undocumented, non-standard Proxy-Connection
8861 header instead. The issue begins when trying to put a load balancer between
8862 browsers and such proxies, because there will be a difference between what
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04008863 HAProxy understands and what the client and the proxy agree on.
Willy Tarreau88d349d2010-01-25 12:15:43 +01008864
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04008865 By setting this option in a frontend, HAProxy can automatically switch to use
Willy Tarreau88d349d2010-01-25 12:15:43 +01008866 that non-standard header if it sees proxied requests. A proxied request is
Lukas Tribusf01a9cd2016-02-03 18:09:37 +01008867 defined here as one where the URI begins with neither a '/' nor a '*'. This
8868 is incompatible with the HTTP tunnel mode. Note that this option can only be
8869 specified in a frontend and will affect the request along its whole life.
Willy Tarreau88d349d2010-01-25 12:15:43 +01008870
Willy Tarreau844a7e72010-01-31 21:46:18 +01008871 Also, when this option is set, a request which requires authentication will
8872 automatically switch to use proxy authentication headers if it is itself a
8873 proxied request. That makes it possible to check or enforce authentication in
8874 front of an existing proxy.
8875
Willy Tarreau88d349d2010-01-25 12:15:43 +01008876 This option should normally never be used, except in front of a proxy.
8877
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02008878 See also : "option httpclose", and "option http-server-close".
Willy Tarreau88d349d2010-01-25 12:15:43 +01008879
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008880option httpchk
8881option httpchk <uri>
8882option httpchk <method> <uri>
8883option httpchk <method> <uri> <version>
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02008884 Enables HTTP protocol to check on the servers health
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008885 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8886 yes | no | yes | yes
8887 Arguments :
8888 <method> is the optional HTTP method used with the requests. When not set,
8889 the "OPTIONS" method is used, as it generally requires low server
8890 processing and is easy to filter out from the logs. Any method
8891 may be used, though it is not recommended to invent non-standard
8892 ones.
8893
8894 <uri> is the URI referenced in the HTTP requests. It defaults to " / "
8895 which is accessible by default on almost any server, but may be
8896 changed to any other URI. Query strings are permitted.
8897
8898 <version> is the optional HTTP version string. It defaults to "HTTP/1.0"
8899 but some servers might behave incorrectly in HTTP 1.0, so turning
8900 it to HTTP/1.1 may sometimes help. Note that the Host field is
Christopher Faulet8acb1282020-04-09 08:44:06 +02008901 mandatory in HTTP/1.1, use "http-check send" directive to add it.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008902
8903 By default, server health checks only consist in trying to establish a TCP
8904 connection. When "option httpchk" is specified, a complete HTTP request is
8905 sent once the TCP connection is established, and responses 2xx and 3xx are
8906 considered valid, while all other ones indicate a server failure, including
8907 the lack of any response.
8908
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02008909 Combined with "http-check" directives, it is possible to customize the
8910 request sent during the HTTP health checks or the matching rules on the
8911 response. It is also possible to configure a send/expect sequence, just like
8912 with the directive "tcp-check" for TCP health checks.
8913
8914 The server configuration is used by default to open connections to perform
8915 HTTP health checks. By it is also possible to overwrite server parameters
8916 using "http-check connect" rules.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008917
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02008918 "httpchk" option does not necessarily require an HTTP backend, it also works
8919 with plain TCP backends. This is particularly useful to check simple scripts
Christopher Faulet14cd3162020-04-16 14:50:06 +02008920 bound to some dedicated ports using the inetd daemon. However, it will always
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -04008921 internally relies on an HTX multiplexer. Thus, it means the request
Christopher Faulet14cd3162020-04-16 14:50:06 +02008922 formatting and the response parsing will be strict.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008923
Christopher Faulet8acb1282020-04-09 08:44:06 +02008924 Note : For a while, there was no way to add headers or body in the request
8925 used for HTTP health checks. So a workaround was to hide it at the end
8926 of the version string with a "\r\n" after the version. It is now
8927 deprecated. The directive "http-check send" must be used instead.
8928
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008929 Examples :
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02008930 # Relay HTTPS traffic to Apache instance and check service availability
8931 # using HTTP request "OPTIONS * HTTP/1.1" on port 80.
8932 backend https_relay
8933 mode tcp
8934 option httpchk OPTIONS * HTTP/1.1
8935 http-check send hdr Host www
8936 server apache1 192.168.1.1:443 check port 80
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008937
Simon Hormanafc47ee2013-11-25 10:46:35 +09008938 See also : "option ssl-hello-chk", "option smtpchk", "option mysql-check",
8939 "option pgsql-check", "http-check" and the "check", "port" and
8940 "inter" server options.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008941
8942
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01008943option httpclose
8944no option httpclose
Christopher Faulet84145a72023-02-20 17:09:34 +01008945 Enable or disable HTTP/1.x connection closing
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01008946 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8947 yes | yes | yes | yes
8948 Arguments : none
8949
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01008950 By default HAProxy operates in keep-alive mode with regards to persistent
Christopher Faulet84145a72023-02-20 17:09:34 +01008951 HTTP/1.x connections: for each connection it processes each request and
8952 response, and leaves the connection idle on both sides. This mode may be
8953 changed by several options such as "option http-server-close" or "option
8954 httpclose".
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01008955
Christopher Faulet84145a72023-02-20 17:09:34 +01008956 If "option httpclose" is set, HAProxy will close the client or the server
8957 connection, depending where the option is set. Only the frontend is
8958 considered for client connections while the frontend and the backend are
8959 considered for server ones. In this case the option is enabled if at least
8960 one of the frontend or backend holding the connection has it enabled. If the
8961 option is set on a listener, it is applied both on client and server
8962 connections. It will check if a "Connection: close" header is already set in
8963 each direction, and will add one if missing.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01008964
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02008965 This option may also be combined with "option http-pretend-keepalive", which
Christopher Faulet84145a72023-02-20 17:09:34 +01008966 will disable sending of the "Connection: close" request header, but will
8967 still cause the connection to be closed once the whole response is received.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01008968
Christopher Faulet159e6672019-07-16 15:09:52 +02008969 It disables and replaces any previous "option http-server-close" or "option
Christopher Faulet84145a72023-02-20 17:09:34 +01008970 http-keep-alive".
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01008971
8972 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
8973 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
8974
Christopher Faulet84145a72023-02-20 17:09:34 +01008975 See also : "option http-server-close".
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01008976
8977
Emeric Brun3a058f32009-06-30 18:26:00 +02008978option httplog [ clf ]
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01008979 Enable logging of HTTP request, session state and timers
8980 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Tim Duesterhus9ad9f352018-02-05 20:52:27 +01008981 yes | yes | yes | no
Emeric Brun3a058f32009-06-30 18:26:00 +02008982 Arguments :
8983 clf if the "clf" argument is added, then the output format will be
8984 the CLF format instead of HAProxy's default HTTP format. You can
8985 use this when you need to feed HAProxy's logs through a specific
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008986 log analyzer which only support the CLF format and which is not
Emeric Brun3a058f32009-06-30 18:26:00 +02008987 extensible.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01008988
8989 By default, the log output format is very poor, as it only contains the
8990 source and destination addresses, and the instance name. By specifying
8991 "option httplog", each log line turns into a much richer format including,
8992 but not limited to, the HTTP request, the connection timers, the session
8993 status, the connections numbers, the captured headers and cookies, the
8994 frontend, backend and server name, and of course the source address and
8995 ports.
8996
PiBa-NLbd556bf2014-12-11 21:31:54 +01008997 Specifying only "option httplog" will automatically clear the 'clf' mode
8998 if it was set by default.
Emeric Brun3a058f32009-06-30 18:26:00 +02008999
Guillaume de Lafond29f45602017-03-31 19:52:15 +02009000 "option httplog" overrides any previous "log-format" directive.
9001
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009002 See also : section 8 about logging.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01009003
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02009004
9005option http_proxy
9006no option http_proxy
9007 Enable or disable plain HTTP proxy mode
9008 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9009 yes | yes | yes | yes
9010 Arguments : none
9011
9012 It sometimes happens that people need a pure HTTP proxy which understands
9013 basic proxy requests without caching nor any fancy feature. In this case,
9014 it may be worth setting up an HAProxy instance with the "option http_proxy"
9015 set. In this mode, no server is declared, and the connection is forwarded to
9016 the IP address and port found in the URL after the "http://" scheme.
9017
9018 No host address resolution is performed, so this only works when pure IP
9019 addresses are passed. Since this option's usage perimeter is rather limited,
Lukas Tribusf01a9cd2016-02-03 18:09:37 +01009020 it will probably be used only by experts who know they need exactly it. This
9021 is incompatible with the HTTP tunnel mode.
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02009022
9023 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
9024 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
9025
9026 Example :
9027 # this backend understands HTTP proxy requests and forwards them directly.
9028 backend direct_forward
9029 option httpclose
9030 option http_proxy
9031
9032 See also : "option httpclose"
9033
Willy Tarreau211ad242009-10-03 21:45:07 +02009034
Jamie Gloudon801a0a32012-08-25 00:18:33 -04009035option independent-streams
9036no option independent-streams
9037 Enable or disable independent timeout processing for both directions
Willy Tarreauf27b5ea2009-10-03 22:01:18 +02009038 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9039 yes | yes | yes | yes
9040 Arguments : none
9041
9042 By default, when data is sent over a socket, both the write timeout and the
9043 read timeout for that socket are refreshed, because we consider that there is
9044 activity on that socket, and we have no other means of guessing if we should
9045 receive data or not.
9046
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009047 While this default behavior is desirable for almost all applications, there
Willy Tarreauf27b5ea2009-10-03 22:01:18 +02009048 exists a situation where it is desirable to disable it, and only refresh the
9049 read timeout if there are incoming data. This happens on sessions with large
9050 timeouts and low amounts of exchanged data such as telnet session. If the
9051 server suddenly disappears, the output data accumulates in the system's
9052 socket buffers, both timeouts are correctly refreshed, and there is no way
9053 to know the server does not receive them, so we don't timeout. However, when
9054 the underlying protocol always echoes sent data, it would be enough by itself
9055 to detect the issue using the read timeout. Note that this problem does not
9056 happen with more verbose protocols because data won't accumulate long in the
9057 socket buffers.
9058
9059 When this option is set on the frontend, it will disable read timeout updates
9060 on data sent to the client. There probably is little use of this case. When
9061 the option is set on the backend, it will disable read timeout updates on
9062 data sent to the server. Doing so will typically break large HTTP posts from
9063 slow lines, so use it with caution.
9064
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02009065 See also : "timeout client", "timeout server" and "timeout tunnel"
Willy Tarreauf27b5ea2009-10-03 22:01:18 +02009066
9067
Gabor Lekenyb4c81e42010-09-29 18:17:05 +02009068option ldap-check
9069 Use LDAPv3 health checks for server testing
9070 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9071 yes | no | yes | yes
9072 Arguments : none
9073
9074 It is possible to test that the server correctly talks LDAPv3 instead of just
9075 testing that it accepts the TCP connection. When this option is set, an
9076 LDAPv3 anonymous simple bind message is sent to the server, and the response
9077 is analyzed to find an LDAPv3 bind response message.
9078
9079 The server is considered valid only when the LDAP response contains success
9080 resultCode (http://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc4511#section-4.1.9).
9081
9082 Logging of bind requests is server dependent see your documentation how to
9083 configure it.
9084
9085 Example :
9086 option ldap-check
9087
9088 See also : "option httpchk"
9089
9090
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09009091option external-check
9092 Use external processes for server health checks
9093 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9094 yes | no | yes | yes
9095
9096 It is possible to test the health of a server using an external command.
9097 This is achieved by running the executable set using "external-check
9098 command".
9099
9100 Requires the "external-check" global to be set.
9101
9102 See also : "external-check", "external-check command", "external-check path"
9103
9104
William Dauchy4711a892022-01-05 22:53:24 +01009105option idle-close-on-response
9106no option idle-close-on-response
9107 Avoid closing idle frontend connections if a soft stop is in progress
9108 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9109 yes | yes | yes | no
9110 Arguments : none
9111
9112 By default, idle connections will be closed during a soft stop. In some
9113 environments, a client talking to the proxy may have prepared some idle
9114 connections in order to send requests later. If there is no proper retry on
9115 write errors, this can result in errors while haproxy is reloading. Even
9116 though a proper implementation should retry on connection/write errors, this
9117 option was introduced to support backwards compatibility with haproxy prior
9118 to version 2.4. Indeed before v2.4, haproxy used to wait for a last request
9119 and response to add a "connection: close" header before closing, thus
9120 notifying the client that the connection would not be reusable.
9121
9122 In a real life example, this behavior was seen in AWS using the ALB in front
9123 of a haproxy. The end result was ALB sending 502 during haproxy reloads.
9124
9125 Users are warned that using this option may increase the number of old
9126 processes if connections remain idle for too long. Adjusting the client
9127 timeouts and/or the "hard-stop-after" parameter accordingly might be
9128 needed in case of frequent reloads.
9129
9130 See also: "timeout client", "timeout client-fin", "timeout http-request",
9131 "hard-stop-after"
9132
9133
Willy Tarreau211ad242009-10-03 21:45:07 +02009134option log-health-checks
9135no option log-health-checks
Willy Tarreaubef1b322014-05-13 21:01:39 +02009136 Enable or disable logging of health checks status updates
Willy Tarreau211ad242009-10-03 21:45:07 +02009137 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9138 yes | no | yes | yes
9139 Arguments : none
9140
Willy Tarreaubef1b322014-05-13 21:01:39 +02009141 By default, failed health check are logged if server is UP and successful
9142 health checks are logged if server is DOWN, so the amount of additional
9143 information is limited.
Willy Tarreau211ad242009-10-03 21:45:07 +02009144
Willy Tarreaubef1b322014-05-13 21:01:39 +02009145 When this option is enabled, any change of the health check status or to
9146 the server's health will be logged, so that it becomes possible to know
9147 that a server was failing occasional checks before crashing, or exactly when
9148 it failed to respond a valid HTTP status, then when the port started to
9149 reject connections, then when the server stopped responding at all.
9150
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009151 Note that status changes not caused by health checks (e.g. enable/disable on
Willy Tarreaubef1b322014-05-13 21:01:39 +02009152 the CLI) are intentionally not logged by this option.
Willy Tarreau211ad242009-10-03 21:45:07 +02009153
Willy Tarreaubef1b322014-05-13 21:01:39 +02009154 See also: "option httpchk", "option ldap-check", "option mysql-check",
9155 "option pgsql-check", "option redis-check", "option smtpchk",
9156 "option tcp-check", "log" and section 8 about logging.
Willy Tarreau211ad242009-10-03 21:45:07 +02009157
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +02009158
9159option log-separate-errors
9160no option log-separate-errors
9161 Change log level for non-completely successful connections
9162 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9163 yes | yes | yes | no
9164 Arguments : none
9165
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04009166 Sometimes looking for errors in logs is not easy. This option makes HAProxy
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +02009167 raise the level of logs containing potentially interesting information such
9168 as errors, timeouts, retries, redispatches, or HTTP status codes 5xx. The
9169 level changes from "info" to "err". This makes it possible to log them
9170 separately to a different file with most syslog daemons. Be careful not to
9171 remove them from the original file, otherwise you would lose ordering which
9172 provides very important information.
9173
9174 Using this option, large sites dealing with several thousand connections per
9175 second may log normal traffic to a rotating buffer and only archive smaller
9176 error logs.
9177
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009178 See also : "log", "dontlognull", "dontlog-normal" and section 8 about
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +02009179 logging.
9180
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01009181
9182option logasap
9183no option logasap
Jerome Magnin95fb57b2020-04-23 19:01:17 +02009184 Enable or disable early logging.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01009185 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9186 yes | yes | yes | no
9187 Arguments : none
9188
Jerome Magnin95fb57b2020-04-23 19:01:17 +02009189 By default, logs are emitted when all the log format variables and sample
9190 fetches used in the definition of the log-format string return a value, or
9191 when the session is terminated. This allows the built in log-format strings
9192 to account for the transfer time, or the number of bytes in log messages.
9193
9194 When handling long lived connections such as large file transfers or RDP,
9195 it may take a while for the request or connection to appear in the logs.
9196 Using "option logasap", the log message is created as soon as the server
9197 connection is established in mode tcp, or as soon as the server sends the
9198 complete headers in mode http. Missing information in the logs will be the
Ilya Shipitsin4329a9a2020-05-05 21:17:10 +05009199 total number of bytes which will only indicate the amount of data transferred
Jerome Magnin95fb57b2020-04-23 19:01:17 +02009200 before the message was created and the total time which will not take the
9201 remainder of the connection life or transfer time into account. For the case
9202 of HTTP, it is good practice to capture the Content-Length response header
9203 so that the logs at least indicate how many bytes are expected to be
Ilya Shipitsin4329a9a2020-05-05 21:17:10 +05009204 transferred.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01009205
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01009206 Examples :
9207 listen http_proxy 0.0.0.0:80
9208 mode http
9209 option httplog
9210 option logasap
9211 log 192.168.2.200 local3
9212
9213 >>> Feb 6 12:14:14 localhost \
9214 haproxy[14389]: 10.0.1.2:33317 [06/Feb/2009:12:14:14.655] http-in \
9215 static/srv1 9/10/7/14/+30 200 +243 - - ---- 3/1/1/1/0 1/0 \
9216 "GET /image.iso HTTP/1.0"
9217
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009218 See also : "option httplog", "capture response header", and section 8 about
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01009219 logging.
9220
9221
Christopher Faulet62f79fe2020-05-18 18:13:03 +02009222option mysql-check [ user <username> [ { post-41 | pre-41 } ] ]
Hervé COMMOWICK8776f1b2010-10-18 15:58:36 +02009223 Use MySQL health checks for server testing
Hervé COMMOWICK698ae002010-01-12 09:25:13 +01009224 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9225 yes | no | yes | yes
Hervé COMMOWICK8776f1b2010-10-18 15:58:36 +02009226 Arguments :
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02009227 <username> This is the username which will be used when connecting to MySQL
9228 server.
Christopher Faulet62f79fe2020-05-18 18:13:03 +02009229 post-41 Send post v4.1 client compatible checks (the default)
9230 pre-41 Send pre v4.1 client compatible checks
Hervé COMMOWICK8776f1b2010-10-18 15:58:36 +02009231
9232 If you specify a username, the check consists of sending two MySQL packet,
9233 one Client Authentication packet, and one QUIT packet, to correctly close
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009234 MySQL session. We then parse the MySQL Handshake Initialization packet and/or
Hervé COMMOWICK8776f1b2010-10-18 15:58:36 +02009235 Error packet. It is a basic but useful test which does not produce error nor
Daniel Black9dc310d2021-07-01 12:09:32 +10009236 aborted connect on the server. However, it requires an unlocked authorised
9237 user without a password. To create a basic limited user in MySQL with
9238 optional resource limits:
Hervé COMMOWICK8776f1b2010-10-18 15:58:36 +02009239
Daniel Black9dc310d2021-07-01 12:09:32 +10009240 CREATE USER '<username>'@'<ip_of_haproxy|network_of_haproxy/netmask>'
9241 /*!50701 WITH MAX_QUERIES_PER_HOUR 1 MAX_UPDATES_PER_HOUR 0 */
9242 /*M!100201 MAX_STATEMENT_TIME 0.0001 */;
Hervé COMMOWICK8776f1b2010-10-18 15:58:36 +02009243
9244 If you don't specify a username (it is deprecated and not recommended), the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009245 check only consists in parsing the Mysql Handshake Initialization packet or
Hervé COMMOWICK8776f1b2010-10-18 15:58:36 +02009246 Error packet, we don't send anything in this mode. It was reported that it
9247 can generate lockout if check is too frequent and/or if there is not enough
9248 traffic. In fact, you need in this case to check MySQL "max_connect_errors"
9249 value as if a connection is established successfully within fewer than MySQL
9250 "max_connect_errors" attempts after a previous connection was interrupted,
9251 the error count for the host is cleared to zero. If HAProxy's server get
9252 blocked, the "FLUSH HOSTS" statement is the only way to unblock it.
9253
9254 Remember that this does not check database presence nor database consistency.
9255 To do this, you can use an external check with xinetd for example.
Hervé COMMOWICK698ae002010-01-12 09:25:13 +01009256
Hervé COMMOWICK212f7782011-06-10 14:05:59 +02009257 The check requires MySQL >=3.22, for older version, please use TCP check.
Hervé COMMOWICK698ae002010-01-12 09:25:13 +01009258
9259 Most often, an incoming MySQL server needs to see the client's IP address for
9260 various purposes, including IP privilege matching and connection logging.
9261 When possible, it is often wise to masquerade the client's IP address when
9262 connecting to the server using the "usesrc" argument of the "source" keyword,
Willy Tarreau29fbe512015-08-20 19:35:14 +02009263 which requires the transparent proxy feature to be compiled in, and the MySQL
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04009264 server to route the client via the machine hosting HAProxy.
Hervé COMMOWICK698ae002010-01-12 09:25:13 +01009265
9266 See also: "option httpchk"
9267
9268
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01009269option nolinger
9270no option nolinger
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01009271 Enable or disable immediate session resource cleaning after close
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01009272 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9273 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01009274 Arguments : none
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01009275
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009276 When clients or servers abort connections in a dirty way (e.g. they are
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01009277 physically disconnected), the session timeouts triggers and the session is
9278 closed. But it will remain in FIN_WAIT1 state for some time in the system,
9279 using some resources and possibly limiting the ability to establish newer
9280 connections.
9281
9282 When this happens, it is possible to activate "option nolinger" which forces
9283 the system to immediately remove any socket's pending data on close. Thus,
Willy Tarreau4a321032020-10-16 04:55:19 +02009284 a TCP RST is emitted, any pending data are truncated, and the session is
9285 instantly purged from the system's tables. The generally visible effect for
9286 a client is that responses are truncated if the close happens with a last
9287 block of data (e.g. on a redirect or error response). On the server side,
9288 it may help release the source ports immediately when forwarding a client
9289 aborts in tunnels. In both cases, TCP resets are emitted and given that
9290 the session is instantly destroyed, there will be no retransmit. On a lossy
9291 network this can increase problems, especially when there is a firewall on
9292 the lossy side, because the firewall might see and process the reset (hence
9293 purge its session) and block any further traffic for this session,, including
9294 retransmits from the other side. So if the other side doesn't receive it,
9295 it will never receive any RST again, and the firewall might log many blocked
9296 packets.
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01009297
Willy Tarreau4a321032020-10-16 04:55:19 +02009298 For all these reasons, it is strongly recommended NOT to use this option,
9299 unless absolutely needed as a last resort. In most situations, using the
9300 "client-fin" or "server-fin" timeouts achieves similar results with a more
9301 reliable behavior. On Linux it's also possible to use the "tcp-ut" bind or
9302 server setting.
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01009303
9304 This option may be used both on frontends and backends, depending on the side
9305 where it is required. Use it on the frontend for clients, and on the backend
Willy Tarreau4a321032020-10-16 04:55:19 +02009306 for servers. While this option is technically supported in "defaults"
Ilya Shipitsin2272d8a2020-12-21 01:22:40 +05009307 sections, it must really not be used there as it risks to accidentally
Willy Tarreau4a321032020-10-16 04:55:19 +02009308 propagate to sections that must no use it and to cause problems there.
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01009309
9310 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
9311 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
9312
Willy Tarreau4a321032020-10-16 04:55:19 +02009313 See also: "timeout client-fin", "timeout server-fin", "tcp-ut" bind or server
9314 keywords.
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01009315
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02009316option originalto [ except <network> ] [ header <name> ]
9317 Enable insertion of the X-Original-To header to requests sent to servers
9318 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9319 yes | yes | yes | yes
9320 Arguments :
9321 <network> is an optional argument used to disable this option for sources
9322 matching <network>
9323 <name> an optional argument to specify a different "X-Original-To"
9324 header name.
9325
9326 Since HAProxy can work in transparent mode, every request from a client can
9327 be redirected to the proxy and HAProxy itself can proxy every request to a
9328 complex SQUID environment and the destination host from SO_ORIGINAL_DST will
9329 be lost. This is annoying when you want access rules based on destination ip
9330 addresses. To solve this problem, a new HTTP header "X-Original-To" may be
9331 added by HAProxy to all requests sent to the server. This header contains a
9332 value representing the original destination IP address. Since this must be
9333 configured to always use the last occurrence of this header only. Note that
9334 only the last occurrence of the header must be used, since it is really
9335 possible that the client has already brought one.
9336
9337 The keyword "header" may be used to supply a different header name to replace
9338 the default "X-Original-To". This can be useful where you might already
9339 have a "X-Original-To" header from a different application, and you need
9340 preserve it. Also if your backend server doesn't use the "X-Original-To"
9341 header and requires different one.
9342
9343 Sometimes, a same HAProxy instance may be shared between a direct client
9344 access and a reverse-proxy access (for instance when an SSL reverse-proxy is
9345 used to decrypt HTTPS traffic). It is possible to disable the addition of the
Amaury Denoyellef8b42922021-03-04 18:41:14 +01009346 header for a known destination address or network by adding the "except"
9347 keyword followed by the network address. In this case, any destination IP
9348 matching the network will not cause an addition of this header. Most common
9349 uses are with private networks or 127.0.0.1. IPv4 and IPv6 are both
9350 supported.
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02009351
9352 This option may be specified either in the frontend or in the backend. If at
9353 least one of them uses it, the header will be added. Note that the backend's
9354 setting of the header subargument takes precedence over the frontend's if
9355 both are defined.
9356
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02009357 Examples :
9358 # Original Destination address
9359 frontend www
9360 mode http
9361 option originalto except 127.0.0.1
9362
9363 # Those servers want the IP Address in X-Client-Dst
9364 backend www
9365 mode http
9366 option originalto header X-Client-Dst
9367
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02009368 See also : "option httpclose", "option http-server-close".
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02009369
9370
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01009371option persist
9372no option persist
9373 Enable or disable forced persistence on down servers
9374 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9375 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01009376 Arguments : none
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01009377
9378 When an HTTP request reaches a backend with a cookie which references a dead
9379 server, by default it is redispatched to another server. It is possible to
9380 force the request to be sent to the dead server first using "option persist"
9381 if absolutely needed. A common use case is when servers are under extreme
9382 load and spend their time flapping. In this case, the users would still be
9383 directed to the server they opened the session on, in the hope they would be
9384 correctly served. It is recommended to use "option redispatch" in conjunction
9385 with this option so that in the event it would not be possible to connect to
9386 the server at all (server definitely dead), the client would finally be
9387 redirected to another valid server.
9388
9389 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
9390 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
9391
Willy Tarreau4de91492010-01-22 19:10:05 +01009392 See also : "option redispatch", "retries", "force-persist"
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01009393
9394
Christopher Faulet36136e52022-10-03 15:00:59 +02009395option pgsql-check user <username>
Willy Tarreau0c122822013-12-15 18:49:01 +01009396 Use PostgreSQL health checks for server testing
9397 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9398 yes | no | yes | yes
9399 Arguments :
9400 <username> This is the username which will be used when connecting to
9401 PostgreSQL server.
9402
9403 The check sends a PostgreSQL StartupMessage and waits for either
9404 Authentication request or ErrorResponse message. It is a basic but useful
9405 test which does not produce error nor aborted connect on the server.
9406 This check is identical with the "mysql-check".
9407
9408 See also: "option httpchk"
9409
9410
Willy Tarreau9420b122013-12-15 18:58:25 +01009411option prefer-last-server
9412no option prefer-last-server
9413 Allow multiple load balanced requests to remain on the same server
9414 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9415 yes | no | yes | yes
9416 Arguments : none
9417
9418 When the load balancing algorithm in use is not deterministic, and a previous
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04009419 request was sent to a server to which HAProxy still holds a connection, it is
Willy Tarreau9420b122013-12-15 18:58:25 +01009420 sometimes desirable that subsequent requests on a same session go to the same
9421 server as much as possible. Note that this is different from persistence, as
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04009422 we only indicate a preference which HAProxy tries to apply without any form
Willy Tarreau9420b122013-12-15 18:58:25 +01009423 of warranty. The real use is for keep-alive connections sent to servers. When
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04009424 this option is used, HAProxy will try to reuse the same connection that is
Willy Tarreau9420b122013-12-15 18:58:25 +01009425 attached to the server instead of rebalancing to another server, causing a
9426 close of the connection. This can make sense for static file servers. It does
Willy Tarreau068621e2013-12-23 15:11:25 +01009427 not make much sense to use this in combination with hashing algorithms. Note,
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04009428 HAProxy already automatically tries to stick to a server which sends a 401 or
Lukas Tribus80512b12018-10-27 20:07:40 +02009429 to a proxy which sends a 407 (authentication required), when the load
9430 balancing algorithm is not deterministic. This is mandatory for use with the
9431 broken NTLM authentication challenge, and significantly helps in
Willy Tarreau068621e2013-12-23 15:11:25 +01009432 troubleshooting some faulty applications. Option prefer-last-server might be
9433 desirable in these environments as well, to avoid redistributing the traffic
9434 after every other response.
Willy Tarreau9420b122013-12-15 18:58:25 +01009435
9436 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
9437 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
9438
9439 See also: "option http-keep-alive"
9440
9441
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01009442option redispatch
Joseph Lynch726ab712015-05-11 23:25:34 -07009443option redispatch <interval>
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01009444no option redispatch
9445 Enable or disable session redistribution in case of connection failure
9446 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9447 yes | no | yes | yes
Joseph Lynch726ab712015-05-11 23:25:34 -07009448 Arguments :
9449 <interval> The optional integer value that controls how often redispatches
9450 occur when retrying connections. Positive value P indicates a
9451 redispatch is desired on every Pth retry, and negative value
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009452 N indicate a redispatch is desired on the Nth retry prior to the
Joseph Lynch726ab712015-05-11 23:25:34 -07009453 last retry. For example, the default of -1 preserves the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009454 historical behavior of redispatching on the last retry, a
Joseph Lynch726ab712015-05-11 23:25:34 -07009455 positive value of 1 would indicate a redispatch on every retry,
9456 and a positive value of 3 would indicate a redispatch on every
9457 third retry. You can disable redispatches with a value of 0.
9458
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01009459
9460 In HTTP mode, if a server designated by a cookie is down, clients may
9461 definitely stick to it because they cannot flush the cookie, so they will not
9462 be able to access the service anymore.
9463
Willy Tarreau59884a62019-01-02 14:48:31 +01009464 Specifying "option redispatch" will allow the proxy to break cookie or
9465 consistent hash based persistence and redistribute them to a working server.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01009466
Olivier Carrère6e6f59b2020-04-15 11:30:18 +02009467 Active servers are selected from a subset of the list of available
9468 servers. Active servers that are not down or in maintenance (i.e., whose
9469 health is not checked or that have been checked as "up"), are selected in the
9470 following order:
9471
9472 1. Any active, non-backup server, if any, or,
9473
9474 2. If the "allbackups" option is not set, the first backup server in the
9475 list, or
9476
9477 3. If the "allbackups" option is set, any backup server.
9478
9479 When a retry occurs, HAProxy tries to select another server than the last
9480 one. The new server is selected from the current list of servers.
9481
9482 Sometimes, if the list is updated between retries (e.g., if numerous retries
9483 occur and last longer than the time needed to check that a server is down,
9484 remove it from the list and fall back on the list of backup servers),
9485 connections may be redirected to a backup server, though.
9486
Joseph Lynch726ab712015-05-11 23:25:34 -07009487 It also allows to retry connections to another server in case of multiple
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01009488 connection failures. Of course, it requires having "retries" set to a nonzero
9489 value.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01009490
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01009491 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
9492 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
9493
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +02009494 See also : "retries", "force-persist"
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01009495
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01009496
Hervé COMMOWICKec032d62011-08-05 16:23:48 +02009497option redis-check
9498 Use redis health checks for server testing
9499 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9500 yes | no | yes | yes
9501 Arguments : none
9502
9503 It is possible to test that the server correctly talks REDIS protocol instead
9504 of just testing that it accepts the TCP connection. When this option is set,
9505 a PING redis command is sent to the server, and the response is analyzed to
9506 find the "+PONG" response message.
9507
9508 Example :
9509 option redis-check
9510
Jarno Huuskonene5ae7022017-04-03 14:36:21 +03009511 See also : "option httpchk", "option tcp-check", "tcp-check expect"
Hervé COMMOWICKec032d62011-08-05 16:23:48 +02009512
9513
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01009514option smtpchk
9515option smtpchk <hello> <domain>
9516 Use SMTP health checks for server testing
9517 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9518 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01009519 Arguments :
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01009520 <hello> is an optional argument. It is the "hello" command to use. It can
Lukas Tribus27935782018-10-01 02:00:16 +02009521 be either "HELO" (for SMTP) or "EHLO" (for ESMTP). All other
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01009522 values will be turned into the default command ("HELO").
9523
9524 <domain> is the domain name to present to the server. It may only be
9525 specified (and is mandatory) if the hello command has been
9526 specified. By default, "localhost" is used.
9527
9528 When "option smtpchk" is set, the health checks will consist in TCP
9529 connections followed by an SMTP command. By default, this command is
9530 "HELO localhost". The server's return code is analyzed and only return codes
9531 starting with a "2" will be considered as valid. All other responses,
9532 including a lack of response will constitute an error and will indicate a
9533 dead server.
9534
9535 This test is meant to be used with SMTP servers or relays. Depending on the
9536 request, it is possible that some servers do not log each connection attempt,
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009537 so you may want to experiment to improve the behavior. Using telnet on port
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01009538 25 is often easier than adjusting the configuration.
9539
9540 Most often, an incoming SMTP server needs to see the client's IP address for
9541 various purposes, including spam filtering, anti-spoofing and logging. When
9542 possible, it is often wise to masquerade the client's IP address when
9543 connecting to the server using the "usesrc" argument of the "source" keyword,
Willy Tarreau29fbe512015-08-20 19:35:14 +02009544 which requires the transparent proxy feature to be compiled in.
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01009545
9546 Example :
9547 option smtpchk HELO mydomain.org
9548
9549 See also : "option httpchk", "source"
9550
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01009551
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkiaeebf9b2009-10-04 15:43:17 +02009552option socket-stats
9553no option socket-stats
9554
9555 Enable or disable collecting & providing separate statistics for each socket.
9556 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9557 yes | yes | yes | no
9558
9559 Arguments : none
9560
9561
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01009562option splice-auto
9563no option splice-auto
9564 Enable or disable automatic kernel acceleration on sockets in both directions
9565 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9566 yes | yes | yes | yes
9567 Arguments : none
9568
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04009569 When this option is enabled either on a frontend or on a backend, HAProxy
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01009570 will automatically evaluate the opportunity to use kernel tcp splicing to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009571 forward data between the client and the server, in either direction. HAProxy
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01009572 uses heuristics to estimate if kernel splicing might improve performance or
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01009573 not. Both directions are handled independently. Note that the heuristics used
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01009574 are not much aggressive in order to limit excessive use of splicing. This
9575 option requires splicing to be enabled at compile time, and may be globally
9576 disabled with the global option "nosplice". Since splice uses pipes, using it
9577 requires that there are enough spare pipes.
9578
9579 Important note: kernel-based TCP splicing is a Linux-specific feature which
9580 first appeared in kernel 2.6.25. It offers kernel-based acceleration to
9581 transfer data between sockets without copying these data to user-space, thus
9582 providing noticeable performance gains and CPU cycles savings. Since many
9583 early implementations are buggy, corrupt data and/or are inefficient, this
9584 feature is not enabled by default, and it should be used with extreme care.
9585 While it is not possible to detect the correctness of an implementation,
9586 2.6.29 is the first version offering a properly working implementation. In
9587 case of doubt, splicing may be globally disabled using the global "nosplice"
9588 keyword.
9589
9590 Example :
9591 option splice-auto
9592
9593 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
9594 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
9595
9596 See also : "option splice-request", "option splice-response", and global
9597 options "nosplice" and "maxpipes"
9598
9599
9600option splice-request
9601no option splice-request
9602 Enable or disable automatic kernel acceleration on sockets for requests
9603 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9604 yes | yes | yes | yes
9605 Arguments : none
9606
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04009607 When this option is enabled either on a frontend or on a backend, HAProxy
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04009608 will use kernel tcp splicing whenever possible to forward data going from
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01009609 the client to the server. It might still use the recv/send scheme if there
9610 are no spare pipes left. This option requires splicing to be enabled at
9611 compile time, and may be globally disabled with the global option "nosplice".
9612 Since splice uses pipes, using it requires that there are enough spare pipes.
9613
9614 Important note: see "option splice-auto" for usage limitations.
9615
9616 Example :
9617 option splice-request
9618
9619 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
9620 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
9621
9622 See also : "option splice-auto", "option splice-response", and global options
9623 "nosplice" and "maxpipes"
9624
9625
9626option splice-response
9627no option splice-response
9628 Enable or disable automatic kernel acceleration on sockets for responses
9629 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9630 yes | yes | yes | yes
9631 Arguments : none
9632
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04009633 When this option is enabled either on a frontend or on a backend, HAProxy
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04009634 will use kernel tcp splicing whenever possible to forward data going from
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01009635 the server to the client. It might still use the recv/send scheme if there
9636 are no spare pipes left. This option requires splicing to be enabled at
9637 compile time, and may be globally disabled with the global option "nosplice".
9638 Since splice uses pipes, using it requires that there are enough spare pipes.
9639
9640 Important note: see "option splice-auto" for usage limitations.
9641
9642 Example :
9643 option splice-response
9644
9645 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
9646 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
9647
9648 See also : "option splice-auto", "option splice-request", and global options
9649 "nosplice" and "maxpipes"
9650
9651
Christopher Fauletba7bc162016-11-07 21:07:38 +01009652option spop-check
9653 Use SPOP health checks for server testing
9654 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Aurelien DARRAGON54832622023-01-12 15:06:11 +01009655 yes | no | yes | yes
Christopher Fauletba7bc162016-11-07 21:07:38 +01009656 Arguments : none
9657
9658 It is possible to test that the server correctly talks SPOP protocol instead
9659 of just testing that it accepts the TCP connection. When this option is set,
9660 a HELLO handshake is performed between HAProxy and the server, and the
9661 response is analyzed to check no error is reported.
9662
9663 Example :
9664 option spop-check
9665
9666 See also : "option httpchk"
9667
9668
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01009669option srvtcpka
9670no option srvtcpka
9671 Enable or disable the sending of TCP keepalive packets on the server side
9672 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9673 yes | no | yes | yes
9674 Arguments : none
9675
9676 When there is a firewall or any session-aware component between a client and
9677 a server, and when the protocol involves very long sessions with long idle
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009678 periods (e.g. remote desktops), there is a risk that one of the intermediate
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01009679 components decides to expire a session which has remained idle for too long.
9680
9681 Enabling socket-level TCP keep-alives makes the system regularly send packets
9682 to the other end of the connection, leaving it active. The delay between
9683 keep-alive probes is controlled by the system only and depends both on the
9684 operating system and its tuning parameters.
9685
9686 It is important to understand that keep-alive packets are neither emitted nor
9687 received at the application level. It is only the network stacks which sees
9688 them. For this reason, even if one side of the proxy already uses keep-alives
9689 to maintain its connection alive, those keep-alive packets will not be
9690 forwarded to the other side of the proxy.
9691
9692 Please note that this has nothing to do with HTTP keep-alive.
9693
9694 Using option "srvtcpka" enables the emission of TCP keep-alive probes on the
9695 server side of a connection, which should help when session expirations are
9696 noticed between HAProxy and a server.
9697
9698 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
9699 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
9700
9701 See also : "option clitcpka", "option tcpka"
9702
9703
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01009704option ssl-hello-chk
9705 Use SSLv3 client hello health checks for server testing
9706 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9707 yes | no | yes | yes
9708 Arguments : none
9709
9710 When some SSL-based protocols are relayed in TCP mode through HAProxy, it is
9711 possible to test that the server correctly talks SSL instead of just testing
9712 that it accepts the TCP connection. When "option ssl-hello-chk" is set, pure
9713 SSLv3 client hello messages are sent once the connection is established to
9714 the server, and the response is analyzed to find an SSL server hello message.
9715 The server is considered valid only when the response contains this server
9716 hello message.
9717
9718 All servers tested till there correctly reply to SSLv3 client hello messages,
9719 and most servers tested do not even log the requests containing only hello
9720 messages, which is appreciable.
9721
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04009722 Note that this check works even when SSL support was not built into HAProxy
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +02009723 because it forges the SSL message. When SSL support is available, it is best
9724 to use native SSL health checks instead of this one.
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01009725
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +02009726 See also: "option httpchk", "check-ssl"
9727
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01009728
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01009729option tcp-check
9730 Perform health checks using tcp-check send/expect sequences
9731 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9732 yes | no | yes | yes
9733
9734 This health check method is intended to be combined with "tcp-check" command
9735 lists in order to support send/expect types of health check sequences.
9736
9737 TCP checks currently support 4 modes of operations :
9738 - no "tcp-check" directive : the health check only consists in a connection
9739 attempt, which remains the default mode.
9740
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03009741 - "tcp-check send" or "tcp-check send-binary" only is mentioned : this is
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01009742 used to send a string along with a connection opening. With some
9743 protocols, it helps sending a "QUIT" message for example that prevents
9744 the server from logging a connection error for each health check. The
9745 check result will still be based on the ability to open the connection
9746 only.
9747
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03009748 - "tcp-check expect" only is mentioned : this is used to test a banner.
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04009749 The connection is opened and HAProxy waits for the server to present some
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01009750 contents which must validate some rules. The check result will be based
9751 on the matching between the contents and the rules. This is suited for
9752 POP, IMAP, SMTP, FTP, SSH, TELNET.
9753
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03009754 - both "tcp-check send" and "tcp-check expect" are mentioned : this is
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009755 used to test a hello-type protocol. HAProxy sends a message, the server
9756 responds and its response is analyzed. the check result will be based on
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03009757 the matching between the response contents and the rules. This is often
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01009758 suited for protocols which require a binding or a request/response model.
9759 LDAP, MySQL, Redis and SSL are example of such protocols, though they
9760 already all have their dedicated checks with a deeper understanding of
9761 the respective protocols.
9762 In this mode, many questions may be sent and many answers may be
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009763 analyzed.
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01009764
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02009765 A fifth mode can be used to insert comments in different steps of the script.
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02009766
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02009767 For each tcp-check rule you create, you can add a "comment" directive,
9768 followed by a string. This string will be reported in the log and stderr in
9769 debug mode. It is useful to make user-friendly error reporting. The
9770 "comment" is of course optional.
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02009771
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02009772 During the execution of a health check, a variable scope is made available to
9773 store data samples, using the "tcp-check set-var" operation. Freeing those
9774 variable is possible using "tcp-check unset-var".
Gaetan Rivet0c39ecc2020-02-24 17:34:11 +01009775
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02009776
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01009777 Examples :
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009778 # perform a POP check (analyze only server's banner)
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01009779 option tcp-check
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02009780 tcp-check expect string +OK\ POP3\ ready comment POP\ protocol
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01009781
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009782 # perform an IMAP check (analyze only server's banner)
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01009783 option tcp-check
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02009784 tcp-check expect string *\ OK\ IMAP4\ ready comment IMAP\ protocol
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01009785
9786 # look for the redis master server after ensuring it speaks well
9787 # redis protocol, then it exits properly.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009788 # (send a command then analyze the response 3 times)
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01009789 option tcp-check
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02009790 tcp-check comment PING\ phase
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01009791 tcp-check send PING\r\n
Baptiste Assmanna3322992015-08-04 10:12:18 +02009792 tcp-check expect string +PONG
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02009793 tcp-check comment role\ check
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01009794 tcp-check send info\ replication\r\n
9795 tcp-check expect string role:master
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02009796 tcp-check comment QUIT\ phase
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01009797 tcp-check send QUIT\r\n
9798 tcp-check expect string +OK
9799
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009800 forge a HTTP request, then analyze the response
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01009801 (send many headers before analyzing)
9802 option tcp-check
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02009803 tcp-check comment forge\ and\ send\ HTTP\ request
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01009804 tcp-check send HEAD\ /\ HTTP/1.1\r\n
9805 tcp-check send Host:\ www.mydomain.com\r\n
9806 tcp-check send User-Agent:\ HAProxy\ tcpcheck\r\n
9807 tcp-check send \r\n
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02009808 tcp-check expect rstring HTTP/1\..\ (2..|3..) comment check\ HTTP\ response
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01009809
9810
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02009811 See also : "tcp-check connect", "tcp-check expect" and "tcp-check send".
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01009812
9813
Willy Tarreau9ea05a72009-06-14 12:07:01 +02009814option tcp-smart-accept
9815no option tcp-smart-accept
9816 Enable or disable the saving of one ACK packet during the accept sequence
9817 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9818 yes | yes | yes | no
9819 Arguments : none
9820
9821 When an HTTP connection request comes in, the system acknowledges it on
9822 behalf of HAProxy, then the client immediately sends its request, and the
9823 system acknowledges it too while it is notifying HAProxy about the new
9824 connection. HAProxy then reads the request and responds. This means that we
9825 have one TCP ACK sent by the system for nothing, because the request could
9826 very well be acknowledged by HAProxy when it sends its response.
9827
9828 For this reason, in HTTP mode, HAProxy automatically asks the system to avoid
9829 sending this useless ACK on platforms which support it (currently at least
9830 Linux). It must not cause any problem, because the system will send it anyway
9831 after 40 ms if the response takes more time than expected to come.
9832
9833 During complex network debugging sessions, it may be desirable to disable
9834 this optimization because delayed ACKs can make troubleshooting more complex
9835 when trying to identify where packets are delayed. It is then possible to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009836 fall back to normal behavior by specifying "no option tcp-smart-accept".
Willy Tarreau9ea05a72009-06-14 12:07:01 +02009837
9838 It is also possible to force it for non-HTTP proxies by simply specifying
9839 "option tcp-smart-accept". For instance, it can make sense with some services
9840 such as SMTP where the server speaks first.
9841
9842 It is recommended to avoid forcing this option in a defaults section. In case
9843 of doubt, consider setting it back to automatic values by prepending the
9844 "default" keyword before it, or disabling it using the "no" keyword.
9845
Willy Tarreaud88edf22009-06-14 15:48:17 +02009846 See also : "option tcp-smart-connect"
9847
9848
9849option tcp-smart-connect
9850no option tcp-smart-connect
9851 Enable or disable the saving of one ACK packet during the connect sequence
9852 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9853 yes | no | yes | yes
9854 Arguments : none
9855
9856 On certain systems (at least Linux), HAProxy can ask the kernel not to
9857 immediately send an empty ACK upon a connection request, but to directly
9858 send the buffer request instead. This saves one packet on the network and
9859 thus boosts performance. It can also be useful for some servers, because they
9860 immediately get the request along with the incoming connection.
9861
9862 This feature is enabled when "option tcp-smart-connect" is set in a backend.
9863 It is not enabled by default because it makes network troubleshooting more
9864 complex.
9865
9866 It only makes sense to enable it with protocols where the client speaks first
9867 such as HTTP. In other situations, if there is no data to send in place of
9868 the ACK, a normal ACK is sent.
9869
9870 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
9871 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
9872
9873 See also : "option tcp-smart-accept"
9874
Willy Tarreau9ea05a72009-06-14 12:07:01 +02009875
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01009876option tcpka
9877 Enable or disable the sending of TCP keepalive packets on both sides
9878 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9879 yes | yes | yes | yes
9880 Arguments : none
9881
9882 When there is a firewall or any session-aware component between a client and
9883 a server, and when the protocol involves very long sessions with long idle
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009884 periods (e.g. remote desktops), there is a risk that one of the intermediate
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01009885 components decides to expire a session which has remained idle for too long.
9886
9887 Enabling socket-level TCP keep-alives makes the system regularly send packets
9888 to the other end of the connection, leaving it active. The delay between
9889 keep-alive probes is controlled by the system only and depends both on the
9890 operating system and its tuning parameters.
9891
9892 It is important to understand that keep-alive packets are neither emitted nor
9893 received at the application level. It is only the network stacks which sees
9894 them. For this reason, even if one side of the proxy already uses keep-alives
9895 to maintain its connection alive, those keep-alive packets will not be
9896 forwarded to the other side of the proxy.
9897
9898 Please note that this has nothing to do with HTTP keep-alive.
9899
9900 Using option "tcpka" enables the emission of TCP keep-alive probes on both
9901 the client and server sides of a connection. Note that this is meaningful
9902 only in "defaults" or "listen" sections. If this option is used in a
9903 frontend, only the client side will get keep-alives, and if this option is
9904 used in a backend, only the server side will get keep-alives. For this
9905 reason, it is strongly recommended to explicitly use "option clitcpka" and
9906 "option srvtcpka" when the configuration is split between frontends and
9907 backends.
9908
9909 See also : "option clitcpka", "option srvtcpka"
9910
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01009911
9912option tcplog
9913 Enable advanced logging of TCP connections with session state and timers
9914 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Tim Duesterhus9ad9f352018-02-05 20:52:27 +01009915 yes | yes | yes | no
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01009916 Arguments : none
9917
9918 By default, the log output format is very poor, as it only contains the
9919 source and destination addresses, and the instance name. By specifying
9920 "option tcplog", each log line turns into a much richer format including, but
9921 not limited to, the connection timers, the session status, the connections
9922 numbers, the frontend, backend and server name, and of course the source
9923 address and ports. This option is useful for pure TCP proxies in order to
9924 find which of the client or server disconnects or times out. For normal HTTP
9925 proxies, it's better to use "option httplog" which is even more complete.
9926
Guillaume de Lafond29f45602017-03-31 19:52:15 +02009927 "option tcplog" overrides any previous "log-format" directive.
9928
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009929 See also : "option httplog", and section 8 about logging.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01009930
9931
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01009932option transparent
9933no option transparent
9934 Enable client-side transparent proxying
9935 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreau4b1f8592008-12-23 23:13:55 +01009936 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01009937 Arguments : none
9938
9939 This option was introduced in order to provide layer 7 persistence to layer 3
9940 load balancers. The idea is to use the OS's ability to redirect an incoming
9941 connection for a remote address to a local process (here HAProxy), and let
9942 this process know what address was initially requested. When this option is
9943 used, sessions without cookies will be forwarded to the original destination
9944 IP address of the incoming request (which should match that of another
9945 equipment), while requests with cookies will still be forwarded to the
9946 appropriate server.
9947
9948 Note that contrary to a common belief, this option does NOT make HAProxy
9949 present the client's IP to the server when establishing the connection.
9950
Willy Tarreaua1146052011-03-01 09:51:54 +01009951 See also: the "usesrc" argument of the "source" keyword, and the
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01009952 "transparent" option of the "bind" keyword.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01009953
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01009954
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09009955external-check command <command>
9956 Executable to run when performing an external-check
9957 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9958 yes | no | yes | yes
9959
9960 Arguments :
9961 <command> is the external command to run
9962
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09009963 The arguments passed to the to the command are:
9964
Cyril Bonté777be862014-12-02 21:21:35 +01009965 <proxy_address> <proxy_port> <server_address> <server_port>
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09009966
Cyril Bonté777be862014-12-02 21:21:35 +01009967 The <proxy_address> and <proxy_port> are derived from the first listener
9968 that is either IPv4, IPv6 or a UNIX socket. In the case of a UNIX socket
9969 listener the proxy_address will be the path of the socket and the
9970 <proxy_port> will be the string "NOT_USED". In a backend section, it's not
9971 possible to determine a listener, and both <proxy_address> and <proxy_port>
9972 will have the string value "NOT_USED".
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09009973
Cyril Bonté72cda2a2014-12-27 22:28:39 +01009974 Some values are also provided through environment variables.
9975
9976 Environment variables :
9977 HAPROXY_PROXY_ADDR The first bind address if available (or empty if not
9978 applicable, for example in a "backend" section).
9979
9980 HAPROXY_PROXY_ID The backend id.
9981
9982 HAPROXY_PROXY_NAME The backend name.
9983
9984 HAPROXY_PROXY_PORT The first bind port if available (or empty if not
9985 applicable, for example in a "backend" section or
9986 for a UNIX socket).
9987
9988 HAPROXY_SERVER_ADDR The server address.
9989
9990 HAPROXY_SERVER_CURCONN The current number of connections on the server.
9991
9992 HAPROXY_SERVER_ID The server id.
9993
9994 HAPROXY_SERVER_MAXCONN The server max connections.
9995
9996 HAPROXY_SERVER_NAME The server name.
9997
9998 HAPROXY_SERVER_PORT The server port if available (or empty for a UNIX
9999 socket).
10000
10001 PATH The PATH environment variable used when executing
10002 the command may be set using "external-check path".
10003
William Lallemand4d03e432019-06-14 15:35:37 +020010004 See also "2.3. Environment variables" for other variables.
10005
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +090010006 If the command executed and exits with a zero status then the check is
10007 considered to have passed, otherwise the check is considered to have
10008 failed.
10009
10010 Example :
10011 external-check command /bin/true
10012
10013 See also : "external-check", "option external-check", "external-check path"
10014
10015
10016external-check path <path>
10017 The value of the PATH environment variable used when running an external-check
10018 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10019 yes | no | yes | yes
10020
10021 Arguments :
10022 <path> is the path used when executing external command to run
10023
10024 The default path is "".
10025
10026 Example :
10027 external-check path "/usr/bin:/bin"
10028
10029 See also : "external-check", "option external-check",
10030 "external-check command"
10031
10032
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +020010033persist rdp-cookie
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +020010034persist rdp-cookie(<name>)
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +020010035 Enable RDP cookie-based persistence
10036 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10037 yes | no | yes | yes
10038 Arguments :
10039 <name> is the optional name of the RDP cookie to check. If omitted, the
Willy Tarreau61e28f22010-05-16 22:31:05 +020010040 default cookie name "msts" will be used. There currently is no
10041 valid reason to change this name.
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +020010042
10043 This statement enables persistence based on an RDP cookie. The RDP cookie
10044 contains all information required to find the server in the list of known
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010045 servers. So when this option is set in the backend, the request is analyzed
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +020010046 and if an RDP cookie is found, it is decoded. If it matches a known server
10047 which is still UP (or if "option persist" is set), then the connection is
10048 forwarded to this server.
10049
10050 Note that this only makes sense in a TCP backend, but for this to work, the
10051 frontend must have waited long enough to ensure that an RDP cookie is present
10052 in the request buffer. This is the same requirement as with the "rdp-cookie"
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010010053 load-balancing method. Thus it is highly recommended to put all statements in
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +020010054 a single "listen" section.
10055
Willy Tarreau61e28f22010-05-16 22:31:05 +020010056 Also, it is important to understand that the terminal server will emit this
10057 RDP cookie only if it is configured for "token redirection mode", which means
10058 that the "IP address redirection" option is disabled.
10059
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +020010060 Example :
10061 listen tse-farm
10062 bind :3389
10063 # wait up to 5s for an RDP cookie in the request
10064 tcp-request inspect-delay 5s
10065 tcp-request content accept if RDP_COOKIE
10066 # apply RDP cookie persistence
10067 persist rdp-cookie
10068 # if server is unknown, let's balance on the same cookie.
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +020010069 # alternatively, "balance leastconn" may be useful too.
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +020010070 balance rdp-cookie
10071 server srv1 1.1.1.1:3389
10072 server srv2 1.1.1.2:3389
10073
Christian Ruppertfd3184c2022-02-20 22:54:01 +010010074 See also : "balance rdp-cookie", "tcp-request" and the "req.rdp_cookie" ACL.
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +020010075
10076
Willy Tarreau3a7d2072009-03-05 23:48:25 +010010077rate-limit sessions <rate>
10078 Set a limit on the number of new sessions accepted per second on a frontend
10079 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10080 yes | yes | yes | no
10081 Arguments :
10082 <rate> The <rate> parameter is an integer designating the maximum number
10083 of new sessions per second to accept on the frontend.
10084
10085 When the frontend reaches the specified number of new sessions per second, it
10086 stops accepting new connections until the rate drops below the limit again.
10087 During this time, the pending sessions will be kept in the socket's backlog
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040010088 (in system buffers) and HAProxy will not even be aware that sessions are
Willy Tarreau3a7d2072009-03-05 23:48:25 +010010089 pending. When applying very low limit on a highly loaded service, it may make
10090 sense to increase the socket's backlog using the "backlog" keyword.
10091
10092 This feature is particularly efficient at blocking connection-based attacks
10093 or service abuse on fragile servers. Since the session rate is measured every
10094 millisecond, it is extremely accurate. Also, the limit applies immediately,
10095 no delay is needed at all to detect the threshold.
10096
10097 Example : limit the connection rate on SMTP to 10 per second max
10098 listen smtp
10099 mode tcp
10100 bind :25
10101 rate-limit sessions 10
Panagiotis Panagiotopoulos7282d8e2016-02-11 16:37:15 +020010102 server smtp1 127.0.0.1:1025
Willy Tarreau3a7d2072009-03-05 23:48:25 +010010103
Willy Tarreaua17c2d92011-07-25 08:16:20 +020010104 Note : when the maximum rate is reached, the frontend's status is not changed
10105 but its sockets appear as "WAITING" in the statistics if the
10106 "socket-stats" option is enabled.
Willy Tarreau3a7d2072009-03-05 23:48:25 +010010107
10108 See also : the "backlog" keyword and the "fe_sess_rate" ACL criterion.
10109
10110
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +020010111redirect location <loc> [code <code>] <option> [{if | unless} <condition>]
10112redirect prefix <pfx> [code <code>] <option> [{if | unless} <condition>]
10113redirect scheme <sch> [code <code>] <option> [{if | unless} <condition>]
Willy Tarreaub463dfb2008-06-07 23:08:56 +020010114 Return an HTTP redirection if/unless a condition is matched
10115 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10116 no | yes | yes | yes
10117
10118 If/unless the condition is matched, the HTTP request will lead to a redirect
Willy Tarreauf285f542010-01-03 20:03:03 +010010119 response. If no condition is specified, the redirect applies unconditionally.
Willy Tarreaub463dfb2008-06-07 23:08:56 +020010120
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +010010121 Arguments :
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +020010122 <loc> With "redirect location", the exact value in <loc> is placed into
Thierry FOURNIERd18cd0f2013-11-29 12:15:45 +010010123 the HTTP "Location" header. When used in an "http-request" rule,
10124 <loc> value follows the log-format rules and can include some
10125 dynamic values (see Custom Log Format in section 8.2.4).
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +020010126
10127 <pfx> With "redirect prefix", the "Location" header is built from the
10128 concatenation of <pfx> and the complete URI path, including the
10129 query string, unless the "drop-query" option is specified (see
10130 below). As a special case, if <pfx> equals exactly "/", then
10131 nothing is inserted before the original URI. It allows one to
Thierry FOURNIERd18cd0f2013-11-29 12:15:45 +010010132 redirect to the same URL (for instance, to insert a cookie). When
10133 used in an "http-request" rule, <pfx> value follows the log-format
10134 rules and can include some dynamic values (see Custom Log Format
10135 in section 8.2.4).
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +020010136
10137 <sch> With "redirect scheme", then the "Location" header is built by
10138 concatenating <sch> with "://" then the first occurrence of the
10139 "Host" header, and then the URI path, including the query string
10140 unless the "drop-query" option is specified (see below). If no
10141 path is found or if the path is "*", then "/" is used instead. If
10142 no "Host" header is found, then an empty host component will be
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030010143 returned, which most recent browsers interpret as redirecting to
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +020010144 the same host. This directive is mostly used to redirect HTTP to
Thierry FOURNIERd18cd0f2013-11-29 12:15:45 +010010145 HTTPS. When used in an "http-request" rule, <sch> value follows
10146 the log-format rules and can include some dynamic values (see
10147 Custom Log Format in section 8.2.4).
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +010010148
10149 <code> The code is optional. It indicates which type of HTTP redirection
Willy Tarreaub67fdc42013-03-29 19:28:11 +010010150 is desired. Only codes 301, 302, 303, 307 and 308 are supported,
10151 with 302 used by default if no code is specified. 301 means
10152 "Moved permanently", and a browser may cache the Location. 302
Baptiste Assmannea849c02015-08-03 11:42:50 +020010153 means "Moved temporarily" and means that the browser should not
Willy Tarreaub67fdc42013-03-29 19:28:11 +010010154 cache the redirection. 303 is equivalent to 302 except that the
10155 browser will fetch the location with a GET method. 307 is just
10156 like 302 but makes it clear that the same method must be reused.
10157 Likewise, 308 replaces 301 if the same method must be used.
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +010010158
10159 <option> There are several options which can be specified to adjust the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010160 expected behavior of a redirection :
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +010010161
10162 - "drop-query"
10163 When this keyword is used in a prefix-based redirection, then the
10164 location will be set without any possible query-string, which is useful
10165 for directing users to a non-secure page for instance. It has no effect
10166 with a location-type redirect.
10167
Willy Tarreau81e3b4f2010-01-10 00:42:19 +010010168 - "append-slash"
10169 This keyword may be used in conjunction with "drop-query" to redirect
10170 users who use a URL not ending with a '/' to the same one with the '/'.
10171 It can be useful to ensure that search engines will only see one URL.
10172 For this, a return code 301 is preferred.
10173
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +010010174 - "set-cookie NAME[=value]"
10175 A "Set-Cookie" header will be added with NAME (and optionally "=value")
10176 to the response. This is sometimes used to indicate that a user has
10177 been seen, for instance to protect against some types of DoS. No other
10178 cookie option is added, so the cookie will be a session cookie. Note
10179 that for a browser, a sole cookie name without an equal sign is
10180 different from a cookie with an equal sign.
10181
10182 - "clear-cookie NAME[=]"
10183 A "Set-Cookie" header will be added with NAME (and optionally "="), but
10184 with the "Max-Age" attribute set to zero. This will tell the browser to
10185 delete this cookie. It is useful for instance on logout pages. It is
10186 important to note that clearing the cookie "NAME" will not remove a
10187 cookie set with "NAME=value". You have to clear the cookie "NAME=" for
10188 that, because the browser makes the difference.
Willy Tarreaub463dfb2008-06-07 23:08:56 +020010189
10190 Example: move the login URL only to HTTPS.
10191 acl clear dst_port 80
10192 acl secure dst_port 8080
10193 acl login_page url_beg /login
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +010010194 acl logout url_beg /logout
Willy Tarreau79da4692008-11-19 20:03:04 +010010195 acl uid_given url_reg /login?userid=[^&]+
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +010010196 acl cookie_set hdr_sub(cookie) SEEN=1
10197
10198 redirect prefix https://mysite.com set-cookie SEEN=1 if !cookie_set
Willy Tarreau79da4692008-11-19 20:03:04 +010010199 redirect prefix https://mysite.com if login_page !secure
10200 redirect prefix http://mysite.com drop-query if login_page !uid_given
10201 redirect location http://mysite.com/ if !login_page secure
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +010010202 redirect location / clear-cookie USERID= if logout
Willy Tarreaub463dfb2008-06-07 23:08:56 +020010203
Willy Tarreau81e3b4f2010-01-10 00:42:19 +010010204 Example: send redirects for request for articles without a '/'.
10205 acl missing_slash path_reg ^/article/[^/]*$
10206 redirect code 301 prefix / drop-query append-slash if missing_slash
10207
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040010208 Example: redirect all HTTP traffic to HTTPS when SSL is handled by HAProxy.
David BERARDe7153042012-11-03 00:11:31 +010010209 redirect scheme https if !{ ssl_fc }
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +020010210
Thierry FOURNIERd18cd0f2013-11-29 12:15:45 +010010211 Example: append 'www.' prefix in front of all hosts not having it
Coen Rosdorff596659b2016-04-11 11:33:49 +020010212 http-request redirect code 301 location \
10213 http://www.%[hdr(host)]%[capture.req.uri] \
10214 unless { hdr_beg(host) -i www }
Thierry FOURNIERd18cd0f2013-11-29 12:15:45 +010010215
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020010216 See section 7 about ACL usage.
Willy Tarreaub463dfb2008-06-07 23:08:56 +020010217
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +010010218
Willy Tarreaue5c5ce92008-06-20 17:27:19 +020010219retries <value>
Willy Tarreaucc834882022-11-25 11:06:20 +010010220 Set the number of retries to perform on a server after a failure
Willy Tarreaue5c5ce92008-06-20 17:27:19 +020010221 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10222 yes | no | yes | yes
10223 Arguments :
Willy Tarreaucc834882022-11-25 11:06:20 +010010224 <value> is the number of times a request or connection attempt should be
10225 retried on a server after a failure.
Willy Tarreaue5c5ce92008-06-20 17:27:19 +020010226
Willy Tarreaucc834882022-11-25 11:06:20 +010010227 By default, retries apply only to new connection attempts. However, when
10228 the "retry-on" directive is used, other conditions might trigger a retry
10229 (e.g. empty response, undesired status code), and each of them will count
10230 one attempt, and when the total number attempts reaches the value here, an
10231 error will be returned.
Willy Tarreaue5c5ce92008-06-20 17:27:19 +020010232
10233 In order to avoid immediate reconnections to a server which is restarting,
Joseph Lynch726ab712015-05-11 23:25:34 -070010234 a turn-around timer of min("timeout connect", one second) is applied before
Willy Tarreaucc834882022-11-25 11:06:20 +010010235 a retry occurs on the same server.
Willy Tarreaue5c5ce92008-06-20 17:27:19 +020010236
Willy Tarreaucc834882022-11-25 11:06:20 +010010237 When "option redispatch" is set, some retries may be performed on another
10238 server even if a cookie references a different server. By default this will
10239 only be the last retry unless an argument is passed to "option redispatch".
Willy Tarreaue5c5ce92008-06-20 17:27:19 +020010240
10241 See also : "option redispatch"
10242
10243
Lukas Tribusbb474ff2021-12-08 11:33:01 +010010244retry-on [space-delimited list of keywords]
Jerome Magnin5ce3c142020-05-13 20:09:57 +020010245 Specify when to attempt to automatically retry a failed request.
10246 This setting is only valid when "mode" is set to http and is silently ignored
10247 otherwise.
Olivier Houcharda254a372019-04-05 15:30:12 +020010248 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10249 yes | no | yes | yes
10250 Arguments :
Lukas Tribusbb474ff2021-12-08 11:33:01 +010010251 <keywords> is a space-delimited list of keywords or HTTP status codes, each
10252 representing a type of failure event on which an attempt to
10253 retry the request is desired. Please read the notes at the
10254 bottom before changing this setting. The following keywords are
10255 supported :
Olivier Houcharda254a372019-04-05 15:30:12 +020010256
10257 none never retry
10258
10259 conn-failure retry when the connection or the SSL handshake failed
10260 and the request could not be sent. This is the default.
10261
10262 empty-response retry when the server connection was closed after part
10263 of the request was sent, and nothing was received from
10264 the server. This type of failure may be caused by the
10265 request timeout on the server side, poor network
10266 condition, or a server crash or restart while
10267 processing the request.
10268
Olivier Houcharde3249a92019-05-03 23:01:47 +020010269 junk-response retry when the server returned something not looking
10270 like a complete HTTP response. This includes partial
10271 responses headers as well as non-HTTP contents. It
10272 usually is a bad idea to retry on such events, which
10273 may be caused a configuration issue (wrong server port)
10274 or by the request being harmful to the server (buffer
10275 overflow attack for example).
10276
Olivier Houcharda254a372019-04-05 15:30:12 +020010277 response-timeout the server timeout stroke while waiting for the server
10278 to respond to the request. This may be caused by poor
10279 network condition, the reuse of an idle connection
10280 which has expired on the path, or by the request being
10281 extremely expensive to process. It generally is a bad
10282 idea to retry on such events on servers dealing with
10283 heavy database processing (full scans, etc) as it may
10284 amplify denial of service attacks.
10285
Olivier Houchard865d8392019-05-03 22:46:27 +020010286 0rtt-rejected retry requests which were sent over early data and were
10287 rejected by the server. These requests are generally
10288 considered to be safe to retry.
10289
Julien Pivotto2de240a2020-11-12 11:14:05 +010010290 <status> any HTTP status code among "401" (Unauthorized), "403"
10291 (Forbidden), "404" (Not Found), "408" (Request Timeout),
10292 "425" (Too Early), "500" (Server Error), "501" (Not
10293 Implemented), "502" (Bad Gateway), "503" (Service
10294 Unavailable), "504" (Gateway Timeout).
Olivier Houcharda254a372019-04-05 15:30:12 +020010295
Olivier Houchardddf0e032019-05-10 18:05:40 +020010296 all-retryable-errors
10297 retry request for any error that are considered
10298 retryable. This currently activates "conn-failure",
10299 "empty-response", "junk-response", "response-timeout",
10300 "0rtt-rejected", "500", "502", "503", and "504".
10301
Olivier Houcharda254a372019-04-05 15:30:12 +020010302 Using this directive replaces any previous settings with the new ones; it is
10303 not cumulative.
10304
10305 Please note that using anything other than "none" and "conn-failure" requires
10306 to allocate a buffer and copy the whole request into it, so it has memory and
10307 performance impacts. Requests not fitting in a single buffer will never be
10308 retried (see the global tune.bufsize setting).
10309
10310 You have to make sure the application has a replay protection mechanism built
10311 in such as a unique transaction IDs passed in requests, or that replaying the
10312 same request has no consequence, or it is very dangerous to use any retry-on
10313 value beside "conn-failure" and "none". Static file servers and caches are
10314 generally considered safe against any type of retry. Using a status code can
10315 be useful to quickly leave a server showing an abnormal behavior (out of
10316 memory, file system issues, etc), but in this case it may be a good idea to
10317 immediately redispatch the connection to another server (please see "option
10318 redispatch" for this). Last, it is important to understand that most causes
10319 of failures are the requests themselves and that retrying a request causing a
10320 server to misbehave will often make the situation even worse for this server,
10321 or for the whole service in case of redispatch.
10322
10323 Unless you know exactly how the application deals with replayed requests, you
10324 should not use this directive.
10325
10326 The default is "conn-failure".
10327
Lukas Tribusbb474ff2021-12-08 11:33:01 +010010328 Example:
10329 retry-on 503 504
10330
Olivier Houcharda254a372019-04-05 15:30:12 +020010331 See also: "retries", "option redispatch", "tune.bufsize"
10332
David du Colombier486df472011-03-17 10:40:26 +010010333server <name> <address>[:[port]] [param*]
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010334 Declare a server in a backend
10335 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10336 no | no | yes | yes
10337 Arguments :
10338 <name> is the internal name assigned to this server. This name will
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010339 appear in logs and alerts. If "http-send-name-header" is
Mark Lamourinec2247f02012-01-04 13:02:01 -050010340 set, it will be added to the request header sent to the server.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010341
David du Colombier486df472011-03-17 10:40:26 +010010342 <address> is the IPv4 or IPv6 address of the server. Alternatively, a
10343 resolvable hostname is supported, but this name will be resolved
10344 during start-up. Address "0.0.0.0" or "*" has a special meaning.
10345 It indicates that the connection will be forwarded to the same IP
Willy Tarreaud669a4f2010-07-13 14:49:50 +020010346 address as the one from the client connection. This is useful in
10347 transparent proxy architectures where the client's connection is
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040010348 intercepted and HAProxy must forward to the original destination
Willy Tarreaud669a4f2010-07-13 14:49:50 +020010349 address. This is more or less what the "transparent" keyword does
10350 except that with a server it's possible to limit concurrency and
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +010010351 to report statistics. Optionally, an address family prefix may be
10352 used before the address to force the family regardless of the
10353 address format, which can be useful to specify a path to a unix
10354 socket with no slash ('/'). Currently supported prefixes are :
10355 - 'ipv4@' -> address is always IPv4
10356 - 'ipv6@' -> address is always IPv6
10357 - 'unix@' -> address is a path to a local unix socket
Willy Tarreauccfccef2014-05-10 01:49:15 +020010358 - 'abns@' -> address is in abstract namespace (Linux only)
William Lallemand2fe7dd02018-09-11 16:51:29 +020010359 - 'sockpair@' -> address is the FD of a connected unix
10360 socket or of a socketpair. During a connection, the
10361 backend creates a pair of connected sockets, and passes
10362 one of them over the FD. The bind part will use the
10363 received socket as the client FD. Should be used
10364 carefully.
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +020010365 You may want to reference some environment variables in the
10366 address parameter, see section 2.3 about environment
Willy Tarreau6a031d12016-11-07 19:42:35 +010010367 variables. The "init-addr" setting can be used to modify the way
10368 IP addresses should be resolved upon startup.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010369
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020010370 <port> is an optional port specification. If set, all connections will
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010371 be sent to this port. If unset, the same port the client
10372 connected to will be used. The port may also be prefixed by a "+"
10373 or a "-". In this case, the server's port will be determined by
10374 adding this value to the client's port.
10375
10376 <param*> is a list of parameters for this server. The "server" keywords
10377 accepts an important number of options and has a complete section
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020010378 dedicated to it. Please refer to section 5 for more details.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010379
10380 Examples :
10381 server first 10.1.1.1:1080 cookie first check inter 1000
10382 server second 10.1.1.2:1080 cookie second check inter 1000
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +010010383 server transp ipv4@
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +020010384 server backup "${SRV_BACKUP}:1080" backup
10385 server www1_dc1 "${LAN_DC1}.101:80"
10386 server www1_dc2 "${LAN_DC2}.101:80"
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010387
Willy Tarreau55dcaf62015-09-27 15:03:15 +020010388 Note: regarding Linux's abstract namespace sockets, HAProxy uses the whole
10389 sun_path length is used for the address length. Some other programs
10390 such as socat use the string length only by default. Pass the option
10391 ",unix-tightsocklen=0" to any abstract socket definition in socat to
10392 make it compatible with HAProxy's.
10393
Mark Lamourinec2247f02012-01-04 13:02:01 -050010394 See also: "default-server", "http-send-name-header" and section 5 about
10395 server options
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010396
Christopher Faulet583b6de2021-02-12 09:27:10 +010010397server-state-file-name [ { use-backend-name | <file> } ]
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +020010398 Set the server state file to read, load and apply to servers available in
Christopher Faulet583b6de2021-02-12 09:27:10 +010010399 this backend.
10400 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10401 no | no | yes | yes
10402
10403 It only applies when the directive "load-server-state-from-file" is set to
10404 "local". When <file> is not provided, if "use-backend-name" is used or if
10405 this directive is not set, then backend name is used. If <file> starts with a
10406 slash '/', then it is considered as an absolute path. Otherwise, <file> is
10407 concatenated to the global directive "server-state-base".
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +020010408
10409 Example: the minimal configuration below would make HAProxy look for the
10410 state server file '/etc/haproxy/states/bk':
10411
10412 global
10413 server-state-file-base /etc/haproxy/states
10414
Willy Tarreauc9c6cdb2020-03-05 16:03:58 +010010415 backend bk
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +020010416 load-server-state-from-file
10417
Christopher Faulet583b6de2021-02-12 09:27:10 +010010418 See also: "server-state-base", "load-server-state-from-file", and
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +020010419 "show servers state"
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010420
Frédéric Lécaillecb4502e2017-04-20 13:36:25 +020010421server-template <prefix> <num | range> <fqdn>[:<port>] [params*]
10422 Set a template to initialize servers with shared parameters.
10423 The names of these servers are built from <prefix> and <num | range> parameters.
10424 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10425 no | no | yes | yes
10426
10427 Arguments:
10428 <prefix> A prefix for the server names to be built.
10429
10430 <num | range>
10431 If <num> is provided, this template initializes <num> servers
10432 with 1 up to <num> as server name suffixes. A range of numbers
10433 <num_low>-<num_high> may also be used to use <num_low> up to
10434 <num_high> as server name suffixes.
10435
10436 <fqdn> A FQDN for all the servers this template initializes.
10437
10438 <port> Same meaning as "server" <port> argument (see "server" keyword).
10439
10440 <params*>
10441 Remaining server parameters among all those supported by "server"
10442 keyword.
10443
10444 Examples:
10445 # Initializes 3 servers with srv1, srv2 and srv3 as names,
10446 # google.com as FQDN, and health-check enabled.
10447 server-template srv 1-3 google.com:80 check
10448
10449 # or
10450 server-template srv 3 google.com:80 check
10451
10452 # would be equivalent to:
10453 server srv1 google.com:80 check
10454 server srv2 google.com:80 check
10455 server srv3 google.com:80 check
10456
10457
10458
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010459source <addr>[:<port>] [usesrc { <addr2>[:<port2>] | client | clientip } ]
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +020010460source <addr>[:<port>] [usesrc { <addr2>[:<port2>] | hdr_ip(<hdr>[,<occ>]) } ]
Willy Tarreaud53f96b2009-02-04 18:46:54 +010010461source <addr>[:<port>] [interface <name>]
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010462 Set the source address for outgoing connections
10463 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10464 yes | no | yes | yes
10465 Arguments :
10466 <addr> is the IPv4 address HAProxy will bind to before connecting to a
10467 server. This address is also used as a source for health checks.
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +010010468
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010469 The default value of 0.0.0.0 means that the system will select
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +010010470 the most appropriate address to reach its destination. Optionally
10471 an address family prefix may be used before the address to force
10472 the family regardless of the address format, which can be useful
10473 to specify a path to a unix socket with no slash ('/'). Currently
10474 supported prefixes are :
10475 - 'ipv4@' -> address is always IPv4
10476 - 'ipv6@' -> address is always IPv6
10477 - 'unix@' -> address is a path to a local unix socket
Willy Tarreauccfccef2014-05-10 01:49:15 +020010478 - 'abns@' -> address is in abstract namespace (Linux only)
Cyril Bonté307ee1e2015-09-28 23:16:06 +020010479 You may want to reference some environment variables in the
10480 address parameter, see section 2.3 about environment variables.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010481
10482 <port> is an optional port. It is normally not needed but may be useful
10483 in some very specific contexts. The default value of zero means
Willy Tarreauc6f4ce82009-06-10 11:09:37 +020010484 the system will select a free port. Note that port ranges are not
10485 supported in the backend. If you want to force port ranges, you
10486 have to specify them on each "server" line.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010487
10488 <addr2> is the IP address to present to the server when connections are
10489 forwarded in full transparent proxy mode. This is currently only
10490 supported on some patched Linux kernels. When this address is
10491 specified, clients connecting to the server will be presented
10492 with this address, while health checks will still use the address
10493 <addr>.
10494
10495 <port2> is the optional port to present to the server when connections
10496 are forwarded in full transparent proxy mode (see <addr2> above).
10497 The default value of zero means the system will select a free
10498 port.
10499
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +020010500 <hdr> is the name of a HTTP header in which to fetch the IP to bind to.
10501 This is the name of a comma-separated header list which can
10502 contain multiple IP addresses. By default, the last occurrence is
10503 used. This is designed to work with the X-Forwarded-For header
Baptiste Assmannea3e73b2013-02-02 23:47:49 +010010504 and to automatically bind to the client's IP address as seen
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +020010505 by previous proxy, typically Stunnel. In order to use another
10506 occurrence from the last one, please see the <occ> parameter
10507 below. When the header (or occurrence) is not found, no binding
10508 is performed so that the proxy's default IP address is used. Also
10509 keep in mind that the header name is case insensitive, as for any
10510 HTTP header.
10511
10512 <occ> is the occurrence number of a value to be used in a multi-value
10513 header. This is to be used in conjunction with "hdr_ip(<hdr>)",
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040010514 in order to specify which occurrence to use for the source IP
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +020010515 address. Positive values indicate a position from the first
10516 occurrence, 1 being the first one. Negative values indicate
10517 positions relative to the last one, -1 being the last one. This
10518 is helpful for situations where an X-Forwarded-For header is set
10519 at the entry point of an infrastructure and must be used several
10520 proxy layers away. When this value is not specified, -1 is
10521 assumed. Passing a zero here disables the feature.
10522
Willy Tarreaud53f96b2009-02-04 18:46:54 +010010523 <name> is an optional interface name to which to bind to for outgoing
10524 traffic. On systems supporting this features (currently, only
10525 Linux), this allows one to bind all traffic to the server to
10526 this interface even if it is not the one the system would select
10527 based on routing tables. This should be used with extreme care.
10528 Note that using this option requires root privileges.
10529
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010530 The "source" keyword is useful in complex environments where a specific
10531 address only is allowed to connect to the servers. It may be needed when a
10532 private address must be used through a public gateway for instance, and it is
10533 known that the system cannot determine the adequate source address by itself.
10534
10535 An extension which is available on certain patched Linux kernels may be used
10536 through the "usesrc" optional keyword. It makes it possible to connect to the
10537 servers with an IP address which does not belong to the system itself. This
10538 is called "full transparent proxy mode". For this to work, the destination
10539 servers have to route their traffic back to this address through the machine
10540 running HAProxy, and IP forwarding must generally be enabled on this machine.
10541
10542 In this "full transparent proxy" mode, it is possible to force a specific IP
10543 address to be presented to the servers. This is not much used in fact. A more
10544 common use is to tell HAProxy to present the client's IP address. For this,
10545 there are two methods :
10546
10547 - present the client's IP and port addresses. This is the most transparent
10548 mode, but it can cause problems when IP connection tracking is enabled on
10549 the machine, because a same connection may be seen twice with different
10550 states. However, this solution presents the huge advantage of not
10551 limiting the system to the 64k outgoing address+port couples, because all
10552 of the client ranges may be used.
10553
10554 - present only the client's IP address and select a spare port. This
10555 solution is still quite elegant but slightly less transparent (downstream
10556 firewalls logs will not match upstream's). It also presents the downside
10557 of limiting the number of concurrent connections to the usual 64k ports.
10558 However, since the upstream and downstream ports are different, local IP
10559 connection tracking on the machine will not be upset by the reuse of the
10560 same session.
10561
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010562 This option sets the default source for all servers in the backend. It may
10563 also be specified in a "defaults" section. Finer source address specification
10564 is possible at the server level using the "source" server option. Refer to
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020010565 section 5 for more information.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010566
Baptiste Assmann91bd3372015-07-17 21:59:42 +020010567 In order to work, "usesrc" requires root privileges.
10568
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010569 Examples :
10570 backend private
10571 # Connect to the servers using our 192.168.1.200 source address
10572 source 192.168.1.200
10573
10574 backend transparent_ssl1
10575 # Connect to the SSL farm from the client's source address
10576 source 192.168.1.200 usesrc clientip
10577
10578 backend transparent_ssl2
10579 # Connect to the SSL farm from the client's source address and port
10580 # not recommended if IP conntrack is present on the local machine.
10581 source 192.168.1.200 usesrc client
10582
10583 backend transparent_ssl3
10584 # Connect to the SSL farm from the client's source address. It
10585 # is more conntrack-friendly.
10586 source 192.168.1.200 usesrc clientip
10587
10588 backend transparent_smtp
10589 # Connect to the SMTP farm from the client's source address/port
10590 # with Tproxy version 4.
10591 source 0.0.0.0 usesrc clientip
10592
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +020010593 backend transparent_http
10594 # Connect to the servers using the client's IP as seen by previous
10595 # proxy.
10596 source 0.0.0.0 usesrc hdr_ip(x-forwarded-for,-1)
10597
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020010598 See also : the "source" server option in section 5, the Tproxy patches for
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010599 the Linux kernel on www.balabit.com, the "bind" keyword.
10600
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010010601
MIZUTA Takeshib24bc0d2020-07-09 11:13:20 +090010602srvtcpka-cnt <count>
10603 Sets the maximum number of keepalive probes TCP should send before dropping
10604 the connection on the server side.
10605 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10606 yes | no | yes | yes
10607 Arguments :
10608 <count> is the maximum number of keepalive probes.
10609
10610 This keyword corresponds to the socket option TCP_KEEPCNT. If this keyword
10611 is not specified, system-wide TCP parameter (tcp_keepalive_probes) is used.
Willy Tarreau52543212020-07-09 05:58:51 +020010612 The availability of this setting depends on the operating system. It is
10613 known to work on Linux.
MIZUTA Takeshib24bc0d2020-07-09 11:13:20 +090010614
10615 See also : "option srvtcpka", "srvtcpka-idle", "srvtcpka-intvl".
10616
10617
10618srvtcpka-idle <timeout>
10619 Sets the time the connection needs to remain idle before TCP starts sending
10620 keepalive probes, if enabled the sending of TCP keepalive packets on the
10621 server side.
10622 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10623 yes | no | yes | yes
10624 Arguments :
10625 <timeout> is the time the connection needs to remain idle before TCP starts
10626 sending keepalive probes. It is specified in seconds by default,
10627 but can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the
10628 unit, as explained at the top of this document.
10629
10630 This keyword corresponds to the socket option TCP_KEEPIDLE. If this keyword
10631 is not specified, system-wide TCP parameter (tcp_keepalive_time) is used.
Willy Tarreau52543212020-07-09 05:58:51 +020010632 The availability of this setting depends on the operating system. It is
10633 known to work on Linux.
MIZUTA Takeshib24bc0d2020-07-09 11:13:20 +090010634
10635 See also : "option srvtcpka", "srvtcpka-cnt", "srvtcpka-intvl".
10636
10637
10638srvtcpka-intvl <timeout>
10639 Sets the time between individual keepalive probes on the server side.
10640 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10641 yes | no | yes | yes
10642 Arguments :
10643 <timeout> is the time between individual keepalive probes. It is specified
10644 in seconds by default, but can be in any other unit if the number
10645 is suffixed by the unit, as explained at the top of this
10646 document.
10647
10648 This keyword corresponds to the socket option TCP_KEEPINTVL. If this keyword
10649 is not specified, system-wide TCP parameter (tcp_keepalive_intvl) is used.
Willy Tarreau52543212020-07-09 05:58:51 +020010650 The availability of this setting depends on the operating system. It is
10651 known to work on Linux.
MIZUTA Takeshib24bc0d2020-07-09 11:13:20 +090010652
10653 See also : "option srvtcpka", "srvtcpka-cnt", "srvtcpka-idle".
10654
10655
Cyril Bonté66c327d2010-10-12 00:14:37 +020010656stats admin { if | unless } <cond>
10657 Enable statistics admin level if/unless a condition is matched
10658 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +020010659 no | yes | yes | yes
Cyril Bonté66c327d2010-10-12 00:14:37 +020010660
10661 This statement enables the statistics admin level if/unless a condition is
10662 matched.
10663
10664 The admin level allows to enable/disable servers from the web interface. By
10665 default, statistics page is read-only for security reasons.
10666
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +010010667 Note : Consider not using this feature in multi-process mode (nbproc > 1)
10668 unless you know what you do : memory is not shared between the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010669 processes, which can result in random behaviors.
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +010010670
Cyril Bonté23b39d92011-02-10 22:54:44 +010010671 Currently, the POST request is limited to the buffer size minus the reserved
10672 buffer space, which means that if the list of servers is too long, the
10673 request won't be processed. It is recommended to alter few servers at a
10674 time.
Cyril Bonté66c327d2010-10-12 00:14:37 +020010675
10676 Example :
10677 # statistics admin level only for localhost
10678 backend stats_localhost
10679 stats enable
10680 stats admin if LOCALHOST
10681
10682 Example :
10683 # statistics admin level always enabled because of the authentication
10684 backend stats_auth
10685 stats enable
10686 stats auth admin:AdMiN123
10687 stats admin if TRUE
10688
10689 Example :
10690 # statistics admin level depends on the authenticated user
10691 userlist stats-auth
10692 group admin users admin
10693 user admin insecure-password AdMiN123
10694 group readonly users haproxy
10695 user haproxy insecure-password haproxy
10696
10697 backend stats_auth
10698 stats enable
10699 acl AUTH http_auth(stats-auth)
10700 acl AUTH_ADMIN http_auth_group(stats-auth) admin
10701 stats http-request auth unless AUTH
10702 stats admin if AUTH_ADMIN
10703
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +010010704 See also : "stats enable", "stats auth", "stats http-request", "nbproc",
10705 "bind-process", section 3.4 about userlists and section 7 about
10706 ACL usage.
Cyril Bonté66c327d2010-10-12 00:14:37 +020010707
10708
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010709stats auth <user>:<passwd>
10710 Enable statistics with authentication and grant access to an account
10711 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +020010712 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010713 Arguments :
10714 <user> is a user name to grant access to
10715
10716 <passwd> is the cleartext password associated to this user
10717
10718 This statement enables statistics with default settings, and restricts access
10719 to declared users only. It may be repeated as many times as necessary to
10720 allow as many users as desired. When a user tries to access the statistics
10721 without a valid account, a "401 Forbidden" response will be returned so that
10722 the browser asks the user to provide a valid user and password. The real
10723 which will be returned to the browser is configurable using "stats realm".
10724
10725 Since the authentication method is HTTP Basic Authentication, the passwords
10726 circulate in cleartext on the network. Thus, it was decided that the
10727 configuration file would also use cleartext passwords to remind the users
Willy Tarreau3c92c5f2011-08-28 09:45:47 +020010728 that those ones should not be sensitive and not shared with any other account.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010729
10730 It is also possible to reduce the scope of the proxies which appear in the
10731 report using "stats scope".
10732
10733 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
10734 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
10735 unobvious parameters.
10736
10737 Example :
10738 # public access (limited to this backend only)
10739 backend public_www
10740 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
10741 stats enable
10742 stats hide-version
10743 stats scope .
10744 stats uri /admin?stats
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010745 stats realm HAProxy\ Statistics
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010746 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
10747 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
10748
10749 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
10750 backend private_monitoring
10751 stats enable
10752 stats uri /admin?stats
10753 stats refresh 5s
10754
10755 See also : "stats enable", "stats realm", "stats scope", "stats uri"
10756
10757
10758stats enable
10759 Enable statistics reporting with default settings
10760 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +020010761 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010762 Arguments : none
10763
10764 This statement enables statistics reporting with default settings defined
10765 at build time. Unless stated otherwise, these settings are used :
10766 - stats uri : /haproxy?stats
10767 - stats realm : "HAProxy Statistics"
10768 - stats auth : no authentication
10769 - stats scope : no restriction
10770
10771 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
10772 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
10773 unobvious parameters.
10774
10775 Example :
10776 # public access (limited to this backend only)
10777 backend public_www
10778 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
10779 stats enable
10780 stats hide-version
10781 stats scope .
10782 stats uri /admin?stats
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010783 stats realm HAProxy\ Statistics
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010784 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
10785 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
10786
10787 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
10788 backend private_monitoring
10789 stats enable
10790 stats uri /admin?stats
10791 stats refresh 5s
10792
10793 See also : "stats auth", "stats realm", "stats uri"
10794
10795
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010796stats hide-version
10797 Enable statistics and hide HAProxy version reporting
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +020010798 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +020010799 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010800 Arguments : none
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +020010801
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010802 By default, the stats page reports some useful status information along with
10803 the statistics. Among them is HAProxy's version. However, it is generally
10804 considered dangerous to report precise version to anyone, as it can help them
10805 target known weaknesses with specific attacks. The "stats hide-version"
10806 statement removes the version from the statistics report. This is recommended
10807 for public sites or any site with a weak login/password.
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +020010808
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki48cb2ae2009-10-02 22:51:14 +020010809 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
10810 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
10811 unobvious parameters.
10812
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010813 Example :
10814 # public access (limited to this backend only)
10815 backend public_www
10816 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki48cb2ae2009-10-02 22:51:14 +020010817 stats enable
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010818 stats hide-version
10819 stats scope .
10820 stats uri /admin?stats
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010821 stats realm HAProxy\ Statistics
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010822 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
10823 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +020010824
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +020010825 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
10826 backend private_monitoring
10827 stats enable
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010828 stats uri /admin?stats
10829 stats refresh 5s
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki15514c22010-01-04 16:03:09 +010010830
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010831 See also : "stats auth", "stats enable", "stats realm", "stats uri"
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +020010832
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +010010833
Cyril Bonté2be1b3f2010-09-30 23:46:30 +020010834stats http-request { allow | deny | auth [realm <realm>] }
10835 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
10836 Access control for statistics
10837
10838 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10839 no | no | yes | yes
10840
10841 As "http-request", these set of options allow to fine control access to
10842 statistics. Each option may be followed by if/unless and acl.
10843 First option with matched condition (or option without condition) is final.
10844 For "deny" a 403 error will be returned, for "allow" normal processing is
10845 performed, for "auth" a 401/407 error code is returned so the client
10846 should be asked to enter a username and password.
10847
10848 There is no fixed limit to the number of http-request statements per
10849 instance.
10850
10851 See also : "http-request", section 3.4 about userlists and section 7
10852 about ACL usage.
10853
10854
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010855stats realm <realm>
10856 Enable statistics and set authentication realm
10857 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +020010858 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010859 Arguments :
10860 <realm> is the name of the HTTP Basic Authentication realm reported to
10861 the browser. The browser uses it to display it in the pop-up
10862 inviting the user to enter a valid username and password.
10863
10864 The realm is read as a single word, so any spaces in it should be escaped
10865 using a backslash ('\').
10866
10867 This statement is useful only in conjunction with "stats auth" since it is
10868 only related to authentication.
10869
10870 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
10871 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
10872 unobvious parameters.
10873
10874 Example :
10875 # public access (limited to this backend only)
10876 backend public_www
10877 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
10878 stats enable
10879 stats hide-version
10880 stats scope .
10881 stats uri /admin?stats
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010882 stats realm HAProxy\ Statistics
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010883 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
10884 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
10885
10886 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
10887 backend private_monitoring
10888 stats enable
10889 stats uri /admin?stats
10890 stats refresh 5s
10891
10892 See also : "stats auth", "stats enable", "stats uri"
10893
10894
10895stats refresh <delay>
10896 Enable statistics with automatic refresh
10897 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +020010898 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010899 Arguments :
10900 <delay> is the suggested refresh delay, specified in seconds, which will
10901 be returned to the browser consulting the report page. While the
10902 browser is free to apply any delay, it will generally respect it
10903 and refresh the page this every seconds. The refresh interval may
10904 be specified in any other non-default time unit, by suffixing the
10905 unit after the value, as explained at the top of this document.
10906
10907 This statement is useful on monitoring displays with a permanent page
10908 reporting the load balancer's activity. When set, the HTML report page will
10909 include a link "refresh"/"stop refresh" so that the user can select whether
Jackie Tapia749f74c2020-07-22 18:59:40 -050010910 they want automatic refresh of the page or not.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010911
10912 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
10913 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
10914 unobvious parameters.
10915
10916 Example :
10917 # public access (limited to this backend only)
10918 backend public_www
10919 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
10920 stats enable
10921 stats hide-version
10922 stats scope .
10923 stats uri /admin?stats
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010924 stats realm HAProxy\ Statistics
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010925 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
10926 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
10927
10928 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
10929 backend private_monitoring
10930 stats enable
10931 stats uri /admin?stats
10932 stats refresh 5s
10933
10934 See also : "stats auth", "stats enable", "stats realm", "stats uri"
10935
10936
10937stats scope { <name> | "." }
10938 Enable statistics and limit access scope
10939 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +020010940 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010941 Arguments :
10942 <name> is the name of a listen, frontend or backend section to be
10943 reported. The special name "." (a single dot) designates the
10944 section in which the statement appears.
10945
10946 When this statement is specified, only the sections enumerated with this
10947 statement will appear in the report. All other ones will be hidden. This
10948 statement may appear as many times as needed if multiple sections need to be
10949 reported. Please note that the name checking is performed as simple string
10950 comparisons, and that it is never checked that a give section name really
10951 exists.
10952
10953 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
10954 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
10955 unobvious parameters.
10956
10957 Example :
10958 # public access (limited to this backend only)
10959 backend public_www
10960 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
10961 stats enable
10962 stats hide-version
10963 stats scope .
10964 stats uri /admin?stats
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010965 stats realm HAProxy\ Statistics
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010966 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
10967 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
10968
10969 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
10970 backend private_monitoring
10971 stats enable
10972 stats uri /admin?stats
10973 stats refresh 5s
10974
10975 See also : "stats auth", "stats enable", "stats realm", "stats uri"
10976
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010977
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020010978stats show-desc [ <desc> ]
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010979 Enable reporting of a description on the statistics page.
10980 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +020010981 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010982
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020010983 <desc> is an optional description to be reported. If unspecified, the
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010984 description from global section is automatically used instead.
10985
10986 This statement is useful for users that offer shared services to their
10987 customers, where node or description should be different for each customer.
10988
10989 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
10990 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010991 unobvious parameters. By default description is not shown.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010992
10993 Example :
10994 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
10995 backend private_monitoring
10996 stats enable
10997 stats show-desc Master node for Europe, Asia, Africa
10998 stats uri /admin?stats
10999 stats refresh 5s
11000
11001 See also: "show-node", "stats enable", "stats uri" and "description" in
11002 global section.
11003
11004
11005stats show-legends
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +020011006 Enable reporting additional information on the statistics page
11007 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
11008 yes | yes | yes | yes
11009 Arguments : none
11010
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030011011 Enable reporting additional information on the statistics page :
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010011012 - cap: capabilities (proxy)
11013 - mode: one of tcp, http or health (proxy)
11014 - id: SNMP ID (proxy, socket, server)
11015 - IP (socket, server)
11016 - cookie (backend, server)
11017
11018 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
11019 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011020 unobvious parameters. Default behavior is not to show this information.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010011021
11022 See also: "stats enable", "stats uri".
11023
11024
Amaury Denoyelle0b70a8a2020-10-05 11:49:45 +020011025stats show-modules
11026 Enable display of extra statistics module on the statistics page
11027 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
11028 yes | yes | yes | yes
11029 Arguments : none
11030
11031 New columns are added at the end of the line containing the extra statistics
11032 values as a tooltip.
11033
11034 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
11035 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
11036 unobvious parameters. Default behavior is not to show this information.
11037
11038 See also: "stats enable", "stats uri".
11039
11040
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010011041stats show-node [ <name> ]
11042 Enable reporting of a host name on the statistics page.
11043 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +020011044 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010011045 Arguments:
11046 <name> is an optional name to be reported. If unspecified, the
11047 node name from global section is automatically used instead.
11048
11049 This statement is useful for users that offer shared services to their
11050 customers, where node or description might be different on a stats page
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011051 provided for each customer. Default behavior is not to show host name.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010011052
11053 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
11054 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
11055 unobvious parameters.
11056
11057 Example:
11058 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
11059 backend private_monitoring
11060 stats enable
11061 stats show-node Europe-1
11062 stats uri /admin?stats
11063 stats refresh 5s
11064
11065 See also: "show-desc", "stats enable", "stats uri", and "node" in global
11066 section.
11067
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010011068
11069stats uri <prefix>
11070 Enable statistics and define the URI prefix to access them
11071 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +020011072 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010011073 Arguments :
11074 <prefix> is the prefix of any URI which will be redirected to stats. This
11075 prefix may contain a question mark ('?') to indicate part of a
11076 query string.
11077
11078 The statistics URI is intercepted on the relayed traffic, so it appears as a
11079 page within the normal application. It is strongly advised to ensure that the
11080 selected URI will never appear in the application, otherwise it will never be
11081 possible to reach it in the application.
11082
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040011083 The default URI compiled in HAProxy is "/haproxy?stats", but this may be
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010011084 changed at build time, so it's better to always explicitly specify it here.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010011085 It is generally a good idea to include a question mark in the URI so that
11086 intermediate proxies refrain from caching the results. Also, since any string
11087 beginning with the prefix will be accepted as a stats request, the question
11088 mark helps ensuring that no valid URI will begin with the same words.
11089
11090 It is sometimes very convenient to use "/" as the URI prefix, and put that
11091 statement in a "listen" instance of its own. That makes it easy to dedicate
11092 an address or a port to statistics only.
11093
11094 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
11095 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
11096 unobvious parameters.
11097
11098 Example :
11099 # public access (limited to this backend only)
11100 backend public_www
11101 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
11102 stats enable
11103 stats hide-version
11104 stats scope .
11105 stats uri /admin?stats
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011106 stats realm HAProxy\ Statistics
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010011107 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
11108 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
11109
11110 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
11111 backend private_monitoring
11112 stats enable
11113 stats uri /admin?stats
11114 stats refresh 5s
11115
11116 See also : "stats auth", "stats enable", "stats realm"
11117
11118
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010011119stick match <pattern> [table <table>] [{if | unless} <cond>]
11120 Define a request pattern matching condition to stick a user to a server
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010011121 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010011122 no | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010011123
11124 Arguments :
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +020011125 <pattern> is a sample expression rule as described in section 7.3. It
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010011126 describes what elements of the incoming request or connection
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011127 will be analyzed in the hope to find a matching entry in a
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010011128 stickiness table. This rule is mandatory.
11129
11130 <table> is an optional stickiness table name. If unspecified, the same
11131 backend's table is used. A stickiness table is declared using
11132 the "stick-table" statement.
11133
11134 <cond> is an optional matching condition. It makes it possible to match
11135 on a certain criterion only when other conditions are met (or
11136 not met). For instance, it could be used to match on a source IP
11137 address except when a request passes through a known proxy, in
11138 which case we'd match on a header containing that IP address.
11139
11140 Some protocols or applications require complex stickiness rules and cannot
11141 always simply rely on cookies nor hashing. The "stick match" statement
11142 describes a rule to extract the stickiness criterion from an incoming request
11143 or connection. See section 7 for a complete list of possible patterns and
11144 transformation rules.
11145
11146 The table has to be declared using the "stick-table" statement. It must be of
11147 a type compatible with the pattern. By default it is the one which is present
11148 in the same backend. It is possible to share a table with other backends by
11149 referencing it using the "table" keyword. If another table is referenced,
11150 the server's ID inside the backends are used. By default, all server IDs
11151 start at 1 in each backend, so the server ordering is enough. But in case of
11152 doubt, it is highly recommended to force server IDs using their "id" setting.
11153
11154 It is possible to restrict the conditions where a "stick match" statement
11155 will apply, using "if" or "unless" followed by a condition. See section 7 for
11156 ACL based conditions.
11157
11158 There is no limit on the number of "stick match" statements. The first that
11159 applies and matches will cause the request to be directed to the same server
11160 as was used for the request which created the entry. That way, multiple
11161 matches can be used as fallbacks.
11162
11163 The stick rules are checked after the persistence cookies, so they will not
11164 affect stickiness if a cookie has already been used to select a server. That
11165 way, it becomes very easy to insert cookies and match on IP addresses in
11166 order to maintain stickiness between HTTP and HTTPS.
11167
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +010011168 Note : Consider not using this feature in multi-process mode (nbproc > 1)
11169 unless you know what you do : memory is not shared between the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011170 processes, which can result in random behaviors.
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +010011171
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010011172 Example :
11173 # forward SMTP users to the same server they just used for POP in the
11174 # last 30 minutes
11175 backend pop
11176 mode tcp
11177 balance roundrobin
11178 stick store-request src
11179 stick-table type ip size 200k expire 30m
11180 server s1 192.168.1.1:110
11181 server s2 192.168.1.1:110
11182
11183 backend smtp
11184 mode tcp
11185 balance roundrobin
11186 stick match src table pop
11187 server s1 192.168.1.1:25
11188 server s2 192.168.1.1:25
11189
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +010011190 See also : "stick-table", "stick on", "nbproc", "bind-process" and section 7
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +020011191 about ACLs and samples fetching.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010011192
11193
11194stick on <pattern> [table <table>] [{if | unless} <condition>]
11195 Define a request pattern to associate a user to a server
11196 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
11197 no | no | yes | yes
11198
11199 Note : This form is exactly equivalent to "stick match" followed by
11200 "stick store-request", all with the same arguments. Please refer
11201 to both keywords for details. It is only provided as a convenience
11202 for writing more maintainable configurations.
11203
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +010011204 Note : Consider not using this feature in multi-process mode (nbproc > 1)
11205 unless you know what you do : memory is not shared between the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011206 processes, which can result in random behaviors.
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +010011207
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010011208 Examples :
11209 # The following form ...
Willy Tarreauec579d82010-02-26 19:15:04 +010011210 stick on src table pop if !localhost
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010011211
11212 # ...is strictly equivalent to this one :
11213 stick match src table pop if !localhost
11214 stick store-request src table pop if !localhost
11215
11216
11217 # Use cookie persistence for HTTP, and stick on source address for HTTPS as
11218 # well as HTTP without cookie. Share the same table between both accesses.
11219 backend http
11220 mode http
11221 balance roundrobin
11222 stick on src table https
11223 cookie SRV insert indirect nocache
11224 server s1 192.168.1.1:80 cookie s1
11225 server s2 192.168.1.1:80 cookie s2
11226
11227 backend https
11228 mode tcp
11229 balance roundrobin
11230 stick-table type ip size 200k expire 30m
11231 stick on src
11232 server s1 192.168.1.1:443
11233 server s2 192.168.1.1:443
11234
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +010011235 See also : "stick match", "stick store-request", "nbproc" and "bind-process".
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010011236
11237
11238stick store-request <pattern> [table <table>] [{if | unless} <condition>]
11239 Define a request pattern used to create an entry in a stickiness table
11240 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
11241 no | no | yes | yes
11242
11243 Arguments :
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +020011244 <pattern> is a sample expression rule as described in section 7.3. It
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010011245 describes what elements of the incoming request or connection
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011246 will be analyzed, extracted and stored in the table once a
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010011247 server is selected.
11248
11249 <table> is an optional stickiness table name. If unspecified, the same
11250 backend's table is used. A stickiness table is declared using
11251 the "stick-table" statement.
11252
11253 <cond> is an optional storage condition. It makes it possible to store
11254 certain criteria only when some conditions are met (or not met).
11255 For instance, it could be used to store the source IP address
11256 except when the request passes through a known proxy, in which
11257 case we'd store a converted form of a header containing that IP
11258 address.
11259
11260 Some protocols or applications require complex stickiness rules and cannot
11261 always simply rely on cookies nor hashing. The "stick store-request" statement
11262 describes a rule to decide what to extract from the request and when to do
11263 it, in order to store it into a stickiness table for further requests to
11264 match it using the "stick match" statement. Obviously the extracted part must
11265 make sense and have a chance to be matched in a further request. Storing a
11266 client's IP address for instance often makes sense. Storing an ID found in a
11267 URL parameter also makes sense. Storing a source port will almost never make
11268 any sense because it will be randomly matched. See section 7 for a complete
11269 list of possible patterns and transformation rules.
11270
11271 The table has to be declared using the "stick-table" statement. It must be of
11272 a type compatible with the pattern. By default it is the one which is present
11273 in the same backend. It is possible to share a table with other backends by
11274 referencing it using the "table" keyword. If another table is referenced,
11275 the server's ID inside the backends are used. By default, all server IDs
11276 start at 1 in each backend, so the server ordering is enough. But in case of
11277 doubt, it is highly recommended to force server IDs using their "id" setting.
11278
11279 It is possible to restrict the conditions where a "stick store-request"
11280 statement will apply, using "if" or "unless" followed by a condition. This
11281 condition will be evaluated while parsing the request, so any criteria can be
11282 used. See section 7 for ACL based conditions.
11283
11284 There is no limit on the number of "stick store-request" statements, but
11285 there is a limit of 8 simultaneous stores per request or response. This
11286 makes it possible to store up to 8 criteria, all extracted from either the
11287 request or the response, regardless of the number of rules. Only the 8 first
11288 ones which match will be kept. Using this, it is possible to feed multiple
11289 tables at once in the hope to increase the chance to recognize a user on
Willy Tarreau9667a802013-12-09 12:52:13 +010011290 another protocol or access method. Using multiple store-request rules with
11291 the same table is possible and may be used to find the best criterion to rely
11292 on, by arranging the rules by decreasing preference order. Only the first
11293 extracted criterion for a given table will be stored. All subsequent store-
11294 request rules referencing the same table will be skipped and their ACLs will
11295 not be evaluated.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010011296
11297 The "store-request" rules are evaluated once the server connection has been
11298 established, so that the table will contain the real server that processed
11299 the request.
11300
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +010011301 Note : Consider not using this feature in multi-process mode (nbproc > 1)
11302 unless you know what you do : memory is not shared between the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011303 processes, which can result in random behaviors.
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +010011304
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010011305 Example :
11306 # forward SMTP users to the same server they just used for POP in the
11307 # last 30 minutes
11308 backend pop
11309 mode tcp
11310 balance roundrobin
11311 stick store-request src
11312 stick-table type ip size 200k expire 30m
11313 server s1 192.168.1.1:110
11314 server s2 192.168.1.1:110
11315
11316 backend smtp
11317 mode tcp
11318 balance roundrobin
11319 stick match src table pop
11320 server s1 192.168.1.1:25
11321 server s2 192.168.1.1:25
11322
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +010011323 See also : "stick-table", "stick on", "nbproc", "bind-process" and section 7
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +020011324 about ACLs and sample fetching.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010011325
11326
Emeric Brun7c6b82e2010-09-24 16:34:28 +020011327stick-table type {ip | integer | string [len <length>] | binary [len <length>]}
Thayne McCombs92149f92020-11-20 01:28:26 -070011328 size <size> [expire <expire>] [nopurge] [peers <peersect>] [srvkey <srvkey>]
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +020011329 [store <data_type>]*
Godbach64cef792013-12-04 16:08:22 +080011330 Configure the stickiness table for the current section
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010011331 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreauc00cdc22010-06-06 16:48:26 +020011332 no | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010011333
11334 Arguments :
11335 ip a table declared with "type ip" will only store IPv4 addresses.
11336 This form is very compact (about 50 bytes per entry) and allows
11337 very fast entry lookup and stores with almost no overhead. This
11338 is mainly used to store client source IP addresses.
11339
David du Colombier9a6d3c92011-03-17 10:40:24 +010011340 ipv6 a table declared with "type ipv6" will only store IPv6 addresses.
11341 This form is very compact (about 60 bytes per entry) and allows
11342 very fast entry lookup and stores with almost no overhead. This
11343 is mainly used to store client source IP addresses.
11344
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010011345 integer a table declared with "type integer" will store 32bit integers
11346 which can represent a client identifier found in a request for
11347 instance.
11348
11349 string a table declared with "type string" will store substrings of up
11350 to <len> characters. If the string provided by the pattern
11351 extractor is larger than <len>, it will be truncated before
11352 being stored. During matching, at most <len> characters will be
11353 compared between the string in the table and the extracted
11354 pattern. When not specified, the string is automatically limited
Emeric Brun7c6b82e2010-09-24 16:34:28 +020011355 to 32 characters.
11356
11357 binary a table declared with "type binary" will store binary blocks
11358 of <len> bytes. If the block provided by the pattern
11359 extractor is larger than <len>, it will be truncated before
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +020011360 being stored. If the block provided by the sample expression
Emeric Brun7c6b82e2010-09-24 16:34:28 +020011361 is shorter than <len>, it will be padded by 0. When not
11362 specified, the block is automatically limited to 32 bytes.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010011363
11364 <length> is the maximum number of characters that will be stored in a
Emeric Brun7c6b82e2010-09-24 16:34:28 +020011365 "string" type table (See type "string" above). Or the number
11366 of bytes of the block in "binary" type table. Be careful when
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010011367 changing this parameter as memory usage will proportionally
11368 increase.
11369
11370 <size> is the maximum number of entries that can fit in the table. This
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +010011371 value directly impacts memory usage. Count approximately
11372 50 bytes per entry, plus the size of a string if any. The size
11373 supports suffixes "k", "m", "g" for 2^10, 2^20 and 2^30 factors.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010011374
11375 [nopurge] indicates that we refuse to purge older entries when the table
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040011376 is full. When not specified and the table is full when HAProxy
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010011377 wants to store an entry in it, it will flush a few of the oldest
11378 entries in order to release some space for the new ones. This is
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011379 most often the desired behavior. In some specific cases, it
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010011380 be desirable to refuse new entries instead of purging the older
11381 ones. That may be the case when the amount of data to store is
11382 far above the hardware limits and we prefer not to offer access
11383 to new clients than to reject the ones already connected. When
11384 using this parameter, be sure to properly set the "expire"
11385 parameter (see below).
11386
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +020011387 <peersect> is the name of the peers section to use for replication. Entries
11388 which associate keys to server IDs are kept synchronized with
11389 the remote peers declared in this section. All entries are also
11390 automatically learned from the local peer (old process) during a
11391 soft restart.
11392
Willy Tarreau1abc6732015-05-01 19:21:02 +020011393 NOTE : each peers section may be referenced only by tables
11394 belonging to the same unique process.
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +010011395
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010011396 <expire> defines the maximum duration of an entry in the table since it
Emeric Brunad57d202022-05-30 18:08:28 +020011397 was last created, refreshed using 'track-sc' or matched using
11398 'stick match' or 'stick on' rule. The expiration delay is
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010011399 defined using the standard time format, similarly as the various
11400 timeouts. The maximum duration is slightly above 24 days. See
Willy Tarreau4b103022021-02-12 17:59:10 +010011401 section 2.5 for more information. If this delay is not specified,
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +020011402 the session won't automatically expire, but older entries will
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010011403 be removed once full. Be sure not to use the "nopurge" parameter
11404 if not expiration delay is specified.
Emeric Brunad57d202022-05-30 18:08:28 +020011405 Note: 'table_*' converters performs lookups but won't update touch
11406 expire since they don't require 'track-sc'.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010011407
Thayne McCombs92149f92020-11-20 01:28:26 -070011408 <srvkey> specifies how each server is identified for the purposes of the
11409 stick table. The valid values are "name" and "addr". If "name" is
11410 given, then <name> argument for the server (may be generated by
11411 a template). If "addr" is given, then the server is identified
11412 by its current network address, including the port. "addr" is
11413 especially useful if you are using service discovery to generate
11414 the addresses for servers with peered stick-tables and want
11415 to consistently use the same host across peers for a stickiness
11416 token.
11417
Willy Tarreau08d5f982010-06-06 13:34:54 +020011418 <data_type> is used to store additional information in the stick-table. This
11419 may be used by ACLs in order to control various criteria related
11420 to the activity of the client matching the stick-table. For each
11421 item specified here, the size of each entry will be inflated so
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020011422 that the additional data can fit. Several data types may be
11423 stored with an entry. Multiple data types may be specified after
11424 the "store" keyword, as a comma-separated list. Alternatively,
11425 it is possible to repeat the "store" keyword followed by one or
11426 several data types. Except for the "server_id" type which is
11427 automatically detected and enabled, all data types must be
11428 explicitly declared to be stored. If an ACL references a data
11429 type which is not stored, the ACL will simply not match. Some
11430 data types require an argument which must be passed just after
11431 the type between parenthesis. See below for the supported data
11432 types and their arguments.
11433
11434 The data types that can be stored with an entry are the following :
11435 - server_id : this is an integer which holds the numeric ID of the server a
11436 request was assigned to. It is used by the "stick match", "stick store",
11437 and "stick on" rules. It is automatically enabled when referenced.
11438
11439 - gpc0 : first General Purpose Counter. It is a positive 32-bit integer
11440 integer which may be used for anything. Most of the time it will be used
11441 to put a special tag on some entries, for instance to note that a
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011442 specific behavior was detected and must be known for future matches.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020011443
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +020011444 - gpc0_rate(<period>) : increment rate of the first General Purpose Counter
11445 over a period. It is a positive 32-bit integer integer which may be used
11446 for anything. Just like <gpc0>, it counts events, but instead of keeping
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011447 a cumulative number, it maintains the rate at which the counter is
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +020011448 incremented. Most of the time it will be used to measure the frequency of
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011449 occurrence of certain events (e.g. requests to a specific URL).
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +020011450
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010011451 - gpc1 : second General Purpose Counter. It is a positive 32-bit integer
11452 integer which may be used for anything. Most of the time it will be used
11453 to put a special tag on some entries, for instance to note that a
11454 specific behavior was detected and must be known for future matches.
11455
11456 - gpc1_rate(<period>) : increment rate of the second General Purpose Counter
11457 over a period. It is a positive 32-bit integer integer which may be used
11458 for anything. Just like <gpc1>, it counts events, but instead of keeping
11459 a cumulative number, it maintains the rate at which the counter is
11460 incremented. Most of the time it will be used to measure the frequency of
11461 occurrence of certain events (e.g. requests to a specific URL).
11462
Emeric Bruna5d15312021-07-01 18:34:48 +020011463 - gpt0 : first General Purpose Tag. It is a positive 32-bit integer
11464 integer which may be used for anything. Most of the time it will be used
11465 to put a special tag on some entries, for instance to note that a
11466 specific behavior was detected and must be known for future matches
11467
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020011468 - conn_cnt : Connection Count. It is a positive 32-bit integer which counts
11469 the absolute number of connections received from clients which matched
11470 this entry. It does not mean the connections were accepted, just that
11471 they were received.
11472
11473 - conn_cur : Current Connections. It is a positive 32-bit integer which
11474 stores the concurrent connection counts for the entry. It is incremented
11475 once an incoming connection matches the entry, and decremented once the
11476 connection leaves. That way it is possible to know at any time the exact
11477 number of concurrent connections for an entry.
11478
11479 - conn_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes an
11480 integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
11481 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
11482 incoming connection rate over that period, in connections per period. The
11483 result is an integer which can be matched using ACLs.
11484
11485 - sess_cnt : Session Count. It is a positive 32-bit integer which counts
11486 the absolute number of sessions received from clients which matched this
11487 entry. A session is a connection that was accepted by the layer 4 rules.
11488
11489 - sess_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes an
11490 integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
11491 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
11492 incoming session rate over that period, in sessions per period. The
11493 result is an integer which can be matched using ACLs.
11494
11495 - http_req_cnt : HTTP request Count. It is a positive 32-bit integer which
11496 counts the absolute number of HTTP requests received from clients which
11497 matched this entry. It does not matter whether they are valid requests or
11498 not. Note that this is different from sessions when keep-alive is used on
11499 the client side.
11500
11501 - http_req_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes an
11502 integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
11503 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
11504 HTTP request rate over that period, in requests per period. The result is
11505 an integer which can be matched using ACLs. It does not matter whether
11506 they are valid requests or not. Note that this is different from sessions
11507 when keep-alive is used on the client side.
11508
11509 - http_err_cnt : HTTP Error Count. It is a positive 32-bit integer which
11510 counts the absolute number of HTTP requests errors induced by clients
11511 which matched this entry. Errors are counted on invalid and truncated
11512 requests, as well as on denied or tarpitted requests, and on failed
11513 authentications. If the server responds with 4xx, then the request is
11514 also counted as an error since it's an error triggered by the client
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011515 (e.g. vulnerability scan).
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020011516
11517 - http_err_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes an
11518 integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
11519 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
11520 HTTP request error rate over that period, in requests per period (see
11521 http_err_cnt above for what is accounted as an error). The result is an
11522 integer which can be matched using ACLs.
11523
Willy Tarreau826f3ab2021-02-10 12:07:15 +010011524 - http_fail_cnt : HTTP Failure Count. It is a positive 32-bit integer which
11525 counts the absolute number of HTTP response failures induced by servers
11526 which matched this entry. Errors are counted on invalid and truncated
11527 responses, as well as any 5xx response other than 501 or 505. It aims at
11528 being used combined with path or URI to detect service failures.
11529
11530 - http_fail_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes
11531 an integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
11532 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
11533 HTTP response failure rate over that period, in requests per period (see
11534 http_fail_cnt above for what is accounted as a failure). The result is an
11535 integer which can be matched using ACLs.
11536
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020011537 - bytes_in_cnt : client to server byte count. It is a positive 64-bit
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011538 integer which counts the cumulative number of bytes received from clients
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020011539 which matched this entry. Headers are included in the count. This may be
11540 used to limit abuse of upload features on photo or video servers.
11541
11542 - bytes_in_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes an
11543 integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
11544 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
11545 incoming bytes rate over that period, in bytes per period. It may be used
11546 to detect users which upload too much and too fast. Warning: with large
11547 uploads, it is possible that the amount of uploaded data will be counted
11548 once upon termination, thus causing spikes in the average transfer speed
11549 instead of having a smooth one. This may partially be smoothed with
11550 "option contstats" though this is not perfect yet. Use of byte_in_cnt is
11551 recommended for better fairness.
11552
11553 - bytes_out_cnt : server to client byte count. It is a positive 64-bit
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011554 integer which counts the cumulative number of bytes sent to clients which
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020011555 matched this entry. Headers are included in the count. This may be used
11556 to limit abuse of bots sucking the whole site.
11557
11558 - bytes_out_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes
11559 an integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
11560 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
11561 outgoing bytes rate over that period, in bytes per period. It may be used
11562 to detect users which download too much and too fast. Warning: with large
11563 transfers, it is possible that the amount of transferred data will be
11564 counted once upon termination, thus causing spikes in the average
11565 transfer speed instead of having a smooth one. This may partially be
11566 smoothed with "option contstats" though this is not perfect yet. Use of
11567 byte_out_cnt is recommended for better fairness.
Willy Tarreau08d5f982010-06-06 13:34:54 +020011568
Willy Tarreauc00cdc22010-06-06 16:48:26 +020011569 There is only one stick-table per proxy. At the moment of writing this doc,
11570 it does not seem useful to have multiple tables per proxy. If this happens
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010011571 to be required, simply create a dummy backend with a stick-table in it and
11572 reference it.
11573
11574 It is important to understand that stickiness based on learning information
11575 has some limitations, including the fact that all learned associations are
Baptiste Assmann123ff042016-03-06 23:29:28 +010011576 lost upon restart unless peers are properly configured to transfer such
11577 information upon restart (recommended). In general it can be good as a
11578 complement but not always as an exclusive stickiness.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010011579
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020011580 Last, memory requirements may be important when storing many data types.
11581 Indeed, storing all indicators above at once in each entry requires 116 bytes
11582 per entry, or 116 MB for a 1-million entries table. This is definitely not
11583 something that can be ignored.
11584
11585 Example:
11586 # Keep track of counters of up to 1 million IP addresses over 5 minutes
11587 # and store a general purpose counter and the average connection rate
11588 # computed over a sliding window of 30 seconds.
11589 stick-table type ip size 1m expire 5m store gpc0,conn_rate(30s)
11590
Willy Tarreau4b103022021-02-12 17:59:10 +010011591 See also : "stick match", "stick on", "stick store-request", section 2.5
David du Colombiera13d1b92011-03-17 10:40:22 +010011592 about time format and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010011593
11594
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +020011595stick store-response <pattern> [table <table>] [{if | unless} <condition>]
Baptiste Assmann2f2d2ec2016-03-06 23:27:24 +010011596 Define a response pattern used to create an entry in a stickiness table
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +020011597 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
11598 no | no | yes | yes
11599
11600 Arguments :
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +020011601 <pattern> is a sample expression rule as described in section 7.3. It
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +020011602 describes what elements of the response or connection will
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011603 be analyzed, extracted and stored in the table once a
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +020011604 server is selected.
11605
11606 <table> is an optional stickiness table name. If unspecified, the same
11607 backend's table is used. A stickiness table is declared using
11608 the "stick-table" statement.
11609
11610 <cond> is an optional storage condition. It makes it possible to store
11611 certain criteria only when some conditions are met (or not met).
11612 For instance, it could be used to store the SSL session ID only
11613 when the response is a SSL server hello.
11614
11615 Some protocols or applications require complex stickiness rules and cannot
11616 always simply rely on cookies nor hashing. The "stick store-response"
11617 statement describes a rule to decide what to extract from the response and
11618 when to do it, in order to store it into a stickiness table for further
11619 requests to match it using the "stick match" statement. Obviously the
11620 extracted part must make sense and have a chance to be matched in a further
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +020011621 request. Storing an ID found in a header of a response makes sense.
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +020011622 See section 7 for a complete list of possible patterns and transformation
11623 rules.
11624
11625 The table has to be declared using the "stick-table" statement. It must be of
11626 a type compatible with the pattern. By default it is the one which is present
11627 in the same backend. It is possible to share a table with other backends by
11628 referencing it using the "table" keyword. If another table is referenced,
11629 the server's ID inside the backends are used. By default, all server IDs
11630 start at 1 in each backend, so the server ordering is enough. But in case of
11631 doubt, it is highly recommended to force server IDs using their "id" setting.
11632
11633 It is possible to restrict the conditions where a "stick store-response"
11634 statement will apply, using "if" or "unless" followed by a condition. This
11635 condition will be evaluated while parsing the response, so any criteria can
11636 be used. See section 7 for ACL based conditions.
11637
11638 There is no limit on the number of "stick store-response" statements, but
11639 there is a limit of 8 simultaneous stores per request or response. This
11640 makes it possible to store up to 8 criteria, all extracted from either the
11641 request or the response, regardless of the number of rules. Only the 8 first
11642 ones which match will be kept. Using this, it is possible to feed multiple
11643 tables at once in the hope to increase the chance to recognize a user on
Willy Tarreau9667a802013-12-09 12:52:13 +010011644 another protocol or access method. Using multiple store-response rules with
11645 the same table is possible and may be used to find the best criterion to rely
11646 on, by arranging the rules by decreasing preference order. Only the first
11647 extracted criterion for a given table will be stored. All subsequent store-
11648 response rules referencing the same table will be skipped and their ACLs will
11649 not be evaluated. However, even if a store-request rule references a table, a
11650 store-response rule may also use the same table. This means that each table
11651 may learn exactly one element from the request and one element from the
11652 response at once.
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +020011653
11654 The table will contain the real server that processed the request.
11655
11656 Example :
11657 # Learn SSL session ID from both request and response and create affinity.
11658 backend https
11659 mode tcp
11660 balance roundrobin
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +020011661 # maximum SSL session ID length is 32 bytes.
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +020011662 stick-table type binary len 32 size 30k expire 30m
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +020011663
Christian Ruppertfd3184c2022-02-20 22:54:01 +010011664 acl clienthello req.ssl_hello_type 1
11665 acl serverhello rep.ssl_hello_type 2
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +020011666
11667 # use tcp content accepts to detects ssl client and server hello.
11668 tcp-request inspect-delay 5s
11669 tcp-request content accept if clienthello
11670
11671 # no timeout on response inspect delay by default.
11672 tcp-response content accept if serverhello
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +020011673
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +020011674 # SSL session ID (SSLID) may be present on a client or server hello.
11675 # Its length is coded on 1 byte at offset 43 and its value starts
11676 # at offset 44.
11677
11678 # Match and learn on request if client hello.
Christian Ruppertfd3184c2022-02-20 22:54:01 +010011679 stick on req.payload_lv(43,1) if clienthello
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +020011680
11681 # Learn on response if server hello.
Christian Ruppertfd3184c2022-02-20 22:54:01 +010011682 stick store-response resp.payload_lv(43,1) if serverhello
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +020011683
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +020011684 server s1 192.168.1.1:443
11685 server s2 192.168.1.1:443
11686
11687 See also : "stick-table", "stick on", and section 7 about ACLs and pattern
11688 extraction.
11689
11690
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +020011691tcp-check comment <string>
11692 Defines a comment for the following the tcp-check rule, reported in logs if
11693 it fails.
11694 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
11695 yes | no | yes | yes
11696
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +020011697 Arguments :
11698 <string> is the comment message to add in logs if the following tcp-check
11699 rule fails.
11700
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +020011701 It only works for connect, send and expect rules. It is useful to make
11702 user-friendly error reporting.
11703
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +020011704 See also : "option tcp-check", "tcp-check connect", "tcp-check send" and
11705 "tcp-check expect".
11706
11707
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +020011708tcp-check connect [default] [port <expr>] [addr <ip>] [send-proxy] [via-socks4]
11709 [ssl] [sni <sni>] [alpn <alpn>] [linger]
Christopher Fauletedc6ed92020-04-23 16:27:59 +020011710 [proto <name>] [comment <msg>]
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020011711 Opens a new connection
11712 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Christopher Faulet404f9192020-04-09 23:13:54 +020011713 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020011714
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +020011715 Arguments :
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +020011716 comment <msg> defines a message to report if the rule evaluation fails.
11717
Christopher Faulet4dce5922020-03-30 13:54:42 +020011718 default Use default options of the server line to do the health
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -040011719 checks. The server options are used only if not redefined.
Christopher Faulet4dce5922020-03-30 13:54:42 +020011720
Christopher Fauletb7d30092020-03-30 15:19:03 +020011721 port <expr> if not set, check port or server port is used.
Christopher Faulet5c288742020-03-31 08:15:58 +020011722 It tells HAProxy where to open the connection to.
11723 <port> must be a valid TCP port source integer, from 1 to
Christopher Fauletb7d30092020-03-30 15:19:03 +020011724 65535 or an sample-fetch expression.
Christopher Faulet5c288742020-03-31 08:15:58 +020011725
11726 addr <ip> defines the IP address to do the health check.
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020011727
11728 send-proxy send a PROXY protocol string
11729
Christopher Faulet085426a2020-03-30 13:07:02 +020011730 via-socks4 enables outgoing health checks using upstream socks4 proxy.
11731
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020011732 ssl opens a ciphered connection
11733
Christopher Faulet79b31d42020-03-30 13:00:05 +020011734 sni <sni> specifies the SNI to use to do health checks over SSL.
11735
Christopher Faulet98572322020-03-30 13:16:44 +020011736 alpn <alpn> defines which protocols to advertise with ALPN. The protocol
11737 list consists in a comma-delimited list of protocol names,
11738 for instance: "http/1.1,http/1.0" (without quotes).
11739 If it is not set, the server ALPN is used.
11740
Christopher Fauletedc6ed92020-04-23 16:27:59 +020011741 proto <name> forces the multiplexer's protocol to use for this connection.
11742 It must be a TCP mux protocol and it must be usable on the
11743 backend side. The list of available protocols is reported in
11744 haproxy -vv.
11745
Christopher Faulet5c288742020-03-31 08:15:58 +020011746 linger cleanly close the connection instead of using a single RST.
Gaetan Rivetf8ba6772020-02-07 15:37:17 +010011747
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +020011748 When an application lies on more than a single TCP port or when HAProxy
11749 load-balance many services in a single backend, it makes sense to probe all
11750 the services individually before considering a server as operational.
11751
11752 When there are no TCP port configured on the server line neither server port
11753 directive, then the 'tcp-check connect port <port>' must be the first step
11754 of the sequence.
11755
11756 In a tcp-check ruleset a 'connect' is required, it is also mandatory to start
11757 the ruleset with a 'connect' rule. Purpose is to ensure admin know what they
11758 do.
11759
11760 When a connect must start the ruleset, if may still be preceded by set-var,
11761 unset-var or comment rules.
11762
11763 Examples :
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020011764 # check HTTP and HTTPs services on a server.
11765 # first open port 80 thanks to server line port directive, then
11766 # tcp-check opens port 443, ciphered and run a request on it:
11767 option tcp-check
11768 tcp-check connect
11769 tcp-check send GET\ /\ HTTP/1.0\r\n
11770 tcp-check send Host:\ haproxy.1wt.eu\r\n
11771 tcp-check send \r\n
11772 tcp-check expect rstring (2..|3..)
11773 tcp-check connect port 443 ssl
11774 tcp-check send GET\ /\ HTTP/1.0\r\n
11775 tcp-check send Host:\ haproxy.1wt.eu\r\n
11776 tcp-check send \r\n
11777 tcp-check expect rstring (2..|3..)
11778 server www 10.0.0.1 check port 80
11779
11780 # check both POP and IMAP from a single server:
11781 option tcp-check
Gaetan Rivetf8ba6772020-02-07 15:37:17 +010011782 tcp-check connect port 110 linger
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020011783 tcp-check expect string +OK\ POP3\ ready
11784 tcp-check connect port 143
11785 tcp-check expect string *\ OK\ IMAP4\ ready
11786 server mail 10.0.0.1 check
11787
11788 See also : "option tcp-check", "tcp-check send", "tcp-check expect"
11789
11790
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +020011791tcp-check expect [min-recv <int>] [comment <msg>]
Christopher Fauletec07e382020-04-07 14:56:26 +020011792 [ok-status <st>] [error-status <st>] [tout-status <st>]
Christopher Faulet98cc57c2020-04-01 20:52:31 +020011793 [on-success <fmt>] [on-error <fmt>] [status-code <expr>]
Christopher Fauletcf80f2f2020-04-01 11:04:52 +020011794 [!] <match> <pattern>
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011795 Specify data to be collected and analyzed during a generic health check
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020011796 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Christopher Faulet404f9192020-04-09 23:13:54 +020011797 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020011798
11799 Arguments :
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +020011800 comment <msg> defines a message to report if the rule evaluation fails.
11801
Gaetan Rivet1afd8262020-02-07 15:37:17 +010011802 min-recv is optional and can define the minimum amount of data required to
11803 evaluate the current expect rule. If the number of received bytes
11804 is under this limit, the check will wait for more data. This
11805 option can be used to resolve some ambiguous matching rules or to
11806 avoid executing costly regex matches on content known to be still
11807 incomplete. If an exact string (string or binary) is used, the
11808 minimum between the string length and this parameter is used.
11809 This parameter is ignored if it is set to -1. If the expect rule
11810 does not match, the check will wait for more data. If set to 0,
11811 the evaluation result is always conclusive.
11812
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020011813 <match> is a keyword indicating how to look for a specific pattern in the
Gaetan Rivetefab6c62020-02-07 15:37:17 +010011814 response. The keyword may be one of "string", "rstring", "binary" or
11815 "rbinary".
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020011816 The keyword may be preceded by an exclamation mark ("!") to negate
11817 the match. Spaces are allowed between the exclamation mark and the
11818 keyword. See below for more details on the supported keywords.
11819
Christopher Fauletec07e382020-04-07 14:56:26 +020011820 ok-status <st> is optional and can be used to set the check status if
11821 the expect rule is successfully evaluated and if it is
11822 the last rule in the tcp-check ruleset. "L7OK", "L7OKC",
Christopher Fauletd888f0f2020-05-07 07:40:17 +020011823 "L6OK" and "L4OK" are supported :
11824 - L7OK : check passed on layer 7
Christopher Faulet83662b52020-11-20 17:47:47 +010011825 - L7OKC : check conditionally passed on layer 7, set
11826 server to NOLB state.
Christopher Fauletd888f0f2020-05-07 07:40:17 +020011827 - L6OK : check passed on layer 6
11828 - L4OK : check passed on layer 4
Christopher Fauletec07e382020-04-07 14:56:26 +020011829 By default "L7OK" is used.
11830
Christopher Fauletcf80f2f2020-04-01 11:04:52 +020011831 error-status <st> is optional and can be used to set the check status if
11832 an error occurred during the expect rule evaluation.
Christopher Faulet83662b52020-11-20 17:47:47 +010011833 "L7OKC", "L7RSP", "L7STS", "L6RSP" and "L4CON" are
11834 supported :
11835 - L7OKC : check conditionally passed on layer 7, set
11836 server to NOLB state.
Christopher Fauletd888f0f2020-05-07 07:40:17 +020011837 - L7RSP : layer 7 invalid response - protocol error
11838 - L7STS : layer 7 response error, for example HTTP 5xx
11839 - L6RSP : layer 6 invalid response - protocol error
11840 - L4CON : layer 1-4 connection problem
11841 By default "L7RSP" is used.
Christopher Fauletcf80f2f2020-04-01 11:04:52 +020011842
Christopher Fauletec07e382020-04-07 14:56:26 +020011843 tout-status <st> is optional and can be used to set the check status if
Christopher Fauletcf80f2f2020-04-01 11:04:52 +020011844 a timeout occurred during the expect rule evaluation.
Christopher Fauletd888f0f2020-05-07 07:40:17 +020011845 "L7TOUT", "L6TOUT", and "L4TOUT" are supported :
11846 - L7TOUT : layer 7 (HTTP/SMTP) timeout
11847 - L6TOUT : layer 6 (SSL) timeout
11848 - L4TOUT : layer 1-4 timeout
Christopher Fauletcf80f2f2020-04-01 11:04:52 +020011849 By default "L7TOUT" is used.
11850
Christopher Fauletbe52b4d2020-04-01 16:30:22 +020011851 on-success <fmt> is optional and can be used to customize the
11852 informational message reported in logs if the expect
11853 rule is successfully evaluated and if it is the last rule
11854 in the tcp-check ruleset. <fmt> is a log-format string.
11855
11856 on-error <fmt> is optional and can be used to customize the
11857 informational message reported in logs if an error
11858 occurred during the expect rule evaluation. <fmt> is a
11859 log-format string.
11860
Christopher Faulet98cc57c2020-04-01 20:52:31 +020011861 status-code <expr> is optional and can be used to set the check status code
11862 reported in logs, on success or on error. <expr> is a
11863 standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
11864 followed by some converters.
11865
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020011866 <pattern> is the pattern to look for. It may be a string or a regular
11867 expression. If the pattern contains spaces, they must be escaped
11868 with the usual backslash ('\').
11869 If the match is set to binary, then the pattern must be passed as
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011870 a series of hexadecimal digits in an even number. Each sequence of
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020011871 two digits will represent a byte. The hexadecimal digits may be
11872 used upper or lower case.
11873
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020011874 The available matches are intentionally similar to their http-check cousins :
11875
11876 string <string> : test the exact string matches in the response buffer.
11877 A health check response will be considered valid if the
11878 response's buffer contains this exact string. If the
11879 "string" keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response
11880 will be considered invalid if the body contains this
11881 string. This can be used to look for a mandatory pattern
11882 in a protocol response, or to detect a failure when a
11883 specific error appears in a protocol banner.
11884
11885 rstring <regex> : test a regular expression on the response buffer.
11886 A health check response will be considered valid if the
11887 response's buffer matches this expression. If the
11888 "rstring" keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response
11889 will be considered invalid if the body matches the
11890 expression.
11891
Christopher Fauletaaab0832020-05-05 15:54:22 +020011892 string-lf <fmt> : test a log-format string match in the response's buffer.
11893 A health check response will be considered valid if the
11894 response's buffer contains the string resulting of the
11895 evaluation of <fmt>, which follows the log-format rules.
11896 If prefixed with "!", then the response will be
11897 considered invalid if the buffer contains the string.
11898
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020011899 binary <hexstring> : test the exact string in its hexadecimal form matches
11900 in the response buffer. A health check response will
11901 be considered valid if the response's buffer contains
11902 this exact hexadecimal string.
11903 Purpose is to match data on binary protocols.
11904
Gaetan Rivetefab6c62020-02-07 15:37:17 +010011905 rbinary <regex> : test a regular expression on the response buffer, like
11906 "rstring". However, the response buffer is transformed
11907 into its hexadecimal form, including NUL-bytes. This
11908 allows using all regex engines to match any binary
11909 content. The hexadecimal transformation takes twice the
11910 size of the original response. As such, the expected
11911 pattern should work on at-most half the response buffer
11912 size.
11913
Christopher Fauletaaab0832020-05-05 15:54:22 +020011914 binary-lf <hexfmt> : test a log-format string in its hexadecimal form
11915 match in the response's buffer. A health check response
11916 will be considered valid if the response's buffer
11917 contains the hexadecimal string resulting of the
11918 evaluation of <fmt>, which follows the log-format
11919 rules. If prefixed with "!", then the response will be
11920 considered invalid if the buffer contains the
11921 hexadecimal string. The hexadecimal string is converted
11922 in a binary string before matching the response's
11923 buffer.
11924
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020011925 It is important to note that the responses will be limited to a certain size
Christopher Fauletbb9fb8b2020-11-25 17:20:57 +010011926 defined by the global "tune.bufsize" option, which defaults to 16384 bytes.
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020011927 Thus, too large responses may not contain the mandatory pattern when using
11928 "string", "rstring" or binary. If a large response is absolutely required, it
11929 is possible to change the default max size by setting the global variable.
11930 However, it is worth keeping in mind that parsing very large responses can
11931 waste some CPU cycles, especially when regular expressions are used, and that
11932 it is always better to focus the checks on smaller resources. Also, in its
11933 current state, the check will not find any string nor regex past a null
11934 character in the response. Similarly it is not possible to request matching
11935 the null character.
11936
11937 Examples :
11938 # perform a POP check
11939 option tcp-check
11940 tcp-check expect string +OK\ POP3\ ready
11941
11942 # perform an IMAP check
11943 option tcp-check
11944 tcp-check expect string *\ OK\ IMAP4\ ready
11945
11946 # look for the redis master server
11947 option tcp-check
11948 tcp-check send PING\r\n
Baptiste Assmanna3322992015-08-04 10:12:18 +020011949 tcp-check expect string +PONG
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020011950 tcp-check send info\ replication\r\n
11951 tcp-check expect string role:master
11952 tcp-check send QUIT\r\n
11953 tcp-check expect string +OK
11954
11955
11956 See also : "option tcp-check", "tcp-check connect", "tcp-check send",
Christopher Fauletbb9fb8b2020-11-25 17:20:57 +010011957 "tcp-check send-binary", "http-check expect", tune.bufsize
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020011958
11959
Christopher Fauletb50b3e62020-05-05 18:43:43 +020011960tcp-check send <data> [comment <msg>]
11961tcp-check send-lf <fmt> [comment <msg>]
11962 Specify a string or a log-format string to be sent as a question during a
11963 generic health check
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020011964 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Christopher Faulet404f9192020-04-09 23:13:54 +020011965 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020011966
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +020011967 Arguments :
11968 comment <msg> defines a message to report if the rule evaluation fails.
11969
Christopher Fauletb50b3e62020-05-05 18:43:43 +020011970 <data> is the string that will be sent during a generic health
11971 check session.
Christopher Faulet16fff672020-04-30 07:50:54 +020011972
Christopher Fauletb50b3e62020-05-05 18:43:43 +020011973 <fmt> is the log-format string that will be sent, once evaluated,
11974 during a generic health check session.
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020011975
11976 Examples :
11977 # look for the redis master server
11978 option tcp-check
11979 tcp-check send info\ replication\r\n
11980 tcp-check expect string role:master
11981
11982 See also : "option tcp-check", "tcp-check connect", "tcp-check expect",
Christopher Fauletbb9fb8b2020-11-25 17:20:57 +010011983 "tcp-check send-binary", tune.bufsize
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020011984
11985
Christopher Fauletb50b3e62020-05-05 18:43:43 +020011986tcp-check send-binary <hexstring> [comment <msg>]
11987tcp-check send-binary-lf <hexfmt> [comment <msg>]
11988 Specify an hex digits string or an hex digits log-format string to be sent as
11989 a binary question during a raw tcp health check
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020011990 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Christopher Faulet404f9192020-04-09 23:13:54 +020011991 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020011992
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +020011993 Arguments :
11994 comment <msg> defines a message to report if the rule evaluation fails.
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +020011995
Christopher Fauletb50b3e62020-05-05 18:43:43 +020011996 <hexstring> is the hexadecimal string that will be send, once converted
11997 to binary, during a generic health check session.
Christopher Faulet16fff672020-04-30 07:50:54 +020011998
Christopher Fauletb50b3e62020-05-05 18:43:43 +020011999 <hexfmt> is the hexadecimal log-format string that will be send, once
12000 evaluated and converted to binary, during a generic health
12001 check session.
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020012002
12003 Examples :
12004 # redis check in binary
12005 option tcp-check
12006 tcp-check send-binary 50494e470d0a # PING\r\n
12007 tcp-check expect binary 2b504F4e47 # +PONG
12008
12009
12010 See also : "option tcp-check", "tcp-check connect", "tcp-check expect",
Christopher Fauletbb9fb8b2020-11-25 17:20:57 +010012011 "tcp-check send", tune.bufsize
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020012012
12013
Gaetan Rivet0c39ecc2020-02-24 17:34:11 +010012014tcp-check set-var(<var-name>) <expr>
Gaetan Rivet0c39ecc2020-02-24 17:34:11 +010012015 This operation sets the content of a variable. The variable is declared inline.
Gaetan Rivet0c39ecc2020-02-24 17:34:11 +010012016 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Christopher Faulet404f9192020-04-09 23:13:54 +020012017 yes | no | yes | yes
Gaetan Rivet0c39ecc2020-02-24 17:34:11 +010012018
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +020012019 Arguments :
Gaetan Rivet0c39ecc2020-02-24 17:34:11 +010012020 <var-name> The name of the variable starts with an indication about its
12021 scope. The scopes allowed for tcp-check are:
12022 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process.
12023 "sess" : the variable is shared with the tcp-check session.
12024 "check": the variable is declared for the lifetime of the tcp-check.
12025 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'.
12026 The name may only contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.',
12027 and '-'.
12028
12029 <expr> Is a sample-fetch expression potentially followed by converters.
12030
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +020012031 Examples :
Gaetan Rivet0c39ecc2020-02-24 17:34:11 +010012032 tcp-check set-var(check.port) int(1234)
12033
12034
12035tcp-check unset-var(<var-name>)
Gaetan Rivet0c39ecc2020-02-24 17:34:11 +010012036 Free a reference to a variable within its scope.
Gaetan Rivet0c39ecc2020-02-24 17:34:11 +010012037 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Christopher Faulet404f9192020-04-09 23:13:54 +020012038 yes | no | yes | yes
Gaetan Rivet0c39ecc2020-02-24 17:34:11 +010012039
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +020012040 Arguments :
Gaetan Rivet0c39ecc2020-02-24 17:34:11 +010012041 <var-name> The name of the variable starts with an indication about its
12042 scope. The scopes allowed for tcp-check are:
12043 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process.
12044 "sess" : the variable is shared with the tcp-check session.
12045 "check": the variable is declared for the lifetime of the tcp-check.
12046 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'.
12047 The name may only contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.',
12048 and '-'.
12049
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +020012050 Examples :
Gaetan Rivet0c39ecc2020-02-24 17:34:11 +010012051 tcp-check unset-var(check.port)
12052
12053
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012054tcp-request connection <action> [{if | unless} <condition>]
12055 Perform an action on an incoming connection depending on a layer 4 condition
Willy Tarreau1a687942010-05-23 22:40:30 +020012056 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
12057 no | yes | yes | no
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012058 Arguments :
Willy Tarreauc870bfd2015-09-28 18:47:38 +020012059 <action> defines the action to perform if the condition applies. See
12060 below.
Willy Tarreau1a687942010-05-23 22:40:30 +020012061
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012062 <condition> is a standard layer4-only ACL-based condition (see section 7).
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020012063
12064 Immediately after acceptance of a new incoming connection, it is possible to
12065 evaluate some conditions to decide whether this connection must be accepted
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012066 or dropped or have its counters tracked. Those conditions cannot make use of
12067 any data contents because the connection has not been read from yet, and the
12068 buffers are not yet allocated. This is used to selectively and very quickly
12069 accept or drop connections from various sources with a very low overhead. If
12070 some contents need to be inspected in order to take the decision, the
12071 "tcp-request content" statements must be used instead.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020012072
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012073 The "tcp-request connection" rules are evaluated in their exact declaration
12074 order. If no rule matches or if there is no rule, the default action is to
12075 accept the incoming connection. There is no specific limit to the number of
12076 rules which may be inserted.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020012077
Willy Tarreaua9083d02015-05-08 15:27:59 +020012078 Four types of actions are supported :
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012079 - accept :
12080 accepts the connection if the condition is true (when used with "if")
12081 or false (when used with "unless"). The first such rule executed ends
12082 the rules evaluation.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020012083
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012084 - reject :
12085 rejects the connection if the condition is true (when used with "if")
12086 or false (when used with "unless"). The first such rule executed ends
12087 the rules evaluation. Rejected connections do not even become a
12088 session, which is why they are accounted separately for in the stats,
12089 as "denied connections". They are not considered for the session
12090 rate-limit and are not logged either. The reason is that these rules
12091 should only be used to filter extremely high connection rates such as
12092 the ones encountered during a massive DDoS attack. Under these extreme
12093 conditions, the simple action of logging each event would make the
12094 system collapse and would considerably lower the filtering capacity. If
12095 logging is absolutely desired, then "tcp-request content" rules should
Willy Tarreau4f614292016-10-21 17:49:36 +020012096 be used instead, as "tcp-request session" rules will not log either.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020012097
Willy Tarreau4f0d9192013-06-11 20:40:55 +020012098 - expect-proxy layer4 :
12099 configures the client-facing connection to receive a PROXY protocol
12100 header before any byte is read from the socket. This is equivalent to
12101 having the "accept-proxy" keyword on the "bind" line, except that using
12102 the TCP rule allows the PROXY protocol to be accepted only for certain
12103 IP address ranges using an ACL. This is convenient when multiple layers
12104 of load balancers are passed through by traffic coming from public
12105 hosts.
12106
Bertrand Jacquin90759682016-06-06 15:35:39 +010012107 - expect-netscaler-cip layer4 :
12108 configures the client-facing connection to receive a NetScaler Client
12109 IP insertion protocol header before any byte is read from the socket.
12110 This is equivalent to having the "accept-netscaler-cip" keyword on the
12111 "bind" line, except that using the TCP rule allows the PROXY protocol
12112 to be accepted only for certain IP address ranges using an ACL. This
12113 is convenient when multiple layers of load balancers are passed
12114 through by traffic coming from public hosts.
12115
Willy Tarreau18bf01e2014-06-13 16:18:52 +020012116 - capture <sample> len <length> :
12117 This only applies to "tcp-request content" rules. It captures sample
12118 expression <sample> from the request buffer, and converts it to a
12119 string of at most <len> characters. The resulting string is stored into
12120 the next request "capture" slot, so it will possibly appear next to
12121 some captured HTTP headers. It will then automatically appear in the
12122 logs, and it will be possible to extract it using sample fetch rules to
12123 feed it into headers or anything. The length should be limited given
12124 that this size will be allocated for each capture during the whole
Willy Tarreaua9083d02015-05-08 15:27:59 +020012125 session life. Please check section 7.3 (Fetching samples) and "capture
12126 request header" for more information.
Willy Tarreau18bf01e2014-06-13 16:18:52 +020012127
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020012128 - { track-sc0 | track-sc1 | track-sc2 } <key> [table <table>] :
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012129 enables tracking of sticky counters from current connection. These
Moemen MHEDHBI9cf46342018-09-25 17:50:53 +020012130 rules do not stop evaluation and do not change default action. The
12131 number of counters that may be simultaneously tracked by the same
12132 connection is set in MAX_SESS_STKCTR at build time (reported in
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050012133 haproxy -vv) which defaults to 3, so the track-sc number is between 0
Matteo Contrini1857b8c2020-10-16 17:35:54 +020012134 and (MAX_SESS_STKCTR-1). The first "track-sc0" rule executed enables
Moemen MHEDHBI9cf46342018-09-25 17:50:53 +020012135 tracking of the counters of the specified table as the first set. The
12136 first "track-sc1" rule executed enables tracking of the counters of the
12137 specified table as the second set. The first "track-sc2" rule executed
12138 enables tracking of the counters of the specified table as the third
12139 set. It is a recommended practice to use the first set of counters for
12140 the per-frontend counters and the second set for the per-backend ones.
12141 But this is just a guideline, all may be used everywhere.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020012142
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012143 These actions take one or two arguments :
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +020012144 <key> is mandatory, and is a sample expression rule as described
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012145 in section 7.3. It describes what elements of the incoming
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012146 request or connection will be analyzed, extracted, combined,
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +010012147 and used to select which table entry to update the counters.
12148 Note that "tcp-request connection" cannot use content-based
12149 fetches.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020012150
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012151 <table> is an optional table to be used instead of the default one,
12152 which is the stick-table declared in the current proxy. All
12153 the counters for the matches and updates for the key will
12154 then be performed in that table until the session ends.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020012155
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012156 Once a "track-sc*" rule is executed, the key is looked up in the table
12157 and if it is not found, an entry is allocated for it. Then a pointer to
12158 that entry is kept during all the session's life, and this entry's
12159 counters are updated as often as possible, every time the session's
12160 counters are updated, and also systematically when the session ends.
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +010012161 Counters are only updated for events that happen after the tracking has
12162 been started. For example, connection counters will not be updated when
12163 tracking layer 7 information, since the connection event happens before
12164 layer7 information is extracted.
12165
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012166 If the entry tracks concurrent connection counters, one connection is
12167 counted for as long as the entry is tracked, and the entry will not
12168 expire during that time. Tracking counters also provides a performance
12169 advantage over just checking the keys, because only one table lookup is
12170 performed for all ACL checks that make use of it.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020012171
Thierry FOURNIERe0627bd2015-08-04 08:20:33 +020012172 - sc-inc-gpc0(<sc-id>):
12173 The "sc-inc-gpc0" increments the GPC0 counter according to the sticky
12174 counter designated by <sc-id>. If an error occurs, this action silently
12175 fails and the actions evaluation continues.
12176
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010012177 - sc-inc-gpc1(<sc-id>):
12178 The "sc-inc-gpc1" increments the GPC1 counter according to the sticky
12179 counter designated by <sc-id>. If an error occurs, this action silently
12180 fails and the actions evaluation continues.
12181
Cédric Dufour0d7712d2019-11-06 18:38:53 +010012182 - sc-set-gpt0(<sc-id>) { <int> | <expr> }:
12183 This action sets the 32-bit unsigned GPT0 tag according to the sticky
12184 counter designated by <sc-id> and the value of <int>/<expr>. The
12185 expected result is a boolean. If an error occurs, this action silently
12186 fails and the actions evaluation continues.
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +020012187
William Lallemand2e785f22016-05-25 01:48:42 +020012188 - set-src <expr> :
12189 Is used to set the source IP address to the value of specified
12190 expression. Useful if you want to mask source IP for privacy.
12191 If you want to provide an IP from a HTTP header use "http-request
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +020012192 set-src".
William Lallemand2e785f22016-05-25 01:48:42 +020012193
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +020012194 Arguments:
12195 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
12196 followed by some converters.
William Lallemand2e785f22016-05-25 01:48:42 +020012197
12198 Example:
William Lallemand2e785f22016-05-25 01:48:42 +020012199 tcp-request connection set-src src,ipmask(24)
12200
Willy Tarreau0c630532016-10-21 17:52:58 +020012201 When possible, set-src preserves the original source port as long as the
12202 address family allows it, otherwise the source port is set to 0.
William Lallemand2e785f22016-05-25 01:48:42 +020012203
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +020012204 - set-src-port <expr> :
12205 Is used to set the source port address to the value of specified
12206 expression.
12207
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +020012208 Arguments:
12209 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
12210 followed by some converters.
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +020012211
12212 Example:
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +020012213 tcp-request connection set-src-port int(4000)
12214
Willy Tarreau0c630532016-10-21 17:52:58 +020012215 When possible, set-src-port preserves the original source address as long
12216 as the address family supports a port, otherwise it forces the source
12217 address to IPv4 "0.0.0.0" before rewriting the port.
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +020012218
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +020012219 - set-dst <expr> :
12220 Is used to set the destination IP address to the value of specified
12221 expression. Useful if you want to mask IP for privacy in log.
12222 If you want to provide an IP from a HTTP header use "http-request
12223 set-dst". If you want to connect to the new address/port, use
12224 '0.0.0.0:0' as a server address in the backend.
12225
12226 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
12227 followed by some converters.
12228
12229 Example:
12230
12231 tcp-request connection set-dst dst,ipmask(24)
12232 tcp-request connection set-dst ipv4(10.0.0.1)
12233
Willy Tarreau0c630532016-10-21 17:52:58 +020012234 When possible, set-dst preserves the original destination port as long as
12235 the address family allows it, otherwise the destination port is set to 0.
12236
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +020012237 - set-dst-port <expr> :
12238 Is used to set the destination port address to the value of specified
12239 expression. If you want to connect to the new address/port, use
12240 '0.0.0.0:0' as a server address in the backend.
12241
12242
12243 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
12244 followed by some converters.
12245
12246 Example:
12247
12248 tcp-request connection set-dst-port int(4000)
12249
Willy Tarreau0c630532016-10-21 17:52:58 +020012250 When possible, set-dst-port preserves the original destination address as
12251 long as the address family supports a port, otherwise it forces the
12252 destination address to IPv4 "0.0.0.0" before rewriting the port.
12253
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +020012254 - "silent-drop" :
12255 This stops the evaluation of the rules and makes the client-facing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012256 connection suddenly disappear using a system-dependent way that tries
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +020012257 to prevent the client from being notified. The effect it then that the
12258 client still sees an established connection while there's none on
12259 HAProxy. The purpose is to achieve a comparable effect to "tarpit"
12260 except that it doesn't use any local resource at all on the machine
12261 running HAProxy. It can resist much higher loads than "tarpit", and
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012262 slow down stronger attackers. It is important to understand the impact
12263 of using this mechanism. All stateful equipment placed between the
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +020012264 client and HAProxy (firewalls, proxies, load balancers) will also keep
12265 the established connection for a long time and may suffer from this
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012266 action. On modern Linux systems running with enough privileges, the
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +020012267 TCP_REPAIR socket option is used to block the emission of a TCP
12268 reset. On other systems, the socket's TTL is reduced to 1 so that the
12269 TCP reset doesn't pass the first router, though it's still delivered to
12270 local networks. Do not use it unless you fully understand how it works.
12271
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012272 Note that the "if/unless" condition is optional. If no condition is set on
12273 the action, it is simply performed unconditionally. That can be useful for
12274 "track-sc*" actions as well as for changing the default action to a reject.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020012275
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012276 Example: accept all connections from white-listed hosts, reject too fast
12277 connection without counting them, and track accepted connections.
12278 This results in connection rate being capped from abusive sources.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020012279
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012280 tcp-request connection accept if { src -f /etc/haproxy/whitelist.lst }
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020012281 tcp-request connection reject if { src_conn_rate gt 10 }
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020012282 tcp-request connection track-sc0 src
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020012283
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012284 Example: accept all connections from white-listed hosts, count all other
12285 connections and reject too fast ones. This results in abusive ones
12286 being blocked as long as they don't slow down.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020012287
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012288 tcp-request connection accept if { src -f /etc/haproxy/whitelist.lst }
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020012289 tcp-request connection track-sc0 src
12290 tcp-request connection reject if { sc0_conn_rate gt 10 }
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020012291
Willy Tarreau4f0d9192013-06-11 20:40:55 +020012292 Example: enable the PROXY protocol for traffic coming from all known proxies.
12293
12294 tcp-request connection expect-proxy layer4 if { src -f proxies.lst }
12295
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020012296 See section 7 about ACL usage.
12297
Willy Tarreau4f614292016-10-21 17:49:36 +020012298 See also : "tcp-request session", "tcp-request content", "stick-table"
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020012299
12300
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012301tcp-request content <action> [{if | unless} <condition>]
12302 Perform an action on a new session depending on a layer 4-7 condition
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020012303 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaufb356202010-08-03 14:02:05 +020012304 no | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012305 Arguments :
Willy Tarreauc870bfd2015-09-28 18:47:38 +020012306 <action> defines the action to perform if the condition applies. See
12307 below.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020012308
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012309 <condition> is a standard layer 4-7 ACL-based condition (see section 7).
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020012310
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012311 A request's contents can be analyzed at an early stage of request processing
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012312 called "TCP content inspection". During this stage, ACL-based rules are
12313 evaluated every time the request contents are updated, until either an
Christopher Fauletae863c62021-03-15 12:03:44 +010012314 "accept", a "reject" or a "switch-mode" rule matches, or the TCP request
12315 inspection delay expires with no matching rule.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020012316
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012317 The first difference between these rules and "tcp-request connection" rules
12318 is that "tcp-request content" rules can make use of contents to take a
12319 decision. Most often, these decisions will consider a protocol recognition or
12320 validity. The second difference is that content-based rules can be used in
Willy Tarreauf3338342014-01-28 21:40:28 +010012321 both frontends and backends. In case of HTTP keep-alive with the client, all
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040012322 tcp-request content rules are evaluated again, so HAProxy keeps a record of
Willy Tarreauf3338342014-01-28 21:40:28 +010012323 what sticky counters were assigned by a "tcp-request connection" versus a
12324 "tcp-request content" rule, and flushes all the content-related ones after
12325 processing an HTTP request, so that they may be evaluated again by the rules
12326 being evaluated again for the next request. This is of particular importance
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030012327 when the rule tracks some L7 information or when it is conditioned by an
Willy Tarreauf3338342014-01-28 21:40:28 +010012328 L7-based ACL, since tracking may change between requests.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020012329
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012330 Content-based rules are evaluated in their exact declaration order. If no
12331 rule matches or if there is no rule, the default action is to accept the
12332 contents. There is no specific limit to the number of rules which may be
12333 inserted.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020012334
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +020012335 Several types of actions are supported :
Willy Tarreau18bf01e2014-06-13 16:18:52 +020012336 - accept : the request is accepted
Baptiste Assmann333939c2019-01-21 08:34:50 +010012337 - do-resolve: perform a DNS resolution
Willy Tarreau18bf01e2014-06-13 16:18:52 +020012338 - reject : the request is rejected and the connection is closed
12339 - capture : the specified sample expression is captured
Patrick Hemmer268a7072018-05-11 12:52:31 -040012340 - set-priority-class <expr> | set-priority-offset <expr>
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020012341 - { track-sc0 | track-sc1 | track-sc2 } <key> [table <table>]
Thierry FOURNIERe0627bd2015-08-04 08:20:33 +020012342 - sc-inc-gpc0(<sc-id>)
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010012343 - sc-inc-gpc1(<sc-id>)
Cédric Dufour0d7712d2019-11-06 18:38:53 +010012344 - sc-set-gpt0(<sc-id>) { <int> | <expr> }
Baptiste Assmanne1afd4f2019-04-18 16:21:13 +020012345 - set-dst <expr>
12346 - set-dst-port <expr>
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020012347 - set-var(<var-name>) <expr>
Christopher Fauletae863c62021-03-15 12:03:44 +010012348 - switch-mode http [ proto <name> ]
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +010012349 - unset-var(<var-name>)
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +020012350 - silent-drop
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012351 - send-spoe-group <engine-name> <group-name>
Christopher Faulet579d83b2019-11-22 15:34:17 +010012352 - use-service <service-name>
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020012353
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012354 They have the same meaning as their counter-parts in "tcp-request connection"
12355 so please refer to that section for a complete description.
Baptiste Assmann333939c2019-01-21 08:34:50 +010012356 For "do-resolve" action, please check the "http-request do-resolve"
12357 configuration section.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020012358
Willy Tarreauf3338342014-01-28 21:40:28 +010012359 While there is nothing mandatory about it, it is recommended to use the
12360 track-sc0 in "tcp-request connection" rules, track-sc1 for "tcp-request
12361 content" rules in the frontend, and track-sc2 for "tcp-request content"
12362 rules in the backend, because that makes the configuration more readable
12363 and easier to troubleshoot, but this is just a guideline and all counters
12364 may be used everywhere.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020012365
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010012366 Note that the "if/unless" condition is optional. If no condition is set on
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012367 the action, it is simply performed unconditionally. That can be useful for
12368 "track-sc*" actions as well as for changing the default action to a reject.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020012369
Christopher Faulet2079a4a2020-10-02 11:48:57 +020012370 Note also that it is recommended to use a "tcp-request session" rule to track
12371 information that does *not* depend on Layer 7 contents, especially for HTTP
12372 frontends. Some HTTP processing are performed at the session level and may
12373 lead to an early rejection of the requests. Thus, the tracking at the content
12374 level may be disturbed in such case. A warning is emitted during startup to
12375 prevent, as far as possible, such unreliable usage.
12376
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012377 It is perfectly possible to match layer 7 contents with "tcp-request content"
Christopher Faulet7ea509e2020-10-02 11:38:46 +020012378 rules from a TCP proxy, since HTTP-specific ACL matches are able to
12379 preliminarily parse the contents of a buffer before extracting the required
12380 data. If the buffered contents do not parse as a valid HTTP message, then the
12381 ACL does not match. The parser which is involved there is exactly the same
12382 as for all other HTTP processing, so there is no risk of parsing something
12383 differently. In an HTTP frontend or an HTTP backend, it is guaranteed that
12384 HTTP contents will always be immediately present when the rule is evaluated
12385 first because the HTTP parsing is performed in the early stages of the
12386 connection processing, at the session level. But for such proxies, using
12387 "http-request" rules is much more natural and recommended.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020012388
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +010012389 Tracking layer7 information is also possible provided that the information
Willy Tarreau4d54c7c2014-09-16 15:48:15 +020012390 are present when the rule is processed. The rule processing engine is able to
12391 wait until the inspect delay expires when the data to be tracked is not yet
12392 available.
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +010012393
Baptiste Assmanne1afd4f2019-04-18 16:21:13 +020012394 The "set-dst" and "set-dst-port" are used to set respectively the destination
12395 IP and port. More information on how to use it at "http-request set-dst".
12396
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020012397 The "set-var" is used to set the content of a variable. The variable is
Willy Tarreau4f614292016-10-21 17:49:36 +020012398 declared inline. For "tcp-request session" rules, only session-level
12399 variables can be used, without any layer7 contents.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020012400
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010012401 <var-name> The name of the variable starts with an indication about
12402 its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010012403 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010012404 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
12405 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020012406 (request and response)
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010012407 "req" : the variable is shared only during request
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020012408 processing
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010012409 "res" : the variable is shared only during response
12410 processing
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020012411 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'.
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010012412 The name may only contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9',
12413 '.' and '_'.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020012414
12415 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
12416 followed by some converters.
12417
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040012418 The "switch-mode" is used to perform a connection upgrade. Only HTTP
Christopher Fauletae863c62021-03-15 12:03:44 +010012419 upgrades are supported for now. The protocol may optionally be
12420 specified. This action is only available for a proxy with the frontend
12421 capability. The connection upgrade is immediately performed, following
12422 "tcp-request content" rules are not evaluated. This upgrade method should be
12423 preferred to the implicit one consisting to rely on the backend mode. When
12424 used, it is possible to set HTTP directives in a frontend without any
Ilya Shipitsin3df59892021-05-10 12:50:00 +050012425 warning. These directives will be conditionally evaluated if the HTTP upgrade
Christopher Fauletae863c62021-03-15 12:03:44 +010012426 is performed. However, an HTTP backend must still be selected. It remains
12427 unsupported to route an HTTP connection (upgraded or not) to a TCP server.
12428
Christopher Faulet4d37e532021-03-26 14:44:00 +010012429 See section 4 about Proxies for more details on HTTP upgrades.
12430
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +010012431 The "unset-var" is used to unset a variable. See above for details about
12432 <var-name>.
12433
Patrick Hemmer268a7072018-05-11 12:52:31 -040012434 The "set-priority-class" is used to set the queue priority class of the
12435 current request. The value must be a sample expression which converts to an
12436 integer in the range -2047..2047. Results outside this range will be
12437 truncated. The priority class determines the order in which queued requests
12438 are processed. Lower values have higher priority.
12439
12440 The "set-priority-offset" is used to set the queue priority timestamp offset
12441 of the current request. The value must be a sample expression which converts
12442 to an integer in the range -524287..524287. Results outside this range will be
12443 truncated. When a request is queued, it is ordered first by the priority
12444 class, then by the current timestamp adjusted by the given offset in
12445 milliseconds. Lower values have higher priority.
12446 Note that the resulting timestamp is is only tracked with enough precision for
12447 524,287ms (8m44s287ms). If the request is queued long enough to where the
12448 adjusted timestamp exceeds this value, it will be misidentified as highest
12449 priority. Thus it is important to set "timeout queue" to a value, where when
12450 combined with the offset, does not exceed this limit.
12451
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +020012452 The "send-spoe-group" is used to trigger sending of a group of SPOE
12453 messages. To do so, the SPOE engine used to send messages must be defined, as
12454 well as the SPOE group to send. Of course, the SPOE engine must refer to an
12455 existing SPOE filter. If not engine name is provided on the SPOE filter line,
12456 the SPOE agent name must be used.
12457
12458 <engine-name> The SPOE engine name.
12459
12460 <group-name> The SPOE group name as specified in the engine configuration.
12461
Christopher Faulet579d83b2019-11-22 15:34:17 +010012462 The "use-service" is used to executes a TCP service which will reply to the
12463 request and stop the evaluation of the rules. This service may choose to
12464 reply by sending any valid response or it may immediately close the
12465 connection without sending anything. Outside natives services, it is possible
12466 to write your own services in Lua. No further "tcp-request" rules are
12467 evaluated.
12468
12469 Example:
Aurelien DARRAGONdf332122022-10-05 18:09:33 +020012470 tcp-request content use-service lua.deny if { src -f /etc/haproxy/blacklist.lst }
Christopher Faulet579d83b2019-11-22 15:34:17 +010012471
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020012472 Example:
12473
12474 tcp-request content set-var(sess.my_var) src
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +010012475 tcp-request content unset-var(sess.my_var2)
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020012476
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020012477 Example:
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012478 # Accept HTTP requests containing a Host header saying "example.com"
Christopher Fauletae863c62021-03-15 12:03:44 +010012479 # and reject everything else. (Only works for HTTP/1 connections)
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012480 acl is_host_com hdr(Host) -i example.com
12481 tcp-request inspect-delay 30s
Willy Tarreauc0239e02012-04-16 14:42:55 +020012482 tcp-request content accept if is_host_com
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012483 tcp-request content reject
12484
Christopher Fauletae863c62021-03-15 12:03:44 +010012485 # Accept HTTP requests containing a Host header saying "example.com"
12486 # and reject everything else. (works for HTTP/1 and HTTP/2 connections)
12487 acl is_host_com hdr(Host) -i example.com
12488 tcp-request inspect-delay 5s
12489 tcp-request switch-mode http if HTTP
12490 tcp-request reject # non-HTTP traffic is implicit here
12491 ...
12492 http-request reject unless is_host_com
12493
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012494 Example:
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020012495 # reject SMTP connection if client speaks first
12496 tcp-request inspect-delay 30s
Christian Ruppertfd3184c2022-02-20 22:54:01 +010012497 acl content_present req.len gt 0
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020012498 tcp-request content reject if content_present
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020012499
12500 # Forward HTTPS connection only if client speaks
12501 tcp-request inspect-delay 30s
Christian Ruppertfd3184c2022-02-20 22:54:01 +010012502 acl content_present req.len gt 0
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020012503 tcp-request content accept if content_present
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012504 tcp-request content reject
12505
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +010012506 Example:
Jarno Huuskonene5ae7022017-04-03 14:36:21 +030012507 # Track the last IP(stick-table type string) from X-Forwarded-For
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +010012508 tcp-request inspect-delay 10s
Willy Tarreau4d54c7c2014-09-16 15:48:15 +020012509 tcp-request content track-sc0 hdr(x-forwarded-for,-1)
Jarno Huuskonene5ae7022017-04-03 14:36:21 +030012510 # Or track the last IP(stick-table type ip|ipv6) from X-Forwarded-For
12511 tcp-request content track-sc0 req.hdr_ip(x-forwarded-for,-1)
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +010012512
12513 Example:
12514 # track request counts per "base" (concatenation of Host+URL)
12515 tcp-request inspect-delay 10s
Willy Tarreau4d54c7c2014-09-16 15:48:15 +020012516 tcp-request content track-sc0 base table req-rate
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +010012517
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012518 Example: track per-frontend and per-backend counters, block abusers at the
Jarno Huuskonene5ae7022017-04-03 14:36:21 +030012519 frontend when the backend detects abuse(and marks gpc0).
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012520
12521 frontend http
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012522 # Use General Purpose Counter 0 in SC0 as a global abuse counter
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012523 # protecting all our sites
12524 stick-table type ip size 1m expire 5m store gpc0
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020012525 tcp-request connection track-sc0 src
12526 tcp-request connection reject if { sc0_get_gpc0 gt 0 }
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012527 ...
12528 use_backend http_dynamic if { path_end .php }
12529
12530 backend http_dynamic
12531 # if a source makes too fast requests to this dynamic site (tracked
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020012532 # by SC1), block it globally in the frontend.
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012533 stick-table type ip size 1m expire 5m store http_req_rate(10s)
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020012534 acl click_too_fast sc1_http_req_rate gt 10
Jarno Huuskonene5ae7022017-04-03 14:36:21 +030012535 acl mark_as_abuser sc0_inc_gpc0(http) gt 0
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020012536 tcp-request content track-sc1 src
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012537 tcp-request content reject if click_too_fast mark_as_abuser
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020012538
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012539 See section 7 about ACL usage.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020012540
Jarno Huuskonen95b012b2017-04-06 13:59:14 +030012541 See also : "tcp-request connection", "tcp-request session",
12542 "tcp-request inspect-delay", and "http-request".
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020012543
12544
12545tcp-request inspect-delay <timeout>
12546 Set the maximum allowed time to wait for data during content inspection
12547 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaufb356202010-08-03 14:02:05 +020012548 no | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020012549 Arguments :
12550 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
12551 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
12552 as explained at the top of this document.
12553
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040012554 People using HAProxy primarily as a TCP relay are often worried about the
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020012555 risk of passing any type of protocol to a server without any analysis. In
12556 order to be able to analyze the request contents, we must first withhold
12557 the data then analyze them. This statement simply enables withholding of
12558 data for at most the specified amount of time.
12559
Willy Tarreaufb356202010-08-03 14:02:05 +020012560 TCP content inspection applies very early when a connection reaches a
12561 frontend, then very early when the connection is forwarded to a backend. This
12562 means that a connection may experience a first delay in the frontend and a
12563 second delay in the backend if both have tcp-request rules.
12564
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040012565 Note that when performing content inspection, HAProxy will evaluate the whole
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020012566 rules for every new chunk which gets in, taking into account the fact that
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010012567 those data are partial. If no rule matches before the aforementioned delay,
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020012568 a last check is performed upon expiration, this time considering that the
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040012569 contents are definitive. If no delay is set, HAProxy will not wait at all
Willy Tarreaud869b242009-03-15 14:43:58 +010012570 and will immediately apply a verdict based on the available information.
12571 Obviously this is unlikely to be very useful and might even be racy, so such
12572 setups are not recommended.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020012573
Christopher Faulet3e2a39e2023-05-16 08:15:12 +020012574 Note the inspection delay is shortened if an connection error or shutdown is
12575 experienced or if the request buffer appears as full.
12576
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020012577 As soon as a rule matches, the request is released and continues as usual. If
12578 the timeout is reached and no rule matches, the default policy will be to let
12579 it pass through unaffected.
12580
12581 For most protocols, it is enough to set it to a few seconds, as most clients
12582 send the full request immediately upon connection. Add 3 or more seconds to
12583 cover TCP retransmits but that's all. For some protocols, it may make sense
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010012584 to use large values, for instance to ensure that the client never talks
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012585 before the server (e.g. SMTP), or to wait for a client to talk before passing
12586 data to the server (e.g. SSL). Note that the client timeout must cover at
Willy Tarreaub824b002010-09-29 16:36:16 +020012587 least the inspection delay, otherwise it will expire first. If the client
12588 closes the connection or if the buffer is full, the delay immediately expires
12589 since the contents will not be able to change anymore.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020012590
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020012591 See also : "tcp-request content accept", "tcp-request content reject",
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020012592 "timeout client".
12593
12594
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020012595tcp-response content <action> [{if | unless} <condition>]
12596 Perform an action on a session response depending on a layer 4-7 condition
12597 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
12598 no | no | yes | yes
12599 Arguments :
Willy Tarreauc870bfd2015-09-28 18:47:38 +020012600 <action> defines the action to perform if the condition applies. See
12601 below.
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020012602
12603 <condition> is a standard layer 4-7 ACL-based condition (see section 7).
12604
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012605 Response contents can be analyzed at an early stage of response processing
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020012606 called "TCP content inspection". During this stage, ACL-based rules are
12607 evaluated every time the response contents are updated, until either an
Willy Tarreaucc1e04b2013-09-11 23:20:29 +020012608 "accept", "close" or a "reject" rule matches, or a TCP response inspection
12609 delay is set and expires with no matching rule.
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020012610
12611 Most often, these decisions will consider a protocol recognition or validity.
12612
12613 Content-based rules are evaluated in their exact declaration order. If no
12614 rule matches or if there is no rule, the default action is to accept the
12615 contents. There is no specific limit to the number of rules which may be
12616 inserted.
12617
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +020012618 Several types of actions are supported :
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020012619 - accept :
12620 accepts the response if the condition is true (when used with "if")
12621 or false (when used with "unless"). The first such rule executed ends
12622 the rules evaluation.
12623
Willy Tarreaucc1e04b2013-09-11 23:20:29 +020012624 - close :
12625 immediately closes the connection with the server if the condition is
12626 true (when used with "if"), or false (when used with "unless"). The
12627 first such rule executed ends the rules evaluation. The main purpose of
12628 this action is to force a connection to be finished between a client
12629 and a server after an exchange when the application protocol expects
12630 some long time outs to elapse first. The goal is to eliminate idle
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030012631 connections which take significant resources on servers with certain
Willy Tarreaucc1e04b2013-09-11 23:20:29 +020012632 protocols.
12633
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020012634 - reject :
12635 rejects the response if the condition is true (when used with "if")
12636 or false (when used with "unless"). The first such rule executed ends
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040012637 the rules evaluation. Rejected session are immediately closed.
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020012638
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020012639 - set-var(<var-name>) <expr>
Willy Tarreau9de54ba2021-09-02 20:51:21 +020012640 Sets a variable from an expression.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020012641
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +010012642 - unset-var(<var-name>)
12643 Unsets a variable.
12644
Thierry FOURNIERe0627bd2015-08-04 08:20:33 +020012645 - sc-inc-gpc0(<sc-id>):
12646 This action increments the GPC0 counter according to the sticky
12647 counter designated by <sc-id>. If an error occurs, this action fails
12648 silently and the actions evaluation continues.
12649
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010012650 - sc-inc-gpc1(<sc-id>):
12651 This action increments the GPC1 counter according to the sticky
12652 counter designated by <sc-id>. If an error occurs, this action fails
12653 silently and the actions evaluation continues.
12654
Cédric Dufour0d7712d2019-11-06 18:38:53 +010012655 - sc-set-gpt0(<sc-id>) { <int> | <expr> }
12656 This action sets the 32-bit unsigned GPT0 tag according to the sticky
12657 counter designated by <sc-id> and the value of <int>/<expr>. The
12658 expected result is a boolean. If an error occurs, this action silently
12659 fails and the actions evaluation continues.
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +020012660
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +020012661 - "silent-drop" :
12662 This stops the evaluation of the rules and makes the client-facing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012663 connection suddenly disappear using a system-dependent way that tries
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +020012664 to prevent the client from being notified. The effect it then that the
12665 client still sees an established connection while there's none on
12666 HAProxy. The purpose is to achieve a comparable effect to "tarpit"
12667 except that it doesn't use any local resource at all on the machine
12668 running HAProxy. It can resist much higher loads than "tarpit", and
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012669 slow down stronger attackers. It is important to understand the impact
12670 of using this mechanism. All stateful equipment placed between the
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +020012671 client and HAProxy (firewalls, proxies, load balancers) will also keep
12672 the established connection for a long time and may suffer from this
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012673 action. On modern Linux systems running with enough privileges, the
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +020012674 TCP_REPAIR socket option is used to block the emission of a TCP
12675 reset. On other systems, the socket's TTL is reduced to 1 so that the
12676 TCP reset doesn't pass the first router, though it's still delivered to
12677 local networks. Do not use it unless you fully understand how it works.
12678
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +020012679 - send-spoe-group <engine-name> <group-name>
12680 Send a group of SPOE messages.
12681
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020012682 Note that the "if/unless" condition is optional. If no condition is set on
12683 the action, it is simply performed unconditionally. That can be useful for
12684 for changing the default action to a reject.
12685
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040012686 It is perfectly possible to match layer 7 contents with "tcp-response
12687 content" rules, but then it is important to ensure that a full response has
12688 been buffered, otherwise no contents will match. In order to achieve this,
12689 the best solution involves detecting the HTTP protocol during the inspection
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020012690 period.
12691
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020012692 The "set-var" is used to set the content of a variable. The variable is
12693 declared inline.
12694
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010012695 <var-name> The name of the variable starts with an indication about
12696 its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010012697 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010012698 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
12699 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020012700 (request and response)
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010012701 "req" : the variable is shared only during request
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020012702 processing
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010012703 "res" : the variable is shared only during response
12704 processing
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020012705 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'.
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010012706 The name may only contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9',
12707 '.' and '_'.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020012708
12709 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
12710 followed by some converters.
12711
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +010012712 The "unset-var" is used to unset a variable. See above for details about
12713 <var-name>.
12714
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +020012715 The "send-spoe-group" is used to trigger sending of a group of SPOE
12716 messages. To do so, the SPOE engine used to send messages must be defined, as
12717 well as the SPOE group to send. Of course, the SPOE engine must refer to an
12718 existing SPOE filter. If not engine name is provided on the SPOE filter line,
12719 the SPOE agent name must be used.
12720
12721 <engine-name> The SPOE engine name.
12722
12723 <group-name> The SPOE group name as specified in the engine configuration.
12724
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020012725 See section 7 about ACL usage.
12726
12727 See also : "tcp-request content", "tcp-response inspect-delay"
12728
12729
Willy Tarreau4f614292016-10-21 17:49:36 +020012730tcp-request session <action> [{if | unless} <condition>]
12731 Perform an action on a validated session depending on a layer 5 condition
12732 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
12733 no | yes | yes | no
12734 Arguments :
12735 <action> defines the action to perform if the condition applies. See
12736 below.
12737
12738 <condition> is a standard layer5-only ACL-based condition (see section 7).
12739
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012740 Once a session is validated, (i.e. after all handshakes have been completed),
Willy Tarreau4f614292016-10-21 17:49:36 +020012741 it is possible to evaluate some conditions to decide whether this session
12742 must be accepted or dropped or have its counters tracked. Those conditions
12743 cannot make use of any data contents because no buffers are allocated yet and
12744 the processing cannot wait at this stage. The main use case it to copy some
12745 early information into variables (since variables are accessible in the
12746 session), or to keep track of some information collected after the handshake,
12747 such as SSL-level elements (SNI, ciphers, client cert's CN) or information
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012748 from the PROXY protocol header (e.g. track a source forwarded this way). The
Willy Tarreau4f614292016-10-21 17:49:36 +020012749 extracted information can thus be copied to a variable or tracked using
12750 "track-sc" rules. Of course it is also possible to decide to accept/reject as
12751 with other rulesets. Most operations performed here could also be performed
12752 in "tcp-request content" rules, except that in HTTP these rules are evaluated
12753 for each new request, and that might not always be acceptable. For example a
12754 rule might increment a counter on each evaluation. It would also be possible
12755 that a country is resolved by geolocation from the source IP address,
12756 assigned to a session-wide variable, then the source address rewritten from
12757 an HTTP header for all requests. If some contents need to be inspected in
12758 order to take the decision, the "tcp-request content" statements must be used
12759 instead.
12760
12761 The "tcp-request session" rules are evaluated in their exact declaration
12762 order. If no rule matches or if there is no rule, the default action is to
12763 accept the incoming session. There is no specific limit to the number of
12764 rules which may be inserted.
12765
12766 Several types of actions are supported :
12767 - accept : the request is accepted
12768 - reject : the request is rejected and the connection is closed
12769 - { track-sc0 | track-sc1 | track-sc2 } <key> [table <table>]
12770 - sc-inc-gpc0(<sc-id>)
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010012771 - sc-inc-gpc1(<sc-id>)
Cédric Dufour0d7712d2019-11-06 18:38:53 +010012772 - sc-set-gpt0(<sc-id>) { <int> | <expr> }
Christopher Faulet57759f32021-06-23 12:19:25 +020012773 - set-dst <expr>
12774 - set-dst-port <expr>
12775 - set-src <expr>
12776 - set-src-port <expr>
Willy Tarreau4f614292016-10-21 17:49:36 +020012777 - set-var(<var-name>) <expr>
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +010012778 - unset-var(<var-name>)
Willy Tarreau4f614292016-10-21 17:49:36 +020012779 - silent-drop
12780
12781 These actions have the same meaning as their respective counter-parts in
12782 "tcp-request connection" and "tcp-request content", so please refer to these
12783 sections for a complete description.
12784
12785 Note that the "if/unless" condition is optional. If no condition is set on
12786 the action, it is simply performed unconditionally. That can be useful for
12787 "track-sc*" actions as well as for changing the default action to a reject.
12788
12789 Example: track the original source address by default, or the one advertised
12790 in the PROXY protocol header for connection coming from the local
12791 proxies. The first connection-level rule enables receipt of the
12792 PROXY protocol for these ones, the second rule tracks whatever
12793 address we decide to keep after optional decoding.
12794
12795 tcp-request connection expect-proxy layer4 if { src -f proxies.lst }
12796 tcp-request session track-sc0 src
12797
12798 Example: accept all sessions from white-listed hosts, reject too fast
12799 sessions without counting them, and track accepted sessions.
12800 This results in session rate being capped from abusive sources.
12801
12802 tcp-request session accept if { src -f /etc/haproxy/whitelist.lst }
12803 tcp-request session reject if { src_sess_rate gt 10 }
12804 tcp-request session track-sc0 src
12805
12806 Example: accept all sessions from white-listed hosts, count all other
12807 sessions and reject too fast ones. This results in abusive ones
12808 being blocked as long as they don't slow down.
12809
12810 tcp-request session accept if { src -f /etc/haproxy/whitelist.lst }
12811 tcp-request session track-sc0 src
12812 tcp-request session reject if { sc0_sess_rate gt 10 }
12813
12814 See section 7 about ACL usage.
12815
12816 See also : "tcp-request connection", "tcp-request content", "stick-table"
12817
12818
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020012819tcp-response inspect-delay <timeout>
12820 Set the maximum allowed time to wait for a response during content inspection
12821 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
12822 no | no | yes | yes
12823 Arguments :
12824 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
12825 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
12826 as explained at the top of this document.
12827
12828 See also : "tcp-response content", "tcp-request inspect-delay".
12829
12830
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +010012831timeout check <timeout>
12832 Set additional check timeout, but only after a connection has been already
12833 established.
12834
12835 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
12836 yes | no | yes | yes
12837 Arguments:
12838 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
12839 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
12840 as explained at the top of this document.
12841
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040012842 If set, HAProxy uses min("timeout connect", "inter") as a connect timeout
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +010012843 for check and "timeout check" as an additional read timeout. The "min" is
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012844 used so that people running with *very* long "timeout connect" (e.g. those
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +010012845 who needed this due to the queue or tarpit) do not slow down their checks.
Willy Tarreaud7550a22010-02-10 05:10:19 +010012846 (Please also note that there is no valid reason to have such long connect
12847 timeouts, because "timeout queue" and "timeout tarpit" can always be used to
12848 avoid that).
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +010012849
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040012850 If "timeout check" is not set HAProxy uses "inter" for complete check
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +010012851 timeout (connect + read) exactly like all <1.3.15 version.
12852
12853 In most cases check request is much simpler and faster to handle than normal
12854 requests and people may want to kick out laggy servers so this timeout should
Willy Tarreau41a340d2008-01-22 12:25:31 +010012855 be smaller than "timeout server".
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +010012856
12857 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
12858 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
12859 forget about it.
12860
Willy Tarreau41a340d2008-01-22 12:25:31 +010012861 See also: "timeout connect", "timeout queue", "timeout server",
12862 "timeout tarpit".
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +010012863
12864
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010012865timeout client <timeout>
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010012866 Set the maximum inactivity time on the client side.
12867 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
12868 yes | yes | yes | no
12869 Arguments :
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010012870 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010012871 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
12872 as explained at the top of this document.
12873
12874 The inactivity timeout applies when the client is expected to acknowledge or
12875 send data. In HTTP mode, this timeout is particularly important to consider
12876 during the first phase, when the client sends the request, and during the
Baptiste Assmann2e1941e2016-03-06 23:24:12 +010012877 response while it is reading data sent by the server. That said, for the
12878 first phase, it is preferable to set the "timeout http-request" to better
12879 protect HAProxy from Slowloris like attacks. The value is specified in
12880 milliseconds by default, but can be in any other unit if the number is
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010012881 suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this document. In TCP mode
12882 (and to a lesser extent, in HTTP mode), it is highly recommended that the
12883 client timeout remains equal to the server timeout in order to avoid complex
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +010012884 situations to debug. It is a good practice to cover one or several TCP packet
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010012885 losses by specifying timeouts that are slightly above multiples of 3 seconds
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012886 (e.g. 4 or 5 seconds). If some long-lived sessions are mixed with short-lived
12887 sessions (e.g. WebSocket and HTTP), it's worth considering "timeout tunnel",
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +020012888 which overrides "timeout client" and "timeout server" for tunnels, as well as
12889 "timeout client-fin" for half-closed connections.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010012890
12891 This parameter is specific to frontends, but can be specified once for all in
12892 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
12893 forget about it. An unspecified timeout results in an infinite timeout, which
12894 is not recommended. Such a usage is accepted and works but reports a warning
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050012895 during startup because it may result in accumulation of expired sessions in
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010012896 the system if the system's timeouts are not configured either.
12897
Tim Duesterhus86e6b6e2019-05-14 20:57:59 +020012898 See also : "timeout server", "timeout tunnel", "timeout http-request".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010012899
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010012900
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +020012901timeout client-fin <timeout>
12902 Set the inactivity timeout on the client side for half-closed connections.
12903 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
12904 yes | yes | yes | no
12905 Arguments :
12906 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
12907 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
12908 as explained at the top of this document.
12909
12910 The inactivity timeout applies when the client is expected to acknowledge or
12911 send data while one direction is already shut down. This timeout is different
12912 from "timeout client" in that it only applies to connections which are closed
12913 in one direction. This is particularly useful to avoid keeping connections in
12914 FIN_WAIT state for too long when clients do not disconnect cleanly. This
12915 problem is particularly common long connections such as RDP or WebSocket.
12916 Note that this timeout can override "timeout tunnel" when a connection shuts
Willy Tarreau599391a2017-11-24 10:16:00 +010012917 down in one direction. It is applied to idle HTTP/2 connections once a GOAWAY
12918 frame was sent, often indicating an expectation that the connection quickly
12919 ends.
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +020012920
12921 This parameter is specific to frontends, but can be specified once for all in
12922 "defaults" sections. By default it is not set, so half-closed connections
12923 will use the other timeouts (timeout.client or timeout.tunnel).
12924
12925 See also : "timeout client", "timeout server-fin", and "timeout tunnel".
12926
12927
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010012928timeout connect <timeout>
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010012929 Set the maximum time to wait for a connection attempt to a server to succeed.
12930 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
12931 yes | no | yes | yes
12932 Arguments :
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010012933 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010012934 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
12935 as explained at the top of this document.
12936
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040012937 If the server is located on the same LAN as HAProxy, the connection should be
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +010012938 immediate (less than a few milliseconds). Anyway, it is a good practice to
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010012939 cover one or several TCP packet losses by specifying timeouts that are
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012940 slightly above multiples of 3 seconds (e.g. 4 or 5 seconds). By default, the
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +010012941 connect timeout also presets both queue and tarpit timeouts to the same value
12942 if these have not been specified.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010012943
12944 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
12945 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
12946 forget about it. An unspecified timeout results in an infinite timeout, which
12947 is not recommended. Such a usage is accepted and works but reports a warning
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050012948 during startup because it may result in accumulation of failed sessions in
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010012949 the system if the system's timeouts are not configured either.
12950
Tim Duesterhus86e6b6e2019-05-14 20:57:59 +020012951 See also: "timeout check", "timeout queue", "timeout server", "timeout tarpit".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010012952
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010012953
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +010012954timeout http-keep-alive <timeout>
12955 Set the maximum allowed time to wait for a new HTTP request to appear
12956 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
12957 yes | yes | yes | yes
12958 Arguments :
12959 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
12960 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
12961 as explained at the top of this document.
12962
12963 By default, the time to wait for a new request in case of keep-alive is set
12964 by "timeout http-request". However this is not always convenient because some
12965 people want very short keep-alive timeouts in order to release connections
12966 faster, and others prefer to have larger ones but still have short timeouts
12967 once the request has started to present itself.
12968
12969 The "http-keep-alive" timeout covers these needs. It will define how long to
12970 wait for a new HTTP request to start coming after a response was sent. Once
12971 the first byte of request has been seen, the "http-request" timeout is used
12972 to wait for the complete request to come. Note that empty lines prior to a
12973 new request do not refresh the timeout and are not counted as a new request.
12974
12975 There is also another difference between the two timeouts : when a connection
12976 expires during timeout http-keep-alive, no error is returned, the connection
12977 just closes. If the connection expires in "http-request" while waiting for a
12978 connection to complete, a HTTP 408 error is returned.
12979
12980 In general it is optimal to set this value to a few tens to hundreds of
12981 milliseconds, to allow users to fetch all objects of a page at once but
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012982 without waiting for further clicks. Also, if set to a very small value (e.g.
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +010012983 1 millisecond) it will probably only accept pipelined requests but not the
12984 non-pipelined ones. It may be a nice trade-off for very large sites running
Patrick Mézard2382ad62010-05-09 10:43:32 +020012985 with tens to hundreds of thousands of clients.
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +010012986
12987 If this parameter is not set, the "http-request" timeout applies, and if both
12988 are not set, "timeout client" still applies at the lower level. It should be
12989 set in the frontend to take effect, unless the frontend is in TCP mode, in
12990 which case the HTTP backend's timeout will be used.
12991
12992 See also : "timeout http-request", "timeout client".
12993
12994
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +010012995timeout http-request <timeout>
12996 Set the maximum allowed time to wait for a complete HTTP request
12997 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaucd7afc02009-07-12 10:03:17 +020012998 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +010012999 Arguments :
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010013000 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +010013001 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
13002 as explained at the top of this document.
13003
13004 In order to offer DoS protection, it may be required to lower the maximum
13005 accepted time to receive a complete HTTP request without affecting the client
13006 timeout. This helps protecting against established connections on which
13007 nothing is sent. The client timeout cannot offer a good protection against
13008 this abuse because it is an inactivity timeout, which means that if the
13009 attacker sends one character every now and then, the timeout will not
13010 trigger. With the HTTP request timeout, no matter what speed the client
Willy Tarreau2705a612014-05-23 17:38:34 +020013011 types, the request will be aborted if it does not complete in time. When the
13012 timeout expires, an HTTP 408 response is sent to the client to inform it
13013 about the problem, and the connection is closed. The logs will report
13014 termination codes "cR". Some recent browsers are having problems with this
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013015 standard, well-documented behavior, so it might be needed to hide the 408
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +020013016 code using "option http-ignore-probes" or "errorfile 408 /dev/null". See
13017 more details in the explanations of the "cR" termination code in section 8.5.
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +010013018
Baptiste Assmanneccdf432015-10-28 13:49:01 +010013019 By default, this timeout only applies to the header part of the request,
13020 and not to any data. As soon as the empty line is received, this timeout is
13021 not used anymore. When combined with "option http-buffer-request", this
13022 timeout also applies to the body of the request..
13023 It is used again on keep-alive connections to wait for a second
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +010013024 request if "timeout http-keep-alive" is not set.
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +010013025
13026 Generally it is enough to set it to a few seconds, as most clients send the
13027 full request immediately upon connection. Add 3 or more seconds to cover TCP
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013028 retransmits but that's all. Setting it to very low values (e.g. 50 ms) will
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +010013029 generally work on local networks as long as there are no packet losses. This
13030 will prevent people from sending bare HTTP requests using telnet.
13031
13032 If this parameter is not set, the client timeout still applies between each
Willy Tarreaucd7afc02009-07-12 10:03:17 +020013033 chunk of the incoming request. It should be set in the frontend to take
13034 effect, unless the frontend is in TCP mode, in which case the HTTP backend's
13035 timeout will be used.
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +010013036
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +020013037 See also : "errorfile", "http-ignore-probes", "timeout http-keep-alive", and
Baptiste Assmanneccdf432015-10-28 13:49:01 +010013038 "timeout client", "option http-buffer-request".
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +010013039
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010013040
13041timeout queue <timeout>
13042 Set the maximum time to wait in the queue for a connection slot to be free
13043 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
13044 yes | no | yes | yes
13045 Arguments :
13046 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
13047 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
13048 as explained at the top of this document.
13049
13050 When a server's maxconn is reached, connections are left pending in a queue
13051 which may be server-specific or global to the backend. In order not to wait
13052 indefinitely, a timeout is applied to requests pending in the queue. If the
13053 timeout is reached, it is considered that the request will almost never be
13054 served, so it is dropped and a 503 error is returned to the client.
13055
13056 The "timeout queue" statement allows to fix the maximum time for a request to
13057 be left pending in a queue. If unspecified, the same value as the backend's
13058 connection timeout ("timeout connect") is used, for backwards compatibility
13059 with older versions with no "timeout queue" parameter.
13060
Tim Duesterhus86e6b6e2019-05-14 20:57:59 +020013061 See also : "timeout connect".
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010013062
13063
13064timeout server <timeout>
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010013065 Set the maximum inactivity time on the server side.
13066 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
13067 yes | no | yes | yes
13068 Arguments :
13069 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
13070 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
13071 as explained at the top of this document.
13072
13073 The inactivity timeout applies when the server is expected to acknowledge or
13074 send data. In HTTP mode, this timeout is particularly important to consider
13075 during the first phase of the server's response, when it has to send the
13076 headers, as it directly represents the server's processing time for the
13077 request. To find out what value to put there, it's often good to start with
13078 what would be considered as unacceptable response times, then check the logs
13079 to observe the response time distribution, and adjust the value accordingly.
13080
13081 The value is specified in milliseconds by default, but can be in any other
13082 unit if the number is suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this
13083 document. In TCP mode (and to a lesser extent, in HTTP mode), it is highly
13084 recommended that the client timeout remains equal to the server timeout in
13085 order to avoid complex situations to debug. Whatever the expected server
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +010013086 response times, it is a good practice to cover at least one or several TCP
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010013087 packet losses by specifying timeouts that are slightly above multiples of 3
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013088 seconds (e.g. 4 or 5 seconds minimum). If some long-lived sessions are mixed
13089 with short-lived sessions (e.g. WebSocket and HTTP), it's worth considering
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +020013090 "timeout tunnel", which overrides "timeout client" and "timeout server" for
13091 tunnels.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010013092
13093 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
13094 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
13095 forget about it. An unspecified timeout results in an infinite timeout, which
13096 is not recommended. Such a usage is accepted and works but reports a warning
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050013097 during startup because it may result in accumulation of expired sessions in
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010013098 the system if the system's timeouts are not configured either.
13099
Tim Duesterhus86e6b6e2019-05-14 20:57:59 +020013100 See also : "timeout client" and "timeout tunnel".
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010013101
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +020013102
13103timeout server-fin <timeout>
13104 Set the inactivity timeout on the server side for half-closed connections.
13105 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
13106 yes | no | yes | yes
13107 Arguments :
13108 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
13109 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
13110 as explained at the top of this document.
13111
13112 The inactivity timeout applies when the server is expected to acknowledge or
13113 send data while one direction is already shut down. This timeout is different
13114 from "timeout server" in that it only applies to connections which are closed
13115 in one direction. This is particularly useful to avoid keeping connections in
13116 FIN_WAIT state for too long when a remote server does not disconnect cleanly.
13117 This problem is particularly common long connections such as RDP or WebSocket.
13118 Note that this timeout can override "timeout tunnel" when a connection shuts
13119 down in one direction. This setting was provided for completeness, but in most
13120 situations, it should not be needed.
13121
13122 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
13123 "defaults" sections. By default it is not set, so half-closed connections
13124 will use the other timeouts (timeout.server or timeout.tunnel).
13125
13126 See also : "timeout client-fin", "timeout server", and "timeout tunnel".
13127
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010013128
13129timeout tarpit <timeout>
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +010013130 Set the duration for which tarpitted connections will be maintained
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010013131 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
13132 yes | yes | yes | yes
13133 Arguments :
13134 <timeout> is the tarpit duration specified in milliseconds by default, but
13135 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
13136 as explained at the top of this document.
13137
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +020013138 When a connection is tarpitted using "http-request tarpit", it is maintained
13139 open with no activity for a certain amount of time, then closed. "timeout
13140 tarpit" defines how long it will be maintained open.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010013141
13142 The value is specified in milliseconds by default, but can be in any other
13143 unit if the number is suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this
13144 document. If unspecified, the same value as the backend's connection timeout
13145 ("timeout connect") is used, for backwards compatibility with older versions
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +010013146 with no "timeout tarpit" parameter.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010013147
Tim Duesterhus86e6b6e2019-05-14 20:57:59 +020013148 See also : "timeout connect".
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010013149
13150
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +020013151timeout tunnel <timeout>
13152 Set the maximum inactivity time on the client and server side for tunnels.
13153 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
13154 yes | no | yes | yes
13155 Arguments :
13156 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
13157 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
13158 as explained at the top of this document.
13159
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040013160 The tunnel timeout applies when a bidirectional connection is established
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +020013161 between a client and a server, and the connection remains inactive in both
13162 directions. This timeout supersedes both the client and server timeouts once
13163 the connection becomes a tunnel. In TCP, this timeout is used as soon as no
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013164 analyzer remains attached to either connection (e.g. tcp content rules are
13165 accepted). In HTTP, this timeout is used when a connection is upgraded (e.g.
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +020013166 when switching to the WebSocket protocol, or forwarding a CONNECT request
13167 to a proxy), or after the first response when no keepalive/close option is
13168 specified.
13169
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +020013170 Since this timeout is usually used in conjunction with long-lived connections,
13171 it usually is a good idea to also set "timeout client-fin" to handle the
13172 situation where a client suddenly disappears from the net and does not
13173 acknowledge a close, or sends a shutdown and does not acknowledge pending
13174 data anymore. This can happen in lossy networks where firewalls are present,
13175 and is detected by the presence of large amounts of sessions in a FIN_WAIT
13176 state.
13177
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +020013178 The value is specified in milliseconds by default, but can be in any other
13179 unit if the number is suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this
13180 document. Whatever the expected normal idle time, it is a good practice to
13181 cover at least one or several TCP packet losses by specifying timeouts that
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013182 are slightly above multiples of 3 seconds (e.g. 4 or 5 seconds minimum).
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +020013183
13184 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
13185 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
13186 forget about it.
13187
13188 Example :
13189 defaults http
13190 option http-server-close
13191 timeout connect 5s
13192 timeout client 30s
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +020013193 timeout client-fin 30s
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +020013194 timeout server 30s
13195 timeout tunnel 1h # timeout to use with WebSocket and CONNECT
13196
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +020013197 See also : "timeout client", "timeout client-fin", "timeout server".
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +020013198
13199
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010013200transparent (deprecated)
13201 Enable client-side transparent proxying
13202 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreau4b1f8592008-12-23 23:13:55 +010013203 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010013204 Arguments : none
13205
13206 This keyword was introduced in order to provide layer 7 persistence to layer
13207 3 load balancers. The idea is to use the OS's ability to redirect an incoming
13208 connection for a remote address to a local process (here HAProxy), and let
13209 this process know what address was initially requested. When this option is
13210 used, sessions without cookies will be forwarded to the original destination
13211 IP address of the incoming request (which should match that of another
13212 equipment), while requests with cookies will still be forwarded to the
13213 appropriate server.
13214
13215 The "transparent" keyword is deprecated, use "option transparent" instead.
13216
13217 Note that contrary to a common belief, this option does NOT make HAProxy
13218 present the client's IP to the server when establishing the connection.
13219
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010013220 See also: "option transparent"
13221
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010013222unique-id-format <string>
13223 Generate a unique ID for each request.
13224 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
13225 yes | yes | yes | no
13226 Arguments :
13227 <string> is a log-format string.
13228
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +020013229 This keyword creates a ID for each request using the custom log format. A
13230 unique ID is useful to trace a request passing through many components of
13231 a complex infrastructure. The newly created ID may also be logged using the
13232 %ID tag the log-format string.
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010013233
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +020013234 The format should be composed from elements that are guaranteed to be
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040013235 unique when combined together. For instance, if multiple HAProxy instances
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +020013236 are involved, it might be important to include the node name. It is often
13237 needed to log the incoming connection's source and destination addresses
13238 and ports. Note that since multiple requests may be performed over the same
13239 connection, including a request counter may help differentiate them.
13240 Similarly, a timestamp may protect against a rollover of the counter.
13241 Logging the process ID will avoid collisions after a service restart.
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010013242
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +020013243 It is recommended to use hexadecimal notation for many fields since it
13244 makes them more compact and saves space in logs.
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010013245
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +020013246 Example:
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010013247
Julien Vehentf21be322014-03-07 08:27:34 -050013248 unique-id-format %{+X}o\ %ci:%cp_%fi:%fp_%Ts_%rt:%pid
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010013249
13250 will generate:
13251
13252 7F000001:8296_7F00001E:1F90_4F7B0A69_0003:790A
13253
13254 See also: "unique-id-header"
13255
13256unique-id-header <name>
13257 Add a unique ID header in the HTTP request.
13258 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
13259 yes | yes | yes | no
13260 Arguments :
13261 <name> is the name of the header.
13262
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +020013263 Add a unique-id header in the HTTP request sent to the server, using the
13264 unique-id-format. It can't work if the unique-id-format doesn't exist.
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010013265
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +020013266 Example:
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010013267
Julien Vehentf21be322014-03-07 08:27:34 -050013268 unique-id-format %{+X}o\ %ci:%cp_%fi:%fp_%Ts_%rt:%pid
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010013269 unique-id-header X-Unique-ID
13270
13271 will generate:
13272
13273 X-Unique-ID: 7F000001:8296_7F00001E:1F90_4F7B0A69_0003:790A
13274
13275 See also: "unique-id-format"
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010013276
Willy Tarreauf51658d2014-04-23 01:21:56 +020013277use_backend <backend> [{if | unless} <condition>]
Willy Tarreau1d0dfb12009-07-07 15:10:31 +020013278 Switch to a specific backend if/unless an ACL-based condition is matched.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010013279 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
13280 no | yes | yes | no
13281 Arguments :
Bertrand Jacquin702d44f2013-11-19 11:43:06 +010013282 <backend> is the name of a valid backend or "listen" section, or a
13283 "log-format" string resolving to a backend name.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010013284
Willy Tarreauf51658d2014-04-23 01:21:56 +020013285 <condition> is a condition composed of ACLs, as described in section 7. If
13286 it is omitted, the rule is unconditionally applied.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010013287
13288 When doing content-switching, connections arrive on a frontend and are then
13289 dispatched to various backends depending on a number of conditions. The
13290 relation between the conditions and the backends is described with the
Willy Tarreau1d0dfb12009-07-07 15:10:31 +020013291 "use_backend" keyword. While it is normally used with HTTP processing, it can
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013292 also be used in pure TCP, either without content using stateless ACLs (e.g.
Willy Tarreau1d0dfb12009-07-07 15:10:31 +020013293 source address validation) or combined with a "tcp-request" rule to wait for
13294 some payload.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010013295
13296 There may be as many "use_backend" rules as desired. All of these rules are
13297 evaluated in their declaration order, and the first one which matches will
13298 assign the backend.
13299
13300 In the first form, the backend will be used if the condition is met. In the
13301 second form, the backend will be used if the condition is not met. If no
13302 condition is valid, the backend defined with "default_backend" will be used.
13303 If no default backend is defined, either the servers in the same section are
13304 used (in case of a "listen" section) or, in case of a frontend, no server is
13305 used and a 503 service unavailable response is returned.
13306
Willy Tarreau51aecc72009-07-12 09:47:04 +020013307 Note that it is possible to switch from a TCP frontend to an HTTP backend. In
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010013308 this case, either the frontend has already checked that the protocol is HTTP,
Willy Tarreau51aecc72009-07-12 09:47:04 +020013309 and backend processing will immediately follow, or the backend will wait for
13310 a complete HTTP request to get in. This feature is useful when a frontend
13311 must decode several protocols on a unique port, one of them being HTTP.
13312
Bertrand Jacquin702d44f2013-11-19 11:43:06 +010013313 When <backend> is a simple name, it is resolved at configuration time, and an
13314 error is reported if the specified backend does not exist. If <backend> is
13315 a log-format string instead, no check may be done at configuration time, so
13316 the backend name is resolved dynamically at run time. If the resulting
13317 backend name does not correspond to any valid backend, no other rule is
13318 evaluated, and the default_backend directive is applied instead. Note that
13319 when using dynamic backend names, it is highly recommended to use a prefix
13320 that no other backend uses in order to ensure that an unauthorized backend
13321 cannot be forced from the request.
13322
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030013323 It is worth mentioning that "use_backend" rules with an explicit name are
Bertrand Jacquin702d44f2013-11-19 11:43:06 +010013324 used to detect the association between frontends and backends to compute the
13325 backend's "fullconn" setting. This cannot be done for dynamic names.
13326
13327 See also: "default_backend", "tcp-request", "fullconn", "log-format", and
13328 section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010013329
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +020013330use-fcgi-app <name>
13331 Defines the FastCGI application to use for the backend.
13332 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
13333 no | no | yes | yes
13334 Arguments :
13335 <name> is the name of the FastCGI application to use.
13336
13337 See section 10.1 about FastCGI application setup for details.
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +010013338
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +020013339use-server <server> if <condition>
13340use-server <server> unless <condition>
13341 Only use a specific server if/unless an ACL-based condition is matched.
13342 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
13343 no | no | yes | yes
13344 Arguments :
Jerome Magnin824186b2020-03-29 09:37:12 +020013345 <server> is the name of a valid server in the same backend section
13346 or a "log-format" string resolving to a server name.
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +020013347
13348 <condition> is a condition composed of ACLs, as described in section 7.
13349
13350 By default, connections which arrive to a backend are load-balanced across
13351 the available servers according to the configured algorithm, unless a
13352 persistence mechanism such as a cookie is used and found in the request.
13353
13354 Sometimes it is desirable to forward a particular request to a specific
13355 server without having to declare a dedicated backend for this server. This
13356 can be achieved using the "use-server" rules. These rules are evaluated after
13357 the "redirect" rules and before evaluating cookies, and they have precedence
13358 on them. There may be as many "use-server" rules as desired. All of these
13359 rules are evaluated in their declaration order, and the first one which
13360 matches will assign the server.
13361
13362 If a rule designates a server which is down, and "option persist" is not used
13363 and no force-persist rule was validated, it is ignored and evaluation goes on
13364 with the next rules until one matches.
13365
13366 In the first form, the server will be used if the condition is met. In the
13367 second form, the server will be used if the condition is not met. If no
13368 condition is valid, the processing continues and the server will be assigned
13369 according to other persistence mechanisms.
13370
13371 Note that even if a rule is matched, cookie processing is still performed but
13372 does not assign the server. This allows prefixed cookies to have their prefix
13373 stripped.
13374
13375 The "use-server" statement works both in HTTP and TCP mode. This makes it
13376 suitable for use with content-based inspection. For instance, a server could
Lukas Tribusa267b5d2020-07-19 00:25:06 +020013377 be selected in a farm according to the TLS SNI field when using protocols with
Alex18c88772021-06-05 13:23:08 +020013378 implicit TLS (also see "req.ssl_sni"). And if these servers have their weight
Lukas Tribusa267b5d2020-07-19 00:25:06 +020013379 set to zero, they will not be used for other traffic.
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +020013380
13381 Example :
13382 # intercept incoming TLS requests based on the SNI field
Alex18c88772021-06-05 13:23:08 +020013383 use-server www if { req.ssl_sni -i www.example.com }
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +020013384 server www 192.168.0.1:443 weight 0
Alex18c88772021-06-05 13:23:08 +020013385 use-server mail if { req.ssl_sni -i mail.example.com }
Lukas Tribusa267b5d2020-07-19 00:25:06 +020013386 server mail 192.168.0.1:465 weight 0
Alex18c88772021-06-05 13:23:08 +020013387 use-server imap if { req.ssl_sni -i imap.example.com }
Lukas Tribus98a3e3f2017-03-26 12:55:35 +000013388 server imap 192.168.0.1:993 weight 0
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +020013389 # all the rest is forwarded to this server
13390 server default 192.168.0.2:443 check
13391
Jerome Magnin824186b2020-03-29 09:37:12 +020013392 When <server> is a simple name, it is checked against existing servers in the
13393 configuration and an error is reported if the specified server does not exist.
13394 If it is a log-format, no check is performed when parsing the configuration,
13395 and if we can't resolve a valid server name at runtime but the use-server rule
Ilya Shipitsin11057a32020-06-21 21:18:27 +050013396 was conditioned by an ACL returning true, no other use-server rule is applied
Jerome Magnin824186b2020-03-29 09:37:12 +020013397 and we fall back to load balancing.
13398
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030013399 See also: "use_backend", section 5 about server and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +020013400
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020013401
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100134025. Bind and server options
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020013403--------------------------
13404
13405The "bind", "server" and "default-server" keywords support a number of settings
13406depending on some build options and on the system HAProxy was built on. These
13407settings generally each consist in one word sometimes followed by a value,
13408written on the same line as the "bind" or "server" line. All these options are
13409described in this section.
13410
13411
134125.1. Bind options
13413-----------------
13414
13415The "bind" keyword supports a certain number of settings which are all passed
13416as arguments on the same line. The order in which those arguments appear makes
13417no importance, provided that they appear after the bind address. All of these
13418parameters are optional. Some of them consist in a single words (booleans),
13419while other ones expect a value after them. In this case, the value must be
13420provided immediately after the setting name.
13421
13422The currently supported settings are the following ones.
13423
Bertrand Jacquin93b227d2016-06-04 15:11:10 +010013424accept-netscaler-cip <magic number>
13425 Enforces the use of the NetScaler Client IP insertion protocol over any
13426 connection accepted by any of the TCP sockets declared on the same line. The
13427 NetScaler Client IP insertion protocol dictates the layer 3/4 addresses of
13428 the incoming connection to be used everywhere an address is used, with the
13429 only exception of "tcp-request connection" rules which will only see the
13430 real connection address. Logs will reflect the addresses indicated in the
13431 protocol, unless it is violated, in which case the real address will still
13432 be used. This keyword combined with support from external components can be
13433 used as an efficient and reliable alternative to the X-Forwarded-For
Bertrand Jacquin90759682016-06-06 15:35:39 +010013434 mechanism which is not always reliable and not even always usable. See also
13435 "tcp-request connection expect-netscaler-cip" for a finer-grained setting of
13436 which client is allowed to use the protocol.
Bertrand Jacquin93b227d2016-06-04 15:11:10 +010013437
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020013438accept-proxy
13439 Enforces the use of the PROXY protocol over any connection accepted by any of
Willy Tarreau77992672014-06-14 11:06:17 +020013440 the sockets declared on the same line. Versions 1 and 2 of the PROXY protocol
13441 are supported and correctly detected. The PROXY protocol dictates the layer
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020013442 3/4 addresses of the incoming connection to be used everywhere an address is
13443 used, with the only exception of "tcp-request connection" rules which will
13444 only see the real connection address. Logs will reflect the addresses
13445 indicated in the protocol, unless it is violated, in which case the real
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013446 address will still be used. This keyword combined with support from external
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020013447 components can be used as an efficient and reliable alternative to the
13448 X-Forwarded-For mechanism which is not always reliable and not even always
Willy Tarreau4f0d9192013-06-11 20:40:55 +020013449 usable. See also "tcp-request connection expect-proxy" for a finer-grained
13450 setting of which client is allowed to use the protocol.
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020013451
Olivier Houchardc2aae742017-09-22 18:26:28 +020013452allow-0rtt
Bertrand Jacquina25282b2018-08-14 00:56:13 +010013453 Allow receiving early data when using TLSv1.3. This is disabled by default,
Olivier Houchard69752962019-01-08 15:35:32 +010013454 due to security considerations. Because it is vulnerable to replay attacks,
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050013455 you should only allow if for requests that are safe to replay, i.e. requests
Olivier Houchard69752962019-01-08 15:35:32 +010013456 that are idempotent. You can use the "wait-for-handshake" action for any
13457 request that wouldn't be safe with early data.
Olivier Houchardc2aae742017-09-22 18:26:28 +020013458
Willy Tarreauab861d32013-04-02 02:30:41 +020013459alpn <protocols>
13460 This enables the TLS ALPN extension and advertises the specified protocol
13461 list as supported on top of ALPN. The protocol list consists in a comma-
13462 delimited list of protocol names, for instance: "http/1.1,http/1.0" (without
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050013463 quotes). This requires that the SSL library is built with support for TLS
Willy Tarreauab861d32013-04-02 02:30:41 +020013464 extensions enabled (check with haproxy -vv). The ALPN extension replaces the
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +010013465 initial NPN extension. ALPN is required to enable HTTP/2 on an HTTP frontend.
13466 Versions of OpenSSL prior to 1.0.2 didn't support ALPN and only supposed the
13467 now obsolete NPN extension. At the time of writing this, most browsers still
13468 support both ALPN and NPN for HTTP/2 so a fallback to NPN may still work for
13469 a while. But ALPN must be used whenever possible. If both HTTP/2 and HTTP/1.1
13470 are expected to be supported, both versions can be advertised, in order of
13471 preference, like below :
13472
13473 bind :443 ssl crt pub.pem alpn h2,http/1.1
Willy Tarreauab861d32013-04-02 02:30:41 +020013474
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020013475backlog <backlog>
Willy Tarreaue2711c72019-02-27 15:39:41 +010013476 Sets the socket's backlog to this value. If unspecified or 0, the frontend's
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020013477 backlog is used instead, which generally defaults to the maxconn value.
13478
Emmanuel Hocdete7f2b732017-01-09 16:15:54 +010013479curves <curves>
13480 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
13481 the string describing the list of elliptic curves algorithms ("curve suite")
13482 that are negotiated during the SSL/TLS handshake with ECDHE. The format of the
13483 string is a colon-delimited list of curve name.
13484 Example: "X25519:P-256" (without quote)
13485 When "curves" is set, "ecdhe" parameter is ignored.
13486
Emeric Brun7fb34422012-09-28 15:26:15 +020013487ecdhe <named curve>
13488 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
Emeric Brun6924ef82013-03-06 14:08:53 +010013489 the named curve (RFC 4492) used to generate ECDH ephemeral keys. By default,
13490 used named curve is prime256v1.
Emeric Brun7fb34422012-09-28 15:26:15 +020013491
Emeric Brunfd33a262012-10-11 16:28:27 +020013492ca-file <cafile>
Emeric Brun1a073b42012-09-28 17:07:34 +020013493 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
13494 designates a PEM file from which to load CA certificates used to verify
13495 client's certificate.
13496
Emeric Brunb6dc9342012-09-28 17:55:37 +020013497ca-ignore-err [all|<errorID>,...]
13498 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in.
13499 Sets a comma separated list of errorIDs to ignore during verify at depth > 0.
13500 If set to 'all', all errors are ignored. SSL handshake is not aborted if an
13501 error is ignored.
13502
Christopher Faulet31af49d2015-06-09 17:29:50 +020013503ca-sign-file <cafile>
13504 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
13505 designates a PEM file containing both the CA certificate and the CA private
13506 key used to create and sign server's certificates. This is a mandatory
13507 setting when the dynamic generation of certificates is enabled. See
13508 'generate-certificates' for details.
13509
Bertrand Jacquind4d0a232016-11-13 16:37:12 +000013510ca-sign-pass <passphrase>
Christopher Faulet31af49d2015-06-09 17:29:50 +020013511 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It is
13512 the CA private key passphrase. This setting is optional and used only when
13513 the dynamic generation of certificates is enabled. See
13514 'generate-certificates' for details.
13515
Emmanuel Hocdet842e94e2019-12-16 16:39:17 +010013516ca-verify-file <cafile>
13517 This setting designates a PEM file from which to load CA certificates used to
13518 verify client's certificate. It designates CA certificates which must not be
13519 included in CA names sent in server hello message. Typically, "ca-file" must
13520 be defined with intermediate certificates, and "ca-verify-file" with
13521 certificates to ending the chain, like root CA.
13522
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020013523ciphers <ciphers>
13524 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
13525 the string describing the list of cipher algorithms ("cipher suite") that are
Bertrand Jacquin8cf7c1e2019-02-03 18:35:25 +000013526 negotiated during the SSL/TLS handshake up to TLSv1.2. The format of the
Bertrand Jacquin4f03ab02019-02-03 18:48:49 +000013527 string is defined in "man 1 ciphers" from OpenSSL man pages. For background
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +020013528 information and recommendations see e.g.
13529 (https://wiki.mozilla.org/Security/Server_Side_TLS) and
13530 (https://mozilla.github.io/server-side-tls/ssl-config-generator/). For TLSv1.3
13531 cipher configuration, please check the "ciphersuites" keyword.
13532
13533ciphersuites <ciphersuites>
13534 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in and
13535 OpenSSL 1.1.1 or later was used to build HAProxy. It sets the string describing
13536 the list of cipher algorithms ("cipher suite") that are negotiated during the
13537 TLSv1.3 handshake. The format of the string is defined in "man 1 ciphers" from
Bertrand Jacquin4f03ab02019-02-03 18:48:49 +000013538 OpenSSL man pages under the "ciphersuites" section. For cipher configuration
13539 for TLSv1.2 and earlier, please check the "ciphers" keyword.
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020013540
Emeric Brunfd33a262012-10-11 16:28:27 +020013541crl-file <crlfile>
Emeric Brun1a073b42012-09-28 17:07:34 +020013542 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
13543 designates a PEM file from which to load certificate revocation list used
Remi Tricot-Le Breton02bd6842021-05-04 12:22:34 +020013544 to verify client's certificate. You need to provide a certificate revocation
13545 list for every certificate of your certificate authority chain.
Emeric Brun1a073b42012-09-28 17:07:34 +020013546
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020013547crt <cert>
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +000013548 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
13549 designates a PEM file containing both the required certificates and any
13550 associated private keys. This file can be built by concatenating multiple
13551 PEM files into one (e.g. cat cert.pem key.pem > combined.pem). If your CA
13552 requires an intermediate certificate, this can also be concatenated into this
Emmanuel Hocdet70df7bf2019-01-04 11:08:20 +010013553 file. Intermediate certificate can also be shared in a directory via
13554 "issuers-chain-path" directive.
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +000013555
William Lallemand4c5adbf2020-02-24 14:23:22 +010013556 If the file does not contain a private key, HAProxy will try to load
13557 the key at the same path suffixed by a ".key".
13558
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +000013559 If the OpenSSL used supports Diffie-Hellman, parameters present in this file
13560 are loaded.
13561
13562 If a directory name is used instead of a PEM file, then all files found in
William Lallemand3f25ae32020-02-24 16:30:12 +010013563 that directory will be loaded in alphabetic order unless their name ends
13564 with '.key', '.issuer', '.ocsp' or '.sctl' (reserved extensions). This
13565 directive may be specified multiple times in order to load certificates from
13566 multiple files or directories. The certificates will be presented to clients
13567 who provide a valid TLS Server Name Indication field matching one of their
13568 CN or alt subjects. Wildcards are supported, where a wildcard character '*'
13569 is used instead of the first hostname component (e.g. *.example.org matches
William Lallemand929da3e2023-04-04 16:28:58 +020013570 www.example.org but not www.sub.example.org). If an empty directory is used,
13571 HAProxy will not start unless the "strict-sni" keyword is used.
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +000013572
13573 If no SNI is provided by the client or if the SSL library does not support
13574 TLS extensions, or if the client provides an SNI hostname which does not
13575 match any certificate, then the first loaded certificate will be presented.
13576 This means that when loading certificates from a directory, it is highly
Cyril Bonté3180f7b2015-01-25 00:16:08 +010013577 recommended to load the default one first as a file or to ensure that it will
13578 always be the first one in the directory.
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +000013579
Emeric Brune032bfa2012-09-28 13:01:45 +020013580 Note that the same cert may be loaded multiple times without side effects.
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020013581
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013582 Some CAs (such as GoDaddy) offer a drop down list of server types that do not
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +000013583 include HAProxy when obtaining a certificate. If this happens be sure to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013584 choose a web server that the CA believes requires an intermediate CA (for
13585 GoDaddy, selection Apache Tomcat will get the correct bundle, but many
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +000013586 others, e.g. nginx, result in a wrong bundle that will not work for some
13587 clients).
13588
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040013589 For each PEM file, HAProxy checks for the presence of file at the same path
Emeric Brun4147b2e2014-06-16 18:36:30 +020013590 suffixed by ".ocsp". If such file is found, support for the TLS Certificate
13591 Status Request extension (also known as "OCSP stapling") is automatically
13592 enabled. The content of this file is optional. If not empty, it must contain
13593 a valid OCSP Response in DER format. In order to be valid an OCSP Response
13594 must comply with the following rules: it has to indicate a good status,
13595 it has to be a single response for the certificate of the PEM file, and it
13596 has to be valid at the moment of addition. If these rules are not respected
13597 the OCSP Response is ignored and a warning is emitted. In order to identify
13598 which certificate an OCSP Response applies to, the issuer's certificate is
13599 necessary. If the issuer's certificate is not found in the PEM file, it will
13600 be loaded from a file at the same path as the PEM file suffixed by ".issuer"
13601 if it exists otherwise it will fail with an error.
13602
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040013603 For each PEM file, HAProxy also checks for the presence of file at the same
Janusz Dziemidowicz2c701b52015-03-07 23:03:59 +010013604 path suffixed by ".sctl". If such file is found, support for Certificate
13605 Transparency (RFC6962) TLS extension is enabled. The file must contain a
13606 valid Signed Certificate Timestamp List, as described in RFC. File is parsed
13607 to check basic syntax, but no signatures are verified.
13608
yanbzhu6c25e9e2016-01-05 12:52:02 -050013609 There are cases where it is desirable to support multiple key types, e.g. RSA
13610 and ECDSA in the cipher suites offered to the clients. This allows clients
13611 that support EC certificates to be able to use EC ciphers, while
13612 simultaneously supporting older, RSA only clients.
yanbzhud19630c2015-12-14 15:10:25 -050013613
William Lallemandf9ff3ec2020-10-02 17:57:44 +020013614 To achieve this, OpenSSL 1.1.1 is required, you can configure this behavior
13615 by providing one crt entry per certificate type, or by configuring a "cert
13616 bundle" like it was required before HAProxy 1.8. See "ssl-load-extra-files".
yanbzhud19630c2015-12-14 15:10:25 -050013617
Emeric Brunb6dc9342012-09-28 17:55:37 +020013618crt-ignore-err <errors>
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +000013619 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. Sets a
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013620 comma separated list of errorIDs to ignore during verify at depth == 0. If
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030013621 set to 'all', all errors are ignored. SSL handshake is not aborted if an error
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +000013622 is ignored.
Emeric Brunb6dc9342012-09-28 17:55:37 +020013623
Emmanuel Hocdetfe616562013-01-22 15:31:15 +010013624crt-list <file>
13625 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Emmanuel Hocdet98263292016-12-29 18:26:15 +010013626 designates a list of PEM file with an optional ssl configuration and a SNI
13627 filter per certificate, with the following format for each line :
Emmanuel Hocdetfe616562013-01-22 15:31:15 +010013628
Emmanuel Hocdet98263292016-12-29 18:26:15 +010013629 <crtfile> [\[<sslbindconf> ...\]] [[!]<snifilter> ...]
13630
William Lallemand5d036392020-06-30 16:11:36 +020013631 sslbindconf supports "allow-0rtt", "alpn", "ca-file", "ca-verify-file",
13632 "ciphers", "ciphersuites", "crl-file", "curves", "ecdhe", "no-ca-names",
13633 "npn", "verify" configuration. With BoringSSL and Openssl >= 1.1.1
13634 "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver" are also supported. It overrides the
13635 configuration set in bind line for the certificate.
Emmanuel Hocdetfe616562013-01-22 15:31:15 +010013636
Emmanuel Hocdet7c41a1b2013-05-07 20:20:06 +020013637 Wildcards are supported in the SNI filter. Negative filter are also supported,
Joao Moraise51fab02020-11-21 07:42:20 -030013638 useful in combination with a wildcard filter to exclude a particular SNI, or
13639 after the first certificate to exclude a pattern from its CN or Subject Alt
13640 Name (SAN). The certificates will be presented to clients who provide a valid
13641 TLS Server Name Indication field matching one of the SNI filters. If no SNI
13642 filter is specified, the CN and SAN are used. This directive may be specified
Emmanuel Hocdet7c41a1b2013-05-07 20:20:06 +020013643 multiple times. See the "crt" option for more information. The default
13644 certificate is still needed to meet OpenSSL expectations. If it is not used,
13645 the 'strict-sni' option may be used.
Emmanuel Hocdetfe616562013-01-22 15:31:15 +010013646
William Lallemandf9ff3ec2020-10-02 17:57:44 +020013647 Multi-cert bundling (see "ssl-load-extra-files") is supported with crt-list,
13648 as long as only the base name is given in the crt-list. SNI filter will do
13649 the same work on all bundled certificates.
yanbzhud19630c2015-12-14 15:10:25 -050013650
William Lallemand7c26ed72020-06-03 17:34:48 +020013651 Empty lines as well as lines beginning with a hash ('#') will be ignored.
13652
Joao Moraisaa8fcc42020-11-24 08:24:30 -030013653 The first declared certificate of a bind line is used as the default
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040013654 certificate, either from crt or crt-list option, which HAProxy should use in
Joao Moraisaa8fcc42020-11-24 08:24:30 -030013655 the TLS handshake if no other certificate matches. This certificate will also
13656 be used if the provided SNI matches its CN or SAN, even if a matching SNI
13657 filter is found on any crt-list. The SNI filter !* can be used after the first
13658 declared certificate to not include its CN and SAN in the SNI tree, so it will
13659 never match except if no other certificate matches. This way the first
13660 declared certificate act as a fallback.
Joao Moraise51fab02020-11-21 07:42:20 -030013661
Emmanuel Hocdet98263292016-12-29 18:26:15 +010013662 crt-list file example:
Joao Moraise51fab02020-11-21 07:42:20 -030013663 cert1.pem !*
William Lallemand7c26ed72020-06-03 17:34:48 +020013664 # comment
Emmanuel Hocdet05942112017-02-20 16:11:50 +010013665 cert2.pem [alpn h2,http/1.1]
Emmanuel Hocdet98263292016-12-29 18:26:15 +010013666 certW.pem *.domain.tld !secure.domain.tld
Emmanuel Hocdet05942112017-02-20 16:11:50 +010013667 certS.pem [curves X25519:P-256 ciphers ECDHE-ECDSA-AES256-GCM-SHA384] secure.domain.tld
Emmanuel Hocdet98263292016-12-29 18:26:15 +010013668
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020013669defer-accept
13670 Is an optional keyword which is supported only on certain Linux kernels. It
13671 states that a connection will only be accepted once some data arrive on it,
13672 or at worst after the first retransmit. This should be used only on protocols
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013673 for which the client talks first (e.g. HTTP). It can slightly improve
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020013674 performance by ensuring that most of the request is already available when
13675 the connection is accepted. On the other hand, it will not be able to detect
13676 connections which don't talk. It is important to note that this option is
13677 broken in all kernels up to 2.6.31, as the connection is never accepted until
13678 the client talks. This can cause issues with front firewalls which would see
13679 an established connection while the proxy will only see it in SYN_RECV. This
13680 option is only supported on TCPv4/TCPv6 sockets and ignored by other ones.
13681
William Lallemandf6975e92017-05-26 17:42:10 +020013682expose-fd listeners
13683 This option is only usable with the stats socket. It gives your stats socket
13684 the capability to pass listeners FD to another HAProxy process.
William Lallemande202b1e2017-06-01 17:38:56 +020013685 During a reload with the master-worker mode, the process is automatically
13686 reexecuted adding -x and one of the stats socket with this option.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013687 See also "-x" in the management guide.
William Lallemandf6975e92017-05-26 17:42:10 +020013688
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020013689force-sslv3
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030013690 This option enforces use of SSLv3 only on SSL connections instantiated from
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020013691 this listener. SSLv3 is generally less expensive than the TLS counterparts
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010013692 for high connection rates. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020013693 "ssl-default-bind-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver".
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020013694
13695force-tlsv10
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030013696 This option enforces use of TLSv1.0 only on SSL connections instantiated from
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010013697 this listener. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020013698 "ssl-default-bind-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver".
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020013699
13700force-tlsv11
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030013701 This option enforces use of TLSv1.1 only on SSL connections instantiated from
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010013702 this listener. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020013703 "ssl-default-bind-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver".
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020013704
13705force-tlsv12
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030013706 This option enforces use of TLSv1.2 only on SSL connections instantiated from
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010013707 this listener. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020013708 "ssl-default-bind-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver".
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020013709
Emmanuel Hocdet42fb9802017-03-30 19:29:39 +020013710force-tlsv13
13711 This option enforces use of TLSv1.3 only on SSL connections instantiated from
13712 this listener. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020013713 "ssl-default-bind-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver".
Emmanuel Hocdet42fb9802017-03-30 19:29:39 +020013714
Christopher Faulet31af49d2015-06-09 17:29:50 +020013715generate-certificates
13716 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
13717 enables the dynamic SSL certificates generation. A CA certificate and its
13718 private key are necessary (see 'ca-sign-file'). When HAProxy is configured as
13719 a transparent forward proxy, SSL requests generate errors because of a common
13720 name mismatch on the certificate presented to the client. With this option
13721 enabled, HAProxy will try to forge a certificate using the SNI hostname
13722 indicated by the client. This is done only if no certificate matches the SNI
13723 hostname (see 'crt-list'). If an error occurs, the default certificate is
13724 used, else the 'strict-sni' option is set.
13725 It can also be used when HAProxy is configured as a reverse proxy to ease the
13726 deployment of an architecture with many backends.
13727
13728 Creating a SSL certificate is an expensive operation, so a LRU cache is used
13729 to store forged certificates (see 'tune.ssl.ssl-ctx-cache-size'). It
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013730 increases the HAProxy's memory footprint to reduce latency when the same
Christopher Faulet31af49d2015-06-09 17:29:50 +020013731 certificate is used many times.
13732
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020013733gid <gid>
13734 Sets the group of the UNIX sockets to the designated system gid. It can also
13735 be set by default in the global section's "unix-bind" statement. Note that
13736 some platforms simply ignore this. This setting is equivalent to the "group"
13737 setting except that the group ID is used instead of its name. This setting is
13738 ignored by non UNIX sockets.
13739
13740group <group>
13741 Sets the group of the UNIX sockets to the designated system group. It can
13742 also be set by default in the global section's "unix-bind" statement. Note
13743 that some platforms simply ignore this. This setting is equivalent to the
13744 "gid" setting except that the group name is used instead of its gid. This
13745 setting is ignored by non UNIX sockets.
13746
13747id <id>
13748 Fixes the socket ID. By default, socket IDs are automatically assigned, but
13749 sometimes it is more convenient to fix them to ease monitoring. This value
13750 must be strictly positive and unique within the listener/frontend. This
13751 option can only be used when defining only a single socket.
13752
13753interface <interface>
Lukas Tribusfce2e962013-02-12 22:13:19 +010013754 Restricts the socket to a specific interface. When specified, only packets
13755 received from that particular interface are processed by the socket. This is
13756 currently only supported on Linux. The interface must be a primary system
13757 interface, not an aliased interface. It is also possible to bind multiple
13758 frontends to the same address if they are bound to different interfaces. Note
13759 that binding to a network interface requires root privileges. This parameter
Jérôme Magnin61275192018-02-07 11:39:58 +010013760 is only compatible with TCPv4/TCPv6 sockets. When specified, return traffic
13761 uses the same interface as inbound traffic, and its associated routing table,
13762 even if there are explicit routes through different interfaces configured.
13763 This can prove useful to address asymmetric routing issues when the same
13764 client IP addresses need to be able to reach frontends hosted on different
13765 interfaces.
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020013766
Willy Tarreauabb175f2012-09-24 12:43:26 +020013767level <level>
13768 This setting is used with the stats sockets only to restrict the nature of
13769 the commands that can be issued on the socket. It is ignored by other
13770 sockets. <level> can be one of :
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013771 - "user" is the least privileged level; only non-sensitive stats can be
Willy Tarreauabb175f2012-09-24 12:43:26 +020013772 read, and no change is allowed. It would make sense on systems where it
13773 is not easy to restrict access to the socket.
13774 - "operator" is the default level and fits most common uses. All data can
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013775 be read, and only non-sensitive changes are permitted (e.g. clear max
Willy Tarreauabb175f2012-09-24 12:43:26 +020013776 counters).
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013777 - "admin" should be used with care, as everything is permitted (e.g. clear
Willy Tarreauabb175f2012-09-24 12:43:26 +020013778 all counters).
13779
Andjelko Iharosc4df59e2017-07-20 11:59:48 +020013780severity-output <format>
13781 This setting is used with the stats sockets only to configure severity
13782 level output prepended to informational feedback messages. Severity
13783 level of messages can range between 0 and 7, conforming to syslog
13784 rfc5424. Valid and successful socket commands requesting data
13785 (i.e. "show map", "get acl foo" etc.) will never have a severity level
13786 prepended. It is ignored by other sockets. <format> can be one of :
13787 - "none" (default) no severity level is prepended to feedback messages.
13788 - "number" severity level is prepended as a number.
13789 - "string" severity level is prepended as a string following the
13790 rfc5424 convention.
13791
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020013792maxconn <maxconn>
13793 Limits the sockets to this number of concurrent connections. Extraneous
13794 connections will remain in the system's backlog until a connection is
13795 released. If unspecified, the limit will be the same as the frontend's
13796 maxconn. Note that in case of port ranges or multiple addresses, the same
13797 value will be applied to each socket. This setting enables different
13798 limitations on expensive sockets, for instance SSL entries which may easily
13799 eat all memory.
13800
13801mode <mode>
13802 Sets the octal mode used to define access permissions on the UNIX socket. It
13803 can also be set by default in the global section's "unix-bind" statement.
13804 Note that some platforms simply ignore this. This setting is ignored by non
13805 UNIX sockets.
13806
13807mss <maxseg>
13808 Sets the TCP Maximum Segment Size (MSS) value to be advertised on incoming
13809 connections. This can be used to force a lower MSS for certain specific
13810 ports, for instance for connections passing through a VPN. Note that this
13811 relies on a kernel feature which is theoretically supported under Linux but
13812 was buggy in all versions prior to 2.6.28. It may or may not work on other
13813 operating systems. It may also not change the advertised value but change the
13814 effective size of outgoing segments. The commonly advertised value for TCPv4
13815 over Ethernet networks is 1460 = 1500(MTU) - 40(IP+TCP). If this value is
13816 positive, it will be used as the advertised MSS. If it is negative, it will
13817 indicate by how much to reduce the incoming connection's advertised MSS for
13818 outgoing segments. This parameter is only compatible with TCP v4/v6 sockets.
13819
13820name <name>
13821 Sets an optional name for these sockets, which will be reported on the stats
13822 page.
13823
Willy Tarreaud72f0f32015-10-13 14:50:22 +020013824namespace <name>
13825 On Linux, it is possible to specify which network namespace a socket will
13826 belong to. This directive makes it possible to explicitly bind a listener to
13827 a namespace different from the default one. Please refer to your operating
13828 system's documentation to find more details about network namespaces.
13829
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020013830nice <nice>
13831 Sets the 'niceness' of connections initiated from the socket. Value must be
13832 in the range -1024..1024 inclusive, and defaults to zero. Positive values
13833 means that such connections are more friendly to others and easily offer
13834 their place in the scheduler. On the opposite, negative values mean that
13835 connections want to run with a higher priority than others. The difference
13836 only happens under high loads when the system is close to saturation.
13837 Negative values are appropriate for low-latency or administration services,
13838 and high values are generally recommended for CPU intensive tasks such as SSL
13839 processing or bulk transfers which are less sensible to latency. For example,
13840 it may make sense to use a positive value for an SMTP socket and a negative
13841 one for an RDP socket.
13842
Emmanuel Hocdet174dfe52017-07-28 15:01:05 +020013843no-ca-names
13844 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
13845 prevents from send CA names in server hello message when ca-file is used.
Emmanuel Hocdet842e94e2019-12-16 16:39:17 +010013846 Use "ca-verify-file" instead of "ca-file" with "no-ca-names".
Emmanuel Hocdet174dfe52017-07-28 15:01:05 +020013847
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020013848no-sslv3
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020013849 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030013850 disables support for SSLv3 on any sockets instantiated from the listener when
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020013851 SSL is supported. Note that SSLv2 is forced disabled in the code and cannot
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010013852 be enabled using any configuration option. This option is also available on
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020013853 global statement "ssl-default-bind-options". Use "ssl-min-ver" and
13854 "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020013855
Emeric Brun90ad8722012-10-02 14:00:59 +020013856no-tls-tickets
13857 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
13858 disables the stateless session resumption (RFC 5077 TLS Ticket
13859 extension) and force to use stateful session resumption. Stateless
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010013860 session resumption is more expensive in CPU usage. This option is also
13861 available on global statement "ssl-default-bind-options".
Lukas Tribusbdb386d2020-03-10 00:56:09 +010013862 The TLS ticket mechanism is only used up to TLS 1.2.
13863 Forward Secrecy is compromised with TLS tickets, unless ticket keys
13864 are periodically rotated (via reload or by using "tls-ticket-keys").
Emeric Brun90ad8722012-10-02 14:00:59 +020013865
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020013866no-tlsv10
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020013867 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030013868 disables support for TLSv1.0 on any sockets instantiated from the listener
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020013869 when SSL is supported. Note that SSLv2 is forced disabled in the code and
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010013870 cannot be enabled using any configuration option. This option is also
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020013871 available on global statement "ssl-default-bind-options". Use "ssl-min-ver"
13872 and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020013873
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020013874no-tlsv11
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +020013875 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030013876 disables support for TLSv1.1 on any sockets instantiated from the listener
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020013877 when SSL is supported. Note that SSLv2 is forced disabled in the code and
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010013878 cannot be enabled using any configuration option. This option is also
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020013879 available on global statement "ssl-default-bind-options". Use "ssl-min-ver"
13880 and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +020013881
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020013882no-tlsv12
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +020013883 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030013884 disables support for TLSv1.2 on any sockets instantiated from the listener
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020013885 when SSL is supported. Note that SSLv2 is forced disabled in the code and
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010013886 cannot be enabled using any configuration option. This option is also
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020013887 available on global statement "ssl-default-bind-options". Use "ssl-min-ver"
13888 and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +020013889
Emmanuel Hocdet42fb9802017-03-30 19:29:39 +020013890no-tlsv13
13891 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
13892 disables support for TLSv1.3 on any sockets instantiated from the listener
13893 when SSL is supported. Note that SSLv2 is forced disabled in the code and
13894 cannot be enabled using any configuration option. This option is also
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020013895 available on global statement "ssl-default-bind-options". Use "ssl-min-ver"
13896 and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Emmanuel Hocdet42fb9802017-03-30 19:29:39 +020013897
Willy Tarreau6c9a3d52012-10-18 18:57:14 +020013898npn <protocols>
13899 This enables the NPN TLS extension and advertises the specified protocol list
13900 as supported on top of NPN. The protocol list consists in a comma-delimited
13901 list of protocol names, for instance: "http/1.1,http/1.0" (without quotes).
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050013902 This requires that the SSL library is built with support for TLS extensions
Willy Tarreauab861d32013-04-02 02:30:41 +020013903 enabled (check with haproxy -vv). Note that the NPN extension has been
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +010013904 replaced with the ALPN extension (see the "alpn" keyword), though this one is
13905 only available starting with OpenSSL 1.0.2. If HTTP/2 is desired on an older
13906 version of OpenSSL, NPN might still be used as most clients still support it
13907 at the time of writing this. It is possible to enable both NPN and ALPN
13908 though it probably doesn't make any sense out of testing.
Willy Tarreau6c9a3d52012-10-18 18:57:14 +020013909
Lukas Tribus53ae85c2017-05-04 15:45:40 +000013910prefer-client-ciphers
13911 Use the client's preference when selecting the cipher suite, by default
13912 the server's preference is enforced. This option is also available on
13913 global statement "ssl-default-bind-options".
Lukas Tribus926594f2018-05-18 17:55:57 +020013914 Note that with OpenSSL >= 1.1.1 ChaCha20-Poly1305 is reprioritized anyway
13915 (without setting this option), if a ChaCha20-Poly1305 cipher is at the top of
13916 the client cipher list.
Lukas Tribus53ae85c2017-05-04 15:45:40 +000013917
Christopher Fauletc644fa92017-11-23 22:44:11 +010013918process <process-set>[/<thread-set>]
Willy Tarreaua36b3242019-02-02 13:14:34 +010013919 This restricts the list of processes or threads on which this listener is
Christopher Fauletc644fa92017-11-23 22:44:11 +010013920 allowed to run. It does not enforce any process but eliminates those which do
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013921 not match. If the frontend uses a "bind-process" setting, the intersection
Christopher Fauletc644fa92017-11-23 22:44:11 +010013922 between the two is applied. If in the end the listener is not allowed to run
13923 on any remaining process, a warning is emitted, and the listener will either
13924 run on the first process of the listener if a single process was specified,
13925 or on all of its processes if multiple processes were specified. If a thread
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013926 set is specified, it limits the threads allowed to process incoming
Willy Tarreaua36b3242019-02-02 13:14:34 +010013927 connections for this listener, for the the process set. If multiple processes
13928 and threads are configured, a warning is emitted, as it either results from a
13929 configuration error or a misunderstanding of these models. For the unlikely
13930 case where several ranges are needed, this directive may be repeated.
13931 <process-set> and <thread-set> must use the format
Christopher Fauletc644fa92017-11-23 22:44:11 +010013932
13933 all | odd | even | number[-[number]]
13934
13935 Ranges can be partially defined. The higher bound can be omitted. In such
13936 case, it is replaced by the corresponding maximum value. The main purpose of
13937 this directive is to be used with the stats sockets and have one different
13938 socket per process. The second purpose is to have multiple bind lines sharing
13939 the same IP:port but not the same process in a listener, so that the system
13940 can distribute the incoming connections into multiple queues and allow a
13941 smoother inter-process load balancing. Currently Linux 3.9 and above is known
13942 for supporting this. See also "bind-process" and "nbproc".
Willy Tarreau6ae1ba62014-05-07 19:01:58 +020013943
Christopher Fauleta717b992018-04-10 14:43:00 +020013944proto <name>
13945 Forces the multiplexer's protocol to use for the incoming connections. It
13946 must be compatible with the mode of the frontend (TCP or HTTP). It must also
13947 be usable on the frontend side. The list of available protocols is reported
Christopher Faulet982e17d2021-03-26 14:44:18 +010013948 in haproxy -vv. The protocols properties are reported : the mode (TCP/HTTP),
13949 the side (FE/BE), the mux name and its flags.
13950
13951 Some protocols report errors on aborts (flag=CLEAN_ABRT). Some others are
13952 subject to the head-of-line blocking on server side (flag=HOL_RISK). Finally
13953 some protocols don't support upgrades (flag=NO_UPG). The HTX compatibility is
13954 also reported (flag=HTX).
13955
13956 Here are the protocols that may be used as argument to a "proto" directive on
13957 a bind line :
13958
13959 h2 : mode=HTTP side=FE|BE mux=H2 flags=HTX|CLEAN_ABRT|HOL_RISK|NO_UPG
13960 h1 : mode=HTTP side=FE|BE mux=H1 flags=HTX|NO_UPG
13961 none : mode=TCP side=FE|BE mux=PASS flags=NO_UPG
13962
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -040013963 Idea behind this option is to bypass the selection of the best multiplexer's
Christopher Fauleta717b992018-04-10 14:43:00 +020013964 protocol for all connections instantiated from this listening socket. For
Joseph Herlant71b4b152018-11-13 16:55:16 -080013965 instance, it is possible to force the http/2 on clear TCP by specifying "proto
Christopher Fauleta717b992018-04-10 14:43:00 +020013966 h2" on the bind line.
13967
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020013968ssl
13969 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030013970 enables SSL deciphering on connections instantiated from this listener. A
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020013971 certificate is necessary (see "crt" above). All contents in the buffers will
13972 appear in clear text, so that ACLs and HTTP processing will only have access
Emmanuel Hocdetbd695fe2017-05-15 15:53:41 +020013973 to deciphered contents. SSLv3 is disabled per default, use "ssl-min-ver SSLv3"
13974 to enable it.
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020013975
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020013976ssl-max-ver [ SSLv3 | TLSv1.0 | TLSv1.1 | TLSv1.2 | TLSv1.3 ]
13977 This option enforces use of <version> or lower on SSL connections instantiated
William Lallemand50df1cb2020-06-02 10:52:24 +020013978 from this listener. Using this setting without "ssl-min-ver" can be
13979 ambiguous because the default ssl-min-ver value could change in future HAProxy
13980 versions. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020013981 "ssl-default-bind-options". See also "ssl-min-ver".
13982
13983ssl-min-ver [ SSLv3 | TLSv1.0 | TLSv1.1 | TLSv1.2 | TLSv1.3 ]
William Lallemand50df1cb2020-06-02 10:52:24 +020013984 This option enforces use of <version> or upper on SSL connections
13985 instantiated from this listener. The default value is "TLSv1.2". This option
13986 is also available on global statement "ssl-default-bind-options".
13987 See also "ssl-max-ver".
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020013988
Emmanuel Hocdet65623372013-01-24 17:17:15 +010013989strict-sni
13990 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. The
13991 SSL/TLS negotiation is allow only if the client provided an SNI which match
William Lallemand929da3e2023-04-04 16:28:58 +020013992 a certificate. The default certificate is not used. This option also allows
13993 to start without any certificate on a bind line, so an empty directory could
13994 be used and filled later from the stats socket.
13995 See the "crt" option for more information. See "add ssl crt-list" command in
13996 the management guide.
Emmanuel Hocdet65623372013-01-24 17:17:15 +010013997
Willy Tarreau2af207a2015-02-04 00:45:58 +010013998tcp-ut <delay>
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +010013999 Sets the TCP User Timeout for all incoming connections instantiated from this
Willy Tarreau2af207a2015-02-04 00:45:58 +010014000 listening socket. This option is available on Linux since version 2.6.37. It
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040014001 allows HAProxy to configure a timeout for sockets which contain data not
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014002 receiving an acknowledgment for the configured delay. This is especially
Willy Tarreau2af207a2015-02-04 00:45:58 +010014003 useful on long-lived connections experiencing long idle periods such as
14004 remote terminals or database connection pools, where the client and server
14005 timeouts must remain high to allow a long period of idle, but where it is
14006 important to detect that the client has disappeared in order to release all
14007 resources associated with its connection (and the server's session). The
14008 argument is a delay expressed in milliseconds by default. This only works
14009 for regular TCP connections, and is ignored for other protocols.
14010
Willy Tarreau1c862c52012-10-05 16:21:00 +020014011tfo
Lukas Tribus0defb902013-02-13 23:35:39 +010014012 Is an optional keyword which is supported only on Linux kernels >= 3.7. It
Willy Tarreau1c862c52012-10-05 16:21:00 +020014013 enables TCP Fast Open on the listening socket, which means that clients which
14014 support this feature will be able to send a request and receive a response
14015 during the 3-way handshake starting from second connection, thus saving one
14016 round-trip after the first connection. This only makes sense with protocols
14017 that use high connection rates and where each round trip matters. This can
14018 possibly cause issues with many firewalls which do not accept data on SYN
14019 packets, so this option should only be enabled once well tested. This option
Lukas Tribus0999f762013-04-02 16:43:24 +020014020 is only supported on TCPv4/TCPv6 sockets and ignored by other ones. You may
14021 need to build HAProxy with USE_TFO=1 if your libc doesn't define
14022 TCP_FASTOPEN.
Willy Tarreau1c862c52012-10-05 16:21:00 +020014023
Nenad Merdanovic188ad3e2015-02-27 19:56:50 +010014024tls-ticket-keys <keyfile>
14025 Sets the TLS ticket keys file to load the keys from. The keys need to be 48
Emeric Brun9e754772019-01-10 17:51:55 +010014026 or 80 bytes long, depending if aes128 or aes256 is used, encoded with base64
14027 with one line per key (ex. openssl rand 80 | openssl base64 -A | xargs echo).
14028 The first key determines the key length used for next keys: you can't mix
14029 aes128 and aes256 keys. Number of keys is specified by the TLS_TICKETS_NO
14030 build option (default 3) and at least as many keys need to be present in
14031 the file. Last TLS_TICKETS_NO keys will be used for decryption and the
14032 penultimate one for encryption. This enables easy key rotation by just
14033 appending new key to the file and reloading the process. Keys must be
14034 periodically rotated (ex. every 12h) or Perfect Forward Secrecy is
14035 compromised. It is also a good idea to keep the keys off any permanent
Nenad Merdanovic188ad3e2015-02-27 19:56:50 +010014036 storage such as hard drives (hint: use tmpfs and don't swap those files).
14037 Lifetime hint can be changed using tune.ssl.timeout.
14038
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020014039transparent
14040 Is an optional keyword which is supported only on certain Linux kernels. It
14041 indicates that the addresses will be bound even if they do not belong to the
14042 local machine, and that packets targeting any of these addresses will be
14043 intercepted just as if the addresses were locally configured. This normally
14044 requires that IP forwarding is enabled. Caution! do not use this with the
14045 default address '*', as it would redirect any traffic for the specified port.
14046 This keyword is available only when HAProxy is built with USE_LINUX_TPROXY=1.
14047 This parameter is only compatible with TCPv4 and TCPv6 sockets, depending on
14048 kernel version. Some distribution kernels include backports of the feature,
14049 so check for support with your vendor.
14050
Willy Tarreau77e3af92012-11-24 15:07:23 +010014051v4v6
14052 Is an optional keyword which is supported only on most recent systems
14053 including Linux kernels >= 2.4.21. It is used to bind a socket to both IPv4
14054 and IPv6 when it uses the default address. Doing so is sometimes necessary
14055 on systems which bind to IPv6 only by default. It has no effect on non-IPv6
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030014056 sockets, and is overridden by the "v6only" option.
Willy Tarreau77e3af92012-11-24 15:07:23 +010014057
Willy Tarreau9b6700f2012-11-24 11:55:28 +010014058v6only
14059 Is an optional keyword which is supported only on most recent systems
14060 including Linux kernels >= 2.4.21. It is used to bind a socket to IPv6 only
14061 when it uses the default address. Doing so is sometimes preferred to doing it
Willy Tarreau77e3af92012-11-24 15:07:23 +010014062 system-wide as it is per-listener. It has no effect on non-IPv6 sockets and
14063 has precedence over the "v4v6" option.
Willy Tarreau9b6700f2012-11-24 11:55:28 +010014064
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020014065uid <uid>
14066 Sets the owner of the UNIX sockets to the designated system uid. It can also
14067 be set by default in the global section's "unix-bind" statement. Note that
14068 some platforms simply ignore this. This setting is equivalent to the "user"
14069 setting except that the user numeric ID is used instead of its name. This
14070 setting is ignored by non UNIX sockets.
14071
14072user <user>
14073 Sets the owner of the UNIX sockets to the designated system user. It can also
14074 be set by default in the global section's "unix-bind" statement. Note that
14075 some platforms simply ignore this. This setting is equivalent to the "uid"
14076 setting except that the user name is used instead of its uid. This setting is
14077 ignored by non UNIX sockets.
14078
Emeric Brun1a073b42012-09-28 17:07:34 +020014079verify [none|optional|required]
14080 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. If set
14081 to 'none', client certificate is not requested. This is the default. In other
14082 cases, a client certificate is requested. If the client does not provide a
14083 certificate after the request and if 'verify' is set to 'required', then the
14084 handshake is aborted, while it would have succeeded if set to 'optional'. The
Emeric Brunfd33a262012-10-11 16:28:27 +020014085 certificate provided by the client is always verified using CAs from
14086 'ca-file' and optional CRLs from 'crl-file'. On verify failure the handshake
14087 is aborted, regardless of the 'verify' option, unless the error code exactly
14088 matches one of those listed with 'ca-ignore-err' or 'crt-ignore-err'.
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +020014089
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +0200140905.2. Server and default-server options
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +010014091------------------------------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020014092
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +010014093The "server" and "default-server" keywords support a certain number of settings
14094which are all passed as arguments on the server line. The order in which those
14095arguments appear does not count, and they are all optional. Some of those
14096settings are single words (booleans) while others expect one or several values
14097after them. In this case, the values must immediately follow the setting name.
14098Except default-server, all those settings must be specified after the server's
14099address if they are used:
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020014100
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014101 server <name> <address>[:port] [settings ...]
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +010014102 default-server [settings ...]
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020014103
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010014104Note that all these settings are supported both by "server" and "default-server"
14105keywords, except "id" which is only supported by "server".
14106
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010014107The currently supported settings are the following ones.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010014108
Willy Tarreauceb4ac92012-04-28 00:41:46 +020014109addr <ipv4|ipv6>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014110 Using the "addr" parameter, it becomes possible to use a different IP address
Baptiste Assmann13f83532016-03-06 23:14:36 +010014111 to send health-checks or to probe the agent-check. On some servers, it may be
14112 desirable to dedicate an IP address to specific component able to perform
14113 complex tests which are more suitable to health-checks than the application.
14114 This parameter is ignored if the "check" parameter is not set. See also the
14115 "port" parameter.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020014116
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090014117agent-check
14118 Enable an auxiliary agent check which is run independently of a regular
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010014119 health check. An agent health check is performed by making a TCP connection
Willy Tarreau7a0139e2018-12-16 08:42:56 +010014120 to the port set by the "agent-port" parameter and reading an ASCII string
14121 terminated by the first '\r' or '\n' met. The string is made of a series of
14122 words delimited by spaces, tabs or commas in any order, each consisting of :
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090014123
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010014124 - An ASCII representation of a positive integer percentage, e.g. "75%".
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090014125 Values in this format will set the weight proportional to the initial
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040014126 weight of a server as configured when HAProxy starts. Note that a zero
Willy Tarreauc5af3a62014-10-07 15:27:33 +020014127 weight is reported on the stats page as "DRAIN" since it has the same
14128 effect on the server (it's removed from the LB farm).
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090014129
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014130 - The string "maxconn:" followed by an integer (no space between). Values
14131 in this format will set the maxconn of a server. The maximum number of
14132 connections advertised needs to be multiplied by the number of load
14133 balancers and different backends that use this health check to get the
14134 total number of connections the server might receive. Example: maxconn:30
Nenad Merdanovic174dd372016-04-24 23:10:06 +020014135
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010014136 - The word "ready". This will turn the server's administrative state to the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014137 READY mode, thus canceling any DRAIN or MAINT state
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090014138
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010014139 - The word "drain". This will turn the server's administrative state to the
14140 DRAIN mode, thus it will not accept any new connections other than those
14141 that are accepted via persistence.
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090014142
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010014143 - The word "maint". This will turn the server's administrative state to the
14144 MAINT mode, thus it will not accept any new connections at all, and health
14145 checks will be stopped.
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090014146
William Dauchyf8e795c2020-09-26 13:35:51 +020014147 - The words "down", "fail", or "stopped", optionally followed by a
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010014148 description string after a sharp ('#'). All of these mark the server's
14149 operating state as DOWN, but since the word itself is reported on the stats
14150 page, the difference allows an administrator to know if the situation was
14151 expected or not : the service may intentionally be stopped, may appear up
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014152 but fail some validity tests, or may be seen as down (e.g. missing process,
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010014153 or port not responding).
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090014154
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010014155 - The word "up" sets back the server's operating state as UP if health checks
14156 also report that the service is accessible.
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090014157
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010014158 Parameters which are not advertised by the agent are not changed. For
14159 example, an agent might be designed to monitor CPU usage and only report a
14160 relative weight and never interact with the operating status. Similarly, an
14161 agent could be designed as an end-user interface with 3 radio buttons
14162 allowing an administrator to change only the administrative state. However,
14163 it is important to consider that only the agent may revert its own actions,
14164 so if a server is set to DRAIN mode or to DOWN state using the agent, the
14165 agent must implement the other equivalent actions to bring the service into
14166 operations again.
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090014167
Simon Horman2f1f9552013-11-25 10:46:37 +090014168 Failure to connect to the agent is not considered an error as connectivity
14169 is tested by the regular health check which is enabled by the "check"
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010014170 parameter. Warning though, it is not a good idea to stop an agent after it
14171 reports "down", since only an agent reporting "up" will be able to turn the
14172 server up again. Note that the CLI on the Unix stats socket is also able to
Willy Tarreau989222a2016-01-15 10:26:26 +010014173 force an agent's result in order to work around a bogus agent if needed.
Simon Horman2f1f9552013-11-25 10:46:37 +090014174
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010014175 Requires the "agent-port" parameter to be set. See also the "agent-inter"
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010014176 and "no-agent-check" parameters.
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090014177
James Brown55f9ff12015-10-21 18:19:05 -070014178agent-send <string>
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040014179 If this option is specified, HAProxy will send the given string (verbatim)
James Brown55f9ff12015-10-21 18:19:05 -070014180 to the agent server upon connection. You could, for example, encode
14181 the backend name into this string, which would enable your agent to send
14182 different responses based on the backend. Make sure to include a '\n' if
14183 you want to terminate your request with a newline.
14184
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090014185agent-inter <delay>
14186 The "agent-inter" parameter sets the interval between two agent checks
14187 to <delay> milliseconds. If left unspecified, the delay defaults to 2000 ms.
14188
14189 Just as with every other time-based parameter, it may be entered in any
14190 other explicit unit among { us, ms, s, m, h, d }. The "agent-inter"
14191 parameter also serves as a timeout for agent checks "timeout check" is
14192 not set. In order to reduce "resonance" effects when multiple servers are
14193 hosted on the same hardware, the agent and health checks of all servers
14194 are started with a small time offset between them. It is also possible to
14195 add some random noise in the agent and health checks interval using the
14196 global "spread-checks" keyword. This makes sense for instance when a lot
14197 of backends use the same servers.
14198
14199 See also the "agent-check" and "agent-port" parameters.
14200
Misiek768d8602017-01-09 09:52:43 +010014201agent-addr <addr>
14202 The "agent-addr" parameter sets address for agent check.
14203
14204 You can offload agent-check to another target, so you can make single place
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040014205 managing status and weights of servers defined in HAProxy in case you can't
Misiek768d8602017-01-09 09:52:43 +010014206 make self-aware and self-managing services. You can specify both IP or
14207 hostname, it will be resolved.
14208
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090014209agent-port <port>
14210 The "agent-port" parameter sets the TCP port used for agent checks.
14211
14212 See also the "agent-check" and "agent-inter" parameters.
14213
Olivier Houchard8cb2d2e2019-05-06 18:58:48 +020014214allow-0rtt
14215 Allow sending early data to the server when using TLS 1.3.
Olivier Houchard22c9b442019-05-06 19:01:04 +020014216 Note that early data will be sent only if the client used early data, or
14217 if the backend uses "retry-on" with the "0rtt-rejected" keyword.
Olivier Houchard8cb2d2e2019-05-06 18:58:48 +020014218
Olivier Houchardc7566002018-11-20 23:33:50 +010014219alpn <protocols>
14220 This enables the TLS ALPN extension and advertises the specified protocol
14221 list as supported on top of ALPN. The protocol list consists in a comma-
14222 delimited list of protocol names, for instance: "http/1.1,http/1.0" (without
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050014223 quotes). This requires that the SSL library is built with support for TLS
Olivier Houchardc7566002018-11-20 23:33:50 +010014224 extensions enabled (check with haproxy -vv). The ALPN extension replaces the
14225 initial NPN extension. ALPN is required to connect to HTTP/2 servers.
14226 Versions of OpenSSL prior to 1.0.2 didn't support ALPN and only supposed the
14227 now obsolete NPN extension.
14228 If both HTTP/2 and HTTP/1.1 are expected to be supported, both versions can
14229 be advertised, in order of preference, like below :
14230
14231 server 127.0.0.1:443 ssl crt pub.pem alpn h2,http/1.1
14232
Amaury Denoyelle69352ec2021-10-18 14:40:29 +020014233 See also "ws" to use an alternative ALPN for websocket streams.
14234
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014235backup
14236 When "backup" is present on a server line, the server is only used in load
14237 balancing when all other non-backup servers are unavailable. Requests coming
14238 with a persistence cookie referencing the server will always be served
14239 though. By default, only the first operational backup server is used, unless
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010014240 the "allbackups" option is set in the backend. See also the "no-backup" and
14241 "allbackups" options.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010014242
Emeric Brunef42d922012-10-11 16:11:36 +020014243ca-file <cafile>
14244 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
14245 designates a PEM file from which to load CA certificates used to verify
14246 server's certificate.
14247
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014248check
Jerome Magnin90702bc2020-04-26 14:23:04 +020014249 This option enables health checks on a server:
14250 - when not set, no health checking is performed, and the server is always
14251 considered available.
14252 - when set and no other check method is configured, the server is considered
14253 available when a connection can be established at the highest configured
14254 transport layer. This means TCP by default, or SSL/TLS when "ssl" or
14255 "check-ssl" are set, both possibly combined with connection prefixes such
14256 as a PROXY protocol header when "send-proxy" or "check-send-proxy" are
14257 set.
14258 - when set and an application-level health check is defined, the
14259 application-level exchanges are performed on top of the configured
14260 transport layer and the server is considered available if all of the
14261 exchanges succeed.
14262
14263 By default, health checks are performed on the same address and port as
14264 configured on the server, using the same encapsulation parameters (SSL/TLS,
14265 proxy-protocol header, etc... ). It is possible to change the destination
14266 address using "addr" and the port using "port". When done, it is assumed the
14267 server isn't checked on the service port, and configured encapsulation
Ilya Shipitsin4329a9a2020-05-05 21:17:10 +050014268 parameters are not reused. One must explicitly set "check-send-proxy" to send
Jerome Magnin90702bc2020-04-26 14:23:04 +020014269 connection headers, "check-ssl" to use SSL/TLS.
14270
14271 When "sni" or "alpn" are set on the server line, their value is not used for
14272 health checks and one must use "check-sni" or "check-alpn".
14273
14274 The default source address for health check traffic is the same as the one
14275 defined in the backend. It can be changed with the "source" keyword.
14276
14277 The interval between checks can be set using the "inter" keyword, and the
14278 "rise" and "fall" keywords can be used to define how many successful or
14279 failed health checks are required to flag a server available or not
14280 available.
14281
14282 Optional application-level health checks can be configured with "option
14283 httpchk", "option mysql-check" "option smtpchk", "option pgsql-check",
14284 "option ldap-check", or "option redis-check".
14285
14286 Example:
14287 # simple tcp check
14288 backend foo
14289 server s1 192.168.0.1:80 check
14290 # this does a tcp connect + tls handshake
14291 backend foo
14292 server s1 192.168.0.1:443 ssl check
14293 # simple tcp check is enough for check success
14294 backend foo
14295 option tcp-check
14296 tcp-check connect
14297 server s1 192.168.0.1:443 ssl check
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010014298
Willy Tarreau6c16adc2012-10-05 00:04:16 +020014299check-send-proxy
14300 This option forces emission of a PROXY protocol line with outgoing health
14301 checks, regardless of whether the server uses send-proxy or not for the
14302 normal traffic. By default, the PROXY protocol is enabled for health checks
14303 if it is already enabled for normal traffic and if no "port" nor "addr"
14304 directive is present. However, if such a directive is present, the
14305 "check-send-proxy" option needs to be used to force the use of the
14306 protocol. See also the "send-proxy" option for more information.
14307
Olivier Houchard92150142018-12-21 19:47:01 +010014308check-alpn <protocols>
14309 Defines which protocols to advertise with ALPN. The protocol list consists in
14310 a comma-delimited list of protocol names, for instance: "http/1.1,http/1.0"
14311 (without quotes). If it is not set, the server ALPN is used.
14312
Christopher Fauletedc6ed92020-04-23 16:27:59 +020014313check-proto <name>
14314 Forces the multiplexer's protocol to use for the server's health-check
14315 connections. It must be compatible with the health-check type (TCP or
14316 HTTP). It must also be usable on the backend side. The list of available
Christopher Faulet982e17d2021-03-26 14:44:18 +010014317 protocols is reported in haproxy -vv. The protocols properties are
14318 reported : the mode (TCP/HTTP), the side (FE/BE), the mux name and its flags.
14319
14320 Some protocols report errors on aborts (flag=CLEAN_ABRT). Some others are
14321 subject to the head-of-line blocking on server side (flag=HOL_RISK). Finally
14322 some protocols don't support upgrades (flag=NO_UPG). The HTX compatibility is
14323 also reported (flag=HTX).
14324
14325 Here are the protocols that may be used as argument to a "check-proto"
14326 directive on a server line:
14327
14328 h2 : mode=HTTP side=FE|BE mux=H2 flags=HTX|CLEAN_ABRT|HOL_RISK|NO_UPG
14329 fcgi : mode=HTTP side=BE mux=FCGI flags=HTX|HOL_RISK|NO_UPG
14330 h1 : mode=HTTP side=FE|BE mux=H1 flags=HTX|NO_UPG
14331 none : mode=TCP side=FE|BE mux=PASS flags=NO_UPG
14332
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -040014333 Idea behind this option is to bypass the selection of the best multiplexer's
Christopher Fauletedc6ed92020-04-23 16:27:59 +020014334 protocol for health-check connections established to this server.
14335 If not defined, the server one will be used, if set.
14336
Jérôme Magninae9bb762018-12-09 16:08:26 +010014337check-sni <sni>
Olivier Houchard9130a962017-10-17 17:33:43 +020014338 This option allows you to specify the SNI to be used when doing health checks
Jérôme Magninae9bb762018-12-09 16:08:26 +010014339 over SSL. It is only possible to use a string to set <sni>. If you want to
14340 set a SNI for proxied traffic, see "sni".
Olivier Houchard9130a962017-10-17 17:33:43 +020014341
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +020014342check-ssl
14343 This option forces encryption of all health checks over SSL, regardless of
14344 whether the server uses SSL or not for the normal traffic. This is generally
14345 used when an explicit "port" or "addr" directive is specified and SSL health
14346 checks are not inherited. It is important to understand that this option
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030014347 inserts an SSL transport layer below the checks, so that a simple TCP connect
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +020014348 check becomes an SSL connect, which replaces the old ssl-hello-chk. The most
14349 common use is to send HTTPS checks by combining "httpchk" with SSL checks.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014350 All SSL settings are common to health checks and traffic (e.g. ciphers).
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010014351 See the "ssl" option for more information and "no-check-ssl" to disable
14352 this option.
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +020014353
Alexander Liu2a54bb72019-05-22 19:44:48 +080014354check-via-socks4
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050014355 This option enables outgoing health checks using upstream socks4 proxy. By
Alexander Liu2a54bb72019-05-22 19:44:48 +080014356 default, the health checks won't go through socks tunnel even it was enabled
14357 for normal traffic.
14358
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020014359ciphers <ciphers>
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +020014360 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. This
14361 option sets the string describing the list of cipher algorithms that is
14362 negotiated during the SSL/TLS handshake with the server. The format of the
Bertrand Jacquin4f03ab02019-02-03 18:48:49 +000014363 string is defined in "man 1 ciphers" from OpenSSL man pages. For background
14364 information and recommendations see e.g.
14365 (https://wiki.mozilla.org/Security/Server_Side_TLS) and
14366 (https://mozilla.github.io/server-side-tls/ssl-config-generator/). For TLSv1.3
14367 cipher configuration, please check the "ciphersuites" keyword.
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020014368
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +020014369ciphersuites <ciphersuites>
14370 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in and
14371 OpenSSL 1.1.1 or later was used to build HAProxy. This option sets the string
14372 describing the list of cipher algorithms that is negotiated during the TLS
14373 1.3 handshake with the server. The format of the string is defined in
Bertrand Jacquin4f03ab02019-02-03 18:48:49 +000014374 "man 1 ciphers" from OpenSSL man pages under the "ciphersuites" section.
14375 For cipher configuration for TLSv1.2 and earlier, please check the "ciphers"
14376 keyword.
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +020014377
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014378cookie <value>
14379 The "cookie" parameter sets the cookie value assigned to the server to
14380 <value>. This value will be checked in incoming requests, and the first
14381 operational server possessing the same value will be selected. In return, in
14382 cookie insertion or rewrite modes, this value will be assigned to the cookie
14383 sent to the client. There is nothing wrong in having several servers sharing
14384 the same cookie value, and it is in fact somewhat common between normal and
14385 backup servers. See also the "cookie" keyword in backend section.
14386
Emeric Brunef42d922012-10-11 16:11:36 +020014387crl-file <crlfile>
14388 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
14389 designates a PEM file from which to load certificate revocation list used
14390 to verify server's certificate.
14391
Emeric Bruna7aa3092012-10-26 12:58:00 +020014392crt <cert>
14393 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in.
14394 It designates a PEM file from which to load both a certificate and the
14395 associated private key. This file can be built by concatenating both PEM
14396 files into one. This certificate will be sent if the server send a client
14397 certificate request.
14398
Remi Tricot-Le Breton7c980df2021-05-07 15:28:08 +020014399 If the file does not contain a private key, HAProxy will try to load the key
14400 at the same path suffixed by a ".key" (provided the "ssl-load-extra-files"
14401 option is set accordingly).
14402
Willy Tarreau96839092010-03-29 10:02:24 +020014403disabled
14404 The "disabled" keyword starts the server in the "disabled" state. That means
14405 that it is marked down in maintenance mode, and no connection other than the
14406 ones allowed by persist mode will reach it. It is very well suited to setup
14407 new servers, because normal traffic will never reach them, while it is still
14408 possible to test the service by making use of the force-persist mechanism.
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010014409 See also "enabled" setting.
Willy Tarreau96839092010-03-29 10:02:24 +020014410
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010014411enabled
14412 This option may be used as 'server' setting to reset any 'disabled'
14413 setting which would have been inherited from 'default-server' directive as
14414 default value.
14415 It may also be used as 'default-server' setting to reset any previous
14416 'default-server' 'disabled' setting.
Willy Tarreau96839092010-03-29 10:02:24 +020014417
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010014418error-limit <count>
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +010014419 If health observing is enabled, the "error-limit" parameter specifies the
14420 number of consecutive errors that triggers event selected by the "on-error"
14421 option. By default it is set to 10 consecutive errors.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +010014422
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010014423 See also the "check", "error-limit" and "on-error".
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +010014424
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010014425fall <count>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014426 The "fall" parameter states that a server will be considered as dead after
14427 <count> consecutive unsuccessful health checks. This value defaults to 3 if
14428 unspecified. See also the "check", "inter" and "rise" parameters.
14429
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020014430force-sslv3
14431 This option enforces use of SSLv3 only when SSL is used to communicate with
14432 the server. SSLv3 is generally less expensive than the TLS counterparts for
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010014433 high connection rates. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020014434 "ssl-default-server-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and ssl-max-ver".
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020014435
14436force-tlsv10
14437 This option enforces use of TLSv1.0 only when SSL is used to communicate with
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010014438 the server. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020014439 "ssl-default-server-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and ssl-max-ver".
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020014440
14441force-tlsv11
14442 This option enforces use of TLSv1.1 only when SSL is used to communicate with
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010014443 the server. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020014444 "ssl-default-server-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and ssl-max-ver".
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020014445
14446force-tlsv12
14447 This option enforces use of TLSv1.2 only when SSL is used to communicate with
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010014448 the server. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020014449 "ssl-default-server-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and ssl-max-ver".
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020014450
Emmanuel Hocdet42fb9802017-03-30 19:29:39 +020014451force-tlsv13
14452 This option enforces use of TLSv1.3 only when SSL is used to communicate with
14453 the server. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020014454 "ssl-default-server-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and ssl-max-ver".
Emmanuel Hocdet42fb9802017-03-30 19:29:39 +020014455
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014456id <value>
Willy Tarreau53fb4ae2009-10-04 23:04:08 +020014457 Set a persistent ID for the server. This ID must be positive and unique for
14458 the proxy. An unused ID will automatically be assigned if unset. The first
14459 assigned value will be 1. This ID is currently only returned in statistics.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014460
Willy Tarreau6a031d12016-11-07 19:42:35 +010014461init-addr {last | libc | none | <ip>},[...]*
14462 Indicate in what order the server's address should be resolved upon startup
14463 if it uses an FQDN. Attempts are made to resolve the address by applying in
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014464 turn each of the methods mentioned in the comma-delimited list. The first
Willy Tarreau6a031d12016-11-07 19:42:35 +010014465 method which succeeds is used. If the end of the list is reached without
14466 finding a working method, an error is thrown. Method "last" suggests to pick
14467 the address which appears in the state file (see "server-state-file"). Method
14468 "libc" uses the libc's internal resolver (gethostbyname() or getaddrinfo()
14469 depending on the operating system and build options). Method "none"
14470 specifically indicates that the server should start without any valid IP
14471 address in a down state. It can be useful to ignore some DNS issues upon
14472 startup, waiting for the situation to get fixed later. Finally, an IP address
14473 (IPv4 or IPv6) may be provided. It can be the currently known address of the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014474 server (e.g. filled by a configuration generator), or the address of a dummy
Willy Tarreau6a031d12016-11-07 19:42:35 +010014475 server used to catch old sessions and present them with a decent error
14476 message for example. When the "first" load balancing algorithm is used, this
14477 IP address could point to a fake server used to trigger the creation of new
14478 instances on the fly. This option defaults to "last,libc" indicating that the
14479 previous address found in the state file (if any) is used first, otherwise
14480 the libc's resolver is used. This ensures continued compatibility with the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014481 historic behavior.
Willy Tarreau6a031d12016-11-07 19:42:35 +010014482
14483 Example:
14484 defaults
14485 # never fail on address resolution
14486 default-server init-addr last,libc,none
14487
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010014488inter <delay>
14489fastinter <delay>
14490downinter <delay>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014491 The "inter" parameter sets the interval between two consecutive health checks
14492 to <delay> milliseconds. If left unspecified, the delay defaults to 2000 ms.
14493 It is also possible to use "fastinter" and "downinter" to optimize delays
14494 between checks depending on the server state :
14495
Pieter Baauw44fc9df2015-09-17 21:30:46 +020014496 Server state | Interval used
14497 ----------------------------------------+----------------------------------
14498 UP 100% (non-transitional) | "inter"
14499 ----------------------------------------+----------------------------------
14500 Transitionally UP (going down "fall"), | "fastinter" if set,
14501 Transitionally DOWN (going up "rise"), | "inter" otherwise.
14502 or yet unchecked. |
14503 ----------------------------------------+----------------------------------
14504 DOWN 100% (non-transitional) | "downinter" if set,
14505 | "inter" otherwise.
14506 ----------------------------------------+----------------------------------
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010014507
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014508 Just as with every other time-based parameter, they can be entered in any
14509 other explicit unit among { us, ms, s, m, h, d }. The "inter" parameter also
14510 serves as a timeout for health checks sent to servers if "timeout check" is
14511 not set. In order to reduce "resonance" effects when multiple servers are
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090014512 hosted on the same hardware, the agent and health checks of all servers
14513 are started with a small time offset between them. It is also possible to
14514 add some random noise in the agent and health checks interval using the
14515 global "spread-checks" keyword. This makes sense for instance when a lot
14516 of backends use the same servers.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014517
Emeric Brun97556472020-05-30 01:42:45 +020014518log-proto <logproto>
14519 The "log-proto" specifies the protocol used to forward event messages to
14520 a server configured in a ring section. Possible values are "legacy"
14521 and "octet-count" corresponding respectively to "Non-transparent-framing"
14522 and "Octet counting" in rfc6587. "legacy" is the default.
14523
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010014524maxconn <maxconn>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014525 The "maxconn" parameter specifies the maximal number of concurrent
14526 connections that will be sent to this server. If the number of incoming
Tim Duesterhuscefbbd92019-11-27 22:35:27 +010014527 concurrent connections goes higher than this value, they will be queued,
14528 waiting for a slot to be released. This parameter is very important as it can
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014529 save fragile servers from going down under extreme loads. If a "minconn"
14530 parameter is specified, the limit becomes dynamic. The default value is "0"
14531 which means unlimited. See also the "minconn" and "maxqueue" parameters, and
14532 the backend's "fullconn" keyword.
14533
Tim Duesterhuscefbbd92019-11-27 22:35:27 +010014534 In HTTP mode this parameter limits the number of concurrent requests instead
14535 of the number of connections. Multiple requests might be multiplexed over a
14536 single TCP connection to the server. As an example if you specify a maxconn
14537 of 50 you might see between 1 and 50 actual server connections, but no more
14538 than 50 concurrent requests.
14539
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010014540maxqueue <maxqueue>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014541 The "maxqueue" parameter specifies the maximal number of connections which
14542 will wait in the queue for this server. If this limit is reached, next
14543 requests will be redispatched to other servers instead of indefinitely
14544 waiting to be served. This will break persistence but may allow people to
Willy Tarreau8ae8c482020-10-22 17:19:07 +020014545 quickly re-log in when the server they try to connect to is dying. Some load
14546 balancing algorithms such as leastconn take this into account and accept to
14547 add requests into a server's queue up to this value if it is explicitly set
14548 to a value greater than zero, which often allows to better smooth the load
14549 when dealing with single-digit maxconn values. The default value is "0" which
14550 means the queue is unlimited. See also the "maxconn" and "minconn" parameters
14551 and "balance leastconn".
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014552
Willy Tarreau9c538e02019-01-23 10:21:49 +010014553max-reuse <count>
14554 The "max-reuse" argument indicates the HTTP connection processors that they
14555 should not reuse a server connection more than this number of times to send
14556 new requests. Permitted values are -1 (the default), which disables this
14557 limit, or any positive value. Value zero will effectively disable keep-alive.
14558 This is only used to work around certain server bugs which cause them to leak
14559 resources over time. The argument is not necessarily respected by the lower
14560 layers as there might be technical limitations making it impossible to
14561 enforce. At least HTTP/2 connections to servers will respect it.
14562
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010014563minconn <minconn>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014564 When the "minconn" parameter is set, the maxconn limit becomes a dynamic
14565 limit following the backend's load. The server will always accept at least
14566 <minconn> connections, never more than <maxconn>, and the limit will be on
14567 the ramp between both values when the backend has less than <fullconn>
14568 concurrent connections. This makes it possible to limit the load on the
14569 server during normal loads, but push it further for important loads without
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010014570 overloading the server during exceptional loads. See also the "maxconn"
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014571 and "maxqueue" parameters, as well as the "fullconn" backend keyword.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +010014572
Willy Tarreaud72f0f32015-10-13 14:50:22 +020014573namespace <name>
14574 On Linux, it is possible to specify which network namespace a socket will
14575 belong to. This directive makes it possible to explicitly bind a server to
14576 a namespace different from the default one. Please refer to your operating
14577 system's documentation to find more details about network namespaces.
14578
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010014579no-agent-check
14580 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "agent-check"
14581 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
14582 default value.
14583 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
14584 "default-server" "agent-check" setting.
14585
14586no-backup
14587 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "backup"
14588 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
14589 default value.
14590 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
14591 "default-server" "backup" setting.
14592
14593no-check
14594 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "check"
14595 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
14596 default value.
14597 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
14598 "default-server" "check" setting.
14599
14600no-check-ssl
14601 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "check-ssl"
14602 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
14603 default value.
14604 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
14605 "default-server" "check-ssl" setting.
14606
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010014607no-send-proxy
14608 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "send-proxy"
14609 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
14610 default value.
14611 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
14612 "default-server" "send-proxy" setting.
14613
14614no-send-proxy-v2
14615 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "send-proxy-v2"
14616 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
14617 default value.
14618 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
14619 "default-server" "send-proxy-v2" setting.
14620
14621no-send-proxy-v2-ssl
14622 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "send-proxy-v2-ssl"
14623 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
14624 default value.
14625 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
14626 "default-server" "send-proxy-v2-ssl" setting.
14627
14628no-send-proxy-v2-ssl-cn
14629 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "send-proxy-v2-ssl-cn"
14630 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
14631 default value.
14632 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
14633 "default-server" "send-proxy-v2-ssl-cn" setting.
14634
14635no-ssl
14636 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "ssl"
14637 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
14638 default value.
14639 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
14640 "default-server" "ssl" setting.
14641
William Dauchyf6370442020-11-14 19:25:33 +010014642 Note that using `default-server ssl` setting and `no-ssl` on server will
14643 however init SSL connection, so it can be later be enabled through the
14644 runtime API: see `set server` commands in management doc.
14645
Willy Tarreau2a3fb1c2015-02-05 16:47:07 +010014646no-ssl-reuse
14647 This option disables SSL session reuse when SSL is used to communicate with
14648 the server. It will force the server to perform a full handshake for every
14649 new connection. It's probably only useful for benchmarking, troubleshooting,
14650 and for paranoid users.
14651
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020014652no-sslv3
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020014653 This option disables support for SSLv3 when SSL is used to communicate with
14654 the server. Note that SSLv2 is disabled in the code and cannot be enabled
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020014655 using any configuration option. Use "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020014656
Emmanuel Hocdet6cb2d1e2017-03-30 14:43:31 +020014657 Supported in default-server: No
14658
Emeric Brunf9c5c472012-10-11 15:28:34 +020014659no-tls-tickets
14660 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
14661 disables the stateless session resumption (RFC 5077 TLS Ticket
14662 extension) and force to use stateful session resumption. Stateless
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010014663 session resumption is more expensive in CPU usage for servers. This option
14664 is also available on global statement "ssl-default-server-options".
Lukas Tribusbdb386d2020-03-10 00:56:09 +010014665 The TLS ticket mechanism is only used up to TLS 1.2.
14666 Forward Secrecy is compromised with TLS tickets, unless ticket keys
14667 are periodically rotated (via reload or by using "tls-ticket-keys").
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010014668 See also "tls-tickets".
Emeric Brunf9c5c472012-10-11 15:28:34 +020014669
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020014670no-tlsv10
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020014671 This option disables support for TLSv1.0 when SSL is used to communicate with
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +020014672 the server. Note that SSLv2 is disabled in the code and cannot be enabled
14673 using any configuration option. TLSv1 is more expensive than SSLv3 so it
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010014674 often makes sense to disable it when communicating with local servers. This
14675 option is also available on global statement "ssl-default-server-options".
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020014676 Use "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +020014677
Emmanuel Hocdet6cb2d1e2017-03-30 14:43:31 +020014678 Supported in default-server: No
14679
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020014680no-tlsv11
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020014681 This option disables support for TLSv1.1 when SSL is used to communicate with
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +020014682 the server. Note that SSLv2 is disabled in the code and cannot be enabled
14683 using any configuration option. TLSv1 is more expensive than SSLv3 so it
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010014684 often makes sense to disable it when communicating with local servers. This
14685 option is also available on global statement "ssl-default-server-options".
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020014686 Use "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +020014687
Emmanuel Hocdet6cb2d1e2017-03-30 14:43:31 +020014688 Supported in default-server: No
14689
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020014690no-tlsv12
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020014691 This option disables support for TLSv1.2 when SSL is used to communicate with
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020014692 the server. Note that SSLv2 is disabled in the code and cannot be enabled
14693 using any configuration option. TLSv1 is more expensive than SSLv3 so it
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010014694 often makes sense to disable it when communicating with local servers. This
14695 option is also available on global statement "ssl-default-server-options".
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020014696 Use "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Emmanuel Hocdet42fb9802017-03-30 19:29:39 +020014697
14698 Supported in default-server: No
14699
14700no-tlsv13
14701 This option disables support for TLSv1.3 when SSL is used to communicate with
14702 the server. Note that SSLv2 is disabled in the code and cannot be enabled
14703 using any configuration option. TLSv1 is more expensive than SSLv3 so it
14704 often makes sense to disable it when communicating with local servers. This
14705 option is also available on global statement "ssl-default-server-options".
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020014706 Use "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020014707
Emmanuel Hocdet6cb2d1e2017-03-30 14:43:31 +020014708 Supported in default-server: No
14709
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010014710no-verifyhost
14711 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "verifyhost"
14712 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
14713 default value.
14714 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
14715 "default-server" "verifyhost" setting.
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +020014716
Frédéric Lécaille1b9423d2019-07-04 14:19:06 +020014717no-tfo
14718 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "tfo"
14719 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
14720 default value.
14721 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
14722 "default-server" "tfo" setting.
14723
Simon Hormanfa461682011-06-25 09:39:49 +090014724non-stick
14725 Never add connections allocated to this sever to a stick-table.
14726 This may be used in conjunction with backup to ensure that
14727 stick-table persistence is disabled for backup servers.
14728
Olivier Houchardc7566002018-11-20 23:33:50 +010014729npn <protocols>
14730 This enables the NPN TLS extension and advertises the specified protocol list
14731 as supported on top of NPN. The protocol list consists in a comma-delimited
14732 list of protocol names, for instance: "http/1.1,http/1.0" (without quotes).
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050014733 This requires that the SSL library is built with support for TLS extensions
Olivier Houchardc7566002018-11-20 23:33:50 +010014734 enabled (check with haproxy -vv). Note that the NPN extension has been
14735 replaced with the ALPN extension (see the "alpn" keyword), though this one is
14736 only available starting with OpenSSL 1.0.2.
14737
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +010014738observe <mode>
14739 This option enables health adjusting based on observing communication with
14740 the server. By default this functionality is disabled and enabling it also
14741 requires to enable health checks. There are two supported modes: "layer4" and
14742 "layer7". In layer4 mode, only successful/unsuccessful tcp connections are
14743 significant. In layer7, which is only allowed for http proxies, responses
14744 received from server are verified, like valid/wrong http code, unparsable
Willy Tarreau150d1462012-03-10 08:19:02 +010014745 headers, a timeout, etc. Valid status codes include 100 to 499, 501 and 505.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +010014746
14747 See also the "check", "on-error" and "error-limit".
14748
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010014749on-error <mode>
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +010014750 Select what should happen when enough consecutive errors are detected.
14751 Currently, four modes are available:
14752 - fastinter: force fastinter
14753 - fail-check: simulate a failed check, also forces fastinter (default)
14754 - sudden-death: simulate a pre-fatal failed health check, one more failed
14755 check will mark a server down, forces fastinter
14756 - mark-down: mark the server immediately down and force fastinter
14757
14758 See also the "check", "observe" and "error-limit".
14759
Simon Hormane0d1bfb2011-06-21 14:34:58 +090014760on-marked-down <action>
14761 Modify what occurs when a server is marked down.
14762 Currently one action is available:
Justin Karnegeseb2c24a2012-05-24 15:28:52 -070014763 - shutdown-sessions: Shutdown peer sessions. When this setting is enabled,
14764 all connections to the server are immediately terminated when the server
14765 goes down. It might be used if the health check detects more complex cases
14766 than a simple connection status, and long timeouts would cause the service
14767 to remain unresponsive for too long a time. For instance, a health check
14768 might detect that a database is stuck and that there's no chance to reuse
14769 existing connections anymore. Connections killed this way are logged with
14770 a 'D' termination code (for "Down").
Simon Hormane0d1bfb2011-06-21 14:34:58 +090014771
14772 Actions are disabled by default
14773
Justin Karnegeseb2c24a2012-05-24 15:28:52 -070014774on-marked-up <action>
14775 Modify what occurs when a server is marked up.
14776 Currently one action is available:
14777 - shutdown-backup-sessions: Shutdown sessions on all backup servers. This is
14778 done only if the server is not in backup state and if it is not disabled
14779 (it must have an effective weight > 0). This can be used sometimes to force
14780 an active server to take all the traffic back after recovery when dealing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014781 with long sessions (e.g. LDAP, SQL, ...). Doing this can cause more trouble
14782 than it tries to solve (e.g. incomplete transactions), so use this feature
Justin Karnegeseb2c24a2012-05-24 15:28:52 -070014783 with extreme care. Sessions killed because a server comes up are logged
14784 with an 'U' termination code (for "Up").
14785
14786 Actions are disabled by default
14787
Willy Tarreau2f3f4d32020-07-01 07:43:51 +020014788pool-low-conn <max>
14789 Set a low threshold on the number of idling connections for a server, below
14790 which a thread will not try to steal a connection from another thread. This
14791 can be useful to improve CPU usage patterns in scenarios involving many very
14792 fast servers, in order to ensure all threads will keep a few idle connections
14793 all the time instead of letting them accumulate over one thread and migrating
14794 them from thread to thread. Typical values of twice the number of threads
14795 seem to show very good performance already with sub-millisecond response
14796 times. The default is zero, indicating that any idle connection can be used
14797 at any time. It is the recommended setting for normal use. This only applies
14798 to connections that can be shared according to the same principles as those
Willy Tarreau0784db82021-02-19 11:45:22 +010014799 applying to "http-reuse". In case connection sharing between threads would
14800 be disabled via "tune.idle-pool.shared", it can become very important to use
14801 this setting to make sure each thread always has a few connections, or the
14802 connection reuse rate will decrease as thread count increases.
Willy Tarreau2f3f4d32020-07-01 07:43:51 +020014803
Olivier Houchard006e3102018-12-10 18:30:32 +010014804pool-max-conn <max>
14805 Set the maximum number of idling connections for a server. -1 means unlimited
14806 connections, 0 means no idle connections. The default is -1. When idle
14807 connections are enabled, orphaned idle connections which do not belong to any
14808 client session anymore are moved to a dedicated pool so that they remain
14809 usable by future clients. This only applies to connections that can be shared
14810 according to the same principles as those applying to "http-reuse".
14811
Olivier Houchardb7b3faa2018-12-14 18:15:36 +010014812pool-purge-delay <delay>
14813 Sets the delay to start purging idle connections. Each <delay> interval, half
Olivier Houcharda56eebf2019-03-19 16:44:02 +010014814 of the idle connections are closed. 0 means we don't keep any idle connection.
Willy Tarreaufb553652019-06-04 14:06:31 +020014815 The default is 5s.
Olivier Houchardb7b3faa2018-12-14 18:15:36 +010014816
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010014817port <port>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014818 Using the "port" parameter, it becomes possible to use a different port to
William Dauchy4858fb22021-02-03 22:30:09 +010014819 send health-checks or to probe the agent-check. On some servers, it may be
14820 desirable to dedicate a port to a specific component able to perform complex
14821 tests which are more suitable to health-checks than the application. It is
14822 common to run a simple script in inetd for instance. This parameter is
14823 ignored if the "check" parameter is not set. See also the "addr" parameter.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014824
Christopher Faulet8ed0a3e2018-04-10 14:45:45 +020014825proto <name>
Christopher Faulet8ed0a3e2018-04-10 14:45:45 +020014826 Forces the multiplexer's protocol to use for the outgoing connections to this
14827 server. It must be compatible with the mode of the backend (TCP or HTTP). It
14828 must also be usable on the backend side. The list of available protocols is
Christopher Faulet982e17d2021-03-26 14:44:18 +010014829 reported in haproxy -vv.The protocols properties are reported : the mode
14830 (TCP/HTTP), the side (FE/BE), the mux name and its flags.
14831
14832 Some protocols report errors on aborts (flag=CLEAN_ABRT). Some others are
14833 subject to the head-of-line blocking on server side (flag=HOL_RISK). Finally
14834 some protocols don't support upgrades (flag=NO_UPG). The HTX compatibility is
14835 also reported (flag=HTX).
14836
14837 Here are the protocols that may be used as argument to a "proto" directive on
14838 a server line :
14839
14840 h2 : mode=HTTP side=FE|BE mux=H2 flags=HTX|CLEAN_ABRT|HOL_RISK|NO_UPG
14841 fcgi : mode=HTTP side=BE mux=FCGI flags=HTX|HOL_RISK|NO_UPG
14842 h1 : mode=HTTP side=FE|BE mux=H1 flags=HTX|NO_UPG
14843 none : mode=TCP side=FE|BE mux=PASS flags=NO_UPG
14844
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -040014845 Idea behind this option is to bypass the selection of the best multiplexer's
Christopher Faulet8ed0a3e2018-04-10 14:45:45 +020014846 protocol for all connections established to this server.
14847
Amaury Denoyelle69352ec2021-10-18 14:40:29 +020014848 See also "ws" to use an alternative protocol for websocket streams.
14849
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014850redir <prefix>
14851 The "redir" parameter enables the redirection mode for all GET and HEAD
14852 requests addressing this server. This means that instead of having HAProxy
14853 forward the request to the server, it will send an "HTTP 302" response with
14854 the "Location" header composed of this prefix immediately followed by the
14855 requested URI beginning at the leading '/' of the path component. That means
14856 that no trailing slash should be used after <prefix>. All invalid requests
14857 will be rejected, and all non-GET or HEAD requests will be normally served by
14858 the server. Note that since the response is completely forged, no header
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010014859 mangling nor cookie insertion is possible in the response. However, cookies in
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014860 requests are still analyzed, making this solution completely usable to direct
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014861 users to a remote location in case of local disaster. Main use consists in
14862 increasing bandwidth for static servers by having the clients directly
14863 connect to them. Note: never use a relative location here, it would cause a
14864 loop between the client and HAProxy!
14865
14866 Example : server srv1 192.168.1.1:80 redir http://image1.mydomain.com check
14867
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010014868rise <count>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014869 The "rise" parameter states that a server will be considered as operational
14870 after <count> consecutive successful health checks. This value defaults to 2
14871 if unspecified. See also the "check", "inter" and "fall" parameters.
14872
Baptiste Assmann8e2d9432018-06-22 15:04:43 +020014873resolve-opts <option>,<option>,...
14874 Comma separated list of options to apply to DNS resolution linked to this
14875 server.
14876
14877 Available options:
14878
14879 * allow-dup-ip
14880 By default, HAProxy prevents IP address duplication in a backend when DNS
14881 resolution at runtime is in operation.
14882 That said, for some cases, it makes sense that two servers (in the same
14883 backend, being resolved by the same FQDN) have the same IP address.
14884 For such case, simply enable this option.
14885 This is the opposite of prevent-dup-ip.
14886
Daniel Corbettf8716912019-11-17 09:48:56 -050014887 * ignore-weight
14888 Ignore any weight that is set within an SRV record. This is useful when
14889 you would like to control the weights using an alternate method, such as
14890 using an "agent-check" or through the runtime api.
14891
Baptiste Assmann8e2d9432018-06-22 15:04:43 +020014892 * prevent-dup-ip
14893 Ensure HAProxy's default behavior is enforced on a server: prevent re-using
14894 an IP address already set to a server in the same backend and sharing the
14895 same fqdn.
14896 This is the opposite of allow-dup-ip.
14897
14898 Example:
14899 backend b_myapp
14900 default-server init-addr none resolvers dns
14901 server s1 myapp.example.com:80 check resolve-opts allow-dup-ip
14902 server s2 myapp.example.com:81 check resolve-opts allow-dup-ip
14903
14904 With the option allow-dup-ip set:
14905 * if the nameserver returns a single IP address, then both servers will use
14906 it
14907 * If the nameserver returns 2 IP addresses, then each server will pick up a
14908 different address
14909
14910 Default value: not set
14911
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020014912resolve-prefer <family>
14913 When DNS resolution is enabled for a server and multiple IP addresses from
14914 different families are returned, HAProxy will prefer using an IP address
14915 from the family mentioned in the "resolve-prefer" parameter.
14916 Available families: "ipv4" and "ipv6"
14917
Baptiste Assmannc4aabae2015-08-04 22:43:06 +020014918 Default value: ipv6
14919
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +020014920 Example:
14921
14922 server s1 app1.domain.com:80 resolvers mydns resolve-prefer ipv6
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020014923
Thierry Fournierac88cfe2016-02-17 22:05:30 +010014924resolve-net <network>[,<network[,...]]
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050014925 This option prioritizes the choice of an ip address matching a network. This is
Thierry Fournierac88cfe2016-02-17 22:05:30 +010014926 useful with clouds to prefer a local ip. In some cases, a cloud high
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +010014927 availability service can be announced with many ip addresses on many
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014928 different datacenters. The latency between datacenter is not negligible, so
14929 this patch permits to prefer a local datacenter. If no address matches the
Thierry Fournierac88cfe2016-02-17 22:05:30 +010014930 configured network, another address is selected.
14931
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +020014932 Example:
14933
14934 server s1 app1.domain.com:80 resolvers mydns resolve-net 10.0.0.0/8
Thierry Fournierac88cfe2016-02-17 22:05:30 +010014935
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020014936resolvers <id>
14937 Points to an existing "resolvers" section to resolve current server's
14938 hostname.
14939
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +020014940 Example:
14941
14942 server s1 app1.domain.com:80 check resolvers mydns
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020014943
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +020014944 See also section 5.3
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020014945
Willy Tarreau5ab04ec2011-03-20 10:32:26 +010014946send-proxy
14947 The "send-proxy" parameter enforces use of the PROXY protocol over any
14948 connection established to this server. The PROXY protocol informs the other
14949 end about the layer 3/4 addresses of the incoming connection, so that it can
14950 know the client's address or the public address it accessed to, whatever the
Bertrand Jacquin93b227d2016-06-04 15:11:10 +010014951 upper layer protocol. For connections accepted by an "accept-proxy" or
14952 "accept-netscaler-cip" listener, the advertised address will be used. Only
14953 TCPv4 and TCPv6 address families are supported. Other families such as
14954 Unix sockets, will report an UNKNOWN family. Servers using this option can
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040014955 fully be chained to another instance of HAProxy listening with an
Bertrand Jacquin93b227d2016-06-04 15:11:10 +010014956 "accept-proxy" setting. This setting must not be used if the server isn't
14957 aware of the protocol. When health checks are sent to the server, the PROXY
14958 protocol is automatically used when this option is set, unless there is an
14959 explicit "port" or "addr" directive, in which case an explicit
14960 "check-send-proxy" directive would also be needed to use the PROXY protocol.
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010014961 See also the "no-send-proxy" option of this section and "accept-proxy" and
14962 "accept-netscaler-cip" option of the "bind" keyword.
Willy Tarreau5ab04ec2011-03-20 10:32:26 +010014963
David Safb76832014-05-08 23:42:08 -040014964send-proxy-v2
14965 The "send-proxy-v2" parameter enforces use of the PROXY protocol version 2
14966 over any connection established to this server. The PROXY protocol informs
14967 the other end about the layer 3/4 addresses of the incoming connection, so
14968 that it can know the client's address or the public address it accessed to,
Emmanuel Hocdet404d9782017-10-24 10:55:14 +020014969 whatever the upper layer protocol. It also send ALPN information if an alpn
14970 have been negotiated. This setting must not be used if the server isn't aware
14971 of this version of the protocol. See also the "no-send-proxy-v2" option of
14972 this section and send-proxy" option of the "bind" keyword.
David Safb76832014-05-08 23:42:08 -040014973
Emmanuel Hocdetf643b802018-02-01 15:20:32 +010014974proxy-v2-options <option>[,<option>]*
Tim Duesterhuscf6e0c82020-03-13 12:34:24 +010014975 The "proxy-v2-options" parameter add options to send in PROXY protocol
14976 version 2 when "send-proxy-v2" is used. Options available are:
14977
14978 - ssl : See also "send-proxy-v2-ssl".
14979 - cert-cn : See also "send-proxy-v2-ssl-cn".
14980 - ssl-cipher: Name of the used cipher.
14981 - cert-sig : Signature algorithm of the used certificate.
14982 - cert-key : Key algorithm of the used certificate
14983 - authority : Host name value passed by the client (only SNI from a TLS
14984 connection is supported).
14985 - crc32c : Checksum of the PROXYv2 header.
14986 - unique-id : Send a unique ID generated using the frontend's
14987 "unique-id-format" within the PROXYv2 header.
14988 This unique-id is primarily meant for "mode tcp". It can
14989 lead to unexpected results in "mode http", because the
14990 generated unique ID is also used for the first HTTP request
14991 within a Keep-Alive connection.
Emmanuel Hocdetf643b802018-02-01 15:20:32 +010014992
David Safb76832014-05-08 23:42:08 -040014993send-proxy-v2-ssl
14994 The "send-proxy-v2-ssl" parameter enforces use of the PROXY protocol version
14995 2 over any connection established to this server. The PROXY protocol informs
14996 the other end about the layer 3/4 addresses of the incoming connection, so
14997 that it can know the client's address or the public address it accessed to,
14998 whatever the upper layer protocol. In addition, the SSL information extension
14999 of the PROXY protocol is added to the PROXY protocol header. This setting
15000 must not be used if the server isn't aware of this version of the protocol.
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010015001 See also the "no-send-proxy-v2-ssl" option of this section and the
15002 "send-proxy-v2" option of the "bind" keyword.
David Safb76832014-05-08 23:42:08 -040015003
15004send-proxy-v2-ssl-cn
15005 The "send-proxy-v2-ssl" parameter enforces use of the PROXY protocol version
15006 2 over any connection established to this server. The PROXY protocol informs
15007 the other end about the layer 3/4 addresses of the incoming connection, so
15008 that it can know the client's address or the public address it accessed to,
15009 whatever the upper layer protocol. In addition, the SSL information extension
15010 of the PROXY protocol, along along with the Common Name from the subject of
15011 the client certificate (if any), is added to the PROXY protocol header. This
15012 setting must not be used if the server isn't aware of this version of the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015013 protocol. See also the "no-send-proxy-v2-ssl-cn" option of this section and
15014 the "send-proxy-v2" option of the "bind" keyword.
David Safb76832014-05-08 23:42:08 -040015015
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010015016slowstart <start_time_in_ms>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020015017 The "slowstart" parameter for a server accepts a value in milliseconds which
15018 indicates after how long a server which has just come back up will run at
15019 full speed. Just as with every other time-based parameter, it can be entered
15020 in any other explicit unit among { us, ms, s, m, h, d }. The speed grows
15021 linearly from 0 to 100% during this time. The limitation applies to two
15022 parameters :
15023
15024 - maxconn: the number of connections accepted by the server will grow from 1
15025 to 100% of the usual dynamic limit defined by (minconn,maxconn,fullconn).
15026
15027 - weight: when the backend uses a dynamic weighted algorithm, the weight
15028 grows linearly from 1 to 100%. In this case, the weight is updated at every
15029 health-check. For this reason, it is important that the "inter" parameter
15030 is smaller than the "slowstart", in order to maximize the number of steps.
15031
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040015032 The slowstart never applies when HAProxy starts, otherwise it would cause
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020015033 trouble to running servers. It only applies when a server has been previously
15034 seen as failed.
15035
Willy Tarreau732eac42015-07-09 11:40:25 +020015036sni <expression>
15037 The "sni" parameter evaluates the sample fetch expression, converts it to a
15038 string and uses the result as the host name sent in the SNI TLS extension to
15039 the server. A typical use case is to send the SNI received from the client in
Willy Tarreau000d4002022-11-25 10:12:12 +010015040 a bridged TCP/SSL scenario, using the "ssl_fc_sni" sample fetch for the
15041 expression. THIS MUST NOT BE USED FOR HTTPS, where req.hdr(host) should be
15042 used instead, since SNI in HTTPS must always match the Host field and clients
15043 are allowed to use different host names over the same connection). If
Willy Tarreau2ab88672017-07-05 18:23:03 +020015044 "verify required" is set (which is the recommended setting), the resulting
Willy Tarreauad92a9a2017-07-28 11:38:41 +020015045 name will also be matched against the server certificate's names. See the
Jérôme Magninb36a6d22018-12-09 16:03:40 +010015046 "verify" directive for more details. If you want to set a SNI for health
15047 checks, see the "check-sni" directive for more details.
Willy Tarreau732eac42015-07-09 11:40:25 +020015048
Willy Tarreauc6f4ce82009-06-10 11:09:37 +020015049source <addr>[:<pl>[-<ph>]] [usesrc { <addr2>[:<port2>] | client | clientip } ]
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +020015050source <addr>[:<port>] [usesrc { <addr2>[:<port2>] | hdr_ip(<hdr>[,<occ>]) } ]
Willy Tarreauc6f4ce82009-06-10 11:09:37 +020015051source <addr>[:<pl>[-<ph>]] [interface <name>] ...
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020015052 The "source" parameter sets the source address which will be used when
15053 connecting to the server. It follows the exact same parameters and principle
15054 as the backend "source" keyword, except that it only applies to the server
15055 referencing it. Please consult the "source" keyword for details.
15056
Willy Tarreauc6f4ce82009-06-10 11:09:37 +020015057 Additionally, the "source" statement on a server line allows one to specify a
15058 source port range by indicating the lower and higher bounds delimited by a
15059 dash ('-'). Some operating systems might require a valid IP address when a
15060 source port range is specified. It is permitted to have the same IP/range for
15061 several servers. Doing so makes it possible to bypass the maximum of 64k
15062 total concurrent connections. The limit will then reach 64k connections per
15063 server.
15064
Lukas Tribus7d56c6d2016-09-13 09:51:15 +000015065 Since Linux 4.2/libc 2.23 IP_BIND_ADDRESS_NO_PORT is set for connections
15066 specifying the source address without port(s).
15067
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020015068ssl
Willy Tarreau44f65392013-06-25 07:56:20 +020015069 This option enables SSL ciphering on outgoing connections to the server. It
15070 is critical to verify server certificates using "verify" when using SSL to
15071 connect to servers, otherwise the communication is prone to trivial man in
15072 the-middle attacks rendering SSL useless. When this option is used, health
15073 checks are automatically sent in SSL too unless there is a "port" or an
15074 "addr" directive indicating the check should be sent to a different location.
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010015075 See the "no-ssl" to disable "ssl" option and "check-ssl" option to force
15076 SSL health checks.
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +020015077
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020015078ssl-max-ver [ SSLv3 | TLSv1.0 | TLSv1.1 | TLSv1.2 | TLSv1.3 ]
15079 This option enforces use of <version> or lower when SSL is used to communicate
15080 with the server. This option is also available on global statement
15081 "ssl-default-server-options". See also "ssl-min-ver".
15082
15083ssl-min-ver [ SSLv3 | TLSv1.0 | TLSv1.1 | TLSv1.2 | TLSv1.3 ]
15084 This option enforces use of <version> or upper when SSL is used to communicate
15085 with the server. This option is also available on global statement
15086 "ssl-default-server-options". See also "ssl-max-ver".
15087
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010015088ssl-reuse
15089 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "no-ssl-reuse"
15090 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
15091 default value.
15092 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
15093 "default-server" "no-ssl-reuse" setting.
15094
15095stick
15096 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "non-stick"
15097 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
15098 default value.
15099 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
15100 "default-server" "non-stick" setting.
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020015101
Alexander Liu2a54bb72019-05-22 19:44:48 +080015102socks4 <addr>:<port>
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050015103 This option enables upstream socks4 tunnel for outgoing connections to the
Alexander Liu2a54bb72019-05-22 19:44:48 +080015104 server. Using this option won't force the health check to go via socks4 by
15105 default. You will have to use the keyword "check-via-socks4" to enable it.
15106
Willy Tarreau163d4622015-10-13 16:16:41 +020015107tcp-ut <delay>
15108 Sets the TCP User Timeout for all outgoing connections to this server. This
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040015109 option is available on Linux since version 2.6.37. It allows HAProxy to
Willy Tarreau163d4622015-10-13 16:16:41 +020015110 configure a timeout for sockets which contain data not receiving an
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015111 acknowledgment for the configured delay. This is especially useful on
Willy Tarreau163d4622015-10-13 16:16:41 +020015112 long-lived connections experiencing long idle periods such as remote
15113 terminals or database connection pools, where the client and server timeouts
15114 must remain high to allow a long period of idle, but where it is important to
15115 detect that the server has disappeared in order to release all resources
15116 associated with its connection (and the client's session). One typical use
15117 case is also to force dead server connections to die when health checks are
15118 too slow or during a soft reload since health checks are then disabled. The
15119 argument is a delay expressed in milliseconds by default. This only works for
15120 regular TCP connections, and is ignored for other protocols.
15121
Willy Tarreau034c88c2017-01-23 23:36:45 +010015122tfo
15123 This option enables using TCP fast open when connecting to servers, on
15124 systems that support it (currently only the Linux kernel >= 4.11).
15125 See the "tfo" bind option for more information about TCP fast open.
15126 Please note that when using tfo, you should also use the "conn-failure",
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040015127 "empty-response" and "response-timeout" keywords for "retry-on", or HAProxy
Frédéric Lécaille1b9423d2019-07-04 14:19:06 +020015128 won't be able to retry the connection on failure. See also "no-tfo".
Willy Tarreau034c88c2017-01-23 23:36:45 +010015129
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020015130track [<proxy>/]<server>
Willy Tarreau32091232014-05-16 13:52:00 +020015131 This option enables ability to set the current state of the server by tracking
15132 another one. It is possible to track a server which itself tracks another
15133 server, provided that at the end of the chain, a server has health checks
15134 enabled. If <proxy> is omitted the current one is used. If disable-on-404 is
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020015135 used, it has to be enabled on both proxies.
15136
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010015137tls-tickets
15138 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "no-tls-tickets"
15139 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
15140 default value.
Lukas Tribusbdb386d2020-03-10 00:56:09 +010015141 The TLS ticket mechanism is only used up to TLS 1.2.
15142 Forward Secrecy is compromised with TLS tickets, unless ticket keys
15143 are periodically rotated (via reload or by using "tls-ticket-keys").
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010015144 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
Bjoern Jacke5ab7eb62020-02-13 14:16:16 +010015145 "default-server" "no-tls-tickets" setting.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010015146
Emeric Brunef42d922012-10-11 16:11:36 +020015147verify [none|required]
15148 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. If set
Emeric Brun850efd52014-01-29 12:24:34 +010015149 to 'none', server certificate is not verified. In the other case, The
Willy Tarreauad92a9a2017-07-28 11:38:41 +020015150 certificate provided by the server is verified using CAs from 'ca-file' and
15151 optional CRLs from 'crl-file' after having checked that the names provided in
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015152 the certificate's subject and subjectAlternateNames attributes match either
Willy Tarreauad92a9a2017-07-28 11:38:41 +020015153 the name passed using the "sni" directive, or if not provided, the static
15154 host name passed using the "verifyhost" directive. When no name is found, the
15155 certificate's names are ignored. For this reason, without SNI it's important
15156 to use "verifyhost". On verification failure the handshake is aborted. It is
15157 critically important to verify server certificates when using SSL to connect
15158 to servers, otherwise the communication is prone to trivial man-in-the-middle
15159 attacks rendering SSL totally useless. Unless "ssl_server_verify" appears in
15160 the global section, "verify" is set to "required" by default.
Emeric Brunef42d922012-10-11 16:11:36 +020015161
Evan Broderbe554312013-06-27 00:05:25 -070015162verifyhost <hostname>
15163 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in, and
Willy Tarreauad92a9a2017-07-28 11:38:41 +020015164 only takes effect if 'verify required' is also specified. This directive sets
15165 a default static hostname to check the server's certificate against when no
15166 SNI was used to connect to the server. If SNI is not used, this is the only
15167 way to enable hostname verification. This static hostname, when set, will
15168 also be used for health checks (which cannot provide an SNI value). If none
15169 of the hostnames in the certificate match the specified hostname, the
15170 handshake is aborted. The hostnames in the server-provided certificate may
15171 include wildcards. See also "verify", "sni" and "no-verifyhost" options.
Evan Broderbe554312013-06-27 00:05:25 -070015172
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010015173weight <weight>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020015174 The "weight" parameter is used to adjust the server's weight relative to
15175 other servers. All servers will receive a load proportional to their weight
15176 relative to the sum of all weights, so the higher the weight, the higher the
Willy Tarreau6704d672009-06-15 10:56:05 +020015177 load. The default weight is 1, and the maximal value is 256. A value of 0
15178 means the server will not participate in load-balancing but will still accept
15179 persistent connections. If this parameter is used to distribute the load
15180 according to server's capacity, it is recommended to start with values which
15181 can both grow and shrink, for instance between 10 and 100 to leave enough
15182 room above and below for later adjustments.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020015183
Amaury Denoyelle69352ec2021-10-18 14:40:29 +020015184ws { auto | h1 | h2 }
15185 This option allows to configure the protocol used when relaying websocket
15186 streams. This is most notably useful when using an HTTP/2 backend without the
15187 support for H2 websockets through the RFC8441.
15188
15189 The default mode is "auto". This will reuse the same protocol as the main
15190 one. The only difference is when using ALPN. In this case, it can try to
15191 downgrade the ALPN to "http/1.1" only for websocket streams if the configured
15192 server ALPN contains it.
15193
15194 The value "h1" is used to force HTTP/1.1 for websockets streams, through ALPN
15195 if SSL ALPN is activated for the server. Similarly, "h2" can be used to
15196 force HTTP/2.0 websockets. Use this value with care : the server must support
15197 RFC8441 or an error will be reported by haproxy when relaying websockets.
15198
15199 Note that NPN is not taken into account as its usage has been deprecated in
15200 favor of the ALPN extension.
15201
15202 See also "alpn" and "proto".
15203
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020015204
Cyril Bonté46175dd2015-07-02 22:45:32 +0200152055.3. Server IP address resolution using DNS
15206-------------------------------------------
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020015207
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020015208HAProxy allows using a host name on the server line to retrieve its IP address
15209using name servers. By default, HAProxy resolves the name when parsing the
Thayne McCombscdbcca92021-01-07 21:24:41 -070015210configuration file, at startup and cache the result for the process's life.
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020015211This is not sufficient in some cases, such as in Amazon where a server's IP
15212can change after a reboot or an ELB Virtual IP can change based on current
15213workload.
15214This chapter describes how HAProxy can be configured to process server's name
15215resolution at run time.
15216Whether run time server name resolution has been enable or not, HAProxy will
15217carry on doing the first resolution when parsing the configuration.
15218
15219
Cyril Bonté46175dd2015-07-02 22:45:32 +0200152205.3.1. Global overview
15221----------------------
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020015222
15223As we've seen in introduction, name resolution in HAProxy occurs at two
15224different steps of the process life:
15225
15226 1. when starting up, HAProxy parses the server line definition and matches a
15227 host name. It uses libc functions to get the host name resolved. This
15228 resolution relies on /etc/resolv.conf file.
15229
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020015230 2. at run time, HAProxy performs periodically name resolutions for servers
15231 requiring DNS resolutions.
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020015232
15233A few other events can trigger a name resolution at run time:
15234 - when a server's health check ends up in a connection timeout: this may be
15235 because the server has a new IP address. So we need to trigger a name
15236 resolution to know this new IP.
15237
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020015238When using resolvers, the server name can either be a hostname, or a SRV label.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015239HAProxy considers anything that starts with an underscore as a SRV label. If a
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020015240SRV label is specified, then the corresponding SRV records will be retrieved
15241from the DNS server, and the provided hostnames will be used. The SRV label
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040015242will be checked periodically, and if any server are added or removed, HAProxy
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020015243will automatically do the same.
Olivier Houchardecfa18d2017-08-07 17:30:03 +020015244
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020015245A few things important to notice:
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050015246 - all the name servers are queried in the meantime. HAProxy will process the
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020015247 first valid response.
15248
15249 - a resolution is considered as invalid (NX, timeout, refused), when all the
15250 servers return an error.
15251
15252
Cyril Bonté46175dd2015-07-02 22:45:32 +0200152535.3.2. The resolvers section
15254----------------------------
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020015255
15256This section is dedicated to host information related to name resolution in
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020015257HAProxy. There can be as many as resolvers section as needed. Each section can
15258contain many name servers.
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020015259
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020015260When multiple name servers are configured in a resolvers section, then HAProxy
15261uses the first valid response. In case of invalid responses, only the last one
15262is treated. Purpose is to give the chance to a slow server to deliver a valid
15263answer after a fast faulty or outdated server.
15264
15265When each server returns a different error type, then only the last error is
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020015266used by HAProxy. The following processing is applied on this error:
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020015267
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020015268 1. HAProxy retries the same DNS query with a new query type. The A queries are
15269 switch to AAAA or the opposite. SRV queries are not concerned here. Timeout
15270 errors are also excluded.
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020015271
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020015272 2. When the fallback on the query type was done (or not applicable), HAProxy
15273 retries the original DNS query, with the preferred query type.
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020015274
Thierry Fournierfc13f792021-12-15 19:03:52 +010015275 3. HAProxy retries previous steps <resolve_retries> times. If no valid
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020015276 response is received after that, it stops the DNS resolution and reports
15277 the error.
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020015278
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020015279For example, with 2 name servers configured in a resolvers section, the
15280following scenarios are possible:
15281
15282 - First response is valid and is applied directly, second response is
15283 ignored
15284
15285 - First response is invalid and second one is valid, then second response is
15286 applied
15287
15288 - First response is a NX domain and second one a truncated response, then
15289 HAProxy retries the query with a new type
15290
15291 - First response is a NX domain and second one is a timeout, then HAProxy
15292 retries the query with a new type
15293
15294 - Query timed out for both name servers, then HAProxy retries it with the
15295 same query type
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020015296
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040015297As a DNS server may not answer all the IPs in one DNS request, HAProxy keeps
Olivier Houcharda8c6db82017-07-06 18:46:47 +020015298a cache of previous answers, an answer will be considered obsolete after
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020015299<hold obsolete> seconds without the IP returned.
Olivier Houcharda8c6db82017-07-06 18:46:47 +020015300
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020015301
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020015302resolvers <resolvers id>
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015303 Creates a new name server list labeled <resolvers id>
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020015304
15305A resolvers section accept the following parameters:
15306
Baptiste Assmann2af08fe2017-08-14 00:13:01 +020015307accepted_payload_size <nb>
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015308 Defines the maximum payload size accepted by HAProxy and announced to all the
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020015309 name servers configured in this resolvers section.
Baptiste Assmann2af08fe2017-08-14 00:13:01 +020015310 <nb> is in bytes. If not set, HAProxy announces 512. (minimal value defined
15311 by RFC 6891)
15312
Emeric Brun4c751952021-03-08 16:41:29 +010015313 Note: the maximum allowed value is 65535. Recommended value for UDP is
15314 4096 and it is not recommended to exceed 8192 except if you are sure
15315 that your system and network can handle this (over 65507 makes no sense
15316 since is the maximum UDP payload size). If you are using only TCP
15317 nameservers to handle huge DNS responses, you should put this value
15318 to the max: 65535.
Baptiste Assmann9d8dbbc2017-08-18 23:35:08 +020015319
Emeric Brunc8f3e452021-04-07 16:04:54 +020015320nameserver <name> <address>[:port] [param*]
15321 Used to configure a nameserver. <name> of the nameserver should ne unique.
15322 By default the <address> is considered of type datagram. This means if an
15323 IPv4 or IPv6 is configured without special address prefixes (paragraph 11.)
15324 the UDP protocol will be used. If an stream protocol address prefix is used,
15325 the nameserver will be considered as a stream server (TCP for instance) and
15326 "server" parameters found in 5.2 paragraph which are relevant for DNS
15327 resolving will be considered. Note: currently, in TCP mode, 4 queries are
15328 pipelined on the same connections. A batch of idle connections are removed
15329 every 5 seconds. "maxconn" can be configured to limit the amount of those
Emeric Brun56fc5d92021-02-12 20:05:45 +010015330 concurrent connections and TLS should also usable if the server supports.
15331
Ben Draut44e609b2018-05-29 15:40:08 -060015332parse-resolv-conf
15333 Adds all nameservers found in /etc/resolv.conf to this resolvers nameservers
15334 list. Ordered as if each nameserver in /etc/resolv.conf was individually
15335 placed in the resolvers section in place of this directive.
15336
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020015337hold <status> <period>
Christopher Fauletcd978582023-02-27 17:53:31 +010015338 Upon receiving the DNS response <status>, determines whether a server's state
15339 should change from UP to DOWN. To make that determination, it checks whether
15340 any valid status has been received during the past <period> in order to
15341 counteract the just received invalid status.
15342
15343 <status> : last name resolution status.
15344 nx After receiving an NXDOMAIN status, check for any valid
15345 status during the concluding period.
15346
15347 refused After receiving a REFUSED status, check for any valid
15348 status during the concluding period.
15349
15350 timeout After the "timeout retry" has struck, check for any
15351 valid status during the concluding period.
15352
15353 other After receiving any other invalid status, check for any
15354 valid status during the concluding period.
15355
15356 valid Applies only to "http-request do-resolve" and
15357 "tcp-request content do-resolve" actions. It defines the
15358 period for which the server will maintain a valid response
15359 before triggering another resolution. It does not affect
15360 dynamic resolution of servers.
15361
15362 obsolete Defines how long to wait before removing obsolete DNS
15363 records after an updated answer record is received. It
15364 applies to SRV records.
15365
15366 <period> : Amount of time into the past during which a valid response must
15367 have been received. It follows the HAProxy time format and is in
15368 milliseconds by default.
15369
15370 For a server that relies on dynamic DNS resolution to determine its IP
15371 address, receiving an invalid DNS response, such as NXDOMAIN, will lead to
15372 changing the server's state from UP to DOWN. The hold directives define how
15373 far into the past to look for a valid response. If a valid response has been
15374 received within <period>, the just received invalid status will be ignored.
15375
15376 Unless a valid response has been receiving during the concluding period, the
15377 server will be marked as DOWN. For example, if "hold nx 30s" is set and the
15378 last received DNS response was NXDOMAIN, the server will be marked DOWN
15379 unless a valid response has been received during the last 30 seconds.
15380
15381 A server in the DOWN state will be marked UP immediately upon receiving a
15382 valid status from the DNS server.
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020015383
Christopher Fauletcd978582023-02-27 17:53:31 +010015384 A separate behavior exists for "hold valid" and "hold obsolete".
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020015385
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020015386resolve_retries <nb>
15387 Defines the number <nb> of queries to send to resolve a server name before
15388 giving up.
15389 Default value: 3
15390
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020015391 A retry occurs on name server timeout or when the full sequence of DNS query
15392 type failover is over and we need to start up from the default ANY query
15393 type.
15394
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020015395timeout <event> <time>
15396 Defines timeouts related to name resolution
15397 <event> : the event on which the <time> timeout period applies to.
15398 events available are:
Frédéric Lécaille93d33162019-03-06 09:35:59 +010015399 - resolve : default time to trigger name resolutions when no
15400 other time applied.
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020015401 Default value: 1s
15402 - retry : time between two DNS queries, when no valid response
Frédéric Lécaille93d33162019-03-06 09:35:59 +010015403 have been received.
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020015404 Default value: 1s
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020015405 <time> : time related to the event. It follows the HAProxy time format.
15406 <time> is expressed in milliseconds.
15407
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +020015408 Example:
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020015409
15410 resolvers mydns
15411 nameserver dns1 10.0.0.1:53
15412 nameserver dns2 10.0.0.2:53
Emeric Brunc8f3e452021-04-07 16:04:54 +020015413 nameserver dns3 tcp@10.0.0.3:53
Ben Draut44e609b2018-05-29 15:40:08 -060015414 parse-resolv-conf
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020015415 resolve_retries 3
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020015416 timeout resolve 1s
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020015417 timeout retry 1s
Baptiste Assmann987e16d2016-11-02 22:23:31 +010015418 hold other 30s
15419 hold refused 30s
15420 hold nx 30s
15421 hold timeout 30s
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020015422 hold valid 10s
Olivier Houcharda8c6db82017-07-06 18:46:47 +020015423 hold obsolete 30s
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020015424
15425
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +0200154266. Cache
15427---------
15428
15429HAProxy provides a cache, which was designed to perform cache on small objects
15430(favicon, css...). This is a minimalist low-maintenance cache which runs in
15431RAM.
15432
15433The cache is based on a memory which is shared between processes and threads,
15434this memory is split in blocks of 1k.
15435
15436If an object is not used anymore, it can be deleted to store a new object
15437independently of its expiration date. The oldest objects are deleted first
15438when we try to allocate a new one.
15439
15440The cache uses a hash of the host header and the URI as the key.
15441
15442It's possible to view the status of a cache using the Unix socket command
15443"show cache" consult section 9.3 "Unix Socket commands" of Management Guide
15444for more details.
15445
15446When an object is delivered from the cache, the server name in the log is
15447replaced by "<CACHE>".
15448
15449
154506.1. Limitation
15451----------------
15452
15453The cache won't store and won't deliver objects in these cases:
15454
15455- If the response is not a 200
Remi Tricot-Le Breton4f730832020-11-26 15:51:50 +010015456- If the response contains a Vary header and either the process-vary option is
15457 disabled, or a currently unmanaged header is specified in the Vary value (only
15458 accept-encoding and referer are managed for now)
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +020015459- If the Content-Length + the headers size is greater than "max-object-size"
15460- If the response is not cacheable
Remi Tricot-Le Bretond493bc82020-11-26 15:51:29 +010015461- If the response does not have an explicit expiration time (s-maxage or max-age
15462 Cache-Control directives or Expires header) or a validator (ETag or Last-Modified
15463 headers)
Remi Tricot-Le Breton5853c0c2020-12-10 17:58:43 +010015464- If the process-vary option is enabled and there are already max-secondary-entries
15465 entries with the same primary key as the current response
Remi Tricot-Le Breton6ca89162021-01-07 14:50:51 +010015466- If the process-vary option is enabled and the response has an unknown encoding (not
15467 mentioned in https://www.iana.org/assignments/http-parameters/http-parameters.xhtml)
15468 while varying on the accept-encoding client header
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +020015469
15470- If the request is not a GET
15471- If the HTTP version of the request is smaller than 1.1
15472- If the request contains an Authorization header
15473
15474
154756.2. Setup
15476-----------
15477
15478To setup a cache, you must define a cache section and use it in a proxy with
15479the corresponding http-request and response actions.
15480
15481
154826.2.1. Cache section
15483---------------------
15484
15485cache <name>
15486 Declare a cache section, allocate a shared cache memory named <name>, the
15487 size of cache is mandatory.
15488
15489total-max-size <megabytes>
15490 Define the size in RAM of the cache in megabytes. This size is split in
15491 blocks of 1kB which are used by the cache entries. Its maximum value is 4095.
15492
15493max-object-size <bytes>
15494 Define the maximum size of the objects to be cached. Must not be greater than
15495 an half of "total-max-size". If not set, it equals to a 256th of the cache size.
15496 All objects with sizes larger than "max-object-size" will not be cached.
15497
15498max-age <seconds>
Remi Tricot-Le Breton5853c0c2020-12-10 17:58:43 +010015499 Define the maximum expiration duration. The expiration is set as the lowest
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +020015500 value between the s-maxage or max-age (in this order) directive in the
15501 Cache-Control response header and this value. The default value is 60
15502 seconds, which means that you can't cache an object more than 60 seconds by
15503 default.
15504
Remi Tricot-Le Bretone6cc5b52020-12-23 18:13:53 +010015505process-vary <on/off>
15506 Enable or disable the processing of the Vary header. When disabled, a response
Remi Tricot-Le Breton754b2422020-11-16 15:56:10 +010015507 containing such a header will never be cached. When enabled, we need to calculate
15508 a preliminary hash for a subset of request headers on all the incoming requests
15509 (which might come with a cpu cost) which will be used to build a secondary key
Remi Tricot-Le Bretone6cc5b52020-12-23 18:13:53 +010015510 for a given request (see RFC 7234#4.1). The default value is off (disabled).
Remi Tricot-Le Breton754b2422020-11-16 15:56:10 +010015511
Remi Tricot-Le Breton5853c0c2020-12-10 17:58:43 +010015512max-secondary-entries <number>
15513 Define the maximum number of simultaneous secondary entries with the same primary
15514 key in the cache. This needs the vary support to be enabled. Its default value is 10
15515 and should be passed a strictly positive integer.
15516
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +020015517
155186.2.2. Proxy section
15519---------------------
15520
15521http-request cache-use <name> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
15522 Try to deliver a cached object from the cache <name>. This directive is also
15523 mandatory to store the cache as it calculates the cache hash. If you want to
15524 use a condition for both storage and delivering that's a good idea to put it
15525 after this one.
15526
15527http-response cache-store <name> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
15528 Store an http-response within the cache. The storage of the response headers
15529 is done at this step, which means you can use others http-response actions
15530 to modify headers before or after the storage of the response. This action
15531 is responsible for the setup of the cache storage filter.
15532
15533
15534Example:
15535
15536 backend bck1
15537 mode http
15538
15539 http-request cache-use foobar
15540 http-response cache-store foobar
15541 server srv1 127.0.0.1:80
15542
15543 cache foobar
15544 total-max-size 4
15545 max-age 240
15546
15547
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200155487. Using ACLs and fetching samples
15549----------------------------------
15550
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015551HAProxy is capable of extracting data from request or response streams, from
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015552client or server information, from tables, environmental information etc...
15553The action of extracting such data is called fetching a sample. Once retrieved,
15554these samples may be used for various purposes such as a key to a stick-table,
15555but most common usages consist in matching them against predefined constant
15556data called patterns.
15557
15558
155597.1. ACL basics
15560---------------
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020015561
15562The use of Access Control Lists (ACL) provides a flexible solution to perform
15563content switching and generally to take decisions based on content extracted
15564from the request, the response or any environmental status. The principle is
15565simple :
15566
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015567 - extract a data sample from a stream, table or the environment
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +010015568 - optionally apply some format conversion to the extracted sample
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015569 - apply one or multiple pattern matching methods on this sample
15570 - perform actions only when a pattern matches the sample
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020015571
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015572The actions generally consist in blocking a request, selecting a backend, or
15573adding a header.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020015574
15575In order to define a test, the "acl" keyword is used. The syntax is :
15576
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015577 acl <aclname> <criterion> [flags] [operator] [<value>] ...
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020015578
15579This creates a new ACL <aclname> or completes an existing one with new tests.
15580Those tests apply to the portion of request/response specified in <criterion>
15581and may be adjusted with optional flags [flags]. Some criteria also support
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +010015582an operator which may be specified before the set of values. Optionally some
15583conversion operators may be applied to the sample, and they will be specified
15584as a comma-delimited list of keywords just after the first keyword. The values
15585are of the type supported by the criterion, and are separated by spaces.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020015586
15587ACL names must be formed from upper and lower case letters, digits, '-' (dash),
15588'_' (underscore) , '.' (dot) and ':' (colon). ACL names are case-sensitive,
15589which means that "my_acl" and "My_Acl" are two different ACLs.
15590
15591There is no enforced limit to the number of ACLs. The unused ones do not affect
15592performance, they just consume a small amount of memory.
15593
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015594The criterion generally is the name of a sample fetch method, or one of its ACL
15595specific declinations. The default test method is implied by the output type of
15596this sample fetch method. The ACL declinations can describe alternate matching
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +010015597methods of a same sample fetch method. The sample fetch methods are the only
15598ones supporting a conversion.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015599
15600Sample fetch methods return data which can be of the following types :
15601 - boolean
15602 - integer (signed or unsigned)
15603 - IPv4 or IPv6 address
15604 - string
15605 - data block
15606
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +010015607Converters transform any of these data into any of these. For example, some
15608converters might convert a string to a lower-case string while other ones
15609would turn a string to an IPv4 address, or apply a netmask to an IP address.
15610The resulting sample is of the type of the last converter applied to the list,
15611which defaults to the type of the sample fetch method.
15612
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +020015613Each sample or converter returns data of a specific type, specified with its
15614keyword in this documentation. When an ACL is declared using a standard sample
15615fetch method, certain types automatically involved a default matching method
15616which are summarized in the table below :
15617
15618 +---------------------+-----------------+
15619 | Sample or converter | Default |
15620 | output type | matching method |
15621 +---------------------+-----------------+
15622 | boolean | bool |
15623 +---------------------+-----------------+
15624 | integer | int |
15625 +---------------------+-----------------+
15626 | ip | ip |
15627 +---------------------+-----------------+
15628 | string | str |
15629 +---------------------+-----------------+
15630 | binary | none, use "-m" |
15631 +---------------------+-----------------+
15632
15633Note that in order to match a binary samples, it is mandatory to specify a
15634matching method, see below.
15635
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015636The ACL engine can match these types against patterns of the following types :
15637 - boolean
15638 - integer or integer range
15639 - IP address / network
15640 - string (exact, substring, suffix, prefix, subdir, domain)
15641 - regular expression
15642 - hex block
15643
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020015644The following ACL flags are currently supported :
15645
Willy Tarreau2b5285d2010-05-09 23:45:24 +020015646 -i : ignore case during matching of all subsequent patterns.
15647 -f : load patterns from a file.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015648 -m : use a specific pattern matching method
Thierry FOURNIERb7729c92014-02-11 16:24:41 +010015649 -n : forbid the DNS resolutions
Thierry FOURNIER9860c412014-01-29 14:23:29 +010015650 -M : load the file pointed by -f like a map file.
Thierry FOURNIER3534d882014-01-20 17:01:44 +010015651 -u : force the unique id of the ACL
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020015652 -- : force end of flags. Useful when a string looks like one of the flags.
15653
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015654The "-f" flag is followed by the name of a file from which all lines will be
15655read as individual values. It is even possible to pass multiple "-f" arguments
15656if the patterns are to be loaded from multiple files. Empty lines as well as
15657lines beginning with a sharp ('#') will be ignored. All leading spaces and tabs
15658will be stripped. If it is absolutely necessary to insert a valid pattern
15659beginning with a sharp, just prefix it with a space so that it is not taken for
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040015660a comment. Depending on the data type and match method, HAProxy may load the
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015661lines into a binary tree, allowing very fast lookups. This is true for IPv4 and
15662exact string matching. In this case, duplicates will automatically be removed.
15663
Thierry FOURNIER9860c412014-01-29 14:23:29 +010015664The "-M" flag allows an ACL to use a map file. If this flag is set, the file is
15665parsed as two column file. The first column contains the patterns used by the
15666ACL, and the second column contain the samples. The sample can be used later by
15667a map. This can be useful in some rare cases where an ACL would just be used to
15668check for the existence of a pattern in a map before a mapping is applied.
15669
Thierry FOURNIER3534d882014-01-20 17:01:44 +010015670The "-u" flag forces the unique id of the ACL. This unique id is used with the
15671socket interface to identify ACL and dynamically change its values. Note that a
15672file is always identified by its name even if an id is set.
15673
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015674Also, note that the "-i" flag applies to subsequent entries and not to entries
15675loaded from files preceding it. For instance :
15676
15677 acl valid-ua hdr(user-agent) -f exact-ua.lst -i -f generic-ua.lst test
15678
15679In this example, each line of "exact-ua.lst" will be exactly matched against
15680the "user-agent" header of the request. Then each line of "generic-ua" will be
15681case-insensitively matched. Then the word "test" will be insensitively matched
15682as well.
15683
15684The "-m" flag is used to select a specific pattern matching method on the input
15685sample. All ACL-specific criteria imply a pattern matching method and generally
15686do not need this flag. However, this flag is useful with generic sample fetch
15687methods to describe how they're going to be matched against the patterns. This
15688is required for sample fetches which return data type for which there is no
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015689obvious matching method (e.g. string or binary). When "-m" is specified and
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015690followed by a pattern matching method name, this method is used instead of the
15691default one for the criterion. This makes it possible to match contents in ways
15692that were not initially planned, or with sample fetch methods which return a
15693string. The matching method also affects the way the patterns are parsed.
15694
Thierry FOURNIERb7729c92014-02-11 16:24:41 +010015695The "-n" flag forbids the dns resolutions. It is used with the load of ip files.
15696By default, if the parser cannot parse ip address it considers that the parsed
15697string is maybe a domain name and try dns resolution. The flag "-n" disable this
15698resolution. It is useful for detecting malformed ip lists. Note that if the DNS
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040015699server is not reachable, the HAProxy configuration parsing may last many minutes
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050015700waiting for the timeout. During this time no error messages are displayed. The
Thierry FOURNIERb7729c92014-02-11 16:24:41 +010015701flag "-n" disable this behavior. Note also that during the runtime, this
15702function is disabled for the dynamic acl modifications.
15703
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015704There are some restrictions however. Not all methods can be used with all
15705sample fetch methods. Also, if "-m" is used in conjunction with "-f", it must
15706be placed first. The pattern matching method must be one of the following :
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020015707
15708 - "found" : only check if the requested sample could be found in the stream,
15709 but do not compare it against any pattern. It is recommended not
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015710 to pass any pattern to avoid confusion. This matching method is
15711 particularly useful to detect presence of certain contents such
15712 as headers, cookies, etc... even if they are empty and without
15713 comparing them to anything nor counting them.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020015714
15715 - "bool" : check the value as a boolean. It can only be applied to fetches
15716 which return a boolean or integer value, and takes no pattern.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015717 Value zero or false does not match, all other values do match.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020015718
15719 - "int" : match the value as an integer. It can be used with integer and
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015720 boolean samples. Boolean false is integer 0, true is integer 1.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020015721
15722 - "ip" : match the value as an IPv4 or IPv6 address. It is compatible
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015723 with IP address samples only, so it is implied and never needed.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020015724
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015725 - "bin" : match the contents against a hexadecimal string representing a
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020015726 binary sequence. This may be used with binary or string samples.
15727
15728 - "len" : match the sample's length as an integer. This may be used with
15729 binary or string samples.
15730
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015731 - "str" : exact match : match the contents against a string. This may be
15732 used with binary or string samples.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020015733
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015734 - "sub" : substring match : check that the contents contain at least one of
15735 the provided string patterns. This may be used with binary or
15736 string samples.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020015737
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015738 - "reg" : regex match : match the contents against a list of regular
15739 expressions. This may be used with binary or string samples.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020015740
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015741 - "beg" : prefix match : check that the contents begin like the provided
15742 string patterns. This may be used with binary or string samples.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020015743
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015744 - "end" : suffix match : check that the contents end like the provided
15745 string patterns. This may be used with binary or string samples.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020015746
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015747 - "dir" : subdir match : check that a slash-delimited portion of the
15748 contents exactly matches one of the provided string patterns.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020015749 This may be used with binary or string samples.
15750
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015751 - "dom" : domain match : check that a dot-delimited portion of the contents
15752 exactly match one of the provided string patterns. This may be
15753 used with binary or string samples.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020015754
15755For example, to quickly detect the presence of cookie "JSESSIONID" in an HTTP
15756request, it is possible to do :
15757
Christian Ruppertfd3184c2022-02-20 22:54:01 +010015758 acl jsess_present req.cook(JSESSIONID) -m found
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020015759
15760In order to apply a regular expression on the 500 first bytes of data in the
15761buffer, one would use the following acl :
15762
Christian Ruppertfd3184c2022-02-20 22:54:01 +010015763 acl script_tag req.payload(0,500) -m reg -i <script>
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020015764
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +010015765On systems where the regex library is much slower when using "-i", it is
15766possible to convert the sample to lowercase before matching, like this :
15767
Christian Ruppertfd3184c2022-02-20 22:54:01 +010015768 acl script_tag req.payload(0,500),lower -m reg <script>
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +010015769
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015770All ACL-specific criteria imply a default matching method. Most often, these
15771criteria are composed by concatenating the name of the original sample fetch
15772method and the matching method. For example, "hdr_beg" applies the "beg" match
Willy Tarreauedbeab12022-11-25 10:49:41 +010015773to samples retrieved using the "hdr" fetch method. This matching method is only
15774usable when the keyword is used alone, without any converter. In case any such
15775converter were to be applied after such an ACL keyword, the default matching
15776method from the ACL keyword is simply ignored since what will matter for the
15777matching is the output type of the last converter. Since all ACL-specific
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015778criteria rely on a sample fetch method, it is always possible instead to use
15779the original sample fetch method and the explicit matching method using "-m".
Willy Tarreau2b5285d2010-05-09 23:45:24 +020015780
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015781If an alternate match is specified using "-m" on an ACL-specific criterion,
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030015782the matching method is simply applied to the underlying sample fetch method.
15783For example, all ACLs below are exact equivalent :
Willy Tarreau2b5285d2010-05-09 23:45:24 +020015784
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015785 acl short_form hdr_beg(host) www.
15786 acl alternate1 hdr_beg(host) -m beg www.
15787 acl alternate2 hdr_dom(host) -m beg www.
15788 acl alternate3 hdr(host) -m beg www.
Willy Tarreau2b5285d2010-05-09 23:45:24 +020015789
Willy Tarreau2b5285d2010-05-09 23:45:24 +020015790
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +020015791The table below summarizes the compatibility matrix between sample or converter
15792types and the pattern types to fetch against. It indicates for each compatible
15793combination the name of the matching method to be used, surrounded with angle
15794brackets ">" and "<" when the method is the default one and will work by
15795default without "-m".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010015796
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015797 +-------------------------------------------------+
15798 | Input sample type |
15799 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +020015800 | pattern type | boolean | integer | ip | string | binary |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015801 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
15802 | none (presence only) | found | found | found | found | found |
15803 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +020015804 | none (boolean value) |> bool <| bool | | bool | |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015805 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +020015806 | integer (value) | int |> int <| int | int | |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015807 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +010015808 | integer (length) | len | len | len | len | len |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015809 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +020015810 | IP address | | |> ip <| ip | ip |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015811 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +020015812 | exact string | str | str | str |> str <| str |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015813 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +010015814 | prefix | beg | beg | beg | beg | beg |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015815 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +010015816 | suffix | end | end | end | end | end |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015817 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +010015818 | substring | sub | sub | sub | sub | sub |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015819 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +010015820 | subdir | dir | dir | dir | dir | dir |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015821 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +010015822 | domain | dom | dom | dom | dom | dom |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015823 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +010015824 | regex | reg | reg | reg | reg | reg |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015825 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
15826 | hex block | | | | bin | bin |
15827 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020015828
15829
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200158307.1.1. Matching booleans
15831------------------------
15832
15833In order to match a boolean, no value is needed and all values are ignored.
15834Boolean matching is used by default for all fetch methods of type "boolean".
15835When boolean matching is used, the fetched value is returned as-is, which means
15836that a boolean "true" will always match and a boolean "false" will never match.
15837
15838Boolean matching may also be enforced using "-m bool" on fetch methods which
15839return an integer value. Then, integer value 0 is converted to the boolean
15840"false" and all other values are converted to "true".
15841
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020015842
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200158437.1.2. Matching integers
15844------------------------
15845
15846Integer matching applies by default to integer fetch methods. It can also be
15847enforced on boolean fetches using "-m int". In this case, "false" is converted
15848to the integer 0, and "true" is converted to the integer 1.
15849
15850Integer matching also supports integer ranges and operators. Note that integer
15851matching only applies to positive values. A range is a value expressed with a
15852lower and an upper bound separated with a colon, both of which may be omitted.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020015853
15854For instance, "1024:65535" is a valid range to represent a range of
15855unprivileged ports, and "1024:" would also work. "0:1023" is a valid
15856representation of privileged ports, and ":1023" would also work.
15857
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020015858As a special case, some ACL functions support decimal numbers which are in fact
15859two integers separated by a dot. This is used with some version checks for
15860instance. All integer properties apply to those decimal numbers, including
15861ranges and operators.
15862
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020015863For an easier usage, comparison operators are also supported. Note that using
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010015864operators with ranges does not make much sense and is strongly discouraged.
15865Similarly, it does not make much sense to perform order comparisons with a set
15866of values.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020015867
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010015868Available operators for integer matching are :
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020015869
15870 eq : true if the tested value equals at least one value
15871 ge : true if the tested value is greater than or equal to at least one value
15872 gt : true if the tested value is greater than at least one value
15873 le : true if the tested value is less than or equal to at least one value
15874 lt : true if the tested value is less than at least one value
15875
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010015876For instance, the following ACL matches any negative Content-Length header :
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020015877
Christian Ruppertfd3184c2022-02-20 22:54:01 +010015878 acl negative-length req.hdr_val(content-length) lt 0
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020015879
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020015880This one matches SSL versions between 3.0 and 3.1 (inclusive) :
15881
Christian Ruppertfd3184c2022-02-20 22:54:01 +010015882 acl sslv3 req.ssl_ver 3:3.1
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020015883
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020015884
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200158857.1.3. Matching strings
15886-----------------------
15887
15888String matching applies to string or binary fetch methods, and exists in 6
15889different forms :
15890
15891 - exact match (-m str) : the extracted string must exactly match the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015892 patterns;
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015893
15894 - substring match (-m sub) : the patterns are looked up inside the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015895 extracted string, and the ACL matches if any of them is found inside;
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015896
15897 - prefix match (-m beg) : the patterns are compared with the beginning of
15898 the extracted string, and the ACL matches if any of them matches.
15899
15900 - suffix match (-m end) : the patterns are compared with the end of the
15901 extracted string, and the ACL matches if any of them matches.
15902
Willy Tarreau71e58732022-11-25 12:02:25 +010015903 - subdir match (-m dir) : the patterns are looked up anywhere inside the
15904 extracted string, delimited with slashes ("/"), the beginning or the end
15905 of the string. The ACL matches if any of them matches. As such, the string
15906 "/images/png/logo/32x32.png", would match "/images", "/images/png",
15907 "images/png", "/png/logo", "logo/32x32.png" or "32x32.png" but not "png"
15908 nor "32x32".
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015909
Willy Tarreau71e58732022-11-25 12:02:25 +010015910 - domain match (-m dom) : the patterns are looked up anywhere inside the
15911 extracted string, delimited with dots ("."), colons (":"), slashes ("/"),
15912 question marks ("?"), the beginning or the end of the string. This is made
15913 to be used with URLs. Leading and trailing delimiters in the pattern are
15914 ignored. The ACL matches if any of them matches. As such, in the example
15915 string "http://www1.dc-eu.example.com:80/blah", the patterns "http",
15916 "www1", ".www1", "dc-eu", "example", "com", "80", "dc-eu.example",
15917 "blah", ":www1:", "dc-eu.example:80" would match, but not "eu" nor "dc".
15918 Using it to match domain suffixes for filtering or routing is generally
15919 not a good idea, as the routing could easily be fooled by prepending the
15920 matching prefix in front of another domain for example.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020015921
15922String matching applies to verbatim strings as they are passed, with the
15923exception of the backslash ("\") which makes it possible to escape some
15924characters such as the space. If the "-i" flag is passed before the first
15925string, then the matching will be performed ignoring the case. In order
15926to match the string "-i", either set it second, or pass the "--" flag
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010015927before the first string. Same applies of course to match the string "--".
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020015928
Mathias Weiersmuellercb250fc2019-12-02 09:43:40 +010015929Do not use string matches for binary fetches which might contain null bytes
15930(0x00), as the comparison stops at the occurrence of the first null byte.
15931Instead, convert the binary fetch to a hex string with the hex converter first.
15932
15933Example:
15934 # matches if the string <tag> is present in the binary sample
15935 acl tag_found req.payload(0,0),hex -m sub 3C7461673E
15936
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020015937
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200159387.1.4. Matching regular expressions (regexes)
15939---------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020015940
15941Just like with string matching, regex matching applies to verbatim strings as
15942they are passed, with the exception of the backslash ("\") which makes it
15943possible to escape some characters such as the space. If the "-i" flag is
15944passed before the first regex, then the matching will be performed ignoring
15945the case. In order to match the string "-i", either set it second, or pass
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010015946the "--" flag before the first string. Same principle applies of course to
15947match the string "--".
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020015948
15949
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200159507.1.5. Matching arbitrary data blocks
15951-------------------------------------
15952
15953It is possible to match some extracted samples against a binary block which may
15954not safely be represented as a string. For this, the patterns must be passed as
15955a series of hexadecimal digits in an even number, when the match method is set
15956to binary. Each sequence of two digits will represent a byte. The hexadecimal
15957digits may be used upper or lower case.
15958
15959Example :
15960 # match "Hello\n" in the input stream (\x48 \x65 \x6c \x6c \x6f \x0a)
Christian Ruppertfd3184c2022-02-20 22:54:01 +010015961 acl hello req.payload(0,6) -m bin 48656c6c6f0a
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015962
15963
159647.1.6. Matching IPv4 and IPv6 addresses
15965---------------------------------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020015966
15967IPv4 addresses values can be specified either as plain addresses or with a
15968netmask appended, in which case the IPv4 address matches whenever it is
15969within the network. Plain addresses may also be replaced with a resolvable
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +010015970host name, but this practice is generally discouraged as it makes it more
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010015971difficult to read and debug configurations. If hostnames are used, you should
15972at least ensure that they are present in /etc/hosts so that the configuration
15973does not depend on any random DNS match at the moment the configuration is
15974parsed.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020015975
Daniel Schnellereba56342016-04-13 00:26:52 +020015976The dotted IPv4 address notation is supported in both regular as well as the
15977abbreviated form with all-0-octets omitted:
15978
15979 +------------------+------------------+------------------+
15980 | Example 1 | Example 2 | Example 3 |
15981 +------------------+------------------+------------------+
15982 | 192.168.0.1 | 10.0.0.12 | 127.0.0.1 |
15983 | 192.168.1 | 10.12 | 127.1 |
15984 | 192.168.0.1/22 | 10.0.0.12/8 | 127.0.0.1/8 |
15985 | 192.168.1/22 | 10.12/8 | 127.1/8 |
15986 +------------------+------------------+------------------+
15987
15988Notice that this is different from RFC 4632 CIDR address notation in which
15989192.168.42/24 would be equivalent to 192.168.42.0/24.
15990
Willy Tarreauceb4ac92012-04-28 00:41:46 +020015991IPv6 may be entered in their usual form, with or without a netmask appended.
15992Only bit counts are accepted for IPv6 netmasks. In order to avoid any risk of
15993trouble with randomly resolved IP addresses, host names are never allowed in
15994IPv6 patterns.
15995
15996HAProxy is also able to match IPv4 addresses with IPv6 addresses in the
15997following situations :
15998 - tested address is IPv4, pattern address is IPv4, the match applies
15999 in IPv4 using the supplied mask if any.
16000 - tested address is IPv6, pattern address is IPv6, the match applies
16001 in IPv6 using the supplied mask if any.
16002 - tested address is IPv6, pattern address is IPv4, the match applies in IPv4
16003 using the pattern's mask if the IPv6 address matches with 2002:IPV4::,
16004 ::IPV4 or ::ffff:IPV4, otherwise it fails.
16005 - tested address is IPv4, pattern address is IPv6, the IPv4 address is first
16006 converted to IPv6 by prefixing ::ffff: in front of it, then the match is
16007 applied in IPv6 using the supplied IPv6 mask.
16008
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016009
160107.2. Using ACLs to form conditions
16011----------------------------------
16012
16013Some actions are only performed upon a valid condition. A condition is a
16014combination of ACLs with operators. 3 operators are supported :
16015
16016 - AND (implicit)
16017 - OR (explicit with the "or" keyword or the "||" operator)
16018 - Negation with the exclamation mark ("!")
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020016019
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016020A condition is formed as a disjunctive form:
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020016021
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016022 [!]acl1 [!]acl2 ... [!]acln { or [!]acl1 [!]acl2 ... [!]acln } ...
Willy Tarreaubef91e72013-03-31 23:14:46 +020016023
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016024Such conditions are generally used after an "if" or "unless" statement,
16025indicating when the condition will trigger the action.
Willy Tarreaubef91e72013-03-31 23:14:46 +020016026
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016027For instance, to block HTTP requests to the "*" URL with methods other than
16028"OPTIONS", as well as POST requests without content-length, and GET or HEAD
16029requests with a content-length greater than 0, and finally every request which
16030is not either GET/HEAD/POST/OPTIONS !
16031
Christian Ruppertfd3184c2022-02-20 22:54:01 +010016032 acl missing_cl req.hdr_cnt(Content-length) eq 0
Jarno Huuskonen84c51ec2017-04-03 14:20:34 +030016033 http-request deny if HTTP_URL_STAR !METH_OPTIONS || METH_POST missing_cl
16034 http-request deny if METH_GET HTTP_CONTENT
16035 http-request deny unless METH_GET or METH_POST or METH_OPTIONS
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016036
16037To select a different backend for requests to static contents on the "www" site
16038and to every request on the "img", "video", "download" and "ftp" hosts :
16039
16040 acl url_static path_beg /static /images /img /css
16041 acl url_static path_end .gif .png .jpg .css .js
16042 acl host_www hdr_beg(host) -i www
16043 acl host_static hdr_beg(host) -i img. video. download. ftp.
16044
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016045 # now use backend "static" for all static-only hosts, and for static URLs
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016046 # of host "www". Use backend "www" for the rest.
16047 use_backend static if host_static or host_www url_static
16048 use_backend www if host_www
16049
16050It is also possible to form rules using "anonymous ACLs". Those are unnamed ACL
16051expressions that are built on the fly without needing to be declared. They must
16052be enclosed between braces, with a space before and after each brace (because
16053the braces must be seen as independent words). Example :
16054
16055 The following rule :
16056
Christian Ruppertfd3184c2022-02-20 22:54:01 +010016057 acl missing_cl req.hdr_cnt(Content-length) eq 0
Jarno Huuskonen84c51ec2017-04-03 14:20:34 +030016058 http-request deny if METH_POST missing_cl
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016059
16060 Can also be written that way :
16061
Christian Ruppertfd3184c2022-02-20 22:54:01 +010016062 http-request deny if METH_POST { req.hdr_cnt(Content-length) eq 0 }
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016063
16064It is generally not recommended to use this construct because it's a lot easier
16065to leave errors in the configuration when written that way. However, for very
16066simple rules matching only one source IP address for instance, it can make more
16067sense to use them than to declare ACLs with random names. Another example of
16068good use is the following :
16069
16070 With named ACLs :
16071
16072 acl site_dead nbsrv(dynamic) lt 2
16073 acl site_dead nbsrv(static) lt 2
16074 monitor fail if site_dead
16075
16076 With anonymous ACLs :
16077
16078 monitor fail if { nbsrv(dynamic) lt 2 } || { nbsrv(static) lt 2 }
16079
Jarno Huuskonen84c51ec2017-04-03 14:20:34 +030016080See section 4.2 for detailed help on the "http-request deny" and "use_backend"
16081keywords.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016082
16083
160847.3. Fetching samples
16085---------------------
16086
16087Historically, sample fetch methods were only used to retrieve data to match
16088against patterns using ACLs. With the arrival of stick-tables, a new class of
16089sample fetch methods was created, most often sharing the same syntax as their
16090ACL counterpart. These sample fetch methods are also known as "fetches". As
16091of now, ACLs and fetches have converged. All ACL fetch methods have been made
16092available as fetch methods, and ACLs may use any sample fetch method as well.
16093
16094This section details all available sample fetch methods and their output type.
16095Some sample fetch methods have deprecated aliases that are used to maintain
16096compatibility with existing configurations. They are then explicitly marked as
16097deprecated and should not be used in new setups.
16098
16099The ACL derivatives are also indicated when available, with their respective
16100matching methods. These ones all have a well defined default pattern matching
16101method, so it is never necessary (though allowed) to pass the "-m" option to
16102indicate how the sample will be matched using ACLs.
16103
16104As indicated in the sample type versus matching compatibility matrix above,
16105when using a generic sample fetch method in an ACL, the "-m" option is
16106mandatory unless the sample type is one of boolean, integer, IPv4 or IPv6. When
16107the same keyword exists as an ACL keyword and as a standard fetch method, the
16108ACL engine will automatically pick the ACL-only one by default.
16109
16110Some of these keywords support one or multiple mandatory arguments, and one or
16111multiple optional arguments. These arguments are strongly typed and are checked
16112when the configuration is parsed so that there is no risk of running with an
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016113incorrect argument (e.g. an unresolved backend name). Fetch function arguments
16114are passed between parenthesis and are delimited by commas. When an argument
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016115is optional, it will be indicated below between square brackets ('[ ]'). When
16116all arguments are optional, the parenthesis may be omitted.
16117
16118Thus, the syntax of a standard sample fetch method is one of the following :
16119 - name
16120 - name(arg1)
16121 - name(arg1,arg2)
16122
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020016123
161247.3.1. Converters
16125-----------------
16126
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +010016127Sample fetch methods may be combined with transformations to be applied on top
16128of the fetched sample (also called "converters"). These combinations form what
16129is called "sample expressions" and the result is a "sample". Initially this
16130was only supported by "stick on" and "stick store-request" directives but this
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016131has now be extended to all places where samples may be used (ACLs, log-format,
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +010016132unique-id-format, add-header, ...).
16133
16134These transformations are enumerated as a series of specific keywords after the
16135sample fetch method. These keywords may equally be appended immediately after
16136the fetch keyword's argument, delimited by a comma. These keywords can also
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016137support some arguments (e.g. a netmask) which must be passed in parenthesis.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010016138
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010016139A certain category of converters are bitwise and arithmetic operators which
16140support performing basic operations on integers. Some bitwise operations are
16141supported (and, or, xor, cpl) and some arithmetic operations are supported
16142(add, sub, mul, div, mod, neg). Some comparators are provided (odd, even, not,
16143bool) which make it possible to report a match without having to write an ACL.
16144
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016145The currently available list of transformation keywords include :
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010016146
Ben Shillitof25e8e52016-12-02 14:25:37 +00001614751d.single(<prop>[,<prop>*])
16148 Returns values for the properties requested as a string, where values are
16149 separated by the delimiter specified with "51degrees-property-separator".
16150 The device is identified using the User-Agent header passed to the
16151 converter. The function can be passed up to five property names, and if a
16152 property name can't be found, the value "NoData" is returned.
16153
16154 Example :
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016155 # Here the header "X-51D-DeviceTypeMobileTablet" is added to the request,
16156 # containing values for the three properties requested by using the
Ben Shillitof25e8e52016-12-02 14:25:37 +000016157 # User-Agent passed to the converter.
16158 frontend http-in
16159 bind *:8081
16160 default_backend servers
16161 http-request set-header X-51D-DeviceTypeMobileTablet \
16162 %[req.fhdr(User-Agent),51d.single(DeviceType,IsMobile,IsTablet)]
16163
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010016164add(<value>)
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020016165 Adds <value> to the input value of type signed integer, and returns the
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020016166 result as a signed integer. <value> can be a numeric value or a variable
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010016167 name. The name of the variable starts with an indication about its scope. The
16168 scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010016169 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010016170 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
16171 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and response)
16172 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing
16173 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016174 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010016175 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010016176
Nenad Merdanovicc31499d2019-03-23 11:00:32 +010016177aes_gcm_dec(<bits>,<nonce>,<key>,<aead_tag>)
16178 Decrypts the raw byte input using the AES128-GCM, AES192-GCM or
16179 AES256-GCM algorithm, depending on the <bits> parameter. All other parameters
16180 need to be base64 encoded and the returned result is in raw byte format.
16181 If the <aead_tag> validation fails, the converter doesn't return any data.
16182 The <nonce>, <key> and <aead_tag> can either be strings or variables. This
16183 converter requires at least OpenSSL 1.0.1.
16184
16185 Example:
16186 http-response set-header X-Decrypted-Text %[var(txn.enc),\
16187 aes_gcm_dec(128,txn.nonce,Zm9vb2Zvb29mb29wZm9vbw==,txn.aead_tag)]
16188
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010016189and(<value>)
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020016190 Performs a bitwise "AND" between <value> and the input value of type signed
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020016191 integer, and returns the result as an signed integer. <value> can be a
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010016192 numeric value or a variable name. The name of the variable starts with an
16193 indication about its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010016194 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010016195 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
16196 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and response)
16197 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing
16198 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016199 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010016200 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010016201
Holger Just1bfc24b2017-05-06 00:56:53 +020016202b64dec
16203 Converts (decodes) a base64 encoded input string to its binary
16204 representation. It performs the inverse operation of base64().
Moemen MHEDHBI92f7d432021-04-01 20:53:59 +020016205 For base64url("URL and Filename Safe Alphabet" (RFC 4648)) variant
16206 see "ub64dec".
Holger Just1bfc24b2017-05-06 00:56:53 +020016207
Emeric Brun53d1a982014-04-30 18:21:37 +020016208base64
16209 Converts a binary input sample to a base64 string. It is used to log or
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016210 transfer binary content in a way that can be reliably transferred (e.g.
Moemen MHEDHBI92f7d432021-04-01 20:53:59 +020016211 an SSL ID can be copied in a header). For base64url("URL and Filename
16212 Safe Alphabet" (RFC 4648)) variant see "ub64enc".
Emeric Brun53d1a982014-04-30 18:21:37 +020016213
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010016214bool
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020016215 Returns a boolean TRUE if the input value of type signed integer is
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010016216 non-null, otherwise returns FALSE. Used in conjunction with and(), it can be
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016217 used to report true/false for bit testing on input values (e.g. verify the
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010016218 presence of a flag).
16219
Emeric Brun54c4ac82014-11-03 15:32:43 +010016220bytes(<offset>[,<length>])
16221 Extracts some bytes from an input binary sample. The result is a binary
16222 sample starting at an offset (in bytes) of the original sample and
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +010016223 optionally truncated at the given length.
Emeric Brun54c4ac82014-11-03 15:32:43 +010016224
Willy Tarreau280f42b2018-02-19 15:34:12 +010016225concat([<start>],[<var>],[<end>])
16226 Concatenates up to 3 fields after the current sample which is then turned to
16227 a string. The first one, <start>, is a constant string, that will be appended
16228 immediately after the existing sample. It may be omitted if not used. The
16229 second one, <var>, is a variable name. The variable will be looked up, its
16230 contents converted to a string, and it will be appended immediately after the
16231 <first> part. If the variable is not found, nothing is appended. It may be
16232 omitted as well. The third field, <end> is a constant string that will be
16233 appended after the variable. It may also be omitted. Together, these elements
16234 allow to concatenate variables with delimiters to an existing set of
16235 variables. This can be used to build new variables made of a succession of
Willy Tarreauef21fac2020-02-14 13:37:20 +010016236 other variables, such as colon-delimited values. If commas or closing
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -040016237 parenthesis are needed as delimiters, they must be protected by quotes or
Willy Tarreauef21fac2020-02-14 13:37:20 +010016238 backslashes, themselves protected so that they are not stripped by the first
16239 level parser. See examples below.
Willy Tarreau280f42b2018-02-19 15:34:12 +010016240
16241 Example:
16242 tcp-request session set-var(sess.src) src
16243 tcp-request session set-var(sess.dn) ssl_c_s_dn
16244 tcp-request session set-var(txn.sig) str(),concat(<ip=,sess.ip,>),concat(<dn=,sess.dn,>)
Willy Tarreauef21fac2020-02-14 13:37:20 +010016245 tcp-request session set-var(txn.ipport) "str(),concat('addr=(',sess.ip),concat(',',sess.port,')')"
Willy Tarreau280f42b2018-02-19 15:34:12 +010016246 http-request set-header x-hap-sig %[var(txn.sig)]
16247
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010016248cpl
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020016249 Takes the input value of type signed integer, applies a ones-complement
16250 (flips all bits) and returns the result as an signed integer.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010016251
Willy Tarreau80599772015-01-20 19:35:24 +010016252crc32([<avalanche>])
16253 Hashes a binary input sample into an unsigned 32-bit quantity using the CRC32
16254 hash function. Optionally, it is possible to apply a full avalanche hash
16255 function to the output if the optional <avalanche> argument equals 1. This
16256 converter uses the same functions as used by the various hash-based load
16257 balancing algorithms, so it will provide exactly the same results. It is
16258 provided for compatibility with other software which want a CRC32 to be
16259 computed on some input keys, so it follows the most common implementation as
16260 found in Ethernet, Gzip, PNG, etc... It is slower than the other algorithms
16261 but may provide a better or at least less predictable distribution. It must
16262 not be used for security purposes as a 32-bit hash is trivial to break. See
Emmanuel Hocdet50791a72018-03-21 11:19:01 +010016263 also "djb2", "sdbm", "wt6", "crc32c" and the "hash-type" directive.
16264
16265crc32c([<avalanche>])
16266 Hashes a binary input sample into an unsigned 32-bit quantity using the CRC32C
16267 hash function. Optionally, it is possible to apply a full avalanche hash
16268 function to the output if the optional <avalanche> argument equals 1. This
16269 converter uses the same functions as described in RFC4960, Appendix B [8].
16270 It is provided for compatibility with other software which want a CRC32C to be
16271 computed on some input keys. It is slower than the other algorithms and it must
16272 not be used for security purposes as a 32-bit hash is trivial to break. See
16273 also "djb2", "sdbm", "wt6", "crc32" and the "hash-type" directive.
Willy Tarreau80599772015-01-20 19:35:24 +010016274
Christopher Fauletea159d62020-04-01 16:21:44 +020016275cut_crlf
16276 Cuts the string representation of the input sample on the first carriage
16277 return ('\r') or newline ('\n') character found. Only the string length is
16278 updated.
16279
David Carlier29b3ca32015-09-25 14:09:21 +010016280da-csv-conv(<prop>[,<prop>*])
David Carlier4542b102015-06-01 13:54:29 +020016281 Asks the DeviceAtlas converter to identify the User Agent string passed on
16282 input, and to emit a string made of the concatenation of the properties
16283 enumerated in argument, delimited by the separator defined by the global
16284 keyword "deviceatlas-property-separator", or by default the pipe character
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040016285 ('|'). There's a limit of 12 different properties imposed by the HAProxy
David Carlier4542b102015-06-01 13:54:29 +020016286 configuration language.
16287
16288 Example:
16289 frontend www
Cyril Bonté307ee1e2015-09-28 23:16:06 +020016290 bind *:8881
16291 default_backend servers
David Carlier840b0242016-03-16 10:09:55 +000016292 http-request set-header X-DeviceAtlas-Data %[req.fhdr(User-Agent),da-csv(primaryHardwareType,osName,osVersion,browserName,browserVersion,browserRenderingEngine)]
David Carlier4542b102015-06-01 13:54:29 +020016293
Willy Tarreau0851fd52019-12-17 10:07:25 +010016294debug([<prefix][,<destination>])
16295 This converter is used as debug tool. It takes a capture of the input sample
16296 and sends it to event sink <destination>, which may designate a ring buffer
16297 such as "buf0", as well as "stdout", or "stderr". Available sinks may be
16298 checked at run time by issuing "show events" on the CLI. When not specified,
16299 the output will be "buf0", which may be consulted via the CLI's "show events"
16300 command. An optional prefix <prefix> may be passed to help distinguish
16301 outputs from multiple expressions. It will then appear before the colon in
16302 the output message. The input sample is passed as-is on the output, so that
16303 it is safe to insert the debug converter anywhere in a chain, even with non-
16304 printable sample types.
16305
16306 Example:
16307 tcp-request connection track-sc0 src,debug(track-sc)
Thierry FOURNIER9687c772015-05-07 15:46:29 +020016308
Patrick Gansterer8e366512020-04-22 16:47:57 +020016309digest(<algorithm>)
16310 Converts a binary input sample to a message digest. The result is a binary
16311 sample. The <algorithm> must be an OpenSSL message digest name (e.g. sha256).
16312
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040016313 Please note that this converter is only available when HAProxy has been
Patrick Gansterer8e366512020-04-22 16:47:57 +020016314 compiled with USE_OPENSSL.
16315
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010016316div(<value>)
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020016317 Divides the input value of type signed integer by <value>, and returns the
16318 result as an signed integer. If <value> is null, the largest unsigned
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020016319 integer is returned (typically 2^63-1). <value> can be a numeric value or a
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010016320 variable name. The name of the variable starts with an indication about its
16321 scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010016322 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010016323 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
16324 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and response)
16325 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing
16326 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016327 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010016328 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010016329
Willy Tarreau23ec4ca2014-07-15 20:15:37 +020016330djb2([<avalanche>])
16331 Hashes a binary input sample into an unsigned 32-bit quantity using the DJB2
16332 hash function. Optionally, it is possible to apply a full avalanche hash
16333 function to the output if the optional <avalanche> argument equals 1. This
16334 converter uses the same functions as used by the various hash-based load
16335 balancing algorithms, so it will provide exactly the same results. It is
16336 mostly intended for debugging, but can be used as a stick-table entry to
16337 collect rough statistics. It must not be used for security purposes as a
Emmanuel Hocdet50791a72018-03-21 11:19:01 +010016338 32-bit hash is trivial to break. See also "crc32", "sdbm", "wt6", "crc32c",
16339 and the "hash-type" directive.
Willy Tarreau23ec4ca2014-07-15 20:15:37 +020016340
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010016341even
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020016342 Returns a boolean TRUE if the input value of type signed integer is even
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010016343 otherwise returns FALSE. It is functionally equivalent to "not,and(1),bool".
16344
Marcin Deranek9631a282018-04-16 14:30:46 +020016345field(<index>,<delimiters>[,<count>])
16346 Extracts the substring at the given index counting from the beginning
16347 (positive index) or from the end (negative index) considering given delimiters
16348 from an input string. Indexes start at 1 or -1 and delimiters are a string
16349 formatted list of chars. Optionally you can specify <count> of fields to
16350 extract (default: 1). Value of 0 indicates extraction of all remaining
16351 fields.
16352
16353 Example :
16354 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),field(5,_) # f5
16355 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),field(2,_,0) # f2_f3__f5
16356 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),field(2,_,2) # f2_f3
16357 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),field(-2,_,3) # f2_f3_
16358 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),field(-3,_,0) # f1_f2_f3
Emeric Brunf399b0d2014-11-03 17:07:03 +010016359
Baptiste Assmanne138dda2020-10-22 15:39:03 +020016360fix_is_valid
16361 Parses a binary payload and performs sanity checks regarding FIX (Financial
16362 Information eXchange):
16363
16364 - checks that all tag IDs and values are not empty and the tags IDs are well
16365 numeric
Ilya Shipitsin2272d8a2020-12-21 01:22:40 +050016366 - checks the BeginString tag is the first tag with a valid FIX version
Baptiste Assmanne138dda2020-10-22 15:39:03 +020016367 - checks the BodyLength tag is the second one with the right body length
Christopher Fauleted4bef72021-03-18 17:40:56 +010016368 - checks the MsgType tag is the third tag.
Baptiste Assmanne138dda2020-10-22 15:39:03 +020016369 - checks that last tag in the message is the CheckSum tag with a valid
16370 checksum
16371
16372 Due to current HAProxy design, only the first message sent by the client and
16373 the server can be parsed.
16374
16375 This converter returns a boolean, true if the payload contains a valid FIX
16376 message, false if not.
16377
16378 See also the fix_tag_value converter.
16379
16380 Example:
16381 tcp-request inspect-delay 10s
16382 tcp-request content reject unless { req.payload(0,0),fix_is_valid }
16383
16384fix_tag_value(<tag>)
16385 Parses a FIX (Financial Information eXchange) message and extracts the value
16386 from the tag <tag>. <tag> can be a string or an integer pointing to the
16387 desired tag. Any integer value is accepted, but only the following strings
16388 are translated into their integer equivalent: BeginString, BodyLength,
Daniel Corbettbefef702021-03-09 23:00:34 -050016389 MsgType, SenderCompID, TargetCompID, CheckSum. More tag names can be easily
Baptiste Assmanne138dda2020-10-22 15:39:03 +020016390 added.
16391
16392 Due to current HAProxy design, only the first message sent by the client and
16393 the server can be parsed. No message validation is performed by this
16394 converter. It is highly recommended to validate the message first using
16395 fix_is_valid converter.
16396
16397 See also the fix_is_valid converter.
16398
16399 Example:
16400 tcp-request inspect-delay 10s
16401 tcp-request content reject unless { req.payload(0,0),fix_is_valid }
16402 # MsgType tag ID is 35, so both lines below will return the same content
16403 tcp-request content set-var(txn.foo) req.payload(0,0),fix_tag_value(35)
16404 tcp-request content set-var(txn.bar) req.payload(0,0),fix_tag_value(MsgType)
16405
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020016406hex
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016407 Converts a binary input sample to a hex string containing two hex digits per
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020016408 input byte. It is used to log or transfer hex dumps of some binary input data
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016409 in a way that can be reliably transferred (e.g. an SSL ID can be copied in a
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020016410 header).
Thierry FOURNIER2f49d6d2014-03-12 15:01:52 +010016411
Dragan Dosen3f957b22017-10-24 09:27:34 +020016412hex2i
16413 Converts a hex string containing two hex digits per input byte to an
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050016414 integer. If the input value cannot be converted, then zero is returned.
Dragan Dosen3f957b22017-10-24 09:27:34 +020016415
Christopher Faulet4ccc12f2020-04-01 09:08:32 +020016416htonl
16417 Converts the input integer value to its 32-bit binary representation in the
16418 network byte order. Because sample fetches own signed 64-bit integer, when
16419 this converter is used, the input integer value is first casted to an
16420 unsigned 32-bit integer.
16421
Tim Duesterhusa3082092021-01-21 17:40:49 +010016422hmac(<algorithm>,<key>)
Patrick Gansterer8e366512020-04-22 16:47:57 +020016423 Converts a binary input sample to a message authentication code with the given
16424 key. The result is a binary sample. The <algorithm> must be one of the
16425 registered OpenSSL message digest names (e.g. sha256). The <key> parameter must
16426 be base64 encoded and can either be a string or a variable.
16427
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040016428 Please note that this converter is only available when HAProxy has been
Patrick Gansterer8e366512020-04-22 16:47:57 +020016429 compiled with USE_OPENSSL.
16430
Cyril Bonté6bcd1822019-11-05 23:13:59 +010016431http_date([<offset],[<unit>])
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020016432 Converts an integer supposed to contain a date since epoch to a string
16433 representing this date in a format suitable for use in HTTP header fields. If
Damien Claisseae6f1252019-10-30 15:57:28 +000016434 an offset value is specified, then it is added to the date before the
16435 conversion is operated. This is particularly useful to emit Date header fields,
16436 Expires values in responses when combined with a positive offset, or
16437 Last-Modified values when the offset is negative.
16438 If a unit value is specified, then consider the timestamp as either
16439 "s" for seconds (default behavior), "ms" for milliseconds, or "us" for
16440 microseconds since epoch. Offset is assumed to have the same unit as
16441 input timestamp.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016442
Tim Duesterhus3943e4f2020-09-11 14:25:23 +020016443iif(<true>,<false>)
16444 Returns the <true> string if the input value is true. Returns the <false>
16445 string otherwise.
16446
16447 Example:
Tim Duesterhus870713b2020-09-11 17:13:12 +020016448 http-request set-header x-forwarded-proto %[ssl_fc,iif(https,http)]
Tim Duesterhus3943e4f2020-09-11 14:25:23 +020016449
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020016450in_table(<table>)
16451 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
16452 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, a boolean false
16453 is returned. Otherwise a boolean true is returned. This can be used to verify
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016454 the presence of a certain key in a table tracking some elements (e.g. whether
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020016455 or not a source IP address or an Authorization header was already seen).
16456
Tim Duesterhusa3082092021-01-21 17:40:49 +010016457ipmask(<mask4>,[<mask6>])
Tim Duesterhus1478aa72018-01-25 16:24:51 +010016458 Apply a mask to an IP address, and use the result for lookups and storage.
Willy Tarreauffcb2e42014-07-10 16:29:08 +020016459 This can be used to make all hosts within a certain mask to share the same
Tim Duesterhus1478aa72018-01-25 16:24:51 +010016460 table entries and as such use the same server. The mask4 can be passed in
16461 dotted form (e.g. 255.255.255.0) or in CIDR form (e.g. 24). The mask6 can
16462 be passed in quadruplet form (e.g. ffff:ffff::) or in CIDR form (e.g. 64).
16463 If no mask6 is given IPv6 addresses will fail to convert for backwards
16464 compatibility reasons.
Willy Tarreauffcb2e42014-07-10 16:29:08 +020016465
Thierry FOURNIER317e1c42014-08-12 10:20:47 +020016466json([<input-code>])
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016467 Escapes the input string and produces an ASCII output string ready to use as a
Thierry FOURNIER317e1c42014-08-12 10:20:47 +020016468 JSON string. The converter tries to decode the input string according to the
Herve COMMOWICK8dfe8632016-08-05 12:01:20 +020016469 <input-code> parameter. It can be "ascii", "utf8", "utf8s", "utf8p" or
Thierry FOURNIER317e1c42014-08-12 10:20:47 +020016470 "utf8ps". The "ascii" decoder never fails. The "utf8" decoder detects 3 types
16471 of errors:
16472 - bad UTF-8 sequence (lone continuation byte, bad number of continuation
16473 bytes, ...)
16474 - invalid range (the decoded value is within a UTF-8 prohibited range),
16475 - code overlong (the value is encoded with more bytes than necessary).
16476
16477 The UTF-8 JSON encoding can produce a "too long value" error when the UTF-8
16478 character is greater than 0xffff because the JSON string escape specification
16479 only authorizes 4 hex digits for the value encoding. The UTF-8 decoder exists
16480 in 4 variants designated by a combination of two suffix letters : "p" for
16481 "permissive" and "s" for "silently ignore". The behaviors of the decoders
16482 are :
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016483 - "ascii" : never fails;
16484 - "utf8" : fails on any detected errors;
16485 - "utf8s" : never fails, but removes characters corresponding to errors;
Thierry FOURNIER317e1c42014-08-12 10:20:47 +020016486 - "utf8p" : accepts and fixes the overlong errors, but fails on any other
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016487 error;
Thierry FOURNIER317e1c42014-08-12 10:20:47 +020016488 - "utf8ps" : never fails, accepts and fixes the overlong errors, but removes
16489 characters corresponding to the other errors.
16490
16491 This converter is particularly useful for building properly escaped JSON for
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016492 logging to servers which consume JSON-formatted traffic logs.
Thierry FOURNIER317e1c42014-08-12 10:20:47 +020016493
16494 Example:
Thierry FOURNIER317e1c42014-08-12 10:20:47 +020016495 capture request header Host len 15
Herve COMMOWICK8dfe8632016-08-05 12:01:20 +020016496 capture request header user-agent len 150
16497 log-format '{"ip":"%[src]","user-agent":"%[capture.req.hdr(1),json(utf8s)]"}'
Thierry FOURNIER317e1c42014-08-12 10:20:47 +020016498
16499 Input request from client 127.0.0.1:
16500 GET / HTTP/1.0
16501 User-Agent: Very "Ugly" UA 1/2
16502
16503 Output log:
16504 {"ip":"127.0.0.1","user-agent":"Very \"Ugly\" UA 1\/2"}
16505
Alex51c8ad42021-04-15 16:45:15 +020016506json_query(<json_path>,[<output_type>])
16507 The json_query converter supports the JSON types string, boolean and
16508 number. Floating point numbers will be returned as a string. By
16509 specifying the output_type 'int' the value will be converted to an
16510 Integer. If conversion is not possible the json_query converter fails.
16511
16512 <json_path> must be a valid JSON Path string as defined in
16513 https://datatracker.ietf.org/doc/draft-ietf-jsonpath-base/
16514
16515 Example:
16516 # get a integer value from the request body
16517 # "{"integer":4}" => 5
16518 http-request set-var(txn.pay_int) req.body,json_query('$.integer','int'),add(1)
16519
16520 # get a key with '.' in the name
16521 # {"my.key":"myvalue"} => myvalue
16522 http-request set-var(txn.pay_mykey) req.body,json_query('$.my\\.key')
16523
16524 # {"boolean-false":false} => 0
16525 http-request set-var(txn.pay_boolean_false) req.body,json_query('$.boolean-false')
16526
16527 # get the value of the key 'iss' from a JWT Bearer token
16528 http-request set-var(txn.token_payload) req.hdr(Authorization),word(2,.),ub64dec,json_query('$.iss')
16529
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020016530language(<value>[,<default>])
16531 Returns the value with the highest q-factor from a list as extracted from the
16532 "accept-language" header using "req.fhdr". Values with no q-factor have a
16533 q-factor of 1. Values with a q-factor of 0 are dropped. Only values which
16534 belong to the list of semi-colon delimited <values> will be considered. The
16535 argument <value> syntax is "lang[;lang[;lang[;...]]]". If no value matches the
16536 given list and a default value is provided, it is returned. Note that language
16537 names may have a variant after a dash ('-'). If this variant is present in the
16538 list, it will be matched, but if it is not, only the base language is checked.
16539 The match is case-sensitive, and the output string is always one of those
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016540 provided in arguments. The ordering of arguments is meaningless, only the
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020016541 ordering of the values in the request counts, as the first value among
16542 multiple sharing the same q-factor is used.
Thierry FOURNIERad903512014-04-11 17:51:01 +020016543
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020016544 Example :
Thierry FOURNIERad903512014-04-11 17:51:01 +020016545
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020016546 # this configuration switches to the backend matching a
16547 # given language based on the request :
Thierry FOURNIERad903512014-04-11 17:51:01 +020016548
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020016549 acl es req.fhdr(accept-language),language(es;fr;en) -m str es
16550 acl fr req.fhdr(accept-language),language(es;fr;en) -m str fr
16551 acl en req.fhdr(accept-language),language(es;fr;en) -m str en
16552 use_backend spanish if es
16553 use_backend french if fr
16554 use_backend english if en
16555 default_backend choose_your_language
Thierry FOURNIERad903512014-04-11 17:51:01 +020016556
Willy Tarreau60a2ee72017-12-15 07:13:48 +010016557length
Etienne Carriereed0d24e2017-12-13 13:41:34 +010016558 Get the length of the string. This can only be placed after a string
16559 sample fetch function or after a transformation keyword returning a string
16560 type. The result is of type integer.
16561
Willy Tarreauffcb2e42014-07-10 16:29:08 +020016562lower
16563 Convert a string sample to lower case. This can only be placed after a string
16564 sample fetch function or after a transformation keyword returning a string
16565 type. The result is of type string.
16566
Willy Tarreau0dbfdba2014-07-10 16:37:47 +020016567ltime(<format>[,<offset>])
16568 Converts an integer supposed to contain a date since epoch to a string
16569 representing this date in local time using a format defined by the <format>
16570 string using strftime(3). The purpose is to allow any date format to be used
16571 in logs. An optional <offset> in seconds may be applied to the input date
16572 (positive or negative). See the strftime() man page for the format supported
16573 by your operating system. See also the utime converter.
16574
16575 Example :
16576
16577 # Emit two colons, one with the local time and another with ip:port
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016578 # e.g. 20140710162350 127.0.0.1:57325
Willy Tarreau0dbfdba2014-07-10 16:37:47 +020016579 log-format %[date,ltime(%Y%m%d%H%M%S)]\ %ci:%cp
16580
Christopher Faulet51fc9d12020-04-01 17:24:41 +020016581ltrim(<chars>)
16582 Skips any characters from <chars> from the beginning of the string
16583 representation of the input sample.
16584
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020016585map(<map_file>[,<default_value>])
16586map_<match_type>(<map_file>[,<default_value>])
16587map_<match_type>_<output_type>(<map_file>[,<default_value>])
16588 Search the input value from <map_file> using the <match_type> matching method,
16589 and return the associated value converted to the type <output_type>. If the
16590 input value cannot be found in the <map_file>, the converter returns the
16591 <default_value>. If the <default_value> is not set, the converter fails and
16592 acts as if no input value could be fetched. If the <match_type> is not set, it
16593 defaults to "str". Likewise, if the <output_type> is not set, it defaults to
16594 "str". For convenience, the "map" keyword is an alias for "map_str" and maps a
16595 string to another string.
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010016596
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020016597 It is important to avoid overlapping between the keys : IP addresses and
16598 strings are stored in trees, so the first of the finest match will be used.
16599 Other keys are stored in lists, so the first matching occurrence will be used.
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010016600
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +010016601 The following array contains the list of all map functions available sorted by
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020016602 input type, match type and output type.
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010016603
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020016604 input type | match method | output type str | output type int | output type ip
16605 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
16606 str | str | map_str | map_str_int | map_str_ip
16607 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
Willy Tarreau787a4c02014-05-10 07:55:30 +020016608 str | beg | map_beg | map_beg_int | map_end_ip
16609 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020016610 str | sub | map_sub | map_sub_int | map_sub_ip
16611 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
16612 str | dir | map_dir | map_dir_int | map_dir_ip
16613 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
16614 str | dom | map_dom | map_dom_int | map_dom_ip
16615 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
16616 str | end | map_end | map_end_int | map_end_ip
16617 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
Ruoshan Huang3c5e3742016-12-02 16:25:31 +080016618 str | reg | map_reg | map_reg_int | map_reg_ip
16619 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
16620 str | reg | map_regm | map_reg_int | map_reg_ip
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020016621 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
16622 int | int | map_int | map_int_int | map_int_ip
16623 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
16624 ip | ip | map_ip | map_ip_int | map_ip_ip
16625 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010016626
Thierry Fournier8feaa662016-02-10 22:55:20 +010016627 The special map called "map_regm" expect matching zone in the regular
16628 expression and modify the output replacing back reference (like "\1") by
16629 the corresponding match text.
16630
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020016631 The file contains one key + value per line. Lines which start with '#' are
16632 ignored, just like empty lines. Leading tabs and spaces are stripped. The key
16633 is then the first "word" (series of non-space/tabs characters), and the value
16634 is what follows this series of space/tab till the end of the line excluding
16635 trailing spaces/tabs.
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010016636
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020016637 Example :
16638
16639 # this is a comment and is ignored
16640 2.22.246.0/23 United Kingdom \n
16641 <-><-----------><--><------------><---->
16642 | | | | `- trailing spaces ignored
16643 | | | `---------- value
16644 | | `-------------------- middle spaces ignored
16645 | `---------------------------- key
16646 `------------------------------------ leading spaces ignored
16647
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010016648mod(<value>)
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020016649 Divides the input value of type signed integer by <value>, and returns the
16650 remainder as an signed integer. If <value> is null, then zero is returned.
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020016651 <value> can be a numeric value or a variable name. The name of the variable
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010016652 starts with an indication about its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010016653 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010016654 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
16655 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and response)
16656 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing
16657 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016658 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010016659 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010016660
Alexbf1bd5a2021-04-24 13:02:21 +020016661mqtt_field_value(<packettype>,<fieldname_or_property_ID>)
Baptiste Assmanne279ca62020-10-27 18:10:06 +010016662 Returns value of <fieldname> found in input MQTT payload of type
16663 <packettype>.
16664 <packettype> can be either a string (case insensitive matching) or a numeric
16665 value corresponding to the type of packet we're supposed to extract data
16666 from.
16667 Supported string and integers can be found here:
16668 https://docs.oasis-open.org/mqtt/mqtt/v3.1.1/os/mqtt-v3.1.1-os.html#_Toc398718021
16669 https://docs.oasis-open.org/mqtt/mqtt/v5.0/os/mqtt-v5.0-os.html#_Toc3901022
16670
16671 <fieldname> depends on <packettype> and can be any of the following below.
16672 (note that <fieldname> matching is case insensitive).
16673 <property id> can only be found in MQTT v5.0 streams. check this table:
16674 https://docs.oasis-open.org/mqtt/mqtt/v5.0/os/mqtt-v5.0-os.html#_Toc3901029
16675
16676 - CONNECT (or 1): flags, protocol_name, protocol_version, client_identifier,
16677 will_topic, will_payload, username, password, keepalive
16678 OR any property ID as a numeric value (for MQTT v5.0
16679 packets only):
16680 17: Session Expiry Interval
16681 33: Receive Maximum
16682 39: Maximum Packet Size
16683 34: Topic Alias Maximum
16684 25: Request Response Information
16685 23: Request Problem Information
16686 21: Authentication Method
16687 22: Authentication Data
16688 18: Will Delay Interval
16689 1: Payload Format Indicator
16690 2: Message Expiry Interval
16691 3: Content Type
16692 8: Response Topic
16693 9: Correlation Data
16694 Not supported yet:
16695 38: User Property
16696
16697 - CONNACK (or 2): flags, protocol_version, reason_code
16698 OR any property ID as a numeric value (for MQTT v5.0
16699 packets only):
16700 17: Session Expiry Interval
16701 33: Receive Maximum
16702 36: Maximum QoS
16703 37: Retain Available
16704 39: Maximum Packet Size
16705 18: Assigned Client Identifier
16706 34: Topic Alias Maximum
16707 31: Reason String
16708 40; Wildcard Subscription Available
16709 41: Subscription Identifiers Available
16710 42: Shared Subscription Available
16711 19: Server Keep Alive
16712 26: Response Information
16713 28: Server Reference
16714 21: Authentication Method
16715 22: Authentication Data
16716 Not supported yet:
16717 38: User Property
16718
16719 Due to current HAProxy design, only the first message sent by the client and
16720 the server can be parsed. Thus this converter can extract data only from
16721 CONNECT and CONNACK packet types. CONNECT is the first message sent by the
16722 client and CONNACK is the first response sent by the server.
16723
16724 Example:
16725
16726 acl data_in_buffer req.len ge 4
16727 tcp-request content set-var(txn.username) \
16728 req.payload(0,0),mqtt_field_value(connect,protocol_name) \
16729 if data_in_buffer
16730 # do the same as above
16731 tcp-request content set-var(txn.username) \
16732 req.payload(0,0),mqtt_field_value(1,protocol_name) \
16733 if data_in_buffer
16734
16735mqtt_is_valid
16736 Checks that the binary input is a valid MQTT packet. It returns a boolean.
16737
16738 Due to current HAProxy design, only the first message sent by the client and
16739 the server can be parsed. Thus this converter can extract data only from
16740 CONNECT and CONNACK packet types. CONNECT is the first message sent by the
16741 client and CONNACK is the first response sent by the server.
16742
Christopher Fauletc7907732022-03-22 09:41:11 +010016743 Only MQTT 3.1, 3.1.1 and 5.0 are supported.
16744
Baptiste Assmanne279ca62020-10-27 18:10:06 +010016745 Example:
16746
16747 acl data_in_buffer req.len ge 4
Daniel Corbettcc9d9b02021-05-13 10:46:07 -040016748 tcp-request content reject unless { req.payload(0,0),mqtt_is_valid }
Baptiste Assmanne279ca62020-10-27 18:10:06 +010016749
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010016750mul(<value>)
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020016751 Multiplies the input value of type signed integer by <value>, and returns
Thierry FOURNIER00c005c2015-07-08 01:10:21 +020016752 the product as an signed integer. In case of overflow, the largest possible
16753 value for the sign is returned so that the operation doesn't wrap around.
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020016754 <value> can be a numeric value or a variable name. The name of the variable
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010016755 starts with an indication about its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010016756 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010016757 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
16758 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and response)
16759 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing
16760 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016761 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010016762 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010016763
Nenad Merdanovicb7e7c472017-03-12 21:56:55 +010016764nbsrv
16765 Takes an input value of type string, interprets it as a backend name and
16766 returns the number of usable servers in that backend. Can be used in places
16767 where we want to look up a backend from a dynamic name, like a result of a
16768 map lookup.
16769
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010016770neg
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020016771 Takes the input value of type signed integer, computes the opposite value,
16772 and returns the remainder as an signed integer. 0 is identity. This operator
16773 is provided for reversed subtracts : in order to subtract the input from a
16774 constant, simply perform a "neg,add(value)".
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010016775
16776not
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020016777 Returns a boolean FALSE if the input value of type signed integer is
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010016778 non-null, otherwise returns TRUE. Used in conjunction with and(), it can be
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016779 used to report true/false for bit testing on input values (e.g. verify the
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010016780 absence of a flag).
16781
16782odd
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020016783 Returns a boolean TRUE if the input value of type signed integer is odd
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010016784 otherwise returns FALSE. It is functionally equivalent to "and(1),bool".
16785
16786or(<value>)
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020016787 Performs a bitwise "OR" between <value> and the input value of type signed
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020016788 integer, and returns the result as an signed integer. <value> can be a
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010016789 numeric value or a variable name. The name of the variable starts with an
16790 indication about its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010016791 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010016792 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
16793 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and response)
16794 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing
16795 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016796 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010016797 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010016798
Frédéric Lécaillebfe61382019-03-06 14:34:36 +010016799protobuf(<field_number>,[<field_type>])
16800 This extracts the protocol buffers message field in raw mode of an input binary
16801 sample representation of a protocol buffer message with <field_number> as field
16802 number (dotted notation) if <field_type> is not present, or as an integer sample
16803 if this field is present (see also "ungrpc" below).
16804 The list of the authorized types is the following one: "int32", "int64", "uint32",
16805 "uint64", "sint32", "sint64", "bool", "enum" for the "varint" wire type 0
16806 "fixed64", "sfixed64", "double" for the 64bit wire type 1, "fixed32", "sfixed32",
16807 "float" for the wire type 5. Note that "string" is considered as a length-delimited
16808 type, so it does not require any <field_type> argument to be extracted.
16809 More information may be found here about the protocol buffers message field types:
16810 https://developers.google.com/protocol-buffers/docs/encoding
16811
Willy Tarreauc4dc3502015-01-23 20:39:28 +010016812regsub(<regex>,<subst>[,<flags>])
Willy Tarreau7eda8492015-01-20 19:47:06 +010016813 Applies a regex-based substitution to the input string. It does the same
16814 operation as the well-known "sed" utility with "s/<regex>/<subst>/". By
16815 default it will replace in the input string the first occurrence of the
16816 largest part matching the regular expression <regex> with the substitution
16817 string <subst>. It is possible to replace all occurrences instead by adding
16818 the flag "g" in the third argument <flags>. It is also possible to make the
16819 regex case insensitive by adding the flag "i" in <flags>. Since <flags> is a
16820 string, it is made up from the concatenation of all desired flags. Thus if
16821 both "i" and "g" are desired, using "gi" or "ig" will have the same effect.
Willy Tarreauef21fac2020-02-14 13:37:20 +010016822 The first use of this converter is to replace certain characters or sequence
16823 of characters with other ones.
16824
16825 It is highly recommended to enclose the regex part using protected quotes to
16826 improve clarity and never have a closing parenthesis from the regex mixed up
16827 with the parenthesis from the function. Just like in Bourne shell, the first
16828 level of quotes is processed when delimiting word groups on the line, a
16829 second level is usable for argument. It is recommended to use single quotes
16830 outside since these ones do not try to resolve backslashes nor dollar signs.
Willy Tarreau7eda8492015-01-20 19:47:06 +010016831
Willy Tarreaucd0d2ed2020-02-14 17:33:06 +010016832 Examples:
Willy Tarreau7eda8492015-01-20 19:47:06 +010016833
16834 # de-duplicate "/" in header "x-path".
16835 # input: x-path: /////a///b/c/xzxyz/
16836 # output: x-path: /a/b/c/xzxyz/
Willy Tarreauef21fac2020-02-14 13:37:20 +010016837 http-request set-header x-path "%[hdr(x-path),regsub('/+','/','g')]"
Willy Tarreau7eda8492015-01-20 19:47:06 +010016838
Willy Tarreaucd0d2ed2020-02-14 17:33:06 +010016839 # copy query string to x-query and drop all leading '?', ';' and '&'
16840 http-request set-header x-query "%[query,regsub([?;&]*,'')]"
16841
Jerome Magnin07e1e3c2020-02-16 19:20:19 +010016842 # capture groups and backreferences
16843 # both lines do the same.
Willy Tarreau465dc7d2020-10-08 18:05:56 +020016844 http-request redirect location %[url,'regsub("(foo|bar)([0-9]+)?","\2\1",i)']
Jerome Magnin07e1e3c2020-02-16 19:20:19 +010016845 http-request redirect location %[url,regsub(\"(foo|bar)([0-9]+)?\",\"\2\1\",i)]
16846
Thierry FOURNIER35ab2752015-05-28 13:22:03 +020016847capture-req(<id>)
16848 Capture the string entry in the request slot <id> and returns the entry as
16849 is. If the slot doesn't exist, the capture fails silently.
16850
16851 See also: "declare capture", "http-request capture",
Baptiste Assmann5ac425c2015-10-21 23:13:46 +020016852 "http-response capture", "capture.req.hdr" and
16853 "capture.res.hdr" (sample fetches).
Thierry FOURNIER35ab2752015-05-28 13:22:03 +020016854
16855capture-res(<id>)
16856 Capture the string entry in the response slot <id> and returns the entry as
16857 is. If the slot doesn't exist, the capture fails silently.
16858
16859 See also: "declare capture", "http-request capture",
Baptiste Assmann5ac425c2015-10-21 23:13:46 +020016860 "http-response capture", "capture.req.hdr" and
16861 "capture.res.hdr" (sample fetches).
Thierry FOURNIER35ab2752015-05-28 13:22:03 +020016862
Christopher Faulet568415a2020-04-01 17:24:47 +020016863rtrim(<chars>)
16864 Skips any characters from <chars> from the end of the string representation
16865 of the input sample.
16866
Willy Tarreau23ec4ca2014-07-15 20:15:37 +020016867sdbm([<avalanche>])
16868 Hashes a binary input sample into an unsigned 32-bit quantity using the SDBM
16869 hash function. Optionally, it is possible to apply a full avalanche hash
16870 function to the output if the optional <avalanche> argument equals 1. This
16871 converter uses the same functions as used by the various hash-based load
16872 balancing algorithms, so it will provide exactly the same results. It is
16873 mostly intended for debugging, but can be used as a stick-table entry to
16874 collect rough statistics. It must not be used for security purposes as a
Emmanuel Hocdet50791a72018-03-21 11:19:01 +010016875 32-bit hash is trivial to break. See also "crc32", "djb2", "wt6", "crc32c",
16876 and the "hash-type" directive.
Willy Tarreau23ec4ca2014-07-15 20:15:37 +020016877
Tim Duesterhusf38175c2020-06-09 11:48:42 +020016878secure_memcmp(<var>)
16879 Compares the contents of <var> with the input value. Both values are treated
16880 as a binary string. Returns a boolean indicating whether both binary strings
16881 match.
16882
16883 If both binary strings have the same length then the comparison will be
16884 performed in constant time.
16885
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040016886 Please note that this converter is only available when HAProxy has been
Tim Duesterhusf38175c2020-06-09 11:48:42 +020016887 compiled with USE_OPENSSL.
16888
16889 Example :
16890
16891 http-request set-var(txn.token) hdr(token)
16892 # Check whether the token sent by the client matches the secret token
16893 # value, without leaking the contents using a timing attack.
16894 acl token_given str(my_secret_token),secure_memcmp(txn.token)
16895
Tim Duesterhusef4e45c2021-01-21 17:40:50 +010016896set-var(<var>)
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016897 Sets a variable with the input content and returns the content on the output
16898 as-is. The variable keeps the value and the associated input type. The name of
16899 the variable starts with an indication about its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010016900 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010016901 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
16902 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020016903 response),
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010016904 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing,
16905 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020016906 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010016907 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020016908
Dragan Dosen6e5a9ca2017-10-24 09:18:23 +020016909sha1
Tim Duesterhusd4376302019-06-17 12:41:44 +020016910 Converts a binary input sample to a SHA-1 digest. The result is a binary
Dragan Dosen6e5a9ca2017-10-24 09:18:23 +020016911 sample with length of 20 bytes.
16912
Tim Duesterhusd4376302019-06-17 12:41:44 +020016913sha2([<bits>])
16914 Converts a binary input sample to a digest in the SHA-2 family. The result
16915 is a binary sample with length of <bits>/8 bytes.
16916
16917 Valid values for <bits> are 224, 256, 384, 512, each corresponding to
16918 SHA-<bits>. The default value is 256.
16919
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040016920 Please note that this converter is only available when HAProxy has been
Tim Duesterhusd4376302019-06-17 12:41:44 +020016921 compiled with USE_OPENSSL.
16922
Nenad Merdanovic177adc92019-08-27 01:58:13 +020016923srv_queue
16924 Takes an input value of type string, either a server name or <backend>/<server>
16925 format and returns the number of queued sessions on that server. Can be used
16926 in places where we want to look up queued sessions from a dynamic name, like a
16927 cookie value (e.g. req.cook(SRVID),srv_queue) and then make a decision to break
16928 persistence or direct a request elsewhere.
16929
Tim Duesterhusca097c12018-04-27 21:18:45 +020016930strcmp(<var>)
16931 Compares the contents of <var> with the input value of type string. Returns
16932 the result as a signed integer compatible with strcmp(3): 0 if both strings
16933 are identical. A value less than 0 if the left string is lexicographically
16934 smaller than the right string or if the left string is shorter. A value greater
16935 than 0 otherwise (right string greater than left string or the right string is
16936 shorter).
16937
Tim Duesterhusf38175c2020-06-09 11:48:42 +020016938 See also the secure_memcmp converter if you need to compare two binary
16939 strings in constant time.
16940
Tim Duesterhusca097c12018-04-27 21:18:45 +020016941 Example :
16942
16943 http-request set-var(txn.host) hdr(host)
16944 # Check whether the client is attempting domain fronting.
16945 acl ssl_sni_http_host_match ssl_fc_sni,strcmp(txn.host) eq 0
16946
16947
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010016948sub(<value>)
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020016949 Subtracts <value> from the input value of type signed integer, and returns
16950 the result as an signed integer. Note: in order to subtract the input from
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020016951 a constant, simply perform a "neg,add(value)". <value> can be a numeric value
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010016952 or a variable name. The name of the variable starts with an indication about
16953 its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010016954 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010016955 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
16956 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020016957 response),
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010016958 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing,
16959 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing.
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020016960 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010016961 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010016962
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020016963table_bytes_in_rate(<table>)
16964 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
16965 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
16966 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the average client-to-server
16967 bytes rate associated with the input sample in the designated table, measured
16968 in amount of bytes over the period configured in the table. See also the
16969 sc_bytes_in_rate sample fetch keyword.
16970
16971
16972table_bytes_out_rate(<table>)
16973 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
16974 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
16975 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the average server-to-client
16976 bytes rate associated with the input sample in the designated table, measured
16977 in amount of bytes over the period configured in the table. See also the
16978 sc_bytes_out_rate sample fetch keyword.
16979
16980table_conn_cnt(<table>)
16981 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
16982 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016983 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the cumulative number of incoming
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020016984 connections associated with the input sample in the designated table. See
16985 also the sc_conn_cnt sample fetch keyword.
16986
16987table_conn_cur(<table>)
16988 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
16989 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
16990 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the current amount of concurrent
16991 tracked connections associated with the input sample in the designated table.
16992 See also the sc_conn_cur sample fetch keyword.
16993
16994table_conn_rate(<table>)
16995 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
16996 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
16997 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the average incoming connection
16998 rate associated with the input sample in the designated table. See also the
16999 sc_conn_rate sample fetch keyword.
17000
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +020017001table_gpt0(<table>)
17002 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
17003 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, boolean value zero
17004 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the current value of the first
17005 general purpose tag associated with the input sample in the designated table.
17006 See also the sc_get_gpt0 sample fetch keyword.
17007
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020017008table_gpc0(<table>)
17009 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
17010 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
17011 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the current value of the first
17012 general purpose counter associated with the input sample in the designated
17013 table. See also the sc_get_gpc0 sample fetch keyword.
17014
17015table_gpc0_rate(<table>)
17016 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
17017 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
17018 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the frequency which the gpc0
17019 counter was incremented over the configured period in the table, associated
17020 with the input sample in the designated table. See also the sc_get_gpc0_rate
17021 sample fetch keyword.
17022
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010017023table_gpc1(<table>)
17024 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
17025 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
17026 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the current value of the second
17027 general purpose counter associated with the input sample in the designated
17028 table. See also the sc_get_gpc1 sample fetch keyword.
17029
17030table_gpc1_rate(<table>)
17031 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
17032 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
17033 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the frequency which the gpc1
17034 counter was incremented over the configured period in the table, associated
17035 with the input sample in the designated table. See also the sc_get_gpc1_rate
17036 sample fetch keyword.
17037
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020017038table_http_err_cnt(<table>)
17039 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
17040 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017041 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the cumulative number of HTTP
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020017042 errors associated with the input sample in the designated table. See also the
17043 sc_http_err_cnt sample fetch keyword.
17044
17045table_http_err_rate(<table>)
17046 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
17047 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
17048 is returned. Otherwise the average rate of HTTP errors associated with the
17049 input sample in the designated table, measured in amount of errors over the
17050 period configured in the table. See also the sc_http_err_rate sample fetch
17051 keyword.
17052
Willy Tarreau826f3ab2021-02-10 12:07:15 +010017053table_http_fail_cnt(<table>)
17054 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
17055 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
17056 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the cumulative number of HTTP
17057 failures associated with the input sample in the designated table. See also
17058 the sc_http_fail_cnt sample fetch keyword.
17059
17060table_http_fail_rate(<table>)
17061 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
17062 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
17063 is returned. Otherwise the average rate of HTTP failures associated with the
17064 input sample in the designated table, measured in amount of failures over the
17065 period configured in the table. See also the sc_http_fail_rate sample fetch
17066 keyword.
17067
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020017068table_http_req_cnt(<table>)
17069 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
17070 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017071 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the cumulative number of HTTP
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020017072 requests associated with the input sample in the designated table. See also
17073 the sc_http_req_cnt sample fetch keyword.
17074
17075table_http_req_rate(<table>)
17076 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
17077 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
17078 is returned. Otherwise the average rate of HTTP requests associated with the
17079 input sample in the designated table, measured in amount of requests over the
17080 period configured in the table. See also the sc_http_req_rate sample fetch
17081 keyword.
17082
17083table_kbytes_in(<table>)
17084 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
17085 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017086 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the cumulative number of client-
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020017087 to-server data associated with the input sample in the designated table,
17088 measured in kilobytes. The test is currently performed on 32-bit integers,
17089 which limits values to 4 terabytes. See also the sc_kbytes_in sample fetch
17090 keyword.
17091
17092table_kbytes_out(<table>)
17093 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
17094 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017095 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the cumulative number of server-
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020017096 to-client data associated with the input sample in the designated table,
17097 measured in kilobytes. The test is currently performed on 32-bit integers,
17098 which limits values to 4 terabytes. See also the sc_kbytes_out sample fetch
17099 keyword.
17100
17101table_server_id(<table>)
17102 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
17103 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
17104 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the server ID associated with
17105 the input sample in the designated table. A server ID is associated to a
17106 sample by a "stick" rule when a connection to a server succeeds. A server ID
17107 zero means that no server is associated with this key.
17108
17109table_sess_cnt(<table>)
17110 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
17111 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017112 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the cumulative number of incoming
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020017113 sessions associated with the input sample in the designated table. Note that
17114 a session here refers to an incoming connection being accepted by the
17115 "tcp-request connection" rulesets. See also the sc_sess_cnt sample fetch
17116 keyword.
17117
17118table_sess_rate(<table>)
17119 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
17120 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
17121 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the average incoming session
17122 rate associated with the input sample in the designated table. Note that a
17123 session here refers to an incoming connection being accepted by the
17124 "tcp-request connection" rulesets. See also the sc_sess_rate sample fetch
17125 keyword.
17126
17127table_trackers(<table>)
17128 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
17129 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
17130 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the current amount of concurrent
17131 connections tracking the same key as the input sample in the designated
17132 table. It differs from table_conn_cur in that it does not rely on any stored
17133 information but on the table's reference count (the "use" value which is
17134 returned by "show table" on the CLI). This may sometimes be more suited for
17135 layer7 tracking. It can be used to tell a server how many concurrent
17136 connections there are from a given address for example. See also the
17137 sc_trackers sample fetch keyword.
17138
Moemen MHEDHBI92f7d432021-04-01 20:53:59 +020017139ub64dec
17140 This converter is the base64url variant of b64dec converter. base64url
17141 encoding is the "URL and Filename Safe Alphabet" variant of base64 encoding.
17142 It is also the encoding used in JWT (JSON Web Token) standard.
17143
17144 Example:
17145 # Decoding a JWT payload:
17146 http-request set-var(txn.token_payload) req.hdr(Authorization),word(2,.),ub64dec
17147
17148ub64enc
17149 This converter is the base64url variant of base64 converter.
17150
Willy Tarreauffcb2e42014-07-10 16:29:08 +020017151upper
17152 Convert a string sample to upper case. This can only be placed after a string
17153 sample fetch function or after a transformation keyword returning a string
17154 type. The result is of type string.
17155
Willy Tarreau62ba9ba2020-04-23 17:54:47 +020017156url_dec([<in_form>])
17157 Takes an url-encoded string provided as input and returns the decoded version
17158 as output. The input and the output are of type string. If the <in_form>
17159 argument is set to a non-zero integer value, the input string is assumed to
17160 be part of a form or query string and the '+' character will be turned into a
17161 space (' '). Otherwise this will only happen after a question mark indicating
17162 a query string ('?').
Thierry FOURNIER82ff3c92015-05-07 15:46:20 +020017163
William Dauchy888b0ae2021-01-06 23:39:50 +010017164url_enc([<enc_type>])
17165 Takes a string provided as input and returns the encoded version as output.
17166 The input and the output are of type string. By default the type of encoding
17167 is meant for `query` type. There is no other type supported for now but the
17168 optional argument is here for future changes.
17169
Frédéric Lécaille756d97f2019-03-04 19:03:48 +010017170ungrpc(<field_number>,[<field_type>])
Frédéric Lécaille50290fb2019-02-27 14:34:51 +010017171 This extracts the protocol buffers message field in raw mode of an input binary
Frédéric Lécaillebfe61382019-03-06 14:34:36 +010017172 sample representation of a gRPC message with <field_number> as field number
17173 (dotted notation) if <field_type> is not present, or as an integer sample if this
17174 field is present.
Frédéric Lécaille756d97f2019-03-04 19:03:48 +010017175 The list of the authorized types is the following one: "int32", "int64", "uint32",
17176 "uint64", "sint32", "sint64", "bool", "enum" for the "varint" wire type 0
17177 "fixed64", "sfixed64", "double" for the 64bit wire type 1, "fixed32", "sfixed32",
17178 "float" for the wire type 5. Note that "string" is considered as a length-delimited
Frédéric Lécaille93d33162019-03-06 09:35:59 +010017179 type, so it does not require any <field_type> argument to be extracted.
Frédéric Lécaille756d97f2019-03-04 19:03:48 +010017180 More information may be found here about the protocol buffers message field types:
17181 https://developers.google.com/protocol-buffers/docs/encoding
Frédéric Lécaille50290fb2019-02-27 14:34:51 +010017182
17183 Example:
17184 // with such a protocol buffer .proto file content adapted from
17185 // https://github.com/grpc/grpc/blob/master/examples/protos/route_guide.proto
17186
17187 message Point {
17188 int32 latitude = 1;
17189 int32 longitude = 2;
17190 }
17191
17192 message PPoint {
17193 Point point = 59;
17194 }
17195
17196 message Rectangle {
17197 // One corner of the rectangle.
17198 PPoint lo = 48;
17199 // The other corner of the rectangle.
17200 PPoint hi = 49;
17201 }
17202
Peter Gervaidf4c9d22020-06-11 18:05:11 +020017203 let's say a body request is made of a "Rectangle" object value (two PPoint
17204 protocol buffers messages), the four protocol buffers fields could be
17205 extracted with these "ungrpc" directives:
Frédéric Lécaille50290fb2019-02-27 14:34:51 +010017206
Frédéric Lécaille756d97f2019-03-04 19:03:48 +010017207 req.body,ungrpc(48.59.1,int32) # "latitude" of "lo" first PPoint
17208 req.body,ungrpc(48.59.2,int32) # "longitude" of "lo" first PPoint
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050017209 req.body,ungrpc(49.59.1,int32) # "latitude" of "hi" second PPoint
Frédéric Lécaille756d97f2019-03-04 19:03:48 +010017210 req.body,ungrpc(49.59.2,int32) # "longitude" of "hi" second PPoint
17211
Peter Gervaidf4c9d22020-06-11 18:05:11 +020017212 We could also extract the intermediary 48.59 field as a binary sample as follows:
Frédéric Lécaille756d97f2019-03-04 19:03:48 +010017213
Frédéric Lécaille93d33162019-03-06 09:35:59 +010017214 req.body,ungrpc(48.59)
Frédéric Lécaille756d97f2019-03-04 19:03:48 +010017215
Peter Gervaidf4c9d22020-06-11 18:05:11 +020017216 As a gRPC message is always made of a gRPC header followed by protocol buffers
17217 messages, in the previous example the "latitude" of "lo" first PPoint
17218 could be extracted with these equivalent directives:
Frédéric Lécaillebfe61382019-03-06 14:34:36 +010017219
17220 req.body,ungrpc(48.59),protobuf(1,int32)
17221 req.body,ungrpc(48),protobuf(59.1,int32)
17222 req.body,ungrpc(48),protobuf(59),protobuf(1,int32)
17223
Peter Gervaidf4c9d22020-06-11 18:05:11 +020017224 Note that the first convert must be "ungrpc", the remaining ones must be
17225 "protobuf" and only the last one may have or not a second argument to
17226 interpret the previous binary sample.
Frédéric Lécaillebfe61382019-03-06 14:34:36 +010017227
Frédéric Lécaille50290fb2019-02-27 14:34:51 +010017228
Tim Duesterhusef4e45c2021-01-21 17:40:50 +010017229unset-var(<var>)
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +010017230 Unsets a variable if the input content is defined. The name of the variable
17231 starts with an indication about its scope. The scopes allowed are:
17232 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
17233 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
17234 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and
17235 response),
17236 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing,
17237 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing.
17238 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
17239 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
17240
Willy Tarreau0dbfdba2014-07-10 16:37:47 +020017241utime(<format>[,<offset>])
17242 Converts an integer supposed to contain a date since epoch to a string
17243 representing this date in UTC time using a format defined by the <format>
17244 string using strftime(3). The purpose is to allow any date format to be used
17245 in logs. An optional <offset> in seconds may be applied to the input date
17246 (positive or negative). See the strftime() man page for the format supported
17247 by your operating system. See also the ltime converter.
17248
17249 Example :
17250
17251 # Emit two colons, one with the UTC time and another with ip:port
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017252 # e.g. 20140710162350 127.0.0.1:57325
Willy Tarreau0dbfdba2014-07-10 16:37:47 +020017253 log-format %[date,utime(%Y%m%d%H%M%S)]\ %ci:%cp
17254
Marcin Deranek9631a282018-04-16 14:30:46 +020017255word(<index>,<delimiters>[,<count>])
17256 Extracts the nth word counting from the beginning (positive index) or from
17257 the end (negative index) considering given delimiters from an input string.
17258 Indexes start at 1 or -1 and delimiters are a string formatted list of chars.
Jerome Magnin88209322020-01-28 13:33:44 +010017259 Delimiters at the beginning or end of the input string are ignored.
Marcin Deranek9631a282018-04-16 14:30:46 +020017260 Optionally you can specify <count> of words to extract (default: 1).
17261 Value of 0 indicates extraction of all remaining words.
17262
17263 Example :
17264 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),word(4,_) # f5
17265 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),word(2,_,0) # f2_f3__f5
17266 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),word(3,_,2) # f3__f5
17267 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),word(-2,_,3) # f1_f2_f3
17268 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),word(-3,_,0) # f1_f2
Jerome Magnin88209322020-01-28 13:33:44 +010017269 str(/f1/f2/f3/f4),word(1,/) # f1
Emeric Brunc9a0f6d2014-11-25 14:09:01 +010017270
Willy Tarreau23ec4ca2014-07-15 20:15:37 +020017271wt6([<avalanche>])
17272 Hashes a binary input sample into an unsigned 32-bit quantity using the WT6
17273 hash function. Optionally, it is possible to apply a full avalanche hash
17274 function to the output if the optional <avalanche> argument equals 1. This
17275 converter uses the same functions as used by the various hash-based load
17276 balancing algorithms, so it will provide exactly the same results. It is
17277 mostly intended for debugging, but can be used as a stick-table entry to
17278 collect rough statistics. It must not be used for security purposes as a
Emmanuel Hocdet50791a72018-03-21 11:19:01 +010017279 32-bit hash is trivial to break. See also "crc32", "djb2", "sdbm", "crc32c",
17280 and the "hash-type" directive.
Willy Tarreau23ec4ca2014-07-15 20:15:37 +020017281
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010017282xor(<value>)
17283 Performs a bitwise "XOR" (exclusive OR) between <value> and the input value
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020017284 of type signed integer, and returns the result as an signed integer.
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020017285 <value> can be a numeric value or a variable name. The name of the variable
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010017286 starts with an indication about its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010017287 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010017288 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
17289 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020017290 response),
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010017291 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing,
17292 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing.
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020017293 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010017294 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010017295
Dragan Dosen04bf0cc2020-12-22 21:44:33 +010017296xxh3([<seed>])
17297 Hashes a binary input sample into a signed 64-bit quantity using the XXH3
17298 64-bit variant of the XXhash hash function. This hash supports a seed which
17299 defaults to zero but a different value maybe passed as the <seed> argument.
17300 This hash is known to be very good and very fast so it can be used to hash
17301 URLs and/or URL parameters for use as stick-table keys to collect statistics
17302 with a low collision rate, though care must be taken as the algorithm is not
17303 considered as cryptographically secure.
17304
Thierry FOURNIER01e09742016-12-26 11:46:11 +010017305xxh32([<seed>])
17306 Hashes a binary input sample into an unsigned 32-bit quantity using the 32-bit
17307 variant of the XXHash hash function. This hash supports a seed which defaults
17308 to zero but a different value maybe passed as the <seed> argument. This hash
17309 is known to be very good and very fast so it can be used to hash URLs and/or
17310 URL parameters for use as stick-table keys to collect statistics with a low
17311 collision rate, though care must be taken as the algorithm is not considered
17312 as cryptographically secure.
17313
17314xxh64([<seed>])
17315 Hashes a binary input sample into a signed 64-bit quantity using the 64-bit
17316 variant of the XXHash hash function. This hash supports a seed which defaults
17317 to zero but a different value maybe passed as the <seed> argument. This hash
17318 is known to be very good and very fast so it can be used to hash URLs and/or
17319 URL parameters for use as stick-table keys to collect statistics with a low
17320 collision rate, though care must be taken as the algorithm is not considered
17321 as cryptographically secure.
17322
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010017323
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +0200173247.3.2. Fetching samples from internal states
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017325--------------------------------------------
17326
17327A first set of sample fetch methods applies to internal information which does
17328not even relate to any client information. These ones are sometimes used with
17329"monitor-fail" directives to report an internal status to external watchers.
17330The sample fetch methods described in this section are usable anywhere.
17331
17332always_false : boolean
17333 Always returns the boolean "false" value. It may be used with ACLs as a
17334 temporary replacement for another one when adjusting configurations.
17335
17336always_true : boolean
17337 Always returns the boolean "true" value. It may be used with ACLs as a
17338 temporary replacement for another one when adjusting configurations.
17339
17340avg_queue([<backend>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010017341 Returns the total number of queued connections of the designated backend
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017342 divided by the number of active servers. The current backend is used if no
17343 backend is specified. This is very similar to "queue" except that the size of
17344 the farm is considered, in order to give a more accurate measurement of the
17345 time it may take for a new connection to be processed. The main usage is with
17346 ACL to return a sorry page to new users when it becomes certain they will get
17347 a degraded service, or to pass to the backend servers in a header so that
17348 they decide to work in degraded mode or to disable some functions to speed up
17349 the processing a bit. Note that in the event there would not be any active
17350 server anymore, twice the number of queued connections would be considered as
17351 the measured value. This is a fair estimate, as we expect one server to get
17352 back soon anyway, but we still prefer to send new traffic to another backend
17353 if in better shape. See also the "queue", "be_conn", and "be_sess_rate"
17354 sample fetches.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki346f76d2010-01-12 21:59:30 +010017355
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017356be_conn([<backend>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaua36af912009-10-10 12:02:45 +020017357 Applies to the number of currently established connections on the backend,
17358 possibly including the connection being evaluated. If no backend name is
17359 specified, the current one is used. But it is also possible to check another
17360 backend. It can be used to use a specific farm when the nominal one is full.
Patrick Hemmer4cdf3ab2018-06-14 17:10:27 -040017361 See also the "fe_conn", "queue", "be_conn_free", and "be_sess_rate" criteria.
17362
17363be_conn_free([<backend>]) : integer
17364 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of available connections
17365 across available servers in the backend. Queue slots are not included. Backup
17366 servers are also not included, unless all other servers are down. If no
17367 backend name is specified, the current one is used. But it is also possible
17368 to check another backend. It can be used to use a specific farm when the
Patrick Hemmer155e93e2018-06-14 18:01:35 -040017369 nominal one is full. See also the "be_conn", "connslots", and "srv_conn_free"
17370 criteria.
Patrick Hemmer4cdf3ab2018-06-14 17:10:27 -040017371
17372 OTHER CAVEATS AND NOTES: if any of the server maxconn, or maxqueue is 0
17373 (meaning unlimited), then this fetch clearly does not make sense, in which
17374 case the value returned will be -1.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020017375
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017376be_sess_rate([<backend>]) : integer
17377 Returns an integer value corresponding to the sessions creation rate on the
17378 backend, in number of new sessions per second. This is used with ACLs to
17379 switch to an alternate backend when an expensive or fragile one reaches too
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017380 high a session rate, or to limit abuse of service (e.g. prevent sucking of an
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017381 online dictionary). It can also be useful to add this element to logs using a
17382 log-format directive.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010017383
17384 Example :
17385 # Redirect to an error page if the dictionary is requested too often
17386 backend dynamic
17387 mode http
17388 acl being_scanned be_sess_rate gt 100
17389 redirect location /denied.html if being_scanned
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010017390
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017391bin(<hex>) : bin
Thierry FOURNIERcc103292015-06-06 19:30:17 +020017392 Returns a binary chain. The input is the hexadecimal representation
17393 of the string.
17394
17395bool(<bool>) : bool
17396 Returns a boolean value. <bool> can be 'true', 'false', '1' or '0'.
17397 'false' and '0' are the same. 'true' and '1' are the same.
17398
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017399connslots([<backend>]) : integer
17400 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of connection slots
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030017401 still available in the backend, by totaling the maximum amount of
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017402 connections on all servers and the maximum queue size. This is probably only
17403 used with ACLs.
Tait Clarridge7896d522012-12-05 21:39:31 -050017404
Jeffrey 'jf' Lim5051d7b2008-09-04 01:03:03 +080017405 The basic idea here is to be able to measure the number of connection "slots"
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020017406 still available (connection + queue), so that anything beyond that (intended
Jeffrey 'jf' Lim5051d7b2008-09-04 01:03:03 +080017407 usage; see "use_backend" keyword) can be redirected to a different backend.
17408
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020017409 'connslots' = number of available server connection slots, + number of
17410 available server queue slots.
Jeffrey 'jf' Lim5051d7b2008-09-04 01:03:03 +080017411
Willy Tarreaua36af912009-10-10 12:02:45 +020017412 Note that while "fe_conn" may be used, "connslots" comes in especially
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020017413 useful when you have a case of traffic going to one single ip, splitting into
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017414 multiple backends (perhaps using ACLs to do name-based load balancing) and
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020017415 you want to be able to differentiate between different backends, and their
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017416 available "connslots". Also, whereas "nbsrv" only measures servers that are
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017417 actually *down*, this fetch is more fine-grained and looks into the number of
Willy Tarreaua36af912009-10-10 12:02:45 +020017418 available connection slots as well. See also "queue" and "avg_queue".
Jeffrey 'jf' Lim5051d7b2008-09-04 01:03:03 +080017419
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020017420 OTHER CAVEATS AND NOTES: at this point in time, the code does not take care
17421 of dynamic connections. Also, if any of the server maxconn, or maxqueue is 0,
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017422 then this fetch clearly does not make sense, in which case the value returned
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020017423 will be -1.
Jeffrey 'jf' Lim5051d7b2008-09-04 01:03:03 +080017424
Willy Tarreau70fe9442018-11-22 16:07:39 +010017425cpu_calls : integer
17426 Returns the number of calls to the task processing the stream or current
17427 request since it was allocated. This number is reset for each new request on
17428 the same connections in case of HTTP keep-alive. This value should usually be
17429 low and stable (around 2 calls for a typically simple request) but may become
17430 high if some processing (compression, caching or analysis) is performed. This
17431 is purely for performance monitoring purposes.
17432
17433cpu_ns_avg : integer
17434 Returns the average number of nanoseconds spent in each call to the task
17435 processing the stream or current request. This number is reset for each new
17436 request on the same connections in case of HTTP keep-alive. This value
17437 indicates the overall cost of processing the request or the connection for
17438 each call. There is no good nor bad value but the time spent in a call
17439 automatically causes latency for other processing (see lat_ns_avg below),
17440 and may affect other connection's apparent response time. Certain operations
17441 like compression, complex regex matching or heavy Lua operations may directly
17442 affect this value, and having it in the logs will make it easier to spot the
17443 faulty processing that needs to be fixed to recover decent performance.
17444 Note: this value is exactly cpu_ns_tot divided by cpu_calls.
17445
17446cpu_ns_tot : integer
17447 Returns the total number of nanoseconds spent in each call to the task
17448 processing the stream or current request. This number is reset for each new
17449 request on the same connections in case of HTTP keep-alive. This value
17450 indicates the overall cost of processing the request or the connection for
17451 each call. There is no good nor bad value but the time spent in a call
17452 automatically causes latency for other processing (see lat_ns_avg below),
17453 induces CPU costs on the machine, and may affect other connection's apparent
17454 response time. Certain operations like compression, complex regex matching or
17455 heavy Lua operations may directly affect this value, and having it in the
17456 logs will make it easier to spot the faulty processing that needs to be fixed
17457 to recover decent performance. The value may be artificially high due to a
17458 high cpu_calls count, for example when processing many HTTP chunks, and for
17459 this reason it is often preferred to log cpu_ns_avg instead.
17460
Cyril Bonté6bcd1822019-11-05 23:13:59 +010017461date([<offset>],[<unit>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau6236d3a2013-07-25 14:28:25 +020017462 Returns the current date as the epoch (number of seconds since 01/01/1970).
Damien Claisseae6f1252019-10-30 15:57:28 +000017463
17464 If an offset value is specified, then it is added to the current date before
17465 returning the value. This is particularly useful to compute relative dates,
17466 as both positive and negative offsets are allowed.
Willy Tarreau276fae92013-07-25 14:36:01 +020017467 It is useful combined with the http_date converter.
17468
Damien Claisseae6f1252019-10-30 15:57:28 +000017469 <unit> is facultative, and can be set to "s" for seconds (default behavior),
17470 "ms" for milliseconds or "us" for microseconds.
17471 If unit is set, return value is an integer reflecting either seconds,
17472 milliseconds or microseconds since epoch, plus offset.
17473 It is useful when a time resolution of less than a second is needed.
17474
Willy Tarreau276fae92013-07-25 14:36:01 +020017475 Example :
17476
17477 # set an expires header to now+1 hour in every response
17478 http-response set-header Expires %[date(3600),http_date]
Willy Tarreau6236d3a2013-07-25 14:28:25 +020017479
Damien Claisseae6f1252019-10-30 15:57:28 +000017480 # set an expires header to now+1 hour in every response, with
17481 # millisecond granularity
17482 http-response set-header Expires %[date(3600000,ms),http_date(0,ms)]
17483
Etienne Carrierea792a0a2018-01-17 13:43:24 +010017484date_us : integer
17485 Return the microseconds part of the date (the "second" part is returned by
17486 date sample). This sample is coherent with the date sample as it is comes
17487 from the same timeval structure.
17488
Willy Tarreaud716f9b2017-10-13 11:03:15 +020017489distcc_body(<token>[,<occ>]) : binary
17490 Parses a distcc message and returns the body associated to occurrence #<occ>
17491 of the token <token>. Occurrences start at 1, and when unspecified, any may
17492 match though in practice only the first one is checked for now. This can be
17493 used to extract file names or arguments in files built using distcc through
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040017494 HAProxy. Please refer to distcc's protocol documentation for the complete
Willy Tarreaud716f9b2017-10-13 11:03:15 +020017495 list of supported tokens.
17496
17497distcc_param(<token>[,<occ>]) : integer
17498 Parses a distcc message and returns the parameter associated to occurrence
17499 #<occ> of the token <token>. Occurrences start at 1, and when unspecified,
17500 any may match though in practice only the first one is checked for now. This
17501 can be used to extract certain information such as the protocol version, the
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040017502 file size or the argument in files built using distcc through HAProxy.
Willy Tarreaud716f9b2017-10-13 11:03:15 +020017503 Another use case consists in waiting for the start of the preprocessed file
17504 contents before connecting to the server to avoid keeping idle connections.
17505 Please refer to distcc's protocol documentation for the complete list of
17506 supported tokens.
17507
17508 Example :
17509 # wait up to 20s for the pre-processed file to be uploaded
17510 tcp-request inspect-delay 20s
17511 tcp-request content accept if { distcc_param(DOTI) -m found }
17512 # send large files to the big farm
17513 use_backend big_farm if { distcc_param(DOTI) gt 1000000 }
17514
Willy Tarreau595ec542013-06-12 21:34:28 +020017515env(<name>) : string
17516 Returns a string containing the value of environment variable <name>. As a
17517 reminder, environment variables are per-process and are sampled when the
17518 process starts. This can be useful to pass some information to a next hop
17519 server, or with ACLs to take specific action when the process is started a
17520 certain way.
17521
17522 Examples :
17523 # Pass the Via header to next hop with the local hostname in it
17524 http-request add-header Via 1.1\ %[env(HOSTNAME)]
17525
17526 # reject cookie-less requests when the STOP environment variable is set
Christian Ruppertfd3184c2022-02-20 22:54:01 +010017527 http-request deny if !{ req.cook(SESSIONID) -m found } { env(STOP) -m found }
Willy Tarreau595ec542013-06-12 21:34:28 +020017528
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017529fe_conn([<frontend>]) : integer
17530 Returns the number of currently established connections on the frontend,
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010017531 possibly including the connection being evaluated. If no frontend name is
17532 specified, the current one is used. But it is also possible to check another
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017533 frontend. It can be used to return a sorry page before hard-blocking, or to
17534 use a specific backend to drain new requests when the farm is considered
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017535 full. This is mostly used with ACLs but can also be used to pass some
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017536 statistics to servers in HTTP headers. See also the "dst_conn", "be_conn",
17537 "fe_sess_rate" fetches.
Willy Tarreaua36af912009-10-10 12:02:45 +020017538
Nenad Merdanovicad9a7e92016-10-03 04:57:37 +020017539fe_req_rate([<frontend>]) : integer
17540 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of HTTP requests per
17541 second sent to a frontend. This number can differ from "fe_sess_rate" in
17542 situations where client-side keep-alive is enabled.
17543
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017544fe_sess_rate([<frontend>]) : integer
17545 Returns an integer value corresponding to the sessions creation rate on the
17546 frontend, in number of new sessions per second. This is used with ACLs to
17547 limit the incoming session rate to an acceptable range in order to prevent
17548 abuse of service at the earliest moment, for example when combined with other
17549 layer 4 ACLs in order to force the clients to wait a bit for the rate to go
17550 down below the limit. It can also be useful to add this element to logs using
17551 a log-format directive. See also the "rate-limit sessions" directive for use
17552 in frontends.
Willy Tarreau079ff0a2009-03-05 21:34:28 +010017553
17554 Example :
17555 # This frontend limits incoming mails to 10/s with a max of 100
17556 # concurrent connections. We accept any connection below 10/s, and
17557 # force excess clients to wait for 100 ms. Since clients are limited to
17558 # 100 max, there cannot be more than 10 incoming mails per second.
17559 frontend mail
17560 bind :25
17561 mode tcp
17562 maxconn 100
17563 acl too_fast fe_sess_rate ge 10
17564 tcp-request inspect-delay 100ms
17565 tcp-request content accept if ! too_fast
17566 tcp-request content accept if WAIT_END
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010017567
Nenad Merdanovic807a6e72017-03-12 22:00:00 +010017568hostname : string
17569 Returns the system hostname.
17570
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020017571int(<integer>) : signed integer
17572 Returns a signed integer.
17573
Thierry FOURNIERcc103292015-06-06 19:30:17 +020017574ipv4(<ipv4>) : ipv4
17575 Returns an ipv4.
17576
17577ipv6(<ipv6>) : ipv6
17578 Returns an ipv6.
17579
Willy Tarreau70fe9442018-11-22 16:07:39 +010017580lat_ns_avg : integer
17581 Returns the average number of nanoseconds spent between the moment the task
17582 handling the stream is woken up and the moment it is effectively called. This
17583 number is reset for each new request on the same connections in case of HTTP
17584 keep-alive. This value indicates the overall latency inflicted to the current
17585 request by all other requests being processed in parallel, and is a direct
17586 indicator of perceived performance due to noisy neighbours. In order to keep
17587 the value low, it is possible to reduce the scheduler's run queue depth using
17588 "tune.runqueue-depth", to reduce the number of concurrent events processed at
17589 once using "tune.maxpollevents", to decrease the stream's nice value using
Willy Tarreaue7723bd2020-06-24 11:11:02 +020017590 the "nice" option on the "bind" lines or in the frontend, to enable low
17591 latency scheduling using "tune.sched.low-latency", or to look for other heavy
17592 requests in logs (those exhibiting large values of "cpu_ns_avg"), whose
17593 processing needs to be adjusted or fixed. Compression of large buffers could
17594 be a culprit, like heavy regex or long lists of regex. Note: this value is
17595 exactly lat_ns_tot divided by cpu_calls.
Willy Tarreau70fe9442018-11-22 16:07:39 +010017596
17597lat_ns_tot : integer
17598 Returns the total number of nanoseconds spent between the moment the task
17599 handling the stream is woken up and the moment it is effectively called. This
17600 number is reset for each new request on the same connections in case of HTTP
17601 keep-alive. This value indicates the overall latency inflicted to the current
17602 request by all other requests being processed in parallel, and is a direct
17603 indicator of perceived performance due to noisy neighbours. In order to keep
17604 the value low, it is possible to reduce the scheduler's run queue depth using
17605 "tune.runqueue-depth", to reduce the number of concurrent events processed at
17606 once using "tune.maxpollevents", to decrease the stream's nice value using
Willy Tarreaue7723bd2020-06-24 11:11:02 +020017607 the "nice" option on the "bind" lines or in the frontend, to enable low
17608 latency scheduling using "tune.sched.low-latency", or to look for other heavy
17609 requests in logs (those exhibiting large values of "cpu_ns_avg"), whose
17610 processing needs to be adjusted or fixed. Compression of large buffers could
17611 be a culprit, like heavy regex or long lists of regex. Note: while it
Willy Tarreau70fe9442018-11-22 16:07:39 +010017612 may intuitively seem that the total latency adds to a transfer time, it is
17613 almost never true because while a task waits for the CPU, network buffers
17614 continue to fill up and the next call will process more at once. The value
17615 may be artificially high due to a high cpu_calls count, for example when
17616 processing many HTTP chunks, and for this reason it is often preferred to log
17617 lat_ns_avg instead, which is a more relevant performance indicator.
17618
Thierry FOURNIERcc103292015-06-06 19:30:17 +020017619meth(<method>) : method
17620 Returns a method.
17621
Willy Tarreau0f30d262014-11-24 16:02:05 +010017622nbproc : integer
17623 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of processes that were
17624 started (it equals the global "nbproc" setting). This is useful for logging
17625 and debugging purposes.
17626
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017627nbsrv([<backend>]) : integer
17628 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of usable servers of
17629 either the current backend or the named backend. This is mostly used with
17630 ACLs but can also be useful when added to logs. This is normally used to
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010017631 switch to an alternate backend when the number of servers is too low to
17632 to handle some load. It is useful to report a failure when combined with
17633 "monitor fail".
Willy Tarreau079ff0a2009-03-05 21:34:28 +010017634
Patrick Hemmerfabb24f2018-08-13 14:07:57 -040017635prio_class : integer
17636 Returns the priority class of the current session for http mode or connection
17637 for tcp mode. The value will be that set by the last call to "http-request
17638 set-priority-class" or "tcp-request content set-priority-class".
17639
17640prio_offset : integer
17641 Returns the priority offset of the current session for http mode or
17642 connection for tcp mode. The value will be that set by the last call to
17643 "http-request set-priority-offset" or "tcp-request content
17644 set-priority-offset".
17645
Willy Tarreau0f30d262014-11-24 16:02:05 +010017646proc : integer
17647 Returns an integer value corresponding to the position of the process calling
17648 the function, between 1 and global.nbproc. This is useful for logging and
17649 debugging purposes.
17650
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017651queue([<backend>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010017652 Returns the total number of queued connections of the designated backend,
17653 including all the connections in server queues. If no backend name is
17654 specified, the current one is used, but it is also possible to check another
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017655 one. This is useful with ACLs or to pass statistics to backend servers. This
17656 can be used to take actions when queuing goes above a known level, generally
17657 indicating a surge of traffic or a massive slowdown on the servers. One
17658 possible action could be to reject new users but still accept old ones. See
17659 also the "avg_queue", "be_conn", and "be_sess_rate" fetches.
17660
Willy Tarreau84310e22014-02-14 11:59:04 +010017661rand([<range>]) : integer
17662 Returns a random integer value within a range of <range> possible values,
17663 starting at zero. If the range is not specified, it defaults to 2^32, which
17664 gives numbers between 0 and 4294967295. It can be useful to pass some values
17665 needed to take some routing decisions for example, or just for debugging
17666 purposes. This random must not be used for security purposes.
17667
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017668srv_conn([<backend>/]<server>) : integer
17669 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of currently established
17670 connections on the designated server, possibly including the connection being
17671 evaluated. If <backend> is omitted, then the server is looked up in the
17672 current backend. It can be used to use a specific farm when one server is
17673 full, or to inform the server about our view of the number of active
Patrick Hemmer155e93e2018-06-14 18:01:35 -040017674 connections with it. See also the "fe_conn", "be_conn", "queue", and
17675 "srv_conn_free" fetch methods.
17676
17677srv_conn_free([<backend>/]<server>) : integer
17678 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of available connections
17679 on the designated server, possibly including the connection being evaluated.
17680 The value does not include queue slots. If <backend> is omitted, then the
17681 server is looked up in the current backend. It can be used to use a specific
17682 farm when one server is full, or to inform the server about our view of the
17683 number of active connections with it. See also the "be_conn_free" and
17684 "srv_conn" fetch methods.
17685
17686 OTHER CAVEATS AND NOTES: If the server maxconn is 0, then this fetch clearly
17687 does not make sense, in which case the value returned will be -1.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017688
17689srv_is_up([<backend>/]<server>) : boolean
17690 Returns true when the designated server is UP, and false when it is either
17691 DOWN or in maintenance mode. If <backend> is omitted, then the server is
17692 looked up in the current backend. It is mainly used to take action based on
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017693 an external status reported via a health check (e.g. a geographical site's
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017694 availability). Another possible use which is more of a hack consists in
17695 using dummy servers as boolean variables that can be enabled or disabled from
17696 the CLI, so that rules depending on those ACLs can be tweaked in realtime.
17697
Willy Tarreauff2b7af2017-10-13 11:46:26 +020017698srv_queue([<backend>/]<server>) : integer
17699 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of connections currently
17700 pending in the designated server's queue. If <backend> is omitted, then the
17701 server is looked up in the current backend. It can sometimes be used together
17702 with the "use-server" directive to force to use a known faster server when it
17703 is not much loaded. See also the "srv_conn", "avg_queue" and "queue" sample
17704 fetch methods.
17705
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017706srv_sess_rate([<backend>/]<server>) : integer
17707 Returns an integer corresponding to the sessions creation rate on the
17708 designated server, in number of new sessions per second. If <backend> is
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030017709 omitted, then the server is looked up in the current backend. This is mostly
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017710 used with ACLs but can make sense with logs too. This is used to switch to an
17711 alternate backend when an expensive or fragile one reaches too high a session
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017712 rate, or to limit abuse of service (e.g. prevent latent requests from
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017713 overloading servers).
17714
17715 Example :
17716 # Redirect to a separate back
17717 acl srv1_full srv_sess_rate(be1/srv1) gt 50
17718 acl srv2_full srv_sess_rate(be1/srv2) gt 50
17719 use_backend be2 if srv1_full or srv2_full
17720
Alexbf1bd5a2021-04-24 13:02:21 +020017721srv_iweight([<backend>/]<server>) : integer
Christopher Faulet1bea8652020-07-10 16:03:45 +020017722 Returns an integer corresponding to the server's initial weight. If <backend>
17723 is omitted, then the server is looked up in the current backend. See also
17724 "srv_weight" and "srv_uweight".
17725
Alexbf1bd5a2021-04-24 13:02:21 +020017726srv_uweight([<backend>/]<server>) : integer
Christopher Faulet1bea8652020-07-10 16:03:45 +020017727 Returns an integer corresponding to the user visible server's weight. If
17728 <backend> is omitted, then the server is looked up in the current
17729 backend. See also "srv_weight" and "srv_iweight".
17730
Alexbf1bd5a2021-04-24 13:02:21 +020017731srv_weight([<backend>/]<server>) : integer
Christopher Faulet1bea8652020-07-10 16:03:45 +020017732 Returns an integer corresponding to the current (or effective) server's
17733 weight. If <backend> is omitted, then the server is looked up in the current
17734 backend. See also "srv_iweight" and "srv_uweight".
17735
Willy Tarreau0f30d262014-11-24 16:02:05 +010017736stopping : boolean
17737 Returns TRUE if the process calling the function is currently stopping. This
17738 can be useful for logging, or for relaxing certain checks or helping close
17739 certain connections upon graceful shutdown.
17740
Thierry FOURNIERcc103292015-06-06 19:30:17 +020017741str(<string>) : string
17742 Returns a string.
17743
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017744table_avl([<table>]) : integer
17745 Returns the total number of available entries in the current proxy's
17746 stick-table or in the designated stick-table. See also table_cnt.
17747
17748table_cnt([<table>]) : integer
17749 Returns the total number of entries currently in use in the current proxy's
17750 stick-table or in the designated stick-table. See also src_conn_cnt and
17751 table_avl for other entry counting methods.
17752
Christopher Faulet34adb2a2017-11-21 21:45:38 +010017753thread : integer
17754 Returns an integer value corresponding to the position of the thread calling
17755 the function, between 0 and (global.nbthread-1). This is useful for logging
17756 and debugging purposes.
17757
Alexandar Lazica429ad32021-06-01 00:27:01 +020017758uuid([<version>]) : string
17759 Returns a UUID following the RFC4122 standard. If the version is not
17760 specified, a UUID version 4 (fully random) is returned.
17761 Currently, only version 4 is supported.
17762
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020017763var(<var-name>) : undefined
17764 Returns a variable with the stored type. If the variable is not set, the
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010017765 sample fetch fails. The name of the variable starts with an indication
17766 about its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010017767 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010017768 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
17769 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020017770 response),
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010017771 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing,
17772 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020017773 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010017774 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020017775
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +0200177767.3.3. Fetching samples at Layer 4
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017777----------------------------------
17778
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040017779The layer 4 usually describes just the transport layer which in HAProxy is
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017780closest to the connection, where no content is yet made available. The fetch
17781methods described here are usable as low as the "tcp-request connection" rule
17782sets unless they require some future information. Those generally include
17783TCP/IP addresses and ports, as well as elements from stick-tables related to
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020017784the incoming connection. For retrieving a value from a sticky counters, the
17785counter number can be explicitly set as 0, 1, or 2 using the pre-defined
Moemen MHEDHBI9cf46342018-09-25 17:50:53 +020017786"sc0_", "sc1_", or "sc2_" prefix. These three pre-defined prefixes can only be
17787used if MAX_SESS_STKCTR value does not exceed 3, otherwise the counter number
17788can be specified as the first integer argument when using the "sc_" prefix.
17789Starting from "sc_0" to "sc_N" where N is (MAX_SESS_STKCTR-1). An optional
17790table may be specified with the "sc*" form, in which case the currently
17791tracked key will be looked up into this alternate table instead of the table
17792currently being tracked.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017793
Christopher Faulet7d081f02021-04-15 09:38:37 +020017794bc_dst : ip
17795 This is the destination ip address of the connection on the server side,
17796 which is the server address HAProxy connected to. It is of type IP and works
17797 on both IPv4 and IPv6 tables. On IPv6 tables, IPv4 address is mapped to its
17798 IPv6 equivalent, according to RFC 4291.
17799
17800bc_dst_port : integer
17801 Returns an integer value corresponding to the destination TCP port of the
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040017802 connection on the server side, which is the port HAProxy connected to.
Christopher Faulet7d081f02021-04-15 09:38:37 +020017803
Jérôme Magnin35e53a62019-01-16 14:38:37 +010017804bc_http_major : integer
Jérôme Magnin86577422018-12-07 09:03:11 +010017805 Returns the backend connection's HTTP major version encoding, which may be 1
17806 for HTTP/0.9 to HTTP/1.1 or 2 for HTTP/2. Note, this is based on the on-wire
17807 encoding and not the version present in the request header.
17808
Christopher Faulet7d081f02021-04-15 09:38:37 +020017809bc_src : ip
17810 This is the source ip address of the connection on the server side, which is
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040017811 the server address HAProxy connected from. It is of type IP and works on both
Christopher Faulet7d081f02021-04-15 09:38:37 +020017812 IPv4 and IPv6 tables. On IPv6 tables, IPv4 addresses are mapped to their IPv6
17813 equivalent, according to RFC 4291.
17814
17815bc_src_port : integer
17816 Returns an integer value corresponding to the TCP source port of the
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040017817 connection on the server side, which is the port HAProxy connected from.
Christopher Faulet7d081f02021-04-15 09:38:37 +020017818
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017819be_id : integer
17820 Returns an integer containing the current backend's id. It can be used in
Christopher Fauletd1b44642020-04-30 09:51:15 +020017821 frontends with responses to check which backend processed the request. It can
17822 also be used in a tcp-check or an http-check ruleset.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017823
Marcin Deranekd2471c22016-12-12 14:08:05 +010017824be_name : string
17825 Returns a string containing the current backend's name. It can be used in
Christopher Fauletd1b44642020-04-30 09:51:15 +020017826 frontends with responses to check which backend processed the request. It can
17827 also be used in a tcp-check or an http-check ruleset.
Marcin Deranekd2471c22016-12-12 14:08:05 +010017828
Amaury Denoyelled91d7792020-12-10 13:43:56 +010017829be_server_timeout : integer
17830 Returns the configuration value in millisecond for the server timeout of the
17831 current backend. This timeout can be overwritten by a "set-timeout" rule. See
17832 also the "cur_server_timeout".
17833
17834be_tunnel_timeout : integer
17835 Returns the configuration value in millisecond for the tunnel timeout of the
17836 current backend. This timeout can be overwritten by a "set-timeout" rule. See
17837 also the "cur_tunnel_timeout".
17838
Amaury Denoyellef7719a22020-12-10 13:43:58 +010017839cur_server_timeout : integer
17840 Returns the currently applied server timeout in millisecond for the stream.
17841 In the default case, this will be equal to be_server_timeout unless a
17842 "set-timeout" rule has been applied. See also "be_server_timeout".
17843
17844cur_tunnel_timeout : integer
17845 Returns the currently applied tunnel timeout in millisecond for the stream.
17846 In the default case, this will be equal to be_tunnel_timeout unless a
17847 "set-timeout" rule has been applied. See also "be_tunnel_timeout".
17848
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017849dst : ip
17850 This is the destination IPv4 address of the connection on the client side,
17851 which is the address the client connected to. It can be useful when running
17852 in transparent mode. It is of type IP and works on both IPv4 and IPv6 tables.
17853 On IPv6 tables, IPv4 address is mapped to its IPv6 equivalent, according to
Willy Tarreau64ded3d2019-01-23 10:02:15 +010017854 RFC 4291. When the incoming connection passed through address translation or
17855 redirection involving connection tracking, the original destination address
17856 before the redirection will be reported. On Linux systems, the source and
17857 destination may seldom appear reversed if the nf_conntrack_tcp_loose sysctl
17858 is set, because a late response may reopen a timed out connection and switch
17859 what is believed to be the source and the destination.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017860
17861dst_conn : integer
17862 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of currently established
17863 connections on the same socket including the one being evaluated. It is
17864 normally used with ACLs but can as well be used to pass the information to
17865 servers in an HTTP header or in logs. It can be used to either return a sorry
17866 page before hard-blocking, or to use a specific backend to drain new requests
17867 when the socket is considered saturated. This offers the ability to assign
17868 different limits to different listening ports or addresses. See also the
17869 "fe_conn" and "be_conn" fetches.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010017870
Willy Tarreau16e01562016-08-09 16:46:18 +020017871dst_is_local : boolean
17872 Returns true if the destination address of the incoming connection is local
17873 to the system, or false if the address doesn't exist on the system, meaning
17874 that it was intercepted in transparent mode. It can be useful to apply
17875 certain rules by default to forwarded traffic and other rules to the traffic
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017876 targeting the real address of the machine. For example the stats page could
Willy Tarreau16e01562016-08-09 16:46:18 +020017877 be delivered only on this address, or SSH access could be locally redirected.
17878 Please note that the check involves a few system calls, so it's better to do
17879 it only once per connection.
17880
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017881dst_port : integer
17882 Returns an integer value corresponding to the destination TCP port of the
17883 connection on the client side, which is the port the client connected to.
17884 This might be used when running in transparent mode, when assigning dynamic
17885 ports to some clients for a whole application session, to stick all users to
17886 a same server, or to pass the destination port information to a server using
17887 an HTTP header.
17888
Christopher Faulet9f074f62021-10-25 16:18:15 +020017889fc_fackets : integer
17890 Returns the fack counter measured by the kernel for the client
17891 connection. If the server connection is not established, if the connection is
17892 not TCP or if the operating system does not support TCP_INFO, for example
17893 Linux kernels before 2.4, the sample fetch fails.
17894
Willy Tarreau60ca10a2017-08-18 15:26:54 +020017895fc_http_major : integer
17896 Reports the front connection's HTTP major version encoding, which may be 1
17897 for HTTP/0.9 to HTTP/1.1 or 2 for HTTP/2. Note, this is based on the on-wire
17898 encoding and not on the version present in the request header.
17899
Christopher Faulet9f074f62021-10-25 16:18:15 +020017900fc_lost : integer
17901 Returns the lost counter measured by the kernel for the client
17902 connection. If the server connection is not established, if the connection is
17903 not TCP or if the operating system does not support TCP_INFO, for example
17904 Linux kernels before 2.4, the sample fetch fails.
17905
Geoff Simmons7185b782019-08-27 18:31:16 +020017906fc_pp_authority : string
17907 Returns the authority TLV sent by the client in the PROXY protocol header,
17908 if any.
17909
Tim Duesterhusd1b15b62020-03-13 12:34:23 +010017910fc_pp_unique_id : string
17911 Returns the unique ID TLV sent by the client in the PROXY protocol header,
17912 if any.
17913
Emeric Brun4f603012017-01-05 15:11:44 +010017914fc_rcvd_proxy : boolean
17915 Returns true if the client initiated the connection with a PROXY protocol
17916 header.
17917
Christopher Faulet9f074f62021-10-25 16:18:15 +020017918fc_reordering : integer
17919 Returns the reordering counter measured by the kernel for the client
17920 connection. If the server connection is not established, if the connection is
17921 not TCP or if the operating system does not support TCP_INFO, for example
17922 Linux kernels before 2.4, the sample fetch fails.
17923
17924fc_retrans : integer
17925 Returns the retransmits counter measured by the kernel for the client
17926 connection. If the server connection is not established, if the connection is
17927 not TCP or if the operating system does not support TCP_INFO, for example
17928 Linux kernels before 2.4, the sample fetch fails.
17929
Thierry Fournier / OZON.IO6310bef2016-07-24 20:16:50 +020017930fc_rtt(<unit>) : integer
17931 Returns the Round Trip Time (RTT) measured by the kernel for the client
17932 connection. <unit> is facultative, by default the unit is milliseconds. <unit>
17933 can be set to "ms" for milliseconds or "us" for microseconds. If the server
17934 connection is not established, if the connection is not TCP or if the
17935 operating system does not support TCP_INFO, for example Linux kernels before
17936 2.4, the sample fetch fails.
17937
17938fc_rttvar(<unit>) : integer
17939 Returns the Round Trip Time (RTT) variance measured by the kernel for the
17940 client connection. <unit> is facultative, by default the unit is milliseconds.
17941 <unit> can be set to "ms" for milliseconds or "us" for microseconds. If the
17942 server connection is not established, if the connection is not TCP or if the
17943 operating system does not support TCP_INFO, for example Linux kernels before
17944 2.4, the sample fetch fails.
17945
Christopher Fauletba0c53e2019-10-17 14:40:48 +020017946fc_sacked : integer
Joe Williams30fcd392016-08-10 07:06:44 -070017947 Returns the sacked counter measured by the kernel for the client connection.
17948 If the server connection is not established, if the connection is not TCP or
17949 if the operating system does not support TCP_INFO, for example Linux kernels
17950 before 2.4, the sample fetch fails.
17951
Joe Williams30fcd392016-08-10 07:06:44 -070017952
Christopher Faulet9f074f62021-10-25 16:18:15 +020017953fc_unacked : integer
17954 Returns the unacked counter measured by the kernel for the client connection.
17955 If the server connection is not established, if the connection is not TCP or
17956 if the operating system does not support TCP_INFO, for example Linux kernels
17957 before 2.4, the sample fetch fails.
Joe Williams30fcd392016-08-10 07:06:44 -070017958
Marcin Deranek9a66dfb2018-04-13 14:37:50 +020017959fe_defbe : string
17960 Returns a string containing the frontend's default backend name. It can be
17961 used in frontends to check which backend will handle requests by default.
17962
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017963fe_id : integer
17964 Returns an integer containing the current frontend's id. It can be used in
Marcin Deranek6e413ed2016-12-13 12:40:01 +010017965 backends to check from which frontend it was called, or to stick all users
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017966 coming via a same frontend to the same server.
17967
Marcin Deranekd2471c22016-12-12 14:08:05 +010017968fe_name : string
17969 Returns a string containing the current frontend's name. It can be used in
17970 backends to check from which frontend it was called, or to stick all users
17971 coming via a same frontend to the same server.
17972
Amaury Denoyelleda184d52020-12-10 13:43:55 +010017973fe_client_timeout : integer
17974 Returns the configuration value in millisecond for the client timeout of the
17975 current frontend.
17976
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020017977sc_bytes_in_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020017978sc0_bytes_in_rate([<table>]) : integer
17979sc1_bytes_in_rate([<table>]) : integer
17980sc2_bytes_in_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020017981 Returns the average client-to-server bytes rate from the currently tracked
17982 counters, measured in amount of bytes over the period configured in the
17983 table. See also src_bytes_in_rate.
17984
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020017985sc_bytes_out_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020017986sc0_bytes_out_rate([<table>]) : integer
17987sc1_bytes_out_rate([<table>]) : integer
17988sc2_bytes_out_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020017989 Returns the average server-to-client bytes rate from the currently tracked
17990 counters, measured in amount of bytes over the period configured in the
17991 table. See also src_bytes_out_rate.
17992
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020017993sc_clr_gpc0(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020017994sc0_clr_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
17995sc1_clr_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
17996sc2_clr_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020017997 Clears the first General Purpose Counter associated to the currently tracked
17998 counters, and returns its previous value. Before the first invocation, the
Willy Tarreau869948b2013-01-04 14:14:57 +010017999 stored value is zero, so first invocation will always return zero. This is
18000 typically used as a second ACL in an expression in order to mark a connection
18001 when a first ACL was verified :
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020018002
Jarno Huuskonen676f6222017-03-30 09:19:45 +030018003 Example:
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020018004 # block if 5 consecutive requests continue to come faster than 10 sess
18005 # per second, and reset the counter as soon as the traffic slows down.
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020018006 acl abuse sc0_http_req_rate gt 10
18007 acl kill sc0_inc_gpc0 gt 5
18008 acl save sc0_clr_gpc0 ge 0
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020018009 tcp-request connection accept if !abuse save
18010 tcp-request connection reject if abuse kill
18011
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010018012sc_clr_gpc1(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
18013sc0_clr_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
18014sc1_clr_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
18015sc2_clr_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
18016 Clears the second General Purpose Counter associated to the currently tracked
18017 counters, and returns its previous value. Before the first invocation, the
18018 stored value is zero, so first invocation will always return zero. This is
18019 typically used as a second ACL in an expression in order to mark a connection
18020 when a first ACL was verified.
18021
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020018022sc_conn_cnt(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020018023sc0_conn_cnt([<table>]) : integer
18024sc1_conn_cnt([<table>]) : integer
18025sc2_conn_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010018026 Returns the cumulative number of incoming connections from currently tracked
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020018027 counters. See also src_conn_cnt.
18028
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020018029sc_conn_cur(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020018030sc0_conn_cur([<table>]) : integer
18031sc1_conn_cur([<table>]) : integer
18032sc2_conn_cur([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020018033 Returns the current amount of concurrent connections tracking the same
18034 tracked counters. This number is automatically incremented when tracking
18035 begins and decremented when tracking stops. See also src_conn_cur.
18036
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020018037sc_conn_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020018038sc0_conn_rate([<table>]) : integer
18039sc1_conn_rate([<table>]) : integer
18040sc2_conn_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020018041 Returns the average connection rate from the currently tracked counters,
18042 measured in amount of connections over the period configured in the table.
18043 See also src_conn_rate.
18044
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020018045sc_get_gpc0(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020018046sc0_get_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
18047sc1_get_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
18048sc2_get_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020018049 Returns the value of the first General Purpose Counter associated to the
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020018050 currently tracked counters. See also src_get_gpc0 and sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_inc_gpc0.
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +020018051
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010018052sc_get_gpc1(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
18053sc0_get_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
18054sc1_get_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
18055sc2_get_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
18056 Returns the value of the second General Purpose Counter associated to the
18057 currently tracked counters. See also src_get_gpc1 and sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_inc_gpc1.
18058
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +020018059sc_get_gpt0(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
18060sc0_get_gpt0([<table>]) : integer
18061sc1_get_gpt0([<table>]) : integer
18062sc2_get_gpt0([<table>]) : integer
18063 Returns the value of the first General Purpose Tag associated to the
18064 currently tracked counters. See also src_get_gpt0.
18065
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020018066sc_gpc0_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020018067sc0_gpc0_rate([<table>]) : integer
18068sc1_gpc0_rate([<table>]) : integer
18069sc2_gpc0_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +020018070 Returns the average increment rate of the first General Purpose Counter
18071 associated to the currently tracked counters. It reports the frequency
18072 which the gpc0 counter was incremented over the configured period. See also
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020018073 src_gpc0_rate, sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_get_gpc0, and sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_inc_gpc0. Note
18074 that the "gpc0_rate" counter must be stored in the stick-table for a value to
18075 be returned, as "gpc0" only holds the event count.
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020018076
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010018077sc_gpc1_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
18078sc0_gpc1_rate([<table>]) : integer
18079sc1_gpc1_rate([<table>]) : integer
18080sc2_gpc1_rate([<table>]) : integer
18081 Returns the average increment rate of the second General Purpose Counter
18082 associated to the currently tracked counters. It reports the frequency
18083 which the gpc1 counter was incremented over the configured period. See also
18084 src_gpcA_rate, sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_get_gpc1, and sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_inc_gpc1. Note
18085 that the "gpc1_rate" counter must be stored in the stick-table for a value to
18086 be returned, as "gpc1" only holds the event count.
18087
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020018088sc_http_err_cnt(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020018089sc0_http_err_cnt([<table>]) : integer
18090sc1_http_err_cnt([<table>]) : integer
18091sc2_http_err_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010018092 Returns the cumulative number of HTTP errors from the currently tracked
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020018093 counters. This includes the both request errors and 4xx error responses.
18094 See also src_http_err_cnt.
18095
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020018096sc_http_err_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020018097sc0_http_err_rate([<table>]) : integer
18098sc1_http_err_rate([<table>]) : integer
18099sc2_http_err_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020018100 Returns the average rate of HTTP errors from the currently tracked counters,
18101 measured in amount of errors over the period configured in the table. This
18102 includes the both request errors and 4xx error responses. See also
18103 src_http_err_rate.
18104
Willy Tarreau826f3ab2021-02-10 12:07:15 +010018105sc_http_fail_cnt(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
18106sc0_http_fail_cnt([<table>]) : integer
18107sc1_http_fail_cnt([<table>]) : integer
18108sc2_http_fail_cnt([<table>]) : integer
18109 Returns the cumulative number of HTTP response failures from the currently
18110 tracked counters. This includes the both response errors and 5xx status codes
18111 other than 501 and 505. See also src_http_fail_cnt.
18112
18113sc_http_fail_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
18114sc0_http_fail_rate([<table>]) : integer
18115sc1_http_fail_rate([<table>]) : integer
18116sc2_http_fail_rate([<table>]) : integer
18117 Returns the average rate of HTTP response failures from the currently tracked
18118 counters, measured in amount of failures over the period configured in the
18119 table. This includes the both response errors and 5xx status codes other than
18120 501 and 505. See also src_http_fail_rate.
18121
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020018122sc_http_req_cnt(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020018123sc0_http_req_cnt([<table>]) : integer
18124sc1_http_req_cnt([<table>]) : integer
18125sc2_http_req_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010018126 Returns the cumulative number of HTTP requests from the currently tracked
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020018127 counters. This includes every started request, valid or not. See also
18128 src_http_req_cnt.
18129
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020018130sc_http_req_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020018131sc0_http_req_rate([<table>]) : integer
18132sc1_http_req_rate([<table>]) : integer
18133sc2_http_req_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020018134 Returns the average rate of HTTP requests from the currently tracked
18135 counters, measured in amount of requests over the period configured in
18136 the table. This includes every started request, valid or not. See also
18137 src_http_req_rate.
18138
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020018139sc_inc_gpc0(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020018140sc0_inc_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
18141sc1_inc_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
18142sc2_inc_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020018143 Increments the first General Purpose Counter associated to the currently
Willy Tarreau869948b2013-01-04 14:14:57 +010018144 tracked counters, and returns its new value. Before the first invocation,
18145 the stored value is zero, so first invocation will increase it to 1 and will
18146 return 1. This is typically used as a second ACL in an expression in order
18147 to mark a connection when a first ACL was verified :
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020018148
Jarno Huuskonen676f6222017-03-30 09:19:45 +030018149 Example:
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020018150 acl abuse sc0_http_req_rate gt 10
18151 acl kill sc0_inc_gpc0 gt 0
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020018152 tcp-request connection reject if abuse kill
18153
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010018154sc_inc_gpc1(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
18155sc0_inc_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
18156sc1_inc_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
18157sc2_inc_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
18158 Increments the second General Purpose Counter associated to the currently
18159 tracked counters, and returns its new value. Before the first invocation,
18160 the stored value is zero, so first invocation will increase it to 1 and will
18161 return 1. This is typically used as a second ACL in an expression in order
18162 to mark a connection when a first ACL was verified.
18163
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020018164sc_kbytes_in(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020018165sc0_kbytes_in([<table>]) : integer
18166sc1_kbytes_in([<table>]) : integer
18167sc2_kbytes_in([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaua01b9742014-07-10 15:29:24 +020018168 Returns the total amount of client-to-server data from the currently tracked
18169 counters, measured in kilobytes. The test is currently performed on 32-bit
18170 integers, which limits values to 4 terabytes. See also src_kbytes_in.
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020018171
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020018172sc_kbytes_out(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020018173sc0_kbytes_out([<table>]) : integer
18174sc1_kbytes_out([<table>]) : integer
18175sc2_kbytes_out([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaua01b9742014-07-10 15:29:24 +020018176 Returns the total amount of server-to-client data from the currently tracked
18177 counters, measured in kilobytes. The test is currently performed on 32-bit
18178 integers, which limits values to 4 terabytes. See also src_kbytes_out.
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020018179
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020018180sc_sess_cnt(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020018181sc0_sess_cnt([<table>]) : integer
18182sc1_sess_cnt([<table>]) : integer
18183sc2_sess_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010018184 Returns the cumulative number of incoming connections that were transformed
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020018185 into sessions, which means that they were accepted by a "tcp-request
18186 connection" rule, from the currently tracked counters. A backend may count
18187 more sessions than connections because each connection could result in many
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040018188 backend sessions if some HTTP keep-alive is performed over the connection
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020018189 with the client. See also src_sess_cnt.
18190
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020018191sc_sess_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020018192sc0_sess_rate([<table>]) : integer
18193sc1_sess_rate([<table>]) : integer
18194sc2_sess_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020018195 Returns the average session rate from the currently tracked counters,
18196 measured in amount of sessions over the period configured in the table. A
18197 session is a connection that got past the early "tcp-request connection"
18198 rules. A backend may count more sessions than connections because each
18199 connection could result in many backend sessions if some HTTP keep-alive is
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040018200 performed over the connection with the client. See also src_sess_rate.
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020018201
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020018202sc_tracked(<ctr>[,<table>]) : boolean
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020018203sc0_tracked([<table>]) : boolean
18204sc1_tracked([<table>]) : boolean
18205sc2_tracked([<table>]) : boolean
Willy Tarreau6f1615f2013-06-03 15:15:22 +020018206 Returns true if the designated session counter is currently being tracked by
18207 the current session. This can be useful when deciding whether or not we want
18208 to set some values in a header passed to the server.
18209
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020018210sc_trackers(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020018211sc0_trackers([<table>]) : integer
18212sc1_trackers([<table>]) : integer
18213sc2_trackers([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau2406db42012-12-09 12:16:43 +010018214 Returns the current amount of concurrent connections tracking the same
18215 tracked counters. This number is automatically incremented when tracking
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020018216 begins and decremented when tracking stops. It differs from sc0_conn_cur in
Willy Tarreau2406db42012-12-09 12:16:43 +010018217 that it does not rely on any stored information but on the table's reference
18218 count (the "use" value which is returned by "show table" on the CLI). This
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018219 may sometimes be more suited for layer7 tracking. It can be used to tell a
18220 server how many concurrent connections there are from a given address for
18221 example.
Willy Tarreau2406db42012-12-09 12:16:43 +010018222
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018223so_id : integer
18224 Returns an integer containing the current listening socket's id. It is useful
18225 in frontends involving many "bind" lines, or to stick all users coming via a
18226 same socket to the same server.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010018227
Jerome Magnineb421b22020-03-27 22:08:40 +010018228so_name : string
18229 Returns a string containing the current listening socket's name, as defined
18230 with name on a "bind" line. It can serve the same purposes as so_id but with
18231 strings instead of integers.
18232
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018233src : ip
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010018234 This is the source IPv4 address of the client of the session. It is of type
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018235 IP and works on both IPv4 and IPv6 tables. On IPv6 tables, IPv4 addresses are
18236 mapped to their IPv6 equivalent, according to RFC 4291. Note that it is the
18237 TCP-level source address which is used, and not the address of a client
Bertrand Jacquin93b227d2016-06-04 15:11:10 +010018238 behind a proxy. However if the "accept-proxy" or "accept-netscaler-cip" bind
18239 directive is used, it can be the address of a client behind another
18240 PROXY-protocol compatible component for all rule sets except
Willy Tarreau64ded3d2019-01-23 10:02:15 +010018241 "tcp-request connection" which sees the real address. When the incoming
18242 connection passed through address translation or redirection involving
18243 connection tracking, the original destination address before the redirection
18244 will be reported. On Linux systems, the source and destination may seldom
18245 appear reversed if the nf_conntrack_tcp_loose sysctl is set, because a late
18246 response may reopen a timed out connection and switch what is believed to be
18247 the source and the destination.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010018248
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010018249 Example:
18250 # add an HTTP header in requests with the originating address' country
18251 http-request set-header X-Country %[src,map_ip(geoip.lst)]
18252
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018253src_bytes_in_rate([<table>]) : integer
18254 Returns the average bytes rate from the incoming connection's source address
18255 in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table, measured
18256 in amount of bytes over the period configured in the table. If the address is
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020018257 not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_bytes_in_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020018258
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018259src_bytes_out_rate([<table>]) : integer
18260 Returns the average bytes rate to the incoming connection's source address in
18261 the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table, measured in
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020018262 amount of bytes over the period configured in the table. If the address is
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020018263 not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_bytes_out_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020018264
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018265src_clr_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
18266 Clears the first General Purpose Counter associated to the incoming
18267 connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the
18268 designated stick-table, and returns its previous value. If the address is not
18269 found, an entry is created and 0 is returned. This is typically used as a
18270 second ACL in an expression in order to mark a connection when a first ACL
18271 was verified :
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020018272
Jarno Huuskonen676f6222017-03-30 09:19:45 +030018273 Example:
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020018274 # block if 5 consecutive requests continue to come faster than 10 sess
18275 # per second, and reset the counter as soon as the traffic slows down.
18276 acl abuse src_http_req_rate gt 10
18277 acl kill src_inc_gpc0 gt 5
Willy Tarreau869948b2013-01-04 14:14:57 +010018278 acl save src_clr_gpc0 ge 0
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020018279 tcp-request connection accept if !abuse save
18280 tcp-request connection reject if abuse kill
18281
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010018282src_clr_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
18283 Clears the second General Purpose Counter associated to the incoming
18284 connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the
18285 designated stick-table, and returns its previous value. If the address is not
18286 found, an entry is created and 0 is returned. This is typically used as a
18287 second ACL in an expression in order to mark a connection when a first ACL
18288 was verified.
18289
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018290src_conn_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010018291 Returns the cumulative number of connections initiated from the current
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018292 incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020018293 the designated stick-table. If the address is not found, zero is returned.
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020018294 See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_conn_cnt.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020018295
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018296src_conn_cur([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020018297 Returns the current amount of concurrent connections initiated from the
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018298 current incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's
18299 stick-table or in the designated stick-table. If the address is not found,
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020018300 zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_conn_cur.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020018301
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018302src_conn_rate([<table>]) : integer
18303 Returns the average connection rate from the incoming connection's source
18304 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table,
18305 measured in amount of connections over the period configured in the table. If
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020018306 the address is not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_conn_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020018307
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018308src_get_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020018309 Returns the value of the first General Purpose Counter associated to the
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018310 incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020018311 the designated stick-table. If the address is not found, zero is returned.
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020018312 See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_get_gpc0 and src_inc_gpc0.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020018313
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010018314src_get_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
18315 Returns the value of the second General Purpose Counter associated to the
18316 incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in
18317 the designated stick-table. If the address is not found, zero is returned.
18318 See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_get_gpc1 and src_inc_gpc1.
18319
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +020018320src_get_gpt0([<table>]) : integer
18321 Returns the value of the first General Purpose Tag associated to the
18322 incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in
18323 the designated stick-table. If the address is not found, zero is returned.
18324 See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_get_gpt0.
18325
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018326src_gpc0_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +020018327 Returns the average increment rate of the first General Purpose Counter
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018328 associated to the incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +020018329 stick-table or in the designated stick-table. It reports the frequency
18330 which the gpc0 counter was incremented over the configured period. See also
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020018331 sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_gpc0_rate, src_get_gpc0, and sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_inc_gpc0. Note
18332 that the "gpc0_rate" counter must be stored in the stick-table for a value to
18333 be returned, as "gpc0" only holds the event count.
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +020018334
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010018335src_gpc1_rate([<table>]) : integer
18336 Returns the average increment rate of the second General Purpose Counter
18337 associated to the incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's
18338 stick-table or in the designated stick-table. It reports the frequency
18339 which the gpc1 counter was incremented over the configured period. See also
18340 sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_gpc1_rate, src_get_gpc1, and sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_inc_gpc1. Note
18341 that the "gpc1_rate" counter must be stored in the stick-table for a value to
18342 be returned, as "gpc1" only holds the event count.
18343
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018344src_http_err_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010018345 Returns the cumulative number of HTTP errors from the incoming connection's
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018346 source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020018347 stick-table. This includes the both request errors and 4xx error responses.
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020018348 See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_http_err_cnt. If the address is not found, zero is
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018349 returned.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020018350
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018351src_http_err_rate([<table>]) : integer
18352 Returns the average rate of HTTP errors from the incoming connection's source
18353 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table,
18354 measured in amount of errors over the period configured in the table. This
18355 includes the both request errors and 4xx error responses. If the address is
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020018356 not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_http_err_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020018357
Willy Tarreau826f3ab2021-02-10 12:07:15 +010018358src_http_fail_cnt([<table>]) : integer
18359 Returns the cumulative number of HTTP response failures triggered by the
18360 incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in
Ilya Shipitsin0de36ad2021-02-20 00:23:36 +050018361 the designated stick-table. This includes the both response errors and 5xx
Willy Tarreau826f3ab2021-02-10 12:07:15 +010018362 status codes other than 501 and 505. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_http_fail_cnt.
18363 If the address is not found, zero is returned.
18364
18365src_http_fail_rate([<table>]) : integer
18366 Returns the average rate of HTTP response failures triggered by the incoming
18367 connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the
18368 designated stick-table, measured in amount of failures over the period
18369 configured in the table. This includes the both response errors and 5xx
18370 status codes other than 501 and 505. If the address is not found, zero is
18371 returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_http_fail_rate.
18372
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018373src_http_req_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010018374 Returns the cumulative number of HTTP requests from the incoming connection's
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018375 source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-
18376 table. This includes every started request, valid or not. If the address is
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020018377 not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_http_req_cnt.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020018378
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018379src_http_req_rate([<table>]) : integer
18380 Returns the average rate of HTTP requests from the incoming connection's
18381 source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-
18382 table, measured in amount of requests over the period configured in the
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020018383 table. This includes every started request, valid or not. If the address is
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020018384 not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_http_req_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020018385
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018386src_inc_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
18387 Increments the first General Purpose Counter associated to the incoming
18388 connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the
18389 designated stick-table, and returns its new value. If the address is not
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020018390 found, an entry is created and 1 is returned. See also sc0/sc2/sc2_inc_gpc0.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018391 This is typically used as a second ACL in an expression in order to mark a
18392 connection when a first ACL was verified :
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020018393
Jarno Huuskonen676f6222017-03-30 09:19:45 +030018394 Example:
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020018395 acl abuse src_http_req_rate gt 10
Willy Tarreau869948b2013-01-04 14:14:57 +010018396 acl kill src_inc_gpc0 gt 0
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020018397 tcp-request connection reject if abuse kill
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020018398
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010018399src_inc_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
18400 Increments the second General Purpose Counter associated to the incoming
18401 connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the
18402 designated stick-table, and returns its new value. If the address is not
18403 found, an entry is created and 1 is returned. See also sc0/sc2/sc2_inc_gpc1.
18404 This is typically used as a second ACL in an expression in order to mark a
18405 connection when a first ACL was verified.
18406
Willy Tarreau16e01562016-08-09 16:46:18 +020018407src_is_local : boolean
18408 Returns true if the source address of the incoming connection is local to the
18409 system, or false if the address doesn't exist on the system, meaning that it
18410 comes from a remote machine. Note that UNIX addresses are considered local.
18411 It can be useful to apply certain access restrictions based on where the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010018412 client comes from (e.g. require auth or https for remote machines). Please
Willy Tarreau16e01562016-08-09 16:46:18 +020018413 note that the check involves a few system calls, so it's better to do it only
18414 once per connection.
18415
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018416src_kbytes_in([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaua01b9742014-07-10 15:29:24 +020018417 Returns the total amount of data received from the incoming connection's
18418 source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated
18419 stick-table, measured in kilobytes. If the address is not found, zero is
18420 returned. The test is currently performed on 32-bit integers, which limits
18421 values to 4 terabytes. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_kbytes_in.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020018422
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018423src_kbytes_out([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaua01b9742014-07-10 15:29:24 +020018424 Returns the total amount of data sent to the incoming connection's source
18425 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table,
18426 measured in kilobytes. If the address is not found, zero is returned. The
18427 test is currently performed on 32-bit integers, which limits values to 4
18428 terabytes. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_kbytes_out.
Willy Tarreaua975b8f2010-06-05 19:13:27 +020018429
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018430src_port : integer
18431 Returns an integer value corresponding to the TCP source port of the
18432 connection on the client side, which is the port the client connected from.
18433 Usage of this function is very limited as modern protocols do not care much
18434 about source ports nowadays.
Willy Tarreau079ff0a2009-03-05 21:34:28 +010018435
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018436src_sess_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010018437 Returns the cumulative number of connections initiated from the incoming
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020018438 connection's source IPv4 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the
18439 designated stick-table, that were transformed into sessions, which means that
18440 they were accepted by "tcp-request" rules. If the address is not found, zero
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020018441 is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_sess_cnt.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020018442
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018443src_sess_rate([<table>]) : integer
18444 Returns the average session rate from the incoming connection's source
18445 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table,
18446 measured in amount of sessions over the period configured in the table. A
18447 session is a connection that went past the early "tcp-request" rules. If the
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020018448 address is not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_sess_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020018449
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018450src_updt_conn_cnt([<table>]) : integer
18451 Creates or updates the entry associated to the incoming connection's source
18452 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table.
18453 This table must be configured to store the "conn_cnt" data type, otherwise
18454 the match will be ignored. The current count is incremented by one, and the
18455 expiration timer refreshed. The updated count is returned, so this match
18456 can't return zero. This was used to reject service abusers based on their
18457 source address. Note: it is recommended to use the more complete "track-sc*"
18458 actions in "tcp-request" rules instead.
Willy Tarreaua975b8f2010-06-05 19:13:27 +020018459
18460 Example :
18461 # This frontend limits incoming SSH connections to 3 per 10 second for
18462 # each source address, and rejects excess connections until a 10 second
18463 # silence is observed. At most 20 addresses are tracked.
18464 listen ssh
18465 bind :22
18466 mode tcp
18467 maxconn 100
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020018468 stick-table type ip size 20 expire 10s store conn_cnt
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018469 tcp-request content reject if { src_updt_conn_cnt gt 3 }
Willy Tarreaua975b8f2010-06-05 19:13:27 +020018470 server local 127.0.0.1:22
18471
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018472srv_id : integer
18473 Returns an integer containing the server's id when processing the response.
18474 While it's almost only used with ACLs, it may be used for logging or
Christopher Fauletd1b44642020-04-30 09:51:15 +020018475 debugging. It can also be used in a tcp-check or an http-check ruleset.
Hervé COMMOWICKdaa824e2011-08-05 12:09:44 +020018476
vkill1dfd1652019-10-30 16:58:14 +080018477srv_name : string
18478 Returns a string containing the server's name when processing the response.
18479 While it's almost only used with ACLs, it may be used for logging or
Christopher Fauletd1b44642020-04-30 09:51:15 +020018480 debugging. It can also be used in a tcp-check or an http-check ruleset.
vkill1dfd1652019-10-30 16:58:14 +080018481
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +0200184827.3.4. Fetching samples at Layer 5
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018483----------------------------------
Willy Tarreau0b1cd942010-05-16 22:18:27 +020018484
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040018485The layer 5 usually describes just the session layer which in HAProxy is
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018486closest to the session once all the connection handshakes are finished, but
18487when no content is yet made available. The fetch methods described here are
18488usable as low as the "tcp-request content" rule sets unless they require some
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030018489future information. Those generally include the results of SSL negotiations.
Willy Tarreauc735a072011-03-29 00:57:02 +020018490
Ben Shillitof25e8e52016-12-02 14:25:37 +00001849151d.all(<prop>[,<prop>*]) : string
18492 Returns values for the properties requested as a string, where values are
18493 separated by the delimiter specified with "51degrees-property-separator".
18494 The device is identified using all the important HTTP headers from the
18495 request. The function can be passed up to five property names, and if a
18496 property name can't be found, the value "NoData" is returned.
18497
18498 Example :
18499 # Here the header "X-51D-DeviceTypeMobileTablet" is added to the request
18500 # containing the three properties requested using all relevant headers from
18501 # the request.
18502 frontend http-in
18503 bind *:8081
18504 default_backend servers
18505 http-request set-header X-51D-DeviceTypeMobileTablet \
18506 %[51d.all(DeviceType,IsMobile,IsTablet)]
18507
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020018508ssl_bc : boolean
18509 Returns true when the back connection was made via an SSL/TLS transport
18510 layer and is locally deciphered. This means the outgoing connection was made
Mariam John3d379952023-05-22 13:11:13 -050018511 to a server with the "ssl" option. It can be used in a tcp-check or an
Christopher Fauletd92ea7f2020-04-30 10:03:55 +020018512 http-check ruleset.
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020018513
18514ssl_bc_alg_keysize : integer
18515 Returns the symmetric cipher key size supported in bits when the outgoing
Christopher Fauletd92ea7f2020-04-30 10:03:55 +020018516 connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It can be used in a
18517 tcp-check or an http-check ruleset.
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020018518
Olivier Houchard6b77f492018-11-22 18:18:29 +010018519ssl_bc_alpn : string
18520 This extracts the Application Layer Protocol Negotiation field from an
18521 outgoing connection made via a TLS transport layer.
Michael Prokop4438c602019-05-24 10:25:45 +020018522 The result is a string containing the protocol name negotiated with the
Olivier Houchard6b77f492018-11-22 18:18:29 +010018523 server. The SSL library must have been built with support for TLS
18524 extensions enabled (check haproxy -vv). Note that the TLS ALPN extension is
18525 not advertised unless the "alpn" keyword on the "server" line specifies a
18526 protocol list. Also, nothing forces the server to pick a protocol from this
18527 list, any other one may be requested. The TLS ALPN extension is meant to
Christopher Fauletd92ea7f2020-04-30 10:03:55 +020018528 replace the TLS NPN extension. See also "ssl_bc_npn". It can be used in a
18529 tcp-check or an http-check ruleset.
Olivier Houchard6b77f492018-11-22 18:18:29 +010018530
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020018531ssl_bc_cipher : string
18532 Returns the name of the used cipher when the outgoing connection was made
Christopher Fauletd92ea7f2020-04-30 10:03:55 +020018533 over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It can be used in a tcp-check or an
18534 http-check ruleset.
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020018535
Patrick Hemmer65674662019-06-04 08:13:03 -040018536ssl_bc_client_random : binary
18537 Returns the client random of the back connection when the incoming connection
18538 was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It is useful to to decrypt traffic
18539 sent using ephemeral ciphers. This requires OpenSSL >= 1.1.0, or BoringSSL.
Christopher Fauletd92ea7f2020-04-30 10:03:55 +020018540 It can be used in a tcp-check or an http-check ruleset.
Patrick Hemmer65674662019-06-04 08:13:03 -040018541
Emeric Brun74f7ffa2018-02-19 16:14:12 +010018542ssl_bc_is_resumed : boolean
18543 Returns true when the back connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport
18544 layer and the newly created SSL session was resumed using a cached
Christopher Fauletd92ea7f2020-04-30 10:03:55 +020018545 session or a TLS ticket. It can be used in a tcp-check or an http-check
18546 ruleset.
Emeric Brun74f7ffa2018-02-19 16:14:12 +010018547
Olivier Houchard6b77f492018-11-22 18:18:29 +010018548ssl_bc_npn : string
18549 This extracts the Next Protocol Negotiation field from an outgoing connection
18550 made via a TLS transport layer. The result is a string containing the
Michael Prokop4438c602019-05-24 10:25:45 +020018551 protocol name negotiated with the server . The SSL library must have been
Olivier Houchard6b77f492018-11-22 18:18:29 +010018552 built with support for TLS extensions enabled (check haproxy -vv). Note that
18553 the TLS NPN extension is not advertised unless the "npn" keyword on the
18554 "server" line specifies a protocol list. Also, nothing forces the server to
18555 pick a protocol from this list, any other one may be used. Please note that
Christopher Fauletd92ea7f2020-04-30 10:03:55 +020018556 the TLS NPN extension was replaced with ALPN. It can be used in a tcp-check
18557 or an http-check ruleset.
Olivier Houchard6b77f492018-11-22 18:18:29 +010018558
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020018559ssl_bc_protocol : string
18560 Returns the name of the used protocol when the outgoing connection was made
Christopher Fauletd92ea7f2020-04-30 10:03:55 +020018561 over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It can be used in a tcp-check or an
18562 http-check ruleset.
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020018563
Emeric Brunb73a9b02014-04-30 18:49:19 +020018564ssl_bc_unique_id : binary
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020018565 When the outgoing connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
Emeric Brunb73a9b02014-04-30 18:49:19 +020018566 returns the TLS unique ID as defined in RFC5929 section 3. The unique id
Christopher Fauletd92ea7f2020-04-30 10:03:55 +020018567 can be encoded to base64 using the converter: "ssl_bc_unique_id,base64". It
18568 can be used in a tcp-check or an http-check ruleset.
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020018569
Patrick Hemmer65674662019-06-04 08:13:03 -040018570ssl_bc_server_random : binary
18571 Returns the server random of the back connection when the incoming connection
18572 was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It is useful to to decrypt traffic
18573 sent using ephemeral ciphers. This requires OpenSSL >= 1.1.0, or BoringSSL.
Christopher Fauletd92ea7f2020-04-30 10:03:55 +020018574 It can be used in a tcp-check or an http-check ruleset.
Patrick Hemmer65674662019-06-04 08:13:03 -040018575
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020018576ssl_bc_session_id : binary
18577 Returns the SSL ID of the back connection when the outgoing connection was
18578 made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It is useful to log if we want to know
Christopher Fauletd92ea7f2020-04-30 10:03:55 +020018579 if session was reused or not. It can be used in a tcp-check or an http-check
18580 ruleset.
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020018581
Patrick Hemmere0275472018-04-28 19:15:51 -040018582ssl_bc_session_key : binary
18583 Returns the SSL session master key of the back connection when the outgoing
18584 connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It is useful to decrypt
18585 traffic sent using ephemeral ciphers. This requires OpenSSL >= 1.1.0, or
Christopher Fauletd92ea7f2020-04-30 10:03:55 +020018586 BoringSSL. It can be used in a tcp-check or an http-check ruleset.
Patrick Hemmere0275472018-04-28 19:15:51 -040018587
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020018588ssl_bc_use_keysize : integer
18589 Returns the symmetric cipher key size used in bits when the outgoing
Christopher Fauletd92ea7f2020-04-30 10:03:55 +020018590 connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It can be used in a
18591 tcp-check or an http-check ruleset.
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020018592
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018593ssl_c_ca_err : integer
18594 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
18595 returns the ID of the first error detected during verification of the client
18596 certificate at depth > 0, or 0 if no error was encountered during this
18597 verification process. Please refer to your SSL library's documentation to
18598 find the exhaustive list of error codes.
Willy Tarreauc735a072011-03-29 00:57:02 +020018599
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018600ssl_c_ca_err_depth : integer
18601 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
18602 returns the depth in the CA chain of the first error detected during the
18603 verification of the client certificate. If no error is encountered, 0 is
18604 returned.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010018605
Christopher Faulet70d10d12020-11-06 12:10:33 +010018606ssl_c_chain_der : binary
William Dauchya598b502020-08-06 18:11:38 +020018607 Returns the DER formatted chain certificate presented by the client when the
18608 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. When used for
18609 an ACL, the value(s) to match against can be passed in hexadecimal form. One
Ilya Shipitsin2272d8a2020-12-21 01:22:40 +050018610 can parse the result with any lib accepting ASN.1 DER data. It currently
William Dauchya598b502020-08-06 18:11:38 +020018611 does not support resumed sessions.
18612
Christopher Faulet70d10d12020-11-06 12:10:33 +010018613ssl_c_der : binary
18614 Returns the DER formatted certificate presented by the client when the
18615 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. When used for
18616 an ACL, the value(s) to match against can be passed in hexadecimal form.
18617
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018618ssl_c_err : integer
18619 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
18620 returns the ID of the first error detected during verification at depth 0, or
18621 0 if no error was encountered during this verification process. Please refer
18622 to your SSL library's documentation to find the exhaustive list of error
18623 codes.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020018624
Elliot Otchet71f82972020-01-15 08:12:14 -050018625ssl_c_i_dn([<entry>[,<occ>[,<format>]]]) : string
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018626 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
18627 returns the full distinguished name of the issuer of the certificate
18628 presented by the client when no <entry> is specified, or the value of the
18629 first given entry found from the beginning of the DN. If a positive/negative
18630 occurrence number is specified as the optional second argument, it returns
18631 the value of the nth given entry value from the beginning/end of the DN.
18632 For instance, "ssl_c_i_dn(OU,2)" the second organization unit, and
18633 "ssl_c_i_dn(CN)" retrieves the common name.
Elliot Otchet71f82972020-01-15 08:12:14 -050018634 The <format> parameter allows you to receive the DN suitable for
18635 consumption by different protocols. Currently supported is rfc2253 for
18636 LDAP v3.
18637 If you'd like to modify the format only you can specify an empty string
18638 and zero for the first two parameters. Example: ssl_c_i_dn(,0,rfc2253)
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020018639
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018640ssl_c_key_alg : string
18641 Returns the name of the algorithm used to generate the key of the certificate
18642 presented by the client when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS
18643 transport layer.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020018644
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018645ssl_c_notafter : string
18646 Returns the end date presented by the client as a formatted string
18647 YYMMDDhhmmss[Z] when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS
18648 transport layer.
Emeric Brunbede3d02009-06-30 17:54:00 +020018649
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018650ssl_c_notbefore : string
18651 Returns the start date presented by the client as a formatted string
18652 YYMMDDhhmmss[Z] when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS
18653 transport layer.
Willy Tarreaub6672b52011-12-12 17:23:41 +010018654
Elliot Otchet71f82972020-01-15 08:12:14 -050018655ssl_c_s_dn([<entry>[,<occ>[,<format>]]]) : string
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018656 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
18657 returns the full distinguished name of the subject of the certificate
18658 presented by the client when no <entry> is specified, or the value of the
18659 first given entry found from the beginning of the DN. If a positive/negative
18660 occurrence number is specified as the optional second argument, it returns
18661 the value of the nth given entry value from the beginning/end of the DN.
18662 For instance, "ssl_c_s_dn(OU,2)" the second organization unit, and
18663 "ssl_c_s_dn(CN)" retrieves the common name.
Elliot Otchet71f82972020-01-15 08:12:14 -050018664 The <format> parameter allows you to receive the DN suitable for
18665 consumption by different protocols. Currently supported is rfc2253 for
18666 LDAP v3.
18667 If you'd like to modify the format only you can specify an empty string
18668 and zero for the first two parameters. Example: ssl_c_s_dn(,0,rfc2253)
Willy Tarreaub6672b52011-12-12 17:23:41 +010018669
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018670ssl_c_serial : binary
18671 Returns the serial of the certificate presented by the client when the
18672 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. When used for
18673 an ACL, the value(s) to match against can be passed in hexadecimal form.
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +020018674
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018675ssl_c_sha1 : binary
18676 Returns the SHA-1 fingerprint of the certificate presented by the client when
18677 the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. This can be
18678 used to stick a client to a server, or to pass this information to a server.
Willy Tarreau2d0caa32014-07-02 19:01:22 +020018679 Note that the output is binary, so if you want to pass that signature to the
18680 server, you need to encode it in hex or base64, such as in the example below:
18681
Jarno Huuskonen676f6222017-03-30 09:19:45 +030018682 Example:
Willy Tarreau2d0caa32014-07-02 19:01:22 +020018683 http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-SHA1 %[ssl_c_sha1,hex]
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +020018684
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018685ssl_c_sig_alg : string
18686 Returns the name of the algorithm used to sign the certificate presented by
18687 the client when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport
18688 layer.
Emeric Brun87855892012-10-17 17:39:35 +020018689
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018690ssl_c_used : boolean
18691 Returns true if current SSL session uses a client certificate even if current
18692 connection uses SSL session resumption. See also "ssl_fc_has_crt".
Emeric Brun7f56e742012-10-19 18:15:40 +020018693
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018694ssl_c_verify : integer
18695 Returns the verify result error ID when the incoming connection was made over
18696 an SSL/TLS transport layer, otherwise zero if no error is encountered. Please
18697 refer to your SSL library's documentation for an exhaustive list of error
18698 codes.
Emeric Brunce5ad802012-10-22 14:11:22 +020018699
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018700ssl_c_version : integer
18701 Returns the version of the certificate presented by the client when the
18702 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
Emeric Brunce5ad802012-10-22 14:11:22 +020018703
Emeric Brun43e79582014-10-29 19:03:26 +010018704ssl_f_der : binary
18705 Returns the DER formatted certificate presented by the frontend when the
18706 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. When used for
18707 an ACL, the value(s) to match against can be passed in hexadecimal form.
18708
Elliot Otchet71f82972020-01-15 08:12:14 -050018709ssl_f_i_dn([<entry>[,<occ>[,<format>]]]) : string
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018710 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
18711 returns the full distinguished name of the issuer of the certificate
18712 presented by the frontend when no <entry> is specified, or the value of the
18713 first given entry found from the beginning of the DN. If a positive/negative
Emeric Brun87855892012-10-17 17:39:35 +020018714 occurrence number is specified as the optional second argument, it returns
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018715 the value of the nth given entry value from the beginning/end of the DN.
18716 For instance, "ssl_f_i_dn(OU,2)" the second organization unit, and
18717 "ssl_f_i_dn(CN)" retrieves the common name.
Elliot Otchet71f82972020-01-15 08:12:14 -050018718 The <format> parameter allows you to receive the DN suitable for
18719 consumption by different protocols. Currently supported is rfc2253 for
18720 LDAP v3.
18721 If you'd like to modify the format only you can specify an empty string
18722 and zero for the first two parameters. Example: ssl_f_i_dn(,0,rfc2253)
Emeric Brun87855892012-10-17 17:39:35 +020018723
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018724ssl_f_key_alg : string
18725 Returns the name of the algorithm used to generate the key of the certificate
18726 presented by the frontend when the incoming connection was made over an
18727 SSL/TLS transport layer.
Emeric Brun7f56e742012-10-19 18:15:40 +020018728
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018729ssl_f_notafter : string
18730 Returns the end date presented by the frontend as a formatted string
18731 YYMMDDhhmmss[Z] when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS
18732 transport layer.
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +020018733
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018734ssl_f_notbefore : string
18735 Returns the start date presented by the frontend as a formatted string
18736 YYMMDDhhmmss[Z] when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS
18737 transport layer.
Emeric Brun87855892012-10-17 17:39:35 +020018738
Elliot Otchet71f82972020-01-15 08:12:14 -050018739ssl_f_s_dn([<entry>[,<occ>[,<format>]]]) : string
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018740 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
18741 returns the full distinguished name of the subject of the certificate
18742 presented by the frontend when no <entry> is specified, or the value of the
18743 first given entry found from the beginning of the DN. If a positive/negative
18744 occurrence number is specified as the optional second argument, it returns
18745 the value of the nth given entry value from the beginning/end of the DN.
18746 For instance, "ssl_f_s_dn(OU,2)" the second organization unit, and
18747 "ssl_f_s_dn(CN)" retrieves the common name.
Elliot Otchet71f82972020-01-15 08:12:14 -050018748 The <format> parameter allows you to receive the DN suitable for
18749 consumption by different protocols. Currently supported is rfc2253 for
18750 LDAP v3.
18751 If you'd like to modify the format only you can specify an empty string
18752 and zero for the first two parameters. Example: ssl_f_s_dn(,0,rfc2253)
Emeric Brunce5ad802012-10-22 14:11:22 +020018753
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018754ssl_f_serial : binary
18755 Returns the serial of the certificate presented by the frontend when the
18756 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. When used for
18757 an ACL, the value(s) to match against can be passed in hexadecimal form.
Emeric Brun87855892012-10-17 17:39:35 +020018758
Emeric Brun55f4fa82014-04-30 17:11:25 +020018759ssl_f_sha1 : binary
18760 Returns the SHA-1 fingerprint of the certificate presented by the frontend
18761 when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. This
18762 can be used to know which certificate was chosen using SNI.
18763
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018764ssl_f_sig_alg : string
18765 Returns the name of the algorithm used to sign the certificate presented by
18766 the frontend when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport
18767 layer.
Emeric Brun7f56e742012-10-19 18:15:40 +020018768
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018769ssl_f_version : integer
18770 Returns the version of the certificate presented by the frontend when the
18771 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
18772
18773ssl_fc : boolean
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +020018774 Returns true when the front connection was made via an SSL/TLS transport
18775 layer and is locally deciphered. This means it has matched a socket declared
18776 with a "bind" line having the "ssl" option.
18777
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018778 Example :
18779 # This passes "X-Proto: https" to servers when client connects over SSL
18780 listen http-https
18781 bind :80
18782 bind :443 ssl crt /etc/haproxy.pem
18783 http-request add-header X-Proto https if { ssl_fc }
18784
18785ssl_fc_alg_keysize : integer
18786 Returns the symmetric cipher key size supported in bits when the incoming
18787 connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
18788
18789ssl_fc_alpn : string
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030018790 This extracts the Application Layer Protocol Negotiation field from an
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018791 incoming connection made via a TLS transport layer and locally deciphered by
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040018792 HAProxy. The result is a string containing the protocol name advertised by
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018793 the client. The SSL library must have been built with support for TLS
18794 extensions enabled (check haproxy -vv). Note that the TLS ALPN extension is
18795 not advertised unless the "alpn" keyword on the "bind" line specifies a
18796 protocol list. Also, nothing forces the client to pick a protocol from this
18797 list, any other one may be requested. The TLS ALPN extension is meant to
18798 replace the TLS NPN extension. See also "ssl_fc_npn".
18799
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018800ssl_fc_cipher : string
18801 Returns the name of the used cipher when the incoming connection was made
18802 over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
Willy Tarreauab861d32013-04-02 02:30:41 +020018803
Thierry FOURNIER5bf77322017-02-25 12:45:22 +010018804ssl_fc_cipherlist_bin : binary
18805 Returns the binary form of the client hello cipher list. The maximum returned
18806 value length is according with the value of
Emmanuel Hocdetaaee7502017-03-07 18:34:58 +010018807 "tune.ssl.capture-cipherlist-size".
Thierry FOURNIER5bf77322017-02-25 12:45:22 +010018808
18809ssl_fc_cipherlist_hex : string
18810 Returns the binary form of the client hello cipher list encoded as
18811 hexadecimal. The maximum returned value length is according with the value of
Emmanuel Hocdetaaee7502017-03-07 18:34:58 +010018812 "tune.ssl.capture-cipherlist-size".
Thierry FOURNIER5bf77322017-02-25 12:45:22 +010018813
18814ssl_fc_cipherlist_str : string
18815 Returns the decoded text form of the client hello cipher list. The maximum
18816 number of ciphers returned is according with the value of
18817 "tune.ssl.capture-cipherlist-size". Note that this sample-fetch is only
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010018818 available with OpenSSL >= 1.0.2. If the function is not enabled, this
Emmanuel Hocdetddcde192017-09-01 17:32:08 +020018819 sample-fetch returns the hash like "ssl_fc_cipherlist_xxh".
Thierry FOURNIER5bf77322017-02-25 12:45:22 +010018820
18821ssl_fc_cipherlist_xxh : integer
18822 Returns a xxh64 of the cipher list. This hash can be return only is the value
18823 "tune.ssl.capture-cipherlist-size" is set greater than 0, however the hash
Emmanuel Hocdetaaee7502017-03-07 18:34:58 +010018824 take in account all the data of the cipher list.
Thierry FOURNIER5bf77322017-02-25 12:45:22 +010018825
Patrick Hemmer65674662019-06-04 08:13:03 -040018826ssl_fc_client_random : binary
18827 Returns the client random of the front connection when the incoming connection
18828 was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It is useful to to decrypt traffic
18829 sent using ephemeral ciphers. This requires OpenSSL >= 1.1.0, or BoringSSL.
18830
William Lallemand7d42ef52020-07-06 11:41:30 +020018831ssl_fc_client_early_traffic_secret : string
18832 Return the CLIENT_EARLY_TRAFFIC_SECRET as an hexadecimal string for the
18833 front connection when the incoming connection was made over a TLS 1.3
18834 transport layer.
18835 Require OpenSSL >= 1.1.1. This is one of the keys dumped by the OpenSSL
18836 keylog callback to generate the SSLKEYLOGFILE. The SSL Key logging must be
18837 activated with "tune.ssl.keylog on" in the global section. See also
18838 "tune.ssl.keylog"
18839
18840ssl_fc_client_handshake_traffic_secret : string
18841 Return the CLIENT_HANDSHAKE_TRAFFIC_SECRET as an hexadecimal string for the
18842 front connection when the incoming connection was made over a TLS 1.3
18843 transport layer.
18844 Require OpenSSL >= 1.1.1. This is one of the keys dumped by the OpenSSL
18845 keylog callback to generate the SSLKEYLOGFILE. The SSL Key logging must be
18846 activated with "tune.ssl.keylog on" in the global section. See also
18847 "tune.ssl.keylog"
18848
18849ssl_fc_client_traffic_secret_0 : string
18850 Return the CLIENT_TRAFFIC_SECRET_0 as an hexadecimal string for the
18851 front connection when the incoming connection was made over a TLS 1.3
18852 transport layer.
18853 Require OpenSSL >= 1.1.1. This is one of the keys dumped by the OpenSSL
18854 keylog callback to generate the SSLKEYLOGFILE. The SSL Key logging must be
18855 activated with "tune.ssl.keylog on" in the global section. See also
18856 "tune.ssl.keylog"
18857
18858ssl_fc_exporter_secret : string
18859 Return the EXPORTER_SECRET as an hexadecimal string for the
18860 front connection when the incoming connection was made over a TLS 1.3
18861 transport layer.
18862 Require OpenSSL >= 1.1.1. This is one of the keys dumped by the OpenSSL
18863 keylog callback to generate the SSLKEYLOGFILE. The SSL Key logging must be
18864 activated with "tune.ssl.keylog on" in the global section. See also
18865 "tune.ssl.keylog"
18866
18867ssl_fc_early_exporter_secret : string
18868 Return the EARLY_EXPORTER_SECRET as an hexadecimal string for the
18869 front connection when the incoming connection was made over an TLS 1.3
18870 transport layer.
18871 Require OpenSSL >= 1.1.1. This is one of the keys dumped by the OpenSSL
18872 keylog callback to generate the SSLKEYLOGFILE. The SSL Key logging must be
18873 activated with "tune.ssl.keylog on" in the global section. See also
18874 "tune.ssl.keylog"
18875
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018876ssl_fc_has_crt : boolean
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +020018877 Returns true if a client certificate is present in an incoming connection over
18878 SSL/TLS transport layer. Useful if 'verify' statement is set to 'optional'.
Emeric Brun9143d372012-12-20 15:44:16 +010018879 Note: on SSL session resumption with Session ID or TLS ticket, client
18880 certificate is not present in the current connection but may be retrieved
18881 from the cache or the ticket. So prefer "ssl_c_used" if you want to check if
18882 current SSL session uses a client certificate.
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +020018883
Olivier Houchardccaa7de2017-10-02 11:51:03 +020018884ssl_fc_has_early : boolean
18885 Returns true if early data were sent, and the handshake didn't happen yet. As
18886 it has security implications, it is useful to be able to refuse those, or
18887 wait until the handshake happened.
18888
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018889ssl_fc_has_sni : boolean
18890 This checks for the presence of a Server Name Indication TLS extension (SNI)
Willy Tarreauf7bc57c2012-10-03 00:19:48 +020018891 in an incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. Returns
18892 true when the incoming connection presents a TLS SNI field. This requires
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050018893 that the SSL library is built with support for TLS extensions enabled (check
Willy Tarreauf7bc57c2012-10-03 00:19:48 +020018894 haproxy -vv).
Willy Tarreau7875d092012-09-10 08:20:03 +020018895
Nenad Merdanovic1516fe32016-05-17 03:31:21 +020018896ssl_fc_is_resumed : boolean
Nenad Merdanovic26ea8222015-05-18 02:28:57 +020018897 Returns true if the SSL/TLS session has been resumed through the use of
Jérôme Magnin4a326cb2018-01-15 14:01:17 +010018898 SSL session cache or TLS tickets on an incoming connection over an SSL/TLS
18899 transport layer.
Nenad Merdanovic26ea8222015-05-18 02:28:57 +020018900
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018901ssl_fc_npn : string
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030018902 This extracts the Next Protocol Negotiation field from an incoming connection
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040018903 made via a TLS transport layer and locally deciphered by HAProxy. The result
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018904 is a string containing the protocol name advertised by the client. The SSL
18905 library must have been built with support for TLS extensions enabled (check
18906 haproxy -vv). Note that the TLS NPN extension is not advertised unless the
18907 "npn" keyword on the "bind" line specifies a protocol list. Also, nothing
18908 forces the client to pick a protocol from this list, any other one may be
18909 requested. Please note that the TLS NPN extension was replaced with ALPN.
Willy Tarreaua33c6542012-10-15 13:19:06 +020018910
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018911ssl_fc_protocol : string
18912 Returns the name of the used protocol when the incoming connection was made
18913 over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
Willy Tarreau7875d092012-09-10 08:20:03 +020018914
Emeric Brunb73a9b02014-04-30 18:49:19 +020018915ssl_fc_unique_id : binary
David Sc1ad52e2014-04-08 18:48:47 -040018916 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
Emeric Brunb73a9b02014-04-30 18:49:19 +020018917 returns the TLS unique ID as defined in RFC5929 section 3. The unique id
Christopher Fauletc5de4192021-11-09 14:23:36 +010018918 can be encoded to base64 using the converter: "ssl_fc_unique_id,base64".
David Sc1ad52e2014-04-08 18:48:47 -040018919
William Lallemand7d42ef52020-07-06 11:41:30 +020018920ssl_fc_server_handshake_traffic_secret : string
18921 Return the SERVER_HANDSHAKE_TRAFFIC_SECRET as an hexadecimal string for the
18922 front connection when the incoming connection was made over a TLS 1.3
18923 transport layer.
18924 Require OpenSSL >= 1.1.1. This is one of the keys dumped by the OpenSSL
18925 keylog callback to generate the SSLKEYLOGFILE. The SSL Key logging must be
18926 activated with "tune.ssl.keylog on" in the global section. See also
18927 "tune.ssl.keylog"
18928
18929ssl_fc_server_traffic_secret_0 : string
18930 Return the SERVER_TRAFFIC_SECRET_0 as an hexadecimal string for the
18931 front connection when the incoming connection was made over an TLS 1.3
18932 transport layer.
18933 Require OpenSSL >= 1.1.1. This is one of the keys dumped by the OpenSSL
18934 keylog callback to generate the SSLKEYLOGFILE. The SSL Key logging must be
18935 activated with "tune.ssl.keylog on" in the global section. See also
18936 "tune.ssl.keylog"
18937
Patrick Hemmer65674662019-06-04 08:13:03 -040018938ssl_fc_server_random : binary
18939 Returns the server random of the front connection when the incoming connection
18940 was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It is useful to to decrypt traffic
18941 sent using ephemeral ciphers. This requires OpenSSL >= 1.1.0, or BoringSSL.
18942
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018943ssl_fc_session_id : binary
18944 Returns the SSL ID of the front connection when the incoming connection was
18945 made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It is useful to stick a given client to
18946 a server. It is important to note that some browsers refresh their session ID
18947 every few minutes.
Willy Tarreau7875d092012-09-10 08:20:03 +020018948
Patrick Hemmere0275472018-04-28 19:15:51 -040018949ssl_fc_session_key : binary
18950 Returns the SSL session master key of the front connection when the incoming
18951 connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It is useful to decrypt
18952 traffic sent using ephemeral ciphers. This requires OpenSSL >= 1.1.0, or
18953 BoringSSL.
18954
18955
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018956ssl_fc_sni : string
18957 This extracts the Server Name Indication TLS extension (SNI) field from an
18958 incoming connection made via an SSL/TLS transport layer and locally
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040018959 deciphered by HAProxy. The result (when present) typically is a string
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018960 matching the HTTPS host name (253 chars or less). The SSL library must have
18961 been built with support for TLS extensions enabled (check haproxy -vv).
18962
Alex18c88772021-06-05 13:23:08 +020018963 This fetch is different from "req.ssl_sni" above in that it applies to the
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040018964 connection being deciphered by HAProxy and not to SSL contents being blindly
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018965 forwarded. See also "ssl_fc_sni_end" and "ssl_fc_sni_reg" below. This
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050018966 requires that the SSL library is built with support for TLS extensions
Cyril Bonté9c1eb1e2012-10-09 22:45:34 +020018967 enabled (check haproxy -vv).
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020018968
Willy Tarreau000d4002022-11-25 10:12:12 +010018969 CAUTION! Except under very specific conditions, it is normally not correct to
18970 use this field as a substitute for the HTTP "Host" header field. For example,
18971 when forwarding an HTTPS connection to a server, the SNI field must be set
18972 from the HTTP Host header field using "req.hdr(host)" and not from the front
18973 SNI value. The reason is that SNI is solely used to select the certificate
18974 the server side will present, and that clients are then allowed to send
18975 requests with different Host values as long as they match the names in the
18976 certificate. As such, "ssl_fc_sni" should normally not be used as an argument
18977 to the "sni" server keyword, unless the backend works in TCP mode.
18978
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018979 ACL derivatives :
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018980 ssl_fc_sni_end : suffix match
18981 ssl_fc_sni_reg : regex match
Emeric Brun589fcad2012-10-16 14:13:26 +020018982
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018983ssl_fc_use_keysize : integer
18984 Returns the symmetric cipher key size used in bits when the incoming
18985 connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
Willy Tarreaub6fb4202008-07-20 11:18:28 +020018986
William Lallemandbfa3e812020-06-25 20:07:18 +020018987ssl_s_der : binary
18988 Returns the DER formatted certificate presented by the server when the
18989 outgoing connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. When used for
18990 an ACL, the value(s) to match against can be passed in hexadecimal form.
18991
William Dauchya598b502020-08-06 18:11:38 +020018992ssl_s_chain_der : binary
18993 Returns the DER formatted chain certificate presented by the server when the
18994 outgoing connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. When used for
18995 an ACL, the value(s) to match against can be passed in hexadecimal form. One
Ilya Shipitsin2272d8a2020-12-21 01:22:40 +050018996 can parse the result with any lib accepting ASN.1 DER data. It currently
William Dauchya598b502020-08-06 18:11:38 +020018997 does not support resumed sessions.
18998
William Lallemandbfa3e812020-06-25 20:07:18 +020018999ssl_s_key_alg : string
19000 Returns the name of the algorithm used to generate the key of the certificate
19001 presented by the server when the outgoing connection was made over an
19002 SSL/TLS transport layer.
19003
19004ssl_s_notafter : string
19005 Returns the end date presented by the server as a formatted string
19006 YYMMDDhhmmss[Z] when the outgoing connection was made over an SSL/TLS
19007 transport layer.
19008
19009ssl_s_notbefore : string
19010 Returns the start date presented by the server as a formatted string
19011 YYMMDDhhmmss[Z] when the outgoing connection was made over an SSL/TLS
19012 transport layer.
19013
19014ssl_s_i_dn([<entry>[,<occ>[,<format>]]]) : string
19015 When the outgoing connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
19016 returns the full distinguished name of the issuer of the certificate
19017 presented by the server when no <entry> is specified, or the value of the
19018 first given entry found from the beginning of the DN. If a positive/negative
19019 occurrence number is specified as the optional second argument, it returns
19020 the value of the nth given entry value from the beginning/end of the DN.
William Lallemand8f600c82020-06-26 09:55:06 +020019021 For instance, "ssl_s_i_dn(OU,2)" the second organization unit, and
19022 "ssl_s_i_dn(CN)" retrieves the common name.
William Lallemandbfa3e812020-06-25 20:07:18 +020019023 The <format> parameter allows you to receive the DN suitable for
19024 consumption by different protocols. Currently supported is rfc2253 for
19025 LDAP v3.
19026 If you'd like to modify the format only you can specify an empty string
19027 and zero for the first two parameters. Example: ssl_s_i_dn(,0,rfc2253)
19028
19029ssl_s_s_dn([<entry>[,<occ>[,<format>]]]) : string
19030 When the outgoing connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
19031 returns the full distinguished name of the subject of the certificate
19032 presented by the server when no <entry> is specified, or the value of the
19033 first given entry found from the beginning of the DN. If a positive/negative
19034 occurrence number is specified as the optional second argument, it returns
19035 the value of the nth given entry value from the beginning/end of the DN.
William Lallemand8f600c82020-06-26 09:55:06 +020019036 For instance, "ssl_s_s_dn(OU,2)" the second organization unit, and
19037 "ssl_s_s_dn(CN)" retrieves the common name.
William Lallemandbfa3e812020-06-25 20:07:18 +020019038 The <format> parameter allows you to receive the DN suitable for
19039 consumption by different protocols. Currently supported is rfc2253 for
19040 LDAP v3.
19041 If you'd like to modify the format only you can specify an empty string
19042 and zero for the first two parameters. Example: ssl_s_s_dn(,0,rfc2253)
19043
19044ssl_s_serial : binary
19045 Returns the serial of the certificate presented by the server when the
19046 outgoing connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. When used for
19047 an ACL, the value(s) to match against can be passed in hexadecimal form.
19048
19049ssl_s_sha1 : binary
19050 Returns the SHA-1 fingerprint of the certificate presented by the server
19051 when the outgoing connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. This
19052 can be used to know which certificate was chosen using SNI.
19053
19054ssl_s_sig_alg : string
19055 Returns the name of the algorithm used to sign the certificate presented by
19056 the server when the outgoing connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport
19057 layer.
19058
19059ssl_s_version : integer
19060 Returns the version of the certificate presented by the server when the
19061 outgoing connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
Willy Tarreaub6fb4202008-07-20 11:18:28 +020019062
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +0200190637.3.5. Fetching samples from buffer contents (Layer 6)
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019064------------------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreaub6fb4202008-07-20 11:18:28 +020019065
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019066Fetching samples from buffer contents is a bit different from the previous
19067sample fetches above because the sampled data are ephemeral. These data can
19068only be used when they're available and will be lost when they're forwarded.
19069For this reason, samples fetched from buffer contents during a request cannot
19070be used in a response for example. Even while the data are being fetched, they
19071can change. Sometimes it is necessary to set some delays or combine multiple
19072sample fetch methods to ensure that the expected data are complete and usable,
19073for example through TCP request content inspection. Please see the "tcp-request
19074content" keyword for more detailed information on the subject.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020019075
Christopher Fauleta434a002021-03-25 11:58:51 +010019076Warning : Following sample fetches are ignored if used from HTTP proxies. They
19077 only deal with raw contents found in the buffers. On their side,
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040019078 HTTP proxies use structured content. Thus raw representation of
Christopher Fauleta434a002021-03-25 11:58:51 +010019079 these data are meaningless. A warning is emitted if an ACL relies on
19080 one of the following sample fetches. But it is not possible to detect
19081 all invalid usage (for instance inside a log-format string or a
19082 sample expression). So be careful.
19083
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019084payload(<offset>,<length>) : binary (deprecated)
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010019085 This is an alias for "req.payload" when used in the context of a request (e.g.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019086 "stick on", "stick match"), and for "res.payload" when used in the context of
19087 a response such as in "stick store response".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010019088
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019089payload_lv(<offset1>,<length>[,<offset2>]) : binary (deprecated)
19090 This is an alias for "req.payload_lv" when used in the context of a request
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010019091 (e.g. "stick on", "stick match"), and for "res.payload_lv" when used in the
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019092 context of a response such as in "stick store response".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010019093
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019094req.len : integer
19095req_len : integer (deprecated)
19096 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of bytes present in the
19097 request buffer. This is mostly used in ACL. It is important to understand
19098 that this test does not return false as long as the buffer is changing. This
19099 means that a check with equality to zero will almost always immediately match
19100 at the beginning of the session, while a test for more data will wait for
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040019101 that data to come in and return false only when HAProxy is certain that no
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019102 more data will come in. This test was designed to be used with TCP request
19103 content inspection.
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020019104
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019105req.payload(<offset>,<length>) : binary
19106 This extracts a binary block of <length> bytes and starting at byte <offset>
Willy Tarreau00f00842013-08-02 11:07:32 +020019107 in the request buffer. As a special case, if the <length> argument is zero,
19108 the the whole buffer from <offset> to the end is extracted. This can be used
19109 with ACLs in order to check for the presence of some content in a buffer at
19110 any location.
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020019111
Christian Ruppertfd3184c2022-02-20 22:54:01 +010019112 ACL derivatives :
19113 req.payload(<offset>,<length>) : hex binary match
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020019114
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019115req.payload_lv(<offset1>,<length>[,<offset2>]) : binary
19116 This extracts a binary block whose size is specified at <offset1> for <length>
19117 bytes, and which starts at <offset2> if specified or just after the length in
19118 the request buffer. The <offset2> parameter also supports relative offsets if
19119 prepended with a '+' or '-' sign.
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020019120
Christian Ruppertfd3184c2022-02-20 22:54:01 +010019121 ACL derivatives :
19122 req.payload_lv(<offset1>,<length>[,<offset2>]) : hex binary match
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020019123
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019124 Example : please consult the example from the "stick store-response" keyword.
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020019125
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019126req.proto_http : boolean
19127req_proto_http : boolean (deprecated)
19128 Returns true when data in the request buffer look like HTTP and correctly
19129 parses as such. It is the same parser as the common HTTP request parser which
19130 is used so there should be no surprises. The test does not match until the
19131 request is complete, failed or timed out. This test may be used to report the
19132 protocol in TCP logs, but the biggest use is to block TCP request analysis
19133 until a complete HTTP request is present in the buffer, for example to track
19134 a header.
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020019135
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019136 Example:
19137 # track request counts per "base" (concatenation of Host+URL)
19138 tcp-request inspect-delay 10s
19139 tcp-request content reject if !HTTP
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020019140 tcp-request content track-sc0 base table req-rate
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020019141
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019142req.rdp_cookie([<name>]) : string
19143rdp_cookie([<name>]) : string (deprecated)
19144 When the request buffer looks like the RDP protocol, extracts the RDP cookie
19145 <name>, or any cookie if unspecified. The parser only checks for the first
19146 cookie, as illustrated in the RDP protocol specification. The cookie name is
19147 case insensitive. Generally the "MSTS" cookie name will be used, as it can
19148 contain the user name of the client connecting to the server if properly
19149 configured on the client. The "MSTSHASH" cookie is often used as well for
19150 session stickiness to servers.
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020019151
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019152 This differs from "balance rdp-cookie" in that any balancing algorithm may be
19153 used and thus the distribution of clients to backend servers is not linked to
19154 a hash of the RDP cookie. It is envisaged that using a balancing algorithm
19155 such as "balance roundrobin" or "balance leastconn" will lead to a more even
19156 distribution of clients to backend servers than the hash used by "balance
19157 rdp-cookie".
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020019158
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019159 ACL derivatives :
Christian Ruppertfd3184c2022-02-20 22:54:01 +010019160 req.rdp_cookie([<name>]) : exact string match
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020019161
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019162 Example :
19163 listen tse-farm
19164 bind 0.0.0.0:3389
19165 # wait up to 5s for an RDP cookie in the request
19166 tcp-request inspect-delay 5s
19167 tcp-request content accept if RDP_COOKIE
19168 # apply RDP cookie persistence
19169 persist rdp-cookie
19170 # Persist based on the mstshash cookie
19171 # This is only useful makes sense if
19172 # balance rdp-cookie is not used
19173 stick-table type string size 204800
19174 stick on req.rdp_cookie(mstshash)
19175 server srv1 1.1.1.1:3389
19176 server srv1 1.1.1.2:3389
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020019177
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019178 See also : "balance rdp-cookie", "persist rdp-cookie", "tcp-request" and the
Christian Ruppertfd3184c2022-02-20 22:54:01 +010019179 "req.rdp_cookie" ACL.
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020019180
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019181req.rdp_cookie_cnt([name]) : integer
19182rdp_cookie_cnt([name]) : integer (deprecated)
19183 Tries to parse the request buffer as RDP protocol, then returns an integer
19184 corresponding to the number of RDP cookies found. If an optional cookie name
19185 is passed, only cookies matching this name are considered. This is mostly
19186 used in ACL.
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020019187
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019188 ACL derivatives :
Christian Ruppertfd3184c2022-02-20 22:54:01 +010019189 req.rdp_cookie_cnt([<name>]) : integer match
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020019190
Alex Zorin4afdd132018-12-30 13:56:28 +110019191req.ssl_alpn : string
19192 Returns a string containing the values of the Application-Layer Protocol
19193 Negotiation (ALPN) TLS extension (RFC7301), sent by the client within the SSL
19194 ClientHello message. Note that this only applies to raw contents found in the
19195 request buffer and not to the contents deciphered via an SSL data layer, so
19196 this will not work with "bind" lines having the "ssl" option. This is useful
19197 in ACL to make a routing decision based upon the ALPN preferences of a TLS
Jarno Huuskonene504f812019-01-03 07:56:49 +020019198 client, like in the example below. See also "ssl_fc_alpn".
Alex Zorin4afdd132018-12-30 13:56:28 +110019199
19200 Examples :
19201 # Wait for a client hello for at most 5 seconds
19202 tcp-request inspect-delay 5s
Christian Ruppertfd3184c2022-02-20 22:54:01 +010019203 tcp-request content accept if { req.ssl_hello_type 1 }
Jarno Huuskonene504f812019-01-03 07:56:49 +020019204 use_backend bk_acme if { req.ssl_alpn acme-tls/1 }
Alex Zorin4afdd132018-12-30 13:56:28 +110019205 default_backend bk_default
19206
Nenad Merdanovic5fc7d7e2015-07-07 22:00:17 +020019207req.ssl_ec_ext : boolean
19208 Returns a boolean identifying if client sent the Supported Elliptic Curves
19209 Extension as defined in RFC4492, section 5.1. within the SSL ClientHello
Cyril Bonté307ee1e2015-09-28 23:16:06 +020019210 message. This can be used to present ECC compatible clients with EC
19211 certificate and to use RSA for all others, on the same IP address. Note that
19212 this only applies to raw contents found in the request buffer and not to
19213 contents deciphered via an SSL data layer, so this will not work with "bind"
19214 lines having the "ssl" option.
Nenad Merdanovic5fc7d7e2015-07-07 22:00:17 +020019215
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019216req.ssl_hello_type : integer
19217req_ssl_hello_type : integer (deprecated)
19218 Returns an integer value containing the type of the SSL hello message found
19219 in the request buffer if the buffer contains data that parse as a complete
19220 SSL (v3 or superior) client hello message. Note that this only applies to raw
19221 contents found in the request buffer and not to contents deciphered via an
19222 SSL data layer, so this will not work with "bind" lines having the "ssl"
19223 option. This is mostly used in ACL to detect presence of an SSL hello message
19224 that is supposed to contain an SSL session ID usable for stickiness.
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020019225
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019226req.ssl_sni : string
19227req_ssl_sni : string (deprecated)
19228 Returns a string containing the value of the Server Name TLS extension sent
19229 by a client in a TLS stream passing through the request buffer if the buffer
19230 contains data that parse as a complete SSL (v3 or superior) client hello
19231 message. Note that this only applies to raw contents found in the request
19232 buffer and not to contents deciphered via an SSL data layer, so this will not
Lukas Tribusa267b5d2020-07-19 00:25:06 +020019233 work with "bind" lines having the "ssl" option. This will only work for actual
19234 implicit TLS based protocols like HTTPS (443), IMAPS (993), SMTPS (465),
19235 however it will not work for explicit TLS based protocols, like SMTP (25/587)
19236 or IMAP (143). SNI normally contains the name of the host the client tries to
19237 connect to (for recent browsers). SNI is useful for allowing or denying access
19238 to certain hosts when SSL/TLS is used by the client. This test was designed to
19239 be used with TCP request content inspection. If content switching is needed,
19240 it is recommended to first wait for a complete client hello (type 1), like in
19241 the example below. See also "ssl_fc_sni".
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020019242
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019243 ACL derivatives :
Alex18c88772021-06-05 13:23:08 +020019244 req.ssl_sni : exact string match
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020019245
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019246 Examples :
19247 # Wait for a client hello for at most 5 seconds
19248 tcp-request inspect-delay 5s
Christian Ruppertfd3184c2022-02-20 22:54:01 +010019249 tcp-request content accept if { req.ssl_hello_type 1 }
Alex18c88772021-06-05 13:23:08 +020019250 use_backend bk_allow if { req.ssl_sni -f allowed_sites }
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019251 default_backend bk_sorry_page
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020019252
Pradeep Jindalbb2acf52015-09-29 10:12:57 +053019253req.ssl_st_ext : integer
19254 Returns 0 if the client didn't send a SessionTicket TLS Extension (RFC5077)
19255 Returns 1 if the client sent SessionTicket TLS Extension
19256 Returns 2 if the client also sent non-zero length TLS SessionTicket
19257 Note that this only applies to raw contents found in the request buffer and
19258 not to contents deciphered via an SSL data layer, so this will not work with
19259 "bind" lines having the "ssl" option. This can for example be used to detect
19260 whether the client sent a SessionTicket or not and stick it accordingly, if
19261 no SessionTicket then stick on SessionID or don't stick as there's no server
19262 side state is there when SessionTickets are in use.
19263
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019264req.ssl_ver : integer
19265req_ssl_ver : integer (deprecated)
19266 Returns an integer value containing the version of the SSL/TLS protocol of a
19267 stream present in the request buffer. Both SSLv2 hello messages and SSLv3
19268 messages are supported. TLSv1 is announced as SSL version 3.1. The value is
19269 composed of the major version multiplied by 65536, added to the minor
19270 version. Note that this only applies to raw contents found in the request
19271 buffer and not to contents deciphered via an SSL data layer, so this will not
19272 work with "bind" lines having the "ssl" option. The ACL version of the test
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010019273 matches against a decimal notation in the form MAJOR.MINOR (e.g. 3.1). This
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019274 fetch is mostly used in ACL.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010019275
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019276 ACL derivatives :
Christian Ruppertfd3184c2022-02-20 22:54:01 +010019277 req.ssl_ver : decimal match
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010019278
Willy Tarreau47e8eba2013-09-11 23:28:46 +020019279res.len : integer
19280 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of bytes present in the
19281 response buffer. This is mostly used in ACL. It is important to understand
19282 that this test does not return false as long as the buffer is changing. This
19283 means that a check with equality to zero will almost always immediately match
19284 at the beginning of the session, while a test for more data will wait for
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040019285 that data to come in and return false only when HAProxy is certain that no
Willy Tarreau47e8eba2013-09-11 23:28:46 +020019286 more data will come in. This test was designed to be used with TCP response
Christopher Faulete596d182020-05-05 17:46:34 +020019287 content inspection. But it may also be used in tcp-check based expect rules.
Willy Tarreau47e8eba2013-09-11 23:28:46 +020019288
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019289res.payload(<offset>,<length>) : binary
19290 This extracts a binary block of <length> bytes and starting at byte <offset>
Willy Tarreau00f00842013-08-02 11:07:32 +020019291 in the response buffer. As a special case, if the <length> argument is zero,
Christopher Faulete596d182020-05-05 17:46:34 +020019292 the whole buffer from <offset> to the end is extracted. This can be used
Willy Tarreau00f00842013-08-02 11:07:32 +020019293 with ACLs in order to check for the presence of some content in a buffer at
Christopher Faulete596d182020-05-05 17:46:34 +020019294 any location. It may also be used in tcp-check based expect rules.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010019295
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019296res.payload_lv(<offset1>,<length>[,<offset2>]) : binary
19297 This extracts a binary block whose size is specified at <offset1> for <length>
19298 bytes, and which starts at <offset2> if specified or just after the length in
19299 the response buffer. The <offset2> parameter also supports relative offsets
Christopher Faulete596d182020-05-05 17:46:34 +020019300 if prepended with a '+' or '-' sign. It may also be used in tcp-check based
19301 expect rules.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010019302
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019303 Example : please consult the example from the "stick store-response" keyword.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010019304
Willy Tarreau971f7b62015-09-29 14:06:59 +020019305res.ssl_hello_type : integer
19306rep_ssl_hello_type : integer (deprecated)
19307 Returns an integer value containing the type of the SSL hello message found
19308 in the response buffer if the buffer contains data that parses as a complete
19309 SSL (v3 or superior) hello message. Note that this only applies to raw
19310 contents found in the response buffer and not to contents deciphered via an
19311 SSL data layer, so this will not work with "server" lines having the "ssl"
19312 option. This is mostly used in ACL to detect presence of an SSL hello message
19313 that is supposed to contain an SSL session ID usable for stickiness.
19314
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019315wait_end : boolean
19316 This fetch either returns true when the inspection period is over, or does
19317 not fetch. It is only used in ACLs, in conjunction with content analysis to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010019318 avoid returning a wrong verdict early. It may also be used to delay some
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019319 actions, such as a delayed reject for some special addresses. Since it either
19320 stops the rules evaluation or immediately returns true, it is recommended to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010019321 use this acl as the last one in a rule. Please note that the default ACL
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019322 "WAIT_END" is always usable without prior declaration. This test was designed
19323 to be used with TCP request content inspection.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010019324
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019325 Examples :
19326 # delay every incoming request by 2 seconds
19327 tcp-request inspect-delay 2s
19328 tcp-request content accept if WAIT_END
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010019329
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019330 # don't immediately tell bad guys they are rejected
19331 tcp-request inspect-delay 10s
19332 acl goodguys src 10.0.0.0/24
19333 acl badguys src 10.0.1.0/24
19334 tcp-request content accept if goodguys
19335 tcp-request content reject if badguys WAIT_END
19336 tcp-request content reject
19337
19338
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +0200193397.3.6. Fetching HTTP samples (Layer 7)
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019340--------------------------------------
19341
19342It is possible to fetch samples from HTTP contents, requests and responses.
19343This application layer is also called layer 7. It is only possible to fetch the
19344data in this section when a full HTTP request or response has been parsed from
19345its respective request or response buffer. This is always the case with all
19346HTTP specific rules and for sections running with "mode http". When using TCP
19347content inspection, it may be necessary to support an inspection delay in order
19348to let the request or response come in first. These fetches may require a bit
19349more CPU resources than the layer 4 ones, but not much since the request and
19350response are indexed.
19351
Christopher Faulet4d37e532021-03-26 14:44:00 +010019352Note : Regarding HTTP processing from the tcp-request content rules, everything
19353 will work as expected from an HTTP proxy. However, from a TCP proxy,
19354 without an HTTP upgrade, it will only work for HTTP/1 content. For
19355 HTTP/2 content, only the preface is visible. Thus, it is only possible
19356 to rely to "req.proto_http", "req.ver" and eventually "method" sample
19357 fetches. All other L7 sample fetches will fail. After an HTTP upgrade,
19358 they will work in the same manner than from an HTTP proxy.
19359
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019360base : string
19361 This returns the concatenation of the first Host header and the path part of
19362 the request, which starts at the first slash and ends before the question
19363 mark. It can be useful in virtual hosted environments to detect URL abuses as
19364 well as to improve shared caches efficiency. Using this with a limited size
19365 stick table also allows one to collect statistics about most commonly
19366 requested objects by host/path. With ACLs it can allow simple content
19367 switching rules involving the host and the path at the same time, such as
19368 "www.example.com/favicon.ico". See also "path" and "uri".
19369
19370 ACL derivatives :
19371 base : exact string match
19372 base_beg : prefix match
19373 base_dir : subdir match
19374 base_dom : domain match
19375 base_end : suffix match
19376 base_len : length match
19377 base_reg : regex match
19378 base_sub : substring match
19379
19380base32 : integer
19381 This returns a 32-bit hash of the value returned by the "base" fetch method
19382 above. This is useful to track per-URL activity on high traffic sites without
19383 having to store all URLs. Instead a shorter hash is stored, saving a lot of
Willy Tarreau23ec4ca2014-07-15 20:15:37 +020019384 memory. The output type is an unsigned integer. The hash function used is
19385 SDBM with full avalanche on the output. Technically, base32 is exactly equal
19386 to "base,sdbm(1)".
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019387
19388base32+src : binary
19389 This returns the concatenation of the base32 fetch above and the src fetch
19390 below. The resulting type is of type binary, with a size of 8 or 20 bytes
19391 depending on the source address family. This can be used to track per-IP,
19392 per-URL counters.
19393
Yves Lafonb4d37082021-02-11 11:01:28 +010019394baseq : string
19395 This returns the concatenation of the first Host header and the path part of
19396 the request with the query-string, which starts at the first slash. Using this
19397 instead of "base" allows one to properly identify the target resource, for
19398 statistics or caching use cases. See also "path", "pathq" and "base".
19399
William Lallemand65ad6e12014-01-31 15:08:02 +010019400capture.req.hdr(<idx>) : string
19401 This extracts the content of the header captured by the "capture request
19402 header", idx is the position of the capture keyword in the configuration.
19403 The first entry is an index of 0. See also: "capture request header".
19404
19405capture.req.method : string
19406 This extracts the METHOD of an HTTP request. It can be used in both request
19407 and response. Unlike "method", it can be used in both request and response
19408 because it's allocated.
19409
19410capture.req.uri : string
19411 This extracts the request's URI, which starts at the first slash and ends
19412 before the first space in the request (without the host part). Unlike "path"
19413 and "url", it can be used in both request and response because it's
19414 allocated.
19415
Willy Tarreau3c1b5ec2014-04-24 23:41:57 +020019416capture.req.ver : string
19417 This extracts the request's HTTP version and returns either "HTTP/1.0" or
19418 "HTTP/1.1". Unlike "req.ver", it can be used in both request, response, and
19419 logs because it relies on a persistent flag.
19420
William Lallemand65ad6e12014-01-31 15:08:02 +010019421capture.res.hdr(<idx>) : string
19422 This extracts the content of the header captured by the "capture response
19423 header", idx is the position of the capture keyword in the configuration.
19424 The first entry is an index of 0.
19425 See also: "capture response header"
19426
Willy Tarreau3c1b5ec2014-04-24 23:41:57 +020019427capture.res.ver : string
19428 This extracts the response's HTTP version and returns either "HTTP/1.0" or
19429 "HTTP/1.1". Unlike "res.ver", it can be used in logs because it relies on a
19430 persistent flag.
19431
Willy Tarreaua5910cc2015-05-02 00:46:08 +020019432req.body : binary
Christopher Fauletaf4dc4c2020-05-05 17:33:25 +020019433 This returns the HTTP request's available body as a block of data. It is
19434 recommended to use "option http-buffer-request" to be sure to wait, as much
19435 as possible, for the request's body.
Willy Tarreaua5910cc2015-05-02 00:46:08 +020019436
Thierry FOURNIER9826c772015-05-20 15:50:54 +020019437req.body_param([<name>) : string
19438 This fetch assumes that the body of the POST request is url-encoded. The user
19439 can check if the "content-type" contains the value
19440 "application/x-www-form-urlencoded". This extracts the first occurrence of the
19441 parameter <name> in the body, which ends before '&'. The parameter name is
19442 case-sensitive. If no name is given, any parameter will match, and the first
19443 one will be returned. The result is a string corresponding to the value of the
19444 parameter <name> as presented in the request body (no URL decoding is
19445 performed). Note that the ACL version of this fetch iterates over multiple
19446 parameters and will iteratively report all parameters values if no name is
19447 given.
19448
Willy Tarreaua5910cc2015-05-02 00:46:08 +020019449req.body_len : integer
19450 This returns the length of the HTTP request's available body in bytes. It may
19451 be lower than the advertised length if the body is larger than the buffer. It
Christopher Fauletaf4dc4c2020-05-05 17:33:25 +020019452 is recommended to use "option http-buffer-request" to be sure to wait, as
19453 much as possible, for the request's body.
Willy Tarreaua5910cc2015-05-02 00:46:08 +020019454
19455req.body_size : integer
19456 This returns the advertised length of the HTTP request's body in bytes. It
Christopher Fauletaf4dc4c2020-05-05 17:33:25 +020019457 will represent the advertised Content-Length header, or the size of the
19458 available data in case of chunked encoding.
Willy Tarreaua5910cc2015-05-02 00:46:08 +020019459
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019460req.cook([<name>]) : string
19461cook([<name>]) : string (deprecated)
19462 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Cookie"
19463 header line from the request, and returns its value as string. If no name is
19464 specified, the first cookie value is returned. When used with ACLs, all
19465 matching cookies are evaluated. Spaces around the name and the value are
19466 ignored as requested by the Cookie header specification (RFC6265). The cookie
19467 name is case-sensitive. Empty cookies are valid, so an empty cookie may very
19468 well return an empty value if it is present. Use the "found" match to detect
19469 presence. Use the res.cook() variant for response cookies sent by the server.
19470
19471 ACL derivatives :
Christian Ruppertfd3184c2022-02-20 22:54:01 +010019472 req.cook([<name>]) : exact string match
19473 req.cook_beg([<name>]) : prefix match
19474 req.cook_dir([<name>]) : subdir match
19475 req.cook_dom([<name>]) : domain match
19476 req.cook_end([<name>]) : suffix match
19477 req.cook_len([<name>]) : length match
19478 req.cook_reg([<name>]) : regex match
19479 req.cook_sub([<name>]) : substring match
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010019480
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019481req.cook_cnt([<name>]) : integer
19482cook_cnt([<name>]) : integer (deprecated)
19483 Returns an integer value representing the number of occurrences of the cookie
19484 <name> in the request, or all cookies if <name> is not specified.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010019485
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019486req.cook_val([<name>]) : integer
19487cook_val([<name>]) : integer (deprecated)
19488 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Cookie"
19489 header line from the request, and converts its value to an integer which is
19490 returned. If no name is specified, the first cookie value is returned. When
19491 used in ACLs, all matching names are iterated over until a value matches.
Willy Tarreau0e698542011-09-16 08:32:32 +020019492
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019493cookie([<name>]) : string (deprecated)
19494 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Cookie"
19495 header line from the request, or a "Set-Cookie" header from the response, and
19496 returns its value as a string. A typical use is to get multiple clients
19497 sharing a same profile use the same server. This can be similar to what
Willy Tarreau294d0f02015-08-10 19:40:12 +020019498 "appsession" did with the "request-learn" statement, but with support for
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019499 multi-peer synchronization and state keeping across restarts. If no name is
19500 specified, the first cookie value is returned. This fetch should not be used
19501 anymore and should be replaced by req.cook() or res.cook() instead as it
19502 ambiguously uses the direction based on the context where it is used.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010019503
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019504hdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : string
19505 This is equivalent to req.hdr() when used on requests, and to res.hdr() when
19506 used on responses. Please refer to these respective fetches for more details.
19507 In case of doubt about the fetch direction, please use the explicit ones.
19508 Note that contrary to the hdr() sample fetch method, the hdr_* ACL keywords
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030019509 unambiguously apply to the request headers.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010019510
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019511req.fhdr(<name>[,<occ>]) : string
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010019512 This returns the full value of the last occurrence of header <name> in an
19513 HTTP request. It differs from req.hdr() in that any commas present in the
19514 value are returned and are not used as delimiters. This is sometimes useful
19515 with headers such as User-Agent.
19516
19517 When used from an ACL, all occurrences are iterated over until a match is
19518 found.
19519
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019520 Optionally, a specific occurrence might be specified as a position number.
19521 Positive values indicate a position from the first occurrence, with 1 being
19522 the first one. Negative values indicate positions relative to the last one,
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010019523 with -1 being the last one.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010019524
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019525req.fhdr_cnt([<name>]) : integer
19526 Returns an integer value representing the number of occurrences of request
19527 header field name <name>, or the total number of header fields if <name> is
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010019528 not specified. Like req.fhdr() it differs from res.hdr_cnt() by not splitting
19529 headers at commas.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010019530
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019531req.hdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : string
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010019532 This returns the last comma-separated value of the header <name> in an HTTP
19533 request. The fetch considers any comma as a delimiter for distinct values.
19534 This is useful if you need to process headers that are defined to be a list
19535 of values, such as Accept, or X-Forwarded-For. If full-line headers are
19536 desired instead, use req.fhdr(). Please carefully check RFC 7231 to know how
19537 certain headers are supposed to be parsed. Also, some of them are case
19538 insensitive (e.g. Connection).
19539
19540 When used from an ACL, all occurrences are iterated over until a match is
19541 found.
19542
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019543 Optionally, a specific occurrence might be specified as a position number.
19544 Positive values indicate a position from the first occurrence, with 1 being
19545 the first one. Negative values indicate positions relative to the last one,
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010019546 with -1 being the last one.
19547
19548 A typical use is with the X-Forwarded-For header once converted to IP,
19549 associated with an IP stick-table.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010019550
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019551 ACL derivatives :
19552 hdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : exact string match
19553 hdr_beg([<name>[,<occ>]]) : prefix match
19554 hdr_dir([<name>[,<occ>]]) : subdir match
19555 hdr_dom([<name>[,<occ>]]) : domain match
19556 hdr_end([<name>[,<occ>]]) : suffix match
19557 hdr_len([<name>[,<occ>]]) : length match
19558 hdr_reg([<name>[,<occ>]]) : regex match
19559 hdr_sub([<name>[,<occ>]]) : substring match
19560
19561req.hdr_cnt([<name>]) : integer
19562hdr_cnt([<header>]) : integer (deprecated)
19563 Returns an integer value representing the number of occurrences of request
19564 header field name <name>, or the total number of header field values if
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010019565 <name> is not specified. Like req.hdr() it counts each comma separated
19566 part of the header's value. If counting of full-line headers is desired,
19567 then req.fhdr_cnt() should be used instead.
19568
19569 With ACLs, it can be used to detect presence, absence or abuse of a specific
19570 header, as well as to block request smuggling attacks by rejecting requests
19571 which contain more than one of certain headers.
19572
19573 Refer to req.hdr() for more information on header matching.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019574
19575req.hdr_ip([<name>[,<occ>]]) : ip
19576hdr_ip([<name>[,<occ>]]) : ip (deprecated)
19577 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP request,
19578 converts it to an IPv4 or IPv6 address and returns this address. When used
19579 with ACLs, all occurrences are checked, and if <name> is omitted, every value
Willy Tarreau7b0e00d2021-03-25 14:12:29 +010019580 of every header is checked. The parser strictly adheres to the format
19581 described in RFC7239, with the extension that IPv4 addresses may optionally
19582 be followed by a colon (':') and a valid decimal port number (0 to 65535),
19583 which will be silently dropped. All other forms will not match and will
19584 cause the address to be ignored.
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010019585
19586 The <occ> parameter is processed as with req.hdr().
19587
19588 A typical use is with the X-Forwarded-For and X-Client-IP headers.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019589
19590req.hdr_val([<name>[,<occ>]]) : integer
19591hdr_val([<name>[,<occ>]]) : integer (deprecated)
19592 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP request, and
19593 converts it to an integer value. When used with ACLs, all occurrences are
19594 checked, and if <name> is omitted, every value of every header is checked.
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010019595
19596 The <occ> parameter is processed as with req.hdr().
19597
19598 A typical use is with the X-Forwarded-For header.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019599
Christopher Faulet687a68e2020-11-24 17:13:24 +010019600req.hdrs : string
19601 Returns the current request headers as string including the last empty line
19602 separating headers from the request body. The last empty line can be used to
19603 detect a truncated header block. This sample fetch is useful for some SPOE
19604 headers analyzers and for advanced logging.
19605
19606req.hdrs_bin : binary
19607 Returns the current request headers contained in preparsed binary form. This
19608 is useful for offloading some processing with SPOE. Each string is described
19609 by a length followed by the number of bytes indicated in the length. The
19610 length is represented using the variable integer encoding detailed in the
19611 SPOE documentation. The end of the list is marked by a couple of empty header
19612 names and values (length of 0 for both).
19613
19614 *(<str:header-name><str:header-value>)<empty string><empty string>
Frédéric Lécailleec891192019-02-26 15:02:35 +010019615
Christopher Faulet687a68e2020-11-24 17:13:24 +010019616 int: refer to the SPOE documentation for the encoding
19617 str: <int:length><bytes>
Frédéric Lécailleec891192019-02-26 15:02:35 +010019618
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019619http_auth(<userlist>) : boolean
19620 Returns a boolean indicating whether the authentication data received from
19621 the client match a username & password stored in the specified userlist. This
19622 fetch function is not really useful outside of ACLs. Currently only http
19623 basic auth is supported.
19624
Thierry FOURNIER9eec0a62014-01-22 18:38:02 +010019625http_auth_group(<userlist>) : string
19626 Returns a string corresponding to the user name found in the authentication
19627 data received from the client if both the user name and password are valid
19628 according to the specified userlist. The main purpose is to use it in ACLs
19629 where it is then checked whether the user belongs to any group within a list.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019630 This fetch function is not really useful outside of ACLs. Currently only http
19631 basic auth is supported.
19632
19633 ACL derivatives :
Thierry FOURNIER9eec0a62014-01-22 18:38:02 +010019634 http_auth_group(<userlist>) : group ...
19635 Returns true when the user extracted from the request and whose password is
19636 valid according to the specified userlist belongs to at least one of the
19637 groups.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019638
Christopher Fauleta4063562019-08-02 11:51:37 +020019639http_auth_pass : string
Willy Tarreauc9c6cdb2020-03-05 16:03:58 +010019640 Returns the user's password found in the authentication data received from
19641 the client, as supplied in the Authorization header. Not checks are
19642 performed by this sample fetch. Only Basic authentication is supported.
Christopher Fauleta4063562019-08-02 11:51:37 +020019643
19644http_auth_type : string
Willy Tarreauc9c6cdb2020-03-05 16:03:58 +010019645 Returns the authentication method found in the authentication data received from
19646 the client, as supplied in the Authorization header. Not checks are
19647 performed by this sample fetch. Only Basic authentication is supported.
Christopher Fauleta4063562019-08-02 11:51:37 +020019648
19649http_auth_user : string
Willy Tarreauc9c6cdb2020-03-05 16:03:58 +010019650 Returns the user name found in the authentication data received from the
19651 client, as supplied in the Authorization header. Not checks are performed by
19652 this sample fetch. Only Basic authentication is supported.
Christopher Fauleta4063562019-08-02 11:51:37 +020019653
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019654http_first_req : boolean
Willy Tarreau7f18e522010-10-22 20:04:13 +020019655 Returns true when the request being processed is the first one of the
19656 connection. This can be used to add or remove headers that may be missing
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019657 from some requests when a request is not the first one, or to help grouping
19658 requests in the logs.
Willy Tarreau7f18e522010-10-22 20:04:13 +020019659
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019660method : integer + string
19661 Returns an integer value corresponding to the method in the HTTP request. For
19662 example, "GET" equals 1 (check sources to establish the matching). Value 9
19663 means "other method" and may be converted to a string extracted from the
19664 stream. This should not be used directly as a sample, this is only meant to
19665 be used from ACLs, which transparently convert methods from patterns to these
19666 integer + string values. Some predefined ACL already check for most common
19667 methods.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020019668
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019669 ACL derivatives :
19670 method : case insensitive method match
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020019671
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019672 Example :
19673 # only accept GET and HEAD requests
19674 acl valid_method method GET HEAD
19675 http-request deny if ! valid_method
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020019676
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019677path : string
19678 This extracts the request's URL path, which starts at the first slash and
19679 ends before the question mark (without the host part). A typical use is with
19680 prefetch-capable caches, and with portals which need to aggregate multiple
19681 information from databases and keep them in caches. Note that with outgoing
19682 caches, it would be wiser to use "url" instead. With ACLs, it's typically
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010019683 used to match exact file names (e.g. "/login.php"), or directory parts using
Willy Tarreau3706e172023-08-08 19:35:25 +020019684 the derivative forms. See also the "url" and "base" fetch methods. Please
19685 note that any fragment reference in the URI ('#' after the path) is strictly
19686 forbidden by the HTTP standard and will be rejected. However, if the frontend
19687 receiving the request has "option accept-invalid-http-request", then this
19688 fragment part will be accepted and will also appear in the path.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020019689
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019690 ACL derivatives :
19691 path : exact string match
19692 path_beg : prefix match
19693 path_dir : subdir match
19694 path_dom : domain match
19695 path_end : suffix match
19696 path_len : length match
19697 path_reg : regex match
19698 path_sub : substring match
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020019699
Christopher Faulete720c322020-09-02 17:25:18 +020019700pathq : string
19701 This extracts the request's URL path with the query-string, which starts at
19702 the first slash. This sample fetch is pretty handy to always retrieve a
19703 relative URI, excluding the scheme and the authority part, if any. Indeed,
19704 while it is the common representation for an HTTP/1.1 request target, in
19705 HTTP/2, an absolute URI is often used. This sample fetch will return the same
Willy Tarreau3706e172023-08-08 19:35:25 +020019706 result in both cases. Please note that any fragment reference in the URI ('#'
19707 after the path) is strictly forbidden by the HTTP standard and will be
19708 rejected. However, if the frontend receiving the request has "option
19709 accept-invalid-http-request", then this fragment part will be accepted and
19710 will also appear in the path.
Christopher Faulete720c322020-09-02 17:25:18 +020019711
Willy Tarreau49ad95c2015-01-19 15:06:26 +010019712query : string
19713 This extracts the request's query string, which starts after the first
19714 question mark. If no question mark is present, this fetch returns nothing. If
19715 a question mark is present but nothing follows, it returns an empty string.
19716 This means it's possible to easily know whether a query string is present
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +010019717 using the "found" matching method. This fetch is the complement of "path"
Willy Tarreau49ad95c2015-01-19 15:06:26 +010019718 which stops before the question mark.
19719
Willy Tarreaueb27ec72015-02-20 13:55:29 +010019720req.hdr_names([<delim>]) : string
19721 This builds a string made from the concatenation of all header names as they
19722 appear in the request when the rule is evaluated. The default delimiter is
19723 the comma (',') but it may be overridden as an optional argument <delim>. In
19724 this case, only the first character of <delim> is considered.
19725
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019726req.ver : string
19727req_ver : string (deprecated)
19728 Returns the version string from the HTTP request, for example "1.1". This can
19729 be useful for logs, but is mostly there for ACL. Some predefined ACL already
19730 check for versions 1.0 and 1.1.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010019731
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019732 ACL derivatives :
Christian Ruppertfd3184c2022-02-20 22:54:01 +010019733 req.ver : exact string match
Willy Tarreau0e698542011-09-16 08:32:32 +020019734
Christopher Faulete596d182020-05-05 17:46:34 +020019735res.body : binary
19736 This returns the HTTP response's available body as a block of data. Unlike
19737 the request side, there is no directive to wait for the response's body. This
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010019738 sample fetch is really useful (and usable) in the health-check context.
19739
19740 It may be used in tcp-check based expect rules.
Christopher Faulete596d182020-05-05 17:46:34 +020019741
19742res.body_len : integer
19743 This returns the length of the HTTP response available body in bytes. Unlike
19744 the request side, there is no directive to wait for the response's body. This
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010019745 sample fetch is really useful (and usable) in the health-check context.
19746
19747 It may be used in tcp-check based expect rules.
Christopher Faulete596d182020-05-05 17:46:34 +020019748
19749res.body_size : integer
19750 This returns the advertised length of the HTTP response body in bytes. It
19751 will represent the advertised Content-Length header, or the size of the
19752 available data in case of chunked encoding. Unlike the request side, there is
19753 no directive to wait for the response body. This sample fetch is really
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010019754 useful (and usable) in the health-check context.
19755
19756 It may be used in tcp-check based expect rules.
Christopher Faulete596d182020-05-05 17:46:34 +020019757
Remi Tricot-Le Bretonbf971212020-10-27 11:55:57 +010019758res.cache_hit : boolean
19759 Returns the boolean "true" value if the response has been built out of an
19760 HTTP cache entry, otherwise returns boolean "false".
19761
19762res.cache_name : string
19763 Returns a string containing the name of the HTTP cache that was used to
19764 build the HTTP response if res.cache_hit is true, otherwise returns an
19765 empty string.
19766
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019767res.comp : boolean
19768 Returns the boolean "true" value if the response has been compressed by
19769 HAProxy, otherwise returns boolean "false". This may be used to add
19770 information in the logs.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020019771
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019772res.comp_algo : string
19773 Returns a string containing the name of the algorithm used if the response
19774 was compressed by HAProxy, for example : "deflate". This may be used to add
19775 some information in the logs.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010019776
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019777res.cook([<name>]) : string
19778scook([<name>]) : string (deprecated)
19779 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Set-Cookie"
19780 header line from the response, and returns its value as string. If no name is
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010019781 specified, the first cookie value is returned.
19782
19783 It may be used in tcp-check based expect rules.
Willy Tarreau0ce3aa02012-04-25 18:46:33 +020019784
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019785 ACL derivatives :
Christian Ruppertfd3184c2022-02-20 22:54:01 +010019786 res.scook([<name>] : exact string match
Willy Tarreau0ce3aa02012-04-25 18:46:33 +020019787
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019788res.cook_cnt([<name>]) : integer
19789scook_cnt([<name>]) : integer (deprecated)
19790 Returns an integer value representing the number of occurrences of the cookie
19791 <name> in the response, or all cookies if <name> is not specified. This is
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010019792 mostly useful when combined with ACLs to detect suspicious responses.
19793
19794 It may be used in tcp-check based expect rules.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010019795
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019796res.cook_val([<name>]) : integer
19797scook_val([<name>]) : integer (deprecated)
19798 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Set-Cookie"
19799 header line from the response, and converts its value to an integer which is
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010019800 returned. If no name is specified, the first cookie value is returned.
19801
19802 It may be used in tcp-check based expect rules.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010019803
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019804res.fhdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : string
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010019805 This fetch works like the req.fhdr() fetch with the difference that it acts
19806 on the headers within an HTTP response.
19807
19808 Like req.fhdr() the res.fhdr() fetch returns full values. If the header is
19809 defined to be a list you should use res.hdr().
19810
19811 This fetch is sometimes useful with headers such as Date or Expires.
19812
19813 It may be used in tcp-check based expect rules.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020019814
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019815res.fhdr_cnt([<name>]) : integer
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010019816 This fetch works like the req.fhdr_cnt() fetch with the difference that it
19817 acts on the headers within an HTTP response.
19818
19819 Like req.fhdr_cnt() the res.fhdr_cnt() fetch acts on full values. If the
19820 header is defined to be a list you should use res.hdr_cnt().
19821
19822 It may be used in tcp-check based expect rules.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020019823
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019824res.hdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : string
19825shdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : string (deprecated)
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010019826 This fetch works like the req.hdr() fetch with the difference that it acts
19827 on the headers within an HTTP response.
19828
Ilya Shipitsinacf84592021-02-06 22:29:08 +050019829 Like req.hdr() the res.hdr() fetch considers the comma to be a delimiter. If
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010019830 this is not desired res.fhdr() should be used.
19831
19832 It may be used in tcp-check based expect rules.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020019833
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019834 ACL derivatives :
Christian Ruppertfd3184c2022-02-20 22:54:01 +010019835 res.hdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : exact string match
19836 res.hdr_beg([<name>[,<occ>]]) : prefix match
19837 res.hdr_dir([<name>[,<occ>]]) : subdir match
19838 res.hdr_dom([<name>[,<occ>]]) : domain match
19839 res.hdr_end([<name>[,<occ>]]) : suffix match
19840 res.hdr_len([<name>[,<occ>]]) : length match
19841 res.hdr_reg([<name>[,<occ>]]) : regex match
19842 res.hdr_sub([<name>[,<occ>]]) : substring match
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019843
19844res.hdr_cnt([<name>]) : integer
19845shdr_cnt([<name>]) : integer (deprecated)
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010019846 This fetch works like the req.hdr_cnt() fetch with the difference that it
19847 acts on the headers within an HTTP response.
19848
19849 Like req.hdr_cnt() the res.hdr_cnt() fetch considers the comma to be a
Ilya Shipitsinacf84592021-02-06 22:29:08 +050019850 delimiter. If this is not desired res.fhdr_cnt() should be used.
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010019851
19852 It may be used in tcp-check based expect rules.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020019853
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019854res.hdr_ip([<name>[,<occ>]]) : ip
19855shdr_ip([<name>[,<occ>]]) : ip (deprecated)
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010019856 This fetch works like the req.hdr_ip() fetch with the difference that it
19857 acts on the headers within an HTTP response.
19858
19859 This can be useful to learn some data into a stick table.
19860
19861 It may be used in tcp-check based expect rules.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020019862
Willy Tarreaueb27ec72015-02-20 13:55:29 +010019863res.hdr_names([<delim>]) : string
19864 This builds a string made from the concatenation of all header names as they
19865 appear in the response when the rule is evaluated. The default delimiter is
19866 the comma (',') but it may be overridden as an optional argument <delim>. In
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010019867 this case, only the first character of <delim> is considered.
19868
19869 It may be used in tcp-check based expect rules.
Willy Tarreaueb27ec72015-02-20 13:55:29 +010019870
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019871res.hdr_val([<name>[,<occ>]]) : integer
19872shdr_val([<name>[,<occ>]]) : integer (deprecated)
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010019873 This fetch works like the req.hdr_val() fetch with the difference that it
19874 acts on the headers within an HTTP response.
19875
19876 This can be useful to learn some data into a stick table.
19877
19878 It may be used in tcp-check based expect rules.
Christopher Faulete596d182020-05-05 17:46:34 +020019879
19880res.hdrs : string
19881 Returns the current response headers as string including the last empty line
19882 separating headers from the request body. The last empty line can be used to
19883 detect a truncated header block. This sample fetch is useful for some SPOE
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010019884 headers analyzers and for advanced logging.
19885
19886 It may also be used in tcp-check based expect rules.
Christopher Faulete596d182020-05-05 17:46:34 +020019887
19888res.hdrs_bin : binary
19889 Returns the current response headers contained in preparsed binary form. This
19890 is useful for offloading some processing with SPOE. It may be used in
19891 tcp-check based expect rules. Each string is described by a length followed
19892 by the number of bytes indicated in the length. The length is represented
19893 using the variable integer encoding detailed in the SPOE documentation. The
19894 end of the list is marked by a couple of empty header names and values
19895 (length of 0 for both).
19896
19897 *(<str:header-name><str:header-value>)<empty string><empty string>
19898
19899 int: refer to the SPOE documentation for the encoding
19900 str: <int:length><bytes>
Alexandre Cassen5eb1a902007-11-29 15:43:32 +010019901
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019902res.ver : string
19903resp_ver : string (deprecated)
19904 Returns the version string from the HTTP response, for example "1.1". This
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010019905 can be useful for logs, but is mostly there for ACL.
19906
19907 It may be used in tcp-check based expect rules.
Willy Tarreau0e698542011-09-16 08:32:32 +020019908
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019909 ACL derivatives :
Christian Ruppertfd3184c2022-02-20 22:54:01 +010019910 resp.ver : exact string match
Alexandre Cassen5eb1a902007-11-29 15:43:32 +010019911
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019912set-cookie([<name>]) : string (deprecated)
19913 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Set-Cookie"
19914 header line from the response and uses the corresponding value to match. This
Willy Tarreau294d0f02015-08-10 19:40:12 +020019915 can be comparable to what "appsession" did with default options, but with
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019916 support for multi-peer synchronization and state keeping across restarts.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +010019917
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019918 This fetch function is deprecated and has been superseded by the "res.cook"
19919 fetch. This keyword will disappear soon.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +010019920
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019921status : integer
19922 Returns an integer containing the HTTP status code in the HTTP response, for
19923 example, 302. It is mostly used within ACLs and integer ranges, for example,
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010019924 to remove any Location header if the response is not a 3xx.
19925
19926 It may be used in tcp-check based expect rules.
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020019927
Thierry Fournier0e00dca2016-04-07 15:47:40 +020019928unique-id : string
19929 Returns the unique-id attached to the request. The directive
19930 "unique-id-format" must be set. If it is not set, the unique-id sample fetch
19931 fails. Note that the unique-id is usually used with HTTP requests, however this
19932 sample fetch can be used with other protocols. Obviously, if it is used with
19933 other protocols than HTTP, the unique-id-format directive must not contain
19934 HTTP parts. See: unique-id-format and unique-id-header
19935
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019936url : string
19937 This extracts the request's URL as presented in the request. A typical use is
19938 with prefetch-capable caches, and with portals which need to aggregate
19939 multiple information from databases and keep them in caches. With ACLs, using
19940 "path" is preferred over using "url", because clients may send a full URL as
19941 is normally done with proxies. The only real use is to match "*" which does
19942 not match in "path", and for which there is already a predefined ACL. See
Willy Tarreau3706e172023-08-08 19:35:25 +020019943 also "path" and "base". Please note that any fragment reference in the URI
19944 ('#' after the path) is strictly forbidden by the HTTP standard and will be
19945 rejected. However, if the frontend receiving the request has "option
19946 accept-invalid-http-request", then this fragment part will be accepted and
19947 will also appear in the url.
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020019948
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019949 ACL derivatives :
19950 url : exact string match
19951 url_beg : prefix match
19952 url_dir : subdir match
19953 url_dom : domain match
19954 url_end : suffix match
19955 url_len : length match
19956 url_reg : regex match
19957 url_sub : substring match
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020019958
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019959url_ip : ip
19960 This extracts the IP address from the request's URL when the host part is
19961 presented as an IP address. Its use is very limited. For instance, a
19962 monitoring system might use this field as an alternative for the source IP in
19963 order to test what path a given source address would follow, or to force an
19964 entry in a table for a given source address. With ACLs it can be used to
19965 restrict access to certain systems through a proxy, for example when combined
19966 with option "http_proxy".
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020019967
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019968url_port : integer
19969 This extracts the port part from the request's URL. Note that if the port is
19970 not specified in the request, port 80 is assumed. With ACLs it can be used to
19971 restrict access to certain systems through a proxy, for example when combined
19972 with option "http_proxy".
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020019973
Willy Tarreau1ede1da2015-05-07 16:06:18 +020019974urlp([<name>[,<delim>]]) : string
19975url_param([<name>[,<delim>]]) : string
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019976 This extracts the first occurrence of the parameter <name> in the query
19977 string, which begins after either '?' or <delim>, and which ends before '&',
Willy Tarreau1ede1da2015-05-07 16:06:18 +020019978 ';' or <delim>. The parameter name is case-sensitive. If no name is given,
19979 any parameter will match, and the first one will be returned. The result is
19980 a string corresponding to the value of the parameter <name> as presented in
19981 the request (no URL decoding is performed). This can be used for session
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019982 stickiness based on a client ID, to extract an application cookie passed as a
19983 URL parameter, or in ACLs to apply some checks. Note that the ACL version of
Willy Tarreau1ede1da2015-05-07 16:06:18 +020019984 this fetch iterates over multiple parameters and will iteratively report all
19985 parameters values if no name is given
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020019986
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019987 ACL derivatives :
19988 urlp(<name>[,<delim>]) : exact string match
19989 urlp_beg(<name>[,<delim>]) : prefix match
19990 urlp_dir(<name>[,<delim>]) : subdir match
19991 urlp_dom(<name>[,<delim>]) : domain match
19992 urlp_end(<name>[,<delim>]) : suffix match
19993 urlp_len(<name>[,<delim>]) : length match
19994 urlp_reg(<name>[,<delim>]) : regex match
19995 urlp_sub(<name>[,<delim>]) : substring match
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020019996
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020019997
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019998 Example :
19999 # match http://example.com/foo?PHPSESSIONID=some_id
20000 stick on urlp(PHPSESSIONID)
20001 # match http://example.com/foo;JSESSIONID=some_id
20002 stick on urlp(JSESSIONID,;)
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020020003
Jarno Huuskonen676f6222017-03-30 09:19:45 +030020004urlp_val([<name>[,<delim>]]) : integer
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020020005 See "urlp" above. This one extracts the URL parameter <name> in the request
20006 and converts it to an integer value. This can be used for session stickiness
20007 based on a user ID for example, or with ACLs to match a page number or price.
Willy Tarreaua9fddca2012-07-31 07:51:48 +020020008
Dragan Dosen0070cd52016-06-16 12:19:49 +020020009url32 : integer
20010 This returns a 32-bit hash of the value obtained by concatenating the first
20011 Host header and the whole URL including parameters (not only the path part of
20012 the request, as in the "base32" fetch above). This is useful to track per-URL
20013 activity. A shorter hash is stored, saving a lot of memory. The output type
20014 is an unsigned integer.
20015
20016url32+src : binary
20017 This returns the concatenation of the "url32" fetch and the "src" fetch. The
20018 resulting type is of type binary, with a size of 8 or 20 bytes depending on
20019 the source address family. This can be used to track per-IP, per-URL counters.
20020
Christopher Faulet16032ab2020-04-30 11:30:00 +020020021
Christopher Faulete596d182020-05-05 17:46:34 +0200200227.3.7. Fetching samples for developers
Christopher Fauletd47941d2020-01-08 14:40:19 +010020023---------------------------------------
20024
20025This set of sample fetch methods is reserved to developers and must never be
20026used on a production environment, except on developer demand, for debugging
20027purposes. Moreover, no special care will be taken on backwards compatibility.
20028There is no warranty the following sample fetches will never change, be renamed
20029or simply removed. So be really careful if you should use one of them. To avoid
20030any ambiguity, these sample fetches are placed in the dedicated scope "internal",
20031for instance "internal.strm.is_htx".
20032
20033internal.htx.data : integer
20034 Returns the size in bytes used by data in the HTX message associated to a
20035 channel. The channel is chosen depending on the sample direction.
20036
20037internal.htx.free : integer
20038 Returns the free space (size - used) in bytes in the HTX message associated
20039 to a channel. The channel is chosen depending on the sample direction.
20040
20041internal.htx.free_data : integer
20042 Returns the free space for the data in bytes in the HTX message associated to
20043 a channel. The channel is chosen depending on the sample direction.
20044
20045internal.htx.has_eom : boolean
Christopher Fauletd1ac2b92020-12-02 19:12:22 +010020046 Returns true if the HTX message associated to a channel contains the
20047 end-of-message flag (EOM). Otherwise, it returns false. The channel is chosen
20048 depending on the sample direction.
Christopher Fauletd47941d2020-01-08 14:40:19 +010020049
20050internal.htx.nbblks : integer
20051 Returns the number of blocks present in the HTX message associated to a
20052 channel. The channel is chosen depending on the sample direction.
20053
20054internal.htx.size : integer
20055 Returns the total size in bytes of the HTX message associated to a
20056 channel. The channel is chosen depending on the sample direction.
20057
20058internal.htx.used : integer
20059 Returns the total size used in bytes (data + metadata) in the HTX message
20060 associated to a channel. The channel is chosen depending on the sample
20061 direction.
20062
20063internal.htx_blk.size(<idx>) : integer
20064 Returns the size of the block at the position <idx> in the HTX message
20065 associated to a channel or 0 if it does not exist. The channel is chosen
20066 depending on the sample direction. <idx> may be any positive integer or one
20067 of the special value :
20068 * head : The oldest inserted block
20069 * tail : The newest inserted block
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +050020070 * first : The first block where to (re)start the analysis
Christopher Fauletd47941d2020-01-08 14:40:19 +010020071
20072internal.htx_blk.type(<idx>) : string
20073 Returns the type of the block at the position <idx> in the HTX message
20074 associated to a channel or "HTX_BLK_UNUSED" if it does not exist. The channel
20075 is chosen depending on the sample direction. <idx> may be any positive
20076 integer or one of the special value :
20077 * head : The oldest inserted block
20078 * tail : The newest inserted block
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +050020079 * first : The first block where to (re)start the analysis
Christopher Fauletd47941d2020-01-08 14:40:19 +010020080
20081internal.htx_blk.data(<idx>) : binary
20082 Returns the value of the DATA block at the position <idx> in the HTX message
20083 associated to a channel or an empty string if it does not exist or if it is
20084 not a DATA block. The channel is chosen depending on the sample direction.
20085 <idx> may be any positive integer or one of the special value :
20086
20087 * head : The oldest inserted block
20088 * tail : The newest inserted block
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +050020089 * first : The first block where to (re)start the analysis
Christopher Fauletd47941d2020-01-08 14:40:19 +010020090
20091internal.htx_blk.hdrname(<idx>) : string
20092 Returns the header name of the HEADER block at the position <idx> in the HTX
20093 message associated to a channel or an empty string if it does not exist or if
20094 it is not an HEADER block. The channel is chosen depending on the sample
20095 direction. <idx> may be any positive integer or one of the special value :
20096
20097 * head : The oldest inserted block
20098 * tail : The newest inserted block
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +050020099 * first : The first block where to (re)start the analysis
Christopher Fauletd47941d2020-01-08 14:40:19 +010020100
20101internal.htx_blk.hdrval(<idx>) : string
20102 Returns the header value of the HEADER block at the position <idx> in the HTX
20103 message associated to a channel or an empty string if it does not exist or if
20104 it is not an HEADER block. The channel is chosen depending on the sample
20105 direction. <idx> may be any positive integer or one of the special value :
20106
20107 * head : The oldest inserted block
20108 * tail : The newest inserted block
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +050020109 * first : The first block where to (re)start the analysis
Christopher Fauletd47941d2020-01-08 14:40:19 +010020110
20111internal.htx_blk.start_line(<idx>) : string
20112 Returns the value of the REQ_SL or RES_SL block at the position <idx> in the
20113 HTX message associated to a channel or an empty string if it does not exist
20114 or if it is not a SL block. The channel is chosen depending on the sample
20115 direction. <idx> may be any positive integer or one of the special value :
20116
20117 * head : The oldest inserted block
20118 * tail : The newest inserted block
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +050020119 * first : The first block where to (re)start the analysis
Christopher Fauletd47941d2020-01-08 14:40:19 +010020120
20121internal.strm.is_htx : boolean
20122 Returns true if the current stream is an HTX stream. It means the data in the
20123 channels buffers are stored using the internal HTX representation. Otherwise,
20124 it returns false.
20125
20126
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200201277.4. Pre-defined ACLs
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020020128---------------------
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +010020129
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020020130Some predefined ACLs are hard-coded so that they do not have to be declared in
20131every frontend which needs them. They all have their names in upper case in
Patrick Mézard2382ad62010-05-09 10:43:32 +020020132order to avoid confusion. Their equivalence is provided below.
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +010020133
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020020134ACL name Equivalent to Usage
Christopher Faulet779184e2021-04-01 17:24:04 +020020135---------------+----------------------------------+------------------------------------------------------
20136FALSE always_false never match
20137HTTP req.proto_http match if request protocol is valid HTTP
20138HTTP_1.0 req.ver 1.0 match if HTTP request version is 1.0
20139HTTP_1.1 req.ver 1.1 match if HTTP request version is 1.1
Christopher Faulet8043e832021-03-26 16:00:54 +010020140HTTP_2.0 req.ver 2.0 match if HTTP request version is 2.0
Christopher Faulet779184e2021-04-01 17:24:04 +020020141HTTP_CONTENT req.hdr_val(content-length) gt 0 match an existing content-length in the HTTP request
20142HTTP_URL_ABS url_reg ^[^/:]*:// match absolute URL with scheme
20143HTTP_URL_SLASH url_beg / match URL beginning with "/"
20144HTTP_URL_STAR url * match URL equal to "*"
20145LOCALHOST src 127.0.0.1/8 match connection from local host
20146METH_CONNECT method CONNECT match HTTP CONNECT method
20147METH_DELETE method DELETE match HTTP DELETE method
20148METH_GET method GET HEAD match HTTP GET or HEAD method
20149METH_HEAD method HEAD match HTTP HEAD method
20150METH_OPTIONS method OPTIONS match HTTP OPTIONS method
20151METH_POST method POST match HTTP POST method
20152METH_PUT method PUT match HTTP PUT method
20153METH_TRACE method TRACE match HTTP TRACE method
20154RDP_COOKIE req.rdp_cookie_cnt gt 0 match presence of an RDP cookie in the request buffer
20155REQ_CONTENT req.len gt 0 match data in the request buffer
20156TRUE always_true always match
20157WAIT_END wait_end wait for end of content analysis
20158---------------+----------------------------------+------------------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +010020159
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010020160
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200201618. Logging
20162----------
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010020163
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020164One of HAProxy's strong points certainly lies is its precise logs. It probably
20165provides the finest level of information available for such a product, which is
20166very important for troubleshooting complex environments. Standard information
20167provided in logs include client ports, TCP/HTTP state timers, precise session
20168state at termination and precise termination cause, information about decisions
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010020169to direct traffic to a server, and of course the ability to capture arbitrary
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020170headers.
20171
20172In order to improve administrators reactivity, it offers a great transparency
20173about encountered problems, both internal and external, and it is possible to
20174send logs to different sources at the same time with different level filters :
20175
20176 - global process-level logs (system errors, start/stop, etc..)
20177 - per-instance system and internal errors (lack of resource, bugs, ...)
20178 - per-instance external troubles (servers up/down, max connections)
20179 - per-instance activity (client connections), either at the establishment or
20180 at the termination.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010020181 - per-request control of log-level, e.g.
Jim Freeman9e8714b2015-05-26 09:16:34 -060020182 http-request set-log-level silent if sensitive_request
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020183
20184The ability to distribute different levels of logs to different log servers
20185allow several production teams to interact and to fix their problems as soon
20186as possible. For example, the system team might monitor system-wide errors,
20187while the application team might be monitoring the up/down for their servers in
20188real time, and the security team might analyze the activity logs with one hour
20189delay.
20190
20191
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200201928.1. Log levels
20193---------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020194
Simon Hormandf791f52011-05-29 15:01:10 +090020195TCP and HTTP connections can be logged with information such as the date, time,
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020196source IP address, destination address, connection duration, response times,
Simon Hormandf791f52011-05-29 15:01:10 +090020197HTTP request, HTTP return code, number of bytes transmitted, conditions
20198in which the session ended, and even exchanged cookies values. For example
20199track a particular user's problems. All messages may be sent to up to two
20200syslog servers. Check the "log" keyword in section 4.2 for more information
20201about log facilities.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020202
20203
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200202048.2. Log formats
20205----------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020206
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010020207HAProxy supports 5 log formats. Several fields are common between these formats
Simon Hormandf791f52011-05-29 15:01:10 +090020208and will be detailed in the following sections. A few of them may vary
20209slightly with the configuration, due to indicators specific to certain
20210options. The supported formats are as follows :
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020211
20212 - the default format, which is very basic and very rarely used. It only
20213 provides very basic information about the incoming connection at the moment
20214 it is accepted : source IP:port, destination IP:port, and frontend-name.
20215 This mode will eventually disappear so it will not be described to great
20216 extents.
20217
20218 - the TCP format, which is more advanced. This format is enabled when "option
20219 tcplog" is set on the frontend. HAProxy will then usually wait for the
20220 connection to terminate before logging. This format provides much richer
20221 information, such as timers, connection counts, queue size, etc... This
20222 format is recommended for pure TCP proxies.
20223
20224 - the HTTP format, which is the most advanced for HTTP proxying. This format
20225 is enabled when "option httplog" is set on the frontend. It provides the
20226 same information as the TCP format with some HTTP-specific fields such as
20227 the request, the status code, and captures of headers and cookies. This
20228 format is recommended for HTTP proxies.
20229
Emeric Brun3a058f32009-06-30 18:26:00 +020020230 - the CLF HTTP format, which is equivalent to the HTTP format, but with the
20231 fields arranged in the same order as the CLF format. In this mode, all
20232 timers, captures, flags, etc... appear one per field after the end of the
20233 common fields, in the same order they appear in the standard HTTP format.
20234
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010020235 - the custom log format, allows you to make your own log line.
20236
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020237Next sections will go deeper into details for each of these formats. Format
20238specification will be performed on a "field" basis. Unless stated otherwise, a
20239field is a portion of text delimited by any number of spaces. Since syslog
20240servers are susceptible of inserting fields at the beginning of a line, it is
20241always assumed that the first field is the one containing the process name and
20242identifier.
20243
20244Note : Since log lines may be quite long, the log examples in sections below
20245 might be broken into multiple lines. The example log lines will be
20246 prefixed with 3 closing angle brackets ('>>>') and each time a log is
20247 broken into multiple lines, each non-final line will end with a
20248 backslash ('\') and the next line will start indented by two characters.
20249
20250
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200202518.2.1. Default log format
20252-------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020253
20254This format is used when no specific option is set. The log is emitted as soon
20255as the connection is accepted. One should note that this currently is the only
20256format which logs the request's destination IP and ports.
20257
20258 Example :
20259 listen www
20260 mode http
20261 log global
20262 server srv1 127.0.0.1:8000
20263
20264 >>> Feb 6 12:12:09 localhost \
20265 haproxy[14385]: Connect from 10.0.1.2:33312 to 10.0.3.31:8012 \
20266 (www/HTTP)
20267
20268 Field Format Extract from the example above
20269 1 process_name '[' pid ']:' haproxy[14385]:
20270 2 'Connect from' Connect from
20271 3 source_ip ':' source_port 10.0.1.2:33312
20272 4 'to' to
20273 5 destination_ip ':' destination_port 10.0.3.31:8012
20274 6 '(' frontend_name '/' mode ')' (www/HTTP)
20275
20276Detailed fields description :
20277 - "source_ip" is the IP address of the client which initiated the connection.
20278 - "source_port" is the TCP port of the client which initiated the connection.
20279 - "destination_ip" is the IP address the client connected to.
20280 - "destination_port" is the TCP port the client connected to.
20281 - "frontend_name" is the name of the frontend (or listener) which received
20282 and processed the connection.
20283 - "mode is the mode the frontend is operating (TCP or HTTP).
20284
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +010020285In case of a UNIX socket, the source and destination addresses are marked as
20286"unix:" and the ports reflect the internal ID of the socket which accepted the
20287connection (the same ID as reported in the stats).
20288
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020289It is advised not to use this deprecated format for newer installations as it
20290will eventually disappear.
20291
20292
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200202938.2.2. TCP log format
20294---------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020295
20296The TCP format is used when "option tcplog" is specified in the frontend, and
20297is the recommended format for pure TCP proxies. It provides a lot of precious
20298information for troubleshooting. Since this format includes timers and byte
20299counts, the log is normally emitted at the end of the session. It can be
20300emitted earlier if "option logasap" is specified, which makes sense in most
20301environments with long sessions such as remote terminals. Sessions which match
20302the "monitor" rules are never logged. It is also possible not to emit logs for
20303sessions for which no data were exchanged between the client and the server, by
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +020020304specifying "option dontlognull" in the frontend. Successful connections will
20305not be logged if "option dontlog-normal" is specified in the frontend. A few
20306fields may slightly vary depending on some configuration options, those are
20307marked with a star ('*') after the field name below.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020308
20309 Example :
20310 frontend fnt
20311 mode tcp
20312 option tcplog
20313 log global
20314 default_backend bck
20315
20316 backend bck
20317 server srv1 127.0.0.1:8000
20318
20319 >>> Feb 6 12:12:56 localhost \
20320 haproxy[14387]: 10.0.1.2:33313 [06/Feb/2009:12:12:51.443] fnt \
20321 bck/srv1 0/0/5007 212 -- 0/0/0/0/3 0/0
20322
20323 Field Format Extract from the example above
20324 1 process_name '[' pid ']:' haproxy[14387]:
20325 2 client_ip ':' client_port 10.0.1.2:33313
20326 3 '[' accept_date ']' [06/Feb/2009:12:12:51.443]
20327 4 frontend_name fnt
20328 5 backend_name '/' server_name bck/srv1
20329 6 Tw '/' Tc '/' Tt* 0/0/5007
20330 7 bytes_read* 212
20331 8 termination_state --
20332 9 actconn '/' feconn '/' beconn '/' srv_conn '/' retries* 0/0/0/0/3
20333 10 srv_queue '/' backend_queue 0/0
20334
20335Detailed fields description :
20336 - "client_ip" is the IP address of the client which initiated the TCP
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040020337 connection to HAProxy. If the connection was accepted on a UNIX socket
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +010020338 instead, the IP address would be replaced with the word "unix". Note that
20339 when the connection is accepted on a socket configured with "accept-proxy"
Bertrand Jacquin93b227d2016-06-04 15:11:10 +010020340 and the PROXY protocol is correctly used, or with a "accept-netscaler-cip"
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010020341 and the NetScaler Client IP insertion protocol is correctly used, then the
Bertrand Jacquin93b227d2016-06-04 15:11:10 +010020342 logs will reflect the forwarded connection's information.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020343
20344 - "client_port" is the TCP port of the client which initiated the connection.
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +010020345 If the connection was accepted on a UNIX socket instead, the port would be
20346 replaced with the ID of the accepting socket, which is also reported in the
20347 stats interface.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020348
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040020349 - "accept_date" is the exact date when the connection was received by HAProxy
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020350 (which might be very slightly different from the date observed on the
20351 network if there was some queuing in the system's backlog). This is usually
Willy Tarreau590a0512018-09-05 11:56:48 +020020352 the same date which may appear in any upstream firewall's log. When used in
20353 HTTP mode, the accept_date field will be reset to the first moment the
20354 connection is ready to receive a new request (end of previous response for
20355 HTTP/1, immediately after previous request for HTTP/2).
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020356
20357 - "frontend_name" is the name of the frontend (or listener) which received
20358 and processed the connection.
20359
20360 - "backend_name" is the name of the backend (or listener) which was selected
20361 to manage the connection to the server. This will be the same as the
20362 frontend if no switching rule has been applied, which is common for TCP
20363 applications.
20364
20365 - "server_name" is the name of the last server to which the connection was
20366 sent, which might differ from the first one if there were connection errors
20367 and a redispatch occurred. Note that this server belongs to the backend
20368 which processed the request. If the connection was aborted before reaching
20369 a server, "<NOSRV>" is indicated instead of a server name.
20370
20371 - "Tw" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting in the various queues.
20372 It can be "-1" if the connection was aborted before reaching the queue.
20373 See "Timers" below for more details.
20374
20375 - "Tc" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting for the connection to
20376 establish to the final server, including retries. It can be "-1" if the
20377 connection was aborted before a connection could be established. See
20378 "Timers" below for more details.
20379
20380 - "Tt" is the total time in milliseconds elapsed between the accept and the
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030020381 last close. It covers all possible processing. There is one exception, if
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020382 "option logasap" was specified, then the time counting stops at the moment
20383 the log is emitted. In this case, a '+' sign is prepended before the value,
20384 indicating that the final one will be larger. See "Timers" below for more
20385 details.
20386
20387 - "bytes_read" is the total number of bytes transmitted from the server to
20388 the client when the log is emitted. If "option logasap" is specified, the
20389 this value will be prefixed with a '+' sign indicating that the final one
20390 may be larger. Please note that this value is a 64-bit counter, so log
20391 analysis tools must be able to handle it without overflowing.
20392
20393 - "termination_state" is the condition the session was in when the session
20394 ended. This indicates the session state, which side caused the end of
20395 session to happen, and for what reason (timeout, error, ...). The normal
20396 flags should be "--", indicating the session was closed by either end with
20397 no data remaining in buffers. See below "Session state at disconnection"
20398 for more details.
20399
20400 - "actconn" is the total number of concurrent connections on the process when
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040020401 the session was logged. It is useful to detect when some per-process system
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020402 limits have been reached. For instance, if actconn is close to 512 when
20403 multiple connection errors occur, chances are high that the system limits
20404 the process to use a maximum of 1024 file descriptors and that all of them
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020020405 are used. See section 3 "Global parameters" to find how to tune the system.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020406
20407 - "feconn" is the total number of concurrent connections on the frontend when
20408 the session was logged. It is useful to estimate the amount of resource
20409 required to sustain high loads, and to detect when the frontend's "maxconn"
20410 has been reached. Most often when this value increases by huge jumps, it is
20411 because there is congestion on the backend servers, but sometimes it can be
20412 caused by a denial of service attack.
20413
20414 - "beconn" is the total number of concurrent connections handled by the
20415 backend when the session was logged. It includes the total number of
20416 concurrent connections active on servers as well as the number of
20417 connections pending in queues. It is useful to estimate the amount of
20418 additional servers needed to support high loads for a given application.
20419 Most often when this value increases by huge jumps, it is because there is
20420 congestion on the backend servers, but sometimes it can be caused by a
20421 denial of service attack.
20422
20423 - "srv_conn" is the total number of concurrent connections still active on
20424 the server when the session was logged. It can never exceed the server's
20425 configured "maxconn" parameter. If this value is very often close or equal
20426 to the server's "maxconn", it means that traffic regulation is involved a
20427 lot, meaning that either the server's maxconn value is too low, or that
20428 there aren't enough servers to process the load with an optimal response
20429 time. When only one of the server's "srv_conn" is high, it usually means
20430 that this server has some trouble causing the connections to take longer to
20431 be processed than on other servers.
20432
20433 - "retries" is the number of connection retries experienced by this session
20434 when trying to connect to the server. It must normally be zero, unless a
20435 server is being stopped at the same moment the connection was attempted.
20436 Frequent retries generally indicate either a network problem between
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040020437 HAProxy and the server, or a misconfigured system backlog on the server
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020438 preventing new connections from being queued. This field may optionally be
20439 prefixed with a '+' sign, indicating that the session has experienced a
20440 redispatch after the maximal retry count has been reached on the initial
20441 server. In this case, the server name appearing in the log is the one the
20442 connection was redispatched to, and not the first one, though both may
20443 sometimes be the same in case of hashing for instance. So as a general rule
20444 of thumb, when a '+' is present in front of the retry count, this count
20445 should not be attributed to the logged server.
20446
20447 - "srv_queue" is the total number of requests which were processed before
20448 this one in the server queue. It is zero when the request has not gone
20449 through the server queue. It makes it possible to estimate the approximate
20450 server's response time by dividing the time spent in queue by the number of
20451 requests in the queue. It is worth noting that if a session experiences a
20452 redispatch and passes through two server queues, their positions will be
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010020453 cumulative. A request should not pass through both the server queue and the
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020454 backend queue unless a redispatch occurs.
20455
20456 - "backend_queue" is the total number of requests which were processed before
20457 this one in the backend's global queue. It is zero when the request has not
20458 gone through the global queue. It makes it possible to estimate the average
20459 queue length, which easily translates into a number of missing servers when
20460 divided by a server's "maxconn" parameter. It is worth noting that if a
20461 session experiences a redispatch, it may pass twice in the backend's queue,
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010020462 and then both positions will be cumulative. A request should not pass
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020463 through both the server queue and the backend queue unless a redispatch
20464 occurs.
20465
20466
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200204678.2.3. HTTP log format
20468----------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020469
20470The HTTP format is the most complete and the best suited for HTTP proxies. It
20471is enabled by when "option httplog" is specified in the frontend. It provides
20472the same level of information as the TCP format with additional features which
20473are specific to the HTTP protocol. Just like the TCP format, the log is usually
20474emitted at the end of the session, unless "option logasap" is specified, which
20475generally only makes sense for download sites. A session which matches the
20476"monitor" rules will never logged. It is also possible not to log sessions for
20477which no data were sent by the client by specifying "option dontlognull" in the
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +020020478frontend. Successful connections will not be logged if "option dontlog-normal"
20479is specified in the frontend.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020480
20481Most fields are shared with the TCP log, some being different. A few fields may
20482slightly vary depending on some configuration options. Those ones are marked
20483with a star ('*') after the field name below.
20484
20485 Example :
20486 frontend http-in
20487 mode http
20488 option httplog
20489 log global
20490 default_backend bck
20491
20492 backend static
20493 server srv1 127.0.0.1:8000
20494
20495 >>> Feb 6 12:14:14 localhost \
20496 haproxy[14389]: 10.0.1.2:33317 [06/Feb/2009:12:14:14.655] http-in \
20497 static/srv1 10/0/30/69/109 200 2750 - - ---- 1/1/1/1/0 0/0 {1wt.eu} \
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010020498 {} "GET /index.html HTTP/1.1"
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020499
20500 Field Format Extract from the example above
20501 1 process_name '[' pid ']:' haproxy[14389]:
20502 2 client_ip ':' client_port 10.0.1.2:33317
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020020503 3 '[' request_date ']' [06/Feb/2009:12:14:14.655]
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020504 4 frontend_name http-in
20505 5 backend_name '/' server_name static/srv1
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020020506 6 TR '/' Tw '/' Tc '/' Tr '/' Ta* 10/0/30/69/109
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020507 7 status_code 200
20508 8 bytes_read* 2750
20509 9 captured_request_cookie -
20510 10 captured_response_cookie -
20511 11 termination_state ----
20512 12 actconn '/' feconn '/' beconn '/' srv_conn '/' retries* 1/1/1/1/0
20513 13 srv_queue '/' backend_queue 0/0
20514 14 '{' captured_request_headers* '}' {haproxy.1wt.eu}
20515 15 '{' captured_response_headers* '}' {}
20516 16 '"' http_request '"' "GET /index.html HTTP/1.1"
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010020517
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020518Detailed fields description :
20519 - "client_ip" is the IP address of the client which initiated the TCP
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040020520 connection to HAProxy. If the connection was accepted on a UNIX socket
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +010020521 instead, the IP address would be replaced with the word "unix". Note that
20522 when the connection is accepted on a socket configured with "accept-proxy"
Bertrand Jacquin93b227d2016-06-04 15:11:10 +010020523 and the PROXY protocol is correctly used, or with a "accept-netscaler-cip"
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010020524 and the NetScaler Client IP insertion protocol is correctly used, then the
Bertrand Jacquin93b227d2016-06-04 15:11:10 +010020525 logs will reflect the forwarded connection's information.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020526
20527 - "client_port" is the TCP port of the client which initiated the connection.
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +010020528 If the connection was accepted on a UNIX socket instead, the port would be
20529 replaced with the ID of the accepting socket, which is also reported in the
20530 stats interface.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020531
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020020532 - "request_date" is the exact date when the first byte of the HTTP request
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040020533 was received by HAProxy (log field %tr).
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020534
20535 - "frontend_name" is the name of the frontend (or listener) which received
20536 and processed the connection.
20537
20538 - "backend_name" is the name of the backend (or listener) which was selected
20539 to manage the connection to the server. This will be the same as the
20540 frontend if no switching rule has been applied.
20541
20542 - "server_name" is the name of the last server to which the connection was
20543 sent, which might differ from the first one if there were connection errors
20544 and a redispatch occurred. Note that this server belongs to the backend
20545 which processed the request. If the request was aborted before reaching a
20546 server, "<NOSRV>" is indicated instead of a server name. If the request was
20547 intercepted by the stats subsystem, "<STATS>" is indicated instead.
20548
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020020549 - "TR" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting for a full HTTP
20550 request from the client (not counting body) after the first byte was
20551 received. It can be "-1" if the connection was aborted before a complete
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050020552 request could be received or a bad request was received. It should
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020020553 always be very small because a request generally fits in one single packet.
20554 Large times here generally indicate network issues between the client and
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040020555 HAProxy or requests being typed by hand. See section 8.4 "Timing Events"
Willy Tarreau590a0512018-09-05 11:56:48 +020020556 for more details.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020557
20558 - "Tw" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting in the various queues.
20559 It can be "-1" if the connection was aborted before reaching the queue.
Willy Tarreau590a0512018-09-05 11:56:48 +020020560 See section 8.4 "Timing Events" for more details.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020561
20562 - "Tc" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting for the connection to
20563 establish to the final server, including retries. It can be "-1" if the
Willy Tarreau590a0512018-09-05 11:56:48 +020020564 request was aborted before a connection could be established. See section
20565 8.4 "Timing Events" for more details.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020566
20567 - "Tr" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting for the server to send
20568 a full HTTP response, not counting data. It can be "-1" if the request was
20569 aborted before a complete response could be received. It generally matches
20570 the server's processing time for the request, though it may be altered by
20571 the amount of data sent by the client to the server. Large times here on
Willy Tarreau590a0512018-09-05 11:56:48 +020020572 "GET" requests generally indicate an overloaded server. See section 8.4
20573 "Timing Events" for more details.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020574
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040020575 - "Ta" is the time the request remained active in HAProxy, which is the total
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020020576 time in milliseconds elapsed between the first byte of the request was
20577 received and the last byte of response was sent. It covers all possible
20578 processing except the handshake (see Th) and idle time (see Ti). There is
20579 one exception, if "option logasap" was specified, then the time counting
20580 stops at the moment the log is emitted. In this case, a '+' sign is
20581 prepended before the value, indicating that the final one will be larger.
Willy Tarreau590a0512018-09-05 11:56:48 +020020582 See section 8.4 "Timing Events" for more details.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020583
20584 - "status_code" is the HTTP status code returned to the client. This status
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040020585 is generally set by the server, but it might also be set by HAProxy when
20586 the server cannot be reached or when its response is blocked by HAProxy.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020587
20588 - "bytes_read" is the total number of bytes transmitted to the client when
20589 the log is emitted. This does include HTTP headers. If "option logasap" is
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050020590 specified, this value will be prefixed with a '+' sign indicating that
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020591 the final one may be larger. Please note that this value is a 64-bit
20592 counter, so log analysis tools must be able to handle it without
20593 overflowing.
20594
20595 - "captured_request_cookie" is an optional "name=value" entry indicating that
20596 the client had this cookie in the request. The cookie name and its maximum
20597 length are defined by the "capture cookie" statement in the frontend
20598 configuration. The field is a single dash ('-') when the option is not
20599 set. Only one cookie may be captured, it is generally used to track session
20600 ID exchanges between a client and a server to detect session crossing
20601 between clients due to application bugs. For more details, please consult
20602 the section "Capturing HTTP headers and cookies" below.
20603
20604 - "captured_response_cookie" is an optional "name=value" entry indicating
20605 that the server has returned a cookie with its response. The cookie name
20606 and its maximum length are defined by the "capture cookie" statement in the
20607 frontend configuration. The field is a single dash ('-') when the option is
20608 not set. Only one cookie may be captured, it is generally used to track
20609 session ID exchanges between a client and a server to detect session
20610 crossing between clients due to application bugs. For more details, please
20611 consult the section "Capturing HTTP headers and cookies" below.
20612
20613 - "termination_state" is the condition the session was in when the session
20614 ended. This indicates the session state, which side caused the end of
20615 session to happen, for what reason (timeout, error, ...), just like in TCP
20616 logs, and information about persistence operations on cookies in the last
20617 two characters. The normal flags should begin with "--", indicating the
20618 session was closed by either end with no data remaining in buffers. See
20619 below "Session state at disconnection" for more details.
20620
20621 - "actconn" is the total number of concurrent connections on the process when
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040020622 the session was logged. It is useful to detect when some per-process system
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020623 limits have been reached. For instance, if actconn is close to 512 or 1024
20624 when multiple connection errors occur, chances are high that the system
20625 limits the process to use a maximum of 1024 file descriptors and that all
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020020626 of them are used. See section 3 "Global parameters" to find how to tune the
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020627 system.
20628
20629 - "feconn" is the total number of concurrent connections on the frontend when
20630 the session was logged. It is useful to estimate the amount of resource
20631 required to sustain high loads, and to detect when the frontend's "maxconn"
20632 has been reached. Most often when this value increases by huge jumps, it is
20633 because there is congestion on the backend servers, but sometimes it can be
20634 caused by a denial of service attack.
20635
20636 - "beconn" is the total number of concurrent connections handled by the
20637 backend when the session was logged. It includes the total number of
20638 concurrent connections active on servers as well as the number of
20639 connections pending in queues. It is useful to estimate the amount of
20640 additional servers needed to support high loads for a given application.
20641 Most often when this value increases by huge jumps, it is because there is
20642 congestion on the backend servers, but sometimes it can be caused by a
20643 denial of service attack.
20644
20645 - "srv_conn" is the total number of concurrent connections still active on
20646 the server when the session was logged. It can never exceed the server's
20647 configured "maxconn" parameter. If this value is very often close or equal
20648 to the server's "maxconn", it means that traffic regulation is involved a
20649 lot, meaning that either the server's maxconn value is too low, or that
20650 there aren't enough servers to process the load with an optimal response
20651 time. When only one of the server's "srv_conn" is high, it usually means
20652 that this server has some trouble causing the requests to take longer to be
20653 processed than on other servers.
20654
20655 - "retries" is the number of connection retries experienced by this session
20656 when trying to connect to the server. It must normally be zero, unless a
20657 server is being stopped at the same moment the connection was attempted.
20658 Frequent retries generally indicate either a network problem between
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040020659 HAProxy and the server, or a misconfigured system backlog on the server
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020660 preventing new connections from being queued. This field may optionally be
20661 prefixed with a '+' sign, indicating that the session has experienced a
20662 redispatch after the maximal retry count has been reached on the initial
20663 server. In this case, the server name appearing in the log is the one the
20664 connection was redispatched to, and not the first one, though both may
20665 sometimes be the same in case of hashing for instance. So as a general rule
20666 of thumb, when a '+' is present in front of the retry count, this count
20667 should not be attributed to the logged server.
20668
20669 - "srv_queue" is the total number of requests which were processed before
20670 this one in the server queue. It is zero when the request has not gone
20671 through the server queue. It makes it possible to estimate the approximate
20672 server's response time by dividing the time spent in queue by the number of
20673 requests in the queue. It is worth noting that if a session experiences a
20674 redispatch and passes through two server queues, their positions will be
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010020675 cumulative. A request should not pass through both the server queue and the
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020676 backend queue unless a redispatch occurs.
20677
20678 - "backend_queue" is the total number of requests which were processed before
20679 this one in the backend's global queue. It is zero when the request has not
20680 gone through the global queue. It makes it possible to estimate the average
20681 queue length, which easily translates into a number of missing servers when
20682 divided by a server's "maxconn" parameter. It is worth noting that if a
20683 session experiences a redispatch, it may pass twice in the backend's queue,
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010020684 and then both positions will be cumulative. A request should not pass
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020685 through both the server queue and the backend queue unless a redispatch
20686 occurs.
20687
20688 - "captured_request_headers" is a list of headers captured in the request due
20689 to the presence of the "capture request header" statement in the frontend.
20690 Multiple headers can be captured, they will be delimited by a vertical bar
20691 ('|'). When no capture is enabled, the braces do not appear, causing a
20692 shift of remaining fields. It is important to note that this field may
20693 contain spaces, and that using it requires a smarter log parser than when
20694 it's not used. Please consult the section "Capturing HTTP headers and
20695 cookies" below for more details.
20696
20697 - "captured_response_headers" is a list of headers captured in the response
20698 due to the presence of the "capture response header" statement in the
20699 frontend. Multiple headers can be captured, they will be delimited by a
20700 vertical bar ('|'). When no capture is enabled, the braces do not appear,
20701 causing a shift of remaining fields. It is important to note that this
20702 field may contain spaces, and that using it requires a smarter log parser
20703 than when it's not used. Please consult the section "Capturing HTTP headers
20704 and cookies" below for more details.
20705
20706 - "http_request" is the complete HTTP request line, including the method,
20707 request and HTTP version string. Non-printable characters are encoded (see
20708 below the section "Non-printable characters"). This is always the last
20709 field, and it is always delimited by quotes and is the only one which can
20710 contain quotes. If new fields are added to the log format, they will be
20711 added before this field. This field might be truncated if the request is
20712 huge and does not fit in the standard syslog buffer (1024 characters). This
20713 is the reason why this field must always remain the last one.
20714
20715
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +0200207168.2.4. Custom log format
20717------------------------
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010020718
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010020719The directive log-format allows you to customize the logs in http mode and tcp
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010020720mode. It takes a string as argument.
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010020721
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010020722HAProxy understands some log format variables. % precedes log format variables.
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010020723Variables can take arguments using braces ('{}'), and multiple arguments are
20724separated by commas within the braces. Flags may be added or removed by
20725prefixing them with a '+' or '-' sign.
20726
20727Special variable "%o" may be used to propagate its flags to all other
20728variables on the same format string. This is particularly handy with quoted
Dragan Dosen835b9212016-02-12 13:23:03 +010020729("Q") and escaped ("E") string formats.
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010020730
Willy Tarreauc8368452012-12-21 00:09:23 +010020731If a variable is named between square brackets ('[' .. ']') then it is used
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +020020732as a sample expression rule (see section 7.3). This it useful to add some
Willy Tarreauc8368452012-12-21 00:09:23 +010020733less common information such as the client's SSL certificate's DN, or to log
20734the key that would be used to store an entry into a stick table.
20735
Dragan Dosen1e3b16f2020-06-23 18:16:44 +020020736Note: spaces must be escaped. In configuration directives "log-format",
20737"log-format-sd" and "unique-id-format", spaces are considered as
20738delimiters and are merged. In order to emit a verbatim '%', it must be
20739preceded by another '%' resulting in '%%'.
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010020740
Dragan Dosen835b9212016-02-12 13:23:03 +010020741Note: when using the RFC5424 syslog message format, the characters '"',
20742'\' and ']' inside PARAM-VALUE should be escaped with '\' as prefix (see
20743https://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc5424#section-6.3.3 for more details). In
20744such cases, the use of the flag "E" should be considered.
20745
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010020746Flags are :
20747 * Q: quote a string
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040020748 * X: hexadecimal representation (IPs, Ports, %Ts, %rt, %pid)
Dragan Dosen835b9212016-02-12 13:23:03 +010020749 * E: escape characters '"', '\' and ']' in a string with '\' as prefix
20750 (intended purpose is for the RFC5424 structured-data log formats)
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010020751
20752 Example:
20753
20754 log-format %T\ %t\ Some\ Text
20755 log-format %{+Q}o\ %t\ %s\ %{-Q}r
20756
Dragan Dosen835b9212016-02-12 13:23:03 +010020757 log-format-sd %{+Q,+E}o\ [exampleSDID@1234\ header=%[capture.req.hdr(0)]]
20758
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010020759At the moment, the default HTTP format is defined this way :
20760
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020020761 log-format "%ci:%cp [%tr] %ft %b/%s %TR/%Tw/%Tc/%Tr/%Ta %ST %B %CC \
20762 %CS %tsc %ac/%fc/%bc/%sc/%rc %sq/%bq %hr %hs %{+Q}r"
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010020763
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010020764the default CLF format is defined this way :
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010020765
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020020766 log-format "%{+Q}o %{-Q}ci - - [%trg] %r %ST %B \"\" \"\" %cp \
20767 %ms %ft %b %s %TR %Tw %Tc %Tr %Ta %tsc %ac %fc \
20768 %bc %sc %rc %sq %bq %CC %CS %hrl %hsl"
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010020769
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010020770and the default TCP format is defined this way :
20771
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020020772 log-format "%ci:%cp [%t] %ft %b/%s %Tw/%Tc/%Tt %B %ts \
20773 %ac/%fc/%bc/%sc/%rc %sq/%bq"
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010020774
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010020775Please refer to the table below for currently defined variables :
20776
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010020777 +---+------+-----------------------------------------------+-------------+
Willy Tarreauffc3fcd2012-10-12 20:17:54 +020020778 | R | var | field name (8.2.2 and 8.2.3 for description) | type |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010020779 +---+------+-----------------------------------------------+-------------+
20780 | | %o | special variable, apply flags on all next var | |
20781 +---+------+-----------------------------------------------+-------------+
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010020782 | | %B | bytes_read (from server to client) | numeric |
20783 | H | %CC | captured_request_cookie | string |
20784 | H | %CS | captured_response_cookie | string |
William Lallemand5f232402012-04-05 18:02:55 +020020785 | | %H | hostname | string |
Andrew Hayworth0ebc55f2015-04-27 21:37:03 +000020786 | H | %HM | HTTP method (ex: POST) | string |
Maciej Zdeb21acc332020-11-26 10:45:52 +000020787 | H | %HP | HTTP request URI without query string | string |
Maciej Zdebfcdfd852020-11-30 18:27:47 +000020788 | H | %HPO | HTTP path only (without host nor query string)| string |
Andrew Hayworthe63ac872015-07-31 16:14:16 +000020789 | H | %HQ | HTTP request URI query string (ex: ?bar=baz) | string |
Andrew Hayworth0ebc55f2015-04-27 21:37:03 +000020790 | H | %HU | HTTP request URI (ex: /foo?bar=baz) | string |
20791 | H | %HV | HTTP version (ex: HTTP/1.0) | string |
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010020792 | | %ID | unique-id | string |
Willy Tarreau4bf99632014-06-13 12:21:40 +020020793 | | %ST | status_code | numeric |
William Lallemand5f232402012-04-05 18:02:55 +020020794 | | %T | gmt_date_time | date |
Christopher Faulet3f177162021-12-03 10:48:36 +010020795 | H | %Ta | Active time of the request (from TR to end) | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010020796 | | %Tc | Tc | numeric |
Willy Tarreau27b639d2016-05-17 17:55:27 +020020797 | | %Td | Td = Tt - (Tq + Tw + Tc + Tr) | numeric |
Yuxans Yao4e25b012012-10-19 10:36:09 +080020798 | | %Tl | local_date_time | date |
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020020799 | | %Th | connection handshake time (SSL, PROXY proto) | numeric |
20800 | H | %Ti | idle time before the HTTP request | numeric |
20801 | H | %Tq | Th + Ti + TR | numeric |
20802 | H | %TR | time to receive the full request from 1st byte| numeric |
20803 | H | %Tr | Tr (response time) | numeric |
William Lallemand5f232402012-04-05 18:02:55 +020020804 | | %Ts | timestamp | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010020805 | | %Tt | Tt | numeric |
Damien Claisse57c8eb92020-04-28 12:09:19 +000020806 | | %Tu | Tu | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010020807 | | %Tw | Tw | numeric |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010020808 | | %U | bytes_uploaded (from client to server) | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010020809 | | %ac | actconn | numeric |
20810 | | %b | backend_name | string |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010020811 | | %bc | beconn (backend concurrent connections) | numeric |
20812 | | %bi | backend_source_ip (connecting address) | IP |
20813 | | %bp | backend_source_port (connecting address) | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010020814 | | %bq | backend_queue | numeric |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010020815 | | %ci | client_ip (accepted address) | IP |
20816 | | %cp | client_port (accepted address) | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010020817 | | %f | frontend_name | string |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010020818 | | %fc | feconn (frontend concurrent connections) | numeric |
20819 | | %fi | frontend_ip (accepting address) | IP |
20820 | | %fp | frontend_port (accepting address) | numeric |
Willy Tarreau773d65f2012-10-12 14:56:11 +020020821 | | %ft | frontend_name_transport ('~' suffix for SSL) | string |
Willy Tarreau7346acb2014-08-28 15:03:15 +020020822 | | %lc | frontend_log_counter | numeric |
Willy Tarreaud9ed3d22014-06-13 12:23:06 +020020823 | | %hr | captured_request_headers default style | string |
20824 | | %hrl | captured_request_headers CLF style | string list |
20825 | | %hs | captured_response_headers default style | string |
20826 | | %hsl | captured_response_headers CLF style | string list |
Willy Tarreau812c88e2015-08-09 10:56:35 +020020827 | | %ms | accept date milliseconds (left-padded with 0) | numeric |
William Lallemand5f232402012-04-05 18:02:55 +020020828 | | %pid | PID | numeric |
Willy Tarreauffc3fcd2012-10-12 20:17:54 +020020829 | H | %r | http_request | string |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010020830 | | %rc | retries | numeric |
Willy Tarreau1f0da242014-01-25 11:01:50 +010020831 | | %rt | request_counter (HTTP req or TCP session) | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010020832 | | %s | server_name | string |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010020833 | | %sc | srv_conn (server concurrent connections) | numeric |
20834 | | %si | server_IP (target address) | IP |
20835 | | %sp | server_port (target address) | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010020836 | | %sq | srv_queue | numeric |
Willy Tarreauffc3fcd2012-10-12 20:17:54 +020020837 | S | %sslc| ssl_ciphers (ex: AES-SHA) | string |
20838 | S | %sslv| ssl_version (ex: TLSv1) | string |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010020839 | | %t | date_time (with millisecond resolution) | date |
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020020840 | H | %tr | date_time of HTTP request | date |
20841 | H | %trg | gmt_date_time of start of HTTP request | date |
Jens Bissinger15c64ff2018-08-23 14:11:27 +020020842 | H | %trl | local_date_time of start of HTTP request | date |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010020843 | | %ts | termination_state | string |
Willy Tarreauffc3fcd2012-10-12 20:17:54 +020020844 | H | %tsc | termination_state with cookie status | string |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010020845 +---+------+-----------------------------------------------+-------------+
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010020846
Willy Tarreauffc3fcd2012-10-12 20:17:54 +020020847 R = Restrictions : H = mode http only ; S = SSL only
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010020848
Willy Tarreau5f51e1a2012-12-03 18:40:10 +010020849
208508.2.5. Error log format
20851-----------------------
20852
20853When an incoming connection fails due to an SSL handshake or an invalid PROXY
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040020854protocol header, HAProxy will log the event using a shorter, fixed line format.
Willy Tarreau5f51e1a2012-12-03 18:40:10 +010020855By default, logs are emitted at the LOG_INFO level, unless the option
20856"log-separate-errors" is set in the backend, in which case the LOG_ERR level
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010020857will be used. Connections on which no data are exchanged (e.g. probes) are not
Willy Tarreau5f51e1a2012-12-03 18:40:10 +010020858logged if the "dontlognull" option is set.
20859
20860The format looks like this :
20861
20862 >>> Dec 3 18:27:14 localhost \
20863 haproxy[6103]: 127.0.0.1:56059 [03/Dec/2012:17:35:10.380] frt/f1: \
20864 Connection error during SSL handshake
20865
20866 Field Format Extract from the example above
20867 1 process_name '[' pid ']:' haproxy[6103]:
20868 2 client_ip ':' client_port 127.0.0.1:56059
20869 3 '[' accept_date ']' [03/Dec/2012:17:35:10.380]
20870 4 frontend_name "/" bind_name ":" frt/f1:
20871 5 message Connection error during SSL handshake
20872
20873These fields just provide minimal information to help debugging connection
20874failures.
20875
20876
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200208778.3. Advanced logging options
20878-----------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020879
20880Some advanced logging options are often looked for but are not easy to find out
20881just by looking at the various options. Here is an entry point for the few
20882options which can enable better logging. Please refer to the keywords reference
20883for more information about their usage.
20884
20885
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200208868.3.1. Disabling logging of external tests
20887------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020888
20889It is quite common to have some monitoring tools perform health checks on
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040020890HAProxy. Sometimes it will be a layer 3 load-balancer such as LVS or any
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020891commercial load-balancer, and sometimes it will simply be a more complete
20892monitoring system such as Nagios. When the tests are very frequent, users often
20893ask how to disable logging for those checks. There are three possibilities :
20894
20895 - if connections come from everywhere and are just TCP probes, it is often
20896 desired to simply disable logging of connections without data exchange, by
20897 setting "option dontlognull" in the frontend. It also disables logging of
20898 port scans, which may or may not be desired.
20899
Willy Tarreau9e9919d2020-10-14 15:55:23 +020020900 - it is possible to use the "http-request set-log-level silent" action using
20901 a variety of conditions (source networks, paths, user-agents, etc).
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020902
20903 - if the tests are performed on a known URI, use "monitor-uri" to declare
20904 this URI as dedicated to monitoring. Any host sending this request will
20905 only get the result of a health-check, and the request will not be logged.
20906
20907
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200209088.3.2. Logging before waiting for the session to terminate
20909----------------------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020910
20911The problem with logging at end of connection is that you have no clue about
20912what is happening during very long sessions, such as remote terminal sessions
20913or large file downloads. This problem can be worked around by specifying
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010020914"option logasap" in the frontend. HAProxy will then log as soon as possible,
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020915just before data transfer begins. This means that in case of TCP, it will still
20916log the connection status to the server, and in case of HTTP, it will log just
20917after processing the server headers. In this case, the number of bytes reported
20918is the number of header bytes sent to the client. In order to avoid confusion
20919with normal logs, the total time field and the number of bytes are prefixed
20920with a '+' sign which means that real numbers are certainly larger.
20921
20922
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200209238.3.3. Raising log level upon errors
20924------------------------------------
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +020020925
20926Sometimes it is more convenient to separate normal traffic from errors logs,
20927for instance in order to ease error monitoring from log files. When the option
20928"log-separate-errors" is used, connections which experience errors, timeouts,
20929retries, redispatches or HTTP status codes 5xx will see their syslog level
20930raised from "info" to "err". This will help a syslog daemon store the log in
20931a separate file. It is very important to keep the errors in the normal traffic
20932file too, so that log ordering is not altered. You should also be careful if
20933you already have configured your syslog daemon to store all logs higher than
20934"notice" in an "admin" file, because the "err" level is higher than "notice".
20935
20936
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200209378.3.4. Disabling logging of successful connections
20938--------------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +020020939
20940Although this may sound strange at first, some large sites have to deal with
20941multiple thousands of logs per second and are experiencing difficulties keeping
20942them intact for a long time or detecting errors within them. If the option
20943"dontlog-normal" is set on the frontend, all normal connections will not be
20944logged. In this regard, a normal connection is defined as one without any
20945error, timeout, retry nor redispatch. In HTTP, the status code is checked too,
20946and a response with a status 5xx is not considered normal and will be logged
20947too. Of course, doing is is really discouraged as it will remove most of the
20948useful information from the logs. Do this only if you have no other
20949alternative.
20950
20951
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200209528.4. Timing events
20953------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020954
20955Timers provide a great help in troubleshooting network problems. All values are
20956reported in milliseconds (ms). These timers should be used in conjunction with
20957the session termination flags. In TCP mode with "option tcplog" set on the
20958frontend, 3 control points are reported under the form "Tw/Tc/Tt", and in HTTP
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020020959mode, 5 control points are reported under the form "TR/Tw/Tc/Tr/Ta". In
20960addition, three other measures are provided, "Th", "Ti", and "Tq".
20961
Guillaume de Lafondf27cddc2016-12-23 17:32:43 +010020962Timings events in HTTP mode:
20963
20964 first request 2nd request
20965 |<-------------------------------->|<-------------- ...
20966 t tr t tr ...
20967 ---|----|----|----|----|----|----|----|----|--
20968 : Th Ti TR Tw Tc Tr Td : Ti ...
20969 :<---- Tq ---->: :
20970 :<-------------- Tt -------------->:
Damien Claisse57c8eb92020-04-28 12:09:19 +000020971 :<-- -----Tu--------------->:
Guillaume de Lafondf27cddc2016-12-23 17:32:43 +010020972 :<--------- Ta --------->:
20973
20974Timings events in TCP mode:
20975
20976 TCP session
20977 |<----------------->|
20978 t t
20979 ---|----|----|----|----|---
20980 | Th Tw Tc Td |
20981 |<------ Tt ------->|
20982
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020020983 - Th: total time to accept tcp connection and execute handshakes for low level
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010020984 protocols. Currently, these protocols are proxy-protocol and SSL. This may
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020020985 only happen once during the whole connection's lifetime. A large time here
20986 may indicate that the client only pre-established the connection without
20987 speaking, that it is experiencing network issues preventing it from
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010020988 completing a handshake in a reasonable time (e.g. MTU issues), or that an
Willy Tarreau590a0512018-09-05 11:56:48 +020020989 SSL handshake was very expensive to compute. Please note that this time is
20990 reported only before the first request, so it is safe to average it over
20991 all request to calculate the amortized value. The second and subsequent
20992 request will always report zero here.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020993
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020020994 - Ti: is the idle time before the HTTP request (HTTP mode only). This timer
20995 counts between the end of the handshakes and the first byte of the HTTP
20996 request. When dealing with a second request in keep-alive mode, it starts
Willy Tarreau590a0512018-09-05 11:56:48 +020020997 to count after the end of the transmission the previous response. When a
20998 multiplexed protocol such as HTTP/2 is used, it starts to count immediately
20999 after the previous request. Some browsers pre-establish connections to a
21000 server in order to reduce the latency of a future request, and keep them
21001 pending until they need it. This delay will be reported as the idle time. A
21002 value of -1 indicates that nothing was received on the connection.
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020021003
21004 - TR: total time to get the client request (HTTP mode only). It's the time
21005 elapsed between the first bytes received and the moment the proxy received
21006 the empty line marking the end of the HTTP headers. The value "-1"
21007 indicates that the end of headers has never been seen. This happens when
21008 the client closes prematurely or times out. This time is usually very short
21009 since most requests fit in a single packet. A large time may indicate a
21010 request typed by hand during a test.
21011
21012 - Tq: total time to get the client request from the accept date or since the
21013 emission of the last byte of the previous response (HTTP mode only). It's
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010021014 exactly equal to Th + Ti + TR unless any of them is -1, in which case it
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020021015 returns -1 as well. This timer used to be very useful before the arrival of
21016 HTTP keep-alive and browsers' pre-connect feature. It's recommended to drop
21017 it in favor of TR nowadays, as the idle time adds a lot of noise to the
21018 reports.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021019
21020 - Tw: total time spent in the queues waiting for a connection slot. It
21021 accounts for backend queue as well as the server queues, and depends on the
21022 queue size, and the time needed for the server to complete previous
21023 requests. The value "-1" means that the request was killed before reaching
21024 the queue, which is generally what happens with invalid or denied requests.
21025
21026 - Tc: total time to establish the TCP connection to the server. It's the time
21027 elapsed between the moment the proxy sent the connection request, and the
21028 moment it was acknowledged by the server, or between the TCP SYN packet and
21029 the matching SYN/ACK packet in return. The value "-1" means that the
21030 connection never established.
21031
21032 - Tr: server response time (HTTP mode only). It's the time elapsed between
21033 the moment the TCP connection was established to the server and the moment
21034 the server sent its complete response headers. It purely shows its request
21035 processing time, without the network overhead due to the data transmission.
21036 It is worth noting that when the client has data to send to the server, for
21037 instance during a POST request, the time already runs, and this can distort
21038 apparent response time. For this reason, it's generally wise not to trust
21039 too much this field for POST requests initiated from clients behind an
21040 untrusted network. A value of "-1" here means that the last the response
21041 header (empty line) was never seen, most likely because the server timeout
21042 stroke before the server managed to process the request.
21043
William Lallemand90b82122023-07-25 09:06:51 +020021044 - Td: this is the total transfer time of the response payload till the last
21045 byte sent to the client. In HTTP it starts after the last response header
21046 (after Tr).
21047
21048 The data sent are not guaranteed to be received by the client, they can be
21049 stuck in either the kernel or the network.
21050
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020021051 - Ta: total active time for the HTTP request, between the moment the proxy
21052 received the first byte of the request header and the emission of the last
21053 byte of the response body. The exception is when the "logasap" option is
21054 specified. In this case, it only equals (TR+Tw+Tc+Tr), and is prefixed with
21055 a '+' sign. From this field, we can deduce "Td", the data transmission time,
21056 by subtracting other timers when valid :
21057
21058 Td = Ta - (TR + Tw + Tc + Tr)
21059
21060 Timers with "-1" values have to be excluded from this equation. Note that
21061 "Ta" can never be negative.
21062
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021063 - Tt: total session duration time, between the moment the proxy accepted it
21064 and the moment both ends were closed. The exception is when the "logasap"
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020021065 option is specified. In this case, it only equals (Th+Ti+TR+Tw+Tc+Tr), and
21066 is prefixed with a '+' sign. From this field, we can deduce "Td", the data
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030021067 transmission time, by subtracting other timers when valid :
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021068
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020021069 Td = Tt - (Th + Ti + TR + Tw + Tc + Tr)
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021070
21071 Timers with "-1" values have to be excluded from this equation. In TCP
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020021072 mode, "Ti", "Tq" and "Tr" have to be excluded too. Note that "Tt" can never
21073 be negative and that for HTTP, Tt is simply equal to (Th+Ti+Ta).
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021074
Damien Claisse57c8eb92020-04-28 12:09:19 +000021075 - Tu: total estimated time as seen from client, between the moment the proxy
21076 accepted it and the moment both ends were closed, without idle time.
21077 This is useful to roughly measure end-to-end time as a user would see it,
21078 without idle time pollution from keep-alive time between requests. This
21079 timer in only an estimation of time seen by user as it assumes network
21080 latency is the same in both directions. The exception is when the "logasap"
21081 option is specified. In this case, it only equals (Th+TR+Tw+Tc+Tr), and is
21082 prefixed with a '+' sign.
21083
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021084These timers provide precious indications on trouble causes. Since the TCP
21085protocol defines retransmit delays of 3, 6, 12... seconds, we know for sure
21086that timers close to multiples of 3s are nearly always related to lost packets
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020021087due to network problems (wires, negotiation, congestion). Moreover, if "Ta" or
21088"Tt" is close to a timeout value specified in the configuration, it often means
21089that a session has been aborted on timeout.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021090
21091Most common cases :
21092
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020021093 - If "Th" or "Ti" are close to 3000, a packet has probably been lost between
21094 the client and the proxy. This is very rare on local networks but might
21095 happen when clients are on far remote networks and send large requests. It
21096 may happen that values larger than usual appear here without any network
21097 cause. Sometimes, during an attack or just after a resource starvation has
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040021098 ended, HAProxy may accept thousands of connections in a few milliseconds.
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020021099 The time spent accepting these connections will inevitably slightly delay
21100 processing of other connections, and it can happen that request times in the
21101 order of a few tens of milliseconds are measured after a few thousands of
21102 new connections have been accepted at once. Using one of the keep-alive
21103 modes may display larger idle times since "Ti" measures the time spent
Patrick Mezard105faca2010-06-12 17:02:46 +020021104 waiting for additional requests.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021105
21106 - If "Tc" is close to 3000, a packet has probably been lost between the
21107 server and the proxy during the server connection phase. This value should
21108 always be very low, such as 1 ms on local networks and less than a few tens
21109 of ms on remote networks.
21110
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020021111 - If "Tr" is nearly always lower than 3000 except some rare values which seem
21112 to be the average majored by 3000, there are probably some packets lost
21113 between the proxy and the server.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021114
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020021115 - If "Ta" is large even for small byte counts, it generally is because
21116 neither the client nor the server decides to close the connection while
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040021117 HAProxy is running in tunnel mode and both have agreed on a keep-alive
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020021118 connection mode. In order to solve this issue, it will be needed to specify
21119 one of the HTTP options to manipulate keep-alive or close options on either
21120 the frontend or the backend. Having the smallest possible 'Ta' or 'Tt' is
21121 important when connection regulation is used with the "maxconn" option on
21122 the servers, since no new connection will be sent to the server until
21123 another one is released.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021124
21125Other noticeable HTTP log cases ('xx' means any value to be ignored) :
21126
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020021127 TR/Tw/Tc/Tr/+Ta The "option logasap" is present on the frontend and the log
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021128 was emitted before the data phase. All the timers are valid
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020021129 except "Ta" which is shorter than reality.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021130
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020021131 -1/xx/xx/xx/Ta The client was not able to send a complete request in time
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021132 or it aborted too early. Check the session termination flags
21133 then "timeout http-request" and "timeout client" settings.
21134
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020021135 TR/-1/xx/xx/Ta It was not possible to process the request, maybe because
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021136 servers were out of order, because the request was invalid
21137 or forbidden by ACL rules. Check the session termination
21138 flags.
21139
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020021140 TR/Tw/-1/xx/Ta The connection could not establish on the server. Either it
21141 actively refused it or it timed out after Ta-(TR+Tw) ms.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021142 Check the session termination flags, then check the
21143 "timeout connect" setting. Note that the tarpit action might
21144 return similar-looking patterns, with "Tw" equal to the time
21145 the client connection was maintained open.
21146
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020021147 TR/Tw/Tc/-1/Ta The server has accepted the connection but did not return
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030021148 a complete response in time, or it closed its connection
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020021149 unexpectedly after Ta-(TR+Tw+Tc) ms. Check the session
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021150 termination flags, then check the "timeout server" setting.
21151
21152
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200211538.5. Session state at disconnection
21154-----------------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021155
21156TCP and HTTP logs provide a session termination indicator in the
21157"termination_state" field, just before the number of active connections. It is
211582-characters long in TCP mode, and is extended to 4 characters in HTTP mode,
21159each of which has a special meaning :
21160
21161 - On the first character, a code reporting the first event which caused the
21162 session to terminate :
21163
21164 C : the TCP session was unexpectedly aborted by the client.
21165
21166 S : the TCP session was unexpectedly aborted by the server, or the
21167 server explicitly refused it.
21168
21169 P : the session was prematurely aborted by the proxy, because of a
21170 connection limit enforcement, because a DENY filter was matched,
21171 because of a security check which detected and blocked a dangerous
21172 error in server response which might have caused information leak
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010021173 (e.g. cacheable cookie).
Willy Tarreau570f2212013-06-10 16:42:09 +020021174
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040021175 L : the session was locally processed by HAProxy and was not passed to
Willy Tarreau570f2212013-06-10 16:42:09 +020021176 a server. This is what happens for stats and redirects.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021177
21178 R : a resource on the proxy has been exhausted (memory, sockets, source
21179 ports, ...). Usually, this appears during the connection phase, and
21180 system logs should contain a copy of the precise error. If this
21181 happens, it must be considered as a very serious anomaly which
21182 should be fixed as soon as possible by any means.
21183
21184 I : an internal error was identified by the proxy during a self-check.
21185 This should NEVER happen, and you are encouraged to report any log
21186 containing this, because this would almost certainly be a bug. It
21187 would be wise to preventively restart the process after such an
21188 event too, in case it would be caused by memory corruption.
21189
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040021190 D : the session was killed by HAProxy because the server was detected
Simon Horman752dc4a2011-06-21 14:34:59 +090021191 as down and was configured to kill all connections when going down.
21192
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040021193 U : the session was killed by HAProxy on this backup server because an
Justin Karnegeseb2c24a2012-05-24 15:28:52 -070021194 active server was detected as up and was configured to kill all
21195 backup connections when going up.
21196
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040021197 K : the session was actively killed by an admin operating on HAProxy.
Willy Tarreaua2a64e92011-09-07 23:01:56 +020021198
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021199 c : the client-side timeout expired while waiting for the client to
21200 send or receive data.
21201
21202 s : the server-side timeout expired while waiting for the server to
21203 send or receive data.
21204
21205 - : normal session completion, both the client and the server closed
21206 with nothing left in the buffers.
21207
21208 - on the second character, the TCP or HTTP session state when it was closed :
21209
Willy Tarreauf7b30a92010-12-06 22:59:17 +010021210 R : the proxy was waiting for a complete, valid REQUEST from the client
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021211 (HTTP mode only). Nothing was sent to any server.
21212
21213 Q : the proxy was waiting in the QUEUE for a connection slot. This can
21214 only happen when servers have a 'maxconn' parameter set. It can
21215 also happen in the global queue after a redispatch consecutive to
21216 a failed attempt to connect to a dying server. If no redispatch is
21217 reported, then no connection attempt was made to any server.
21218
21219 C : the proxy was waiting for the CONNECTION to establish on the
21220 server. The server might at most have noticed a connection attempt.
21221
21222 H : the proxy was waiting for complete, valid response HEADERS from the
21223 server (HTTP only).
21224
21225 D : the session was in the DATA phase.
21226
21227 L : the proxy was still transmitting LAST data to the client while the
21228 server had already finished. This one is very rare as it can only
21229 happen when the client dies while receiving the last packets.
21230
21231 T : the request was tarpitted. It has been held open with the client
21232 during the whole "timeout tarpit" duration or until the client
21233 closed, both of which will be reported in the "Tw" timer.
21234
21235 - : normal session completion after end of data transfer.
21236
21237 - the third character tells whether the persistence cookie was provided by
21238 the client (only in HTTP mode) :
21239
21240 N : the client provided NO cookie. This is usually the case for new
21241 visitors, so counting the number of occurrences of this flag in the
21242 logs generally indicate a valid trend for the site frequentation.
21243
21244 I : the client provided an INVALID cookie matching no known server.
21245 This might be caused by a recent configuration change, mixed
Cyril Bontéa8e7bbc2010-04-25 22:29:29 +020021246 cookies between HTTP/HTTPS sites, persistence conditionally
21247 ignored, or an attack.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021248
21249 D : the client provided a cookie designating a server which was DOWN,
21250 so either "option persist" was used and the client was sent to
21251 this server, or it was not set and the client was redispatched to
21252 another server.
21253
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020021254 V : the client provided a VALID cookie, and was sent to the associated
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021255 server.
21256
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020021257 E : the client provided a valid cookie, but with a last date which was
21258 older than what is allowed by the "maxidle" cookie parameter, so
21259 the cookie is consider EXPIRED and is ignored. The request will be
21260 redispatched just as if there was no cookie.
21261
21262 O : the client provided a valid cookie, but with a first date which was
21263 older than what is allowed by the "maxlife" cookie parameter, so
21264 the cookie is consider too OLD and is ignored. The request will be
21265 redispatched just as if there was no cookie.
21266
Willy Tarreauc89ccb62012-04-05 21:18:22 +020021267 U : a cookie was present but was not used to select the server because
21268 some other server selection mechanism was used instead (typically a
21269 "use-server" rule).
21270
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021271 - : does not apply (no cookie set in configuration).
21272
21273 - the last character reports what operations were performed on the persistence
21274 cookie returned by the server (only in HTTP mode) :
21275
21276 N : NO cookie was provided by the server, and none was inserted either.
21277
21278 I : no cookie was provided by the server, and the proxy INSERTED one.
21279 Note that in "cookie insert" mode, if the server provides a cookie,
21280 it will still be overwritten and reported as "I" here.
21281
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020021282 U : the proxy UPDATED the last date in the cookie that was presented by
21283 the client. This can only happen in insert mode with "maxidle". It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030021284 happens every time there is activity at a different date than the
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020021285 date indicated in the cookie. If any other change happens, such as
21286 a redispatch, then the cookie will be marked as inserted instead.
21287
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021288 P : a cookie was PROVIDED by the server and transmitted as-is.
21289
21290 R : the cookie provided by the server was REWRITTEN by the proxy, which
21291 happens in "cookie rewrite" or "cookie prefix" modes.
21292
21293 D : the cookie provided by the server was DELETED by the proxy.
21294
21295 - : does not apply (no cookie set in configuration).
21296
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020021297The combination of the two first flags gives a lot of information about what
21298was happening when the session terminated, and why it did terminate. It can be
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021299helpful to detect server saturation, network troubles, local system resource
21300starvation, attacks, etc...
21301
21302The most common termination flags combinations are indicated below. They are
21303alphabetically sorted, with the lowercase set just after the upper case for
21304easier finding and understanding.
21305
21306 Flags Reason
21307
21308 -- Normal termination.
21309
21310 CC The client aborted before the connection could be established to the
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040021311 server. This can happen when HAProxy tries to connect to a recently
21312 dead (or unchecked) server, and the client aborts while HAProxy is
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021313 waiting for the server to respond or for "timeout connect" to expire.
21314
21315 CD The client unexpectedly aborted during data transfer. This can be
21316 caused by a browser crash, by an intermediate equipment between the
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040021317 client and HAProxy which decided to actively break the connection,
21318 by network routing issues between the client and HAProxy, or by a
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021319 keep-alive session between the server and the client terminated first
21320 by the client.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010021321
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021322 cD The client did not send nor acknowledge any data for as long as the
21323 "timeout client" delay. This is often caused by network failures on
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +020021324 the client side, or the client simply leaving the net uncleanly.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021325
21326 CH The client aborted while waiting for the server to start responding.
21327 It might be the server taking too long to respond or the client
21328 clicking the 'Stop' button too fast.
21329
21330 cH The "timeout client" stroke while waiting for client data during a
21331 POST request. This is sometimes caused by too large TCP MSS values
21332 for PPPoE networks which cannot transport full-sized packets. It can
21333 also happen when client timeout is smaller than server timeout and
21334 the server takes too long to respond.
21335
21336 CQ The client aborted while its session was queued, waiting for a server
21337 with enough empty slots to accept it. It might be that either all the
21338 servers were saturated or that the assigned server was taking too
21339 long a time to respond.
21340
21341 CR The client aborted before sending a full HTTP request. Most likely
21342 the request was typed by hand using a telnet client, and aborted
21343 too early. The HTTP status code is likely a 400 here. Sometimes this
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040021344 might also be caused by an IDS killing the connection between HAProxy
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +020021345 and the client. "option http-ignore-probes" can be used to ignore
21346 connections without any data transfer.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021347
21348 cR The "timeout http-request" stroke before the client sent a full HTTP
21349 request. This is sometimes caused by too large TCP MSS values on the
21350 client side for PPPoE networks which cannot transport full-sized
21351 packets, or by clients sending requests by hand and not typing fast
21352 enough, or forgetting to enter the empty line at the end of the
Willy Tarreau2705a612014-05-23 17:38:34 +020021353 request. The HTTP status code is likely a 408 here. Note: recently,
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +020021354 some browsers started to implement a "pre-connect" feature consisting
21355 in speculatively connecting to some recently visited web sites just
21356 in case the user would like to visit them. This results in many
21357 connections being established to web sites, which end up in 408
21358 Request Timeout if the timeout strikes first, or 400 Bad Request when
21359 the browser decides to close them first. These ones pollute the log
21360 and feed the error counters. Some versions of some browsers have even
21361 been reported to display the error code. It is possible to work
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010021362 around the undesirable effects of this behavior by adding "option
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +020021363 http-ignore-probes" in the frontend, resulting in connections with
21364 zero data transfer to be totally ignored. This will definitely hide
21365 the errors of people experiencing connectivity issues though.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021366
21367 CT The client aborted while its session was tarpitted. It is important to
21368 check if this happens on valid requests, in order to be sure that no
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020021369 wrong tarpit rules have been written. If a lot of them happen, it
21370 might make sense to lower the "timeout tarpit" value to something
21371 closer to the average reported "Tw" timer, in order not to consume
21372 resources for just a few attackers.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021373
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040021374 LR The request was intercepted and locally handled by HAProxy. Generally
Willy Tarreau570f2212013-06-10 16:42:09 +020021375 it means that this was a redirect or a stats request.
21376
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040021377 SC The server or an equipment between it and HAProxy explicitly refused
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021378 the TCP connection (the proxy received a TCP RST or an ICMP message
21379 in return). Under some circumstances, it can also be the network
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010021380 stack telling the proxy that the server is unreachable (e.g. no route,
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021381 or no ARP response on local network). When this happens in HTTP mode,
21382 the status code is likely a 502 or 503 here.
21383
21384 sC The "timeout connect" stroke before a connection to the server could
21385 complete. When this happens in HTTP mode, the status code is likely a
21386 503 or 504 here.
21387
21388 SD The connection to the server died with an error during the data
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040021389 transfer. This usually means that HAProxy has received an RST from
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021390 the server or an ICMP message from an intermediate equipment while
21391 exchanging data with the server. This can be caused by a server crash
21392 or by a network issue on an intermediate equipment.
21393
21394 sD The server did not send nor acknowledge any data for as long as the
21395 "timeout server" setting during the data phase. This is often caused
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010021396 by too short timeouts on L4 equipment before the server (firewalls,
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021397 load-balancers, ...), as well as keep-alive sessions maintained
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040021398 between the client and the server expiring first on HAProxy.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021399
21400 SH The server aborted before sending its full HTTP response headers, or
21401 it crashed while processing the request. Since a server aborting at
21402 this moment is very rare, it would be wise to inspect its logs to
21403 control whether it crashed and why. The logged request may indicate a
21404 small set of faulty requests, demonstrating bugs in the application.
21405 Sometimes this might also be caused by an IDS killing the connection
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040021406 between HAProxy and the server.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021407
21408 sH The "timeout server" stroke before the server could return its
21409 response headers. This is the most common anomaly, indicating too
21410 long transactions, probably caused by server or database saturation.
21411 The immediate workaround consists in increasing the "timeout server"
21412 setting, but it is important to keep in mind that the user experience
21413 will suffer from these long response times. The only long term
21414 solution is to fix the application.
21415
21416 sQ The session spent too much time in queue and has been expired. See
21417 the "timeout queue" and "timeout connect" settings to find out how to
21418 fix this if it happens too often. If it often happens massively in
21419 short periods, it may indicate general problems on the affected
21420 servers due to I/O or database congestion, or saturation caused by
21421 external attacks.
21422
21423 PC The proxy refused to establish a connection to the server because the
Thayne McCombscdbcca92021-01-07 21:24:41 -070021424 process's socket limit has been reached while attempting to connect.
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +020021425 The global "maxconn" parameter may be increased in the configuration
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021426 so that it does not happen anymore. This status is very rare and
21427 might happen when the global "ulimit-n" parameter is forced by hand.
21428
Willy Tarreaued2fd2d2010-12-29 11:23:27 +010021429 PD The proxy blocked an incorrectly formatted chunked encoded message in
21430 a request or a response, after the server has emitted its headers. In
21431 most cases, this will indicate an invalid message from the server to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010021432 the client. HAProxy supports chunk sizes of up to 2GB - 1 (2147483647
Willy Tarreauf3a3e132013-08-31 08:16:26 +020021433 bytes). Any larger size will be considered as an error.
Willy Tarreaued2fd2d2010-12-29 11:23:27 +010021434
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021435 PH The proxy blocked the server's response, because it was invalid,
21436 incomplete, dangerous (cache control), or matched a security filter.
21437 In any case, an HTTP 502 error is sent to the client. One possible
21438 cause for this error is an invalid syntax in an HTTP header name
Willy Tarreaued2fd2d2010-12-29 11:23:27 +010021439 containing unauthorized characters. It is also possible but quite
21440 rare, that the proxy blocked a chunked-encoding request from the
21441 client due to an invalid syntax, before the server responded. In this
21442 case, an HTTP 400 error is sent to the client and reported in the
Christopher Fauletae72ae42022-05-05 12:27:07 +020021443 logs. Finally, it may be due to an HTTP header rewrite failure on the
21444 response. In this case, an HTTP 500 error is sent (see
21445 "tune.maxrewrite" and "http-response strict-mode" for more
21446 inforomation).
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021447
21448 PR The proxy blocked the client's HTTP request, either because of an
21449 invalid HTTP syntax, in which case it returned an HTTP 400 error to
21450 the client, or because a deny filter matched, in which case it
Christopher Fauletae72ae42022-05-05 12:27:07 +020021451 returned an HTTP 403 error. It may also be due to an HTTP header
21452 rewrite failure on the request. In this case, an HTTP 500 error is
21453 sent (see "tune.maxrewrite" and "http-request strict-mode" for more
21454 inforomation).
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021455
21456 PT The proxy blocked the client's request and has tarpitted its
21457 connection before returning it a 500 server error. Nothing was sent
21458 to the server. The connection was maintained open for as long as
21459 reported by the "Tw" timer field.
21460
21461 RC A local resource has been exhausted (memory, sockets, source ports)
21462 preventing the connection to the server from establishing. The error
21463 logs will tell precisely what was missing. This is very rare and can
21464 only be solved by proper system tuning.
21465
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020021466The combination of the two last flags gives a lot of information about how
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040021467persistence was handled by the client, the server and by HAProxy. This is very
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020021468important to troubleshoot disconnections, when users complain they have to
21469re-authenticate. The commonly encountered flags are :
21470
21471 -- Persistence cookie is not enabled.
21472
21473 NN No cookie was provided by the client, none was inserted in the
21474 response. For instance, this can be in insert mode with "postonly"
21475 set on a GET request.
21476
21477 II A cookie designating an invalid server was provided by the client,
21478 a valid one was inserted in the response. This typically happens when
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040021479 a "server" entry is removed from the configuration, since its cookie
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020021480 value can be presented by a client when no other server knows it.
21481
21482 NI No cookie was provided by the client, one was inserted in the
21483 response. This typically happens for first requests from every user
21484 in "insert" mode, which makes it an easy way to count real users.
21485
21486 VN A cookie was provided by the client, none was inserted in the
21487 response. This happens for most responses for which the client has
21488 already got a cookie.
21489
21490 VU A cookie was provided by the client, with a last visit date which is
21491 not completely up-to-date, so an updated cookie was provided in
21492 response. This can also happen if there was no date at all, or if
21493 there was a date but the "maxidle" parameter was not set, so that the
21494 cookie can be switched to unlimited time.
21495
21496 EI A cookie was provided by the client, with a last visit date which is
21497 too old for the "maxidle" parameter, so the cookie was ignored and a
21498 new cookie was inserted in the response.
21499
21500 OI A cookie was provided by the client, with a first visit date which is
21501 too old for the "maxlife" parameter, so the cookie was ignored and a
21502 new cookie was inserted in the response.
21503
21504 DI The server designated by the cookie was down, a new server was
21505 selected and a new cookie was emitted in the response.
21506
21507 VI The server designated by the cookie was not marked dead but could not
21508 be reached. A redispatch happened and selected another one, which was
21509 then advertised in the response.
21510
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021511
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200215128.6. Non-printable characters
21513-----------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021514
21515In order not to cause trouble to log analysis tools or terminals during log
21516consulting, non-printable characters are not sent as-is into log files, but are
21517converted to the two-digits hexadecimal representation of their ASCII code,
21518prefixed by the character '#'. The only characters that can be logged without
21519being escaped are comprised between 32 and 126 (inclusive). Obviously, the
21520escape character '#' itself is also encoded to avoid any ambiguity ("#23"). It
21521is the same for the character '"' which becomes "#22", as well as '{', '|' and
21522'}' when logging headers.
21523
21524Note that the space character (' ') is not encoded in headers, which can cause
21525issues for tools relying on space count to locate fields. A typical header
21526containing spaces is "User-Agent".
21527
21528Last, it has been observed that some syslog daemons such as syslog-ng escape
21529the quote ('"') with a backslash ('\'). The reverse operation can safely be
21530performed since no quote may appear anywhere else in the logs.
21531
21532
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200215338.7. Capturing HTTP cookies
21534---------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021535
21536Cookie capture simplifies the tracking a complete user session. This can be
21537achieved using the "capture cookie" statement in the frontend. Please refer to
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020021538section 4.2 for more details. Only one cookie can be captured, and the same
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021539cookie will simultaneously be checked in the request ("Cookie:" header) and in
21540the response ("Set-Cookie:" header). The respective values will be reported in
21541the HTTP logs at the "captured_request_cookie" and "captured_response_cookie"
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020021542locations (see section 8.2.3 about HTTP log format). When either cookie is
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021543not seen, a dash ('-') replaces the value. This way, it's easy to detect when a
21544user switches to a new session for example, because the server will reassign it
21545a new cookie. It is also possible to detect if a server unexpectedly sets a
21546wrong cookie to a client, leading to session crossing.
21547
21548 Examples :
21549 # capture the first cookie whose name starts with "ASPSESSION"
21550 capture cookie ASPSESSION len 32
21551
21552 # capture the first cookie whose name is exactly "vgnvisitor"
21553 capture cookie vgnvisitor= len 32
21554
21555
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200215568.8. Capturing HTTP headers
21557---------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021558
21559Header captures are useful to track unique request identifiers set by an upper
21560proxy, virtual host names, user-agents, POST content-length, referrers, etc. In
21561the response, one can search for information about the response length, how the
21562server asked the cache to behave, or an object location during a redirection.
21563
21564Header captures are performed using the "capture request header" and "capture
21565response header" statements in the frontend. Please consult their definition in
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020021566section 4.2 for more details.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021567
21568It is possible to include both request headers and response headers at the same
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010021569time. Non-existent headers are logged as empty strings, and if one header
21570appears more than once, only its last occurrence will be logged. Request headers
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021571are grouped within braces '{' and '}' in the same order as they were declared,
21572and delimited with a vertical bar '|' without any space. Response headers
21573follow the same representation, but are displayed after a space following the
21574request headers block. These blocks are displayed just before the HTTP request
21575in the logs.
21576
Willy Tarreaud9ed3d22014-06-13 12:23:06 +020021577As a special case, it is possible to specify an HTTP header capture in a TCP
21578frontend. The purpose is to enable logging of headers which will be parsed in
21579an HTTP backend if the request is then switched to this HTTP backend.
21580
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021581 Example :
21582 # This instance chains to the outgoing proxy
21583 listen proxy-out
21584 mode http
21585 option httplog
21586 option logasap
21587 log global
21588 server cache1 192.168.1.1:3128
21589
21590 # log the name of the virtual server
21591 capture request header Host len 20
21592
21593 # log the amount of data uploaded during a POST
21594 capture request header Content-Length len 10
21595
21596 # log the beginning of the referrer
21597 capture request header Referer len 20
21598
21599 # server name (useful for outgoing proxies only)
21600 capture response header Server len 20
21601
21602 # logging the content-length is useful with "option logasap"
21603 capture response header Content-Length len 10
21604
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010021605 # log the expected cache behavior on the response
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021606 capture response header Cache-Control len 8
21607
21608 # the Via header will report the next proxy's name
21609 capture response header Via len 20
21610
21611 # log the URL location during a redirection
21612 capture response header Location len 20
21613
21614 >>> Aug 9 20:26:09 localhost \
21615 haproxy[2022]: 127.0.0.1:34014 [09/Aug/2004:20:26:09] proxy-out \
21616 proxy-out/cache1 0/0/0/162/+162 200 +350 - - ---- 0/0/0/0/0 0/0 \
21617 {fr.adserver.yahoo.co||http://fr.f416.mail.} {|864|private||} \
21618 "GET http://fr.adserver.yahoo.com/"
21619
21620 >>> Aug 9 20:30:46 localhost \
21621 haproxy[2022]: 127.0.0.1:34020 [09/Aug/2004:20:30:46] proxy-out \
21622 proxy-out/cache1 0/0/0/182/+182 200 +279 - - ---- 0/0/0/0/0 0/0 \
21623 {w.ods.org||} {Formilux/0.1.8|3495|||} \
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010021624 "GET http://trafic.1wt.eu/ HTTP/1.1"
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021625
21626 >>> Aug 9 20:30:46 localhost \
21627 haproxy[2022]: 127.0.0.1:34028 [09/Aug/2004:20:30:46] proxy-out \
21628 proxy-out/cache1 0/0/2/126/+128 301 +223 - - ---- 0/0/0/0/0 0/0 \
21629 {www.sytadin.equipement.gouv.fr||http://trafic.1wt.eu/} \
21630 {Apache|230|||http://www.sytadin.} \
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010021631 "GET http://www.sytadin.equipement.gouv.fr/ HTTP/1.1"
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021632
21633
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200216348.9. Examples of logs
21635---------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021636
21637These are real-world examples of logs accompanied with an explanation. Some of
21638them have been made up by hand. The syslog part has been removed for better
21639reading. Their sole purpose is to explain how to decipher them.
21640
21641 >>> haproxy[674]: 127.0.0.1:33318 [15/Oct/2003:08:31:57.130] px-http \
21642 px-http/srv1 6559/0/7/147/6723 200 243 - - ---- 5/3/3/1/0 0/0 \
21643 "HEAD / HTTP/1.0"
21644
21645 => long request (6.5s) entered by hand through 'telnet'. The server replied
21646 in 147 ms, and the session ended normally ('----')
21647
21648 >>> haproxy[674]: 127.0.0.1:33319 [15/Oct/2003:08:31:57.149] px-http \
21649 px-http/srv1 6559/1230/7/147/6870 200 243 - - ---- 324/239/239/99/0 \
21650 0/9 "HEAD / HTTP/1.0"
21651
21652 => Idem, but the request was queued in the global queue behind 9 other
21653 requests, and waited there for 1230 ms.
21654
21655 >>> haproxy[674]: 127.0.0.1:33320 [15/Oct/2003:08:32:17.654] px-http \
21656 px-http/srv1 9/0/7/14/+30 200 +243 - - ---- 3/3/3/1/0 0/0 \
21657 "GET /image.iso HTTP/1.0"
21658
21659 => request for a long data transfer. The "logasap" option was specified, so
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010021660 the log was produced just before transferring data. The server replied in
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021661 14 ms, 243 bytes of headers were sent to the client, and total time from
21662 accept to first data byte is 30 ms.
21663
21664 >>> haproxy[674]: 127.0.0.1:33320 [15/Oct/2003:08:32:17.925] px-http \
21665 px-http/srv1 9/0/7/14/30 502 243 - - PH-- 3/2/2/0/0 0/0 \
21666 "GET /cgi-bin/bug.cgi? HTTP/1.0"
21667
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +020021668 => the proxy blocked a server response either because of an "http-response
21669 deny" rule, or because the response was improperly formatted and not
21670 HTTP-compliant, or because it blocked sensitive information which risked
21671 being cached. In this case, the response is replaced with a "502 bad
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040021672 gateway". The flags ("PH--") tell us that it was HAProxy who decided to
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +020021673 return the 502 and not the server.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021674
21675 >>> haproxy[18113]: 127.0.0.1:34548 [15/Oct/2003:15:18:55.798] px-http \
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010021676 px-http/<NOSRV> -1/-1/-1/-1/8490 -1 0 - - CR-- 2/2/2/0/0 0/0 ""
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021677
21678 => the client never completed its request and aborted itself ("C---") after
21679 8.5s, while the proxy was waiting for the request headers ("-R--").
21680 Nothing was sent to any server.
21681
21682 >>> haproxy[18113]: 127.0.0.1:34549 [15/Oct/2003:15:19:06.103] px-http \
21683 px-http/<NOSRV> -1/-1/-1/-1/50001 408 0 - - cR-- 2/2/2/0/0 0/0 ""
21684
21685 => The client never completed its request, which was aborted by the
21686 time-out ("c---") after 50s, while the proxy was waiting for the request
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010021687 headers ("-R--"). Nothing was sent to any server, but the proxy could
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021688 send a 408 return code to the client.
21689
21690 >>> haproxy[18989]: 127.0.0.1:34550 [15/Oct/2003:15:24:28.312] px-tcp \
21691 px-tcp/srv1 0/0/5007 0 cD 0/0/0/0/0 0/0
21692
21693 => This log was produced with "option tcplog". The client timed out after
21694 5 seconds ("c----").
21695
21696 >>> haproxy[18989]: 10.0.0.1:34552 [15/Oct/2003:15:26:31.462] px-http \
21697 px-http/srv1 3183/-1/-1/-1/11215 503 0 - - SC-- 205/202/202/115/3 \
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010021698 0/0 "HEAD / HTTP/1.0"
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021699
21700 => The request took 3s to complete (probably a network problem), and the
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020021701 connection to the server failed ('SC--') after 4 attempts of 2 seconds
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021702 (config says 'retries 3'), and no redispatch (otherwise we would have
21703 seen "/+3"). Status code 503 was returned to the client. There were 115
21704 connections on this server, 202 connections on this proxy, and 205 on
21705 the global process. It is possible that the server refused the
21706 connection because of too many already established.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010021707
Willy Tarreau52b2d222011-09-07 23:48:48 +020021708
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +0200217099. Supported filters
21710--------------------
21711
21712Here are listed officially supported filters with the list of parameters they
21713accept. Depending on compile options, some of these filters might be
21714unavailable. The list of available filters is reported in haproxy -vv.
21715
21716See also : "filter"
21717
217189.1. Trace
21719----------
21720
Christopher Fauletc41d8bd2020-11-17 10:43:26 +010021721filter trace [name <name>] [random-forwarding] [hexdump]
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +020021722
21723 Arguments:
21724 <name> is an arbitrary name that will be reported in
21725 messages. If no name is provided, "TRACE" is used.
21726
Christopher Faulet96a577a2020-11-17 10:45:05 +010021727 <quiet> inhibits trace messages.
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +020021728
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010021729 <random-forwarding> enables the random forwarding of parsed data. By
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +020021730 default, this filter forwards all previously parsed
21731 data. With this parameter, it only forwards a random
21732 amount of the parsed data.
21733
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010021734 <hexdump> dumps all forwarded data to the server and the client.
Christopher Faulet31bfe1f2016-12-09 17:42:38 +010021735
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +020021736This filter can be used as a base to develop new filters. It defines all
21737callbacks and print a message on the standard error stream (stderr) with useful
21738information for all of them. It may be useful to debug the activity of other
21739filters or, quite simply, HAProxy's activity.
21740
21741Using <random-parsing> and/or <random-forwarding> parameters is a good way to
21742tests the behavior of a filter that parses data exchanged between a client and
21743a server by adding some latencies in the processing.
21744
21745
217469.2. HTTP compression
21747---------------------
21748
21749filter compression
21750
21751The HTTP compression has been moved in a filter in HAProxy 1.7. "compression"
21752keyword must still be used to enable and configure the HTTP compression. And
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +020021753when no other filter is used, it is enough. When used with the cache or the
21754fcgi-app enabled, it is also enough. In this case, the compression is always
21755done after the response is stored in the cache. But it is mandatory to
21756explicitly use a filter line to enable the HTTP compression when at least one
21757filter other than the cache or the fcgi-app is used for the same
21758listener/frontend/backend. This is important to know the filters evaluation
21759order.
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +020021760
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +020021761See also : "compression", section 9.4 about the cache filter and section 9.5
21762 about the fcgi-app filter.
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +020021763
21764
Christopher Fauletf7e4e7e2016-10-27 22:29:49 +0200217659.3. Stream Processing Offload Engine (SPOE)
21766--------------------------------------------
21767
21768filter spoe [engine <name>] config <file>
21769
21770 Arguments :
21771
21772 <name> is the engine name that will be used to find the right scope in
21773 the configuration file. If not provided, all the file will be
21774 parsed.
21775
21776 <file> is the path of the engine configuration file. This file can
21777 contain configuration of several engines. In this case, each
21778 part must be placed in its own scope.
21779
21780The Stream Processing Offload Engine (SPOE) is a filter communicating with
21781external components. It allows the offload of some specifics processing on the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010021782streams in tiered applications. These external components and information
Christopher Fauletf7e4e7e2016-10-27 22:29:49 +020021783exchanged with them are configured in dedicated files, for the main part. It
21784also requires dedicated backends, defined in HAProxy configuration.
21785
21786SPOE communicates with external components using an in-house binary protocol,
21787the Stream Processing Offload Protocol (SPOP).
21788
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +010021789For all information about the SPOE configuration and the SPOP specification, see
Christopher Fauletf7e4e7e2016-10-27 22:29:49 +020021790"doc/SPOE.txt".
21791
Christopher Faulet99a17a22018-12-11 09:18:27 +0100217929.4. Cache
21793----------
21794
21795filter cache <name>
21796
21797 Arguments :
21798
21799 <name> is name of the cache section this filter will use.
21800
21801The cache uses a filter to store cacheable responses. The HTTP rules
21802"cache-store" and "cache-use" must be used to define how and when to use a
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050021803cache. By default the corresponding filter is implicitly defined. And when no
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +020021804other filters than fcgi-app or compression are used, it is enough. In such
21805case, the compression filter is always evaluated after the cache filter. But it
21806is mandatory to explicitly use a filter line to use a cache when at least one
21807filter other than the compression or the fcgi-app is used for the same
Christopher Faulet27d93c32018-12-15 22:32:02 +010021808listener/frontend/backend. This is important to know the filters evaluation
21809order.
Christopher Faulet99a17a22018-12-11 09:18:27 +010021810
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +020021811See also : section 9.2 about the compression filter, section 9.5 about the
21812 fcgi-app filter and section 6 about cache.
21813
21814
218159.5. Fcgi-app
21816-------------
21817
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -040021818filter fcgi-app <name>
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +020021819
21820 Arguments :
21821
21822 <name> is name of the fcgi-app section this filter will use.
21823
21824The FastCGI application uses a filter to evaluate all custom parameters on the
21825request path, and to process the headers on the response path. the <name> must
21826reference an existing fcgi-app section. The directive "use-fcgi-app" should be
21827used to define the application to use. By default the corresponding filter is
21828implicitly defined. And when no other filters than cache or compression are
21829used, it is enough. But it is mandatory to explicitly use a filter line to a
21830fcgi-app when at least one filter other than the compression or the cache is
21831used for the same backend. This is important to know the filters evaluation
21832order.
21833
21834See also: "use-fcgi-app", section 9.2 about the compression filter, section 9.4
21835 about the cache filter and section 10 about FastCGI application.
21836
21837
Miroslav Zagoracdc32cd92020-12-13 18:32:57 +0100218389.6. OpenTracing
21839----------------
21840
21841The OpenTracing filter adds native support for using distributed tracing in
21842HAProxy. This is enabled by sending an OpenTracing compliant request to one
21843of the supported tracers such as Datadog, Jaeger, Lightstep and Zipkin tracers.
21844Please note: tracers are not listed by any preference, but alphabetically.
21845
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040021846This feature is only enabled when HAProxy was built with USE_OT=1.
Miroslav Zagoracdc32cd92020-12-13 18:32:57 +010021847
21848The OpenTracing filter activation is done explicitly by specifying it in the
21849HAProxy configuration. If this is not done, the OpenTracing filter in no way
21850participates in the work of HAProxy.
21851
21852filter opentracing [id <id>] config <file>
21853
21854 Arguments :
21855
21856 <id> is the OpenTracing filter id that will be used to find the
21857 right scope in the configuration file. If no filter id is
21858 specified, 'ot-filter' is used as default. If scope is not
21859 specified in the configuration file, it applies to all defined
21860 OpenTracing filters.
21861
21862 <file> is the path of the OpenTracing configuration file. The same
21863 file can contain configurations for multiple OpenTracing
21864 filters simultaneously. In that case we do not need to define
21865 scope so the same configuration applies to all filters or each
21866 filter must have its own scope defined.
21867
21868More detailed documentation related to the operation, configuration and use
Willy Tarreaua63d1a02021-04-02 17:16:46 +020021869of the filter can be found in the addons/ot directory.
Miroslav Zagoracdc32cd92020-12-13 18:32:57 +010021870
21871
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +02002187210. FastCGI applications
21873-------------------------
21874
21875HAProxy is able to send HTTP requests to Responder FastCGI applications. This
21876feature was added in HAProxy 2.1. To do so, servers must be configured to use
21877the FastCGI protocol (using the keyword "proto fcgi" on the server line) and a
21878FastCGI application must be configured and used by the backend managing these
21879servers (using the keyword "use-fcgi-app" into the proxy section). Several
21880FastCGI applications may be defined, but only one can be used at a time by a
21881backend.
21882
21883HAProxy implements all features of the FastCGI specification for Responder
21884application. Especially it is able to multiplex several requests on a simple
21885connection.
21886
2188710.1. Setup
21888-----------
21889
2189010.1.1. Fcgi-app section
21891--------------------------
21892
21893fcgi-app <name>
21894 Declare a FastCGI application named <name>. To be valid, at least the
21895 document root must be defined.
21896
21897acl <aclname> <criterion> [flags] [operator] <value> ...
21898 Declare or complete an access list.
21899
21900 See "acl" keyword in section 4.2 and section 7 about ACL usage for
21901 details. ACLs defined for a FastCGI application are private. They cannot be
21902 used by any other application or by any proxy. In the same way, ACLs defined
21903 in any other section are not usable by a FastCGI application. However,
21904 Pre-defined ACLs are available.
21905
21906docroot <path>
21907 Define the document root on the remote host. <path> will be used to build
21908 the default value of FastCGI parameters SCRIPT_FILENAME and
21909 PATH_TRANSLATED. It is a mandatory setting.
21910
21911index <script-name>
21912 Define the script name that will be appended after an URI that ends with a
21913 slash ("/") to set the default value of the FastCGI parameter SCRIPT_NAME. It
21914 is an optional setting.
21915
21916 Example :
21917 index index.php
21918
21919log-stderr global
21920log-stderr <address> [len <length>] [format <format>]
Jan Wagner3e678602020-12-17 22:22:32 +010021921 [sample <ranges>:<sample_size>] <facility> [<level> [<minlevel>]]
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +020021922 Enable logging of STDERR messages reported by the FastCGI application.
21923
21924 See "log" keyword in section 4.2 for details. It is an optional setting. By
21925 default STDERR messages are ignored.
21926
21927pass-header <name> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
21928 Specify the name of a request header which will be passed to the FastCGI
21929 application. It may optionally be followed by an ACL-based condition, in
21930 which case it will only be evaluated if the condition is true.
21931
21932 Most request headers are already available to the FastCGI application,
21933 prefixed with "HTTP_". Thus, this directive is only required to pass headers
21934 that are purposefully omitted. Currently, the headers "Authorization",
21935 "Proxy-Authorization" and hop-by-hop headers are omitted.
21936
21937 Note that the headers "Content-type" and "Content-length" are never passed to
21938 the FastCGI application because they are already converted into parameters.
21939
21940path-info <regex>
Christopher Faulet28cb3662020-02-14 14:47:37 +010021941 Define a regular expression to extract the script-name and the path-info from
Christopher Faulet6c57f2d2020-02-14 16:55:52 +010021942 the URL-decoded path. Thus, <regex> may have two captures: the first one to
21943 capture the script name and the second one to capture the path-info. The
21944 first one is mandatory, the second one is optional. This way, it is possible
21945 to extract the script-name from the path ignoring the path-info. It is an
21946 optional setting. If it is not defined, no matching is performed on the
21947 path. and the FastCGI parameters PATH_INFO and PATH_TRANSLATED are not
21948 filled.
Christopher Faulet28cb3662020-02-14 14:47:37 +010021949
21950 For security reason, when this regular expression is defined, the newline and
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +050021951 the null characters are forbidden from the path, once URL-decoded. The reason
Christopher Faulet28cb3662020-02-14 14:47:37 +010021952 to such limitation is because otherwise the matching always fails (due to a
21953 limitation one the way regular expression are executed in HAProxy). So if one
21954 of these two characters is found in the URL-decoded path, an error is
21955 returned to the client. The principle of least astonishment is applied here.
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +020021956
21957 Example :
Christopher Faulet6c57f2d2020-02-14 16:55:52 +010021958 path-info ^(/.+\.php)(/.*)?$ # both script-name and path-info may be set
21959 path-info ^(/.+\.php) # the path-info is ignored
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +020021960
21961option get-values
21962no option get-values
21963 Enable or disable the retrieve of variables about connection management.
21964
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -040021965 HAProxy is able to send the record FCGI_GET_VALUES on connection
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +020021966 establishment to retrieve the value for following variables:
21967
21968 * FCGI_MAX_REQS The maximum number of concurrent requests this
21969 application will accept.
21970
William Lallemand93e548e2019-09-30 13:54:02 +020021971 * FCGI_MPXS_CONNS "0" if this application does not multiplex connections,
21972 "1" otherwise.
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +020021973
21974 Some FastCGI applications does not support this feature. Some others close
Ilya Shipitsin11057a32020-06-21 21:18:27 +050021975 the connection immediately after sending their response. So, by default, this
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +020021976 option is disabled.
21977
21978 Note that the maximum number of concurrent requests accepted by a FastCGI
21979 application is a connection variable. It only limits the number of streams
21980 per connection. If the global load must be limited on the application, the
21981 server parameters "maxconn" and "pool-max-conn" must be set. In addition, if
21982 an application does not support connection multiplexing, the maximum number
21983 of concurrent requests is automatically set to 1.
21984
21985option keep-conn
21986no option keep-conn
21987 Instruct the FastCGI application to keep the connection open or not after
21988 sending a response.
21989
21990 If disabled, the FastCGI application closes the connection after responding
21991 to this request. By default, this option is enabled.
21992
21993option max-reqs <reqs>
21994 Define the maximum number of concurrent requests this application will
21995 accept.
21996
21997 This option may be overwritten if the variable FCGI_MAX_REQS is retrieved
21998 during connection establishment. Furthermore, if the application does not
21999 support connection multiplexing, this option will be ignored. By default set
22000 to 1.
22001
22002option mpxs-conns
22003no option mpxs-conns
22004 Enable or disable the support of connection multiplexing.
22005
22006 This option may be overwritten if the variable FCGI_MPXS_CONNS is retrieved
22007 during connection establishment. It is disabled by default.
22008
22009set-param <name> <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
22010 Set a FastCGI parameter that should be passed to this application. Its
22011 value, defined by <fmt> must follows the log-format rules (see section 8.2.4
22012 "Custom Log format"). It may optionally be followed by an ACL-based
22013 condition, in which case it will only be evaluated if the condition is true.
22014
22015 With this directive, it is possible to overwrite the value of default FastCGI
22016 parameters. If the value is evaluated to an empty string, the rule is
22017 ignored. These directives are evaluated in their declaration order.
22018
22019 Example :
22020 # PHP only, required if PHP was built with --enable-force-cgi-redirect
22021 set-param REDIRECT_STATUS 200
22022
22023 set-param PHP_AUTH_DIGEST %[req.hdr(Authorization)]
22024
22025
2202610.1.2. Proxy section
22027---------------------
22028
22029use-fcgi-app <name>
22030 Define the FastCGI application to use for the backend.
22031
22032 Arguments :
22033 <name> is the name of the FastCGI application to use.
22034
22035 This keyword is only available for HTTP proxies with the backend capability
22036 and with at least one FastCGI server. However, FastCGI servers can be mixed
22037 with HTTP servers. But except there is a good reason to do so, it is not
22038 recommended (see section 10.3 about the limitations for details). Only one
22039 application may be defined at a time per backend.
22040
22041 Note that, once a FastCGI application is referenced for a backend, depending
22042 on the configuration some processing may be done even if the request is not
22043 sent to a FastCGI server. Rules to set parameters or pass headers to an
22044 application are evaluated.
22045
22046
2204710.1.3. Example
22048---------------
22049
22050 frontend front-http
22051 mode http
22052 bind *:80
22053 bind *:
22054
22055 use_backend back-dynamic if { path_reg ^/.+\.php(/.*)?$ }
22056 default_backend back-static
22057
22058 backend back-static
22059 mode http
22060 server www A.B.C.D:80
22061
22062 backend back-dynamic
22063 mode http
22064 use-fcgi-app php-fpm
22065 server php-fpm A.B.C.D:9000 proto fcgi
22066
22067 fcgi-app php-fpm
22068 log-stderr global
22069 option keep-conn
22070
22071 docroot /var/www/my-app
22072 index index.php
22073 path-info ^(/.+\.php)(/.*)?$
22074
22075
2207610.2. Default parameters
22077------------------------
22078
22079A Responder FastCGI application has the same purpose as a CGI/1.1 program. In
22080the CGI/1.1 specification (RFC3875), several variables must be passed to the
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +050022081script. So HAProxy set them and some others commonly used by FastCGI
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +020022082applications. All these variables may be overwritten, with caution though.
22083
22084 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
22085 | AUTH_TYPE | Identifies the mechanism, if any, used by HAProxy |
22086 | | to authenticate the user. Concretely, only the |
22087 | | BASIC authentication mechanism is supported. |
22088 | | |
22089 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
22090 | CONTENT_LENGTH | Contains the size of the message-body attached to |
22091 | | the request. It means only requests with a known |
22092 | | size are considered as valid and sent to the |
22093 | | application. |
22094 | | |
22095 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
22096 | CONTENT_TYPE | Contains the type of the message-body attached to |
22097 | | the request. It may not be set. |
22098 | | |
22099 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
22100 | DOCUMENT_ROOT | Contains the document root on the remote host under |
22101 | | which the script should be executed, as defined in |
22102 | | the application's configuration. |
22103 | | |
22104 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
22105 | GATEWAY_INTERFACE | Contains the dialect of CGI being used by HAProxy |
22106 | | to communicate with the FastCGI application. |
22107 | | Concretely, it is set to "CGI/1.1". |
22108 | | |
22109 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
22110 | PATH_INFO | Contains the portion of the URI path hierarchy |
22111 | | following the part that identifies the script |
22112 | | itself. To be set, the directive "path-info" must |
22113 | | be defined. |
22114 | | |
22115 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
22116 | PATH_TRANSLATED | If PATH_INFO is set, it is its translated version. |
22117 | | It is the concatenation of DOCUMENT_ROOT and |
22118 | | PATH_INFO. If PATH_INFO is not set, this parameters |
22119 | | is not set too. |
22120 | | |
22121 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
22122 | QUERY_STRING | Contains the request's query string. It may not be |
22123 | | set. |
22124 | | |
22125 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
22126 | REMOTE_ADDR | Contains the network address of the client sending |
22127 | | the request. |
22128 | | |
22129 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
22130 | REMOTE_USER | Contains the user identification string supplied by |
22131 | | client as part of user authentication. |
22132 | | |
22133 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
22134 | REQUEST_METHOD | Contains the method which should be used by the |
22135 | | script to process the request. |
22136 | | |
22137 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
22138 | REQUEST_URI | Contains the request's URI. |
22139 | | |
22140 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
22141 | SCRIPT_FILENAME | Contains the absolute pathname of the script. it is |
22142 | | the concatenation of DOCUMENT_ROOT and SCRIPT_NAME. |
22143 | | |
22144 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
22145 | SCRIPT_NAME | Contains the name of the script. If the directive |
22146 | | "path-info" is defined, it is the first part of the |
22147 | | URI path hierarchy, ending with the script name. |
22148 | | Otherwise, it is the entire URI path. |
22149 | | |
22150 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
22151 | SERVER_NAME | Contains the name of the server host to which the |
22152 | | client request is directed. It is the value of the |
22153 | | header "Host", if defined. Otherwise, the |
22154 | | destination address of the connection on the client |
22155 | | side. |
22156 | | |
22157 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
22158 | SERVER_PORT | Contains the destination TCP port of the connection |
22159 | | on the client side, which is the port the client |
22160 | | connected to. |
22161 | | |
22162 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
22163 | SERVER_PROTOCOL | Contains the request's protocol. |
22164 | | |
22165 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
Christopher Fauletb2a50292021-06-11 13:34:42 +020022166 | SERVER_SOFTWARE | Contains the string "HAProxy" followed by the |
22167 | | current HAProxy version. |
22168 | | |
22169 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +020022170 | HTTPS | Set to a non-empty value ("on") if the script was |
22171 | | queried through the HTTPS protocol. |
22172 | | |
22173 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
22174
22175
2217610.3. Limitations
22177------------------
22178
22179The current implementation have some limitations. The first one is about the
22180way some request headers are hidden to the FastCGI applications. This happens
22181during the headers analysis, on the backend side, before the connection
22182establishment. At this stage, HAProxy know the backend is using a FastCGI
22183application but it don't know if the request will be routed to a FastCGI server
22184or not. But to hide request headers, it simply removes them from the HTX
22185message. So, if the request is finally routed to an HTTP server, it never see
22186these headers. For this reason, it is not recommended to mix FastCGI servers
22187and HTTP servers under the same backend.
22188
22189Similarly, the rules "set-param" and "pass-header" are evaluated during the
22190request headers analysis. So the evaluation is always performed, even if the
22191requests is finally forwarded to an HTTP server.
22192
22193About the rules "set-param", when a rule is applied, a pseudo header is added
22194into the HTX message. So, the same way than for HTTP header rewrites, it may
22195fail if the buffer is full. The rules "set-param" will compete with
22196"http-request" ones.
22197
22198Finally, all FastCGI params and HTTP headers are sent into a unique record
22199FCGI_PARAM. Encoding of this record must be done in one pass, otherwise a
22200processing error is returned. It means the record FCGI_PARAM, once encoded,
22201must not exceeds the size of a buffer. However, there is no reserve to respect
22202here.
William Lallemand86d0df02017-11-24 21:36:45 +010022203
Emeric Brunce325c42021-04-02 17:05:09 +020022204
2220511. Address formats
22206-------------------
22207
22208Several statements as "bind, "server", "nameserver" and "log" requires an
22209address.
22210
22211This address can be a host name, an IPv4 address, an IPv6 address, or '*'.
22212The '*' is equal to the special address "0.0.0.0" and can be used, in the case
22213of "bind" or "dgram-bind" to listen on all IPv4 of the system.The IPv6
22214equivalent is '::'.
22215
22216Depending of the statement, a port or port range follows the IP address. This
22217is mandatory on 'bind' statement, optional on 'server'.
22218
22219This address can also begin with a slash '/'. It is considered as the "unix"
22220family, and '/' and following characters must be present the path.
22221
22222Default socket type or transport method "datagram" or "stream" depends on the
22223configuration statement showing the address. Indeed, 'bind' and 'server' will
22224use a "stream" socket type by default whereas 'log', 'nameserver' or
22225'dgram-bind' will use a "datagram".
22226
22227Optionally, a prefix could be used to force the address family and/or the
22228socket type and the transport method.
22229
22230
Daniel Corbette95f3072023-01-17 18:32:31 -05002223111.1. Address family prefixes
22232-----------------------------
Emeric Brunce325c42021-04-02 17:05:09 +020022233
22234'abns@<name>' following <name> is an abstract namespace (Linux only).
22235
22236'fd@<n>' following address is a file descriptor <n> inherited from the
22237 parent. The fd must be bound and may or may not already be
22238 listening.
22239
22240'ip@<address>[:port1[-port2]]' following <address> is considered as an IPv4 or
22241 IPv6 address depending on the syntax. Depending
22242 on the statement using this address, a port or
22243 a port range may or must be specified.
22244
22245'ipv4@<address>[:port1[-port2]]' following <address> is always considered as
22246 an IPv4 address. Depending on the statement
22247 using this address, a port or a port range
22248 may or must be specified.
22249
22250'ipv6@<address>[:port1[-port2]]' following <address> is always considered as
22251 an IPv6 address. Depending on the statement
22252 using this address, a port or a port range
22253 may or must be specified.
22254
22255'sockpair@<n>' following address is the file descriptor of a connected unix
22256 socket or of a socketpair. During a connection, the initiator
22257 creates a pair of connected sockets, and passes one of them
22258 over the FD to the other end. The listener waits to receive
22259 the FD from the unix socket and uses it as if it were the FD
22260 of an accept(). Should be used carefully.
22261
22262'unix@<path>' following string is considered as a UNIX socket <path>. this
22263 prefix is useful to declare an UNIX socket path which don't
22264 start by slash '/'.
22265
22266
Daniel Corbette95f3072023-01-17 18:32:31 -05002226711.2. Socket type prefixes
22268--------------------------
Emeric Brunce325c42021-04-02 17:05:09 +020022269
22270Previous "Address family prefixes" can also be prefixed to force the socket
22271type and the transport method. The default depends of the statement using
22272this address but in some cases the user may force it to a different one.
22273This is the case for "log" statement where the default is syslog over UDP
22274but we could force to use syslog over TCP.
22275
22276Those prefixes were designed for internal purpose and users should
Willy Tarreaudc2b3f82023-01-16 12:07:12 +010022277instead use aliases of the next section "11.3 Protocol prefixes".
Emeric Brunce325c42021-04-02 17:05:09 +020022278
22279If users need one those prefixes to perform what they expect because
22280they can not configure the same using the protocol prefixes, they should
22281report this to the maintainers.
22282
22283'stream+<family>@<address>' forces socket type and transport method
22284 to "stream"
22285
22286'dgram+<family>@<address>' forces socket type and transport method
22287 to "datagram".
22288
22289
Daniel Corbette95f3072023-01-17 18:32:31 -05002229011.3. Protocol prefixes
22291-----------------------
Emeric Brunce325c42021-04-02 17:05:09 +020022292
22293'tcp@<address>[:port1[-port2]]' following <address> is considered as an IPv4
22294 or IPv6 address depending of the syntax but
22295 socket type and transport method is forced to
22296 "stream". Depending on the statement using
22297 this address, a port or a port range can or
22298 must be specified. It is considered as an alias
22299 of 'stream+ip@'.
22300
22301'tcp4@<address>[:port1[-port2]]' following <address> is always considered as
22302 an IPv4 address but socket type and transport
22303 method is forced to "stream". Depending on the
22304 statement using this address, a port or port
22305 range can or must be specified.
22306 It is considered as an alias of 'stream+ipv4@'.
22307
22308'tcp6@<address>[:port1[-port2]]' following <address> is always considered as
22309 an IPv6 address but socket type and transport
22310 method is forced to "stream". Depending on the
22311 statement using this address, a port or port
22312 range can or must be specified.
22313 It is considered as an alias of 'stream+ipv4@'.
22314
22315'udp@<address>[:port1[-port2]]' following <address> is considered as an IPv4
22316 or IPv6 address depending of the syntax but
22317 socket type and transport method is forced to
22318 "datagram". Depending on the statement using
22319 this address, a port or a port range can or
22320 must be specified. It is considered as an alias
22321 of 'dgram+ip@'.
22322
22323'udp4@<address>[:port1[-port2]]' following <address> is always considered as
22324 an IPv4 address but socket type and transport
22325 method is forced to "datagram". Depending on
22326 the statement using this address, a port or
22327 port range can or must be specified.
Willy Tarreau26460482023-01-16 12:11:38 +010022328 It is considered as an alias of 'dgram+ipv4@'.
Emeric Brunce325c42021-04-02 17:05:09 +020022329
22330'udp6@<address>[:port1[-port2]]' following <address> is always considered as
22331 an IPv6 address but socket type and transport
22332 method is forced to "datagram". Depending on
22333 the statement using this address, a port or
22334 port range can or must be specified.
Willy Tarreau26460482023-01-16 12:11:38 +010022335 It is considered as an alias of 'dgram+ipv4@'.
Emeric Brunce325c42021-04-02 17:05:09 +020022336
22337'uxdg@<path>' following string is considered as a unix socket <path> but
22338 transport method is forced to "datagram". It is considered as
22339 an alias of 'dgram+unix@'.
22340
22341'uxst@<path>' following string is considered as a unix socket <path> but
22342 transport method is forced to "stream". It is considered as
22343 an alias of 'stream+unix@'.
22344
22345In future versions, other prefixes could be used to specify protocols like
22346QUIC which proposes stream transport based on socket of type "datagram".
22347
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010022348/*
22349 * Local variables:
22350 * fill-column: 79
22351 * End:
22352 */